Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Dark Dungeons X PDF

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 410

D ark

D ungeons X

10
th n g s
An i
at eon
Ed niver o p
r
o ng
itio sa c u
n ry In er D
r k
Da
d her ear to
sa tio n, an d ev er so gently presse
nver
eir whispered co
m pa ni on s to ge t them to stop th la ng ua ge.
frantically at her
co ng dead
Black Leaf waved t so un ds of chanting in a lo ingly oblivi-
co ul d ju st m ake out the fa in
ng as O er ic sto mped back seem
e ci
the door. Sh safe distance; win
p, an d m ot io ne d them back to a
grou
to the rest of the
She turned back w ar m ou r was making.
ise his ne
ous to all the no
from the door; be able to
w hi sp ered af te r creeping away d attack, we should
it gu ys !” sh e e bu rs t in an
“Okay, this is ing the ritual. If
w
th ro ug h th er e; and he’s just start
is
of it, that priest
“From the sounds stop the priest.
rescue the kids be
fore...”
t w ou ld ha pp en if they didn’t
wha
to. They all knew iet and reas-
he r se nt en ce . She didn’t need ns io n in her usual qu
di dn ’t fini sh br ok e th e te
Black Leaf before Gretchen
as th ey w er e al l lost in thought,
ce
f moment of silen against those
There was a brie al l fought very well
t w e
suring way : e all scar ed ; bu you be on the
be fo re , and I know we’r w e ca n do this. Elfstar —
rt of th in g d I kn ow have a good
ne of us have done this so a m em be r of this team, an ardi ng th e place and you
“Okay, I kn ow no e proud to be may be gu follow us in
in he re. You make m ve n’t se en them yet, so they rt figh tin g. Black Leaf —
goblins on th e w ay about. W e ha in an d sta . Al — You
th os e sk el et on s that we heard O er ic — yo u and I will charge e if yo u ca n sta b him in the back
look out fo r away from us . then se
able to keep them cupied with us;
chance of being e th e ki ds w hi le the priest is oc w he ne ve r it seems best.
sn ea k arou nd and releas d I’l l tr us t yo u to use it
and try to hang back an
magic yet, so you
haven’t used your
Then let’s go.
Everyone ready?
as fighting to
ed in and she w
3... 2... 1... NO
W!” enaline had kick
te r the others. Adr
into the room af
nt ro l he r br ea thing as she ran
to co d an orcish body
-
Black Leaf tried d. t at him. He ha
an d co nt ro lle ch ar ge d strai gh
keep calm e dwarven wom
an
ri se as th e la rg e warrior and th rs .
st look up in surp ding the prisone ept towards the
She saw the prie — th ere w as another orc guar of the room and cr
m n it e sid e
guard, an d — da shadow s at th ipping behind
Le af ducked into the jo in in the main fight. Sl
the char ge , B la ck post and go in g to r. As she did so
e of the distraction of tw ee n keeping at his at he r ba nds of his armou
Taking ad va nt ag ly di th er in g be betwee n th e le ard, and slam
di ng th e pr iso ne rs. He was foolish t w ith he r da gg er; forcing it up , cu rv e ro un d the priest’s bodygu
orc guar him in the gu om
ck Leaf stabbed eak across the ro disperse.
him unseen, Bla nd of m ag ic al glowing force str
al en er gi es he w as summoning to
made of some ki agic
she saw an arrow d causing the m
lm et ; m ak in g him stumble an
s he
into the side of hi
all...
ld succeed, after
Maybe they wou

Baroness Black lo
oked at herself in
it now. And it w the mirror and ad
as worth the expe mired her reflectio
nse. The queen he n. The dress had
rself had commen cost her a small fo
Just yesterday sh ted on it during rtune, but she co
e’d been plain ol th e investiture cere uld afford
d Black Leaf. Bu mony.
t now she was a
Well, that wasn’ baroness. And al
t strictly true. Th l for slaying a dr
and that assassin e dragon was just agon.
cult that they’d de th e latest thing they
stroyed; and the ’d done for King
vampire with th Elberet. There w
She shuddered at e undead army.. as also the matte
the memory of th . r of the trolls;
Luckily, Elfstar e undead army.
had been able to U ndead really wer
icy touch and fe revive her before en’t her thing an
el her life being she turned into d she’d actually di
sucked from her. one herself; but ed fighting those
she still had nigh awful spectres.
Black Leaf shook tm ares where she co
herself out of her uld feel their
absurdity of find reverie, and got
ing armour and ch anged out of her
fool, and the po weapons more co finery into more
sh new titles that mfortable than comfortable garb
dangerous and un they’d all received fancy dresses. St ; chuckling to he
tamed. They wer had come with ill , th ere was work to rself at the
were supposed to e going to need to adjacent land gr be done. The king
be meeting with work together if an ts. Land that was, was no
at the maps befo the royal cartogra they were going not coincidental
rehand to make ph er tonight — an to cl ear the land and ly, wild,
sure there were no d Black Leaf was attract settlers; an
big surprises in sto damned if she w d they
re. asn’t going to sn
eak a look
Countess Black lis
tened to the villa
banditry had no ge elder’s plea. H
w been brought e was very gratef
muscle to raid to un der control. How ul for the extra gu
wns and then selli ever, the remaini ards that she’d as
ng the trade good ng bandits had signed to the area
s — and slaves — allied with a loca , and the petty
The countess sighe th at the orcs acquired l orc tribe: using
d. With Lord Th . The guards wer the orcs as
didn’t want to hi alx testing her bo e simply not able
re the Grey Eagl rders at every tu to cope.
e mercenaries ag rn she had hard
ain after the trou ly the army to sp
She held up her ble that Count O are as it was; an
hand for the elde eric had had with d she certainly
r to be quiet, an them.
d beckoned over
“Jabe, go see the her herald.
new sheriff and
orcs and bandits find out what the go
, so we’re looking ing rate is for ad
over 2,000 gold for reasonable ex venturers these da
then come back perience — we do ys. We only need
you’re doing, so an d check with me fi n’t need to pay for dr a bunch that ca
I’ll leave it up to rst, otherwise go agon slayers or an n take out
up to. If the band yo u to work out how ah ea d and make it kn ything silly like th
its have been selli to find adventur own that we’re hi at. If it’s
adventurers to re ng slaves, we may ers without aler ri ng . Yo u kn ow
port to me before need to follow th ting the bandits what
they set off.” is up by checking that we know w
out who they’re hat they’re
selling them to -
so get the

and smiled.
hi rl in g vo rt ex of energy below
e at the w
over the precipic
Black Leaf looked n climb down, no
problem.”
er ha ng bu t I ca
a bit of an ov
she said, “There’s
“No problem.”,
ly turned pale.
Her face sudden rest of the party.
te d — po in ting behind the of tentacles the siz
e
H AT is a prob lem!”, she sh ou
ng th e co rn er, each one a ball
“But T di
ng creatures roun
e sh oc ke d to se e a swarm of flyi
ound and wer
The other spun ar me kind of spell.
of a man. loys iu s an d sta rted preparing so
dA
oyed...” muttere
do es n’t w an t this artefact destr
ne
“Looks like someo

Black Leaf ’s spir


it form flew down
and surveyed th
e scene.
Her followers ha
d quite an army
battle. Those gnol down there, and
ls were tough, an they looked like
d unusually orga they would need
nised. all the help they
She knew why, of could get if they
course. Grakklak were to win the
his creations to un Bonegnawer had
ite their tribes. Sh been doing his be
people’s lands. U e respected that, st to inspire his ra
nfortunately her and had told him ce to greatness, an
attempts at dipl so. But she wasn’ d had worked ha
omacy with the t going to let the rd to get
Black Leaf though Im m ortal patron of gn gn ol l empire march ov
t briefly about ap olls had failed, so er her
be no match for pearing in her m here she was.
her Immortal po anifest form and
directly interferin wer. The though routing the gnolls
g on the prime pl t quickly passed. herself. After all,
ane would cause Th ere would be man even an army of
her no end of trou y eyes watching gnolls would
No, there were on bl e... th is battle, and be
ly two choices. Sh ing caught
oracular advice e could appear as
from, Azelda the Might
them to retreat an and hope that Azelda could help y, a mortal dragon
body that she do
d fight another turn the tide of ba nned occasionally
mistake to make. day. Flying over ttle; or she could to dispense
His famed troll-s the enemy lines, appear in a visio
the other front in masher brigade sh e realised that Gra n to her priests an
his battle. Trust wasn’t here and kklak had over d warn
a barbarian to at neither was Urlak extended himself;
tack on two fron , his preferred m a serious
Although he had ts at the same tim ortal form. They
no reason to know e, overconfident must be aiding
dragon would he that Azelda was as always.
lp the Halderite really one of Bla
s in their time of ck Leaf ’s mortal
need and prepar forms, he really
With a smile, Bla ed for her to be should have know
ck Leaf flew into in this fight. Not n that the
and help them w a nearby cave an do in g so was a bad m
in the battle at th d shifted form to ist ake.
make another, an e cost of Azelda’s her mortal dragon
d she was confide life. It was worth body. She would
nt that Grakkla losing the form to lead the army fr
k wouldn’t try an set such an exam om the front,
ything while she ple for them. She
was recovering. could easily
Table of Contents
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats.................................67
Part 1 – The Basics of the Game...............7 Starting Weapon Feats...................................................... 67
Gaining Weapon Feats...................................................... 67
Chapter 1 - What is Dark Dungeons.................. 9 Effects of Proficiency........................................................ 67
What Is an Rpg?................................................................. 9 Opponent Types............................................................... 67
How Do You Play?........................................................... 10 Ammunition & Loading................................................... 67
Dark, Darker, Darkest...................................................... 10 Weapon List..................................................................... 67
Weapon Abilities............................................................... 89
Chapter 2 - Into Dark Dungeons..................... 13
Rags to Riches.................................................................. 13 Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting................... 93
An Adventurer’s Life......................................................... 13 Spell Levels....................................................................... 93
The First Adventures......................................................... 13 Acquiring Spells................................................................ 93
Expanding Horizons......................................................... 13 Spell Domains & Types.................................................... 96
Power & Responsibility.................................................... 14 Preparing Spells................................................................ 99
A New Playground........................................................... 14 Reversible Spells............................................................... 99
A New Beginning............................................................. 14 Casting Spells................................................................. 100
The Rest of the Book........................................................ 14 Saving Throws................................................................ 100
Conflicting Spells........................................................... 100
Chapter 3 - Basic Game Concepts.................... 15 Alphabetical Spell List.................................................... 100
Dice................................................................................. 15
Checks............................................................................. 15 Part 3 – Playing the Game....................143
Creature Attributes........................................................... 16
Ability Scores.................................................................... 16 Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure............. 145
Fighting............................................................................ 17 Money............................................................................ 145
Attack Bonus.................................................................... 17 Starting Money.............................................................. 145
Armour Class.................................................................... 17 Encumbrance................................................................. 145
Hit Points......................................................................... 18 Mundane Items.............................................................. 145
Saving Throws.................................................................. 18 Weapons......................................................................... 147
Experience and Levels....................................................... 18 Armour........................................................................... 149
Character Classes.............................................................. 18 Land Transport............................................................... 150
Sea Transport.................................................................. 152
Part 2 – Characters & Their Abilities..... 21 Buildings & Dungeons................................................... 154
Services.......................................................................... 156
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character..................... 23 Siege Weaponry.............................................................. 159
Step by Step Process......................................................... 23
Cleric............................................................................... 24 Chapter 9 - Dungeon Delving........................ 163
Clockwork........................................................................ 27 Time & Movement......................................................... 163
Druid............................................................................... 30 Light & Darkness........................................................... 163
Dwarf............................................................................... 34 Noticing Things............................................................. 164
Elf.................................................................................... 36 Doors............................................................................. 165
Fighter.............................................................................. 39 Traps.............................................................................. 165
Halfling.............................................................................41 Environmental Damage.................................................. 166
Lupine.............................................................................. 44 Wandering Monsters....................................................... 167
Magic-user....................................................................... 49 Encounters..................................................................... 167
Mountebank......................................................................51 Mapping........................................................................ 169
Thief................................................................................. 54

Chapter 5 - Ability Checks & Skills................. 59


Ability Checks.................................................................. 59
Modifiers.......................................................................... 60
Using Skills...................................................................... 60
Special Skills......................................................................61
Adding New Skills.............................................................61
Alphabetical Skill List........................................................61

4
Table of Contents
Chapter 10 - Combat......................................171 Chapter 13 - Settling Down........................... 203
Surprise...........................................................................171 Titles of Nobility............................................................ 203
The Combat Round.........................................................171 Rogue States................................................................... 205
Statement of Intent.........................................................171 Building a Stronghold.................................................... 205
Initiative......................................................................... 172 Terrain & Resources....................................................... 206
Actions........................................................................... 172 Settled Terrain................................................................ 206
Attack Rolls.................................................................... 175 Material Resources......................................................... 206
Attack Modifiers............................................................. 176 Ruling a Dominion........................................................ 207
Armour Class Modifiers.................................................. 177 Seasonal Economy Check............................................... 207
Missile Weapons in Melee.............................................. 177 Experience for Income.................................................... 210
Haste & Slow................................................................. 177 Public Works.................................................................. 210
Two Weapon Fighting.................................................... 178 Confidence Level.............................................................211
Damage.......................................................................... 178 Yearly Confidence Check.................................................211
Effects of Damage.......................................................... 179 Events............................................................................. 213
Helpless Targets.............................................................. 179
Dying & Death.............................................................. 179 Chapter 14 - War!........................................... 215
Structures in Combat..................................................... 180 Armies............................................................................ 215
Morale............................................................................ 180 Capability Score............................................................. 215
Rank.............................................................................. 215
Chapter 11 - Getting Better........................... 183 Battle Rating.................................................................. 216
Healing Damage............................................................. 183 Battles............................................................................ 216
Preventing Dying........................................................... 183 Battle Turns.................................................................... 216
Bringing the Dead Back................................................. 183 Resolving the Clash........................................................ 219
Restoring the Petrified.................................................... 183
Restoring Life Energy..................................................... 184 Chapter 15 - Out of This World......................221
Gaining Experience........................................................ 184 Overview.........................................................................221
Gaining Levels................................................................ 184 The Void......................................................................... 222
Learning Weapon Feats.................................................. 185 The Celestial Sphere........................................................ 224
Learning New Spells....................................................... 185 The Inner Planes............................................................. 225
The Ethereal Plane.......................................................... 225
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World................ 189 The Elemental Planes...................................................... 226
Maps & Hexes................................................................ 189 The Outer Planes............................................................ 227
Overland Movement...................................................... 189 Luminiferous Aether...................................................... 228
Mixed Terrain................................................................. 190
Fatigue........................................................................... 190 Chapter 16 - Questing for Immortality...........231
Getting Lost................................................................... 190 What Is an Immortal?......................................................231
Foraging......................................................................... 192 The Three Forms..............................................................231
Waterborne Movement................................................... 192 Becoming an Immortal................................................... 232
Wind & Storms.............................................................. 193 Worshippers.................................................................... 233
Becalmed........................................................................ 193 Home Plane................................................................... 233
Storms............................................................................ 193 Appearance..................................................................... 233
Lost At Sea..................................................................... 193 Embodied Form Powers................................................. 234
Ship to Ship Combat...................................................... 193 Favoured Domains......................................................... 236
Boarding Actions............................................................ 194
Damage to Ships............................................................ 194
Repairing Ships.............................................................. 194
Airborne Movement....................................................... 194
Mounts & Devices......................................................... 194
Skysailing....................................................................... 194
Take Off & Landing....................................................... 196
Leaving the Planet.......................................................... 196
Skysailing Combat......................................................... 196
Wilderness Encounters................................................... 197
Castles............................................................................ 197
Encounter Balance.......................................................... 198

5
Table of Contents
Chapter 17 - Immortals................................. 239 Chapter 20 - Artifacts......................................381
Immortality & Death..................................................... 239 Finding an Artifact..........................................................381
Level & Experience........................................................ 239 Using an Artifact.............................................................381
Spending Experience...................................................... 239 Destroying an Artifact.....................................................381
Power Reserve..................................................................241 Creating an Artifact........................................................ 382
Skills...............................................................................241 Power Reserve................................................................. 382
Vessels, Avatars, and Forms..............................................241 Artifact Powers............................................................... 382
Greater and Lesser Avatars...............................................241 Handicaps & Penalties................................................... 393
Forms & Abilities........................................................... 243
Spirit Form..................................................................... 243 Chapter 21 - Game Master Advice................. 395
Mortal Form................................................................... 243 Character Aging............................................................. 395
Manifest Form................................................................ 243 Creating a Setting........................................................... 395
Aura............................................................................... 245 Crafting Magic Items..................................................... 396
Aura Combat.................................................................. 245 Constructs...................................................................... 397
Immortal Level Spells..................................................... 247 Conversion..................................................................... 397

Part 4 – Mastering the Game............... 255 Part 5 – Additional Material................ 401


Chapter 18 - Monsters....................................257 Index.............................................................. 403
Monster Format............................................................. 257
Open Game License....................................... 409
Chapter 19 - Treasure......................................357 Designation of Open Content........................................ 409
Treasure Types................................................................ 357 OPEN GAME LICENSE Version 1.0a.......................... 409
Items of Value................................................................ 357
Magic Items.................................................................... 359
Potions............................................................................361
Scrolls & Maps............................................................... 363
Wands, Staves & Rods.................................................... 366
Rings.............................................................................. 370
Wondrous Items............................................................. 372
Armour & Shields.......................................................... 376
Weapons & Ammunition............................................... 377

6
Part 1

The Basics of
the Game
Chapter 1 - What is Dark Dungeons

W
elcome to the Dark Dungeons table-top role-playing The game consists of trying to get the story to progress towards its
game! this book contains the rules of the game, and climax, often involving combat and problem solving.
the only other things that are needed to play are pencils,
paper and dice. Table-top role-playing games like Dark Dungeons have a similar
basis, except that the game is controlled by a human Game Master
If you already play table-top role-playing games (and particularly rather than by a computer, and rather than the action taking place
if you acquired this Dark Dungeons 10th anniversary edition be- on a computer screen the action takes place in the imaginations
cause you’re already a fan of Dark Dungeons) you can safely skip of the players.
this chapter.
While this may sound like a step backwards at first glance, it is
On the other hand, if you’re less familiar with what table-top role- much more flexible and adaptable. On a crpg, you are limited to
playing games (usually abbreviated to rpgs) are then some explana- telling the single story that the game designers wrote. You can’t go
tion may be in order. “off the map”. In a table-top role-playing game, however, you are
not limited to fixed stories. The Game Master and the players can
What Is an Rpg? between them create an infinite number of stories, limited only
Role-playing games have been around since the mid 1970’s. by their imaginations.

When they first started, they had their roots in war-gaming (mov- The Game Master can create whatever scenarios and situations they
ing model armies around in simulation of historical battles) and want to, and the players are not constrained to only doing what
descriptions of role-playing games would have used those war has been anticipated.
games, along with such childhood games as “cops and robbers”
and “cowboys and indians” as reference points. If they want their characters to do something, they don’t have to
simply hope that some designer wrote it into the game. They simply
However, now that we’re in the third decade of the 21st century, tell the Game Master what their character is trying to do and the
times – and cultural reference points – have changed. Game Master can improvise in a way that a computer never could
(although the rules and guidelines in this book cover most common
For most people today, the term “role playing game” is usually situations so that they can be handled in a consistent manner).
found abbreviated to “rpg” and is usually preceded by the letters
“c” (becoming “crpg” or “computer role playing game”) or “mmo” The other main difference between a table-top role-playing game
(becoming “mmorpg” or “massively multiplayer online role play- and a crpg is the social aspect. Although many crpgs allow the player
ing game”). to control a whole party of characters rather than just a single one,
they are still largely solitary affairs.
In this genre of computer games, the player takes on the role of a
character in an ongoing storyline – usually the main protagonist
of the story.

9
Chapter 1 - What is Dark Dungeons
Table-top role-playing games, on the other hand, are generally de- Unfortunately for me, my copy of the game I wanted to play was
signed for groups of players to play together and Dark Dungeons old and tatty and falling apart. Knowing that various people had
is no exception. made “retro-clones” of old editions of this game (newer fan-pro-
duced games that replicate the non-copyrightable rules of these
Although it can be played with only a single player and a Game older editions without reproducing the copyrighted artistic pres-
Master, it plays best with 3–8 players playing together, each con- entation of those rules), I went online to see if I could find one for
trolling a single character. my edition of choice.

Interaction between the characters controlled by the different play- I was disappointed to find that no-one had made one yet.
ers, as well as non-scripted interaction between the characters con-
trolled by players and characters controlled by the Game Master, is So I decided to make one of my own. Nine months and 500 hours
one of the chief elements of a table-top role-playing game. later, Dark Dungeons was finished. It’s proved rather popular in
the decade since it was released.
How Do You Play?
Before starting, one person will decide to be the Game Master. That When writing Dark Dungeons, I had many editorial choices to
person is responsible for establishing a setting for the game (either make. Some of them were forced on me by the nature of the edi-
creating their own or using a published one). tion that I was cloning. That edition itself was a compilation of a
number of earlier products, and was inconsistent in places where it
The other players create characters that live in that setting. The had compiled rules together or was ambiguous about how conflict-
characters have a set of abilities which represent their capabilities; ing rules worked together. When emulating the edition, I had to
for example how strong they are or what sort of magic they are resolve the inconsistencies and clean up the ambiguities – which
capable of using. led to there being minor differences between Dark Dungeons and
its source material.
Then, normal play consists of the Game Master describing the
situation that the characters find themselves in, and the players However, what I didn’t do (for the most part) was include my
responding by telling the Game Master what their characters are own house rules in the game. It was a bit strange. Although I was
doing. making the game for myself and would be using my house rules at
the table when playing it, I knew that other people would want to
In many situations, this is all that is required, but to provide struc- replicate the old edition as closely as possible. So I made a conscious
ture and consistency to the game, this book provides rules covering choice to avoid putting in house rules that would significantly
what characters can do in various situations. change the game.

Additionally, many situations involve random factors, where a Developer Commentary


character has a chance of successfully doing something (which may Throughout this book, you’ll see a number of “developer commentary”
vary depending on their abilities) rather than being automatically boxes like this one.
successful or relying on the Game Master’s whim; for example,
when fighting with monsters. These will contain information about the design decisions that went
into various rules, both for the original Dark Dungeons and for
In these situations, the rules tell you which type of dice to roll and this 10th anniversary edition.
how to interpret the results.
As well as their obvious informational purpose (which may or may not
Dark, Darker, Darkest be interesting to the average reader), these also hope to shed some light
This version of the game that you are holding in your hand (or into the intent behind some of the rules and especially some of the rules
viewing on a screen – this is the twenty first century after all – is that are different in this book than in the original source material.
the tenth anniversary edition of Dark Dungeons.

This needs some explanation... Once I’d released a clean version of Dark Dungeons, I then decided
to add my house rules. After all, I was primarily writing the game
(Warning, this section is pretty lengthy and self-indulgent, so feel for my own benefit; so I wanted to have a book that would reflect
free to skip it!) the game as I played it.

Ten years ago, I wanted to play a particular edition of the world’s So I added my house rules, and some other rule changes that I
most popular role-playing game. Unfortunately, for legal reasons I thought improved the game. Chiefly amongst the latter was a
can’t name it here; but anyone reading this far probably has a good change to the way many dice rolls in the game worked, which left
idea what edition of what game I’m talking about. If you’re one of them mathematically identical to the original game but made the
the minority that doesn’t, don’t worry – you don’t need to in order game much more consistent and easier to learn – especially for
to enjoy this game on its own merits. younger children, which was important because I was playing the
game with my children.

10
Chapter 1 - What is Dark Dungeons
This modified version of the game, which in my opinion was a time I contemplated adding to Darker Dungeons to make a second
better game but which was less faithful to the original edition, was edition of the game?
released under the name of Darker Dungeons.
The deciding factor for this was that the original edition that Dark
While finishing off Darker Dungeons I had an idea for a third game Dungeons emulated has now been made available once again. The
which added elements from another game to the mix. I mentioned very reason for Dark Dungeons’ writing and existence – to emulate
this (under the name of “Darkest Dungeons”) in the introduction that edition – no longer applies. Anyone wanting to play that edi-
to Darker Dungeons, but this third game never got completed or tion can simply buy a copy and doesn’t need to use Dark Dungeons
released. Not as part of Dark Dungeons, anyway. Eventually the instead.
game morphed into something very different and was released
under a different name entirely. So for the 10th anniversary edition of Dark Dungeons, I’m includ-
ing the material from Darker Dungeons in the game. This makes
So here we are ten years later, and I’m writing Dark Dungeons 10th Dark Dungeons into more of its own thing rather than a slavish
anniversary edition. And the question springs to mind – what do I emulation, means that for my own personal use it more closely
include in this edition? do I stick to the material in Dark Dungeons, reflects the game as played at my own table, and means that it neatly
keeping it close to the original edition that game emulated? do I replaces both Dark Dungeons and Darker Dungeons, combining
include the material in Darker Dungeons keeping it closer to the them into a single work.
game I actually play? do I include additional material that at one

11
Chapter 2 - Into Dark Dungeons
D
ark dungeons is a large book, and can seem rather intimi- Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting contains the rules for learn-
dating; especially if you haven’t played before. This chapter ing and casting spells, as well as a description of each spell.
explains the sort of things that Dark Dungeons characters
do over the course of their adventuring careers, and how the book The First Adventures
is laid out to mirror that story path. Before setting off on their first quest, most adventurers will want
to spend some of their money on equipment.
Rags to Riches
Adventurers start their careers as inexperienced and under-equipped Chapter 8 – Equipping for Adventure contains price lists and
novices. Over the course of their career, they will become far more descriptions of a wide variety of equipment and services that char-
powerful and capable – this capability being measured in terms of acters may wish to purchase.
their “level”. They start at 1st level and can reach as high as 30th
to 36th level before (hopefully) becoming immortals – whereupon Some of this – such as building castles – will be way out of the
another 36 levels of experience await them. league of starting adventurers, but the basic necessities like weap-
ons and lanterns and rope and so on will prove both affordable
Even at first level, adventurers are a cut above the normal person. and essential.
Adventurers are assumed to have been trained by (or undergone
apprenticeships to) older mentors. Therefore even at first level Starting adventurers may even wish to hire men-at-arms to ac-
they have a better than average ability to fight and maybe even company them on dangerous quests.
the ability to cast a simple spell or drive away minor undead with
the power of their faith. Once equipment has been bought, the adventurers are ready to go.

However, they are by no means the only people to have undergone Some stories may vary, but it is most common for low level adven-
this type of training. Town and city guards may be low level fight- turers who are just beginning their careers to start by doing small
ers, and a village may be looked after by a mid-level magic-user. jobs in their local area such as fighting bandits or local humanoid
tribes; or exploring local caves and ruins. Most of these initial jobs
Trained characters are more common in the upper echelons of and quests will not involve straying too far from civilisation and
society where there is less pressing need to work in a mundane job will involve underground exploration.
to put food on the table and where such training and experience
is considered good leadership material. Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving provides the rules and guidelines
for underground exploration; and Chapter 10 – Combat provides
Consequently, many castles and large temples are run by experi- the rules for fighting whatever dangers are found in those dungeons.
enced adventurers who have the wisdom and worldliness to know
what problems need an adventurer’s touch but lack the time to sort Of course, such fighting and exploration has its consequences.
the problems out themselves. Some adventurers will be injured; others will die. But those who
survive will emerge more experienced and hopefully richer.
Such characters make excellent patrons for new adventurers – and
many new adventurers aspire to achieve just such a position them- Chapter 11 – Getting Better provides the rules for how charac-
selves. ters recover from injuries – both magical and mundane – and even
death; and provides rules for the gaining of experience and conse-
An Adventurer’s Life quent increasing of levels. It also provides rules for how adventurers
Chapter 4 – Creating a Character takes you through the pro- can spend their new–found riches on improving their abilities.
cess of creating an adventuring character, and includes the special
rules that apply to the different classes of character. Expanding Horizons
After a few adventures, most adventuring parties start venturing
All characters will have certain abilities such as skills and weapon further afield.
feats, and some characters will also be able to cast spells. The next
three chapters of Dark Dungeons describe those abilities in detail. Whether through increased confidence or through necessity, they
will start exploring the dangerous wilderness that exists away from
Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills contains the rules for skill civilised areas. The dangers are greater in such areas, but so are the
use and a description of each individual skill, along with rules for potential rewards.
using checks on ability scores in circumstances where no particular
skill is appropriate. Chapter 12 – Into the Wider World contains the rules for
such exploration, and the rules for urban encounters for when
Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats contains information about what adventurers decide to visit big cities.
abilities a character can get with different weapons (and different
levels of expertise at using those weapons).

13
Chapter 2 - Into Dark Dungeons
At some point, the adventurers will want to join the ranks of the
Power & Responsibility immortals themselves. Doing so is never easy, and usually involves
By the time they reach 9th–11th level, adventurers have probably both finding an existing immortal willing to act as a sponsor and
made quite a name for themselves in their country, and are likely undergoing an extended quest to prove one’s worthiness. Chap-
to have come to the attention of the rulers of the land. ter 16 – Questing for Immortality provides details of this
process.
It is common at this time (although by no means universal – some
adventuring parties continue to wander for their entire career and A New Beginning
never settle down) for such adventurers to be granted titles of If everything goes right, eventually adventurers will achieve that
nobility and be expected to expand their liege’s country into the ultimate goal – they will have become immortals.
untamed wilderness.
This marks a new beginning for their adventuring careers. Although
At this point, the focus of the game switches from mostly adven- they no longer care about such mundane things as money and
turing to mostly politics with the occasional adventure. Chap- they are – even as newly fledged first level immortals – far more
ter 13 – Settling Down contains rules for both acquiring and powerful than most mortal creatures; they are still lowly compared
running fiefdoms and domains, including managing the economy to the more powerful immortals and creatures of the multiverse.
and both attracting (and managing the happiness of ) populace to
the new area. Adventuring at this level becomes much more freeform, with poli-
tics and exploration both playing a part. While most immortals en-
Of course, all the monsters in an area don’t simply get up and walk joy playing political games, others are more interested in meddling
away when someone plonks a castle down in their territories – so in the affairs of mortals; acting as patron for clerics and knights
they will need killing or driving out as the land is settled. and acting as protectors of whole races or even creating new races!

Similarly, rival nobles (from the same country or enemy states) may Other immortals prefer to wander the multiverse and explore the
also do their best to make sure that the new upstarts fail. new horizons that such exploring brings. Still others retire from
adventuring completely, and simply live a life of comfort and he-
All this means that life isn’t just throwing festivals and making sure donism free of mortal cares.
the books balance.
Chapter 17 – Immortals contains the rules for playing at im-
There is still plenty of intrigue and diplomacy, and if all else fails mortal levels. Whatever an immortal’s passion, immortality is the
there is always the possibility that things will erupt into open war- final reward for a lifetime of adventuring.
fare. Chapter 14 – War! contains the rules for armies and for
mass battles. The Rest of the Book
Beyond chapter 17, the rest of the book contains resources for the
A New Playground Game Master. This is not to say that you shouldn’t read them if
Eventually, adventurers will set their sights on higher goals than you’re not going to be the Game Master, but there is no reason
simple temporal power. Immortality is there for the taking! for you to do so and you may spoil surprises for yourself if you do.

Whether they have spent time ruling a domain or they have lived Chapter 18 – Monsters contains the abilities and descriptions
the life of a wanderer, particularly powerful adventurers can still of the various types of monster that may be encountered over an
find new places to explore. adventuring career.

The mundane world is not the only world in existence. There are Chapter 19 – Treasure contains information about the sort of
other worlds out there and even other planes of existence. At high treasure that might be found, and contains descriptions of many
levels, adventurers can explore these planes for knowledge and magical items that adventurers can find or even make during their
riches far beyond anything available at home. careers.

Chapter 15 – Out of this World provides descriptions of other Chapter 20 – Artifacts contains rules for the most powerful of
planes and of planar travelling. items. Artifacts can be made only by immortals and are too power-
ful for mortals to safely use. That doesn’t mean that mortals don’t
Of course, travelling the planes also means that adventurers will use them anyway, of course.
encounter threats and dangers far greater than they would ever see
on the mundane world. Finally, Chapter 21 – Game Master Advice contains miscel-
laneous other advice and tips for the Game Master that don’t fit
Adventurers will find themselves meeting immortals face-to-face into any other chapter.
and getting involved in their plots, along with the machinations
of other planar creatures.

14
Chapter 3 - Basic Game Concepts
T
he first two chapters of Dark Dungeons talked about what To “roll” a d2, roll any die and if the number shown is odd then
the game is and what the characters (and by extension the you “rolled” a 1. If the number shown is even then you “rolled” a 2.
players) do. This chapter talks about how you do it.
To “roll” a d3, roll a normal d6 and halve the result (rounding up).
Dice This will give you:
In Dark Dungeons, dice will be needed to resolve a lot of situa-
tions where the whims of fortune have an effect on the outcome 1–2 = 1
of a situation. As well as the traditional cubic dice numbered from 3–4 = 2
one to six, the game uses a variety of other dice of different shapes. 5–6 = 3
Since these each have different numbers of sides, they are often
called polyhedral dice. The same halving process can be used with a d10 in order to “roll”
a d5.
If you have already played other role playing games, you may al-
ready own some of these dice. If not, you can buy them at your To “roll” a d100, take two d10s that are easily distinguished and
friendly local game store or online. In order to distinguish between roll them both. Read one of them as the tens digit and the other
the different types of die that you can use, Dark Dungeons uses a as the units digit, although if both roll ‘0’ then the result is always
standard terminology throughout. treated as 100 rather than 00. Sometimes, particularly with older
dice sets, the two d10s will be different colours – in which case
Types of Die you need to say which will be tens and which will be units before
Each die is referred to using the letter ‘d’ followed by the number rolling. Most new dice sets include a special d10 which has tens
of sides that the die has. For example, a regular die with six sides already marked on it, so this always counts as the tens die.
is referred to as a ‘d6’, whereas a die with twenty sides is referred
to as a ‘d20’. If you only have one d10, simply roll it twice with the first roll
counting as the tens and the second roll counting as the units.

Multiple Dice
Often, you will need to roll more than one die at the same time.
In this case, there will be a number before the ‘d’ as well as after it.

The number before the ‘d’ shows how many dice must be rolled. If
this number is one then it is sometimes skipped.

When rolling multiple dice in this way, simply add the numbers
rolled on each die together in order to generate a single result.

Therefore if you are told to roll “3d6”, you should roll three six
sided dice and add the numbers rolled together. If you are told
to roll “2d8”, you should roll two eight sided dice and add the
numbers rolled together. If you are told to roll “d4”, then this is
exactly the same as being told to roll “1d4”, and you should roll
A normal set of polyhedral dice comes with a four-sided die, a six- a single four sided die.
sided die, an eight-sided die, one or two ten-sided dice, a twelve-
sided die, and a twenty-sided die – or, to use dark dungeon’s termi- Dice Modifiers
nology, a d4, a d6, a d8, one or two d10s, a d12 and a d20. Sometimes rolls will have additional modifiers. These are straight-
forward and are simply added or subtracted from the total rolled.
Therefore, if the rules say that you roll a d20 for something, they
mean that you should roll the die with twenty sides. If they say For example, if instructed to roll “2d6+4”, roll two six sided dice
that you roll a d8 for something, they mean that you should roll and add the numbers rolled together; and then add four to the
the die with eight sides. If they say that you roll a d6 for something, result. If instructed to roll “1d8–1”, roll a single eight sided die
they mean that you should roll the die with six sides. And so on. and subtract one from the number rolled.

There are a small number of special cases where there is not a single Checks
die that fits the roll that is needed. Sometimes you will be asked The most common type of die roll in Dark Dungeons is a check.
to roll a d2, d3 or d100. This type of roll us used for attacking, using skills, defending against
magic, and various other things throughout the game.
In these cases, you must roll one or more other dice and interpret
the result.

15
Chapter 3 - Basic Game Concepts
To make a check, take your relevant score (when you are asked to
make a check you will be told which score to use) and add any Ability Scores
modifiers that you are asked to add. Then roll a d20 and add that The innate abilities of player characters are described by six values,
to the total. called ability scores.

If the total is 20 or higher, then the check has succeeded. If the These represent the core abilities of the character and rarely change.
total is less than 20, then the check has failed. These values are strength, intelligence, wisdom, dexterity, constitu-
tion and charisma. In normal humans (and demi-humans), these
Example: Marcie has said that she wishes Black Leaf (her thief ability scores will normally range from a minimum of 3 to a maxi-
character) to climb up the wall of the palace tower and in through mum of 18, with the average being 11. As player characters are
the window. To see if Black Leaf succeeds or not, Marcie will have to assumed to be above average for their race, they start with scores
make a climb walls check. ranging from 9 to 16.

To make the check, she first looks on her character sheet to see what These ability scores show the strengths and weaknesses of the char-
Black Leaf ’s “climb walls” ability is. It is a +17. acter, and are used as target numbers for various tasks (see Chap-
ter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for more details). Additionally,
The Game Master tells Marcie that because it is raining the wall each score also has one or more bonuses or penalties associated with
will be wet and somewhat slippery, so there will be a –2 penalty to it that are used to modify other die rolls and checks. Table 3–1
the check. shows the modifiers for different ability score values (it includes
values much higher than 18, since immortal characters may have
Therefore, to make the check, Marcie must roll: much higher ability scores than normal humans).

17 – 2 + 1d20 Strength (abbreviated to “Str”)


Strength needs little explanation. It represents the raw muscle power
Marcie rolls the die, and to her horror rolls only a 3. Since 17 – 2 of a character. Strength checks are made when trying to perform
+ 3 = 18, which is less than 20, the check has failed. Black Leaf is tasks that rely on raw bodily strength rather than skill, for example
unable to find suitable hand holds in the wet stone and is unable to when trying to break down doors. Strength bonuses and penal-
climb the wall. ties apply to a character’s melee attacks, and to the damage that a
character does with melee or hurled weapons.

Creature Attributes Intelligence (abbreviated to “Int”)


Creatures (including people) in Dark Dungeons are split into two Intelligence represents the memory and reasoning power of a char-
broad categories, player characters (often abbreviated to “PCs”), acter. Characters with a high intelligence will be able to perform
which are the adventurers controlled by the players; and monsters difficult calculations and make deductive leaps, whereas those with
which are the other creatures and people in the world controlled lower intelligence will only do such things more slowly if at all. In-
by the Game Master. telligence checks are used in a variety of situations where characters
need to reason things out or remember things, particularly with
Although creatures and characters controlled by the Game Master academic or formally taught knowledge.
are referred to collectively as monsters, they are not necessarily
particularly monstrous or hostile. Some of them are simply neutral Wisdom (abbreviated to “Wis”)
characters and even allies of the player characters that are controlled Wisdom represents a combination of intuition, common sense, and
by the Game Master. spirituality. To a lesser extent, wisdom also represents the percep-
tiveness of a character and their ability to notice subtle clues and
Intelligent monsters, particularly ones that the players interact with things out of place.
socially as opposed to fighting, are often referred to as non-player
characters (abbreviated to “NPCs”). Characters with high wisdom are likely to possess these traits, and
be level headed, whereas those with lower wisdom may be rash or
Since the varying capabilities of different creatures and characters act without thinking.
can have a large impact on the success or failure of various actions
that the players wish their characters to take, these capabilities are Wisdom checks are used in situations where characters must notice
recorded as (mostly numeric) values and traits that can be used to something, and wisdom bonuses or penalties apply to characters’
modify or provide target numbers for die rolls, or to determine saving throws against spells.
what sort of actions are possible.
Dexterity (abbreviated to “Dex”)
Since player characters play the largest part in the game and are Dexterity represents the co-ordination and agility of a character, as
the centre of most of the action, they have the most attributes. well as the speed of their reflexes. Characters with a high dexterity
Monsters that are expected to only be in the game for a short while will be agile and graceful, whereas those with a lower dexterity may
(for example a single fight) are described in less detail.

16
Chapter 3 - Basic Game Concepts
be clumsy and awkward. Dexterity checks are used when a character orators, whereas those with lower charisma may be boring or find
must do something involving balance or fine manipulation. it hard to communicate.

Dexterity penalties or bonuses are applied to a character’s attacks On a physical level, charisma is unrelated to how attractive a charac-
with thrown or missile weapons, and also to their armour class. ter looks; although charismatic individuals often have better bearing
Dexterity also provides a bonus or penalty to initiative. and confidence which enhances their attractiveness.

Table 3–1: Ability Score Bonuses & Penalties Charisma checks are often used in social situations. Charisma also
Ability Score Ability Score provides limits on a character’s leadership potential and provides
Value Modifier a special bonus or penalty to the reactions of monsters that the
1 –4 character meets.

2–3 –3 Fighting
4–5 –2 When it comes to fighting, time is divided up into rounds, each
6–8 –1 of which represents ten seconds of combat. This results in a level
of abstraction where the game does not attempt to model every
9–12 +0
single thrust, parry and cut.
13–15 +1
16–17 +2 In a single round, most characters and other creatures will make a
18–19 +3 single “attack”. Although this is resolved as a single check, an at-
tack does not represent a single swing of a sword or a single punch.
20–21 +4
During a round, a character will swing repeatedly and also block,
22–23 +5 parry and manoeuvre.
24–27 +6
28–32 +7 Instead, the attack check represents the sum total of this activity
(although some characters and creatures may get more than one roll
33–38 +8 if they are particularly effective in combat). The attacker’s attack
39–45 +9 bonus is used for the check, and the check is modified by defender’s
46–53 +10 armour class (sometimes with various other modifiers – see Chap-
ter 10 – Combat for more details); and a successful attack check
54–62 +11
means that the attacker has “hit” the defender.
63–70 +12
71–77 +13 In the same way that an attack check does not necessarily represent
78–83 +14 a single swing of the sword, a “hit” does not necessarily represent
a solid blow with a weapon.
84–88 +15
89–93 +16 A hit in combat represents a potentially lethal blow. If a defender
94–96 +17 is inexperienced or badly weakened and exhausted, it may indeed
97–98 +18 kill them or knock them unconscious. However, a defender who
is fresh and experienced is able to partially or wholly avoid the
99 +19 blow, although not without cost. The hit points of the target will
100 +20 be reduced.

Constitution (abbreviated to “Con”) Attack Bonus


Constitution represents the toughness and general healthiness of A character or creature’s attack bonus represents their combat skill.
a character. Characters with a high constitution are likely to be fit For player characters it is based on their level and class. For mon-
and healthy, whereas those with a low constitution are more likely sters it is based on their hit dice. Attack bonuses start at +0, which
to get ill and get winded easily. represents a person or monster who is completely unskilled and
unused to combat, and increase with increasing ability, to a maxi-
Constitution checks are rarely made, although might be in some mum of +50 or more.
circumstances where stamina and endurance are important. Con-
stitution bonuses or penalties are applied to the hit point rolls that Armour Class
a character gains each level. A character or creature’s armour class represents how hard they are
to hit in combat. Remember, a “hit” in combat does not represent
Charisma (abbreviated to “Chr”) a single solid blow with a weapon but instead represents one or
Charisma represents the likeability and force of personality of a more potentially lethal blows.
character. Characters with a high charisma are born leaders and

17
Chapter 3 - Basic Game Concepts
Armour makes these potentially lethal blows less likely, and there- A saving throw is rolled as a normal check, and is made using the
fore makes it harder for an attack roll to score a hit. Again, this character’s relevant saving throw bonus. There is rarely a modifier
is abstracted and does not represent the armour making it harder to this check, although a character’s saving throw bonuses will
to actually hit the character, merely making it harder to score a increase as they increase in level.
potentially lethal blow.
Although rods, staffs and spells are covered by the same saving
The armour class of a “standard” warrior wearing suit armour is 0, throw, player characters only add their wisdom bonus (or penalty)
and characters wearing less armour have armour classes that are when this saving throw is used against spells.
represented by positive numbers (representing a bonus to an at-
tacker’s rolls) whereas characters wearing more armour have armour Developer Commentary
classes that are represented by negative numbers (representing a In the original edition of Dark Dungeons (and in the original game
penalty to an attacker’s rolls). It is important to always remember that Dark Dungeons is based on), saving throws were handled in
that a lower armour class is better; this is why a character’s dexterity a different way to attack rolls and skill checks. Instead of having a
bonus is subtracted from their armour class, rather than added to it. bonus that you then add a d20 roll to and try to get a total of 20+,
you instead had a variable target number that you had to roll higher
Hit Points than on a d20.
The ability of a character or creature to avoid potentially lethal
damage – whether in or out of combat – is represented by their The change to making saving throws (and various other rolls such
hit points. These hit points indicate a combination of skill, luck, as those a thief needs to make to use their skills and those that a
divine favour, and sheer determination. A heroic character with cleric needs to make to turn undead) was one of the main changes
many hit points will be able to keep fighting and keep dodging between Dark Dungeons and Darker Dungeons. The change made
such blows for a long time, whereas a character with few hit points the game simpler because all the different rolls use the same easy-to-
is inexperienced and is likely to be killed rather quickly by the first learn mechanic, and the numbers have been adjusted carefully so
or second such blow. that the chance of success remains the same for any given situation.

As characters avoid more and more potentially lethal blows, they


will still pick up nicks, bruises and scrapes; and they will become Experience and Levels
more and more fatigued. Therefore, when something potentially As mentioned previously, the adventuring careers of player charac-
lethal hits a character, they take damage. ters are split up into levels.

Damage reduces the number of hit points a character has left, and Each character normally starts at level one, which means that they
if a character takes enough damage they will run out of hit points are inexperienced and have never adventured before. Once char-
and be knocked unconscious or killed. acters start adventuring, they gain experience. In game terms, this
means that they gain experience points for doing adventurous
See Chapter 10 – Combat for more details on taking damage. things – slaying monsters, recovering treasure, undertaking quests,
Hit points lost to damage can be recovered by either time, the and so on.
application of first aid, or magical healing.
When a character has acquired enough experience points, their level
Monsters have a number of hit dice, which shows how many d8’s increases. An increase in level is accompanied by an increase in the
should be rolled to determine their hit points. Characters get extra character’s abilities and attributes, showing that the character is
hit points each level, at lower levels the character’s constitution now more experienced and becoming more capable in their chosen
bonus or penalty is added to the hit points gained. At higher lev- adventuring profession.
els, characters gain a fixed number of hit points per level (again
depending on their class) and no longer also add their constitution Character Classes
bonus or penalty. Even with the same amount of experience, not all player characters
are the same. Although they are all assumed to be adventurers, their
Saving Throws backgrounds may be rather different from each other.
In some situations, something might have a harmful effect on a
creature other than direct damage (for example the gaze of a basi- For example a young elf that has just finished a five year apprentice-
lisk), or it might have a damaging effect that does not rely on an ship and has now mastered the essentials of spell casting is going
attack hitting (for example a dragon’s fiery breath). to be very different than a dwarven warrior who has spent every
weekend doing combat training in case of goblin attack.
In these cases, player characters and monsters often have a chance to
partially or fully avoid the effect by rolling a saving throw on a d20. In the game, this difference in background, upbringing and training
is represented by character classes. Each player character (and some
There are five types of saving throws that between them cover ten of important non-player characters, if they are also adventurers) has
these situations: death, death rays & poison; magic wands; paralysis a character class based on their background.
& petrification; breath weapons; rods, staffs, and spells.

18
Chapter 3 - Basic Game Concepts
As a player, you have a free choice of character class for your char- Developer Commentary
acter, providing your ability scores meet some minimum criteria. In the original edition of Dark Dungeons (and in the original game
See Chapter 4 – Creating a Character for more details. that Dark Dungeons is based on), there were fewer classes.
The character’s class determines which sorts of weapon and armour Druids weren’t a class that could be played from the start of the game
they will have been trained how to use, and also may provide them (you had to start as a cleric until you reached 9th level and then
with various special abilities. you could become a druid) mountebanks and clockworks didn’t exist.
And while there was a class that had the abilities of the lupine, it
There is little difference between the classes at low levels, since all was a human class that got its abilities through martial arts rather
the characters are novices in their chosen professions. However, as than a non-human class that gets its abilities through shape-shifting.
characters gain experience and levels, the differences between the
classes become more pronounced. Also, the elf and magic-user class were partially swapped around.
Elves were the ones who could fight and use magic, whereas human
Dark dungeons has six different classes for human adventurers, and magic-users were the ones who couldn’t fight well or wear armour.
five classes for non-human adventurers. Non-humans have different
cultures to humans and different natural abilities, so their adventur- The reason for these changes was simply the personal taste of the
ers are brought up with different backgrounds and are sufficiently author. Martial artists weren’t a good fit for an otherwise very “eu-
different from human adventurers to warrant their own classes. ropean” setting, and having humans unable to wear armour and
use magic while elves could didn’t seem right. It made more sense to
The six human character classes are, cleric, druid, fighter, magic-user, make the lack of ability to wear armour a racial trait of traditionally
mountebank, and thief; and the non-human ones are elf, dwarf, fragile elves while allowing humans to combine swinging a sword
halfling, clockwork, and lupine. and casting spells like such literary heroes as gandalf.
Each of these character classes is fully described in Chapter 4 –
Creating a Character.

19
Part 2

Characters &
Their Abilities
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
C
reating a character for Dark Dungeons is a pretty straight- Step 3) Assign Ability Scores
forward process. All you will need is a pencil and paper. You Write down each of the six abilities in order on a piece of scratch
won’t even need any dice. paper: strength, intelligence, wisdom, dexterity, constitution, cha-
risma.
Step by Step Process
Next, note down the following scores: 16, 14, 13, 12, 11, 9.
Step 1) Name and Concept
The first thing to do is to decide what sort of character you want If you wish, you may increase one of these scores by 2 points at
to play. Do you want to be a brave warrior or a stealthy rogue? do the cost of decreasing all five of the others by 1 point each. You
you want to be human or non-human? do you want to be dour may only do this once.
or happy-go-lucky? are you a paragon of virtue or a conniving
schemer? Then, assign each of those scores to one of your abilities. Note that
each class has an ability that must be assigned at least a 14, and an
It’s important to decide what sort of character you want to play ability that must be assigned at least a 13.
before picking up any dice, but also important to be flexible in
such a concept and to talk to the Game Master first. Table 4–1: Ability Score Requirements by Class
Class Ability Scores
If the Game Master is starting a game with first level characters Wisdom 14+
(which is the usual way to start a game) then deciding you want to Cleric
Charisma 13+
play an experienced swashbuckling pirate captain who is an expert
Strength 14+
fencer isn’t going to work. Clockwork
Constitution 13+
You would be better deciding you want to play someone who as- Wisdom 14+
Druid
pires to be a swashbuckling pirate captain but is just starting out Charisma 13+
on their adventuring career. Constitution 14+
Dwarf
Strength 13+
Similarly, if your Game Master has decided that the campaign will Intelligence 14+
take place in a world where humans are the only race, it’s no good Elf
Dexterity 13+
deciding that you want to play an elf.
Strength 14+
Fighter
Example: Marcie decides that she’d like to play a carefree young Dexterity 13+
tearaway who is bored with travelling on merchant caravans with Dexterity 14+
Halfling
her parents and wants to set off on a life of adventure instead. She sees Constitution 13+
the character – who she names Black Leaf – as possibly being magical Dexterity 14+
(maybe an elf ) but definitely being someone who is tall and slender, Lupine
Wisdom 13+
light on their feet, and highly mobile rather than being weighed down.
Intelligence 14+
Magic-user
Strength 13+

Step 2) Choose a Class Charisma 14+


Mountebank
Choose the class that you think best represents the sort of character Dexterity 13+
you wish to play. Dexterity 14+
Thief
Intelligence 13+
While the classes represent archetypal characters, there is room for
much variation within them. Example: Having decided that Black Leaf should be a thief, Marcie
sees that she needs a dexterity of 14 or higher and an intelligence
For example, a noble wishing to prove themselves worthy of knight- of 13 or higher.
hood, an “army brat” who grew up in a constantly moving mer-
cenary camp, and an escaped slave trained for gladiator school Deciding that Black Leaf won’t be the brightest or wisest of thieves,
would all be very different characters but they would all fit the but will be fairly resilient, Marcie arranges her scores as follows:
“fighter” class.
Strength = 12, intelligence = 13, wisdom = 9, dexterity = 16, con-
Example: Marcie reads over the descriptions of the various character stitution = 14, charisma = 11.
classes and, while tempted by the mountebank class, eventually decides
that Black Leaf should be a thief.

23
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character

Developer Commentary
In the original edition of Dark Dungeons (and in the original game
that Dark Dungeons is based on) you rolled ability scores on 3d6
rather than assigning a standard array of fixed values to them.

I switched to the standard array, since it means that you don’t end
up with a long-term disparity between characters over a lengthy
campaign based on a single set of rolls at the start.

If your group prefers to roll for your ability scores rather than use the
standard values, you should replace the rule about increasing one
ability by two and decreasing the rest by one with a rule that you can
increase one ability by one (to a maximum of 18) by decreasing two
other abilities by one each, providing those abilities are 9 or higher
before the decrease.

Step 4) Fill in Class Details With the Game Master’s permission, it is even possible for a cleric to
Now that you know what class your character is and what your abil- be completely non-religious – having been given clerical power by
ity scores are, you can fill in your character sheet with the abilities an immortal as part of some other more business-like arrangement.
that your character gets from that class. Details of these abilities
are given in the description of each class. Within an adventuring party, clerics tend to operate in a support
role. Their spells emphasise healing and protection rather than
Cleric flashy attacks.
Class Description: Clerics are human characters who have devoted
themselves to religious service. Equipment Restrictions: Clerics may wear any armour or shield,
but may only use blunt weapons.
In exchange for taking vows to uphold their religion’s principles
and tenets and to never use bladed weapons, clerics gain the abil- Cleric Abilities (see Table 4–2a)
ity to drive away or even destroy undead creatures; and to cast Hit Points: Clerics gain (6 + Con bonus) hit points at first level,
clerical spells. and then another (4 + Con bonus) hit points per level of experi-
ence until 9th level.
Depending on the particular religion the cleric follows, the cleric
may worship one or more gods – or even an entire pantheon of gods. After 9th level, clerics gain 1 hit point per level and do not add
Other religions involve the worship of abstract concepts such as additional Con bonuses (but do retain the bonuses to hit points
“fire” or “good”, or involve the worship of ancestral or other spirits. gained at previous levels).
Yet other religions are based on abstract philosophies.
Base Attack Bonus: A cleric’s attack bonus is based on their level.
Regardless of the type of religion, the powers wielded by a cleric See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of how this translates into
are normally provided by an individual immortal. It is up to the to-hit numbers for different armour classes.
Game Master to determine the exact details of the religion and
what role the immortal plays in it. Commonly this role will be Skills: A cleric starts with 4 skill points plus extra points equal to
as an intermediary, servant or messenger of the god(s) that the their Int bonus. These points can be used on the same skill or dif-
cleric worships. ferent skills. Clerics gain more skill points as they rise in level. See
Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for the list of available skills.
Developer Commentary
There are two editions of the original game that Dark Dungeons is Weapon Feats: Clerics start with two weapon feats, which must be
based on. In one of those, clerics gain their power from immortals spent immediately on basic proficiency with two different weapons.
and immortals fulfil the role of gods in the campaign world. In the See Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats for a description of how weapon
other, immortals are nothing to do with gods, clerics, or religion; and feats work. Clerics gain more weapon feats as they rise in level,
are basically cosmically powered superheroes. If you prefer the latter but these weapon feats cannot be spent immediately upon gaining
role for immortals, then ignore the text above and instead assume the level. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for further details.
that clerical power comes directly from the god or other force or entity
that the cleric worships. Spells: Starting at 2nd level, clerics can cast clerical spells. See
Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for detailed descriptions
Also, domains are a new addition in this edition. The original Dark of these spells.
Dungeons and the game that it is based on do not have domains. They
were added to give extra differentiation to clerics in play.

24
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–2a: Cleric Abilities by Level Providing a cleric has had a good night’s sleep (8 hours),
Spells per Day by Spell they can spend an hour meditating and/or performing

Weapon Feats
religious rites after waking up in order to gain spells

Base Attack
Experience

Hit Points
Level

Bonus
for the day as indicated on Table 4–2a.

Skills
Level

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Every cleric has access to all cleric spells of levels they


can cast, and chooses freely which ones to prepare
1 0 6+c +1 4 2 – – – – – – – each day within the limits of the numbers shown on
Table 4–2a.
2 1,500 10+2c +1 4 2 1 – – – – – –
3 3,000 14+3c +1 4 3 2 – – – – – – Each prepared spell can be cast once during the day,
and if a cleric wishes to cast a spell more than once
4 6,000 18+4c +2 4 3 2 1 – – – – –
then they must prepare the spell more than once, tak-
5 12,000 22+5c +2 5 3 2 2 – – – – – ing up multiple spell slots of the spell’s level. However,
6 25,000 26+6c +3 5 4 2 2 1 – – – – some spells will be easier or more difficult to prepare
than others of their level based on the domains that
7 50,000 30+7c +3 5 4 3 2 2 – – – – the cleric’s patron immortal is aligned with.
8 100,000 34+8c +4 5 4 3 3 2 1 – – –
Some clerical spells are reversible. These spells can be
9 200,000 38+9c +4 6 5 3 3 3 2 – – – reversed in order to have an effect opposite to the nor-
10 300,000 39+9c +5 6 5 4 4 3 2 1 – – mal effect of the spell. A cleric chooses whether or not
to reverse the spell at the time of casting, not at the
11 400,000 40+9c +5 6 6 4 4 3 3 2 – –
time of preparation. Clerical spells are always prepared
12 500,000 41+9c +6 6 6 4 4 4 3 2 1 – in their normal form.
13 600,000 42+9c +6 7 6 5 5 4 3 2 2 –
See Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for more
14 700,000 43+9c +7 7 6 5 5 5 3 3 2 – information on spells and spell casting.
15 800,000 44+9c +7 7 7 6 5 5 3 3 3 –
Turn Undead: clerics have the ability to channel divine
16 900,000 45+9c +8 7 7 6 5 5 4 4 3 – power from their patron in order to drive away or even
17 1,000,000 46+9c +8 8 7 6 6 5 4 4 3 1 destroy undead creatures such as zombies or vampires.
18 1,100,000 47+9c +9 8 7 6 6 5 4 4 3 2 When your cleric tries to turn undead, you must first
19 1,200,000 48+9c +9 8 7 7 6 5 4 4 4 2 decide which undead you are targeting. If you are fac-
ing a mixed group of undead you can only turn one
20 1,300,000 49+9c +10 8 7 7 6 5 4 4 4 3
type of undead each round.
21 1,400,000 50+9c +10 9 7 7 6 5 5 5 4 3
22 1,500,000 51+9c +11 9 7 7 6 5 5 5 4 4 Once you have decided which undead you wish to
attempt to turn, consult Table 4–2c and compare
23 1,600,000 52+9c +11 9 8 7 7 6 6 5 4 4 your cleric’s level with the type of undead that you are
24 1,700,000 53+9c +12 9 8 8 7 6 6 5 5 4 trying to turn. The entry in the table will indicate the
level of success, as follows:
25 1,800,000 54+9c +12 10 8 8 7 6 6 5 5 5
26 1,900,000 55+9c +13 10 8 8 7 7 6 6 5 5 ‘-’  – you are not powerful enough to turn this type
of undead.
27 2,000,000 56+9c +13 10 8 8 8 7 6 6 6 5
28 2,100,000 57+9c +14 10 8 8 8 7 7 7 6 5 ‘+2’ – make a check with a bonus of +2. Your attempt
29 2,200,000 58+9c +14 11 8 8 8 7 7 7 6 6 at turning the undead will be successful if the check
succeeds. If the check fails, you will not be able to
30 2,300,000 59+9c +15 11 9 8 8 8 7 7 7 6 try to turn these same undead again during this fight.
31 2,400,000 60+9c +15 11 9 8 8 8 8 8 7 6
If the check succeeds then roll 2d6 to see how many of
32 2,500,000 61+9c +16 11 9 9 8 8 8 8 7 7 the undead are affected. Targeted undead with a total
33 2,600,000 62+9c +16 12 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 7 number of hit dice equal to this roll will be turned,
with the exception that at least one undead will always
34 2,700,000 63+9c +17 12 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8
be affected even if it has more hit dice than the roll.
35 2,800,000 64+9c +17 12 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8
36 2,900,000 65+9c +18 12 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 9

25
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–2b: Cleric Saving Throws by Level ‘+5’ – make a check with a bonus of +5. Your attempt at turning the undead will be
successful if the check succeeds. If the check fails, you will not be able to try to turn

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /
these same undead again during this fight.

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
Level

Spell
If the check succeeds then roll 2d6 to see how many of the undead are affected. Tar-
geted undead with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll will be turned, with
the exception that at least one undead will always be affected even if it has more hit
1 +9 +8 +6 +4 +5 dice than the roll.
2 +9 +8 +6 +4 +5 ‘+11’ – make a check with a bonus of +11. Your attempt at turning the undead will
3 +9 +8 +6 +4 +5 be successful if the check succeeds. If the check fails, you will not be able to try to
turn these same undead again during this fight.
4 +10 +9 +7 +5 +6
5 +10 +9 +7 +5 +6 If the check succeeds then roll 2d6 to see how many of the undead are affected. Tar-
6 +11 +10 +8 +6 +7 geted undead with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll will be turned, with
the exception that at least one undead will always be affected even if it has more hit
7 +11 +10 +8 +6 +7 dice than the roll.
8 +12 +11 +9 +7 +8
‘t’ – your attempt at turning the undead automatically succeeds. Roll 2d6 to see how
9 +12 +11 +9 +7 +8 many undead are affected.
10 +13 +12 +10 +8 +9
Targeted undead with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll will be turned,
11 +13 +12 +10 +8 +9
with the exception that at least one will always be affected even if it has more hit
12 +13 +12 +11 +9 +10 dice than the roll.
13 +14 +13 +11 +9 +10
‘d’ – your attempt at turning the undead is automatically successful, and will destroy
14 +14 +13 +12 +10 +11 the undead rather than simply turning them. Roll 2d6 to see how many of the
15 +14 +13 +12 +10 +11 undead are affected.

16 +14 +13 +13 +11 +12 Targeted undead with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll will be destroyed,
17 +15 +13 +13 +11 +12 with the exception that at least one undead will always be affected even if it has more
hit dice than the roll.
18 +15 +13 +14 +12 +13
19 +15 +13 +14 +12 +13 ‘D’ – your attempt at turning the undead is automatically successful, and will de-
stroy the undead rather than simply turning them. Roll 3d6 to see how many of the
20 +15 +14 +14 +13 +14
undead are affected.
21 +16 +14 +15 +13 +14
22 +16 +15 +15 +14 +15 Targeted undead with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll will be destroyed,
with the exception that at least one undead will always be affected even if it has more
23 +16 +15 +15 +14 +15 hit dice than the roll.
24 +16 +15 +15 +15 +15
‘X’ – your attempt at turning the undead is automatically successful, and will destroy
25 +17 +16 +16 +15 +16 the undead rather than simply turning them. Roll 4d6 to see how many of the
26 +17 +16 +16 +16 +16 undead are affected.
27 +17 +16 +16 +16 +16
Targeted undead with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll will be destroyed,
28 +17 +16 +16 +16 +16 with the exception that at least one undead will always be affected even if it has more
29 +18 +17 +17 +17 +17 hit dice than the roll.

30 +18 +17 +17 +17 +17 Undead that have been turned will be compelled to flee from the cleric as fast as they
31 +18 +17 +17 +17 +17 are able for at least five minutes.

32 +18 +17 +17 +17 +17 If cornered during this time, they will cower and be unable to make any kind of
33 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 attack, although intelligent undead may use whatever defensive powers they possess
in order to protect themselves. The bodies of undead that have been destroyed will
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
crumble to a fine ash, and incorporeal undead will fade away to nothing.
35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

26
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–2c: Turning Undead by Cleric Level Example: Elfstar, the second level cleric, is
facing a pack of zombies. On her action she
decides to use her turn undead ability rather

Nightshade
Phantom
Skeleton

Vampire
Mummy
Zombie

Spectre
Wraith

Special
Haunt
Wight
Ghoul than attacking with her mace.

Spirit
Level

Lich
Elfstar’s player announces that she is target-
ing the zombies with her turn attempt, and
1 +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - - - - - - looks on her character sheet (onto which she
has copied the relevant information from TA-
2 t +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - - - - - BLE 4–2C).
3 t t +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - - - -
This shows a ‘+11’, so she needs to roll a d20,
4 d t t +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - - -
add eleven, and get a total of 20 or higher
5 d d t t +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - - to successfully turn the zombies. She rolls the
6 d d d t t +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - dice and gets a 10, for a total of 21 – success!

7 d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 - - - - - Elfstar’s player now rolls 2d6 to see how many


8 d d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 - - - - zombies Elfstar has just turned. She rolls a 9.
Since zombies have two hit dice each, Elfstar
9 d d d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 - - - has successfully turned four of the zombies (a
10 d d d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 - - - total of 8 hit dice). She cannot turn a fifth
one, since that would be a total of 10 hit dice
11 D d d d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 - -
which is higher than her roll of 9).
12 D d d d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 - -
13 D D d d d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 - Some particularly powerful undead might
have ways of resisting being turned, and a
14 D D d d d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 - powerful master may be able to protect their
15 D D D d d d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 minions making them harder to turn.

16 D D D d d d d d d t t +11 +5 +2 Saving Throws: Clerics make saving throws


17 D D D D d d d d d d t t +11 +5 using the bonuses listed on Table 4–2b.
18 D D D D d d d d d d t t +11 +5 Clockwork
19 D D D D d d d d d d t t +11 +5 Class Description: Clockworks are a de-
mi-human race of mechanical humanoids.
20 D D D D d d d d d d t t +11 +5
Although they aren’t made from flesh and
21 D D D D D d d d d d d t t +11 blood, they are still sapient living creatures
22 D D D D D d d d d d d t t +11 with souls and free will. This possession of a
soul distinguishes them from other mechan-
23 D D D D D d d d d d d t t +11 ical or inorganic entities such as golems and
24 D D D D D d d d d d d t t +11 constructs. Physically, a clockwork is the
height and build of a human, although they
25 X D D D D D d d d d d d t t are completely genderless. Their outer casing
26 X D D D D D d d d d d d t t is made from brass and leather, and their
innards are an intricate mesh of clockwork
27 X D D D D D d d d d d d t t
and tubes containing milky lubricating flu-
28 X D D D D D d d d d d d t t ids. Clockworks have no need for clothing,
29 X X D D D D D d d d d d t t although those who live amongst humans
will often wear clothes (and sometimes even
30 X X D D D D D d d d d d t t wigs) in order to better fit in with those
31 X X D D D D D d d d d d t t around them.

32 X X D D D D D d d d d d t t Clockworks need no power source to func-


33 X X X D D D D D d d d d t t tion as their mechanisms are kept working
by their soul directly, although they do need
34 X X X D D D D D d d d d t t
to drink organic liquids from which their
35 X X X D D D D D d d d d t t body will synthesise its own internal flu-
ids and they can starve if they are forced to
36 X X X D D D D D d d d d t t

27
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–3a: Clockwork Abilities by Level go without for too long. Clockworks reproduce
by physically constructing a new clockwork body

Weapon Feats
(they instinctively know how to do so) and then

Base Attack
Experience

Hit Points

Bonus
transferring a part of their soul into it to form

Skills
Level

Special Abilities
a child clockwork, which will be modified by its
parent into a full adult form once it has had the
appropriate mental and emotional growth.
1 0 8+c +1 4 4 Artificial body/armoured/fists
Although it might be technically possible for a
2 2,200 13+2c +1 4 4 clockwork to create a non-humanoid body for
3 4,400 18+3c +2 4 5 themselves or one of an unusual size, the thought
of inhabiting such a body is extremely uncomfort-
4 8,800 13+4c +2 4 5
able to a clockwork on a mental and emotional
5 17,000 28+5c +3 5 5 level and no clockwork would even contemplate
6 35,000 33+6c +4 5 6 doing such a thing to themselves.

7 70,000 38+7c +4 5 6 Equipment Restrictions: Clockworks do not have


8 140,000 43+8c +5 5 6 any restrictions on their weapon selection. They
can use any weapon or shield, although due to their
9 270,000 48+9c +6 6 7 metal fists they may often be better off fighting
10 400,000 50+9c +6 6 7 unarmed. Clockworks can’t wear normal armour,
although they can have armour fitted to their body.
11 530,000 52+9c +7 6 8
See below for details.
12 660,000 54+9c +8 6 8 Multiple attacks/smash/parry
Developer Commentary
13 800,000 56+9c +8 7 8 Clockworks are a new addition to this edtion of Dark
14 950,000 58+9c +9 7 8 Dungeons, and have not appeared in the game before.
15 1,100,000 60+9c +10 7 9
They are not based on any specific individual source,
16 1,250,000 62+9c +10 7 9 Spell resistance but just on the generic trope of clockwork people that
are often seen in fantasy and sci-fi.
17 1,400,000 64+9c +11 8 9
18 1,550,000 66+9c +12 8 9 Clockwork Abilities (see Table 4–3a)
19 1,700,000 68+9c +12 8 10 Hit Points: Clockworks start with (8 + Con bonus)
hit points at first level, and then gain another (5 +
20 1,850,000 70+9c +13 8 10 Multiple attacks (3)
Con bonus) hit points per level until they reach 9th
21 2,000,000 72+9c +14 9 10 level. After 9th level, clockworks gain 2 hit points
22 2,150,000 74+9c +14 9 10 per level and no longer add additional Con bonuses
(but do retain the bonuses to hit points they gained
23 2,300,000 76+9c +15 9 11 at previous levels).
24 2,450,000 78+9c +16 9 11
Base Attack Bonus: A clockwork’s attack bonus in
25 2,600,000 80+9c +16 10 11 combat is based on their level. See Chapter 10 –
26 2,750,000 82+9c +17 10 11 Combat for details of how this translates into dif-
ferent to-hit numbers for opponents with different
27 2,900,000 84+9c +18 10 12
armour classes.
28 3,050,000 86+9c +18 10 12
29 3,200,000 88+9c +19 11 12 Skills: A clockwork starts with 4 skill points at 1st
level, plus extra points equal to their Int bonus.
30 3,350,000 90+9c +20 11 13 These points can be used on the same skill or dif-
31 3,500,000 92+9c +20 11 13 ferent skills. Clockworks gain more skill points as
they increase in level. See Chapter 5 – Ability
32 3,650,000 94+9c +21 11 13 Checks & Skills for the list of available skills.
33 3,800,000 96+9c +22 12 14
Weapon Feats: Clockworks start with four weapon
34 3,950,000 98+9c +22 12 14
feats, which must be spent immediately on ba-
35 4,100,000 100+9c +23 12 14 sic proficiency on four different weapons, one of
which may be their fists. See Chapter 6 – Weapon
36 4,250,000 102+9c +23 12 15 Multiple attacks (4)

28
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Feats for a full description of how weapon feats work. Clockworks gain more Table 4–3b: Clockwork Saving Throws by Level
weapon feats as they rise in level, but these weapon feats cannot be spent im-

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /
mediately upon gaining the new level. See Chapter 11– Gaining Experience

Paralysis /

Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
for further details on spending new weapon feats.

Level

Spell
Artificial Body: Clockworks have an artificial body made from leather, metal
and other materials. Their internals are a mesh of clockwork and tubes contain-
ing lubricating fluids. Because of this artificial body, clockworks do not need to 1 +12 +11 +10 +7 +8
sleep and they are immune to poison, disease, fatigue, paralysis, nausea, sleep
and exhaustion. 2 +12 +11 +10 +7 +8
3 +13 +12 +11 +8 +9
The artificial bodies of clockworks do not naturally heal. A clockwork does not
4 +13 +12 +11 +9 +10
heal damage by resting, and cannot be healed using the first aid skill. Clockworks
can still be healed by magical means, and the craft (clockwork) skill can be used 5 +14 +13 +12 +10 +11
to do minor field repairs (using the standard rules as if using the first aid skill 6 +15 +14 +13 +11 +12
on other characters). With a blacksmith’s forge and a week’s worth of work, a
clockwork can be repaired back to full hit points with no skill check required. 7 +15 +14 +13 +12 +13
8 +16 +15 +14 +13 +14
Armoured: The outer plating of clockwork bodies is equivalent to leather ar-
mour and automatically gives them a natural armour class of 7, but they cannot 9 +17 +16 +15 +14 +15
wear additional armour on top of this. A clockwork can have its armour plating 10 +17 +16 +15 +15 +16
upgraded and replaced with better armour (including magical armour that has
11 +17 +17 +16 +16 +17
been found), but the upgrade process takes a full week and requires access to a
blacksmith’s forge and tools. 12 +18 +17 +16 +16 +17
13 +18 +17 +16 +17 +17
Fists: The fists and forearms of a clockwork are reinforced by metal plates, and
this allows them to strike and parry in combat as effectively as most melee 14 +18 +17 +16 +17 +17
weapons. A clockwork must spend weapon feats on proficiency with this attack 15 +18 +18 +17 +18 +18
just like any other attack, and normal off-hand penalties apply if a clockwork
wishes to use both fists in combat (although the fists are off-hand weapons; see 16 +18 +18 +17 +18 +18
Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats for a full description of how weapon feats and 17 +18 +18 +17 +18 +18
off-hand weapons work). Clockworks using their reinforced fists count as armed
opponents for the purposes of their opponents’ weapon proficiency bonuses. 18 +18 +18 +17 +18 +18
A clockwork can attach magical fist/arm plates, although this takes a day and 19 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
requires access to a blacksmith’s forge and tools. A clockwork’s fist/arm plates
20 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
can’t be disarmed, and they do not prevent the clockwork from also carrying and
using other weapons or shields. However, a clockwork can’t attack with both a 21 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
carried weapon and the fist carrying that weapon at the same time. 22 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

Multiple Attacks: At 12th level, a clockwork is able to make two attacks per 23 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
round against any creature that they would be able to hit by rolling a 2+ on 24 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
the attack roll (after modifiers). At 20th level, this rises to three attacks and
at 36th level it rises to four attacks. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of 25 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
how multiple attacks work. 26 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
27 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
Smash: At 12th level, a clockwork gains the ability to make smash attacks in
melee combat. At the beginning of each round, the clockwork’s player declares 28 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
whether their character is making a smash attack. The clockwork automatically 29 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
loses initiative, and takes a –5 penalty to their attack roll for the attack. However,
if the attack hits, the clockwork gets to add their entire strength score to the 30 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
damage done by the attack as well as their strength bonus. See Chapter 10 – 31 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
Combat for full details of how smash attacks work.
32 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
Parry: At 12th level, a clockwork can use the parry action in combat. The 33 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
clockwork’s player must declare that their character is parrying at the begin-
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
ning of the round before initiative is rolled. The clockwork makes no attacks
during the round (and therefore needs no initiative), but all incoming attacks 35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
are made at a –4 penalty.
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

29
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Spell Resistance: At 16th level and higher, a clockwork Table 4–4a: Druid Abilities by Level
only takes half damage from all spells and spell-like
Spells per Day by Spell

Weapon Feats
abilities that do direct damage. If the spell normally

Base Attack
Experience

Hit Points
Level

Bonus
allows a saving throw for half damage then the clock-

Skills
Level
work only takes a quarter of normal damage if they
save successfully. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

Saving Throws: A clockwork makes its saving throws 1 0 6+c +1 4 2 – – – – – – –


against magical attacks and other similar effects using
the bonuses listed on Table 4–3b. 2 1,500 10+2c +1 4 2 1 – – – – – –
3 3,000 14+3c +1 4 3 2 – – – – – –
Druid 4 6,000 18+4c +2 4 3 2 1 – – – – –
Class Description: Druids are humans who worship
nature. In exchange for their worship, they gain the 5 12,000 22+5c +2 5 3 2 2 – – – – –
ability to cast spells and the ability to control animals. 6 25,000 26+6c +3 5 4 2 2 1 – – – –
Druids sometimes claim that their worship is older 7 50,000 30+7c +3 5 4 3 2 2 – – – –
than the first immortal, and that the way that clerics 8 100,000 34+8c +4 5 4 3 3 2 1 – – –
get their power from immortals is a lesser imitation
of their own abilities. 9 200,000 38+9c +4 6 5 3 3 3 2 – – –
10 300,000 39+9c +5 6 5 4 4 3 2 1 – –
While it is true that druids can cast all the spells that
11 400,000 40+9c +5 6 6 4 4 3 3 2 – –
clerics can and more, and can do so without needing
to come to any kind of arrangement with an immor- 12 500,000 41+9c +6 6 6 4 4 4 3 2 1 –
tal, the true relationship between clerical worship and 13 600,000 42+9c +6 7 6 5 5 4 3 2 2 –
druidic worship is not known and such theories are
mere philosophical speculation. 14 700,000 43+9c +7 7 6 5 5 5 3 3 2 –
15 800,000 44+9c +7 7 7 6 5 5 3 3 3 –
In fact, no-one knows where druids get their power
from. A new initiate vows to respect and protect “na- 16 900,000 45+9c +8 7 7 6 5 5 4 4 3 –
ture”, and when druids Commune they do so with 17 1,000,000 46+9c +8 8 7 6 6 5 4 4 3 1
“nature” – and get responses; but if there is any sapient
entity personifying nature then it has never revealed 18 1,100,000 47+9c +9 8 7 6 6 5 4 4 3 2
itself to either mortal or immortal. 19 1,200,000 48+9c +9 8 7 7 6 5 4 4 4 2
20 1,300,000 49+9c +10 8 7 7 6 5 4 4 4 3
Druidic society has no hierarchy or structure and each
druid is effectively their own master, doing as they 21 1,400,000 50+9c +10 9 7 7 6 5 5 5 4 3
think right. 22 1,500,000 51+9c +11 9 7 7 6 5 5 5 4 4

The druidic philosophy is primarily concerned with 23 1,600,000 52+9c +11 9 8 7 7 6 6 5 4 4


protecting nature from corruption and destruction. 24 1,700,000 53+9c +12 9 8 8 7 6 6 5 5 4
As such, druids live apart from civilisation, often in
woodland areas but occasionally in mountains or de- 25 1,800,000 54+9c +12 10 8 8 7 6 6 5 5 5
sert regions. 26 1,900,000 55+9c +13 10 8 8 7 7 6 6 5 5
27 2,000,000 56+9c +13 10 8 8 8 7 6 6 6 5
Although there are occasional extremists who seek to
kill or drive off all those who intrude on their protected 28 2,100,000 57+9c +14 10 8 8 8 7 7 7 6 5
areas, most druids are pragmatic in their protection. 29 2,200,000 58+9c +14 11 8 8 8 7 7 7 6 6
They will not hinder those who travel through or even
hunt in their realms – providing such travel or hunting 30 2,300,000 59+9c +15 11 9 8 8 8 7 7 7 6
is done responsibly. 31 2,400,000 60+9c +15 11 9 8 8 8 8 8 7 6

However, they do oppose the encroachment of farm- 32 2,500,000 61+9c +16 11 9 9 8 8 8 8 7 7


land and cities into their realm, as well as protecting 33 2,600,000 62+9c +16 12 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 7
it from unnatural creatures.
34 2,700,000 63+9c +17 12 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8
35 2,800,000 64+9c +17 12 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8
36 2,900,000 65+9c +18 12 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 9

30
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–4b: Druid Saving Throws by Level Druids shun technology, and do not like to use manufactured items. Most will use
money on occasion, but will generally prefer to barter for what few goods they use

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /
and for their services.

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
Level

Spell
In general, druids will keep on friendly terms with people who live around (or even
in) their lands; helping and protecting them in exchange for their keeping respect-
ful of nature.
1 +9 +8 +6 +4 +5
Within an adventuring party, druids tend to operate in a support role. Their spells
2 +9 +8 +6 +4 +5 emphasise healing and protection rather than flashy attacks.
3 +9 +8 +6 +4 +5
Equipment Restrictions: Druids’ distaste for manufactured and refined goods makes
4 +10 +9 +7 +5 +6
them unable to wear metal items or use metal weapons. They may only use weapons
5 +10 +9 +7 +5 +6 and shields made of wood and/or natural stone, and may only use leather armour.
6 +11 +10 +8 +6 +7
7 +11 +10 +8 +6 +7
Developer Commentary
In the original edition of Dark Dungeons (and in the original game that Dark Dungeons
8 +12 +11 +9 +7 +8 is based on), druids were not a separate class but were instead something that a cleric
9 +12 +11 +9 +7 +8 could become after reaching ninth level. They lost the ability to wear metal armour and
to turn undead and all they gained in exchange was a couple of extra spells, making
10 +13 +12 +10 +8 +9 becoming a druid a very unattractive option to most players.
11 +13 +12 +10 +8 +9
In Darker Dungeons, and in this new edition of Dark Dungeons, I made the druid into
12 +13 +12 +11 +9 +10 a stand-alone class that can be taken from the start and gave them animal control as a
13 +14 +13 +11 +9 +10 replacement for turn undead so that they wouldn’t be underpowered compared to clerics.
14 +14 +13 +12 +10 +11
15 +14 +13 +12 +10 +11 Druid Abilities (see Table 4–4a)
Hit Points: Druids gain (6 + Con bonus) hit points at first level, and then another
16 +14 +13 +13 +11 +12 (4 + Con bonus) hit points per level of experience until 9th level.
17 +15 +13 +13 +11 +12
After 9th level, druids gain 1 hit point per level and do not add additional Con
18 +15 +13 +14 +12 +13
bonuses (but do retain the bonuses to hit points gained at previous levels).
19 +15 +13 +14 +12 +13
Base Attack Bonus: A druid’s attack bonus is based on their level. See Chapter 10 –
20 +15 +14 +14 +13 +14
Combat for details of how this translates into to-hit numbers for different armour
21 +16 +14 +15 +13 +14 classes.
22 +16 +15 +15 +14 +15
Skills: A druid starts with 4 skill points plus extra points equal to their Int bonus.
23 +16 +15 +15 +14 +15 These points can be used on the same skill or different skills. Druids gain more skill
24 +16 +15 +15 +15 +15 points as they rise in level. See Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for the list
of available skills.
25 +17 +16 +16 +15 +16
26 +17 +16 +16 +16 +16 Weapon Feats: Druids start with two weapon feats, which must be spent immediately
on basic proficiency with two different weapons. See Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats
27 +17 +16 +16 +16 +16
for a description of how weapon feats work.
28 +17 +16 +16 +16 +16
29 +18 +17 +17 +17 +17 Druids gain more weapon feats as they rise in level, but these weapon feats cannot
be spent immediately upon gaining the level. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better
30 +18 +17 +17 +17 +17 for further details.
31 +18 +17 +17 +17 +17
Spells: Starting at 2nd level, druids can cast clerical spells. See Chapter 7 – Spells
32 +18 +17 +17 +17 +17 & Spell Casting for detailed descriptions of these spells.
33 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
Providing a druid has had a good night’s sleep (8 hours), they can spend an hour
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
meditating and/or performing religious rites after waking up in order to gain spells
35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 for the day as indicated on Table 4–4a.
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

31
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–4c: Controlling Animals by Druid Level

31 or More Hit Dice


Less Than 1 Hit Die

12 To 13+ Hit Dice

14 To 16+ Hit Dice

17 To 20+ Hit Dice

21 To 25+ Hit Dice

26 To 30+ Hit Dice


9 To 11+ Hit Dice
1 To 1+ Hit Dice

4 To 4+ Hit Dice

5 To 6+ Hit Dice


2 To 2+ Hit Dice

3 To 3+ Hit Dice

7 To 8+ Hit Dice


Level

1 +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - - - - - -
2 c +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - - - - -
3 c c +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - - - -
4 m c c +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - - -
5 m m c c +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - -
6 m m m c c +11 +5 +2 - - - - - - Every druid has access to all druidic spells
of levels they can cast, and chooses freely
7 m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 - - - - -
which ones to prepare each day within the
8 m m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 - - - - limits of the numbers shown on Table 4–4a.
9 m m m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 - - -
Each prepared spell can be cast once during
10 m m m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 - - - the day, and if a druid wishes to cast a spell
11 M m m m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 - - more than once then they must prepare the
spell more than once, taking up multiple
12 M m m m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 - -
spell slots of the spell’s level.
13 M M m m m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 -
14 M M m m m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 - Some druidic spells are reversible. These
spells can be reversed in order to have an
15 M M M m m m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 effect opposite to the normal effect of the
16 M M M m m m m m m c c +11 +5 +2 spell. A druid chooses whether or not to
17 M M M M m m m m m m c c +11 +5 reverse the spell at the time of casting, not
at the time of preparation. Druidic spells
18 M M M M m m m m m m c c +11 +5 are always prepared in their normal form.
19 M M M M m m m m m m c c +11 +5
See Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting
20 M M M M m m m m m m c c +11 +5 for more information on spells and spell
21 M M M M M m m m m m m c c +11 casting.
22 M M M M M m m m m m m c c +11
Control Animals: Druids have the ability
23 M M M M M m m m m m m c c +11 to command or even control animals. This
24 M M M M M m m m m m m c c +11 ability only works on natural animals, not
monsters, and only on animals with at least
25 X M M M M M m m m m m m c c
the size and intelligence of a mouse. Lesser
26 X M M M M M m m m m m m c c creatures such as individual insects or slugs
27 X M M M M M m m m m m m c c are too primitive for the ability to work on
them – although it does work on giant ver-
28 X M M M M M m m m m m m c c sions of these creatures.
29 X X M M M M M m m m m m c c
When your druid tries to control animals,
30 X X M M M M M m m m m m c c
you must first decide which animal species
31 X X M M M M M m m m m m c c you are targeting.
32 X X M M M M M m m m m m c c
If you are facing a mixed group of animals
33 X X X M M M M M m m m m c c you can only control one type of animal
34 X X X M M M M M m m m m c c each round.
35 X X X M M M M M m m m m c c
Once you have decided which animal spe-
36 X X X M M M M M m m m m c c cies you wish to attempt to control, consult

32
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–4c and compare your druid’s level with the hit dice of the ‘M’ – your attempt at controlling the animals automatically suc-
type of animal that you are trying to affect. The entry in the table ceeds, and you may choose to master them rather than just com-
will indicate the level of success, as follows: manding them. Roll 3d6 to see how many animals are affected.

‘-’  – you are not powerful enough to command or control this Targeted animals with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll
type of animal. will be commanded or mastered, with the exception that at least
one animal will always be affected even if it has more hit dice than
‘+2’ – make a check with a bonus of +2. Your attempt at controlling the roll.
the animals will be successful if the check succeeds. If the check
fails, you will not be able to try to control these same animals again ‘X’ – your attempt at controlling the animals automatically succeeds,
until the following day. and you may choose to master them rather than just commanding
them. Roll 4d6 to see how many animals are affected.
If the check succeeds then roll 2d6 to see how many of the animals
are affected. Targeted animals with a total number of hit dice equal Targeted animals with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll
to this roll will be commanded, with the exception that at least will be commanded or mastered, with the exception that at least
one animal will always be affected even if it has more hit dice than one animal will always be affected even if it has more hit dice than
the roll. the roll.

‘+5’ – make a check with a bonus of +5. Your attempt at controlling Commanded animals will obey a single mental command from
the animals will be successful if the check succeeds. If the check the druid. This command may be to flee, or to attack a particular
fails, you will not be able to try to control these same animals again target, or to pick up an item and bring it to the druid or any other
until the following day. command of a similar nature. All animals included in a single
command must be given the same command.
If the check succeeds then roll 2d6 to see how many of the animals
are affected. Targeted animals with a total number of hit dice equal The duration of the command lasts for ten minutes or until the
to this roll will be commanded, with the exception that at least animals have finished the task that they have been given, whichever
one animal will always be affected even if it has more hit dice than happens first.
the roll.
Mastered animals will become docile and friendly to the druid, and
‘+11’ – make a check with a bonus of +11. Your attempt at control- if they are normally social or pack animals they will be friendly
ling the animals will be successful if the check succeeds. If the check to the druid’s friends as well. They will fight to protect the druid
fails, you will not be able to try to control these same animals again without being ordered to and willingly lay down their lives on the
until the following day. druid’s behalf.

If the check succeeds then roll 2d6 to see how many of the animals At any time, the druid may (as a standard action) make mental con-
are affected. Targeted animals with a total number of hit dice equal tact with any one of their mastered animals regardless of distance
to this roll will be commanded, with the exception that at least (providing they are on the same plane of existence and within the
one animal will always be affected even if it has more hit dice than same celestial sphere).
the roll.
While in mental contact, the druid experiences the animal’s senses
‘c’ – your attempt at controlling the animals automatically succeeds. rather than their own – so they see through the animal’s eyes, hear
Roll 2d6 to see how many animals are affected. through its ears, and so forth – and can give the animal mental
commands at any time, or even physically take control of the
Targeted animals with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll animal’s movement.
will be commanded, with the exception that at least one animal
will always be affected even if it has more hit dice than the roll. The druid may not cast spells or use magical items through the
animal, and the druid’s control of the animal’s movement is not
‘m’ – your attempt at controlling the animals automatically succeeds, fine enough for them to make the animal reproduce human words.
and you may choose to master them rather than just commanding
them. Roll 2d6 to see how many animals are affected. Mastery of an animal is normally permanent, although a druid can
only have a total number of animals mastered at any given time
Targeted animals with a total number of hit dice equal to this roll equal to twice as many hit dice as the druid has levels. A druid
will be commanded or mastered, with the exception that at least may relinquish mastery of an animal at any time, and can do so at
one animal will always be affected even if it has more hit dice than the same time as mastering a new animal in order to make room
the roll. for the new one.

Saving Throws: Druids make saving throws using the bonuses


listed on Table 4–4b.

33
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–5a: Dwarf Abilities by Level
Dwarf

Weapon Feats
Class Description: Dwarves are a demi-human

Base Attack
Experience

Hit Points

Abilities
Special
Bonus
race. Like most demi-human races, they are less

Skills
Level
flexible than humans, and all dwarf adventurers
are represented by a single class.

Physically, dwarves are slightly shorter than hu- 1 0 8+c +1 4 4 Infravision / stonelore
mans but are similar in weight due to their stockier
build. Skin and hair colour shows the same range as 2 2,200 13+2c +1 4 4
humans, although both male and female dwarves 3 4,400 18+3c +2 4 5
tend to have slightly more facial and body hair
4 8,800 13+4c +2 4 5
than humans and both sexes usually sport beards.
5 17,000 28+5c +3 5 5
Traditionally, dwarves live in mountainous areas 6 35,000 33+6c +4 5 6
near humans, where they live underground and
use their mining and metal-working skills to make 7 70,000 38+7c +4 5 6
goods and tools that they can trade with the hu- 8 140,000 43+8c +5 5 6
mans for food and textiles. Dwarves are an inher-
ently non-magical race, and possess no magic-users 9 270,000 48+9c +6 6 7
or clerics of their own – not even being able to 10 400,000 50+9c +6 6 7
produce the lesser shamans that goblins and gi-
11 530,000 52+9c +7 6 8
ants – their traditional enemies – are able to field
in battle. However, this lack of magical ability 12 660,000 54+9c +8 6 8 Multiple attacks/smash/parry
makes dwarves much more resilient and able to 13 800,000 56+9c +8 7 8
resist magical attacks.
14 950,000 58+9c +9 7 8
Dwarven adventurers make tough warriors who are 15 1,100,000 60+9c +10 7 9
at home in underground environments.
16 1,250,000 62+9c +10 7 9 Spell resistance
Equipment Restrictions: Dwarves can wear any 17 1,400,000 64+9c +11 8 9
armour, and can use any small or medium weapon.
They can use shields except for tower shields. 18 1,550,000 66+9c +12 8 9
19 1,700,000 68+9c +12 8 10
Dwarf Abilities (see Table 4–5a) 20 1,850,000 70+9c +13 8 10 Multiple attacks (3)
Hit Points: Dwarves gain (8 + Con bonus) hit
points at first level, and then another (5 + Con 21 2,000,000 72+9c +14 9 10
bonus) hit points per level of experience until 9th 22 2,150,000 74+9c +14 9 10
level. After 9th level, dwarves gain 2 hit points
per level and do not add additional Con bonuses 23 2,300,000 76+9c +15 9 11
(but do retain the bonuses to hit points gained at 24 2,450,000 78+9c +16 9 11
previous levels).
25 2,600,000 80+9c +16 10 11
Base Attack Bonus: A dwarf ’s attack bonus is 26 2,750,000 82+9c +17 10 11
based on their level. See Chapter 10 – Combat
27 2,900,000 84+9c +18 10 12
for details of how this translates into to-hit num-
bers for different armour classes. 28 3,050,000 86+9c +18 10 12
29 3,200,000 88+9c +19 11 12
Skills: A dwarf starts with 4 skill points plus ex-
tra points equal to their Int bonus. These points 30 3,350,000 90+9c +20 11 13
can be used on the same skill or different skills. 31 3,500,000 92+9c +20 11 13
Dwarves gain more skill points as they rise in level.
See Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for the 32 3,650,000 94+9c +21 11 13
list of available skills. 33 3,800,000 96+9c +22 12 14
34 3,950,000 98+9c +22 12 14
Weapon Feats: Dwarves start with four weapon
feats, which must be spent immediately on basic 35 4,100,000 100+9c +23 12 14
proficiency with four different weapons. See Chap-
36 4,250,000 102+9c +23 12 15 Multiple attacks (4)

34
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–5b: Dwarf Saving Throws by Level ter 6 – Weapon Feats for a description of how weapon feats work. Dwarves gain
more weapon feats as they rise in level, but these weapon feats cannot be spent imme-

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /
diately upon gaining the level. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for further details.

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
Level

Spell
Saving Throws: Dwarves make saving throws using the bonuses listed on Table 4–5b.

Infravision: Dwarves have the ability to see not only the colour of things but also
1 +12 +11 +10 +7 +8 their temperature. When a dwarf is in the dark (and only then – normal light over-
loads a dwarf’s infravision and prevents it from working) they can use their infravision
2 +12 +11 +10 +7 +8 to navigate and even to fight. However, infravision doesn’t allow the dwarf to see
3 +13 +12 +11 +8 +9 pictures and writing unless they are carved into the surface that the dwarf is looking at.
4 +13 +12 +11 +9 +10
Stonelore: A dwarf ’s experience with masonry and stonework – in particular under-
5 +14 +13 +12 +10 +11 ground stonework – gives them a chance to detect irregularities in construction. If a
6 +15 +14 +13 +11 +12 dwarf examines an area looking for irregularities, the Game Master should secretly
roll a check for each feature in the area being searched that is one of the following:
7 +15 +14 +13 +12 +13
8 +16 +15 +14 +13 +14 ◊ Traps involving moving stone walls or blocks of stone.
◊ Secret doors involving moving stone walls.
9 +17 +16 +15 +14 +15 ◊ Newly built stone constructions.
10 +17 +16 +15 +15 +16 ◊ Gently sloping stonework.
11 +17 +17 +16 +16 +17
In each case, the check is made with a bonus of +6.
12 +18 +17 +16 +16 +17
13 +18 +17 +16 +17 +17 If the check fails, then the dwarf in unable to detect the feature (and the dwarf ’s
player should not be told whether this was because the check failed or because there
14 +18 +17 +16 +17 +17 was no feature to detect).
15 +18 +18 +17 +18 +18
Multiple Attacks: At 12th level, a dwarf is able to make two attacks per round
16 +18 +18 +17 +18 +18 against any creature that they are able to hit by rolling a 2+ on the attack roll (after
17 +18 +18 +17 +18 +18 modifiers). At 20th level, this rises to three attacks and at 36th level it rises to four
attacks. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of multiple attacks.
18 +18 +18 +17 +18 +18
19 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 Smash: At 12th level, a dwarf gains the ability to make smash attacks in melee. At
the beginning of the round, the dwarf ’s player declares that their character is mak-
20 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
ing a smash attack. The dwarf automatically loses initiative, and takes a –5 penalty
21 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 to their attack roll for the attack. However, if the attack hits then the dwarf gets to
22 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 add their strength score to the damage done by the attack as well as their strength
bonus. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of smash attacks.
23 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
24 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
25 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
26 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
27 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
28 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
29 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
30 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
31 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
32 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
33 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

35
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Parry: At 12th level, a dwarf can choose to use the parry action. branches. Elven communities usually have a deep respect for nature,
The dwarf ’s player declares that their character is parrying at the and work together with human druids.
beginning of the round before initiative is rolled. The dwarf makes
no attacks during the round (and therefore needs no initiative Elves are fine crafters of wood, and although they rarely mine for
score), but all incoming attacks are made at a –4 penalty. it themselves they are capable of delicate metalwork as well. Their
natural magical ability makes them excellent producers of magic
Spell Resistance: At 16th level and higher, a dwarf only takes half items known for their physical beauty as well as their power.
damage from all spells and spell-like abilities. If the attack normally
allows a saving throw for half damage then the dwarf only takes a Elves are the most powerful spell casters, although their slight frame
quarter of normal damage if they save successfully. and their deep-rooted psychological need for freedom from being
restricted prevents them from wearing armour or using shields.
Elf
Class Description: Elves are a demi-human race. Like most demi- Similarly, elves struggle in non-magical combat, being only able to
human races, they are less flexible than humans, and all elf adven- master the simplest of weapons and progressing more slowly than
turers are represented by a single class. any other character in terms of increasing their base attack bonus.

Elves are more slender and graceful than humans, but they are ap- In an adventuring party, an elf makes excellent artillery with a wide
proximately the same height. Although elves show a similar range of range of offensive spells; but must be protected by other characters
skin colours to those of humans in terms of shade, the hue of their as they are physically weak.
skin tends to be more yellow-brown than that of humans giving
them a colouration resembling that of wood anywhere from light At low levels, the small number of spells that an elf has can make
pine through to dark ebony. The ears of elves are pointed. them almost a liability to their party – but wise parties look after

Elves have no body or facial hair, although the hair on their heads is Developer Commentary
luxuriant, and changes colour throughout their life like the colours In the original edition of Dark Dungeons (and in the original game
of leaves change through seasons – starting a light green and slowly it emulates), magic-users are the ones who are weak and unable
darkening, as the elf matures before changing to brown, gold and to fight effectively, while elves are able to both fight and use magic.
red in old age.
Swapping this is a house rule i’ve used since the ‘90s (and which
Elves are naturally magical creatures, and all elves are capable of I included in Darker Dungeons) for two reasons. Firstly, it makes
casting low level magical spells. more sense to justify the lack of ability to wear armour as a racial
trait and it let magic-users fight Gandalf-style. Secondly, the elf class
Elven adventurers are usually much more highly skilled and have was a little overpowered and the magic-user class underpowered in
spell casting abilities better than the finest human magic-users. comparison, and the swap was an opportunity to move a couple of
However, despite their inherent magic elves are unable to become the racial abilities between them to even things up a bit.
clerics or shamans.
And there was also the fact that I simply liked the aesthetic of elves
Elves usually live in woodland or forest, and have an affinity for being physically weak yet magically powerful.
trees. Their towns tend to be in the treetops, woven out of living

36
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–6a: Elf Abilities by Level

Weapon Feats
Base Attack
Spells per Day by Spell Level
Experience

Hit Points

Bonus

Skills
Level

Special Abilities
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

1 0 4+c +1 4 2 1 – – – – – – – – Infravision / elfsight / ghoul immunity


2 2,500 7+2c +1 4 2 2 – – – – – – – –
3 5,000 10+3c +1 4 3 2 1 – – – – – – –
4 10,000 13+4c +2 4 3 2 2 – – – – – – –
5 20,000 16+5c +2 5 3 2 2 1 – – – – – –
6 40,000 19+6c +3 5 4 3 2 2 – – – – – –
7 80,000 22+7c +3 5 4 3 2 2 1 – – – – –
8 150,000 25+8c +4 5 4 3 3 2 2 – – – – –
9 300,000 28+9c +4 6 5 3 3 2 2 1 – – – –
10 450,000 29+9c +5 6 5 4 3 3 2 2 – – – –
11 600,000 30+9c +5 6 6 4 4 4 3 2 – – – –
12 750,000 31+9c +6 6 6 4 4 4 3 2 1 – – –
13 900,000 32+9c +6 7 6 5 4 4 3 2 2 – – –
14 1,050,000 33+9c +7 7 6 5 4 4 4 3 2 – – – Breath evasion
15 1,200,000 34+9c +7 7 7 5 4 4 4 3 2 1 – –
16 1,350,000 35+9c +8 7 7 5 5 5 4 3 2 2 – –
17 1,500,000 36+9c +8 8 7 6 5 5 4 4 3 2 – –
18 1,650,000 37+9c +9 8 7 6 5 5 4 4 3 2 1 –
19 1,800,000 38+9c +9 8 7 6 5 5 5 4 3 2 2 –
20 1,950,000 39+9c +10 8 7 6 5 5 5 4 4 3 2 –
21 2,100,000 40+9c +10 9 7 6 5 5 5 4 4 3 2 1
22 2,250,000 41+9c +11 9 7 6 6 5 5 5 4 3 2 2
23 2,400,000 42+9c +11 9 8 6 6 6 6 5 4 3 3 2
24 2,550,000 43+9c +12 9 8 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 3 2
25 2,700,000 44+9c +12 10 8 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 4 3
26 2,850,000 45+9c +13 10 8 7 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 3
27 3,000,000 46+9c +13 10 8 7 7 7 6 6 5 5 5 4
28 3,150,000 47+9c +14 10 8 8 8 7 6 6 6 6 5 4
29 3,300,000 48+9c +14 11 8 8 8 7 7 7 6 6 5 5
30 3,450,000 49+9c +15 11 9 8 8 8 7 7 7 6 6 5
31 3,600,000 50+9c +15 11 9 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 6 6
32 3,750,000 51+9c +16 11 9 9 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 6
33 3,900,000 52+9c +16 12 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 7 7 7
34 4,050,000 53+9c +17 12 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 7
35 4,200,000 54+9c +17 12 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8
36 4,350,000 55+9c +18 12 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9

37
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–6b: Elf Saving Throws their elves since should they survive to high level they will begin to wield awesome
destructive power.

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
Equipment Restrictions: Elves may not wear armour or use shields and may not
Level

Spell
use most weapons. The only weapons they may use are daggers, staves, slings, whips,
pistols, and nets.

1 +8 +7 +7 +5 +5 Elf Abilities (see Table 4–6a)


Hit Points: Elves gain (4 + Con bonus) hit points at first level, and then another (3
2 +8 +7 +7 +5 +5 + Con bonus) hit points per level of experience until 9th level. After 9th level, elves
3 +9 +8 +8 +6 +6 gain 1 hit point per level and do not add additional Con bonuses (but do retain the
bonuses to hit points gained at previous levels).
4 +11 +9 +9 +8 +8
5 +12 +10 +10 +9 +9 Base Attack Bonus: An elf ’s attack bonus is based on their level. See Chapter 10 –
6 +13 +11 +11 +10 +10 Combat for details of how this translates into to-hit numbers for different armour
classes.
7 +15 +12 +12 +12 +12
8 +16 +13 +13 +13 +13 Skills: An elf starts with 4 skill points plus extra points equal to their Int bonus.
These points can be used on the same skill or different skills. Elves gain more skill
9 +17 +14 +14 +14 +14 points as they rise in level. See Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for the list
10 +17 +15 +15 +16 +16 of available skills.
11 +18 +16 +16 +17 +17
Weapon Feats: Elves start with two weapon feats, which must be spent immediately
12 +18 +16 +16 +17 +17 on basic proficiency with two different weapons. See Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats
13 +18 +16 +16 +18 +18 for a description of how weapon feats work. Elves gain more weapon feats as they
rise in level, but these weapon feats cannot be spent immediately upon gaining the
14 +18 +17 +17 +18 +18 level. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for further details.
15 +18 +17 +17 +18 +18
Spells: Elves can cast magic-user spells. Additionally, an elf may (but does not have
16 +18 +17 +17 +18 +18 to) choose to specialise in one of the four types of magic-user spells: energy, entropy,
17 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 matter or spirit spells.
18 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 An elf who specialises in one of these types of spell will find that type of spell easier
19 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 to learn and prepare, but will find spells of the opposite type more difficult to learn
and prepare. See Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for detailed descriptions of
20 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
these spells and specialisation.
21 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
22 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 Providing an elf has had a good night’s sleep (8 hours), they can spend an hour study-
ing their spell book after waking up in order to gain spells for the day as indicated
23 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 on Table 4–6a.
24 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
A 1st level elf starts with only two spells in their spell book, and must acquire more
25 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 during their adventures. Elves may prepare any spell from their book in either the
26 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 normal or the reversed form (if the spell has a reversed form), but may not prepare
spells from someone else’s book or from a scroll; not even by using a Read Magic spell.
27 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
28 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 Each prepared spell can be cast once during the day, and if an elf wishes to cast a
29 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 spell more than once then they must prepare the spell more than once, taking up
multiple spell slots of the spell’s level.
30 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
31 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 Some magic-user spells are reversible. These spells can be reversed in order to have
an effect opposite to the normal effect of the spell. An elf chooses whether or not to
32 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 reverse the spell at the time of preparation, not at the time of casting.
33 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
A beginning elf starts with a spell book given to them by their master, and this spell
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
book will contain the spell Read Magic and one other 1st level spell of the player’s
35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 choice.
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

38
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
This spell book is a gift from the character’s master and does Table 4–7a: Fighter Abilities by Level
not need to be paid for.

Weapon Feats
Base Attack
Experience

Hit Points

Bonus
See Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for more informa-

Skills
Level
Special Abilities
tion on spells and spell casting.

Saving Throws: Elves make saving throws using the bonuses


listed on Table 4–6b. 1 0 8+c +1 4 4

Infravision: Elves have the ability to see not only the colour 2 2,000 13+2c +1 4 4
of things but also their temperature. When an elf is in the dark 3 4,000 18+3c +2 4 5
(and only then – normal light overloads an elf ’s infravision
4 8,000 13+4c +2 4 5
and prevents it from working) they can use their infravision to
navigate and even to fight. However, infravision doesn’t allow 5 16,000 28+5c +3 5 5
the elf to see pictures and writing unless they are carved into 6 32,000 33+6c +4 5 6
the surface that the elf is looking at.
7 64,000 38+7c +4 5 6
Elfsight: The superior eyesight of elves enables them to find 8 120,000 43+8c +5 5 6
secret and hidden doors more easily than other characters.
See Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving for more details on 9 240,000 48+9c +6 6 7 Smash / parry
secret doors. 10 360,000 50+9c +6 6 7
11 480,000 52+9c +7 6 8
Ghoul Immunity: Elves are immune to the paralysis caused
by the touch of ghouls and ghasts. They are not immune to 12 600,000 54+9c +8 6 8 Multiple attacks (2)
other forms of paralysis. 13 720,000 56+9c +8 7 8
Breath Evasion: At 14th level and higher, an elf only takes 14 840,000 58+9c +9 7 8
half damage from all breath weapons such as those used by 15 960,000 60+9c +10 7 9
dragons. If the attack normally allows a saving throw for half
damage then the elf only takes a quarter of normal damage if 16 1,080,000 62+9c +10 7 9
they save successfully. 17 1,200,000 64+9c +11 8 9

Fighter 18 1,320,000 66+9c +12 8 9


Class Description: Fighters are human characters who have 19 1,440,000 68+9c +12 8 10
been trained in the art of combat. They range from noble
20 1,560,000 70+9c +13 8 10
chevaliers and daring swashbucklers to brutal thugs and griz-
zled mercenaries. 21 1,680,000 72+9c +14 9 10
22 1,800,000 74+9c +14 9 10
In an adventuring party, fighters form the main front line,
holding off the enemy and protecting the more vulnerable 23 1,920,000 76+9c +15 9 11
party members. 24 2,040,000 78+9c +16 9 11 Multiple attacks (3)

Equipment Restrictions: Fighters can wear any armour or 25 2,160,000 80+9c +16 10 11
shield, and can use any weapon. 26 2,280,000 82+9c +17 10 11
27 2,400,000 84+9c +18 10 12
Fighter Abilities (see Table 4–7a)
Hit Points: Fighters gain (8 + Con bonus) hit points at first 28 2,520,000 86+9c +18 10 12
level, and then another (5 + Con bonus) hit points per level 29 2,640,000 88+9c +19 11 12
of experience until 9th level. After 9th level, fighters gain 2 hit
points per level and do not add additional Con bonuses (but 30 2,760,000 90+9c +20 11 13
do retain the bonuses to hit points gained at previous levels). 31 2,880,000 92+9c +20 11 13

Base Attack Bonus: A fighter’s attack bonus is based on their 32 3,000,000 94+9c +21 11 13
level. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of how this trans- 33 3,120,000 96+9c +22 12 14
lates into to-hit numbers for different armour classes.
34 3,240,000 98+9c +22 12 14
Skills: A fighter starts with 4 skill points plus extra points 35 3,360,000 100+9c +23 12 14
equal to their Int bonus. These points can be used on the
36 3,480,000 102+9c +23 12 15 Multiple attacks (4)

39
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–7b: Fighter Saving Throws same skill or different skills. Fighters gain more skill points as they rise in level. See
Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for the list of available skills.

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
Weapon Feats: Fighters start with four weapon feats, which must be spent imme-
Level

Spell
diately on basic proficiency with four different weapons. See Chapter 6 – Weapon
Feats for a description of how weapon feats work. Fighters gain more weapon feats as
they rise in level, but these weapon feats cannot be spent immediately upon gaining
1 +8 +7 +6 +5 +4 the level. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for further details.
2 +8 +7 +6 +5 +4 Saving Throws: Fighters make saving throws using the bonuses listed on Table 4–7b.
3 +9 +8 +7 +6 +5
Smash: At 9th level, a fighter gains the ability to make smash attacks in melee. At
4 +9 +8 +7 +6 +5
the beginning of the round, the fighter’s player declares that their character is mak-
5 +10 +9 +8 +7 +6 ing a smash attack. The fighter automatically loses initiative, and takes a –5 penalty
6 +11 +10 +9 +8 +7 to their attack roll for the attack. However, if the attack hits then the fighter gets to
add their strength score to the damage done by the attack as well as their strength
7 +11 +10 +9 +8 +7 bonus. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of smash attacks.
8 +12 +11 +10 +9 +8
Parry: At 9th level, a fighter can choose to use the parry action. The fighter’s player
9 +13 +12 +11 +10 +9 declares that their character is parrying at the beginning of the round before initia-
10 +13 +12 +11 +10 +9 tive is rolled. The fighter makes no attacks during the round (and therefore needs
no initiative score), but all incoming attacks are made at a –4 penalty.
11 +14 +13 +12 +11 +10
12 +14 +13 +12 +11 +10 Multiple Attacks: At 12th level, a fighter is able to make two attacks per round
13 +14 +14 +13 +12 +11 against any creature that they are able to hit by rolling a 2+ on the attack roll (after
modifiers). At 24th level, this rises to three attacks and at 36th level it rises to four
14 +14 +14 +13 +12 +11 attacks. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of multiple attacks.
15 +14 +14 +13 +12 +11
Chivalric Vows
16 +15 +14 +14 +13 +12 After reaching 9th level, a fighter who has received a title of nobility (knight or higher)
17 +15 +14 +14 +13 +12 might decide to take chivalric vows and dedicate themselves to a cause such as a
church or a noble. Taking chivalric vows puts restrictions on the fighter’s behaviour
18 +15 +14 +14 +13 +12 but gives them extra abilities in exchange.
19 +15 +15 +14 +14 +13
A fighter wishing to take chivalric vows must first find a suitable chivalric order with
20 +15 +15 +14 +14 +13
which they share an outlook, and then spend a month living with the order.
21 +15 +15 +14 +14 +13
22 +16 +15 +15 +15 +14 At the end of this time, the fighter undertakes a night long vigil, and then becomes
a chevalier. Once the fighter has qualified in this way, the order places them with a
23 +16 +15 +15 +15 +14 particular church or noble who is a supporter of the order.
24 +16 +15 +15 +15 +14
The fighter may or may not get a choice of liege, but betraying a liege is considered
25 +16 +16 +15 +16 +15 betrayal of the order and doing so strips the chevalier of all chivalric abilities and
26 +16 +16 +15 +16 +15 is also likely to incur the wrath of the order. All chevaliers must obey a strict code
of conduct, the exact details of which will vary from order to order but will usually
27 +16 +16 +15 +16 +15
involve a requirement to provide hospitality and/or sanctuary to fellow chevaliers
28 +17 +16 +16 +17 +16 of the same order.
29 +17 +16 +16 +17 +16
As a member of a chivalric order, the fighter gains the following benefits:
30 +17 +16 +16 +17 +16
31 +17 +17 +17 +18 +17 Detect Evil: The chevalier can cast a Detect Evil spell (as per the cleric spell of the
same name) as often as they like. Casting this spell does take the fighter’s action for
32 +17 +17 +17 +18 +17 a round, so cannot be done at the same time as attacking.
33 +17 +17 +17 +18 +17
Spells: Chevaliers with a wisdom score of at least 9 can cast cleric spells as if a cleric
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
of one third the chevalier’s level. For example a 17th level chevalier can cast spells
35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 as if a 6th level cleric. All the normal rules and restrictions that apply to a cleric’s
casting and preparation of spells also apply to the chevalier.
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

40
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character

Turn Undead: Chevaliers can turn undead as if a cleric of one third Encouragement: Once per round, during the statement of intent
the chevalier’s level. For example, a 17th level chevalier can turn phase, a warlord can exhort and encourage a single ally within
undead as if a 6th level cleric. All the normal rules and restrictions earshot, helping them to put aside pain and exhaustion and keep
that apply to a cleric’s turning undead also apply to the chevalier. fighting. The ally is immediately cured of 1d6+1 damage. The ally
must be able to understand the warlord’s words so it doesn’t work
Developer Commentary on unconscious allies, on allies who can’t hear the warlord, or on
In the original game that Dark Dungeons emulates, fighters could allies who don’t share a common language with them. A warlord
become paladins or avengers, depending on their alignment, although can’t encourage themselves, but two warlords can encourage each
both were extremely similar. Dark dungeons simplified this into a other. Giving encouragement does not count as an action for the
single chevalier option. warlord or the target. Each day, the warlord can give encourage-
ment a total number of times equal to their level divided by three.
Darker dungeons added the ranger option for those who preferred to
be associated with nature and druids rather than with religion and Tactics: At the beginning of each round, a warlord can assign some
clerics, and this new edition of Dark Dungeons adds the warlord or all of the benefits that they receive from weapon feats with their
option, loosely based on a class that is in more recent editions of the current weapons (including their shield) to one or more allies who
game that Dark Dungeons emulates. are within earshot and who can understand the warlord’s words by
a combination of advice, warnings and orders. See Chapter 6 –
Rangers Weapon Feats for more details about how the transferring of
Certain chivalric orders pledge their allegiance to an area of land weapon feat bonuses works.
rather than to a particular church or noble. To these orders, it
doesn’t matter who rules the land as long as the land itself is healthy Strategy: During mass battles, a warlord adds half their level to the
and free from monsters. Fighters who join these orders must re- battle score of any army they command. See Chapter 14 – War!
linquish their title of nobility as part of their investiture, and are for details.
known as rangers rather than chevaliers.
Halfling
Rangers have exactly the same benefits and strictures as chevaliers, Class Description: Halflings are a demi-human race. Like most
except that they cast druid spells rather than cleric spells, and get demi-human races, they are less flexible than humans, and all hal-
the control animals ability (as if a druid of one third their level) fling adventurers are represented by a single class.
rather than turn undead.
Halflings are much shorter and lighter than humans, standing
Warlords only 3’ tall. They are of a proportionally similar build to humans,
Fighters who choose to become neither chevaliers nor rangers at 9th with the exception of their feet – which are large and covered in
level may choose to become warlords instead. Unlike chevaliers or hair. The soles of halflings’ feet are tough and resilient, and halflings
rangers, a warlord need not pledge allegiance to any particular cause. often travel bare-footed.
Instead they rely on their great experience and expertise in strategy
and tactics to become leaders of others. Warlords are often found Halflings’ skin tone has a similar range to that of humans, as does
as the heads of mercenary companies or armies. A warlord retains their hair colour. Halflings do not grow beards or moustaches, but
all of their existing abilities and continues to rise in experience as the sideburns of adult males tend to be longer than those of humans.
normal, but also receives the following additional benefits: Like dwarves, halflings are an inherently non-magical race, and

41
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
possess no magic-users or clerics of their own. They Table 4–8a: Halfling Abilities by Level
share the dwarves’ natural resilience and resistance

Weapon Feats
to magical attacks, and although they are not as

Base Attack
Experience

Hit Points

Bonus
physically tough and adept at fighting as dwarves

Skills
Level
Special Abilities
they make up for this with their natural stealth.

Halflings are very gregarious and can be commonly


found living amongst humans and other demi-hu- 1 0 6+c +1 4 2 Small/nimble/unobtrusive
mans. If left to themselves, they form small villages
in grasslands and hills where they excel at farm- 2 2,000 10+2c +1 4 2
ing. Halfling food production and the halfling love 3 4,000 14+3c +1 4 3
of cookery and brewing make them very popular
4 8,000 18+4c +2 4 3
amongst the other races.
5 16,000 22+5c +2 5 3
Halfling adventurers make reasonably skilled war- 6 32,000 26+6c +3 5 4
riors and scouts who are excel in outdoor environ-
ments. 7 64,000 30+7c +3 5 4
8 120,000 34+8c +4 5 4
Equipment Restrictions: Halflings can wear any
armour, and can use any small weapon or shield 9 240,000 38+9c +4 6 5 Spell resistance
(but not a tower shield). They cannot use medium 10 360,000 39+9c +5 6 5
or large weapons.
11 480,000 40+9c +5 6 6 Multiple attacks/smash/parry
Halfling Abilities (see Table 4–8a) 12 600,000 41+9c +6 6 6
Hit Points: Halflings gain (6 + Con bonus) hit 13 720,000 42+9c +6 7 6
points at first level, and then another (4 + Con bo-
nus) hit points per level of experience until 9th level. 14 840,000 43+9c +7 7 6
15 960,000 44+9c +7 7 7 Breath evasion
After 9th level, halflings gain 1 hit point per level
and do not add additional Con bonuses (but do 16 1,080,000 45+9c +8 7 7
retain the bonuses to hit points gained at previous 17 1,200,000 46+9c +8 8 7
levels).
18 1,320,000 47+9c +9 8 7 Multiple attacks (3)
Base Attack Bonus: A halfling’s attack bonus is 19 1,440,000 48+9c +9 8 7
based on their level. See Chapter 10 – Combat for
20 1,560,000 49+9c +10 8 7
details of how this translates into to-hit numbers
for different armour classes. 21 1,680,000 50+9c +10 9 7
22 1,800,000 51+9c +11 9 7
Skills: A halfling starts with 4 skill points plus extra
points equal to their Int bonus. These points can 23 1,920,000 52+9c +11 9 8
be used on the same skill or different skills. Hal- 24 2,040,000 53+9c +12 9 8
flings gain more skill points as they rise in level. See
Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for the list 25 2,160,000 54+9c +12 10 8
of available skills. 26 2,280,000 55+9c +13 10 8
27 2,400,000 56+9c +13 10 8
Weapon Feats: Halflings start with two weapon
feats, which must be spent immediately on basic 28 2,520,000 57+9c +14 10 8
proficiency with two different weapons. See Chap- 29 2,640,000 58+9c +14 11 8
ter 6 – Weapon Feats for a description of how
weapon feats work. Halflings gain more weapon 30 2,760,000 59+9c +15 11 9
feats as they rise in level, but these weapon feats 31 2,880,000 60+9c +15 11 9
cannot be spent immediately upon gaining the level.
See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for further 32 3,000,000 61+9c +16 11 9
details. 33 3,120,000 62+9c +16 12 9
34 3,240,000 63+9c +17 12 9
Saving Throws: Halflings make saving throws using
the target difficulties listed on Table 4–8b. 35 3,360,000 64+9c +17 12 9
36 3,480,000 65+9c +18 12 10

42
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–8b: Halfling Saving Throws Developer Commentary
In the original game that Dark Dungeons emulates, demi-human classes such as halflings

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /
were treated somewhat weirdly when it came to experience points and levels.

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
Level

Spell
In earlier editions of the game, it was rare for an adventurer of any kind to reach level 10
and even the highest level characters were only around level 14. As a “balancing” factor,
demi-human characters were limited to slightly lower levels than human characters, being
1 +12 +11 +10 +7 +8 forced to stop somewhere between level 8 and level 12.
2 +12 +11 +10 +7 +9 However, when later game products came out increasing the maximum level for human
3 +13 +12 +11 +8 +10 characters to 36 this formerly minor difference in upper limit suddenly became huge.
4 +14 +13 +12 +10 +11
To “correct” this, the game designers added various experience point milestones beyond the
5 +15 +14 +13 +11 +12 level cap of demi-humans at which they improved their attacks and gained new special
6 +16 +15 +14 +12 +13 abilities. This meant that although their levels were technically capped, demi-humans
could still keep adventuring with humans at higher levels.
7 +17 +16 +15 +14 +15
8 +18 +17 +16 +15 +16 In the specific edition that Dark Dungeons emulates, there was an optional rule to simply
let demi-human characters increase to 36th level instead of using these experience point
9 +18 +17 +16 +15 +16 milestones. Unfortunately, the author of that edition simply set the experience requirements
10 +18 +18 +17 +16 +17 for level increase to be the same as the former milestones without taking into account
that one of the milestones was a much bigger step than a single level. As a consequence
11 +18 +18 +17 +16 +17
of this, the optional experience values for high level demi-humans were completely out of
12 +18 +18 +18 +17 +18 line with those for high level humans.
13 +18 +18 +18 +17 +18
Dark dungeons treats the higher levels for demi-humans as a core rule rather than an
14 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 option, and also brings down the experience requirements for them so that they are in line
15 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 with those that human characters need to reach similar levels rather than excessively high.

16 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18


Small: Halflings’ small size makes it hard for larger creatures to hit them. Halflings
17 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 gain a –2 bonus to armour class against attacks from creatures of larger than human
18 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 size.

19 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 Nimble: A halfling’s natural agility gives it a +1 bonus to attack rolls when using any
20 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 missile weapon and a +2 bonus to initiative rolls.
21 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 Unobtrusive: In outdoor surroundings, a halfling who remains still can hide by suc-
22 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 ceeding in a check with a bonus of +17, providing there are bushes, rocks or trees that
can be used as cover. Indoors, a halfling who remains still can hide by succeeding in
23 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
a check with a bonus of +6, as long as there is cover or shadow available.
24 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
25 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 Halflings use this ability to hide in natural daylight, but magical light such as that
from a Continual Light spell prevents this ability from working.
26 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
27 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 Spell Resistance: At 9th level and higher, a halfling only takes half damage from all
spells and spell-like abilities. If the attack normally allows a saving throw for half dam-
28 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 age then the halfling only takes a quarter of normal damage if they save successfully.
29 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
Multiple Attacks: At 11th level, a halfling is able to make two attacks per round
30 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
against any creature that they are able to hit by rolling a 2+ on the attack roll (after
31 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 modifiers).
32 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
At 18th level, this rises to three attacks. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of
33 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 multiple attacks.
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
Smash: At 11th level, a halfling gains the ability to make smash attacks in melee. At
35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 the beginning of the round, the halfling’s player declares that their character is making
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 a smash attack. The halfling automatically loses initiative, and takes a –5 penalty to

43
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character

their attack roll for the attack. However, if the attack hits then the eyes. Additionally, the strengthening of the lupine’s bestial spirit
halfling gets to add their strength score to the damage done by the gives them various magical abilities. However, this change is purely
attack as well as their strength bonus. See Chapter 10 – Combat physical. No matter how strong a lupine’s spirit and how savage
for details of smash attacks. their form, they retain their full intelligence and personality.

Parry: At 11th level, a halfling can choose to use the parry action. Lupines are not werewolves, and are completely unrelated to them.
The halfling’s player declares that their character is parrying at the They have little culture of their own and no homelands, having
beginning of the round before initiative is rolled. The halfling lived in human settlements for as long as anyone can remember,
makes no attacks during the round (and therefore needs no initia- although they are more common in rural towns than bigger cities.
tive score), but all incoming attacks are made at a –4 penalty.
Within an adventuring party, lupines can prove to be able warriors,
Breath Evasion: At 15th level and higher, a halfling only takes half though not quite as able as fighters; and back this talent up with
damage from all breath weapons such as those used by dragons. useful scouting skills.
If the attack normally allows a saving throw for half damage then
the halfling only takes a quarter of normal damage if they save Equipment Restrictions: Lupines may not wear any armour or
successfully. use any shield. They may use any weapon, but rarely wield melee
weapons since they are often better using their claws and teeth.
Lupine
Class Description: Lupines are a demi-human race. Like most Developer Commentary
demi-human races, they are less flexible than humans, and all lu- The lupine class is actually mechanically identical to a martial artist
pine adventurers are represented by a single class. class that appeared in the first edition of Dark Dungeons (and in the
game that it emulates). Their attacks and abilities were the result
Lupines are as tall as humans, and appear to be humanoid wolves. of using martial arts rather than being from a non-human form.
Their heads have a distinct canine shape and they have yellow eyes
and pointed ears. Lupines are covered with fur that ranges from Changing this class to a non-human one has been part of my house
white to black through a range of silvers and greys. The hands rules since the ‘90s, and was included in Darker Dungeons. The
and feet of a lupine are clawed, although they do have opposable reason for the change is simply that the rest of the character archetypes
thumbs; and they have bushy tails like those of wolves. are very “western”, and martial artists always seemed out of place
without the games having the cultures to back them up.
Lupines are a very spiritual race, and have a deep connection to
their primal bestial urges. While young lupines or those who have Reversing this change for your campaign won’t break anything.
not given in to their urges very often tend to appear soft and fluffy,
the more a lupine “lets the beast out” the more they physically
transform in a gradual but permanent way. Lupine Abilities (see Table 4–9a)
Hit Points: Lupines gain (6 + Con bonus) hit points at first level,
As a lupine gains experience and increases in level, their appear- and then another (4 + Con bonus) hit points per level of experi-
ance becomes more and more savage, until they reach the point ence until 9th level. After 9th level, lupines gain 2 hit points per
where they look like no natural wolf but more like a caricature of level and do not add additional Con bonuses (but do retain the
a werewolf, with oversized fangs, razor sharp claws, and glowing bonuses to hit points gained at previous levels).

44
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–9a: Lupine Abilities by Level
Thief Abilities

Weapon Feats
Armour Class
Base Attack
Experience

Movement
Hit Points

Claw/bite

Claw/bite

Claw/bite
Attack As
Damage
Attacks

Find Traps
Bonus
Special

Skills
Level

Shadows
Rate

Remove

Hide in
Silently
Climb
Traps

Walls

Move
Abilities

1 0 6+c +1 4 2 9 40’ 1 1d4 – +1 +1 +17 +3 +1


2 2,000 10+2c +1 4 2 8 45’ 1 1d4+1 S +2 +2 +17 +4 +2 Alertness
3 4,000 14+3c +1 4 3 7 45’ 1 1d6 S +3 +3 +17 +5 +3
4 8,000 18+4c +2 4 3 6 50’ 1 1d6+1 S +4 +4 +17 +6 +4 Self healing
5 16,000 22+5c +2 5 3 5 55’ 2 1d8 +1 +5 +5 +18 +7 +5
Speak with
6 32,000 26+6c +3 5 4 4 55’ 2 1d8+1 +1 +6 +6 +18 +8 +6
animals
7 64,000 30+7c +3 5 4 3 60’ 2 1d10 +1 +7 +7 +18 +9 +6
Spell res. /
8 120,000 34+8c +4 5 4 2 65’ 2 1d12 +2 +8 +8 +18 +10 +7
breath ev.
9 240,000 38+9c +4 6 5 1 65’ 3 2d8 +2 +9 +9 +18 +10 +8 Smash / parry
Speak with
10 360,000 40+9c +5 6 5 0 70’ 3 2d10 +2 +10 +9 +19 +11 +8
anyone
11 480,000 42+9c +5 6 6 –1 75’ 3 2d12 +3 +11 +10 +19 +12 +9
Mind of the
12 600,000 44+9c +6 6 6 –2 80’ 3 3d8+1 +3 +12 +11 +19 +12 +9
beast
13 720,000 46+9c +6 7 6 –3 85’ 4 4d6+2 +3 +13 +12 +19 +13 +10
Shadow
14 840,000 48+9c +7 7 6 –4 90’ 4 5d6 +4 +13 +12 +19 +13 +11
predator
15 960,000 50+9c +7 7 7 –5 95’ 4 4d8 +4 +14 +13 +20 +13 +11
16 1,080,000 52+9c +8 7 7 –6 100’ 4 3d12 +5 +15 +13 +20 +14 +11 Apotheriosis
17 1,200,000 54+9c +8 8 7 –6 100’ 4 3d12 +5 +15 +14 +20 +14 +12
18 1,320,000 56+9c +9 8 7 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +16 +15 +20 +15 +12
19 1,440,000 58+9c +9 8 7 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +17 +15 +20 +15 +13
20 1,560,000 60+9c +10 8 7 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +17 +16 +21 +15 +13
21 1,680,000 62+9c +10 9 7 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +18 +16 +21 +16 +13
22 1,800,000 64+9c +11 9 7 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +18 +17 +21 +16 +14
23 1,920,000 66+9c +11 9 8 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +19 +18 +21 +17 +14
24 2,040,000 68+9c +12 9 8 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +19 +18 +21 +17 +15
25 2,160,000 70+9c +12 10 8 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +19 +19 +22 +17 +15
26 2,280,000 72+9c +13 10 8 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +19 +19 +22 +17 +15
27 2,400,000 74+9c +13 10 8 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +20 +20 +22 +18 +16
28 2,520,000 76+9c +14 10 8 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +20 +21 +22 +18 +16
29 2,640,000 78+9c +14 11 8 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +20 +21 +22 +18 +17
30 2,760,000 80+9c +15 11 9 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +20 +22 +23 +18 +17
31 2,880,000 82+9c +15 11 9 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +20 +22 +23 +18 +17
32 3,000,000 84+9c +16 11 9 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +21 +23 +23 +19 +18
33 3,120,000 86+9c +16 12 9 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +21 +24 +23 +19 +18
34 3,240,000 88+9c +17 12 9 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +21 +24 +23 +19 +19
35 3,360,000 90+9c +17 12 9 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +21 +25 +23 +19 +19
36 3,480,000 92+9c +18 12 10 –6 105’ 4 3d12 +5 +21 +25 +23 +19 +19

45
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Base Attack Bonus: A lupine’s attack bonus is based on their level. It is important to note that this bonus is only used to determine
See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of how this translates into whether or not a lupine is capable of hurting an opponent. The lu-
to-hit numbers for different armour classes. pine does not actually get this bonus on their to hit or damage rolls.

Skills: A lupine starts with 4 skill points plus extra points equal to Find Traps: A lupine’s wolf-like senses are able to detect the pres-
their Int bonus. These points can be used on the same skill or dif- ence of traps on objects or in areas. Table 4–9a lists the bonus
ferent skills. Lupines gain more skill points as they rise in level. See to checks for finding each trap in an area. The lupine does not
Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for the list of available skills. automatically get to roll for this ability. Their player must state
that the character is searching the area.
Weapon Feats: Lupines start with two weapon feats, which must be
spent immediately on basic proficiency with two different weapons. The Game Master should roll the dice and inform the lupine’s player
See Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats for a description of how weapon whether any traps were found. If no traps are found the lupine
feats work. Lupines gain more weapon feats as they rise in level, will not know whether it is because there were no traps or whether
but these weapon feats cannot be spent immediately upon gaining they simply failed to notice them. In some cases a particularly well
the level. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for further details. hidden (or badly hidden) trap may cause there to be a modifier to
the lupine’s check.
Armour Class: Although lupines cannot wear armour or use de-
fensive items, their armour class increases as they go up levels and Remove Traps: If a lupine is aware of the existence of a trap, they
their hide toughens to supernatural levels. The armour class of a may try to disarm it to prevent it from being triggered. The bonus
lupine of a particular level is listed on Table 4–9a. to the check needed for this is listed on Table 4–9a.

Movement Rate: Lupines increase their movement rate as they Should this ability fail, the trap will be activated. In some cases
increase in level. The movement of a lupine of a particular level a particularly complex (or simple) trap may cause there to be a
(in feet per round) is listed on Table 4–9a. modifier to the lupine’s check. A lupine may try multiple times
to remove the same trap, although since the trap is activated each
Claw/bite Attacks: When a lupine reaches 5th level, they can make time the lupine tries, doing so can be dangerous.
two attacks per round while they are unarmed and attacking using
their natural weaponry. Climb Walls: Lupines are able to climb walls and other sheer sur-
faces using their sharp claws.
They do not get the extra attack when using weapons or when us-
ing the unarmed strikes proficiency to stun foes (see Chapter 6 – The bonus for the check needed to do this successfully is listed in
Weapon Feats for more details about the unarmed strikes profi- Table 4–9a. The lupine’s player must roll for each 100’ or part
ciency). At 9th level this increases to three attacks per round, and of 100’ climbed, with a failure indicating that the lupine has fallen
at 13th level it increases again to 4 attacks per round. half way through the climb. See Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving
for details about falling.
Claw/Bite Damage: When attacking while unarmed, a lupine can
choose to use their natural weaponry when using the unarmed In some cases a slippery or smooth surface (or a particularly rough
strikes proficiency instead of striking to stun (see Chapter 6 – one) may cause there to be a modifier to the lupine’s check.
Weapon Feats for further details). If they do so, they do more
damage (and strength bonuses apply as normal), but lose the chance Move Silently: Lupines are able to move without being heard. The
to stun or knock out their opponent. bonus to the check needed for success is listed in Table 4–9a. The
lupine’s player must roll for each round of movement, with a failure
This damage starts at 1d4 at 1st level, and increases with level until indicating that the lupine has made a sound that others might hear.
it reaches a maximum of 3d12 damage at 16th level. The damage
done by a lupine of a particular level is listed on Table 4–9a. The Game Master should roll the dice when the lupine is sneak-
ing, so that the lupine’s player does not know whether or not their
Unarmed Attack As: Because of the semi-magical nature of a character has been heard.
lupine’s spiritual transformation, their unarmed attacks (whether
striking to stun or using their natural weapons) count as if they are Hide in Shadows: A lupine is able to hide effectively providing
magical for the purposes of determining whether they can affect there is cover or shadows to hide in. The bonus to the check needed
creatures who may be immune to non-magical weapons. for success is listed in Table 4–9a.

At 2nd level a lupine’s unarmed attacks can hit creatures only hurt The Game Master should roll the dice when the lupine is hiding,
by silver weapons, and at 5th level they can start to hit creatures so that the lupine’s player does not know whether or not their
only hit by magic weapons. The effective bonus of the lupine’s at- character has been spotted.
tacks continues to increase as listed in Table 4–9a.
The Game Master must roll for the initial hiding, and then for each
round of movement, with a failure indicating that the lupine has

46
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
temporarily become visible. If someone is watching the lupine before they start to Table 4–9b: Lupine Saving Throws
hide, they will still be able to see the lupine regardless of the success or otherwise

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /
of this skill.

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
Level

Spell
Saving Throws: Lupines make saving throws using the bonuses listed on Table 4–9b.

Alertness: When a fight suddenly breaks out, or when two groups come face to
face abruptly, a 2nd level or higher lupine is only surprised if their player rolls a 1 1 +8 +7 +6 +5 +4
on a d6, rather than the normal 1–2 on a d6. See Chapter 10 – Combat for more
details on surprise. 2 +8 +7 +6 +5 +4
3 +9 +8 +7 +6 +5
Self Healing: Starting at 4th level, once per day, a lupine can spend a round con-
4 +9 +8 +7 +6 +5
centrating and heal themselves 1 hit point per level that they have.
5 +10 +9 +8 +7 +6
Speak with Animals: A 6th level or higher lupine is able to understand the speech 6 +11 +10 +9 +8 +7
of any animal, and is able to make any animal understand their speech.
7 +11 +10 +9 +8 +7
This is a spiritual ability, not a physical one. For example, if conversing with a cat, 8 +12 +11 +10 +9 +8
the lupine does not actually meow and purr but talks normally – reaching into the
cat’s mind to make it understand. 9 +13 +12 +11 +10 +9
10 +13 +12 +11 +10 +9
This ability does not bestow any extra intelligence to the animal. Neither does it force
11 +14 +13 +12 +11 +10
the animal to obey or even co-operate with the lupine.
12 +14 +13 +12 +11 +10
Spell Resistance: At 8th level and higher, a lupine only takes half damage from all 13 +14 +14 +13 +12 +11
spells and spell-like abilities. If the attack normally allows a saving throw for half
damage then the lupine only takes a quarter of normal damage if they save successfully. 14 +14 +14 +13 +12 +11
15 +14 +14 +13 +12 +11
Breath Evasion: At 8th level and higher, a lupine only takes half damage from all
breath weapons such as those used by dragons. If the attack normally allows a sav- 16 +15 +14 +14 +13 +12
ing throw for half damage then the lupine only takes a quarter of normal damage 17 +15 +14 +14 +13 +12
if they save successfully.
18 +15 +14 +14 +13 +12
Smash: At 9th level, a lupine gains the ability to make smash attacks in melee. At 19 +15 +15 +14 +14 +13
the beginning of the round, the lupine’s player declares that their character is making
20 +15 +15 +14 +14 +13
a smash attack. The lupine automatically loses initiative, and takes a –5 penalty to
their attack roll for the attack. 21 +15 +15 +14 +14 +13
22 +16 +15 +15 +15 +14
However, if the attack hits then the lupine gets to add their strength score to the
damage done by the attack as well as their strength bonus. See Chapter 10 – Combat 23 +16 +15 +15 +15 +14
for details of smash attacks. A lupine can use their smash attack either with a weapon 24 +16 +15 +15 +15 +14
or with a single unarmed attack.
25 +16 +16 +15 +16 +15
Parry: At 9th level, a lupine can choose to use the parry action. The lupine’s player 26 +16 +16 +15 +16 +15
declares that their character is parrying at the beginning of the round before initia-
27 +16 +16 +15 +16 +15
tive is rolled. The lupine makes no attacks during the round (and therefore needs no
initiative score), but all incoming attacks are made at a –4 penalty. 28 +17 +16 +16 +17 +16
29 +17 +16 +16 +17 +16
Speak with Anyone: At 10th level, a lupine’s speak with animals ability is no longer
limited to animals and can now be used to speak with any creature that has a natural 30 +17 +16 +16 +17 +16
language. 31 +17 +17 +17 +18 +17

Mind of the Beast: Starting at 12th level, lupines are immune to charm, quest and 32 +17 +17 +17 +18 +17
Geas spells, hold and Slow spells, and ESP. 33 +17 +17 +17 +18 +17
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
Shadow Predator: At 14th level and higher, a lupine can make themselves fade
from view once per day. This is a mental effect rather than a physical invisibility 35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

47
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–10a: Magic-user Abilities by Level

Weapon Feats
Base Attack
Spells per Day by Spell Level
Experience

Hit Points

Bonus

Skills
Level

Special Abilities
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

1 0 6+c +1 4 2 1 – – – – – – – –
2 4,000 10+2c +1 4 2 2 – – – – – – – –
3 8,000 14+3c +1 4 3 2 1 – – – – – – –
4 16,000 18+4c +2 4 3 2 2 – – – – – – –
5 32,000 22+5c +2 5 3 2 2 1 – – – – – –
6 64,000 26+6c +3 5 4 3 2 2 – – – – – –
7 120,000 30+7c +3 5 4 3 2 2 1 – – – – –
8 250,000 34+8c +4 5 4 3 3 2 2 – – – – –
9 400,000 38+9c +4 6 5 3 3 2 2 1 – – – –
10 550,000 39+9c +5 6 5 4 3 3 2 2 – – – –
11 700,000 40+9c +5 6 6 4 4 4 3 2 – – – – Multiple attacks (2) / smash / parry
12 850,000 41+9c +6 6 6 4 4 4 3 2 1 – – –
13 1,000,000 42+9c +6 7 6 5 4 4 3 2 2 – – –
14 1,150,000 43+9c +7 7 6 5 4 4 4 3 2 – – –
15 1,300,000 44+9c +7 7 7 5 4 4 4 3 2 1 – –
16 1,450,000 45+9c +8 7 7 5 5 5 4 3 2 2 – –
17 1,600,000 46+9c +8 8 7 6 5 5 4 4 3 2 – –
18 1,750,000 47+9c +9 8 7 6 5 5 4 4 3 2 1 –
19 1,900,000 48+9c +9 8 7 6 5 5 5 4 3 2 2 –
20 2,050,000 49+9c +10 8 7 6 5 5 5 4 4 3 2 – Multiple attacks (3)
21 2,200,000 50+9c +10 9 7 6 5 5 5 4 4 3 2 1
22 2,350,000 51+9c +11 9 7 6 6 5 5 5 4 3 2 2
23 2,500,000 52+9c +11 9 8 6 6 6 6 5 4 3 3 2
24 2,650,000 53+9c +12 9 8 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 3 2
25 2,800,000 54+9c +12 10 8 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 4 3
26 2,950,000 55+9c +13 10 8 7 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 3
27 3,100,000 56+9c +13 10 8 7 7 7 6 6 5 5 5 4
28 3,250,000 57+9c +14 10 8 8 8 7 6 6 6 6 5 4
29 3,400,000 58+9c +14 11 8 8 8 7 7 7 6 6 5 5
30 3,550,000 59+9c +15 11 9 8 8 8 7 7 7 6 6 5
31 3,700,000 60+9c +15 11 9 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 6 6
32 3,850,000 61+9c +16 11 9 9 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 6
33 4,000,000 62+9c +16 12 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 7 7 7
34 4,150,000 63+9c +17 12 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 7
35 4,300,000 64+9c +17 12 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8
36 4,450,000 65+9c +18 12 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9

48
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
effect, so spells and abilities that can detect the presence of invisible creatures do Table 4–10b: Magic-user Saving Throws
not detect the lupine.

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
The fade lasts for up to one round per level of the lupine, and stops instantly if the

Level

Spell
lupine does something to attract attention to themselves such as attacking or speaking.

Apotheriosis: At 16th level and higher, a lupine has completed their spiritual trans-
formation and now embodies their beast spirit totally. 1 +7 +6 +7 +4 +5

Once per day, they are able to touch an opponent (this requires an attack check in 2 +7 +6 +7 +4 +5
combat) and allow their beast spirit to influence their target. 3 +7 +6 +7 +4 +5
4 +7 +6 +7 +4 +6
The apotheriosis can have one of the following effects on the target, who gets no sav-
ing throw against the affect but must have no more hit dice or levels than the lupine: 5 +8 +7 +8 +5 +6
6 +8 +7 +8 +5 +7
◊ Charm Person (as the spell of the same name, except lasting only 24 hours)
◊ Cureall (as the spell of the same name) 7 +9 +8 +9 +6 +7
◊ Death 8 +9 +8 +9 +6 +8
◊ Quest (as the spell of the same name except lasting only 24 hours)
◊ Paralysis (lasting 24 hours) 9 +9 +8 +9 +6 +9
10 +10 +9 +10 +7 +9
The apotheriosis ability can only be used once per day, and the desired effect must
11 +10 +9 +10 +7 +10
be announced before the attack check is made. However, if the attack misses then
the apotheriosis is not used up and can be attempted again against the same target 12 +11 +10 +11 +8 +10
or a different target. 13 +11 +10 +11 +8 +11
Magic-user 14 +11 +10 +11 +8 +12
Class Description: Magic-users are human characters who have studied the arcane 15 +12 +11 +12 +9 +12
arts and who are able to cast magical spells.
16 +12 +11 +12 +9 +13
Unlike the inherently magical elves, magic does not come easily to humans, and 17 +13 +12 +13 +10 +13
prospective magic-users must study for years before they are able to master it. In some
larger cities such studying is done in a university, but in more rural areas with fewer 18 +13 +12 +13 +10 +14
resources and fewer people it is more likely to be a master / apprentice system. The 19 +13 +12 +13 +10 +14
rigours of spell casting require the magic-user to be strong in both mind and body, so
20 +14 +13 +14 +11 +15
magic-user training includes a strong martial component as well as an academic one.
21 +14 +13 +14 +11 +15
Unfortunately, this dual training regime is very difficult to maintain, and consequent- 22 +15 +14 +15 +12 +16
ly magic-users increase in level more slowly than any characters of any other class.
23 +15 +14 +15 +12 +16
In an adventuring situation, magic-users can both fight competently (although 24 +15 +15 +15 +13 +16
not quite as well as a fighter or dwarf ) and use magic (casting spells as well as an
elf – although with fewer magic item available to them) making them very flexible. 25 +16 +15 +16 +13 +17
26 +16 +16 +16 +14 +17
Equipment Restrictions: Magic-users may use any armour and shield, and can use
27 +16 +16 +16 +14 +17
any weapons.
28 +16 +16 +16 +15 +17
Magic-user Abilities (see Table 4–10a) 29 +17 +17 +17 +15 +18
Hit Points: Magic-users gain (6 + Con bonus) hit points at first level, and then
another (4 + Con bonus) hit points per level of experience until 9th level. After 9th 30 +17 +17 +17 +16 +18
level, magic-users gain 1 hit point per level and do not add additional Con bonuses 31 +17 +17 +17 +16 +18
(but do retain the bonuses to hit points gained at previous levels).
32 +17 +17 +17 +17 +18
Base Attack Bonus: A magic-user’s attack bonus is based on their level. See Chap- 33 +18 +18 +18 +17 +18
ter 10 – Combat for details of how this translates into to-hit numbers for different
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
armour classes.
35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

49
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character

Skills: A magic-user starts with 4 skill points plus extra points Developer Commentary
equal to their Int bonus. These points can be used on the same The ability to specialise in one of four types of magic-user spell (and
skill or different skills. the equivalent for clerics of specialising in one to three domains) is
a house rule i’ve used since the early ‘90s.
Magic-users gain more skill points as they rise in level. See Chap-
ter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for the list of available skills. It wasn’t put into the original edition of Dark Dungeons because it
might upset purists who wanted a more exact clone of the game that
Weapon Feats: Magic-users start with two weapon feats, which it emulates, but it was included in Darker Dungeons.
must be spent immediately on basic proficiency with two different
weapons. See Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats for a description of how
weapon feats work. Magic-users gain more weapon feats as they the spell more than once, taking up multiple spell slots of the
rise in level, but these weapon feats cannot be spent immediately spell’s level.
upon gaining the level. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for
further details. Some magic-user spells are reversible. These spells can be reversed
in order to have an effect opposite to the normal effect of the spell.
Spells: Magic-users can cast magic-user spells. Additionally, a A magic-user chooses whether or not to reverse the spell at the time
magic-user may (but does not have to) choose to specialise in one of preparation, not at the time of casting.
of the four types of magic-user spells: energy, entropy, matter or
spirit spells. A beginning magic-user starts with a spell book given to them by
their master, and this spell book will contain the spell Read Magic
A magic-user who specialises in one of these types of spell will and one other 1st level spell of the player’s choice. This spell book
find that type of spell easier to learn and prepare, but will find is a gift from the character’s master and does not need to be paid for.
spells of the opposite type more difficult to learn and prepare. See
Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for detailed descriptions See Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for more information
of these spells. on spells and spell casting.

Providing a magic-user has had a good night’s sleep (8 hours), they Saving Throws: Magic-users make saving throws using the bonuses
can spend an hour studying their spell book after waking up in listed on Table 4–10b.
order to gain spells for the day as indicated on Table 4–10a.
Multiple Attacks: At 11th level, a magic-user is able to make two
A 1st level magic-user starts with only two spells in their spell book, attacks per round against any creature that they are able to hit by
and must acquire more during their adventures. Magic-users may rolling a 2+ on the attack roll (after modifiers). At 20th level, this
prepare any spell from their book in either the normal or the re- rises to three attacks. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of
versed form (if the spell has a reversed form), but may not prepare multiple attacks.
spells from someone else’s book or from a scroll; not even by using
a Read Magic spell. Smash: At 11th level, a magic-user gains the ability to make smash
attacks in melee. At the beginning of the round, the magic-user’s
Each prepared spell can be cast once during the day, and if a magic- player declares that their character is making a smash attack.
user wishes to cast a spell more than once then they must prepare

50
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
The magic-user automatically loses initiative, and takes a –5 penalty Base Attack Bonus: A mountebank’s attack bonus is based on their
to their attack roll for the attack. However, if the attack hits then level. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of how this translates
the magic-user gets to add their strength score to the damage done into to-hit numbers for different armour classes.
by the attack as well as their strength bonus. See Chapter 10 –
Combat for details of smash attacks. Skills: A mountebank starts with 4 skill points plus extra points
equal to their Int bonus. These points can be used on the same
Parry: At 11th level, a magic-user can choose to use the parry action. skill or different skills.
The magic-user’s player declares that their character is parrying at
the beginning of the round before initiative is rolled. The magic- Mountebanks gain more skill points as they rise in level. See Chap-
user makes no attacks during the round (and therefore needs no ter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills for the list of available skills.
initiative score), but all incoming attacks are made at a –4 penalty.
Weapon Feats: Mountebanks start with two weapon feats, which
Mountebank must be spent immediately on basic proficiency with two different
Class Description: Mountebanks are human characters who dab- weapons. See Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats for a description of how
ble in many areas rather than concentrating in one. They can fight weapon feats work. Mountebanks gain more weapon feats as they
a bit, and sneak a bit, and cast a bit of magic. rise in level, but these weapon feats cannot be spent immediately
upon gaining the level. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for
They tend to be charismatic social butterflies, who bluff their way further details.
through life and who rely on their wits to survive rather than any
particular ability. Spells: Mountebanks can cast magic-user spells. Unlike magic-
users and elves, mountebanks cannot specialise in a particular type
Although many mountebanks are the worst sort of dishonest char- of spell. See Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for detailed
latans claiming abilities they do not have and making money by descriptions of these spells.
petty con tricks and magically enhanced larceny, they are a varied
bunch and are just as likely to be using their abilities for simple Providing a mountebank has had a good night’s sleep (8 hours),
fun or to take down those who prey on the weak. they can spend an hour studying their spell book after waking up
in order to gain spells for the day as indicated on Table 4–1ia.
As with thieves, they tend to be accepted by adventuring parties
more readily than by the general public, and their charismatic A 1st level mountebank starts with only two spells in their spell
nature often makes them the “face” of the party. book, and must acquire more during their adventures.

Because of their nature as dilettantes, mountebanks tend not to be Mountebanks may prepare any spell from their book in either the
formally trained in the way that magic-users are. However, a moun- normal or the reversed form (if the spell has a reversed form), but
tebank will often take an aspiring youngster under their wing and may not prepare spells from someone else’s book or from a scroll;
teach them the “tricks of the trade”, acting as a mentor and advisor. not even by using a Read Magic spell.

Although mountebanks are not the greatest fighters in the world, Each prepared spell can be cast once during the day, and if a moun-
their swashbuckling skills are not to be derided, and their weak tebank wishes to cast a spell more than once then they must prepare
magic can actually serve as an asset. Because they are unable to the spell more than once, taking up multiple spell slots of the
compete with elves or with “true” magic-users in terms of spells spell’s level.
that do direct damage, it gives them the freedom to prepare more
utilitarian spells that more combat-magic able spell casters would Some magic-user spells are reversible. These spells can be reversed
otherwise not have room for. in order to have an effect opposite to the normal effect of the spell.
A mountebank chooses whether or not to reverse the spell at the
Equipment Restrictions: Mountebanks may use any one-handed time of preparation, not at the time of casting.
weapon, and may use leather armour. Since they must travel lightly
in order to use their abilities they may not use two-handed weapons A beginning mountebank starts with a spell book given to them by
or shields except for bucklers. Mountebanks may use any missile their mentor, and this spell book will contain the spell Read Magic
weapon. and one other 1st level spell of the player’s choice. This spell book is
a gift from the character’s mentor and does not need to be paid for.
Mountebank Abilities (Table 4–11a)
Hit Points: Mountebanks gain (4 + Con bonus) hit points at first See Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for more information
level, and then another (3 + Con bonus) hit points per level of on spells and spell casting.
experience until 9th level.
Climb Walls: Mountebanks are able to climb walls and other sheer
After 9th level, mountebanks gain 2 hit points per level and do surfaces. The bonus for the check needed to do this successfully
not add additional Con bonuses (but do retain the bonuses to hit is listed in Table 4–11a. The mountebank’s player must roll for
points gained at previous levels). each 100’ or part of 100’ climbed, with a failure indicating that

51
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–11a: Mountebank Abilities by Level
Spells per Day by Spell Level Thief Abilities

Weapon Feats
Base Attack
Experience

Hit Points

Bonus

Skills
Level

Shadows

Pockets
Hide in
Silently
Climb
Special Abilities

Walls

Move

Pick
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

1 0 4+c +1 4 2 1 – – – – – – – +17 +3 +1 +3 Weak magic, item use


2 1,200 7+2c +1 4 2 1 – – – – – – – +17 +4 +2 +4
3 2,400 10+3c +1 4 3 2 – – – – – – – +17 +5 +3 +5
4 4,800 13+4c +2 4 3 2 – – – – – – – +17 +6 +4 +6
5 9,600 16+5c +2 5 3 2 1 – – – – – – +18 +7 +5 +7
6 20,000 19+6c +3 5 4 2 1 – – – – – – +18 +8 +6 +8
7 40,000 22+7c +3 5 4 2 2 – – – – – – +18 +9 +6 +9
8 80,000 25+8c +4 5 4 2 2 – – – – – – +18 +10 +7 +10
9 160,000 28+9c +4 6 5 2 2 1 – – – – – +18 +10 +8 +11
10 280,000 30+9c +5 6 5 2 2 1 – – – – – +19 +11 +8 +12
11 400,000 32+9c +5 6 6 3 2 2 – – – – – +19 +12 +9 +13
12 520,000 34+9c +6 6 6 3 2 2 – – – – – +19 +12 +9 +14
13 640,000 36+9c +6 7 6 3 2 2 1 – – – – +19 +13 +10 +15
14 760,000 38+9c +7 7 6 3 2 2 1 – – – – +19 +13 +11 +16
15 880,000 40+9c +7 7 7 3 3 2 2 – – – – +20 +13 +11 +17
16 1,000,000 42+9c +8 7 7 3 3 2 2 – – – – +20 +14 +11 +18
17 1,120,000 44+9c +8 8 7 3 3 2 2 1 – – – +20 +14 +12 +19
18 1,240,000 46+9c +9 8 7 3 3 2 2 1 – – – +20 +15 +12 +20
19 1,360,000 48+9c +9 8 7 4 3 3 2 2 – – – +20 +15 +13 +21
20 1,480,000 50+9c +10 8 7 4 3 3 2 2 – – – +21 +15 +13 +22
21 1,600,000 52+9c +10 9 7 4 4 4 3 2 – – – +21 +16 +13 +23
22 1,720,000 54+9c +11 9 7 4 4 4 3 2 – – – +21 +16 +14 +23
23 1,840,000 56+9c +11 9 8 4 4 4 3 2 1 – – +21 +17 +14 +25
24 1,960,000 58+9c +12 9 8 4 4 4 3 2 1 – – +21 +17 +15 +26
25 2,080,000 60+9c +12 10 8 5 4 4 3 2 2 – – +22 +17 +15 +27
26 2,200,000 62+9c +13 10 8 5 4 4 3 2 2 – – +22 +17 +15 +28
27 2,320,000 64+9c +13 10 8 5 4 4 4 3 2 – – +22 +18 +16 +29
28 2,440,000 66+9c +14 10 8 5 4 4 4 3 2 – – +22 +18 +16 +30
29 2,560,000 68+9c +14 11 8 5 4 4 4 3 2 1 – +22 +18 +17 +31
30 2,680,000 70+9c +15 11 9 5 4 4 4 3 2 1 – +23 +18 +17 +32
31 2,800,000 72+9c +15 11 9 5 5 5 4 3 2 2 – +23 +18 +17 +33
32 2,920,000 74+9c +16 11 9 5 5 5 4 3 2 2 – +23 +19 +18 +34
33 3,040,000 76+9c +16 12 9 6 5 5 4 4 3 2 – +23 +19 +18 +35
34 3,160,000 78+9c +17 12 9 6 5 5 4 4 3 2 – +23 +19 +19 +36
35 3,280,000 80+9c +17 12 9 6 5 5 4 4 3 2 1 +23 +19 +19 +37
36 3,400,000 82+9c +18 12 10 6 5 5 4 4 3 2 1 +23 +19 +19 +38

52
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–11b: Mountebank Saving Throws

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
Level

Spell
1 +7 +6 +7 +4 +5
2 +7 +6 +7 +4 +5
3 +7 +6 +7 +4 +5
4 +8 +7 +8 +5 +6
5 +8 +7 +8 +5 +6
6 +9 +8 +9 +6 +7
7 +9 +8 +9 +6 +7
8 +10 +9 +10 +7 +8
9 +10 +9 +10 +7 +8
the mountebank has fallen half way through the climb. See Chapter 9 – Dungeon 10 +11 +10 +11 +8 +9
Delving for details about falling.
11 +11 +10 +11 +8 +9
In some cases a slippery or smooth surface (or a particularly rough one) may cause 12 +12 +11 +12 +9 +10
there to be a modifier to the mountebank’s check.
13 +12 +11 +12 +9 +10
Move Silently: Mountebanks are able to move without being heard. The bonus to 14 +13 +12 +13 +10 +11
the check needed for success is listed in Table 4–11a.
15 +13 +12 +13 +10 +11
The mountebank’s player must roll for each round of movement, with a failure indicat- 16 +14 +13 +14 +11 +12
ing that the mountebank has made a sound that others might hear. The Game Master 17 +14 +13 +14 +11 +12
should roll the dice when the mountebank is sneaking, so that the mountebank’s
player does not know whether or not their character has been heard. 18 +15 +14 +15 +12 +13
19 +15 +14 +15 +12 +13
Hide in Shadows: A mountebank is able to hide effectively providing there is cover
or shadows to hide in. The bonus to the check needed for success is listed in Ta- 20 +15 +14 +15 +13 +14
ble 4–11a. The mountebank’s player must roll for the initial hiding, and then for 21 +16 +15 +16 +13 +14
each round of movement, with a failure indicating that the mountebank has tem-
22 +16 +15 +16 +14 +15
porarily become visible.
23 +16 +15 +16 +14 +15
The Game Master should roll the dice when the mountebank is hiding, so that the
24 +16 +15 +16 +15 +15
mountebank’s player does not know whether or not their character has been spotted.
If someone is watching the mountebank before they start to hide, they will still be 25 +17 +16 +17 +15 +16
able to see the mountebank regardless of the success or otherwise of this skill. 26 +17 +16 +17 +16 +16

Pick Pockets: A mountebank is able to pick the pockets of others in order to steal 27 +17 +16 +17 +16 +16
small items from them, with the bonus to the check required for success listed in 28 +17 +16 +17 +16 +16
Table 4–11a.
29 +18 +17 +18 +17 +17
This ability can be used to steal purses or belt pouches, or even steal a weapon from 30 +18 +17 +18 +17 +18
its scabbard, but cannot be used to steal anything that is being held by the target or
31 +18 +17 +18 +17 +18
is strapped onto the target such as a backpack or armour. The level or hit dice of the
target is subtracted from the check total as a modifier. 32 +18 +17 +18 +17 +18
33 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
The mountebank’s player must state the item that they wish to steal before rolling. If
the mountebank’s check is a success then they successfully steal the item. If the total 34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
of their check is less than 20 but greater than or equal to 10 then they are unable to 35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
steal the item but their attempted theft goes unnoticed.
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

53
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
If the result of their check is less than 10, or they roll a natural 1 Base Attack Bonus: A thief ’s attack bonus is based on their level.
(i.e. A 1 on the die before any bonuses or modifiers are added), See Chapter 10 – Combat for details of how this translates into
then not only are they unable to steal the item but they are also to-hit numbers for different armour classes.
noticed in the attempt by the target of the theft.
Skills: A thief starts with 4 skill points plus extra points equal
Weak Magic: Although a mountebank can cast magic-user spells, to their Int bonus. These points can be used on the same skill or
they have not had the rigorous training regime that magic-users different skills.
have.
Thieves gain more skill points as they rise in level. See Chapter 5 –
Because of this, the spells of a mountebank are weak. For all pur- Ability Checks & Skills for the list of available skills.
poses (range, duration, damage, etc.) a mountebank counts as a
magic-user of only half their level (rounded up) when casting spells. Weapon Feats: Thieves start with two weapon feats, which must be
spent immediately on basic proficiency with two different weapons.
Item Use: Mountebanks are versatile users of magical items, and See Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats for a description of how weapon
can use any magical item useable by mortals, even those normally feats work. Thieves gain more weapon feats as they rise in level,
only useable by members of a particular class. but these weapon feats cannot be spent immediately upon gaining
the level. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for further details.
This includes the use of spell scrolls, and when using a spell scroll
with a cleric or druid spell on it, treat the spell as if it were a Sneak Attack: If a thief is able to strike an opponent who is not
magic-user spell when determining if it is too high level for the aware of the thief ’s location, the thief can add +4 to their attack
mountebank to cast without a chance of failure. roll and if the attack hits it does twice the normal damage that the
attack would normally do. Should a thief make two simultaneous
Saving Throws: Mountebanks make saving throws using the bo- attacks (because they are wielding two weapons) then both attacks
nuses listed on Table 4–1ia. get the +4 bonus and do double damage if they hit.

Thief Simply being behind an enemy is not enough to get a sneak attack.
Class Description: Thieves are human characters who specialise The thief must actually be hidden, invisible, or otherwise concealed,
in subterfuge and trickery. They come from all social classes, from and their location must not be known to their target.
bored nobles seeking excitement to well trained and subtle assassins
to former street urchins. The sneak attack may be made with a melee attack or with a missile,
thrown or hurled weapon at short range.
Although the class is called “thief ”, thief characters are not always
dishonest and do not always steal. Many of them use their talents Open Locks: If a thief is in possession of a set of lock picks, or
for good rather than for personal benefit, and work as scouts and tools that can make improvised lock picks, they can attempt to
adventurers. Even the most noble and honest adventuring parties pick any lock by making a successful check with a bonus listed in
often need to bypass traps and locks or to have someone who can Table 4–12a. Doing so will set off any trap that the lock is armed
scout ahead without being seen, and many so-called ‘thieves’ spend with unless the trap has been removed or otherwise disabled. In
their adventuring careers in this type of activity and never steal a some cases a particularly complex (or simple) lock may cause there
coin in their lives. to be a modifier to the thief ’s roll.

Adventuring parties find the talents of thieves extremely useful, A thief is only allowed one attempt to pick each lock they encounter.
although thieves do not make the greatest warriors so may need Should they fail then they will not be able to try to open that lock
protecting in fights. again until they have increased in level.

Equipment Restrictions: Thieves may use any one-handed weapon, Find Traps: A thief’s trained senses are able to detect the presence of
and may use leather armour. Since they must travel lightly in order traps on objects or in areas. Table 4–12a lists the bonus to checks
to use their abilities they may not use two-handed weapons or for finding each trap in an area. The thief does not automatically
shields except for bucklers. Thieves may use any missile weapon. get to roll for this ability. Their player must state that the character
is searching the area. The Game Master should roll the dice and
Thief Abilities (see Table 4–12a) inform the thief ’s player whether traps were found.
Hit Points: Thieves gain (4 + Con bonus) hit points at first level,
and then another (3 + Con bonus) hit points per level of experi- If no traps are found the thief will not know whether it is because
ence until 9th level. After 9th level, thieves gain 2 hit points per there were no traps or whether they simply failed to notice them.
level and do not add additional Con bonuses (but do retain the In some cases a particularly well hidden (or badly hidden) trap may
bonuses to hit points gained at previous levels). cause there to be a modifier to the thief ’s roll.

Remove Traps: If a thief is aware of the existence of a trap, they


may try to disarm it to prevent it from being triggered. The bonus

54
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–12a: Thief Abilities by Level
Thief Abilities

Weapon Feats
Base Attack
Experience

Hit Points

Hear Noise
Find Traps

Languages

Use Magic-
user Scroll
Bonus

Skills
Level

Shadows
Remove

Pockets
Hide in
Silently
Climb
Locks

Traps
Open

Walls

Move

Read
Pick
1 0 4+c +1 4 2 +2 +1 +1 +17 +3 +1 +3 +5 – –
2 1,200 7+2c +1 4 2 +3 +2 +2 +17 +4 +2 +4 +6 – –
3 2,400 10+3c +1 4 3 +4 +3 +3 +17 +5 +3 +5 +7 – –
4 4,800 13+4c +2 4 3 +5 +4 +4 +17 +6 +4 +6 +8 +15 –
5 9,600 16+5c +2 5 3 +6 +5 +5 +18 +7 +5 +7 +9 +15 –
6 20,000 19+6c +3 5 4 +7 +6 +6 +18 +8 +6 +8 +10 +15 –
7 40,000 22+7c +3 5 4 +8 +7 +7 +18 +9 +6 +9 +11 +15 –
8 80,000 25+8c +4 5 4 +9 +8 +8 +18 +10 +7 +10 +12 +15 –
9 160,000 28+9c +4 6 5 +10 +9 +9 +18 +10 +8 +11 +13 +15 –
10 280,000 30+9c +5 6 5 +11 +10 +9 +19 +11 +8 +12 +13 +15 +17
11 400,000 32+9c +5 6 6 +12 +11 +10 +19 +12 +9 +13 +14 +15 +17
12 520,000 34+9c +6 6 6 +13 +12 +11 +19 +12 +9 +14 +15 +15 +17
13 640,000 36+9c +6 7 6 +13 +13 +12 +19 +13 +10 +15 +16 +15 +17
14 760,000 38+9c +7 7 6 +14 +13 +12 +19 +13 +11 +16 +16 +15 +17
15 880,000 40+9c +7 7 7 +14 +14 +13 +20 +13 +11 +17 +17 +15 +17
16 1,000,000 42+9c +8 7 7 +15 +15 +13 +20 +14 +11 +18 +17 +15 +17
17 1,120,000 44+9c +8 8 7 +16 +15 +14 +20 +14 +12 +19 +18 +15 +17
18 1,240,000 46+9c +9 8 7 +16 +16 +15 +20 +15 +12 +20 +18 +15 +17
19 1,360,000 48+9c +9 8 7 +17 +17 +15 +20 +15 +13 +21 +19 +15 +17
20 1,480,000 50+9c +10 8 7 +17 +17 +16 +21 +15 +13 +22 +19 +15 +17
21 1,600,000 52+9c +10 9 7 +17 +18 +16 +21 +16 +13 +23 +19 +15 +17
22 1,720,000 54+9c +11 9 7 +18 +18 +17 +21 +16 +14 +23 +20 +15 +17
23 1,840,000 56+9c +11 9 8 +18 +19 +18 +21 +17 +14 +25 +20 +15 +17
24 1,960,000 58+9c +12 9 8 +19 +19 +18 +21 +17 +15 +26 +21 +15 +17
25 2,080,000 60+9c +12 10 8 +19 +19 +19 +22 +17 +15 +27 +21 +15 +17
26 2,200,000 62+9c +13 10 8 +19 +19 +19 +22 +17 +15 +28 +21 +15 +17
27 2,320,000 64+9c +13 10 8 +20 +20 +20 +22 +18 +16 +29 +22 +15 +17
28 2,440,000 66+9c +14 10 8 +20 +20 +21 +22 +18 +16 +30 +22 +15 +17
29 2,560,000 68+9c +14 11 8 +21 +20 +21 +22 +18 +17 +31 +23 +15 +17
30 2,680,000 70+9c +15 11 9 +21 +20 +22 +23 +18 +17 +32 +23 +15 +17
31 2,800,000 72+9c +15 11 9 +21 +20 +22 +23 +18 +17 +33 +23 +15 +17
32 2,920,000 74+9c +16 11 9 +22 +21 +23 +23 +19 +18 +34 +24 +15 +17
33 3,040,000 76+9c +16 12 9 +22 +21 +24 +23 +19 +18 +35 +24 +15 +17
34 3,160,000 78+9c +17 12 9 +23 +21 +24 +23 +19 +19 +36 +25 +15 +17
35 3,280,000 80+9c +17 12 9 +23 +21 +25 +23 +19 +19 +37 +25 +15 +17
36 3,400,000 82+9c +18 12 10 +23 +21 +25 +23 +19 +19 +38 +25 +15 +17

55
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
Table 4–12b: Thief Saving Throws to the check required to do this successfully is listed on Table 4–12a. Should this
ability fail, the trap will be activated. In some cases a particularly complex (or simple)

Magic Wands

Rod / Staff /
Death Ray /
trap may cause there to be a modifier to the thief ’s check.

Paralysis /
Weapon
Poison

Breath
Petrify
Level

Spell
A thief may try multiple times to remove the same trap, although since the trap is
activated each time the thief tries, doing so can be a dangerous activity.

1 +7 +6 +7 +4 +5 Climb Walls: Thieves are able to climb walls and other sheer surfaces. The bonus for
the check needed to do this successfully is listed in Table 4–12a. The thief ’s player
2 +7 +6 +7 +4 +5 must roll for each 100’ or part of 100’ climbed, with a failure indicating that the
3 +7 +6 +7 +4 +5 thief has fallen half way through the climb. See Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving
for details about falling. In some cases a slippery or smooth surface (or a particularly
4 +8 +7 +8 +5 +6
rough one) may cause there to be a modifier to the thief ’s check.
5 +8 +7 +8 +5 +6
6 +9 +8 +9 +6 +7 Move Silently: Thieves are able to move without being heard. The bonus to the
check needed for success is listed in Table 4–12a.
7 +9 +8 +9 +6 +7
8 +10 +9 +10 +7 +8 The thief ’s player must roll for each round of movement, with a failure indicating
that the thief has made a sound that others might hear. The Game Master should roll
9 +10 +9 +10 +7 +8 the dice when the thief is sneaking, so that the thief ’s player does not know whether
10 +11 +10 +11 +8 +9 or not their character has been heard.
11 +11 +10 +11 +8 +9
Hide in Shadows: A thief is able to hide effectively providing there is cover or shad-
12 +12 +11 +12 +9 +10 ows to hide in. The bonus to the check needed for success is listed in Table 4–12a.
13 +12 +11 +12 +9 +10 The thief ’s player must roll for the initial hiding, and then for each round of move-
ment, with a failure indicating that the thief has temporarily become visible.
14 +13 +12 +13 +10 +11
15 +13 +12 +13 +10 +11 The Game Master should roll the dice when the thief is hiding, so that the thief ’s
player does not know whether or not their character has been spotted. If someone
16 +14 +13 +14 +11 +12 is watching the thief before they start to hide, they will still be able to see the thief
17 +14 +13 +14 +11 +12 regardless of the success or otherwise of this skill.
18 +15 +14 +15 +12 +13 Pick Pockets: A thief is able to pick the pockets of others in order to steal small items
19 +15 +14 +15 +12 +13 from them, with the bonus to the check required for success listed in Table 4–12a.
This ability can be used to steal purses or belt pouches, or even steal a weapon from
20 +15 +14 +15 +13 +14
its scabbard, but cannot be used to steal anything that is being held by the target or
21 +16 +15 +16 +13 +14 is strapped onto the target such as a backpack or armour. The level or hit dice of the
22 +16 +15 +16 +14 +15 target is subtracted from the check total as a modifier. The thief ’s player must state
the item that they wish to steal before rolling. If the thief ’s check is a success then
23 +16 +15 +16 +14 +15 they successfully steal the item. If the total of their check is less than 20 but greater
24 +16 +15 +16 +15 +15 than or equal to 10 then they are unable to steal the item but their attempted theft
goes unnoticed.
25 +17 +16 +17 +15 +16
26 +17 +16 +17 +16 +16 If the result of their check is less than 10, or they roll a natural 1 (i.e. A 1 on the die
before any bonuses or modifiers are added), then not only are they unable to steal
27 +17 +16 +17 +16 +16
the item but they are also noticed in the attempt by the target of the theft.
28 +17 +16 +17 +16 +16
29 +18 +17 +18 +17 +17 Hear Noise: If a thief listens quietly at a door, window, or thin wall then they have
a chance of hearing faint noises that other characters would miss. To do this, the
30 +18 +17 +18 +17 +18 thief ’s player must succeed in a check with a bonus as listed on Table 4–12a. The
31 +18 +17 +18 +17 +18 thief must be in quiet conditions to use this ability – noisy chatter of other characters
or fighting swamps any noises that might be heard.
32 +18 +17 +18 +17 +18
33 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18 The Game Master should roll for the success of this ability so that if the result is
negative the thief ’s player does not know whether this was because the roll failed or
34 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
because there was nothing to hear.
35 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18
36 +18 +18 +18 +18 +18

56
Chapter 4 - Creating a Character
scroll containing a magic-user spell. Should this roll fail, the spell
will still be used up from the scroll but will misfire.

An offensive spell will go off centred on the thief rather than their
intended target, and a non-offensive spell will simply fizzle with
no effect.

Saving Throws: Thieves make saving throws using the bonuses


listed on Table 4–12b.

Read Languages: At 4th level or higher, a thief may make a check


with a bonus of +15 to be able to decipher any non-magical written
language or code. This only works on written text and cannot be
used to understand spoken languages.

Use Magic-user Scroll: Beginning at 10th level, a thief may make


a check with a bonus of +17 to be able to decipher and use any

57
Chapter 5 - Ability Checks & Skills
C
haracters of different classes have different unique abilities, Example: Black Leaf has a problem. She has been granted an audi-
for example magic-users can cast spells and thieves can pick ence with queen eloise and wishes to use the opportunity to ask for
pockets. However, there are some things – such as trying to some royal sponsorship to aid her expedition to find the fabled eye
walk along a thin ledge or trying to remember which type of dragon of harmaz. Unfortunately she is panicking because she cannot re-
breathes fire and which type breathes frost before venturing into a member the proper etiquette and is afraid that she will cause offence.
lair – that any character can attempt.
Marcie, her player, asks the Game Master if she can make an abil-
These situations are handled by ability checks and skills. ity check using Black Leaf ’s intelligence in order for Black Leaf to
Ability Checks remember her etiquette.
In general, adventurers are assumed to be competent individu- The Game Master agrees and Marcie rolls 1d20, getting a 4. Add-
als who can do things like riding horses, starting camp fires, and ing Black Leaf ’s intelligence score of 13 make a total of 17, so the
swimming in calm water. roll fails and Black Leaf fails to remember the correct etiquette for
addressing the queen.
If you particularly want to play a character whose competency is
deficient in some area, for example if you decide that you specifi- Some time later, Black Leaf can be found getting drunk in an inn,
cally want to play a character who can’t swim, then you can do that. her expedition without royal patronage due in part to the queen’s
However, these rules assume that your character can do all these offense at her frightful manners.
things in calm situations unless you decide otherwise.

That being the case, sometimes there are situa- Table 5–1: Ability Checks by Ability
tions where your character might fail. Perhaps Situations where this Skills useful in these
they are trying to stay on a horse that is bolting Ability
ability might be checked situations
in fright. Or perhaps they are trying to light a
Where raw physical
fire in torrential rain. Or perhaps they are try- Intimidation
strength is required; such
ing to swim in turbulent water without getting Strength Jumping
as lifting, pushing, or
washed downstream. Swimming
pulling.
In these cases, the Game Master will call for an Arcane lore
ability check in order for your character to suc- Engineering
ceed. To make an ability check, roll a standard Geography
Where calculation,
check using the score (not the modifier) of the History
Intelligence memory or reasoning
relevant ability of your character as the bonus Laws
ability is required.
for the check. As with any other check, if the Magical engineering
total rolled is at least 20 then your character has Nature lore
succeeded. If the total rolled is less than 20 then Religious lore
your character has failed. Cooking
Where intuition or
First aid
In some cases, what your character is doing “common sense” are
Lip reading
will be directly opposed by another character Wisdom required. Also where
Navigating
or monster, for example you may be making a acuity of the senses is
Tracking
strength check to force open a door while some- required.
Sense motive
one else is trying to hold it closed or you may be Balance
making a dexterity check to sneak past a guard Where either agility or Craft
while they are looking out for intruders. In these Dexterity fine manipulative skills Escape artist
cases, instead of simply succeeding if you roll a are required. Performance
total of 20 or higher, you and the other character Riding
or monster both roll and you succeed if you roll
a total equal to or higher than the total that they Where stamina or raw
Constitution –
rolled and fail if you roll a total less than the endurance is required.
total that they rolled. Bluff
Diplomacy
The exact consequences of a success or a fail- Where personality and Disguise
ure will depend on the specific situation your Charisma smooth talking are Etiquette
character faces, although it should be very rare required. Gambling
(but not unheard of ) for a failed ability check Intimidation
Performance

59
Chapter 5 - Ability Checks & Skills
to result in death, unless the character is attempting something that character’s strength is effectively 14 when making the check
spectacularly risky. and their player will only need to roll a 6+ to reach the target of 20.

Modifiers Example: Black Leaf is hot on the trail of the Eye of Harmaz, and
In some circumstances the Game Master may decide that an abil- comes across a narrow rope bridge spanning a chasm. Unfortunately
ity check is particularly easy or hard. Maybe the ledge that the the guide rope for the rope bridge is missing, so Black Leaf will have
character is balancing on is slippery, or maybe the person that the to try to balance without its aid if she wishes to cross. The Game
character is trying to scrutinise in order to see if they are lying is Master tells Marcie that she will need to make a balance check (an
wearing a mask, or maybe the piece of information they are trying ability check against dexterity, using the balance skill) in order to
to remember is reasonably common knowledge. cross the bridge – but that the strong winds blowing through the
chasm will give her a –1 penalty to her check.
In these cases, the Game Master may assign a modifier to the check.
Unless there are exceptional circumstances that would be unknown Black Leaf has a dexterity of 16, and Marcie has spent two points
to the character, the Game Master should always tell the player what on the balance skill, so her normal skill bonus is +18.
modifiers are going to apply before the player rolls.
Overall Marcie is going to have to roll using an effective bonus of
Example: Elfstar has come across an underground temple where (18 – 1=17). Marcie reckons that this is well worth trying, but tells
cultists are performing some kind of ritual in front of a statue of a the Game Master that Black Leaf is looping a rope around the bridge
man who she assumes to be an immortal. and around her waist so that if she falls off she won’t plummet to
her almost certain death at the bottom of the chasm.
Elfstar’s player, Debbie, wishes to roll an intelligence check in order
to recognise the immortal. She also trails a rope behind her so that after she’s crossed she and the
other companions can tie it off so that the less dextrous party members
The Game Master knows that although this immortal is not one who will have a guide rope and not need to cross the bridge the hard way.
has regular dealings with Elfstar’s home country (if he was, then the
Game Master would simply tell Debbie who he is and not require a Such skill modifiers stack with modifiers applied by the Game
roll at all) he is commonly worshipped in the local area and so it is Master due to circumstances.
likely that Elfstar will have heard of him. He gives her a +4 bonus
to her effective intelligence for the roll, modifying it from a 9 to a 13. Social Skills
Special care needs to be used when using skills designed for social
Debbie rolls a 7, which when added to her effective intelligence is 20; situations (bluff, diplomacy, intimidation and sense motive).
just enough to succeed – so the Game Master tells her that Elfstar
recognises the immortal and tells her who he is. Players and game masters should discuss the use of these skills
before the game starts, since they have the potential to unbalance
games.

Using Skills Firstly, it is recommended that these skills are never used against
Every character starts with 4 skill points, plus an extra skill point players. If a player wishes to influence another player then this
per point of intelligence bonus. If a character has an intelligence should be role played rather than rolled for using skills. Many
penalty, then this does not reduce the number of skill points the players don’t like the loss of “free will” and the loss of control that
character has. they feel when their character is forced into particular behaviour
by dice rolls rather than because they wanted their character to
Characters also gain extra skill points as they increase in level. See behave in that way, especially if the forced behaviour is the result
Chapter 4 – Creating a Character for details of skill points of another player’s use of social skills against them. This can be very
per level. disruptive to your gaming group.

These skill points are spent immediately on skills listed in this Secondly, the players and Game Master should agree what propor-
chapter. tion of social interaction with NPCs should be governed by skill
usage and what proportion should be governed by role play.
In most cases, each point spent on a particular skill will give your
character a +1 to the bonus used for ability checks that correspond Some people prefer more skill usage since it means that people
to the skill. can play silver-tongued characters even if they are not good talk-
ers themselves.
So a character with a strength of 12 would normally need to roll
an 8+ on the die to reach the target of 20 and succeed in an ability Others feel that simply rolling a diplomacy check in order to find
check to use his strength to swim upstream in a river but if the out whether the character can talk the king into pardoning their
character’s player has spent two points in the swimming skill then wrongly-imprisoned associates is something of a dramatic let-down
and prefer to role play the issue to its conclusion. There is no

60
Chapter 5 - Ability Checks & Skills
single “correct” way to play using these skills, only the way that spending points on a “stealth” skill to help with it) since that will
your group enjoys. overlap with – and undermine – the move silently ability.

Special Skills Alphabetical Skill List


While most skills simply add bonuses to ability checks, some – no-
tably language skills – work in other ways. Arcane Lore
Each point spent on the arcane lore skill gives a +1 bonus to in-
If a skill works in an unusual way, this will be detailed in the skill’s telligence checks made to recognise spells, magical effects, and
individual description. magical creatures.

Adding New Skills An “average” spell or effect (at the Game Master’s discretion) will
The list of skills in this chapter is not meant to cover all possible give no bonus or penalty to the effective intelligence used for the
situations. Game masters may require (or players may ask for) abil- roll, but a particularly common spell might give a bonus and a
ity checks for a variety of situations other than those given here. If particularly rare spell might give a penalty. Relative obscurity is
a particular situation crops up repeatedly, a player may – with the more important in this regard than level of power.
Game Master’s permission – spend a skill point in order to buy
it as a named skill in order to get a bonus to their effective ability Note: Arcane lore checks should not be used to allow the players
score in that situation. to identify magic items without using the analyze spell.

However, game masters and players should be careful that this Balance
does not overlap with class abilities, particularly not those of the Each point spent on the balance skill gives a +1 bonus to dexterity
thief, mountebank and lupine classes. For example, sneaking up checks made to keep one’s footing on a small (or moving) surface
on someone without being heard is a specific thief ability called or to cross narrow ledges, beams or even tightropes.
move silently.
Modifiers to the effective dexterity score used for the roll can come
While in some specific circumstances it may be acceptable for a non- from a wide variety of factors. Examples include:
thief player to make a dexterity check in order to have their charac-
ter sneak past someone, this should not become standard practice ◊ Strong wind
for sneaking up on opponents (and players certainly shouldn’t start ◊ Slippery surfaces
◊ Heavily encumbered character
Developer Commentary ◊ Trying to move quicker (or slower) than a normal walk
The line between ability checks and thief abilities has often been ◊ Particularly narrow (or wide) ledges
blurred over the years. If a thief has a “hide in shadows” chance, does ◊ Trying to balance while dodging attacks
that mean that no-one else can ever hide? if a thief has a “climb walls” ◊ Using a pole for balance
chance, does that mean no-one else has a chance of ever climbing
anything? and so forth. Bluff
Each point spent on the bluff skill gives a +1 bonus to charisma
The intent of the game is that the thief abilities go above and beyond checks made to convince NPCs of things without evidence. While
what a normal person is capable of, and – crucially – can’t be resisted. the skill is most often used to convince NPCs of untruths, it can
also be used to make a convincing emotional argument in favour
For example, if a normal person tries to sneak past a guard, the Game of something you know is true but cannot prove to be true.
Master may decide to call for a dexterity check for them to successfully
sneak and give the guard an wisdom check to successfully spot them. Bluff checks should get modifiers for both the plausibility of what
If the total of the player’s dexterity check doesn’t match the total of the is being claimed and the potential consequences of the bluff to
guard’s wisdom check then the guard has heard them. the target of the skill. A guard who may get executed if they let a
potential assassin into the royal palace will be harder to bluff your
However, a thief can make a move silently check, and if that succeeds way past than a merchant who may make a bit less profit if you
the guard has no chance of hearing them because they have made manage to convince him that you should get a discount because
no noise at all. If the move silently check fails, then the thief may you’re a member of the city watch.
still make the dexterity check described above at the Game Master’s
discretion. Note: See social skills for a warning about how some uses of this
skill may disrupt the game.
There is no hard-and-fast rule about when something should be pos-
sible with an ability check and when something should only be possible Cooking
using thief abilities. It is up to each group to decide what level of Each point spent on the cooking skill gives a +1 bonus to wisdom
overlap they are comfortable with that will allow players to feel that checks made to cook.
their characters are realistically competent while also not stealing the
spotlight from those with thief abilities.

61
Chapter 5 - Ability Checks & Skills
Modifiers to the effective wisdom used for this roll are likely to For example, trying to persuade the leader of a marauding band
be only rarely needed, except in the case of not having adequate of orcs not to attack a small and lightly armed party is going to be
equipment or when using ingredients that the character has never much more difficult than trying to persuade an offended landlady
cooked before. that you shouldn’t be thrown out of her inn and you should be
allowed to spend your spare cash there instead.
In most cases, failing a cooking check won’t result in inedible food;
merely food that is not as nice as that produced by a successful Note: See social skills for a warning about how some uses of this
cooking check. skill may disrupt the game.

Craft (Choose Medium) Disguise


The craft skill is not a single skill. It is a group of related skills Each point spent on the disguise skill gives a +1 bonus to charisma
used when making things of different types. When spending a checks made to disguise a character as someone else.
skill point on this skill, you must specify what sort of craft your
character is skilled at. These checks should be made when the disguise is first worn; with
modifiers based on the answers to the following:
An exhaustive list of possible craft skills is not possible, but exam-
ples include: ◊ Is the disguise meant to look like a specific person, or merely not
look like the wearer?
◊ Carpentry
◊ Smithing ◊ Is the disguise intended to make the character look like a differ-
◊ Fletching ent gender and/or race?
◊ Skinning
◊ Leatherworking ◊ Is the disguise meant to only be seen in from a distance or is it
◊ Rope binding intended for close scrutiny?
◊ Tailoring
◊ Gem cutting ◊ Is the disguise intended to fool close acquaintances of subject
◊ Forgery (or wearer) of the disguise?
◊ Masonry
◊ Thatching ◊ Does the person applying the disguise have access to make up
◊ Drawing/painting and prosthetics?
◊ Sculpture

Each skill point spent on a specific craft skill gives a +1 bonus to Example: Black Leaf wishes to gain access to the back room of the
dexterity checks used to make items with that craft. cartographer’s guild in order to steal a map that she thinks may be
there despite the guild members’ denials. While her allies “acciden-
Modifiers to the effective dexterity used in craft rolls can come from tally” encounter one of the guild members in an inn and get him
high or low quality materials and tools, as well as time constraints. drunk, Black Leaf disguises herself as the guild member.

Depending on what is being made, success may be not be an all- The Game Master decides that because Black Leaf is trying to im-
or-nothing affair – a failed craft check is likely to still result in a personate a specific person of the opposite gender, she should get a –4
finished item. However, the quality of the finished product should penalty to her effective charisma when making the disguise check.
be subjectively determined by the amount that the craft check
succeeded by or failed by. However, since she has deliberately chosen to impersonate the guild
member who most closely resembles her in terms of build and facial
Craft skills can also be used to assess the workmanship of items features (gender notwithstanding) the Game Master reduces the
made using that skill. For example skill at carpentry can be used penalty to a –3.
to help find the weak spot in a door, or skill at smithing can help
judge how good a sword is. The exact details of this are left to the Unfortunately Black Leaf ’s charisma is only a rather average 11,
Game Master’s discretion. However, in no case should a craft skill and the penalty means it is effectively only an 8 for this roll. The
be able to be used to determine magical properties of an item. Game Master rolls a 10.

Diplomacy Since she only failed by a small amount – and would have succeeded
Each point spent on the diplomacy skill gives a +1 bonus to cha- if not for the penalties – the Game Master decides that Black Leaf ’s
risma checks made to work out compromises and calm tensions. disguise is not going to fool people into thinking she is the guild
member unless seen only from a distance, but is enough that people
Diplomacy checks should get modifiers for both the amount of seeing her will not recognise her real identity.
hostility between the parties and the amount that either side has
to lose if the diplomacy fails.

62
Chapter 5 - Ability Checks & Skills
The exact value of these modifiers should be determined by the First Aid
Game Master on a case by case basis, and the Game Master should Each point spent in the first aid skill gives a +1 bonus on wisdom
roll the dice for the check so that the player doesn’t know whether rolls used to treat injuries.
their character’s disguise will successfully fool people.
The most common use of this skill is to prevent people from dying
A disguise that fails to achieve its target intentions may still work once they have reached 0 hit points. See Chapter 10 – Combat
to a lesser extent. for detailed rules on death and dying. This use of the skill can be
performed during combat, and can be used multiple times until
Engineering it succeeds.
Each point spent on the engineering skill gives a +1 bonus to intel-
ligence checks made to design machinery or identify the function The other use of the skill is to patch people up after they have
of existing machinery such as siege weaponry or orreries. taken damage. After each time a character has been injured (a
whole combat only counts as a single injury for this purpose) they
Modifiers to these the effective intelligence used for checks to iden- can be healed 1d3 of the hit points lost in this particular injury by
tify machinery should come from the complexity of the machinery someone making a successful first aid check. Each character using
being examined. the skill is only able to make one attempt per injury, and if this first
attempt fails then further attempts will not succeed.
In terms of the design of machinery, the Game Master should
also take into account the technological level of the campaign If someone succeeds with a first aid check against a particular injury
and should veto the “invention” of devices that rely on principles then further first aid checks will be of no benefit.
unknown in the game world.
There are normally no modifiers to the effective wisdom used in
Similarly, the presence of magic in the game world may mean that first aid checks.
the laws of nature work differently there than in the real world,
so at the Game Master’s discretion machinery relying on certain Example: Black Leaf is unlucky enough to fall down a pit, and is
physical principles (e.g. Combustion powered guns or engines) injured, taking 5 points of damage out of her 9 hit points, leaving
may not work at all. her on 4 hit points.

Note: although this skill can be used to identify how a large me- She uses the first aid skill to treat this injury, and succeeds in her roll.
chanical trap works, it should not be used as a replacement for Her player rolls 1d3 to see how many hit points are recovered and
either the find traps or remove traps abilities. At best, knowing unfortunately only gets a 1. Black Leaf now recovers one of the hit
how the trap functions may give insight into how the trap may be points lost in the injury, taking her from 4 hit points to 5 hit points.
bypassed by mundane means.
Since she has now had this injury treated, further first aid rolls won’t
Escape Artist be able to recover any more of the lost hit points.
Each point spent on the escape artist skill gives a +1 bonus to
dexterity checks made to escape from bonds or ties. Shortly afterwards, the party encounters some goblins spoiling for
a fight. After a brief combat with the goblins, Black Leaf has lost
The effective dexterity used for this check should be modified by another 2 hit points, leaving her with 3.
the extent to which the character is tied. Escaping from simply
having ones hands tied with a scarf should be much easier than While the party are resting, she tries to use the first aid skill on
escaping from iron manacles. herself in order to recover some of these hit points. The skill check
is not successful and Black Leaf is unable to heal this injury, and
Note: Although this skill allows the character to wriggle free from cannot try again.
locked manacles or padlocked chains, it does not allow the actual
picking of those locks. Seeing that her friend is still injured, Elfstar tries to use the skill on
her. Elfstar’s player succeeds her skill check and rolls 1d3 to see how
Etiquette (choose Culture) much is healed, getting a 3. Although Black Leaf has lost a total of 6
The etiquette skill is not a single skill. It is a group of related skills hit points, only 2 were lost in the injury being treated by the skill roll,
used in social situations in a variety of cultures. so the first aid can only result in the recovery of these 2 hit points.

Each point spent in the etiquette skill for a particular culture gives a
+1 bonus to charisma rolls used to behave properly in formal social Gambling
situations in that culture. Each point spent on the gambling skill gives a +1 bonus to charisma
checks made to determine who wins in games of skill and chance.
Modifiers to the effective charisma used for these checks should
come from particularly common or particularly obscure social
situations within that culture.

63
Chapter 5 - Ability Checks & Skills
Modifiers to the effective charisma used for gambling checks should their tribe’s location to you, which is both an unrealistic threat
be rare, but may be used for games that the character is unfamiliar and has potentially fatal consequences to the ogre and their tribe.
with.
Note: See social skills for a warning about how some uses of this
The simple way to use this skill is to simulate a single game or skill may disrupt the game.
round in a game, by each character making a gambling check, and
the game or round is won by the character who succeeds their roll Jumping
by the biggest margin (or fails by the least margin, if no character Each point spent on the jumping skill gives a +1 bonus to strength
succeeds). checks made to jump long distances.

At the Game Master’s discretion, individual gambling games can Rather than giving modifiers to the effective strength based on the
be devised for their game world, which may operate on a more intended length or height of the jump, the nature of jumping means
complex basis. that a jump will always be successfully made but the distance of
the jump will depend on the result of the check.
Note: This skill is designed for games where psychology, bluffing,
and second-guessing opponents are an essential part of the game With a running start, a character can jump 10’ horizontally or 4’
play. vertically (remember that if the character is jumping up to reach
something then the character’s height should be added to the verti-
The skill does not represent a supernatural “luck” type of ability cal distance jumped in order to determine how high they can reach).
and should not be used to determine the outcome of games of
pure chance. The effects of the roll depend on whether the character is jumping
for height or length. For each point that the character succeeds the
Geography jump check by in the case of a long jump, they jump an extra foot
Each point spent on the geography skill gives a +1 bonus to intel- horizontally. For each two points that the character fails the jump
ligence checks made to recollect information about countries and check by they jump a foot less horizontally.
regions of the game world.
In the case of a high jump, for each two points the character suc-
The use of this skill should be modified by the obscurity of the facts ceeds the jump roll by they jump a foot higher, and for each four
that the player wishes their character to recollect. points the character fails by they jump a foot less high.

Knowing the name of a country and the majority race that lives In either case, jumping from a standing start means that only half
there should be easier than knowing the name of the palace in of the total distance (after modification) can be jumped.
which the king of that country lives or knowing the major trade
imports and exports of that country.
Example: Black Leaf has a strength of only 9, but has spent two
History skill points on the jump skill – so she has an effective strength of 11
Each point spent on the history skill gives a +1 bonus to intelligence when making jump checks.
checks made to recollect information about the game world’s past.
After having fallen into a 10’ deep pit, she needs to try to get out.
The use of this skill should be modified by the obscurity of the Her player announces that she will try to jump up and grab the
facts that the player wishes their character to recollect. Knowing edge of the pit.
the name of countries involved in a war a couple of generations
ago should be easier than knowing the name of the vizier of an The pit is 10’ deep, and Black Leaf is 5’5 tall; so in order to reach
empire that hasn’t existed for thousands of years. the edge of the pit she will have to jump just over four and a half feet.

Intimidation Luckily for Black Leaf, the pit is 20’ wide, so she has chance to get
Each point spent on the intimidation skill gives a +1 bonus to both a run up at the jump. Marcie rolls a 14, for a total check result
charisma checks and strength checks made to bully an NPC into of 14+11=25, which is five points better than the 20 that she
co-operation through threats or shows of physical strength. needed to roll, so Black Leaf jumps two and a half feet more than
the default 4’, for a total of six and a half feet – more than enough
Intimidation checks should get modifiers for both the plausibility to grab the edge of the pit and pull herself out.
of the threats being made and the potential consequences to the
target of the skill for co-operation. Had Black Leaf not been able to take a run up, the total distance
jumped would have been halved from six and a half feet down to
Using a threat of immediate physical violence to get a bandit to flee just over three feet – not high enough to get out.
is both a realistic threat and has only minor consequences to the
bandit if they do flee; so it should be easier than using a threat of
sending a dragon to kill the family of an ogre if they don’t betray

64
Chapter 5 - Ability Checks & Skills
Language (Choose Language) Note: although this skill can be used to identify how a large magical
Each skill point spent on the language skill means that the char- trap works, it should not be used as a replacement for either the
acter knows another language to an acceptable level that they can find traps or remove traps abilities. At best, knowing how the trap
converse. However, even though the character speaks the language, functions may give insight into how the trap may be bypassed by
their speech will be accented and they will be clearly noticeable mundane means.
as a foreigner.
Nature Lore
If a character spends a second skill point on the same language, Each point spent on the nature lore skill gives a +1 bonus to intel-
their skill increases to the point where they speak it like a native ligence checks made to recognise plants, natural terrain features,
and no longer have a noticeable foreign accent. and natural creatures.

The Game Master will determine which languages exist in their Most natural creatures or terrain features will give no bonus or pen-
game world. alty to the effective intelligence used for the roll, but a particularly
common plant or animal might give a bonus and a particularly
Laws (Choose Culture) rare one might give a penalty.
The law skill is not a single skill. It is a group of related skills used
in legal situations in a variety of cultures. Navigating
Each point spent in the navigating skill gives a +1 bonus on wisdom
Each point spent in the law skill for a particular culture gives a +1 rolls used to avoid getting lost by using landmarks and the position
bonus to intelligence checks used to recall/interpret the laws and of the sun and stars.
customs of that country.
The effective wisdom used for navigating checks may be modified
Modifiers to the effective charisma used for these checks should by factors such as weather conditions, visibility, access (or lack of
come from particularly common or particularly obscure customs it) to equipment such as maps and/or sextants, and familiarity with
within that culture. For example knowing that a country has the the area being travelled.
death penalty for banditry is much easier than knowing that the
country requires anyone setting up a market stall to buy a trading Performance (Chose Medium)
license from the alderman of the town. The performance skill is not a single skill. It is a group of related
skills used when putting on different types of artistic performance.
Lip Reading When spending a skill point on this skill, you must specify what sort
Each point spent on the lip reading skill gives a +1 bonus to wisdom of artistic performance your character is skilled at. An exhaustive
checks made to understand what someone is saying even when you list of possible artistic media is not possible, but examples include:
can’t hear them by watching the movement of their mouth.
◊ Singing
Modifiers to the effective wisdom used for this skill should be used ◊ Playing a musical instrument
based on how clearly the person’s mouth can be seen, whether they ◊ Dancing
are deliberately enunciating clearly in order to make it easy for you ◊ Acting
to lip read, and whether you are a native speaker of the language ◊ Juggling
they are speaking (i.e. It’s a starting language or you spent two skill ◊ Jesting
points on it) or whether you are merely fluent in it (i.e. You spent ◊ Storytelling
one skill point on it). ◊ Poetry

Magical Engineering Each skill point spent on a specific craft skill gives a +1 bonus to
Each point spent on the magical engineering skill gives a +1 bonus both dexterity checks and charisma checks used to make these
to intelligence checks made to design large scale magical effects or artistic performances.
identify the function of existing effects such as wormholes, gates,
and some large scale magical traps. Modifiers to the effective dexterity or charisma used in performance
rolls can come from such things as particularly high or low quality
Modifiers to these the effective intelligence used for checks to iden- costume and how much rehearsal time the performance has had.
tify such magic should come from the obscurity of the effect being
examined. Something that uses a standard spell effect should be Success in a performance may not be an all-or-nothing affair – a
easier than something that uses a unique effect. failed performance check is likely to still result in a performance
of some kind. However, the quality of the finished work should
When designing such effects, this skill is used for the design itself, be subjectively determined by the amount that the performance
but the building of large-scale magical constructions will involve check succeeded by or failed by.
spell casting and crafting skills.

65
Chapter 5 - Ability Checks & Skills
Religious Lore Sense Motive
Each point spent on the religious lore skill gives a +1 bonus to Each point spent on the sense motive skill gives a +1 bonus to
intelligence checks made to recall knowledge about religions, their wisdom checks made to read the expressions and body language
targets of worship, and the creatures associated with them. of NPCs in order to tell if they have an ulterior motive for their
speech or behaviour. The skill is most often used to detect when an
The effective intelligence score used for the religious lore check NPC is lying, although it can also in other situations, for example
should be modified by the obscurity of the knowledge being sought. to try to tell if an NPC who is ignoring a character who is hiding
is deliberately ignoring that character while trying to keep an eye
Identifying a statue of a well-known god should be much easier on them or whether they simply haven’t seen them.
than identifying the purpose of a particular religious rite from a
foreign religion. Note: See social skills for a warning about how some uses of this
skill may disrupt the game.
Note: Characters should be assumed to know all about the rites
and details their own religion without needing to make religious Swimming
lore checks. Each point spent on the swimming skill gives a +1 bonus to strength
checks made to swim while weighed down or in fast flowing or
Riding (Choose Animal) turbulent waters. Characters are assumed to be able to swim in
The riding skill is not a single skill. It is a group of related skills calm water (providing they are not weighed down) without need-
used when making rolls to control or stay on various riding ani- ing to make a swimming check, but heavily encumbered characters
mals in unusual circumstances. When spending a skill point on or characters trying to swim in difficult conditions will need to
this skill, you must specify what sort of animal your character is make such checks.
skilled at riding. An exhaustive list of animals is not possible, but
examples include: The effective strength used for swimming checks should be given
modifiers based on the specific conditions that the character is
Horse (includes mules and donkeys) trying to swim in, such as those listed above.

◊ Camel Tracking
◊ Elephant Each point spent on the tracking skill gives a +1 bonus to wisdom
◊ Dire wolf checks made to follow the tracks left by one of more creatures. Fol-
◊ Griffon lowing (at a slow walk) a single human sized creature who walked
◊ Pegasus through light woodland or farmland less than a day ago would
◊ Hippogriff require a roll with no modifiers.
◊ Giant eagle
The effective wisdom used for the tracking check should be modi-
Each skill point spent on a specific riding skill gives a +1 bonus to fied by many factors such as:
dexterity checks used to ride that type of animal.
◊ Number of creatures being tracked
Generally, simply riding a calm animal as it walks shouldn’t require ◊ Size of creatures being tracked
a riding check. However, staying on an animal when it bolts or ◊ Method of locomotion of creatures being tracked
stumbles, or when it is damaged by an attack, should require a ◊ Age of the tracks
check – with the effective dexterity modified by the exact circum- ◊ Terrain being tracked through
stances provoking the check. ◊ Weather conditions
◊ Tracking faster than a slow walk

66
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
A
character’s ability to use a particular type of weapon in com- Some types of weapon have special abilities such as the ability to
bat is represented by weapon feats. These give a character deflect attacks or the ability to ensnare opponents, which can be
increasing attack bonuses and access to special abilities such used only by characters with a high enough level of proficiency.
as armour class bonuses as they get more proficient with a weapon.
Opponent Types
Starting Weapon Feats Although some weapons are equally effective against any opponent,
At first level, characters start with either two or four weapon feats, weapons intended for warfare are often more effective against other
which must be immediately spent on basic weapon proficiency opponents armed with melee weapons; whereas weapons intended
with two or four weapons useable by the character respectively. A for hunting are often more effective against unarmed opponents.
character may not spend more than one first level weapon feat on In the weapon descriptions in this chapter, each weapon has its
the same weapon. effectiveness indicated against each type of opponent separately.

Developer Commentary Note that opponents wielding missile weapons use the same values
In the original game that Dark Dungeons is based on, demi-humans as opponents who are completely unarmed or using natural attacks
were proficient in all weapons at first level. such as claws.

This was fine when demi-humans had level caps, because otherwise Ammunition & Loading
they wouldn’t get enough proficiencies before hitting their level cap All missile weapons require ammunition, for example bows need
to be versatile. Dark dungeons changes this to only two or four arrows and guns need bullets. In addition, guns also require a
weapons, because with level caps removed they would otherwise charge of red powder to work.
have too many proficiency levels.
Any character can load a weapon with ammunition, even those who
are not proficient in its use. Loading a weapon does not take an
Gaining Weapon Feats action, and is assumed to be part of the normal attack action (see
As characters increase in level, they gain more weapon feats. See Chapter 10 – Combat for a full description of actions).
Chapter 4 – Creating a Character for further details. These
additional weapon feats cannot be spent immediately, but must be If a character gets multiple attacks for any reason, they can reload
spent while weapon training. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better between each attack. For example, a 28th level fighter is able to
for more information on weapon training. By training, the char- make three attacks against opponents that they can hit on a 2+
acter can spend these additional weapon feats to either gain basic (after modifiers). That fighter could make all three attacks with a
proficiency with new weapons or increase their proficiency level bow, crossbow, sling or gun and reload between each attack all in
with existing weapons. a single attack action.

Spending a single weapon feat on a weapon will give the character The only exception to this rule is with pistols. Although pistols
a single increase in proficiency level with that weapon (to a maxi- require only one hand to fire, they require two hands to reload.
mum of grandmaster proficiency) regardless of how proficient the Therefore unless a character has a free hand, they can only fire a
character currently is with that weapon or how many other weapons single shot from a pistol in one attack action even if they would
the character is proficient with. normally get more than one attack.

There are 6 levels of proficiency with each weapon: Similarly, if a character has no free hand, they cannot make a second
attack with a pistol in subsequent rounds until such time as they
◊ Non-proficient have a free hand in order to reload.
◊ Basic proficiency
◊ Skilled proficiency A character equipped with multiple pistols but no free hand can
◊ Expert proficiency take advantage of having multiple attacks if they are prepared to
◊ Master proficiency drop each empty pistol after firing it and draw a new loaded one.
◊ Grandmaster proficiency
Weapon List
Characters start out non-proficient with all weapons other than The following pages list each weapon along with most of its abili-
those they spent their starting weapon feats to gain proficiency with. ties. Some weapon abilities which are either extremely common
or are complex enough to need a longer description are not listed
Effects of Proficiency with specific weapons.
As a character gains more proficiency levels with a weapon, they will
usually do more damage with it. The damage done by a weapon All weapon abilities are listed after the weapon descriptions.
is listed for each proficiency level in the detailed weapon descrip-
tions in this chapter.

67
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–1: Master Weapon Table
Useable By
Damage

Halfling

Mounte-
Lupine
Fighter
Dwarf
Weapon (at Basic Cost

Magic-
Druid
Cleric

Clock-

Thief
work

bank
user
Elf
Proficiency)

One Handed Melee Weapons


Axe, Hand – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y Y Y 1d6 4gp
Blackjack Y Y Y Y – Y Y Y Y Y Y 1d2 5gp
Club Y Y Y Y – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d4 3gp
Cestus – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y Y Y 1d3 5gp
Dagger – Y – Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 1d4 3gp
Hammer, Throwing Y Y – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d4 4gp
Hammer, War Y Y – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d6 5gp
Javelin – Y – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d6 1gp
Lance – Y – – – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d10 10gp
Mace Y Y – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d6 5gp
Morning Star Y Y – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d6 8gp
Net – Y – Y Y Y – Y Y Y Y – 4gp
Spear – Y – – – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d6 3gp
Sword, Bastard – Y – – – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d6+1 15gp
Sword, Normal – Y – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d8 10gp
Sword, Short – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y Y Y 1d6 7gp
Trident – Y – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d6 5gp
Unarmed Strike Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 1 –
Whip – Y – Y Y Y – Y Y Y Y 1d2 10gp
Two Handed Melee Weapons
Axe, Battle – Y – Y – Y – Y Y – – 1d8 7gp
Flail Y Y – Y – Y – Y Y – – 1d8 12gp
Halberd – Y – – – Y – Y Y – – 1d10 7gp
Pike – Y – – – Y – Y Y – – 1d10 3gp
Poleaxe – Y – – – Y – Y Y – – 1d10 5gp
Staff Y Y Y Y Y Y – Y Y – – 1d6 5gp
Sword, Bastard – Y – – – Y – Y Y – – 1d8+1 15gp
Sword, Two-handed – Y – – – Y – Y Y – – 1d10 15gp
Shields
Shield, Buckler Y Y – Y – Y Y – Y Y Y – 6gp
Shield, Normal Y Y Y Y – Y Y – Y – – – 10gp
Shield, Tower Y Y – – – Y – – Y – – – 15gp
Missile Weapons
Bolas – Y – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d2 5gp
Bow, Long – Y – – – Y – Y Y Y Y 1d6 40gp
Bow, Short – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y Y Y 1d6 25gp
Crossbow, Heavy – Y – – – Y – Y Y Y Y 2d4 50gp
Crossbow, Light – Y – Y – Y Y Y Y Y Y 1d6 30gp
Pistol – Y – Y Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 1d6 250gp
Sling Y Y Y Y Y Y – Y Y Y Y 1d4 2gp
Smoothbore – Y – – – Y – Y Y – – 2d4 150gp

68
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–2: Axe, Battle vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–4: Axe, Hand vs. Armed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus
To-hit Bonus

Hurl Range

Proficiency
Proficiency

Damage
Damage

Delay

Stun
None – 1d4 – – – None – 1d3 10/20/30
Basic – 1d8 – – – Basic – 1d6 10/20/30
Skilled +1 1d8+2 Y – – Skilled +1 1d6+2 15/25/35
Expert +2 1d8+4 Y – -/5/10 Expert +2 1d6+3 25/35/45
Master +4 1d8+6 Y Y -/5/10 Master +4 1d6+4 30/40/50
Grandmaster +6 1d8+8 Y Y 5/10/15 Grandmaster +6 1d6+6 40/50/60

Table 6–3: Axe, Battle vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–5: Axe, Hand vs. Unarmed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus
To-hit Bonus

Hurl Range

Proficiency
Proficiency

Ac Bonus
Ac Bonus

Damage
Damage

Delay

Stun

None – 1d4 – – – – None – 1d3 – 10/20/30


Basic – 1d8 – – – – Basic – 1d6 – 10/20/30
Skilled +2 1d8+2 –2 vs 2 Y – – Skilled +2 1d6+2 –1 vs 1 15/25/35
Expert +4 1d8+4 –3 vs 2 Y – -/5/10 Expert +4 1d6+3 –2 vs 2 25/35/45
Master +6 1d8+8 –3 vs 3 Y Y -/5/10 Master +6 2d4+4 –3 vs 3 30/40/50
Grandmaster +8 1d10+10 –4 vs 4 Y Y 5/10/15 Grandmaster +8 2d4+7 –3 vs 3 40/50/60

Axe, Battle Axe, Hand


A battle axe is a two handed axe 2’–4’ in length, usually with a A hand axe is a one handed axe 1’–2’ in length, usually with a
double blade or a spike on the reverse of the blade. single blade. A hand axe is often thrown while its owner rushes
towards melee range.
Delay: When the wielder of a weapon with the delay ability hits
an opponent with it, the opponent must make a saving throw vs.
paralysis or automatically lose initiative in the following round.

Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits
that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or
smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray.

A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty
to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned
character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to
shake off the stun.

69
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–6: Blackjack vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–8: Bolas vs. Armed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Strangle Save
Proficiency

Proficiency
Knockout

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage

Strangle
None – 1 – None – 1 – – – 20/40/60
Basic – 1d2 +0 Basic – 1d2 – 20 – 20/40/60
Skilled +2 2d2 –1 Skilled +2 1d3 –1 vs 1 20 –1 25/40/60
Expert +4 1d4+1 –2 Expert +4 1d3+1 –2 vs 2 19 –2 30/50/70
Master +6 1d4+3 –3 Master +6 1d3+2 –3 vs 3 18 –3 35/50/70
Grandmaster +8 1d4+5 –4 Grandmaster +8 1d3+3 –4 vs 3 17 –4 40/60/80

Table 6–7: Blackjack vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–9: Bolas vs. Unarmed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Strangle Save
Proficiency

Proficiency
Knockout
Damage

Damage

Strangle
None – 1 – None – 1 – – 20/40/60
Basic – 1d2 +0 Basic – 1d2 20 – 20/40/60
Skilled +1 2d2 –1 Skilled +1 1d3 20 –1 25/40/60
Expert +2 1d4+1 –2 Expert +2 1d3+1 19 –2 30/50/70
Master +4 1d6+1 –3 Master +4 1d3+2 18 –3 35/50/70
Grandmaster +6 1d6+2 –4 Grandmaster +6 1d3+3 17 –4 40/60/80

Blackjack Bolas
A blackjack, also known as a cosh, is a small leather club usually A bolas is a set of weights (usually three) on the ends of connected
filled with sand. Blackjacks are too soft to do significant damage, ropes 3’–4’ in length. The bolas is whirled around and then thrown
but are very useful for temporarily knocking people unconscious at the opponent in order to entangle or even strangle them.
without doing permanent damage.
Strangle: If the wielder of the weapon rolls the number indicated
Knockout: Any target that the weapon hits may become delayed, or higher on the dice, before modifiers, and the attack hits the
stunned or knocked out depending on their hit dice or level com- target after modifiers, then the target of the attack must make an
pared to the proficiency level of the weapon wielder. See Table 6–81 immediate saving throw vs. death ray with the listed penalty or
for details. The target must make a saving throw vs. death ray with be paralysed and die after 1d6+2 rounds of strangulation. Should
a penalty based on the proficiency of the wielder when hit in order the target be freed from strangulation, they will remain paralysed
to avoid the effect. If this fails, the target is affected as normal by for 2d6 rounds.
the delay, stun or knock out.
If the wielder of the weapon does not roll the required numbers
An enemy who is knocked out will be unconscious for 1d100 but still hits the target, the target is affected as though the weapon
rounds before waking up. were an entangling weapon with the same saving throw penalty.

Entangle: Any target that the weapon hits may become delayed,
slowed or entangled depending on their hit dice or level compared
to the proficiency level of the weapon wielder.

See Table 6–80 for details.

70
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–10: Bow, Long vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–12: Bow, Short vs. Armed Opponents

Missile Range

Missile Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Delay

Delay
None –1 1d3 – – 70/140/210 None –1 1d3 – – 50/100/150
Basic – 1d6 – – 70/140/210 Basic – 1d6 – – 50/100/150
Skilled +1 1d8+1 –1 vs 1 S/m 90/150/220 Skilled +1 1d6+2 –1 vs 1 S 60/110/160
Expert +2 1d10+2 –2 vs 1 S/m 110/170/230 Expert +2 1d6+4 –1 vs 2 S 80/130/170
Master +4 1d10+4 –2 vs 2 S/m 130/180/240 Master +4 1d4+6 –2 vs 2 S 90/130/180
Grandmaster +6 1d10+6 –2 vs 2 S/m 150/200/250 Grandmaster +6 1d6+7 –2 vs 2 S 110/140/190

Table 6–11: Bow, Long vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–13: Bow, Short vs. Unarmed Opponents
Missile Range

Missile Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Damage

Damage
Delay

Delay
None –1 1d3 – 70/140/210 None –1 1d3 – 50/100/150
Basic – 1d6 – 70/140/210 Basic – 1d6 – 50/100/150
Skilled +2 1d8+1 S/m 90/150/220 Skilled +2 1d6+2 S 60/110/160
Expert +4 1d10+2 S/m 110/170/230 Expert +4 1d6+4 S 80/130/170
Master +6 3d6 S/m 130/180/240 Master +6 1d8+6 S 90/130/180
Grandmaster +8 4d4+2 S/m 150/200/250 Grandmaster +8 1d10+8 S 110/140/190

Bow, Long Bow, Short


A long bow is a 4’–6’ bow, either made from a single piece of A short bow is a 3’–4’ bow, either made from a single piece of
wood or a composite of different woods. A long bow requires wood or a composite of different woods. A short bow requires
both hands to fire. both hands to fire.

Delay: When the wielder of a weapon with the delay ability hits Delay: When the wielder of a weapon with the delay ability hits
an opponent with it, the opponent must make a saving throw vs. an opponent with it, the opponent must make a saving throw vs.
paralysis or automatically lose initiative in the following round. paralysis or automatically lose initiative in the following round.

Long bows can only delay opponents at the listed ranges. Short bows can only delay opponents at the listed ranges.

71
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–14: Cestus vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–16: Club vs. Armed Opponents

To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency

Ac Bonus
Off-hand
Damage

Damage

Deflect
None – 1 – None – 1d2 – – –
Basic – 1d3 Y Basic – 1d4 – – –
Skilled +2 1d4+1 Y Skilled +1 1d6+1 –1 vs 2 1 –
Expert +4 2d4 Y Expert +2 1d6+3 –2 vs 2 1 -/15/25
Master +6 2d4 Y Master +4 1d4+5 –3 vs 3 2 -/15/25
Grandmaster +8 3d4 Y Grandmaster +6 1d4+6 –4 vs 4 2 10/25/40

Table 6–15: Cestus vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–17: Club vs. Unarmed Opponents
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency

Ac Bonus
Off-hand
Damage

Damage

Deflect
None – 1 – None – 1d2 – – –
Basic – 1d3 Y Basic – 1d4 – – –
Skilled +1 1d4+1 Y Skilled +2 1d6+1 –1 vs 2 1 –
Expert +2 2d4 Y Expert +4 1d6+3 –2 vs 2 1 -/15/25
Master +4 1d4+3 Y Master +6 1d6+5 –3 vs 3 2 -/15/25
Grandmaster +6 2d4+3 Y Grandmaster +8 1d6+6 –4 vs 4 2 10/25/40

Cestus Club
A cestus is a spiked or bladed metal band that may either be worn A club is a crude blunt weapon – little more than a roughly shaped
around the hand or built into a gauntlet. Although only a small piece of wood – that can be used in one hand.
weapon, it can be used without incurring off-hand penalties.

Off-hand: A weapon with this ability does not suffer the normal
to-hit and proficiency penalties when used in the wielder’s off hand.

72
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–18: Crossbow, Heavy vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–20: Crossbow, Light vs. Armed Opponents

Missile Range

Missile Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Damage

Damage
Stun

Stun
None –1 1d4 – 80/160/240 None –1 1d3 – 60/120/180
Basic – 2d4 – 80/160/240 Basic – 1d6 – 60/120/180
Skilled +2 2d6 S/m 90/160/240 Skilled +2 1d6+2 S 60/120/180
Expert +4 2d6+2 S/m 100/170/240 Expert +4 1d6+4 S 75/130/180
Master +6 3d6+2 S/m 110/170/240 Master +6 1d8+6 S 75/130/180
Grandmaster +8 4d4+4 S/m 120/180/240 Grandmaster +8 1d6+7 S 90/140/180

Table 6–19: Crossbow, Heavy vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–21: Crossbow, Light vs. Unarmed Opponents
Missile Range

Missile Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Stun

Stun
None –1 1d4 – – 80/160/240 None –1 1d3 – – 60/120/180
Basic – 2d4 – – 80/160/240 Basic – 1d6 – – 60/120/180
Skilled +1 2d6 –1 vs 1 S/m 90/160/240 Skilled +1 1d6+2 –1 vs 1 S 60/120/180
Expert +2 2d6+2 –2 vs 2 S/m 100/170/240 Expert +2 1d6+4 –2 vs 2 S 75/130/180
Master +4 1d12+4 –3 vs 2 S/m 110/170/240 Master +4 1d4+6 –3 vs 2 S 75/130/180
Grandmaster +6 1d10+6 –3 vs 3 S/m 120/180/240 Grandmaster +6 2d4+5 –3 vs 3 S 90/140/180

Crossbow, Heavy Crossbow, Light


A heavy crossbow is a large two-handed missile weapon. It has A light crossbow is a medium sized missile weapon, although it still
powerful metal arms and a string that is pulled back using a crank. needs two hands to wield. It has powerful metal arms and a string
that is pulled back using a lever.
Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits
that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits
smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray. that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or
smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray.
Heavy crossbows can only stun opponents at the listed ranges.
Light crossbows can only stun opponents at the listed ranges.
A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty
character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned
shake off the stun. character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to
shake off the stun.

73
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–22: Dagger vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–24: Flail vs. Armed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage

Damage
Double

Disarm
Penalty
Deflect
None – 1d2 – – 10/20/30 None – 1d4 – – –
Basic – 1d4 – – 10/20/30 Basic – 1d8 – –2 –
Skilled +2 1d6 –1 vs 1 20 15/25/35 Skilled +2 1d8+2 –2 vs 2 –4 +0
Expert +4 2d4 –2 vs 2 19 20/30/45 Expert +4 1d8+4 –3 vs 2 –6 –1
Master +6 3d4 –2 vs 2 18 25/35/50 Master +6 1d8+8 –3 vs 3 –8 –2
Grandmaster +8 4d4 –3 vs 3 17 30/50/60 Grandmaster +8 1d10+10 –4 vs 4 –10 –4

Table 6–23: Dagger vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–25: Flail vs. Unarmed Opponents
Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Damage

Damage

Damage
Double

Disarm
None – 1d2 – 10/20/30 None – 1d4 –
Basic – 1d4 – 10/20/30 Basic – 1d8 –
Skilled +1 1d6 20 15/25/35 Skilled +1 1d8+2 +0
Expert +2 2d4 19 20/30/45 Expert +2 1d8+4 –1
Master +4 2d4+2 18 25/35/50 Master +4 1d8+6 –2
Grandmaster +6 3d4+1 17 30/50/60 Grandmaster +6 1d8+8 –4

Dagger Flail
A dagger is a short light blade which is 18” long or less. Daggers A flail is a large two-handed melee weapon consisting of a 2’ to 3’
are popular weapons because their small size makes them easy to wooden shaft with two or three 2’ chains attached to the end. Each
conceal and they can be either thrown or used in melee. chain is tipped with a spiked weight.

Double Damage: If the wielder of the weapon rolls the number Deflect Penalty: Weapons that have the deflect penalty ability
indicated or higher on the dice, before modifiers, and the attack are hard to deflect because of their flexible nature. Any attempts
hits the target after modifiers, then the attack does double the to deflect attacks with one of these weapons is made at the listed
normal amount of damage. penalty for the wielders proficiency level.

Disarm: The wielder of a weapon with the disarm ability can


choose to try to disarm their opponent instead of attacking for
damage. The player must announce that a disarm attempt is being
made before rolling the attack. If the attack hits then the target of
the attack must make a dexterity check (see Chapter 5 – Ability
Checks & Skills) with the listed penalty to their effective dexterity
or drop their weapon.

74
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–26: Halberd vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–28: Hammer, Throwing vs. Armed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Disarm
Deflect
Hook

Stun
None – 1d5 – – – – None – 1d2 – 10/20/30
Basic – 1d10 – +0 – +0 Basic – 1d4 – 10/20/30
Skilled +2 1d10+3 –1 vs 1 –1 – +0 Skilled +1 1d4+2 S/m 10/20/30
Expert +4 1d10+5 –2 vs 1 –2 1 +0 Expert +2 1d6+2 S/m 20/30/45
Master +6 1d8+10 –2 vs 2 –3 1 +0 Master +4 1d4+4 S/m 20/40/45
Grandmaster +8 1d6+15 –3 vs 2 –4 2 +0 Grandmaster +6 1d4+6 S/m 30/50/60

Table 6–27: Halberd vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–29: Hammer, Throwing vs. Unarmed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Disarm
Deflect
Hook

Stun
None – 1d5 – – – None – 1d2 – – 10/20/30
Basic – 1d10 +0 – +0 Basic – 1d4 – – 10/20/30
Skilled +1 1d10+3 –1 – +0 Skilled +2 1d4+2 –1 vs 2 S/m 10/20/30
Expert +2 1d10+5 –2 1 +0 Expert +4 1d6+2 –2 vs 3 S/m 20/30/45
Master +4 1d8+8 –3 1 +0 Master +6 1d6+4 –3 vs 4 S/m 20/40/45
Grandmaster +6 1d6+12 –4 2 +0 Grandmaster +8 1d6+6 –4 vs 5 S/m 30/50/60

Halberd Hammer, Throwing


A halberd is a large pole-arm 6’ to 8’ in length, the head of which A throwing hammer is a one handed hammer from 18” to 2’ in
has a long spike, an axe blade, and a hook. length that is weighted for throwing. Despite the name, it can also
be used in melee.
Disarm: The wielder of a weapon with the disarm ability can
choose to try to disarm their opponent instead of doing damage. Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits
The player must announce a disarm attempt before rolling any that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or
dice for the attack. If the attack hits then the target must make a smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray.
dexterity check (see Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills) with
the listed penalty to their effective dexterity or drop their weapon. Throwing hammers can only stun opponents at the listed ranges.

Hook: The wielder of a weapon with the hook ability can choose A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
to try to hook their opponent and trip them instead of attacking at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty
for damage. The character’s player must announce that a hook at- to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned
tempt is being made before rolling dice for the attack. If the attack character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to
hits, the weapon causes only minimum damage and the target must shake off the stun.
make a saving throw vs. paralysis or fall prone.

75
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–30: Hammer, War vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–32: Javelin vs. Armed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency
Damage

Damage
Stun
None – 1d3 – – None – 1d3 30/60/90
Basic – 1d6 – – Basic – 1d6 30/60/90
Skilled +2 1d6+2 Y – Skilled +2 1d6+2 30/60/90
Expert +4 1d8+2 Y -/10/20 Expert +4 1d6+4 40/80/120
Master +6 1d8+5 Y -/10/20 Master +6 1d6+6 40/80/120
Grandmaster +8 1d8+7 Y 10/20/30 Grandmaster +8 1d6+9 50/100/150

Table 6–31: Hammer, War vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–33: Javelin vs. Unarmed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Stun

None – 1d3 – – – None – 1d3 30/60/90


Basic – 1d6 – – – Basic – 1d6 30/60/90
Skilled +1 1d6+2 –2 vs 2 Y – Skilled +1 1d6+2 30/60/90
Expert +2 1d8+2 –3 vs 3 Y -/10/20 Expert +2 1d6+4 40/80/120
Master +4 1d6+4 –4 vs 3 Y -/10/20 Master +4 1d4+6 40/80/120
Grandmaster +6 1d6+7 –5 vs 4 Y 10/20/30 Grandmaster +6 1d4+8 50/100/150

Hammer, War Javelin


A war hammer is a large one handed hammer, usually 2’ to 3’ in A javelin is a light one-handed throwing spear. Although primarily
length. The head of a war hammer is often symmetrical to aid in used as a thrown weapon, it can also be used in melee.
balance.

Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits
that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or
smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray.

76
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–34: Lance vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–36: Mace vs. Armed Opponents

To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Charge

Deflect
None – 1d5 Y None – 1d3 – – –
Basic – 1d10 Y Basic – 1d6 – – –
Skilled +1 1d10+3 Y Skilled +2 2d4 –1 vs 1 1 –
Expert +2 1d10+7 Y Expert +4 2d4+2 –2 vs 2 2 -/10/20
Master +4 1d8+10 Y Master +6 2d4+4 –3 vs 3 3 -/10/20
Grandmaster +6 1d6+12 Y Grandmaster +8 2d4+6 –4 vs 3 3 10/20/30

Table 6–35: Lance vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–37: Mace vs. Unarmed Opponents
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Charge

Deflect
None – 1d5 – Y None – 1d3 – –
Basic – 1d10 – Y Basic – 1d6 – –
Skilled +2 1d10+3 –2 vs 1 Y Skilled +2 2d4 1 –
Expert +4 1d10+7 –3 vs 1 Y Expert +4 2d4+2 2 -/10/20
Master +6 1d8+12 –3 vs 2 Y Master +6 2d4+4 3 -/10/20
Grandmaster +8 1d8+16 –4 vs 2 Y Grandmaster +8 2d4+6 3 10/20/30

Lance Mace
A lance is an extremely long spear, 9’ to 12’ long. It is too unwieldy A mace is a one handed melee weapon consisting of a 2’–3’ long
to use on foot, and can only be used when mounted – in which shaft with a heavy metal head. The head can be smooth (round or
case it can be used in one hand despite its length. pear shaped), can contain flanges or studs, or can even be sculpted
into the shape of a fist or skull or other roundish object.
Charge: When a weapon with the charge ability is used after the
wielder’s mount has charged 20’ or more in the round, the weapon
does double the normal amount of damage.

77
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–38: Morning Star vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–40: Net vs. Armed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Ac Bonus

Entangle
Damage

Damage
Disarm
Penalty
Deflect
None – 1d3 – – – None – – – +0 10/20/30
Basic – 1d6 – –2 – Basic – – – +0 10/20/30
Skilled +2 2d4 –2 vs 2 –4 +0 Skilled +1 – –2 vs 1 +1 15/25/35
Expert +4 2d4+2 –3 vs 2 –6 –1 Expert +2 – –4 vs 2 +2 20/30/40
Master +6 2d4+4 –3 vs 3 –8 –2 Master +4 – –6 vs 3 +2 25/35/45
Grandmaster +8 2d4+6 –4 vs 4 –10 –4 Grandmaster +6 – –8 vs 4 +3 30/40/50

Table 6–39: Morning Star vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–41: Net vs. Unarmed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency

Ac Bonus

Entangle
Damage

Damage
Disarm

None – 1d3 – None – – – +0 10/20/30


Basic – 1d6 – Basic – – – +0 10/20/30
Skilled +1 2d4 +0 Skilled +2 – –2 vs 1 +1 15/25/35
Expert +2 2d4+2 –1 Expert +4 – –4 vs 2 +2 20/30/40
Master +4 2d4+4 –2 Master +6 – –6 vs 3 +4 25/35/45
Grandmaster +6 2d4+6 –4 Grandmaster +8 – –8 vs 4 +6 30/40/50

Morning Star Net


A morning star is a one handed melee weapon consisting of a 1’ Nets designed for use in combat are generally 6’ to 9’ in diameter,
to 2’ shaft with an 18” to 2’ chain attached to the end. The other and usually have small weights around their edge to hold them
end of the chain holds a spiked weight. open when they are flung. This arrangement lets them be thrown
one-handed if held in their centre. Nets do no damage to opponents
Deflect Penalty: Weapons that have the deflect penalty ability in combat, but are excellent defensive weapons.
are hard to deflect because of their flexible nature. Any attempts
to deflect attacks with one of these weapons is made at the listed Entangle: Any target that the weapon hits may become delayed,
penalty for the wielders proficiency level. slowed or entangled depending on their hit dice or level compared
to the proficiency level of the weapon wielder.
Disarm: The wielder of a weapon with the disarm ability can
choose to try to disarm their opponent instead of attacking for See Table 6–80 for details.
damage. The player must announce that a disarm attempt is being
made before rolling the attack. If the attack hits then the target of
the attack must make a dexterity check (see Chapter 5 – Ability
Checks & Skills) with the listed penalty to their effective dexterity
or drop their weapon.

78
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–42: Pike vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–44: Pistol vs. Armed Opponents

Missile Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Delay
Set
None – 1d5 – – – None –1 1d3 – 50/100/150
Basic – 1d10 – – Y Basic – 1d6 – 50/100/150
Skilled +2 1d12+2 –2 vs 1 1 Y Skilled +2 1d8+1 S/m 60/110/160
Expert +4 1d12+5 –2 vs 2 1 Y Expert +4 1d10+2 S/m 80/130/170
Master +6 1d12+9 –3 vs 2 2 Y Master +6 3d6 S/m 90/130/180
Grandmaster +8 1d10+14 –3 vs 3 2 Y Grandmaster +8 4d4+2 S/m 110/140/190

Table 6–43: Pike vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–45: Pistol vs. Unarmed Opponents

Missile Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Delay
Set

None – 1d5 – – None –1 1d3 – 50/100/150


Basic – 1d10 – Y Basic – 1d6 – 50/100/150
Skilled +1 1d12+2 1 Y Skilled +1 1d8+1 S/m 60/110/160
Expert +2 1d12+5 1 Y Expert +2 1d10+2 S/m 80/130/170
Master +4 1d10+8 2 Y Master +4 1d10+4 S/m 90/130/180
Grandmaster +6 1d8+10 2 Y Grandmaster +6 1d10+6 S/m 110/140/190

Pike Pistol
A pike is an extremely long spear, 7’ to 15’ long. It can only be A pistol is a short gun, 9” to 12” long. It can be fired using only
wielded using two hands. one hand, but needs both hands to reload.

Set: The wielder of this weapon may brace it against a charging foe. Pistols require both red powder and bullets to load. See Chap-
The wielder automatically gains initiative over the charging foe, and ter 8 – Equipping for Adventure for more details about red
if they hit then they do double normal damage. powder.

Delay: When the wielder of a weapon with the delay ability hits
an opponent with it, the opponent must make a saving throw vs.
paralysis or automatically lose initiative in the following round.

Pistols can only delay opponents at the listed ranges.

79
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–46: Poleaxe vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–48: Shield, Buckler vs. Armed Opponents

To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Ac Bonus

Off-hand
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Deflect
None – 1d5 – – None – – –1 vs 1 Y –
Basic – 1d10 – – Basic – – –1 vs 2 Y –
Skilled +2 1d10+3 –1 vs 1 1 Skilled +2 – –2 vs 3 Y –
Expert +4 1d10+6 –2 vs 1 1 Expert +4 1d4 –2 vs 3 Y 1
Master +6 1d10+10 –2 vs 2 2 Master +6 1d4+1 –2 vs 4 Y 1
Grandmaster +8 1d8+16 –3 vs 2 2 Grandmaster +8 2d4 –3 vs 4 Y 2

Table 6–47: Poleaxe vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–49: Shield, Buckler vs. Unarmed Opponents
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency

Ac Bonus

Off-hand
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Deflect
None – 1d5 – None – – –1 vs 1 Y –
Basic – 1d10 – Basic – – –1 vs 2 Y –
Skilled +1 1d10+3 1 Skilled +2 – –2 vs 3 Y –
Expert +2 1d10+6 1 Expert +4 1d4 –2 vs 3 Y 1
Master +4 1d10+8 2 Master +6 1d4+1 –2 vs 4 Y 1
Grandmaster +6 1d8+12 2 Grandmaster +8 2d4 –3 vs 4 Y 2

Poleaxe Shield, Buckler


A poleaxe consists of an axe blade (usually single sided, but oc- A buckler is a small, light shield around 12” to 18” in diameter that
casionally double sided) with a 6’ to 8’ long shaft. It is wielded in is held in the fist and actively used for parrying blows. Although
both hands like a large two-handed axe. it can be used to attack at high levels of skill, at lower proficiency
levels it is merely used for its defensive properties.

Off-hand: A weapon with this ability does not suffer the normal
to-hit and proficiency penalties when used in the wielder’s off hand.

Developer Commentary
In the original edition of Dark Dungeons (and in the original game
that Dark Dungeons is based on), shields gave a flat bonus to armour
class rather than having increasing abilities that are unlocked by
increasing your proficiency with them.

However, there were also special shields “blade shield”, “knife shield”
and so forth, that also counted as weapons. You could increase your
proficiency with these special shields and get various special abilities
with them just like any other weapon.

I simplified and balanced this in Darker Dungeons, dropping the


special shields and giving normal shields abilities with increased
proficiency level instead of them having a flat bonus that stacked with
whatever bonus your weapons had.

80
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–50: Shield, Normal vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–52: Shield, Tower vs. All Opponents

To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Ac Bonus
Off-hand

Off-hand
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Deflect
Delay

Stun
None – – –1 vs 1 Y – – None – – –1 vs 1 Y – –
Basic – – –1 vs 2 Y – – Basic – – –2vs 2 Y – –
Skilled +2 – –2 vs 2 Y – 1 Skilled +2 1d6 –2 vs 2 Y – 1
Expert +4 1d6 –3 vs 2 Y – 1 Expert +4 1d6+2 –3 vs 2 Y – 1
Master +6 1d6+2 –3 vs 3 Y – 2 Master +6 1d8+2 –3 vs 2 Y Y 1
Grandmaster +8 1d8+2 –4 vs 3 Y Y 2 Grandmaster +8 1d8+4 –4 vs 2 Y Y 1

Table 6–51: Shield, Normal vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–53: Shield, Tower vs. All Opponents
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Ac Bonus
Off-hand

Off-hand
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Deflect
Delay

Stun
None – – –1 vs 1 Y – – None – – –1 vs 1 Y – –
Basic – – –1 vs 2 Y – – Basic – – –2vs 2 Y – –
Skilled +2 – –2 vs 2 Y – 1 Skilled +2 1d6 –2 vs 2 Y – 1
Expert +4 1d6 –3 vs 2 Y – 1 Expert +4 1d6+2 –3 vs 2 Y – 1
Master +6 1d6+2 –3 vs 3 Y – 2 Master +6 1d8+2 –3 vs 2 Y Y 1
Grandmaster +8 1d8+2 –4 vs 3 Y Y 2 Grandmaster +8 1d8+4 –4 vs 2 Y Y 1

Shield, Normal Shield, Tower


A normal shield is a medium sized shield around 2’ to 3’ in diameter, A tower shield is a large, oblong or rectangular shield around 2’ wide
although it can come in a variety of shapes. It is held in the fist and up to 5’ tall. Too big to be held in the fist, it is worn strapped
and used for deflecting blows. Although it can be used to attack at to the arm and is used to passively block blows. Although it can
high levels of skill, at lower proficiency levels it is merely used for be used to attack at high levels of skill, at lower proficiency levels
its defensive properties. it is merely used for its defensive properties.

Off-hand: A weapon with this ability does not suffer the normal Off-hand: A weapon with this ability does not suffer the normal
to-hit and proficiency penalties when used in the wielder’s off hand. to-hit and proficiency penalties when used in the wielder’s off hand.

Delay: When the wielder of a weapon with the delay ability hits Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits
an opponent with it, the opponent must make a saving throw vs. that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or
paralysis or automatically lose initiative in the following round. smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray.

A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty
to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned
character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to
shake off the stun.

81
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–54: Sling vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–56: Smoothbore vs. Armed Opponents

Missile Range

Missile Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Stun

Stun
None –1 1d2 – – 40/80/160 None –1 1d4 – 80/160/240
Basic – 1d4 – – 40/80/160 Basic – 2d4 – 80/160/240
Skilled +2 1d6 –1 vs 2 S/m 40/80/160 Skilled +1 2d6 S/m 90/160/240
Expert +4 2d4 –2 vs 3 S/m 60/110/170 Expert +2 2d6+2 S/m 100/170/240
Master +6 3d4 –3 vs 3 S/m 60/110/170 Master +4 1d12+4 S/m 110/170/240
Grandmaster +8 4d4 –4 vs 4 S/m 80/130/180 Grandmaster +6 1d10+6 S/m 120/180/240

Table 6–55: Sling vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–57: Smoothbore vs. Unarmed Opponents
Missile Range

Missile Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Stun

Stun
None –1 1d2 – 40/80/160 None –1 1d4 – – 80/160/240
Basic – 1d4 – 40/80/160 Basic – 2d4 – – 80/160/240
Skilled +1 1d6 S/m 40/80/160 Skilled +2 2d6 –1 vs 1 S/m 90/160/240
Expert +2 2d4 S/m 60/110/170 Expert +4 2d6+2 –2 vs 2 S/m 100/170/240
Master +4 1d8+2 S/m 60/110/170 Master +6 3d6+2 –3 vs 2 S/m 110/170/240
Grandmaster +6 1d10+2 S/m 80/130/180 Grandmaster +8 4d4+4 –3 vs 3 S/m 120/180/240

Sling Smoothbore
A sling is a long (4’ to 6’) leather cord with a pouch half way along. A smoothbore is a long gun, 3’ to 5’ long. It requires two hands to
The wielder places a stone in the pouch and swings the cord over both fire and reload. Smoothbores require both red powder and
their head. bullets to load. See Chapter 8 – Equipping for Adventure for
more details about red powder.
Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits
that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits
smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray. that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or
smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray.
Slings can only stun opponents at the listed ranges.
Smoothbores can only stun opponents at the listed ranges.
A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty
character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned
shake off the stun. character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to
shake off the stun.

82
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–58: Spear vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–60: Staff vs. Armed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage

Deflect
Stun
Set
None – 1d3 – – 20/40/60 None – 1d3 – –
Basic – 1d6 Y – 20/40/60 Basic – 1d6 – –
Skilled +2 1d6+2 Y – 20/40/60 Skilled +2 1d6+2 –1 vs 2 1
Expert +4 2d4+2 Y Y 40/60/75 Expert +4 1d8+2 –2 vs 3 2
Master +6 2d4+4 Y Y 40/60/75 Master +6 1d8+5 –3 vs 3 3
Grandmaster +8 2d4+6 Y Y 60/75/80 Grandmaster +8 1d8+7 –4 vs 4 4

Table 6–59: Spear vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–61: Staff vs. Unarmed Opponents
Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage

Deflect
Stun
Set

None – 1d3 – – 20/40/60 None – 1d3 – –


Basic – 1d6 Y – 20/40/60 Basic – 1d6 – –
Skilled +2 1d6+2 Y – 20/40/60 Skilled +2 1d6+2 –1 vs 2 1
Expert +4 2d4+2 Y Y 40/60/75 Expert +4 1d8+2 –2 vs 3 2
Master +6 2d4+4 Y Y 40/60/75 Master +6 1d8+5 –3 vs 3 3
Grandmaster +8 2d4+6 Y Y 60/75/80 Grandmaster +8 1d8+7 –4 vs 4 4

Spear Staff
A spear is a 5’ to 7’ long shaft with a stabbing blade on the end. A staff is one of the most simple weapons. It consists of just a length
Despite its length, a spear is a well balanced weapon and can either of wood 5’ to 7’ in length, which is wielded in two hands.
be used in melee one-handed or thrown.

Set: The wielder of this weapon may brace it against a charging foe.
The wielder automatically gains initiative over the charging foe, and
if they hit then they do double the normal damage.

Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits
that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or
smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray.

Spears can only stun opponents at the listed ranges.

A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty
to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned
character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to
shake off the stun.

83
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–62: Sword, Bastard (1h) vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–64: Sword, Bastard (2h) vs. Armed Opponents

To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Deflect
None – 1d3 – – None – 1d4 – – –
Basic – 1d6+1 – – Basic – 1d8+1 – – –
Skilled +2 1d6+3 –1 vs 1 – Skilled +2 1d8+3 – 1 –
Expert +4 1d6+5 –2 vs 2 1 Expert +4 1d8+5 –1 vs 1 1 -/-/5
Master +6 1d8+8 –3 vs 2 1 Master +6 1d10+8 –2 vs 2 2 -/-/5
Grandmaster +8 1d8+10 –4 vs 3 2 Grandmaster +8 1d12+10 –3 vs 2 3 -/5/10

Table 6–63: Sword, Bastard (1h) vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–65: Sword, Bastard (2h) vs. Unarmed Opponents
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Deflect
None – 1d3 – None – 1d4 – –
Basic – 1d6+1 – Basic – 1d8+1 – –
Skilled +1 1d6+3 – Skilled +1 1d8+3 1 –
Expert +2 1d6+5 1 Expert +2 1d8+5 1 -/-/5
Master +4 1d6+7 1 Master +4 1d8+7 2 -/-/5
Grandmaster +6 1d6+8 2 Grandmaster +6 1d10+8 3 -/5/10

Sword, Bastard (One-handed) Sword, Bastard (Two-handed)


A bastard sword, also known as a longsword, is a sword with a A bastard sword, also known as a longsword, is a sword with a
long (3’ to 4’) narrow blade that is used either one-handed or two- long (3’ to 4’) narrow blade that is used either one-handed or two-
handed. The same weapon proficiency covers both forms of usage. handed. The same weapon proficiency covers both forms of usage.

84
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–66: Sword, Normal vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–68: Sword, Short vs. Armed Opponents

To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Hurl Range

Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Ac Bonus
Damage

Damage
Disarm

Disarm
Deflect

Deflect
None – 1d4 – – – – None – 1d3 – – – –
Basic – 1d8 – – – – Basic – 1d6 – – – –
Skilled +2 1d12 –2 vs 1 1 +0 – Skilled +2 1d6+2 –1 vs 1 1 –1 –
Expert +4 2d8 –2 vs 2 2 –1 -/5/10 Expert +4 1d6+4 –2 vs 2 2 –2 -/10/20
Master +6 2d8+4 –3 vs 3 2 –2 -/5/10 Master +6 1d6+7 –2 vs 3 3 –4 -/10/20
Grandmaster +8 2d6+8 –4 vs 3 3 –4 5/10/15 Grandmaster +8 1d6+9 –3 vs 4 3 –6 10/20/30

Table 6–67: Sword, Normal vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–69: Sword, Short vs. Unarmed Opponents
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Hurl Range

Hurl Range
Proficiency

Proficiency
Damage

Damage
Disarm

Disarm
Deflect

Deflect
None – 1d4 – – – None – 1d3 – – –
Basic – 1d8 – – – Basic – 1d6 – – –
Skilled +1 1d12 1 +0 – Skilled +1 1d6+2 1 –1 –
Expert +2 2d8 2 –1 -/5/10 Expert +2 1d6+4 2 –2 -/10/20
Master +4 2d6+4 2 –2 -/5/10 Master +4 1d4+7 3 –4 -/10/20
Grandmaster +6 2d4+8 3 –4 5/10/15 Grandmaster +6 1d4+9 3 –6 10/20/30

Sword, Normal Sword, Short


A normal sword is a one-handed sword with a straight or curved A short sword is a sword with a straight 18” to 2’ blade. Primarily
blade 2’ to 3’ long. This category of sword encompasses a variety used as a stabbing rather than slashing weapon, this small blade
of different styles of sword, ranging from scimitars to broadswords can be used in one hand.
and even rapiers.
Disarm: The wielder of a weapon with the disarm ability can
Disarm: The wielder of a weapon with the disarm ability can choose to try to disarm their opponent instead of attacking for
choose to try to disarm their opponent instead of attacking for damage. The character’s player must announce that a disarm at-
damage. The character’s player must announce that a disarm at- tempt is being made before rolling any dice for the attack. If the
tempt is being made before rolling any dice for the attack. If the attack hits then the target of the attack must make a dexterity check
attack hits then the target of the attack must make a dexterity check (see Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills) with the listed penalty
(see Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills) with the listed penalty to their effective dexterity or drop their weapon.
to their effective dexterity or drop their weapon.

85
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–70: Sword, Two-handed vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–72: Trident vs. Armed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Skewer
Stun
None – 1d5 – – None – 1d3 – 10/20/30
Basic – 1d10 – – Basic – 1d6 – 10/20/30
Skilled +1 2d6+1 Y 1 Skilled +1 1d8+1 4hd 10/20/30
Expert +2 2d8+2 Y 2 Expert +2 1d8+4 7hd 20/30/45
Master +4 2d8+3 Y 2 Master +4 1d6+6 10hd 20/30/45
Grandmaster +6 3d6+2 Y 3 Grandmaster +6 1d4+8 15hd 30/45/60

Table 6–71: Sword, Two-handed vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–73: Trident vs. Unarmed Opponents

Throw Range
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Proficiency
Damage

Damage
Deflect

Skewer
Stun

None – 1d5 – – None – 1d3 – 10/20/30


Basic – 1d10 – – Basic – 1d6 – 10/20/30
Skilled +2 2d6+1 Y 1 Skilled +2 1d8+1 4hd 10/20/30
Expert +4 2d8+2 Y 2 Expert +4 1d8+4 7hd 20/30/45
Master +6 3d6+3 Y 2 Master +6 1d8+6 10hd 20/30/45
Grandmaster +8 3d6+6 Y 3 Grandmaster +8 1d6+9 15hd 30/45/60

Sword, Two-handed Trident


A two-handed sword, sometimes known as a greatsword, is a large A trident is a short (4’ to 6’) spear which is split at the end into
and heavy sword with a 4’ to 5’ blade. It is always used in two hands. three tines, like a fork. Each tine is usually barbed. A trident is used
in one hand either in melee or as a thrown weapon, and is often
Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits used as a fishing spear, since the barbs on the points can lift the
that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or fish out of the water when the trident is withdrawn.
smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray.
Skewer: If the weapon hits an opponent with the listed number
Some ranged weapons can only stun opponents at listed ranges. of hit dice (or levels) or less, the opponent may be skewered if the
attacker so chooses.
A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty The attacker must let go of the weapon, and it remains caught in
to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned the opponent for 1d4+4 rounds, doing 1d6 damage each round.
character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to If the opponent spends a round removing the weapon, they take
shake off the stun. double damage that round but are then free of the weapon.

86
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–74: Unarmed Strikes vs. Armed Opponents

To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

Knockout

Off-hand
Damage Developer Commentary
None – 1 – –
In the original game that Dark Dungeons is based on, martial artists
Basic – 1 +0 – (which are reflavoured as lupines in this game), unarmed combat, and
Skilled +2 1d3 +0 – weapon proficiency levels were all introduced separately.
Expert +4 1d4+1 –1 Y
Consequently they had no interaction with each other at all. Unarmed
Master +6 2d4 –3 Y
combat (both strikes and wrestling) used its own system that was
Grandmaster +8 3d4 –5 Y unconnected with either martial arts or proficiency levels and there
were no proficiency levels for martial arts attacks either.
Table 6–75: Unarmed Strikes vs. Unarmed Opponents
In the original edition of Dark Dungeons, I combined martial arts,
To-hit Bonus
Proficiency

unarmed strikes. And weapon proficiency into the system given here.
Knockout

Off-hand
Damage

In this new edition I have also added wrestling into the mix (wrestling
was not included in the original edition of Dark Dungeons), provid-
ing proficiency levels with wrestling.
None – 1 – –
Basic – 1 +0 –
Skilled +1 1d3 +0 –
Expert +2 1d4+1 –1 Y
Master +4 1d4+1 –3 Y
Grandmaster +6 2d4+1 –5 Y

Unarmed Strikes Example: Karne is a 10th level lupine with master level proficiency
Unarmed strikes include boxing, street fighting and other martial with unarmed strikes, and is fighting an ogre who is armed with a
arts. Unarmed attacks are considered to be one-handed attacks for large club.
purposes of mixing them with other attacks, although they may
actually include strikes using other parts of the body. Each round he has a choice between striking twice to stun (using an
off-hand attack with no penalty) with a chance to knock the ogre
Any character can learn unarmed fighting, although lupine char- out, and doing 2d4 damage; or striking three times with his natural
acters are able to use their claws and teeth to kill opponents rather weapons, in which case he will do 2d10 damage but have no chance
than just striking to stun with fists, elbows and feet. If they use to knock the ogre out. In either case, he will get a +6 bonus to hit the
their natural weapons, they do the increased damage listed on ogre since the ogre is armed.
Table 4–9a instead of the damage listed here. A lupine using
claws and teeth does not roll for knockout chances, and gets the
number of attacks listed on Table 4–9a rather than making off-
hand attacks. The lupine must decide which form of attack they
are using before rolling for initiative.

Knockout: Any target that the unarmed strike hits may become
delayed, stunned or knocked out depending on their hit dice
or level compared to the proficiency level of the striker. See Ta-
ble 6–81 for details. The target must make a saving throw vs.
death ray with a penalty based on the proficiency of the striker
when hit in order to avoid the effect. If this fails, the target is af-
fected as normal by the delay, stun or knock out.

An enemy who is knocked out will be unconscious for 1d100


rounds before waking up.

87
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–76: Whip vs. Armed Opponents Table 6–78: Wrestling vs. Armed Opponents

To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Strangle Save
Proficiency

Proficiency
Entangle
Damage

Damage

Strangle
None – 1 – None – 0 – –
Basic – 1d2 +0 Basic – 0 20 –
Skilled +1 1d4 –1 Skilled +2 1 20 –1
Expert +2 1d4+1 –2 Expert +4 1d2 19 –2
Master +4 1d3+2 –3 Master +6 1d4 18 –3
Grandmaster +6 1d3+3 –4 Grandmaster +8 1d6+1 17 –4

Table 6–77: Whip vs. Unarmed Opponents Table 6–79: Wrestling vs. Armed Opponents
To-hit Bonus

To-hit Bonus

Strangle Save
Proficiency

Proficiency
Ac Bonus

Entangle
Damage

Damage

Strangle
None – 1 – – None – 0 – –
Basic – 1d2 – +0 Basic – 0 20 –
Skilled +2 1d4 –2 vs 2 –1 Skilled +2 1 20 –1
Expert +4 1d4+1 –3 vs 3 –2 Expert +4 1d2 19 –2
Master +6 1d4+3 –4 vs 3 –3 Master +6 1d3 18 –3
Grandmaster +8 1d4+5 –4 vs 4 –4 Grandmaster +8 1d4 17 –4

Whip Wrestling
A whip is a woven leather cord from 5’ to 15’ in length that is used Wrestling is a form of unarmed attack that seeks to grapple and
in one hand. Whips do little damage, and are more often used for pin, or even choke, an opponent. However, even at high levels of
corporal punishment than for serious combat. proficiency, wrestling does little damage – relying on its ability to
entangle or strangle an opponent. At lower levels of proficiency
Entangle: Any target that the weapon hits may become delayed, wrestling does no base damage at all, but a strength bonus does
slowed or entangled depending on their hit dice or level compared still apply.
to the proficiency level of the weapon wielder. See Table 6–80 for
details. The target must make a saving throw vs. death ray with a When an opponent is entangled or strangled by a wrestler, the
penalty based on the proficiency of the wielder when first hit in wrestler may not move or take any other action than continuing
order to avoid the effect. If this fails, the target is affected but may to attack the target with wrestling attacks, otherwise the target will
repeat the saving throw each round until they make it, at which be immediately freed from the entangle or strangle.
point they are no longer affected.
Strangle: If the attacker rolls the number indicated or higher on
An entangled target cannot attack, cast spells, or move. the dice, before modifiers, and the attack hits the target after modi-
fiers, then the target of the attack must make an immediate saving
throw vs. death ray with the listed penalty or be paralysed and die
after 1d6+2 rounds of strangulation. Should the target be freed
from strangulation, they will remain paralysed for 2d6 rounds.

If the attacker does not roll the required numbers but still hits the
target, the target is affected as though the weapon were an entan-
gling weapon with the same saving throw penalty.

88
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
one weapon has run out of attacks that it can give a bonus against.
Weapon Abilities Each bonus can be used for either value and attacker type in the pair.
The various weapon abilities listed on the previous tables are de-
scribed below. Charge: When a weapon with the charge ability is used after the
wielder’s mount has charged 20’ or more in the round, the weapon
Ac Bonus: When using the weapon, a character gains the listed does double the normal amount of damage.
armour class bonus against the given number of incoming attacks
each round. For example, an entry of “–2 vs 3” means that the Deflect: If a number is listed for this ability, the wielder of the
wielder of the weapon gains a –2 bonus to their armour class against weapon can attempt to deflect a number of incoming attacks equal
three incoming attacks. to this number by making a saving throw vs. death ray against
each of them.
The character can decide which attacks to use the bonus against so
they can save the bonus for use against a tougher opponent who is A successful saving throw means that the attack is deflected and
attacking later in the round rather than having to use them against the character takes no damage.
a weak opponent who happens to be attacking first. However, the
character must announce which attacks they wish to use the bonus The character can decide which attacks to try to deflect, so they
against before attacks are rolled. can save the attempts for use against a tougher opponent who is
attacking later in the round rather than having to use them against
These armour class bonuses must be used against attacks coming a weak opponent who happens to be attacking first.
from opponents of the relevant type, regardless of what type of
opponent the character is attacking. However, the character must announce which attacks they wish to
try to deflect against before attacks are rolled.
For example, a character who is skilled with a normal sword gets
a –2 ac bonus against one attack from an armed opponent per When a character uses two weapons in combat, the deflection at-
round, even if the character is actually attacking an unarmed op- tempts given by each weapon do not stack. The character gets to
ponent. use a number of attempts equal to the higher number granted by
either of the weapons.
When a character uses two weapons in combat, they get whichever
ac bonus is most beneficial against each incoming attack. The Deflect Penalty: Weapons that have the deflect penalty ability
bonuses do not stack. To work this out, compare the number of are hard to deflect because of their flexible nature. Any attempts
attacks each set of bonuses works against, and pair them up until to deflect attacks with one of these weapons is made at the listed
penalty for the wielders proficiency level.

Example: Black Leaf is wielding a normal sword in her main hand Delay: When the wielder of a weapon with the delay ability hits
and a buckler in her off hand. She has skilled proficiency with the an opponent with it, the opponent must make a saving throw vs.
sword and basic proficiency with the shield. The sword gives her –2 paralysis or automatically lose initiative in the following round.
ac vs 1 attack by an armed opponent. The shield gives her –1 ac
vs 2 attacks by any opponents. Some ranged weapons can only delay opponents at listed ranges.

Pairing these up, we get: Disarm: The wielder of a weapon with the disarm ability can
choose to try to disarm their opponent instead of attacking for
A first bonus that is +2 if the attack is armed (from the sword) or +1 damage. The character’s player must announce that a disarm at-
if the attack is either armed or unarmed (from the shield). tempt is being made before rolling any dice for the attack. If the
attack hits then the target of the attack must make a dexterity check
A second bonus that is +1 if the attack is either armed or unarmed (see Chapter 5 – Ability Checks & Skills) with the listed penalty
(from the shield – there were no more sword bonuses to pair up to their effective dexterity or drop their weapon.
with this one).
Double Damage: If the wielder of the weapon rolls the number
Therefore, each round, Black Leaf can receive a –2 ac bonus against indicated or higher on the dice, before modifiers, and the attack
an armed attack (her first bonus) and a –1 ac bonus against any hits the target after modifiers, then the attack does double the
attack (her second bonus) or she can receive a –1 ac bonus against normal amount of damage.
an unarmed attack (her first bonus) and a –1 ac bonus against any
attack (her second bonus). Entangle: Any target that the weapon hits may become delayed,
slowed or entangled depending on their hit dice or level compared
In either case, the first bonus does not necessarily have to be used to the proficiency level of the weapon wielder. See Table 6–72 for
against the first incoming attack. She can choose which bonus is details. The target must make a saving throw vs. death ray with a
applied to which attack when the attacks are declared. penalty based on the proficiency of the wielder when first hit in
order to avoid the effect. If this fails, the target is affected but may

89
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
Table 6–80: Entangling Weapons
Level or Hit Dice of Target Saving Throw Bonus None/basic/skilled Expert/master Grand Master
Up to 1 +0 Entangled Entangled Entangled
1+ to 3 +1 Entangled Entangled Entangled
3+ to 6 +2 Slow Entangled Entangled
6+ to 9 +3 Slow Slow Entangled
9+ to 12 +4 Delay Slow Slow
12+ to 16 +5 Delay Delay Slow
16+ or More +5 Delay Delay Delay

Table 6–81: Knockout Weapons


Level or Hit Dice of Target Saving Throw Bonus Basic/skilled Expert/master Grand Master
Up to 1 +0 K/o K/o K/o
1+ to 3 +1 K/o K/o K/o
3+ to 6 +2 Stun K/o K/o
6+ to 9 +3 Stun Stun K/o
9+ to 12 +4 Delay Stun Stun
12+ to 16 +5 Delay Delay Stun
16+ or More +5 Delay Delay Delay

repeat the saving throw each round until they make it, at which the effect. If this fails, the target is affected as normal by the delay,
point they are no longer affected. stun or knock out.

An entangled target cannot attack, cast spells, or move. An enemy who is knocked out will be unconscious for 1d100
rounds before waking up.
Hook: The wielder of a weapon with the hook ability can choose to
try to hook their opponent and trip them instead of attacking for Missile Range: The three numbers given are the short/medium/
damage. The character’s player must announce that a hook attempt long ranges of the missiles that the weapon shoots.
is being made before rolling any dice for the attack. If the attack
hits, the weapon causes only minimum damage and the target must Off-hand: A weapon with this ability does not suffer the normal
make a saving throw vs. paralysis or fall prone. to-hit and proficiency penalties when used in the wielder’s off hand.

Hurl Range: A weapon with a hurl range is one that is not normally Set: The wielder of this weapon may brace it against a charging foe.
thrown, but with great skill and effort can be hurled at an opponent The wielder automatically gains initiative over the charging foe, and
at the short/medium/long ranges shown. if they hit then they do double normal damage.

Such hurling of weapons uses the character’s strength modifier Skewer: If the weapon hits an opponent with the listed number
rather than their dexterity modifier. Because such weapons are not of hit dice (or levels) or less, the opponent may be skewered if the
aerodynamic and do not fly well, opponents who are not surprised attacker so chooses.
by the attack may make a saving throw vs. death ray in order to
take half damage. The attacker must let go of the weapon, and it remains caught in
the opponent for 1d4+4 rounds, doing 1d6 damage each round.
However, the first time in each fight that an opponent has the If the opponent spends a round removing the weapon, they take
weapon thrown at them, they must roll for surprise at normal double damage that round but are then free of the weapon.
chances due to the unexpected nature of the attack.
Strangle: If the wielder of the weapon rolls the number indicated
Knockout: Any target that the weapon hits may become delayed, or higher on the dice, before modifiers, and the attack hits the
stunned or knocked out depending on their hit dice or level com- target after modifiers, then the target of the attack must make an
pared to the proficiency level of the weapon wielder. See table 6–80 immediate saving throw vs. death ray with the listed penalty or
for details. be paralysed and die after 1d6+2 rounds of strangulation. Should
the target be freed from strangulation, they will remain paralysed
The target must make a saving throw vs. death ray with a penalty for 2d6 rounds.
based on the proficiency of the wielder when hit in order to avoid

90
Chapter 6 - Weapon Feats
If the wielder of the weapon does not roll the required numbers A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
but still hits the target, the target is affected as though the weapon at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty
were an entangling weapon with the same saving throw penalty. to armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws. A stunned
character can make a saving throw vs. death ray each round to
Stun: A weapon with the stun ability will stun any opponent it hits shake off the stun.
that is approximately the same size as the wielder of the weapon (or
smaller) unless they make a saving throw vs. death ray. Throw Range: The three numbers given are the short/medium/long
ranges of the missiles that the weapon can be thrown.
Some ranged weapons can only stun opponents at listed ranges.

91
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting

M
any characters in Dark Dungeons can use spells. Humans Each spell casting character is limited in the number of spells they
are the most versatile spell casters. They can become magic- can prepare each day. When first able to cast spells they will prob-
users, clerics, druids or mountebanks and learn to cast ably be limited to only preparing a single 1st level spell per day,
many spells per day. Experienced thieves can learn to use magic- but as they get more experienced they will be able to cast more
user scrolls to cast spells with a good chance of success. And even spells and also more powerful spells. See Chapter 4 – Creating
fighters can – if they take chivalric vows – start casting low level a Character for exactly how many spells of each level a character
clerical or druidic spells. gets based on their class.

Many non-human races use spells too. Some creatures have natural Shamans get the same number of spells as clerics of the same level,
(or magical) abilities that work like spells, but many of the intel- and sorcerers get the same number of spells as magic-users of the
ligent races (humanoid or otherwise) can have shamans or sorcer- same level.
ers who cast spells like clerics and magic-users, although doing so
through innate ability rather than formal training they lack the Acquiring Spells
versatility of human spell casters. Spell casting characters acquire spells in different ways.

The demi-human races are somewhat unusual, in that they have Clerics: Clerics (and fighters who have taken chivalric vows) always
no clerical or shaman spell casters, and with the exception of have access to all clerical spells of levels that they can cast. As part
elves – who can cast spells just like human magic-users, indeed it of the new cleric’s rite of investiture (the details of which will vary
was from elves that humans learned this type of magic – have no from religion to religion and may be full of pomp and ceremony
magic-users or sorcerers either. or be a quiet personal affair) their patron immortal magically alters
the cleric’s life force so that it will accept spells from that immortal.
All these major types of spell caster (clerics, druids, magic-users,
mountebanks, shamans, sorcerers) share a common basis for spell This is a permanent alteration, and costs the immortal some of its
casting, as detailed in this chapter. own life force; so it is not done lightly. The cleric now has access
to all their clerical spells, providing nothing untoward happens to
Spell Levels the immortal who grants them the spells. That sort of thing rarely
All spells have a level. This is a measure of how powerful the spell happens, but it is not unheard of.
is and how difficult it is to prepare. Spells of the same level are
roughly similar in terms of power level, and are interchangeable Since the change done to the cleric has a permanent effect, the cleric
when it comes to spell preparation, providing the caster has access will continue to gain spells even if they split from their church into
to each spell. heresy or even give up their religion altogether. However, depend-
ing on the attitude of the church towards this, it may result in the
Cleric and druid spells range in level from 1–7. Magic-user and cleric being denounced or even hunted down and killed.
elf spells range in level from 1–9. Shamans and sorcerers can only
cast spells from levels 1–6. In extreme cases it is possible for the immortal to personally visit
the offending cleric and remove their clerical powers in the same

93
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Table 7–1: Cleric Spells by Level
1st Level Spells 2nd Level Spells 3rd Level Spells
1) Cure Light Wounds (r) (cm/pa) Bless (r) (pu/co) Continual Light (r) (cr/de)
2) Detect Evil (tr) Find Traps (tr) Cure Blindness (cm)
3) Detect Magic (tr) Hold Person (r) (in/vi) Cure Disease (r) (pu/co)
4) Light (r) (cr/de) Know Alignment (r) (tr/dt) Growth of Animal (vi)
5) Protection from Evil (an) Resist Fire (in) Locate Object (tr)
6) Purify Food and Water (pu) Silence 15’ Radius (de) Remove Curse (r) (ho/dr)
7) Remove Fear (r) (ho/dr) Snake Charm (sy) Speak with Dead (in)
8) Resist Cold (vi) Speak with Animal (sy) Striking (vi)
4th Level Spells 5th Level Spells 6th Level Spells
1) Animate Dead (in) Commune Animate Objects (vi)
2) Create Water (cr) Create Food (cr) Barrier (r) (cr/de)
3) Cure Serious Wounds (r) (cm/pa) Cure Critical Wounds (r) (cm/pa) Create Normal Animals (cr)
4) Dispel Magic (in) Dispel Evil (an) Cureall (cm)
5) Neutralise Poison (r) (pu/co) Insect Plague (sy) Find the Path (tr)
6) Protection from Evil 10’ Radius (an) Quest (r) (dr/ho) Speak with Monsters (r) (sy/an)
7) Speak with Plants (sy) Raise Dead (r) (vi/in) Wind Walker (sy)
8) Sticks to Snakes (vi) Truesight (tr) Word of Recall (ho)
7th Level Spells
1) Earthquake (co)
2) Holy Word (an)
3) Raise Dead Fully (r) (vi/in)
4) Restore (r) (pu/co)
5) Survival (ho)
6) Travel (vi)
7) Wish
8) Wizardry (sy)
an = antipathy, cm = comfort, co = corruption, cr = creation, de = destruction, dr = despair,
dt = deceit, ho = hope, in = inertia, pa = pain, pu = purity, sy = sympathy, tr = truth, vi = vitality

way that they granted them. However, since this also costs the A starting magic-user or elf begins with a free spell book, which
immortal some of its life force in just the same way that providing contains the Read Magic spell and one other first level spell of
the clerical powers in the first place did, it is not done by any but their choice.
the most forgiving immortals. Less forgiving immortals will either
ignore the offending cleric and leave them for their worshippers to A spell book is a very personal item, and the spells written in it are
deal with or simply kill them outright. scribed using an arcane symbolism unique to the individual spell
caster. Each caster needs their own spell book in order to prepare
Forsaking one’s church can be a dangerous business. spells, and no caster can prepare spells from anyone else’s spell book.

Druids: Druids get their spells from nature itself. Like clerics, they Although each magic-user or elf is dependent on their spell book
have access to all druidic spells they can cast, but unlike clerics this to be able to prepare spells, their knowledge of spells does not
access cannot be blocked – since nature itself is never in a situation rely on their book. If they lose their book for any reason or it gets
where it is unable to grant spells. destroyed, they can – given time and effort – make a replacement
of it by writing down all the spells that they know.
Magic-users & Elves: Magic-users and elves do not automati-
cally acquire spells. Each spell they wish to learn must be formally However, because of the personal connection to the book, each
studied and recorded in a spell book. Each spell book can contain magic-user or elf can only have one set of spell books in existence
up to 100 levels of spells, so a powerful magic-user may need up at a time.
to 6 spell books to hold all their spells.

94
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Table 7–2: Druid Spells by Level
1st Level Spells 2nd Level Spells 3rd Level Spells
1) Cure Light Wounds (r) Bless (r) Call Lightning
2) Detect Danger Find Traps Continual Light (r)
3) Detect Evil Heat Metal Cure Blindness
4) Detect Magic Hold Person (r) Cure Disease (r)
5) Faerie Fire Know Alignment (r) Growth of Animal
6) Light (r) Obscure Hold Animal
7) Locate Produce Fire Locate Object
8) Predict Weather Resist Fire Protection from Poison
9) Protection from Evil Silence 15’ Radius Remove Curse (r)
10) Purify Food and Water Snake Charm Speak with Dead
11) Remove Fear Speak with Animal Striking
12) Resist Cold Warp Wood Water Breathing
4th Level Spells 5th Level Spells 6th Level Spells
1) Animate Dead Anti-Plant Shell Animate Objects
2) Control Temperature 10’ Radius Commune Anti-Animal Shell
3) Create Water Control Winds Barrier (r)
4) Cure Serious Wounds (r) Create Food Create Normal Animals
5) Dispel Magic Cure Critical Wounds (r) Cureall
6) Neutralise Poison (r) Dispel Evil Find the Path
7) Plant Door Dissolve (r) Speak with Monsters (r)
8) Protection from Evil 10’ Radius Insect Plague Summon Weather
9) Protection from Lightning Pass Plant Transport Through Plants
10) Speak with Plants Quest (r) Turn Wood
11) Sticks to Snakes Raise Dead (r) Wind Walker
12) Summon Animals Truesight Word of Recall
7th Level Spells
1) Creeping Doom
2) Earthquake
3) Holy Word
4) Metal to Wood
5) Raise Dead Fully (r)
6) Restore (r)
7) Summon Elemental
8) Survival
9) Travel
10) Weather Control
11) Wish
12) Wizardry

Writing a spell into a new spell book makes the old copy obsolete containing the spell. This source can be another magic-user or elf
and useless; so it is not possible to keep a spare set around just in willing to teach the spell to them, or it can be another magic-user’s
case. spell book or even a spell scroll. Although a magic-user or elf can-
not use another caster’s spell book to prepare spells, casting a Read
In order to acquire mastery of a new spell so that it can be written Magic spell on it will allow them to read its contents and use it as
into their spell book the magic-user or elf needs two things. Firstly a research tool in order to learn the spells themselves.
they need time to practise the spell. Secondly they need a source

95
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Table 7–3: Shaman Spells by Level
1st Level Spells 2nd Level Spells 3rd Level Spells
1) Cure Light Wounds (r) Bless (r) Continual Light (r)
2) Detect Magic Hold Person (r) Cure Blindness
3) Light (r) Snake Charm Cure Disease (r)
4) Protection from Evil Speak with Animal Remove Curse (r)
4th Level Spells 5th Level Spells 6th Level Spells
1) Cure Serious Wounds (r) Create Food Cureall
2) Dispel Magic Cure Critical Wounds (r) Find the Path
3) Neutralise Poison (r) Dispel Evil Speak with Monsters (r)
4) Speak with Plants Insect Plague Word of Recall

It is far easier (and usually cheaper) to be taught spells than to how to prepare a new spell that they weren’t previously able to
research them, although if no teacher is available then research is prepare.
always an option for a desperate magic-user or elf.
Spell Domains & Types
Developer Commentary Clerics: Clerical magic is based on fourteen divine principles or
In the original game that Dark Dungeons emulates, magic-users and domains. These are arranged in seven pairs of opposing principles,
elves learned new spells by acquiring spell books or scrolls contain- as follows:
ing spells they did not already know, and copying them from there.
Creation & Destruction
This caused a problem in adventures, since the spell book of an enemy Truth & Deceit
magic-user would be worth a fortune and easily the most valuable Sympathy & Antipathy
piece of loot gained. Hope & Despair
Vitality & Inertia
Not only that, but it meant that magic-users and elves acquired new Purity & Corruption
spells far too easily. Every time the Game Master placed an antagonist Comfort & Pain
spell caster, they would have to choose the spells for that caster very
carefully because every spell in the caster’s book would be one that Each clerical spell belongs to one of the fourteen domains, and if
player magic-users would be able to copy once the caster was defeated. the spell is reversible then its reversed form belongs to the opposite
domain to the normal form.
When writing Dark Dungeons, I replaced this rule with my own
house rule (one of the few proper house rules that I put in the game) Each immortal is associated with between one and three of these
whereby learning new spells used the same rules as learning new domains (although never with a pair of opposed domains), and
weapon feats. clerics invested by that immortal will consider those domains to
be favoured.
This served two purposes. Firstly it freed up antagonist spell casters
to have any spell the Game Master wants them to have without The domains opposite to those of the cleric’s patron are considered
worrying that the players will recover those spells from their spell to be opposed. When preparing spells, clerics may prepare spells
book; and secondly it gave spell casters something to spend money from favoured domains as if those spells were one level lower (with
on and something to do during down-time while other characters a minimum of level 1), but must prepare spells from opposed
were learning more weapon feats. domains as if those spells were one level higher (with a maximum
of level 7).

Shamans: Shamans are granted their spells either by an immortal Chevaliers: Although chevaliers get their spells from patron im-
or by nature, depending on the individual shaman and their race mortals just like clerics do, their weaker link to their patron means
and religion. Therefore they follow exactly the same rules as either that the patron’s association with particular spheres is less promi-
clerics or druids. nent.

Sorcerers: Sorcerers are able to use magic via a natural talent. Al- Chevaliers do not have favoured or opposed domains prepare all
though they prepare spells in the same way as magic-users – and spells of a given level with equal ease regardless of the domain of
all sorcerer spells are also magic-user spells – they are able to do those spells.
so without the aid of spell books or any kind of formal training.
However, many chevaliers make a point of avoiding casting spells
A sorcerer’s spell casting is simply intuitive. Every so often, as they from domains that their patron is opposed to anyway, on principle.
get more experienced, they will simply gain an insight and “know”

96
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Table 7–4: Magic-user and Elf Spells by Level
1st Level Spells 2nd Level Spells 3rd Level Spells
1) Analyse (en) Continual Light (r) (en) Clairvoyance (sp)
2) Charm Person (sp) Detect Evil (sp) Create Air (ma)
3) Detect Magic (en) Detect Invisible (ma) Dispel Magic (ep)
4) Floating Disc (ma) Entangle (ma) Fireball (en)
5) Hold Portal (ep) ESP (r) (sp) Fly (ma)
6) Light (r) (en) Invisibility (ep) Haste (r) (en)
7) Magic Missile (ma) Knock (ep) Hold Person (r) (sp)
8) Protection from Evil (sp) Levitate (en) Infravision (en)
9) Read Languages (sp) Locate Object (ma) Invisibility 10’ Radius (ep)
10) Read Magic (sp) Mirror Image (ep) Lightning Bolt (en)
11) Shield (ma) Phantasmal Force (en) Protection from Evil 10’ Radius (sp)
12) Sleep (ep) Web (ma) Protection from Normal Missiles (ep)
13) Ventriloquism (ep) Wizard Lock (ep) Water Breathing (ep)
4th Level Spells 5th Level Spells 6th Level Spells
1) Charm Monster (sp) Animate Dead (en) Anti-Magic Shell (en)
2) Clothform (ma) Cloudkill (ep) Death Spell (sp)
3) Confusion (ep) Conjure Elemental (en) Disintegrate (en)
4) Dimension Door (en) Contact Outer Plane (sp) Geas (r) (sp)
5) Growth of Plants (r) (ma) Dissolve (r) (ma) Invisible Stalker (sp)
6) Hallucinatory Terrain (ep) Feeblemind (sp) Lower Water (ma)
7) Ice Storm / Wall of Ice (en) Hold Monster (r) (sp) Move Earth (ma)
8) Massmorph (ep) Magic Jar (sp) Projected Image (en)
9) Polymorph Other (ma) Passwall (ep) Reincarnation (sp)
10) Polymorph Self (ma) Telekinesis (en) Stone to Flesh (r) (ep)
11) Remove Curse (r) (sp) Teleport (en) Stoneform (ma)
12) Wall of Fire (en) Wall of Stone (ma) Wall of Iron (ma)
13) Wizard Eye (sp) Woodform (ma) Weather Control (ep)
7th Level Spells 8th Level Spells 9th Level Spells
1) Charm Plant (sp) Clone (sp) Contingency (en)
2) Create Normal Monsters (ma) Create Magical Monsters (ma) Create Any Monster (ma)
3) Delayed Blast Fireball (en) Dance (sp) Cureall (sp)
4) Ironform (ma) Explosive Cloud (ep) Gate (r) (sp)
5) Lore (sp) Force Field (en) Immunity (ep)
6) Magic Door (r) (ep) Mass Charm (r) (sp) Maze (sp)
7) Mass Invisibility (r) (ep) Mind Barrier (r) (sp) Meteor Swarm (en)
8) Power Word Stun (en) Permanence (en) Power Word Kill (en)
9) Reverse Gravity (ep) Polymorph Any Object (ma) Prismatic Wall (ep)
10) Statue (ma) Power Word Blind (ma) Shapechange (ma)
11) Summon Object (ep) Steelform (ma) Survival (ma)
12) Sword (en) Symbol (ep) Timestop (ep)
13) Teleport any Object (en) Travel (ep) Wish
en = energy, ep = entropy, ma = matter, sp = spirit

97
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Table 7–5: Sorcerer Spells by Level
1st Level Spells 2nd Level Spells 3rd Level Spells
1) Detect Magic Continual Light (r) Clairvoyance
2) Light (r) Detect Evil Dispel Magic
3) Protection from Evil Detect Invisible Fireball
4) Read Languages Invisibility Fly
5) Read Magic Levitate Lightning Bolt
6) Sleep Web Water Breathing
4th Level Spells 5th Level Spells 6th Level Spells
1) Charm Monster Animate Dead Death Spell
2) Growth of Plants (r) Cloudkill Move Earth
3) Ice Storm / Wall of Ice Dissolve (r) Projected Image
4) Massmorph Hold Monster (r) Reincarnation
5) Remove Curse (r) Passwall Stone to Flesh (r)
6) Wall of Fire Wall of Stone Wall of Iron

Druids: Because druids get their spells directly from nature and level lower (with a minimum of level 1), but must treat spells of
have no connection with any immortal patron, they do not have their opposed type as if those spells were one level higher (with a
favoured or opposed domains. They can prepare all spells of a given maximum of level 9).
level with equal ease.
Mountebanks: The weaker magic of mountebanks means that
Magic-users & Elves: Although each magic-user spell is different, they cannot specialise in a specific type of spell. Spells of all types
they can be split into four distinct types based upon the way they are equally hard for them to cast.
are cast and the aspects of the world that they manipulate.
Shamans: Because shamans can get their spells either from a patron
Much like clerical domains, these types are in opposed pairs: immortal or from nature, they are treated as either clerics or druids.
It is simplest to assume that they do not have favoured or opposed
Energy & Entropy domains and that they cast all spell with equal ease.
Matter & Spirit
However, if your campaign includes a specific immortal patron for
While many magic-users and elves take a general approach to magic, a race then their shamans may use that immortal’s favoured and
some specialise in one of the four types. opposed domains.

This specialisation is a result of being apprenticed to a specialist Sorcerers: The lack of formal magical training for sorcerers means
of the same type, so while a player may freely choose the type of that although they are able to cast spells as well as magic-users or
specialisation (if any) that their character has, the character them- elves, they do not specialise in particular types of spell. Sorcerers
selves may or may not have had a choice. cast all spells at their default level.

The four types of specialists are generally known by different names,


based on their area of speciality: Developer Commentary
The original edition of Dark Dungeons (and the original game that
◊ Conjurers are energy specialists. it emulates) do not have spell domains and types. These are a house
◊ Enchanters are spirit specialists. rule that I have been using in my own games since the early ‘90s.
◊ Thaumaturges are matter specialists.
◊ Warlocks are entropy specialists. The idea was originally inspired by the specialist magic-users and
◊ Wizards are unspecialised magic-users. clerical domains that I’d heard existed in the advanced version of
the original game, but (not possessing that advanced version at the
The type of spell that a magic-user or elf specialises in is known time, only having had it briefly described to me by someone who
as their favoured type, and the opposite type to the one that they had played it) I created my own mechanical implementation of the
specialise in is known as their opposed type. idea rather than copying the one that the advanced version used.

When both learning and preparing spells, magic-users and elves


may treat spells of their favoured type as if those spells were one

98
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting

Preparing Spells Reversible Spells


Spells are complicated affairs involving powerful magical energies, Some spells are reversible. This means that the spell can be cast in
and cannot simply be cast on a whim. one of two ways, usually with the opposite effect. For example, a
Raise Dead spell is normally cast to bring someone back from the
Before a spell can be cast, it must be prepared by the caster. When dead, but it can be reversed and cast as Finger of Death in order
preparing a spell, a caster gathers the magical energy and shapes to kill someone.
it into the spell that they wish to cast, leaving it primed and ready
to be used. Clerics, druids and shamans always prepare their spells in their
normal form, and can choose to either use them in that form or
Then at the time of casting the spell caster says the final words and reverse them at the time of casting. Although any cleric can cast
makes the final gestures, which set the parameters for the spell any clerical spell, some religions may discourage or even prohibit
effect and release the energy. the reversal of some spells.

This final release of the spell’s energy is known as casting the spell. A reversible spell in a cleric’s favoured domain will be in an opposed
domain when reversed, and vice versa.
On a typical day, and adventuring spell caster will prepare all the
spells they can first thing in the morning after waking up, and then In this case, if the cleric has two choices.
cast them at various times during the day – often in the middle
of combat. Firstly, they may prepare the spell in a spell slot one level lower
than normal (with a minimum of first) as with any other favoured
Since each extra spell that is prepared adds more magical energy domain spell. In this case, they may only cast the favoured form of
to the caster’s control, and higher level spells require more precise the spell (whether that is the “normal” form or the reversed form).
control than lower level ones; the number of spells a caster can
have prepared at one time is limited by their experience level, as Alternatively, they may prepare the spell in a spell slot one level
listed in the various tables in Chapter 4 – Creating a Character. higher than normal (with a maximum of seventh) as with any other
opposed domain spell. In this case they may choose to cast either
Once a spell has been prepared, it will not fade away. Prepared spells form of the spell at the time of casting.
can be kept primed for days or even weeks at a time before being
cast; although a caster can dissipate the magical energy of a spell Example: Elfstar has vitality as a favoured domain, and therefore
at any time in order to free up the spell slot that it was taking up. has inertia as an opposed domain.
Preparing spells requires a clear head, and must be done directly Because Hold Person is an inertia spell, Elfstar prepares it as if it
after a good night’s sleep, and before any strenuous or stressful were third level rather than second level, and it takes a third level
activity has happened. spell slot if she prepares it in such a way, she can choose to cast either
the normal (Hold Person) or reversed (Free Person) form of the spell
The character must then spend an hour performing meditation at the time of casting.
and rites (involving their spell book if they use one) in relatively
quiet surroundings. However, because it is a reversible spell, the reversed form is a vitality
spell. Elfstar can prepare the spell in a first level spell slot, but if she
Preparing spells is possible in the bustle of a campsite or shared does this she must cast the reversed (Free Person) form of the spell
room, and the caster can wave away interruptions without disturb- and cannot cast the normal (Hold Person) form.
ing their preparation, but preparation is not possible in a crowded
marketplace or in the middle of a fight. Similarly, Raise Dead is a vitality spell so Elfstar can prepare it as
if it were fourth level rather than fifth level. However, if she does
At the end of the hour, any spare spell slots the character has that this then she must cast the normal (Raise Dead) version of the spell
don’t already contain prepared spells can be filled with the charac- rather than the reversed (Finger of Death) form.
ter’s choice of spells from those that they know (of the appropriate
level). If she chose to prepare the spell in a sixth level spell slot, she would be
able to cast either the normal (Raise Dead) or the reversed (Finger
If the caster already has a prepared spell in a particular spell slot of Death) form of the spell.
then its magical energy may be harmlessly dissipated in order to
make room for a new spell.
Magic-users, elves and sorcerers must decide at the time of prepara-
If a spell caster expects to cast a spell twice during a day, they must tion whether they wish to prepare the normal or reversed form of
prepare it twice, taking up two slots of the appropriate level. the spell. Although they can, of course, prepare both forms of the
same spell if they have two or more spell slots of an appropriate level.

99
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Magic-user spells that are reversible retain their type in their re- In cases where the multiple castings of the same spell could apply
versed form. Therefore a specialist magic-user can prepare either a to the target without conflict (such as having two active Quest
normal or reversed form of a favoured spell in a spell slot one level spells at the same time, or being simultaneously charmed by two
lower than normal (with a minimum of first level) and must prepare different casters and believing both of them to be friends) both
either a normal or reversed form of an opposed spell in a spell slot spells stays active.
one level higher than normal (with a maximum of ninth level).
Alphabetical Spell List
Casting Spells
Unless the spell description explicitly says otherwise, any spell can Analyse
be cast in a character’s turn in combat as a normal action. Energy
Magic-User 1, Elf 1
However, casting a spell requires precise gestures and speaking. Target: one magic item
Therefore a spell caster must have at least one hand free and must Range: special (see below)
be able to speak in order to be able to cast a spell. Duration: instant
To use an Analyse spell, the caster must imitate using the item. This
If you wish to cast a spell, you must announce what spell you are includes wearing armour (which won’t disrupt this spell), wielding
casting at the beginning of the round before initiative is rolled. If weapons, wetting one’s lips with a potion, and so on.
you then take any damage before your initiative, your spell casting
will be disrupted and you will lose the prepared spell but it will Any curses or other ill effects of the item may affect the caster.
dissipate without effect.
The caster then has a chance equal to 15% plus 5% per level to
When casting a spell that targets creatures or objects other than identify one magical property of the item and how to activate it
yourself, you must be able to see those targets. However, you can (or that the item has no more unrevealed magical properties). If
hit unseen or invisible targets with area effect spells even if you can’t an item has more than one magical property, then the one that is
see them (and even if you don’t know they are there). revealed will be one that the caster does not already know about.

Some spells, such as Cause Light Wounds (the reverse form of Cure The caster does find out command words or other instructions
Light Wounds) require the caster to make a successful melee attack needed to activate the power(s) that are discovered on the item, but
in order to touch the target in order for the spell to work. does not discover how many charges each power has.

This attack does not require a separate action in combat – it can Animate Dead
be performed as part of the cast spell action. Energy, Inertia
Cleric 4, Druid 4, Magic-User 5, Elf 5, Sorcerer 5
The attack must be done with bare hands and does not use the Target: one or more corpses
unarmed strikes weapon feats. Touching someone with a spell is Range: 60’
very different from striking someone in melee. Duration: permanent
When this spell is cast, a number of dead bodies or skeletons within
However, if the attack misses the spell is not wasted. The spell that range will be animated and will become zombies or skeletons re-
the caster was attacking with will stay “primed” for ten minutes or spectively.
until they cast another spell. Therefore the caster can try repeatedly
to touch the same (or a different) target. These additional attempts A created skeleton will have the same number of hit dice as the race
to touch a target each require an attack action. of the original creature had (not including extra hit dice gained
from class levels). A created zombie will have one more hit dice
Saving Throws than the original creature had (not including extra hit dice gained
Most spells that have an effect on others allow their targets to roll from class levels).
a saving throw in order to lessen or negate the effect. Unless the
specific spell description mentions otherwise, all such saving throws Therefore, a human or demi-human skeleton will always have 1
are vs. spells. If a spell does not mention giving a saving throw, then hit die, and a human or demi-human zombie will always have 2
none should be given. hit dice.

Conflicting Spells Each casting of the spell will create a total number of hit dice of un-
When different spells are cast on the same target, each of the spells dead equal to the caster’s level, starting with those nearest the caster.
has its normal effect for its duration. However, multiple castings of
the same spell (or spells that are the same except in terms of area See Chapter 18 – Monsters for more details about skeletons
of effect – such as Protection from Evil and Protection from Evil 10’ and zombies.
Radius) do not stack. The target gets the effect only once.

100
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
The animated undead will mindlessly obey the commands of the Anti-Magic Shell
caster, and there is no limit to the total number of undead that the Energy
caster can create and control using multiple castings of this spell. Magic-User 6, Elf 6
Target: caster
The zombies and skeletons created by this spell can be turned or Range: personal
destroyed normally. Unless the caster of this spell is an immortal, Duration: 2 hours
they are also vulnerable the Dispel Magic spell. When this spell is cast, it creates an invisible shell around the
caster that prevents the passage of magic in either direction. For
Animate Objects the duration of the spell, the caster cannot be affected by any spell
Vitality or other magical effect except those that they cast themselves; but
Cleric 6, Druid 6 also cannot affect anything other than themselves with their magic;
Target: one or more objects since magic cannot pass through the shell in either direction.
Range: 60’
Duration: 1 hour The shell cannot be bypassed by any other magic except a Wish
This spell will animate a number of non-magical objects, giving spell, which can be used to destroy it.
them the capability of movement and causing them to mindlessly
obey the caster’s commands, including being made to attack oppo- The caster can cancel the shell at any time before the duration has
nents. Each casting of the spell will animate one large object (such expired, but if they do so then they can’t put it back without cast-
as a bed or tree), two medium objects (such as a table or chest), ing this spell again.
four small objects (such as chairs), or eight tiny objects (such as
candlesticks). Two objects of a size smaller can be substitutes for Anti-Pant Shell
one object of any given size – for example a single casting can ani- Druid 5
mate a medium table, two small chairs and four tiny candlesticks. Target: caster
Range: personal
This spell can be used to animate normally static plants, even if they Duration: 1 rnd/level
are alive; but cannot be used to animate or control the movement This spell prevents any plants from coming within 1” of the caster’s
of normally mobile creatures unless they are dead. body, and therefore prevents plant-like monsters from physically
attacking the caster. This protection also prevents the caster from
A dead body animated by this spell is not undead and uses the physically attacking plants or plant-like monsters for the duration.
statistics of an animated object of the appropriate size and not
those of a zombie. Since the protection is only against the plants themselves, it does
not prevent such things as plants shooting spores at the caster.
See Chapter 18 – Monsters for details and abilities of animated Similarly, it does not prevent the caster from using missile weapons
objects of different sizes. or spells against plants – unless those spells have a touch range.

Anti-Animal Shell While using this spell, the caster can push their way through thorny
Druid 6 and tangled undergrowth without danger, leaving a trail that oth-
Target: caster ers can follow.
Range: personal
Duration: 10 mins/level Barrier (r)
This spell prevents any animals from coming within 1” of the cast- Creation/Destruction
er’s body, and therefore prevents them from physically attacking Cleric 6, Druid 6
the caster. This protection also prevents the caster from physically Target: 15’ radius ring
attacking animals for the duration. Range: 60’
Duration: 2 hours
Since the protection is only against the animals themselves, it does When this spell is cast, a ring shaped wall of spinning and whirling
not prevent such things as animals throwing things at the caster hammers appears up to 15’ in radius and up to 30’ tall.
or spitting at the caster. Similarly, it does not prevent the caster
from using missile weapons or spells against animals – unless those The barrier must be created where there is room for it – it cannot
spells have a touch range. be created on top of creatures or objects. Once it is in place, any
creature passing through it takes 7d10 damage from the hammers.

Reverse: Remove Barrier will destroy the effect created by any one
of the following spells: Barrier, Clothform, Wall of Ice, Wall of Fire,
Wall of Stone, Woodform.

101
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Bless (r) 19 Int = save every 3 hours
Purity/corruption 20 Int = save every hour
Cleric 2, Druid 2, Shaman 2 21–29 Int = save every 10 minutes
Target: all allies in a 20’ radius 30+ Int = save every round
Range: 60’
Duration: 1 hour If the caster behaves in an overtly hostile manner to the charmed
When this spell is cast, all friendly creatures in the area of effect gain target, such as attacking it or ordering others to attack it, then the
a +1 bonus to attack, damage, and morale rolls for the duration, charm is broken.
providing they are not already engaged in combat.
If an immortal is charmed using this spell, they may make a save
Reverse: Blight gives each enemy in the area a –1 penalty to attack, every 10 minutes even if they have less than 21 Int.
damage and morale rolls for the duration providing they are not
already in combat. Each of these enemies may make a saving throw Charm Person
vs. spells to avoid the effect. Spirit
Magic-User 1, Elf 1
Call Lightning Target: one or more humanoids
Druid 3 Range: 120’
Target: one or more 10’ radius bolts Duration: special
Range: 360’ When this spell is cast, one humanoid creature will imagine the
Duration: 10 mins/level caster to be their best friend, and treat them accordingly. It does
This spell can only be used outside when there is stormy weather. not make them fanatically loyal and will not make them attack
Once per 10 minutes (60 rounds) the caster may direct the storm their other friends.
to strike the area of their choosing (within range) with lightning.
All creatures within 10’ of the strike take 8d6 points of electrical This spell works on any living humanoid, but not on undead or
damage, but can make a saving throw vs. spells to take half damage. non-living creatures such as golems and not on non-humanoid
creatures. The target gets a saving throw vs. spells to avoid the effect.
Charm Monster
Spirit If the caster behaves in an overtly hostile manner to the charmed
Magic-User 4, Elf 4, Sorcerer 4 target, such as attacking it or ordering others to attack it, then the
Target: one or more creatures charm is broken.
Range: 120’
Duration: special If the target fails its saving throw, then they get another one peri-
When this spell is cast, one or more creatures will imagine the odically to throw off the charm effect. The frequency of the saving
caster to be their best friend, and treat them accordingly. It does throw is based on the target’s intelligence:
not make them fanatically loyal and will not make them attack
their other friends. 0 Int = save every 120 days
1 Int = save every 90 days
This spell works on any living creature, but not on undead or non- 2 Int = save every 60 days
living creatures such as golems. 3 Int = save every 45 days
4–5 Int = save every 30 days
If cast on creatures with 3 hit dice or fewer, it will affect 3d6 targets, 6–8 Int = save every 15 days
otherwise it will affect only a single target. In either case, all targets 9–12 Int = save every 7 days
get a saving throw vs. spells to avoid the effect. 13–15 Int = save every 3 days
16–17 Int = save every 24 hours
If a target fails its saving throw, then it gets another one periodically 18 Int = save every 8 hours
to throw off the charm effect. The frequency of the saving throw 19 Int = save every 3 hours
is based on the creature’s intelligence: 20 Int = save every hour
21–29 Int = save every 10 minutes
0 Int = save every 120 days 30+ Int = save every round
1 Int = save every 90 days
2 Int = save every 60 days If an immortal is charmed using this spell, they may make a save
3 Int = save every 45 days every 10 minutes even if they have less than 21 Int.
4–5 Int = save every 30 days
6–8 Int = save every 15 days
9–12 Int = save every 7 days
13–15 Int = save every 3 days
16–17 Int = save every 24 hours
18 Int = save every 8 hours

102
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Charm Plant The creatures affected by this spell do not get a saving throw and
Spirit are not aware that they are affected by it. The sight is temporarily
Magic-User 7, Elf 7 blocked if the creature goes out of range or there is more than two
Target: one or more plants feet or rock (or a thin coating of lead) between the creature and
Range: 120’ the caster.
Duration: special
When this spell is cast, one plant or plant-like creature will imagine Clone
the caster to be their best friend, and treat them accordingly. In the Spirit
case of plant-like creatures, it does not make them fanatically loyal Magic-User 8, Elf 8
and will not make them attack their other friends. Target: one creature
Range: 10’
This spell will affect one tree or plant-like creature, six medium sized Duration: permanent
bushes, or 24 smaller plants. If the target is a plant-like creature This spell is cast on a piece of flesh that has been taken from a
such as a treant, it gets a saving throw vs. spells to avoid the effect. single living or dead creature (but not a non-living or undead one).
Normal plants get no save.
The caster must place the flesh in a vat of alchemical reagents and
Normal plants affected by this spell will understand the commands let it slowly grow into a copy of the original creature.
of the caster and mindlessly carry them out, such as entangling or
attacking creatures that come near them. The difficulty (and effect) of making a clone depends on the type
of creature cloned.
On normal plants, the effect lasts for 6 months.
Human or Demi-human: The process takes a week per level of the
If an intelligent plant-like target fails its saving throw, then it gets target, and each such week costs 5,000gp in reagents and compo-
another one periodically to throw off the charm effect. The fre- nents. The piece of flesh used must be at least one pound in weight.
quency of the saving throw is based on the target’s intelligence:
When the clone is fully grown, it wakes up and has the memories,
0 Int = save every 120 days personality and abilities (including level) that the original had at
1 Int = save every 90 days the time the flesh was taken. Note that if the target is alive then
2 Int = save every 60 days they will have gained more memories – and possibly more experi-
3 Int = save every 45 days ence – since that time. The clone will not have these.
4–5 Int = save every 30 days
6–8 Int = save every 15 days If the original is still alive when the clone wakes up (or if the original
9–12 Int = save every 7 days is raised from the dead after this time) and is on the same plane
13–15 Int = save every 3 days (and within the same celestial sphere, if on the prime material plane)
16–17 Int = save every 24 hours as the clone, a mind link is immediately established between the
18 Int = save every 8 hours two of them. They are both aware of each other’s existence and
19 Int = save every 3 hours emotions. Further, any damage taken by one of them is also taken
20 Int = save every hour by the other, although the other can make a saving throw vs. spells
21–29 Int = save every 10 minutes to only take half damage.
30+ Int = save every round
The clone will also immediately become obsessed with destroying
If the caster behaves in an overtly hostile manner to a charmed their original, even at the cost of their own life.
plant-like creature, such as attacking it or ordering others to attack
it, then the charm is broken. This mind link remains even if the original and clone are separated
onto different planes or celestial spheres, but if either one dies then
Clairvoyance it will be cancelled. The clone cannot be raised or reincarnated, but
Spirit if the original was the one that died then raising or resurrecting
Magic-User 3, Elf 3, Sorcerer 3 them will cause the mind-link to re-establish itself.
Target: one creature at a time
Range: 60’ After the pair have been mind-linked for a number of days equal to
Duration: 2 hours the level of the caster of the clone spell, and both are still alive, the
This spell allows the caster to see through the eyes of any one crea- clone will become completely insane. The original will permanently
ture within range. Once the spell is cast, it takes 10 minutes to lose a point of intelligence and a point of wisdom when this hap-
start seeing through the eyes of a creature, but then once the con- pens, and has a 5% chance (not cumulative) per day of also going
nection is established, the caster can change to a different creature insane. Once both are insane, they will both die a week later. The
(within range of the caster and within sight of the current creature) clone cannot be raised or reincarnated, and the original can only
instantly. The caster can keep changing creatures until the spell be raised by a Wish spell.
duration runs out.

103
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
A human or demi-human can only have one clone at a time. Any If the caster chooses to leave one or more ends of the cloth un-
attempt to make a second clone will fail. However, if the original finished, with loose thread hanging from it, then a second casting
is dead, the clone is effectively an independent being, and can be of this spell can add to the existing cloth at that edge rather than
cloned (or raised) itself. Should the original be raised, all clones creating a separate piece.
will be mind-linked as above.
The cloth comes out of the caster’s hands when created and falls in
If a clone is made of the preserved flesh of a person who has become a heap on the floor. The caster cannot use this spell to create cloth
an immortal, it will retain the personality that the immortal had over targets’ heads or create cloth attached to (or tying) anything.
during their mortal life, but not their abilities or memories. Instead
it will be a 1st level character of the immortal’s old class with no Cloudkill
memories (and no knowledge that they are connected with the Entropy
immortal in any way). Magic-User 5, Elf 5, Sorcerer 5
Target: 15’ radius
Other Creatures: If the clone is made from another living creature Range: 1’
other than a human or demi-human, the process takes a week per Duration: 1 hour
hit die of the target, and each such week costs 500gp in reagents and This spell creates a 15’ radius and 20’ tall cloud of poisonous gas,
components. The piece of flesh used must be at least one percent the closest edge of which must be within 1’ of the caster. The gas is
of the weight of the original creature. dense enough to be visible, but does not block sight. If cast within
an enclosed space, the cloud may be smaller than the dimensions
Once the clone wakes up, it will unfailingly obey the commands of above. It will not expand to fill the same volume.
its creator, and the caster can mentally command the clone when
within 10’ of it. The cloud moves in a straight line away from the caster at a rate
of 20’ per round, although it is also affected by winds. It is heavier
The clone will begin with only 50% of the physical abilities (hit than air, so will sink through holes or into pits, and will go around
points, damage caused by attacks, strength, size) of the original rather than over obstacles. If the cloud moves into thick vegetation
creature, and will have a 50% chance to possess each special abil- it will dissipate.
ity (except spell like abilities) that the original creature possessed.
The poisonous nature of the cloud means that all living (but not
Each week after waking, the clone continues to grow. The physical undead or non-living) creatures within it take 1 point of damage
abilities of the clone increase by a further 5%, and it can re-roll for per round. Living creatures with fewer than 5 hit dice must also
any special abilities (including spell like abilities) that it has not yet make a saving throw vs. poison each round or be killed.
acquired, until 8 weeks have passed (at which time it will have 90%
of the physical attributes of the original and will have had 8 chances Commune
to re-roll for special abilities). At this point it stops growing. Cleric 5, Druid 5
Target: caster
The clone does not have any special connection to the original crea- Range: personal
ture, although it does count as an enchanted creature for purposes Duration: 30 minutes
of Protection from Evil and Dispel Evil spells, and can be destroyed This spell can be cast only once per week. The caster uses it to ask
by a Dispel Magic spell (with normal chances of failure against the three questions of their patron immortal that can be answered
Clone spell). with a “yes” or a “no”. The immortal will answer these questions
to the best of their ability, which will almost always be sufficient
Clothform to answer correctly. The immortal may lie if they have a reason to
Matter mislead the caster, and on very rare occasions may be forced to
Magic-User 4, Elf 4 answer “unknown”.
Target: none
Range: touch If the immortal is more than 10 planar boundaries away from
Damage: instant the caster, or is in a different celestial sphere, this spell will fail to
When this spell is cast, it creates a single piece of un-worked and contact them.
un-dyed linen up to 30’x30’ in size.
If this spell is cast on one particular day of the year (which will
If the caster makes a dexterity check (with an appropriate craft vary from religion to religion), the caster will get to ask 6 questions
skill) then the cloth can be created in a more finished form, such instead of the usual 3.
as with seams or twisted into 60’ of rope. The Game Master must
decide on any penalties to the caster’s effective dexterity based on When cast by an immortal, this spell allows a full telepathic con-
the complexity of what is desired. versation with another immortal of their choice (providing that
immortal is no more than 10 planes away and is in the same celes-
The cloth is non-magical once created, and cannot be dispelled. tial sphere) rather than just a limited number of yes/no questions

104
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Confusion Contact Outer Plane
Entropy Spirit
Magic-User 4, Elf 4 Magic-User 5, Elf 5
Target: 3d6 creatures in a 30’ radius Target: caster
Range: 120’ Range: personal
Duration: 12 rounds Duration: special
When this spell is cast, 3d6 creatures within 30’ of the target point This spell contacts an immortal or other powerful entity on another
of the spell, starting with the closest, will be both confused and plane and asks it questions. It can only be cast once per month.
enraged, wishing to lash out at enemies but being unable to de- It is a risky procedure, since the immortal is under no obligation
termine who those enemies are. Creatures with 2 hit dice or fewer to the caster and may not appreciate being disturbed. The caster
will be automatically affected, but creatures with more than 2 hit may not get accurate answers and may be driven insane by the
dice may make a saving throw vs. spells each round to shake off mental contact.
the effect. Creatures who leave the area automatically shake off the
effect, and new creatures who enter the area are unaffected. The caster must choose which plane to direct their questions
to – further planes allow more questions but also increase the
Confused creatures must roll 2d6 each round to see how they are chance of insanity, as shown in Table 7–6. The chance of insanity
affected: must be checked first before any questions are asked.

◊ 2–5 – attack the caster’s party Table 7–6: Contact Outer Plane


◊ 6–8 – do nothing but shout and scream Distance / Chance Of...
◊ 9–12 – attack the creature’s own party number of
Questions Correct False Insanity
Conjure Elemental
1/3 25% 75% 5%
Energy
Magic-User 5, Elf 5 2/4 30% 70% 10%
Target: none 3/5 35% 65% 15%
Range: 240’ 4/6 40% 60% 20%
Duration: concentration
When this spell is cast, a 16 hit dice elemental (see Chapter 18 – 5/7 50% 50% 25%
Monsters for statistics) will appear within 240’ of the caster. 6/8 60% 40% 30%
7/9 70% 30% 35%
If this spell is cast more than once during the same day, a different
8/10 80% 20% 40%
type of elemental must be summoned each time.
9/11 90% 10% 45%
While the caster controls the elemental, they can make it do any- 10/12 95% 5% 50%
thing it is capable of doing, including fighting to the death on the
caster’s behalf. The caster can also send the controlled elemental For each level of the caster above level 20, the chance of insanity
home. is reduced by 5%. If the caster is driven insane, no questions are
answered and in will take a number of weeks equal to the number
The caster must concentrate to keep controlling the elemental, and of questions asked for them to recover.
cannot fight or cast other spells or move at more than half normal
speed. If the caster’s concentration is broken, either because they If the caster is not driven insane, they may ask a number of ques-
did one of those things or they take damage, then the control is tions equal to the distance to the plane contacted plus two, with the
broken. listed chance of each question being answered correctly. Incorrect
answers may be because the immortal does not know the answer,
Once the control is broken, it cannot be re-established. The el- or may be simply because the immortal is unhappy about being
emental will try to kill the caster who summoned it, but will not contacted and is lying to the caster.
commit suicide doing so. If it looks to be a hopeless fight the
elemental will flee instead. When cast by an immortal, this spell allows a full telepathic con-
versation with another immortal of their choice (providing that
A summoned elemental is blocked by a Protection from Evil, and immortal is no more than 10 planes away and is in the same celestial
can be sent home by a Dispel Magic or a Dispel Evil. sphere) rather than just a limited number of questions, and the
caster has no chance of going insane.

105
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Contingency on will not block out the light. However, any amount of lead or 6”
Energy of stone will block the area.
Magic-User 9, Elf 9
Target: one creature, object or place If this spell is cast on a creature’s eyes, that creature must make a
Range: touch saving throw vs. spells or be blinded until the spell is cancelled.
Duration: special
When this spell is cast, the caster also casts a second spell at the See Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving for details about how differ-
same time. The second spell must be 4th level or lower, and must ent types of natural and magical light and darkness interact.
not be a spell that causes damage.
Reverse: Continual Darkness causes the area within 30’ of the tar-
The second spell does not go off immediately. Instead, the caster get point to be absolutely dark, with not even the heat vision of
describes a situation upon which the second spell will activate, and some demi-humans or the dark vision of some monsters able to
the spell remains dormant until that time. penetrate it.

If the contingent spell has parameters that need to be decided at This spell creates ambient darkness rather than darkness radiated
the time of casting, they must be decided at the time the Contin- from a centre point, so covering the object that the spell was cast
gency is set. on will not block the darkness. However, any amount of lead or 6”
of stone will block the area.
When the situation comes about, the spell triggers automatically
and immediately. This may interrupt the action that caused the If this spell is cast on a creature’s eyes, that creature must make a
Contingency to apply. saving throw vs. spells or be blinded until the spell is cancelled.

A Contingency will last until discharged, and each creature or object See Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving for details about how differ-
can only have a single Contingency active on it at any time. Casting ent types of natural and magical light and darkness interact.
a second Contingency dissipates the first. A waiting Contingency
cannot be dispelled, but if the contingent spell has a duration it Control Temperature 10’ Radius
can be dispelled normally once it has activated. Druid 4
Target: 10’
Target: radius
Example: Aloysius casts a Contingency on himself with a Dimen- Range: personal
sion Door spell setting the following condition: “if I am about to be Duration: mins/level
Duration: 10
dealt a blow that would knock me unconscious, Dimension Door This spell allows the caster to alter the air temperature within 10’
me one hundred feet to the left of my position, or to the nearest open of themselves.
space to that point.”
The spell will protect the caster and all around them from hot or
Some weeks later he is bitten by a large dragon. The Game Master cold environments, but will not protect them from fire sources or
rolls the damage for the attack, and it would knock him unconscious. hot or cold items.
The Contingency kicks in and he is teleported away before taking
the damage. The caster can change the ambient temperature by concentrating
for a round, and can vary that temperature from –5 to 40 degrees
Celsius (23 to 104 Fahrenheit).
Continual Light (r)
Energy, Creation/Destruction Control Winds
Cleric 3, Druid 3, Shaman 3, Magic-User 2, Elf 2, Sorcerer 2 Druid 5
Target: 30’ radius Target: 10’ radius/level
Range: 120’ Range: personal
Duration: permanent Duration: 10 mins/level
When this spell is cast, the area within 30’ of the target point is lit This spell lets the caster completely control the speed and direction
with light as bright as daylight on an overcast day. of wind within the area, from dead calm to gale force.

This area will continue to be lit until it is dispelled. Changing the wind is slow and it can take up to 10 minutes to
change from one extreme to another.
The caster can choose to either cast this spell in a location, in which
case it will stay in that location, or cast it on an object – in which If cast at an air elemental or other creature made of air, the creature
case it will move as the object moves. can resist the spell by making a saving throw vs. spells. If this saving
throw fails, the caster can completely control the creature for the
This spell creates ambient light throughout the area, not a light duration of the spell – or even choose to kill it outright.
source in the centre of the area. There are no shadows in the area
covered by this spell, and covering the object that the spell is centred

106
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Create Air construct cannot be destroyed by a Dispel Magic, although it is still
Matter affected by Protection from Evil, Dispel Evil and Anti-Magic Shell.
Magic-User 3, Elf 3
Target: 8,000 cubic feet or one creature or object If this spell is cast by an immortal, the caster may choose to let
Range: touch the monsters remain in existence after the spell runs out, although
Duration: 1 hour/level if they do so the monsters will no longer be under their control.
This spell can be cast in a static area of up to 8,000 cubic feet
(20’x20’x20’ or the equivalent) in order to fill that area with breath- Create Food
able air for the duration. Creation
Cleric 5, Druid 5, Shaman 5
It can also be cast on an enclosed object, from a small one such Target: none
as a helmet to one as large as 20’x20’x20’ such as the interior of Range: 10’
a ship’s hold in order to fill that object with constantly refreshing Duration: permanent
air for the duration even if the object moves around. If the object Each time this spell is cast, it creates enough food to feed up to 36
is not airtight then the air will constantly leak out and be replaced. humans or demi-humans. If mounts such as horses are fed using
this spell, each one eats food equivalent to 2 humans.
Finally, it can be cast on a creature to surround the creature in a
thin skin-like bubble of breathable air for the duration, even if the For every caster level above 10, 36 extra people can be fed by this
creature moves. spell, although the caster can produce less food if desired.

In this last case, a creature that flies using wings can use that air The food created by this spell is similar to a bland and almost
around it to fly even if there is no other air, so it can fly through tasteless porridge, but is highly nutritious. However, it will spoil
an airless void or even the luminiferous aether. This bubble will after 24 hours.
maintain its integrity underwater or in such a void.
Create Magical Monsters
In any of these cases, although the spell provides air where there Matter
may be none, it doesn’t stop poison from mixing with that air – so Magic-User 8, Elf 8
it provides no protection from Cloudkill spells or the poisonous Target: none
breath of some monsters. Range: 60’
Duration: 20 minutes
Create Any Monster This spell causes monsters to temporarily appear and obey the
Matter caster’s commands for the duration, before disappearing.
Magic-User 9, Elf 9
Target: none Any type of creature that has up to two special abilities (up to two
Range: 90’ asterisks on its hit-dice) can be created except for humans and
Duration: 30 minutes demi-humans, and the creatures will be typical for their species.
This spell causes monsters to temporarily appear and obey the Creatures of only one species can be created per casting.
caster’s commands for the duration, before disappearing.
The total number of hit dice of creatures that can be created at once
Any type of mortal (not exalted) creature can be created except is equal to the caster’s level, and if the creatures are humanoid then
for humans and demi-humans, and the creatures will be typical they appear with normal (non-magical) equipment that disappears
for their species. Creatures of only one species can be created per when they do.
casting.
Monsters created by this spell are considered to be enchanted for
The total number of hit dice of creatures that can be created at once purposes of the Protection from Evil, Dispel Evil and Anti-Magic
is equal to the caster’s level, and if the creatures are humanoid then Shell spells, and they can be dispelled by a Dispel Magic with normal
they appear with normal (non-magical) equipment that disappears chances of success.
when they do.
This spell can also be used to create a construct with up to two
Monsters created by this spell are considered to be enchanted for special abilities (up to two asterisks on its hit-dice). See Chap-
purposes of the Protection from Evil, Dispel Evil and Anti-Magic ter 18 – Monsters for details of different types of construct and
Shell spells, and they can be dispelled by a Dispel Magic with normal Chapter 21 – Game Master Advice for how to create them.
chances of success. When used to create a construct, the duration of the spell is per-
manent, and the construct cannot be destroyed by a Dispel Magic,
This spell can also be used to create a construct. See Chapter 18 – although it is still affected by Protection from Evil, Dispel Evil and
Monsters for details of different types of construct and Chap- Anti-Magic Shell.
ter 21 – Game Master Advice for how to create them. When used
to create a construct, the duration of the spell is permanent, and the

107
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
If this spell is cast by an immortal, the caster may choose to let This spell can also be used to create a construct with no special
the monsters remain in existence after the spell runs out, although abilities (no asterisks on its hit-dice). See Chapter 18 – Monsters
if they do so the monsters will no longer be under their control. for details of different types of construct and Chapter 21 – Game
Master Advice for how to create them.
Create Normal Animals
Creation When used to create a construct, the duration of the spell is per-
Cleric 6, Druid 6 manent, and the construct cannot be destroyed by a Dispel Magic,
Target: none although it is still affected by Protection from Evil, Dispel Evil and
Range: 30’ Anti-Magic Shell.
Duration: 2 hours
This spell causes animals to temporarily appear and obey the caster’s If this spell is cast by an immortal, the caster may choose to let
commands for the duration, before disappearing. the monsters remain in existence after the spell runs out, although
if they do so the monsters will no longer be under their control.
The spell will create one large animal (rhinoceros, elephant, etc.),
three medium sized animals (tiger, bear, horse, etc.), or six small Create Water
animals (wolf, cat, monkey, etc.) and the creatures will be typical Creation
for their species. Cleric 4, Druid 4
Target: none
The caster can decide on the number and size of creature that they Range: 10’
wish to create, but not on the actual species. Only one species of Duration: 1 hour
animal will appear per casting, and the animals will be typical for When this spell is cast, a magical spring will appear from the ground
their species. or a wall and flow for an hour.

Animals created by this spell are considered to be enchanted for The spring will provide enough water for 36 humans or demi-
purposes of the Protection from Evil, Dispel Evil and Anti-Magic humans (50 gallons or enough water to fill a 10’x10’x2’ pool)
Shell spells, and they can be dispelled by a Dispel Magic with normal before drying up. If mounts such as horses are being watered, each
chances of success. one will take the same water as 2 humans. For each level of the
caster above 8th, enough water for an additional 36 humans will
If this spell is cast by an immortal, the caster may choose to let the flow through.
animals remain in existence after the spell runs out, although if they
do so the animals will no longer be under their control. The caster can stop the spring at any time before the duration has
expired, although this will not make the existing water disappear.
Create Normal Monsters
Matter Creeping Doom
Magic-User 7, Elf 7 Druid 7
Target: none Target: 10’ to 30’ radius
Range: 30’ Range: 120’
Duration: 10 minutes Duration: 1 rnd/level
This spell causes monsters to temporarily appear and obey the This spell summons a swarm of hundreds of thousands of crawling
caster’s commands for the duration, before disappearing. insects and spiders. The swarm can vary from having a 10’ radius
to a 30’ radius, and the caster can move the swarm up to 20’ per
Any type of creature that has no special abilities (no asterisks on round and also alter the radius on a round by round basis.
its hit-dice) can be created except for humans and demi-humans,
and the creatures will be typical for their species. Creatures of only The swarm is initially capable of doing 1,000 points of damage
one species can be created per casting. per round, which must be split as evenly as possible between all
creatures in the area of the swarm; although no individual creature
The total number of hit dice of creatures that can be created at once can be dealt more than 100 damage, so if there are fewer than 10
is equal to the caster’s level, and if the creatures are humanoid then creatures in the area then some of the potential damage will be
they appear with normal (non-magical) equipment that disappears wasted. The insects cannot damage creatures that can be hit only
when they do. by magical weapons.

Monsters created by this spell are considered to be enchanted for Normal attacks will slay many dozens of insects, with each point of
purposes of the Protection from Evil, Dispel Evil and Anti-Magic damage reducing the damage potential of the swarm on a 1-for–1
Shell spells, and they can be dispelled by a Dispel Magic with normal basis, so if an attack deals 50 damage then the swarm will only be
chances of success.

108
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
capable of doing 950 points of damage from then on. Area effect at- This spell will only cure lycanthropy if cast by a caster of 11th
tacks, such as a Fireball spell, do double damage against the swarm. level or higher.

A Protection from Evil spell won’t keep the insects out, but a Dispel Reverse: Cause Disease causes the target to contract a non-con-
Magic will work against the swarm with normal chances of success. tagious disease that gives them a –2 to attack rolls, stops magical
healing working on them, and causes natural healing to take twice
Cure Blindness as long. The target may make a saving throw vs. spells to avoid
Comfort the effect.
Cleric 3, Druid 3, Shaman 3
Target: one creature This magical disease can only be cured by a Cure Disease spell, and
Range: touch if not cured it will prove fatal in 2d12 days.
Duration: permanent
This spell cures both mundane blindness and magical blindness Cure Light Wounds (r)
caused by Light and Darkness spells (and their continual versions). Comfort/Pain
The only form of blindness it will not normally cure is that caused Cleric 1, Druid 1, Shaman 1
by a Curse. This spell can only cure blindness caused by a Curse Target: one living creature
when it is cast by an immortal. Range: touch
Duration: permanent
Cure Critical Wounds (r) This spell cures one living (not undead or non-living) creature
Comfort/Pain of 1d6+1 points of damage. The caster can cure themselves with
Cleric 5, Druid 5, Shaman 5 this spell.
Target: one living creature
Range: touch Alternately, the spell can be used to cure paralysis (except that
Duration: permanent caused by a Hold Person or Hold Monster spell), although if it does
This spell cures one living (not undead or non-living) creature so then no damage will be cured at the same time.
of 3d6+3 points of damage. The caster can cure themselves with
this spell. Reverse: Cause Light Wounds inflicts 1d6+1 damage to a touched
living (not undead or non-living) target. The target gets no saving
Reverse: Cause Critical Wounds inflicts 3d6+3 damage to a touched throw against the damage, but the caster must make a normal at-
living (not undead or non-living) target. The target gets no saving tack roll to touch an unwilling target.
throw against the damage, but the caster must make a normal at-
tack roll to touch an unwilling target. Cure Serious Wounds (r)
Comfort/Pain
Cure Disease (r) Cleric 4, Druid 4, Shaman 4
Purity/corruption Target: one living creature
Cleric 3, Druid 3, Shaman 3 Range: touch
Target: one living creature Duration: permanent
Range: 30’ This spell cures one living (not undead or non-living) creature
Duration: permanent of 2d6+2 points of damage. The caster can cure themselves with
This spell will cure any living (not undead or non-living) creature this spell.
of a single disease. It will cure any mundane disease, and will even
cure magical diseases such as mummy rot and kill disease-like Reverse: Cause Serious Wounds inflicts 2d6+2 damage to a touched
monsters such as green slime. living (not undead or non-living) target. The target gets no saving
throw against the damage, but the caster must make a normal at-
tack roll to touch an unwilling target.

Cureall
Comfort
Cleric 6, Druid 6, Shaman 6, Magic-User 9, Elf 9
Target: one living creature
Range: touch
Duration: permanent
This spell will cure nearly all damage from a living (not undead or
non-living) target, leaving them with only 1d6 damage – although
if the target is already healthier than that it won’t damage them.

109
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Alternatively, the spell can be used as a Remove Curse, Cure Disease Example: Aloysius casts a Death Spell at a mixed bunch of op-
or Cure Blindness spell, or it can be used to cure a Feeblemind spell. ponents. There are ten goblins with one hit die each, three wolves
However, it will only cure one thing per casting. with 2 hit dice each, and a giant with 9 hit dice along with his 5
hit dice hellhound pet.
If cast on someone who has recently been brought back to life by
a Raise Dead spell, it will eliminate the rest period and bring the Aloysius’s player rolls 4d8 and gets a total of 19. The ten goblins are
target back to full strength immediately. the weakest creatures, so they are all affected, taking 1 hit dice each
from the total (even though two of them make their saving throws
Dance and survive) leaving 9 left. The three wolves take 2 hit dice from
Spirit the total each, leaving 3 more left. This is not enough to kill the 5
Magic-User 8, Elf 8 hit dice hellhound, so it is left alive. The giant is unharmed since
Target: one creature even if there were no other creatures, it has 8 or more hit dice and
Range: touch is too powerful for the spell to kill.
Duration: special
When this spell is cast, the caster must touch a single target by
making a successful attack roll. The target gets no saving throw, Creatures with no hit points (vermin, insects, small plants, etc.)
and is forced to dance wildly for three or more rounds. are instantly slain with no saving throw, and do not count towards
this total.
While dancing, the target is unable to attack, move quicker than
a walk, or use spells or spell like abilities. The target also has a –4 Delayed Blast Fireball
penalty to all saving throws and a +4 penalty to armour class until Energy
they stop dancing. Magic-User 7, Elf 7
Target: 20’ radius
The duration of the spell is based on the caster’s level: Range: 240’
Duration: 0–60 rounds
18th–20th = 3 rounds When this spell is cast, the caster chooses a length of delay, from 0
21st–24th = 4 rounds to 60 rounds. After this delay, a small ruby-like gem then shoots
25th–28th = 5 rounds out to the target location, waits for the specified number of rounds,
29th–32nd = 6 rounds and explodes into a ball of fire.
33rd–36th = 7 rounds
The explosion does 1d6 points of damage per caster level (to a
An immortal target of this spell may make a saving throw each maximum of 20d6 unless the caster is an immortal) to all within
round to stop dancing. a 20’ radius. Creatures within that radius can make a saving throw
vs. spells to take half damage.
Death Spell
Spirit During the time between the casting of this spell and the explosion,
Magic-User 6, Elf 6, Sorcerer 6 the gem can be moved by normal means (carried, thrown, dropped,
Target: one or more creatures in a 30’ radius etc.) but it is immune to all magical attempts to move it (Teleport,
Range: 240’ Telekinesis, etc.)
Duration: instant
This spell sucks the life out of all creatures within a 30’ radius of Nothing can delay the gem’s explosion at the appointed time or
the target point of the spell. make it explode before its time is up except a Wish spell. However,
a Dispel Magic has normal chances to destroy the gem and thus
Roll 4d8 to see how many hit dice worth of creatures are slain by prevent the explosion.
the effect.
Detect Danger
Go through all the living (not undead or non-living) creatures Druid 1
in the area with fewer than 8 hit dice or levels, starting with the Target: 5’/level
weakest. Range: personal
Duration: 1 hour or 1/2 hour
If there are enough hit dice left from the roll, that creature is slain This spell allows the caster to detect the presence of danger. If cast
unless they can make a saving throw vs. death ray and their hit dice outdoors, it lasts for an hour, but if cast indoors then it only lasts
are taken from the running total (whether they make or fail the for half an hour.
save). Once there are no more creatures left with fewer (or equal)
hit dice to the number of hit dice left over, the spell stops. During that time, the caster can concentrate on a square foot of
ground or wall, human-sized creature, or a chest sized object for
a full round and know whether it is immediately dangerous, po-
tentially dangerous, or benign (from the caster’s point of view).

110
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Objects larger than those mentioned above can be examined, but Disintegrate
will take correspondingly more time. Entropy
Magic-User 6, Elf 6
Detect Evil Target: one creature or object
Spirit, Truth Range: 60’
Cleric 1, Druid 1, Magic-User 2, Elf 2, Sorcerer 2 Duration: instant
Target: 120’ radius This spell destroys a single creature or a single non-magical object,
Range: personal leaving only a trace of fine silvery dust. If targeted on a creature, that
Duration: 1 hour creature may make a saving throw vs. death ray to avoid the effect.
This spell allows the caster to see a glow around any creature or
intelligent object within range that wishes them harm. Dispel Evil
Antipathy
The caster does not know exactly what harm the creature is intend- Cleric 5, Druid 5, Shaman 5
ing or what they are capable of, merely that the intent is there. Target: one or more creatures
Range: 30’
Detect Invisible Duration: 10 minutes
Magic-User 2, Elf 2, Sorcerer 2 When cast, the caster can choose to make this spell affects any
Target: 10’ radius/level enchanted, summoned, controlled, animated, charmed or cursed
Range: personal creatures within range, or target it at a single such creature or object.
Duration: 1 hour
This spell allows the caster to see all invisible creatures and objects Each targeted creature must make a saving throw vs. spells (if a
within range. Invisible creatures do not get a saving throw against single creature is targeted it saves at –2) or take the following effect:
this effect.
◊ Animated: creature is no longer animated.
Detect Magic ◊ Summoned: creature is banished to where it was summoned
Truth from.
Cleric 1, Druid 1, Shaman 1, Magic-User 1, Elf 1, Sorcerer 1 ◊ Cursed: the curse is removed from the creature.
Target: 60’ radius ◊ Charmed: the charm is removed from the creature.
Range: personal ◊ Controlled: the control is removed from the creature.
Duration: 20 minutes
This spell allows the caster to see a glow around any magical creature, Even if the creature makes its saving throw, it must still flee for the
object and place within range. Magical creatures do not get a saving duration of the spell. If the caster moves before the duration is up,
throw against this effect. the spell is ended early.

The glow only extends a couple of inches around the magical object, In the case of objects, the spell will remove any curse from the
so if it is in a container or behind another object then some or all object, but only if the object is specifically targeted by the spell.
of the glow may not be visible.
Dispel Magic
Dimension Door Inertia
Energy Cleric 4, Druid 4, Shaman 4, Magic-User 3, Elf 3, Sorcerer 3
Magic-User 4, Elf 4 Target: all spells in 10’ radius
Target: one creature Range: 120’
Range: 10’ Duration: permanent
Duration: instant When this spell is cast, it has a chance of cancelling all ongoing
This spell will teleport either the caster or a single creature within 10’ spell effects that are wholly or partly within a 10’ radius of the
a distance of up to 360’ from its current location. target point of the spell.

If the caster cannot see the destination then it must be described Spells cast by casters of equal or lower level to the caster of the
in terms of direction and distance. dispel are automatically cancelled. Spells cast by higher level cast-
ers have a 5% chance per level of difference of resisting the dispel.
If the destination is occupied by solid matter, the spell fails and
the target does not move.
Example: Elfstar casts Dispel Magic on a Barrier spell cast by a 15th
An unwilling target may make a saving throw vs. spells to avoid level cleric. Elfstar is only 12th level which is three levels difference,
being teleported by the spell. so there is a 15% chance of the Barrier spell resisting the dispel.

111
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
This spell will not destroy magic items unless cast by an immortal, Entangle
although it will cancel spell effects that were created by magic items. Matter
Even if cast by an immortal, this spell will not destroy an artefact. Magic-User 2, Elf 2
Target: one rope or vine
For purposes of this spell, immortals are considered to be casters of Range: 30’
twice their hit dice, rather than casters of their level. For example, Duration: 1 rnd/level
a first level immortal with 15 hit dice dispels other spells as if they This spell animates a single rope or vine that can be up to 50’ long
were a 30th level caster, and has their spells dispelled as if they plus 5’ per level of the caster.
were a 30th level caster.
The rope cannot be ordered to attack, but it can be ordered to loop
Dissolve (r) or tie around something, to knot or unknot itself, or to neatly
Matter coil up.
Druid 5, Magic-User 5, Elf 5, Sorcerer 5
Target: 3,000 square feet of ground Using a combination of these commands, the rope can be used for
Range: 240’ climbing or for capturing enemies. The rope cannot stretch itself
Duration: 3d6 days out, it can only grasp things within 1’ of it – so it must be thrown
This spell turns an area of up to 3,000 square feet of soil or natural by hand at the thing it is commanded to loop or tie around.
rock (not constructions or worked rock) into a slurry of mud.
If the rope is thrown at a creature and commanded to tie it, the
The area can be shaped how the caster desires, but all of it must be creature gets a saving throw vs. spells to avoid the rope.
within the range of the spell.
ESP (r)
The mud is too thin to walk on properly and too thick to swim Spirit
through. Creatures attempting to wade through it can only move Magic-User 2, Elf 2
at 10% of their normal speed. Target: one creature at a time
Range: 60’
The mud will dry out naturally in 3d6 days. Duration: 2 hours
This spell allows the caster to hear and understand the thoughts of
Reverse: Harden will change 3,000 square feet of mud, up to 10’ any living creature within range, regardless of language.
deep, into solid rock permanently.
The caster must concentrate for six rounds. If there is more than
Any creature standing in the mud must make a saving throw vs. one creature in the same direction, it takes the caster an additional
spells to avoid being trapped by the solidifying mud. six rounds to filter the thoughts of a single creature out of the
cacophony.
Earthquake
Corruption The spell is blocked by two feet of stone or any thickness of lead,
Cleric 7, Druid 7 and each individual targeted can make a saving throw vs. spells to
Target: 60’+5’/level diameter block out the ESP.
Range: 360’
Duration: 10 minutes Reverse: Mindmask makes the caster or a touched creature immune
This spell causes a powerful but localised earthquake. It will destroy to all forms of mind reading for the duration.
small buildings and damage large ones, and may cause rockslides.
Explosive Cloud
Each creature in the area has a 1 in 6 chance of being in danger of Entropy
being engulfed in a crack in the ground. The creature must make Magic-User 8, Elf 8
a saving throw vs. death ray in order to stop themselves falling in Target: 15’ radius
and being crushed for 1d100+100 damage per round. Range: 1’
Duration: 1 hour
This spell creates a 15’ radius and 20’ tall cloud of poisonous gas,
the closest edge of which must be within 1’ of the caster. The gas is
dense enough to be visible, but does not block sight. If cast within
an enclosed space, the cloud may be smaller than the dimensions
above. It will not expand to fill the same volume.

112
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting

From the outside, the cloud is indistinguishable from that created


by a Cloudkill spell. Find the Path
Truth
The cloud is poisonous, and each round all within it must make a Cleric 6, Druid 6, Shaman 6
saving throw vs. spells or be paralysed for that round. Additionally, Target: caster
the cloud contains sparkling lights visible only to those within it. Range: personal
Duration: 1 hour + 10 mins/level
These lights are small explosions that do 1 point of damage per This spell mentally guides the caster to a specific place. The caster
two caster levels to each creature within the cloud. This damage is subconsciously able to take the correct route, and even know
will affect any creature, even those immune to fire, gas and poison, the location of secret doors and know passwords. The caster is
and there is no saving throw against it. not conscious of any of this knowledge, however, and is therefore
unable to remember it after the spell’s duration runs out or com-
Faerie Fire municate it to others.
Druid 1
Target: one or more creatures Once the spell runs out, the caster will remember the vague direc-
Range: 60’ tion to the goal, but that is all.
Duration: 1 rnd/level
This spell causes one or more creatures or objects within the area to The spell must be used to direct the caster to a fixed location that the
glow with flickering greenish flames as if on fire. The fire is bright caster has either visited before or had described in detail. It cannot
enough to make the targets glow in the dark, but not bright enough be used to simply find the current location of an object. It will only
to use as a light source. find a path that does not involve crossing planar boundaries. If there
is no such path, then the caster will know this after casting the spell.
The caster can outline one human sized target or the equivalent
per 5 levels. Find Traps
Truth
All attacks against outlined creatures gain a +2 bonus to hit. Cleric 2, Druid 2
Target: 30’ radius
Feeblemind Range: personal
Spirit Duration: 20 minutes
Magic-User 5, Elf 5 This spell causes the caster to see a glow around any mechanical or
Target: one spell-using creature magical traps that are within 30’ of them.
Range: 240’
Duration: permanent It does not give any indication about the type of trap or the trig-
This spell blasts the mind of the target, who must be a spell caster. gering mechanism, and cannot find natural hazards or ambushes.
The target must make a saving throw vs. spells (with a penalty of –4
to the roll unless the target is an immortal) or be made helpless,
unable to think clearly and unable to cast spells. The victim’s intel-
ligence is reduced to a score of 2.

The effect is permanent, although it can be removed by a Dispel


Magic (with the normal chance of success) or by a Cureall spell.

113
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Fireball The Force Field does not need to be supported, its edges are not
Energy sharp, and it is completely immobile – only a Wish spell can move
Magic-User 3, Elf 3, Sorcerer 3 a Force Field.
Target: 20’ radius
Range: 240’ No physical or magical force except those noted above can destroy
Duration: instant or pass through a Force Field, although a Teleport or Dimension
This spell creates a small ball of flame that shoots out to the target Door spell will bypass it. Creatures enclosed within a Force Field
point and then explodes into a 20’ radius ball of fire. are magically preserved, and will not starve or suffocate.

The fire does 1d6 damage per caster level (to a maximum of 20d6, This spell can be made permanent with a Permanence spell, and if
unless the caster is an immortal) to each creature in the area. Crea- this happens then the Permanence can still be dispelled even though
tures that make a saving throw vs. spells take only half damage. the Force Field cannot be. If the Permanence is dispelled after the
normal duration of the Force Field has expired then the Force Field
Floating Disc will immediately disappear.
Matter
Magic-User 1, Elf 1 A Force Field cast by a mortal can be destroyed by an immortal’s
Target: none attacks (treat it as having an armour class of –10 and 50 hit points).
Range: personal
Duration: 1 hour A Force Field cast by an immortal cannot be broken by Disintegrate
This spell creates a small flying platform of force, about the size and or Wish spells cast by mortals, and cannot be penetrated by mortal
shape of a round shield. The platform is invisible to all but the caster Teleport, Gate, or Dimension Door spells.
and hovers at the height of the caster’s waist. The platform follows
the caster around, never getting more than 6’ away from them. Gate (r)
Spirit
The platform can support 500lbs of weight. Magic-User 9, Elf 9
Target: one extraplanar being
The platform has no edges and cannot be used as a weapon in any Range: 30’
way, since it has no physical existence other than to support weight. Duration: special
This spell opens a one-way rift between two planes, even those
Fly attached to two different celestial spheres.
Matter
Magic-User 3, Elf 3, Sorcerer 3 Normally, the caster must specify the target plane and the name
Target: one creature of a creature on that plane.
Range: touch
Duration: 10 mins/level+1d6x10 mins If the creature is on the named plane, then the spell opens a one-
This spell allows the target to fly at 120’ per round by concentrating. way physical portal between the caster’s current location and the
If the target stops concentrating they will hover in place. creature’s location allowing the creature to step through to the caster
(but not vice versa). If the creature is not on the named plane then
Force Field the spell fails. If the creature is an immortal, it can refuse to allow
Energy the Gate to open.
Magic-User 8, Elf 8
Target: none However, the spell can also be cast through the open end of an
Range: 120’ open one-way Gate, targeting the other end of the Gate rather than
Duration: 1 hour a specific creature. In this case, the caster does not need to specify
This spell creates an impossibly hard field of force that cannot be (or even know) where the other end of the Gate is located. If cast
dispelled and can only be broken by a Disintegrate or Wish spell. in this manner, the Gate becomes two-way and creatures can pass
through in either direction.
The Force Field must be a simple smooth shape – either a flat plane
of up to 5,000 square feet, a sphere or hemisphere of up to 20’ The open end of a one-way Gate appears misty and is opaque.
radius, or a rectangular box with a surface area of up to 5,000 The closed end of a one-way Gate is invisible, although detectable
square feet. with a Detect Magic spell. A two-way Gate can be seen through in
either direction. If the either end of the Gate is an outer plane then
Regardless of shape, it must always be created in an empty area. It the Gate only stays open for 10 minutes. Otherwise it stays open
cannot be created inside any object or creature to cut them in half. for 1d10 x 100 minutes.
However, the edges of the Force Field will conform to the shape of
surrounding material such as walls. Any creature can step through the open end of a Gate, and there is
a base 10% chance of a random inhabitant of the far plane (modi-

114
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
fied by the location that the Gate is opened to) noticing the open Growth of Animal
Gate and investigating it. Vitality
Cleric 3, Druid 3
It costs an immortal 50pp to step through a Gate. This makes Target: one animal
summoning one for frivolous reasons a risky proposition at best. Range: 120’
Duration: 2 hours
Reverse: Close Gate closes a Gate to another plane, whether one This spell causes one animal to grow to double its normal size, giv-
made by this spell or a natural planar rift. ing it twice its normal strength and making it do twice its normal
damage in combat. The animal may also carry twice its normal load.
Developer Commentary
The Gate spell here (which is the same as the one in the original Growth of Plants (r)
edition of Dark Dungeons) is different from the one in the original Matter
game that these rules emulate. Magic-User 4, Elf 4, Sorcerer 4
Target: 3,000 square feet of undergrowth
Target:
Rather than emulating that version of the spell, it emulates the Range:
Range: 120’
modified version of the spell that was introduced into that game by Duration: permanent
the supplement that detailed immortals and their magic. This spell causes all undergrowth (grasses, brambles, vines etc.)
within a 3,000 square foot area of whatever shape the caster desires
to become thickly overgrown. This growth makes the area impass-
Geas (r) able to creatures smaller than giant sized.
Spirit
Magic-User 6, Elf 6 The effect can be removed by a Dispel Magic or by the reverse of
Target: one creature this spell.
Range: 30’
Duration: special Reverse: Shrink Plants reverses this spell or makes a similar area
This spell forces the target to either perform a specific action or of naturally overgrown plants shrink and shrivel making the area
refrain from performing a specific action. easily passable.

The target may make a saving throw vs. spells to escape the effect. Hallucinatory Terrain
Entropy
The action must be something that is possible, and can’t be some- Magic-User 4, Elf 4
thing suicidal – for example you can’t Geas someone into jumping Target: one terrain feature up to 480’ diameter
off a cliff or Geas someone into never eating. Range: touch
Duration: special
The target must perform (or refrain from performing) the action, This spell masks a terrain feature (either indoors or outdoors) and
but they are not mind controlled in any way, and they are fully makes it look like a different feature. For example a pit could be
aware that they may only be performing the action or refraining made to look like solid floor or a small hill could be made to look
from it in order to avoid the consequences of this spell. like a patch of swamp.

If the target goes against the Geas, they receive a Curse, as if by the The illusion last until it is touched by an intelligent creature.
reversed form of the Remove Curse spell. Neither this curse nor the
Geas itself can be dispelled or removed via a Remove Curse spell, Haste (r)
although a Dispel Evil will remove it. The curse will not lift until Energy
the Geas is fulfilled (or, in the case of geases against performing Magic-User 3, Elf 3
actions, a week has passed without the action being performed). Target: 24 creatures in a 30’ radius
Range: 240’
This spell cannot affect an immortal, even if cast by another im- Duration: 30 minutes
mortal. This spell speeds up creatures in a 30’ radius of the target point.
Up to 24 creatures can be affected.
Reverse: Remove Geas will remove an unwanted Geas, although for
each level the caster of the Geas is above the caster of the Remove Hasted creatures move and act at twice normal speed, although
Geas there is a 5% chance of failure. spell casting (whether innate or through items) is not sped up. See
Chapter 10 – Combat for details about how Haste affects combat.

This spell has no effect on immortals.

Reverse: Slow slows creatures in the area rather than hasting them.
Affected creatures move and act at half normal speed, although spell

115
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
casting (whether innate or through items) is not slowed down. See Hold Person (r)
Chapter 10 – Combat for details about how Slow affects combat. Spirit, Inertia/Vitality
Cleric 2, Druid 2, Shaman 2, Magic-User 3, Elf 3
Heat Metal Target: one to four humanoids
Druid 2 Range: 180’
Target: one metal object Duration: 90 minutes
Range: 30’ This spell will paralyse up to four living humanoid creatures (not
Duration: 7 rounds undead or non-living creatures) for the duration.
This spell heats one metal object to red hot over the course of 4
rounds. The object then takes a further three rounds to cool. It can be cast at a single target, in which case the target may save vs.
spells at a –2 penalty to avoid the effect; or at a group, in which case
Any metal object of up to half a pound per caster level can be af- it will affect 4 of them each of which may save vs. spells without
fected by this spell. penalty to avoid the effect.

The metal is not damaged by the heating and cooling, although Reverse: Free Person removes the paralysis caused by this spell. It
if the metal forms part of an object that also has wood or leather will also remove the paralysis effect of an immortal’s aura, but only
then the non-metal parts of the object may be scorched unless the when cast by an immortal.
object is magical.
Hold Portal
If the object is being held or worn by a creature, the creature will Entropy
take 1 damage on the first round, 2 on the second, 4 on the third, 8 Magic-User 1, Elf 1
on the fourth, 4 on the fifth, 2 on the sixth, and 1 on the seventh. Target: one door, chest or gate
Range: 10’
The holder of the item gets no saving throw, although creatures will Duration: 2d6x10 minutes
usually drop the item before the duration is up. The holder cannot This spell will hold a single portal or door closed by magical means.
cast spells while holding a hot item. The portal can only be forced open by creatures who have at least
three hit dice more than the caster or opened with a Knock spell,
Hold Animal although in either case if the portal is allowed to close it will con-
Druid 3 tinue to be held for the duration of the spell.
Target: one or more animals
Range: 180’ Immortals can always open doors held by a mortal’s casting of this
Duration: 10 mins/level spell, even if they have fewer hit dice.
This spell will paralyse several animals for the duration.
Holy Word
It will affect 1 hit dice of animal per level of the caster, although Antipathy
each animal gets a saving throw vs. spells to avoid the effect. Cleric 7, Druid 7
Target: all creatures in range
Hold Monster (r) Range: 40’
Spirit Duration: instant
Magic-User 5, Elf 5, Sorcerer 5 This spell affects all creatures within 40’ of the caster. The exact
Target: one to four creatures effect varies depending on the creature’s level or hit dice, and only
Range: 120’ allies of the caster (and any creature of 13 or more hit dice) may
Duration: 1 hour + 10 min/level make saving throws vs. spells to avoid the effect:
This spell will paralyse up to four living creatures (not undead or
non-living creatures) for the duration. up to 5 hd = killed
6–8 hd = stunned for 2d10x10 mins
It can be cast at a single target, in which case the target may save 9–12 hd = stunned for 1d10 rounds
vs. spells at a –2 penalty to avoid the effect; or at a group, in which 13+ hd = deafened for 1d6x10 mins
case it will affect 1d4 of them each of which may save vs. spells
without penalty to avoid the effect. Ice Storm / Wall of Ice
Energy
Reverse: Free Monster removes the paralysis caused by either this Magic-User 4, Elf 4, Sorcerer 4
spell or a Hold Person spell. It will also remove the paralysis effect Target: special
of an immortal’s aura, but only when cast by an immortal. Range: 120’
Duration: instant or 2 hours
This spell can be cast in one of two ways, and the caster can decide
which way to use it at the time of casting.

116
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
The first way to use the spell is to create a 10’ radius Ice Storm. The insects do no damage, but will drive away any creature of less
This ice storm does 1d6 cold damage per caster level (maximum than 3 hit dice with their stinging and biting. There is no saving
of 20d6) to every creature in the area. Each creature can make a throw against this effect.
saving throw vs. spells to take half damage.
The insect swarm can be moved up to 20’ per round by the caster,
Fire based creatures have a –4 penalty to their saving throws, but and lasts until the caster stops concentrating.
cold based creatures are immune to the spell.
Invisibility
The second way to use the spell is to create a vertical Wall of Ice of Entropy
up to 1,200 square feet. The wall is not transparent, and must be Magic-User 2, Elf 2, Sorcerer 2
created in unoccupied space on ground that will support it. Target: one creature or object
Range: 240’
The wall will melt in two hours, but can be broken before that Duration: special
time by creatures of 5 hit dice or more. However, such creatures This spell makes a single creature or object invisible.
take 1d6 cold damage while doing so (fire based creatures take 2d6,
cold based creatures take none). If cast on a creature, the creature’s clothing and equipment also
become invisible.
Immunity
Entropy Any item the creature drops will become visible, but items the
Magic-User 9, Elf 9 creature picks up will not become invisible.
Target: one creature
Range: touch The creature will become visible again if it attacks another creature
Duration: 10 mins/level or if it casts a spell. Otherwise the invisibility is permanent.
This spell gives the creature touched complete immunity to spells
of 3rd level or less, and spells of 5th level or less only have half If the spell is cast on an object, the object remains invisible until
normal effect (halve whatever quantifiable effects they have, such touched by an intelligent creature.
as damage, duration, penalties, etc.)
Invisibility 10’ Radius
The spell also grants immunity to all missiles and all non-magical Entropy
weapons. Magic-User 3, Elf 3
Target: one creature
The target can drop the Immunity temporarily by concentrating, if Range: 120’
they wish to be affected by a beneficial spell. Duration: special
This spell makes all creatures in a 10’ radius around the target
Infravision invisible.
Energy
Magic-User 3, Elf 3 The creatures’ clothing and equipment also become invisible. Any
Target: one living creature item any creature drops will become visible, but items that one of
Range: touch the creatures pick up will not become invisible.
Duration: 1 day
This spell gives a living (not undead or non-living) creature the Any creature that strays more than 10’ from the target creature
infravision ability normally possessed by dwarves and elves. also becomes visible, and re-entering that radius does not make
the creature become visible again.
When the creature is in the dark (and only then – normal light
overloads the creature’s infravision and prevents it from working) Any creature will become visible again if it attacks another creature
they can use their infravision to navigate and even to fight. However, or if it casts a spell. Otherwise the invisibility is permanent.
infravision doesn’t allow the creature to see pictures and writing
unless they are carved into the surface that the creature is looking at. Invisible Stalker
Spirit
Insect Plague Magic-User 6, Elf 6
Sympathy Target: none
Cleric 5, Druid 5, Shaman 5 Range: personal
Target: none Duration: special
Range: 480’ This spell summons an invisible stalker (see Chapter 18 – Mon-
Duration: concentration sters for details).
This spell summons a 30’ radius swarm of insects which obscures
vision in the area. The caster must specify one task for the stalker to perform, and
the stalker will attempt to perform that task even at the cost of its

117
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
own life until either the task becomes impossible or a year and a
day have passed. In either case, the spell then ends.

Ironform
Matter
Magic-User 7, Elf 7
Target: none
Range: touch
Duration: permanent
This spell creates a sheet of iron up to 2” thick and up to 500
square feet in area. The sheet can be created flat or can be created
pre-shaped. The iron does not appear instantly, but takes time to
form, ranging from a single round for a simple sheet of iron to two
hours to create something with a precise specification.

Whatever the complexity of the shape, the iron must form a single
piece with no moving parts. However, the caster can create the iron It is important to note that the attitudes of different immortals (and
in a “rough” form, which can then have the Ironform spell cast on it what they approve and disapprove of ) will vary. This spell does not
again in order to either add to the object or reshape it. If the caster measure things against any objective standard of morality (whether
does create the iron in rough form, then this spell is cast once again or not one exists in your campaign world).
to “set” the iron in its final form so that other casters can’t cast this
spell on it in order to modify it. When cast by an immortal, this spell tells the immortal whether
they would consider the target to be “good”, “neutral” or “evil”.
Note that whatever shape the sheet takes, it is always a maximum
of 2” thick – so that if it is formed into a statue, for example, theReverse: Confuse Alignment lets the caster give a false reading to
statue would be hollow. any attempts to use the normal form of this spell on a touched
creature for 10 minutes per level of the caster. The caster must
Once created, the iron is real and cannot be dispelled, and it will choose whether the creature will detect as “good”, “neutral” or
last until it is physically or magically destroyed. “evil” at the time of casting.

Knock Developer Commentary


Entropy In the original edition of Dark Dungeons, and in the original game
Magic-User 2, Elf 2 that it emulates, alignment was an objective label that every creature
Target: one lock had, based on their behaviour and/or outlook.
Range: 60’
Duration: special Of course, since people are more complex than that, this causes no
This spell will temporarily unlock any lock, or open a door that end of arguments as to what behaviour is or is not compatible with
is closed by a Hold Portal or Wizard Lock spell. If the door was which alignment.
locked by mundane means then it remains unlocked until physi-
cally locked again, but if it is held shut by magical means then it For Darker Dungeons (and this edition of Dark Dungeons), i’ve
will re-fasten once closed. dropped alignment from the game entirely – as I have in my house
rules for the original game. Consequently, the Know Alignment spell
This spell will even unbar a door that is barred on the other side, needed re-writing to be more subjective.
although if the door is both barred and locked then it will take
two castings to remove both.

Know Alignment (r)


Truth/Deceit Levitate
Cleric 2, Druid 2 Energy
Target: one creature or item Magic-User 2, Elf 2, Sorcerer 2
Range: 10’ Target: caster
Duration: instant Range: personal
This spell allows the caster to discern whether a single creature or Duration: 1 hour + 10 mins/level
item within 10’ would be considered to be “good”, “neutral” or “evil” This spell allows the caster to rise into the air supported by magic.
by the moral standards of their patron immortal (or how natural
it is in the case of druids). However, it does not give the specific The caster can rise or lower themselves at a rate of 20’ per round,
reason why they would view the target in that light. but the spell does not let the caster move horizontally.

118
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
The caster can move horizontally via other means while under the Locate
influence of this spell, such as by pulling themselves along a rope Druid 1
or crawling on the underside of a ceiling. Target: one animal or plant
Range: 120’
Light (r) Duration: 1 hour
Energy, Creation/Destruction This spell lets the caster know the direction and distance to all
Cleric 1, Druid 1, Shaman 1, Magic-User 1, Elf 1, Sorcerer 1 instances of a particular animal or plant (chosen at time of casting)
Target: 15’ radius that fall within range. Animals detected by this spell do not get a
Range: 120’ saving throw. It will not locate animals or plants that are not on
Duration: 1 hour + 10 mins/level the same plane as the caster.
When this spell is cast, the area within 15’ of the target point is lit
with light as bright as torchlight. Locate Object
Matter, Truth
The caster can choose to either cast this spell in a location, in which Cleric 3, Druid 3, Magic-User 2, Elf 2
case it will stay in that location, or cast it on an object – in which Target: one object
case it will move as the object moves. Range: 120’
Duration: 1 hour
This spell creates a central light source that radiates light through- This spell lets the caster know the direction (but not distance) to
out the area, so there are shadows in the area covered by this spell, the closest instance of a particular type of object (chosen at time of
and covering the object that the spell is centred on will block out casting) that falls within range. The description of the object can
the light. be as vague or detailed as the caster chooses, although the object
must be described rather than named.
If this spell is cast on a creature’s eyes, that creature must make a
saving throw vs. spells or be blinded for the duration of the spell. This spell will not detect living creatures, and the object must be
on the same plane as the caster.
See Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving for details about how differ-
ent types of natural and magical light and darkness interact. Lore
Spirit
Reverse: Darkness causes the area within 15’ of the target point to Magic-User 7, Elf 7
be absolutely dark, although the infravision of some demi-humans Target: caster
or the dark vision of some monsters is able to penetrate it. Range: personal
Duration: instant
This spell creates a central source that radiates darkness rather, so This spell allows the caster to meditate on an item, place or person
covering the object that the spell was cast on will block the darkness. and gain knowledge about them. The meditation can take a long
If this spell is cast on a creature’s eyes, that creature must make a time, so can be split between multiple castings of this spell.
saving throw vs. spells or be blinded for the duration of the spell.
If the spell is cast with respect to an item that the caster has to
See Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving for details about how differ- hand, it will take 1d4x10 minutes of meditation to receive the
ent types of natural and magical light and darkness interact. information. At the end of that time, the caster learns the name
of the item if it has one, the details of one of the item’s magical
Lightning Bolt powers and how to activate that power (and how many charges it
Energy has, if applicable).
Magic-User 3, Elf 3, Sorcerer 3
Target: 60’x5’ bolt The caster does not learn whether or not the item has any additional
Range: 180’ powers, and must cast this spell again to find out.
Duration: instant
This spell creates a bolt of lightning that strikes creatures in the area If the spell is cast with respect to a place, an object that is not
for 1d6 damage per caster level (to a maximum of 20d6 unless the present, or a person; then the spell takes 1d100 days of meditation
caster is an immortal). Each creature hit may make a saving throw for the caster to learn about the subject, and the exact information
vs. spells to take half damage. learned is up to the Game Master’s discretion.

The caster may start the Lightning Bolt up to 180’ away from them-
selves, and the 60’ area of effect is then measured directly away from
the caster in the same direction. If the bolt hits a wall, door, or
other solid obstacle before it reaches a length of 60’, it will double-
back and return directly towards the caster. Creatures in a doubled
portion of the bolt do not take double damage.

119
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Lower Water The caster may attempt to possess any creature within a range
Matter of 120’ of the jar. The target must make a saving throw vs. spells to
Magic-User 6, Elf 6 prevent this possession, and if the saving throw succeeds the caster
Target: 10,000 square feet of water may not try to possess that target again for 10 minutes – although
Range: 240’ they may try to possess a different target immediately.
Duration: 100 minutes
This spell causes an area of water to be reduced to half its normal If the caster successfully possesses the target, the caster’s life force
depth. If cast on part of a larger body of water, it will create a trench moves into the target’s body, and the target’s life force is forced
in the water’s surface and will hold back the sides for the duration. into the jar.

Any boat or ship caught in such a trench will take 1d12+20 points The caster can use the target’s body, and its natural physical abilities;
of hull damage when the water rushes back at the end of the dura- but cannot use the target’s special or magical abilities, and can cast
tion, and all items on deck (including people if they fail saving neither their own spells nor the target’s spells.
throws vs. spells) will be swept off the ship.
If the target’s body is killed while the caster is in it, the target dies
Magic Door (r) and the caster’s life-force returns to the jar.
Entropy
Magic-User 7, Elf 7 If the jar is destroyed while the caster’s life-force is in it, the caster
Target: one flat surface is killed.
Range: 10’
Duration: 7 uses If the jar is destroyed while the target’s life-force is in it, the target
This spell creates a magical doorway in a solid non-living surface is killed and the caster is trapped in the target’s body until death.
such as a wall or a floor. Behind the doorway is an invisible pas-
sage up to 10’ long with a similar door at the other end. The caster If the caster’s own body is killed while the caster is either in the
can see both door and passage and can pass through the passage 7 jar or in a target’s body, there is no immediate effect but the caster
times before both disappear. can no longer return to their body and must either stay in the jar
or possess other bodies.
The door and passage are completely undetectable by normal means,
although they will show up on a Detect Magic spell. The only way A Protection from Evil spell will stop the caster from possessing a
to destroy the passage (without destroying the wall that it runs potential target, and a Dispel Evil spell will force the caster back
through) is to use a Dispel Magic spell. into the jar.

Reverse: Magic Lock seals any one door, chest lid, gate, archway, or Immortal bodies cannot be possessed by use of this spell, and if an
other portal up to 10’x10’ in size with an invisible barrier. immortal tries to possess a mortal body, the body is destroyed as
if by a Disintegrate spell.
The barrier doesn’t prevent the door (if there is one) from being
opened, but it prevents passage through the portal by any but the Magic Missile
caster. Once the caster has passed through the portal 7 times, the Matter
spell ends and the barrier disappears. Magic-User 1, Elf 1
Target: one or more creatures
The barrier can be removed by either a Dispel Magic or Disintegrate Range: 150’
spell. Duration: 1 hour
This spell creates one or more glowing missiles in the form of ar-
Magic Jar rows that appear in the air around the caster and follow the caster’s
Spirit movements, hovering in position.
Magic-User 5, Elf 5
Target: one object When the caster commands, each missile will launch itself at a
Range: 30’ single target that is visible to the caster (if the caster is firing more
Duration: special than one missile then they may be aimed at different targets) and
This spell takes the caster’s life-force and places it in one object automatically hit for 1d6+1 damage, with no saving throw allowed.
within range (the object does not have to be an actual jar).
For each 5 levels the caster has above 1st, two more missiles are
The caster’s body falls into a deep trance while their life-force is created (i.e. 3 missiles at 6th level, 5 missiles at 11th level, 7 missiles
missing, and appears dead to all but a detailed examination. The at 16th level, 9 missiles at 21st level, 11 missiles at 26th level, 13
caster’s body does not need air or sustenance while their life-force missiles at 31st level, 15 missiles at 36th level).
is in the jar, so the caster can stay in the jar indefinitely.

120
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
The arrows are intangible until used, and cannot be touched or This spell works on any living creature, but not on undead or non-
destroyed except by a Dispel Magic spell. Arrows that are not used living creatures such as golems. The spell will affect a total of 30
within an hour of casting disappear. hit dice or levels of creatures, and all targets get a saving throw vs.
spells at a penalty of –2 to avoid the effect. Creatures who make
Releasing pre-created arrows takes an action in combat, and the the saving throw still count towards the 30 hit dice limit.
caster cannot release more missiles at once than they can create in
a single casting of this spell. The caster may release arrows immedi- Reverse: Remove Charm removes all charm effects in a 10’ radius
ately on casting using the same action that was used to cast the spell. with no chance of failure, and also prevents any object or creature
within that radius from creating charm effects for 10 minutes.
Mass Charm (r)
Spirit Mass Invisibility (r)
Magic-User 8, Elf 8 Entropy
Target: one or more creatures Magic-User 7, Elf 7
Range: 120’ Target: one or more creatures
Duration: special Range: 240’
When this spell is cast, one or more creatures will imagine the Duration: special
caster to be their best friend, and treat them accordingly. It does This spell makes all creatures in a 30’ radius around the target point
not make them fanatically loyal and will not make them attack of the spell invisible. The creatures’ clothing and equipment also
their other friends. become invisible. Any item any creature drops will become visible,
but items that one of the creatures pick up will not become invisible.
If a target fails its saving throw, then it gets another one periodically
to throw off the charm effect. The frequency of the saving throw Any creature will become visible again if it attacks another creature
is based on the creature’s intelligence: or if it casts a spell. Otherwise the invisibility is permanent.

0 Int = save every 120 days Reverse: Appear causes all invisible creatures and objects within
1 Int = save every 90 days a 10’ radius of the target point of the spell to become visible and be
2 Int = save every 60 days unable to become invisible again for 10 minutes. Ethereal creatures
3 Int = save every 45 days are unaffected by this spell.
4–5 Int = save every 30 days
6–8 Int = save every 15 days Massmorph
9–12 Int = save every 7 days Entropy
13–15 Int = save every 3 days Magic-User 4, Elf 4, Sorcerer 4
16–17 Int = save every 24 hours Target: 120’ radius
18 Int = save every 8 hours Range: 240’
19 Int = save every 3 hours Duration: special
20 Int = save every hour This spell creates an illusion that makes up to 100 human sized
21–29 Int = save every 10 minutes creatures within a 120’ radius of the target point appear to be trees.
30+ Int = save every round Creatures that are larger than human sized may count as more than
one towards this 100 creature total, for example horses count as
If the caster does something to break the charm against one target, two people each.
such as attacking it, then other targets who see the incident get an
immediate saving throw to break their charm too. The illusion is effective against creatures both outside and passing
through the area, and is not broken by movement of the illusion-

121
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
covered creatures within the area. If creatures covered by the illusion The meteors automatically hit their targets (no attack roll or saving
leave the area or attack or cast spells then the illusion ends for those throw allowed) doing physical damage, and then explode for fire
individual creatures (even if they return to the area), but continues damage. All in the radius of the fire damage (including the target
to affect those that remain. struck) can make saving throws vs. spells to take half damage from
the explosion.
The spell lasts until none of the targeted creatures are still covered
or until it is dispelled, although the caster can cancel it early if Each meteor must be aimed at a different target, although if the
they desire. targets are close together then some or all of them may take damage
from multiple explosions, which do stack with each other.
Maze
Spirit The caster can choose to shoot either four meteors that each do 8d6
Magic-User 9, Elf 9 physical damage (no save) to their targets plus 8d6 fire damage
Target: 1 creature (save for half ) in their explosions or eight meteors that each do 4d6
Range: 60’ physical damage (no save) to their targets plus 4d6 fire damage
Duration: varies (save for half ) in their explosions.
This spell transports the target to an indestructible maze within
a temporarily created outer planar space unless they can make a Mind Barrier (r)
saving throw vs. spells. Spirit
Magic-User 8, Elf 8
After the target has negotiated their way out of the Maze, they re- Target: one creature
appear in the exact location that they left (or as near to it as possible Range: 10’
without appearing inside a solid object) and the outer planar space Duration: 1 hour/level
collapses into nothingness. This spell makes the target immune to the ESP and Clairvoyance
spells, and any type of magical scrying or information gathering
The length of time taken to escape the Maze is based on the crea- spell.
ture’s intelligence:
This includes protecting the target from being the subject of Lore
up to 8 Int = 1d6x10 mins and Locate spells and protects the target from having their location
9 Int to 12 Int = 2d20 rounds discovered via the use of a Summon Object spell.
13 Int to 17 Int = 2d4 rounds
18+ Int = 1d4 rounds The target also gets a +8 bonus to all saving throws against mind-
affecting attacks such as Charm and Feeblemind spells and abilities,
Metal to Wood illusions and phantasms that require saving throws, etc.
Druid 7
Target: one metal item However, it does not grant a saving throw against abilities that do
Range: 120’ not normally grant one. Neither does it protect the target from
Duration: permanent spells that indirectly reveal information about them, such as Holy
This spell changes a single metal item weighing up to 5 pounds per Word.
level of the caster into wood.
Reverse: Open Mind causes the victim to get a –8 penalty to all
If the metal is magical then this spell has only a 10% chance of saving throws against mind-affecting attacks such as Charm and
working, otherwise it automatically works. Feeblemind spells and abilities, illusions and phantasms that require
saving throws, etc.
The item becomes normal non-magical wood, and this spell cannot
be dispelled. Armour affected by this spell becomes useless and The target gets no saving throw against Open Mind, but the caster
metal weapons become non-magical clubs. must make a melee attack to touch the target.

Meteor Swarm Mirror Image


Energy Entropy
Magic-User 9, Elf 9 Magic-User 2, Elf 2
Target: special Target: caster
Range: 240’ Range: personal
Duration: instant Duration: 1 hour
This spell creates a number of flaming meteors that streak out from This spell creates 1d4 duplicate images of the caster which follow
the caster’s fingertips and strike enemies, before each explodes into the caster’s every move and shift into and through each other.
a 20’ radius fire ball.
It is impossible to tell which is the real caster and which are the
images.

122
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Every time the caster is hit by an attack that requires an attack roll, The mist has no effect other than to completely obscure vision
the attack will instead strike an image, destroying it. The caster within it including the infravision of some demi-humans. Only
takes no damage or other effect from the attack. Attacks and other the caster and creatures able to see invisible things can see through
effects that cause damage automatically (without an attack roll), the mist.
such as falling or the Magic Missile spell, affect the caster normally
without destroying any images. Pass Plant
Druid 5
Any attack that affects everything in an area, such as a Fireball spell Target: caster
or a dragon’s breath, will destroy all remaining images and the caster Range: special
will be affected normally by the attack. Duration: instant
This spell allows the caster to step inside a tree that is large enough
Move Earth to enclose them and instantly step out of another tree of the same
Matter kind some distance away. The maximum distance that can be tel-
Magic-User 6, Elf 6, Sorcerer 6 eported using this spell depends on the type of tree:
Target: special
Range: 240’ oak = 1,800’
Duration: 1 hour ash, elm, linden = 1,080’
This spell allows the caster to cause soil, clay or sand – but not other deciduous = 900’
rock – to move horizontally or vertically in order to build a rampart evergreen = 720’
or hill or to dig a hole or trench.
Passwall
The caster can move soil at a rate of 60’ per turn, and will usually Entropy
be able to dig to a depth of 240’ before reaching solid rock. Magic-User 5, Elf 5, Sorcerer 5
Target: one wall, ceiling or floor
Soil can only be dug and pushed around with this spell. It cannot Range: 30’
be made into structures that won’t support themselves. Duration: 30 minutes
This spell opens a tunnel through a stone wall, ceiling or floor by
When the duration expires, the soil stays where it is, although wind making the stone disappear. The tunnel is 5’ wide and tall, and 10’
and rain may make it settle over the course of time. long.

Neutralise Poison (r) At the end of the duration, the stone re-appears and the tunnel
Purity/corruption closes. Anyone caught in it when that happens must make a saving
Cleric 4, Druid 4, Shaman 4 throw vs. spells or be trapped in the re-appearing stone and killed.
Target: one creature, object or container
Range: touch Those who make their saving throws are ejected from the closest
Duration: instant end of the tunnel.
This spell will make the poison in and on one creature, object or
container harmless. Permanence
Energy
The spell affects all poisons present at the time of casting, but does Magic-User 8, Elf 8
not cure damage. However, if a creature has been killed by poison Target: special
and this spell is cast within 10 rounds of the creature’s death then Range: 10’
it will revive the creature. Duration: permanent
This spell causes another spell to become permanent in duration.
Reverse: Create Poison will either poison a creature touched by The two spells must be cast together (the Permanence spell cannot be
the caster (requiring a melee attack), killing it unless it can make cast on a spell that has already been cast and is currently still active).
a saving throw vs. poison, or poison the contents of a container so
that anyone who drinks or eats those contents will be killed unless The following spells can be made permanent using this spell:
they can make a saving throw vs. poison.
◊ Anti-Magic Shell
Obscure ◊ Cloudkill
Druid 2 ◊ Confusion
Target: caster ◊ Create Air
Range: personal ◊ Create Normal Monsters
Duration: 10 mins/level ◊ Detect Evil
This spell creates a cold, dense cloud of mist around the caster, 1’ ◊ Detect Invisible
high per level of the caster and 10’ radius per level of the caster. ◊ Detect Magic
◊ ESP

123
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
◊ Floating Disc A living creature can have up to two Permanence spells active at
◊ Fly on it one time. If a third one is cast on the same creature than all
◊ Force Field three immediately fail.
◊ Hold Person
◊ Hold Portal Phantasmal Force
◊ Infravision Energy
◊ Levitate Magic-User 2, Elf 2
◊ Light Target: 10’ radius
◊ Lower Water Range: 240’
◊ Mirror Image Duration: concentration
◊ Move Earth This spell creates a visual illusion within the area of effect that
◊ Phantasmal Force disappears when touched or when the caster stops concentrating.
◊ Polymorph Self
◊ Projected Image The illusion can alter the appearance of everything within the area,
◊ Protection from Normal Missiles and create images where there is nothing. The images can be mo-
◊ Protection from Evil bile or static.
◊ Protection from Evil 10’ Radius
◊ Read Languages Any illusionary creatures created by this spell are armour class 9,
◊ Read Magic and disappear if they take any damage.
◊ Shield
◊ Statue If an illusion is of something which attacks a target, the attack is
◊ Sword made as if the caster was making it. If that illusionary attack would
◊ Telekinesis damage the target, the target may make a saving throw vs. spells.
◊ Wall of Fire If the saving throw succeeds, the target realises that the attack is
◊ Wall of Ice illusionary and the attack has no effect.
◊ Water Breathing
◊ Web If the target fails the saving throw, they take damage as normal from
the attack (assuming it is something they would expect to damage
If cast by an immortal, this spell can also make the following spells them) but such damage is illusionary and fades away in 1d4x10
permanent: minutes. Such illusionary damage cannot kill the target. At the
most it can knock them unconscious until it fades.
◊ Explosive Cloud
◊ Gate Since attacking a target with an illusion usually involves the illusion
◊ Polymorph Any Object touching the target, this will normally end the illusion.
◊ Power Word Blind
◊ Prismatic Wall Plant Door
◊ Shapechange Druid 4
◊ Survival Target: caster
◊ Timestop Range: personal
◊ Travel Duration: 10 mins/level
This spell causes the caster to be completely intangible to plants.
The Permanence spell only makes the natural duration of the above The caster can walk through dense undergrowth and even step
spells permanent. Spells that can be partially or fully cancelled be- through living trees (or hide inside them).
fore their duration has expired by particular situations (e.g. Mirror
Image ending because all the images have been struck, Phantasmal The spell only works on living plants, not dead wood; and although
Force or project image ending because the illusion has been touched, the effect includes the caster’s equipment, it doesn’t include other
or Protection from Evil partially ending because the caster has at- creatures carried by the caster.
tacked a target of the spell) will be still partially or fully cancelled
if that situation occurs. When the duration ends, flexible plants will be bent around the
caster to give them room as they reappear, and solid plants such as
This spell can be dispelled by a Dispel Magic spell, and this will trees will gently push the caster out.
cause the spell that it is sustaining to immediately end – even if
that spell cannot normally be dispelled.

Any area or non-living object can only have one Permanence spell
active at a time. If a second one is cast on the same area or object
then both immediately fail.

124
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Polymorph Any Object The target is given all special abilities of the new form, including
Matter thinking and behaving as the new form. It cannot create a duplicate
Magic-User 8, Elf 8 of a specific individual, only a generic individual of the desired race
Target: one object or creature or monster species; and if something is polymorphed into a human
Range: 240’ or demi-human then it will not have class levels.
Duration: special
This spell will change any object or creature into another type of If an immortal is polymorphed by this spell, they change in outward
object or mortal (not exalted) creature. If cast at a large object, it form only. They retain their mind (and their aura), and do not get
will only change a 10’x10’x10’ section of the object. the special abilities of the new form. However, they can return to
their normal form at any time.
If the spell is cast at a creature, the creature may make a saving
throw vs. spells at a –4 penalty to avoid the effect. Polymorph Self
Matter
The duration of the spell depends on the degree of change between Magic-User 4, Elf 4
the old and new forms as indicated in Table 7–7. Target: caster
Range: personal
Regardless of the duration, the change can be dispelled with a Duration: 1 hour + 10 mins/level
Dispel Magic spell. This spell allows the caster to change their shape into that of another
race or mortal (not exalted) species.
This spell cannot affect a creature’s hit points, and only works on
creatures with no more than 2 hit dice per level of the caster. The caster can only change into a form that has no more hit dice
than the caster’s normal form. The caster cannot take the form of
The target is given all special abilities of the new form, including a specific individual, only a generic individual of the desired race
thinking and behaving as the new form. or species.

It cannot create a duplicate of a specific individual, only a generic The caster’s basic statistics (armour class, hit points, attack rolls, and
individual of the desired race or monster species; and if something saving throws) do not change, and the caster does not get special
is polymorphed into a human or demi-human then it will not or magical abilities of the new form (such as the breath of a dragon
have class levels. or hellhound, or the regeneration ability of a troll).

Table 7–7: Polymorph Any Object Durations The caster does get the basic physical characteristics and physical
Original Polymorphed Object Type attacks of the new form (such as a dragon’s flight and a hellhound’s
Object Type Animal Plant Non-living bite). The caster cannot cast spells while polymorphed.
Animal Permanent 1 hour/level 10 mins/level
If the caster is killed while polymorphed, this spell ends and they
Plant 1 hour/level Permanent 1 hour/level revert back to their normal shape. It also ends if dispelled.
Non-living 10 mins/level 1 hour/level Permanent
An immortal under the effect of this spell retains their aura.

Polymorph Other Power Word Blind


Matter Energy
Magic-User 4, Elf 4 Magic-User 8, Elf 8
Target: one living creature Target: one creature
Range: 60’ Range: 120’
Duration: permanent Duration: special
This spell changes a living (not undead or non-living) creature into This spell blinds the targeted creature with no saving throw allowed.
a different type of living mortal (not exalted) creature.
Creatures with 40 or fewer hit points are blinded for 1d4 days.
The target creature type must have no more than twice the num- Creatures with 41–80 hit points are blinded for 2d4 hours. Crea-
ber of hit dice that the original creature has, and the creature’s hit tures with 81+ hit points are unaffected by the spell.
points do not change.

The target of this spell can make a saving throw vs. spells to avoid
the effect.

The change can be dispelled by a Dispel Magic spell.

125
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Power Word Kill Once the wall is in place, only the caster may move through it
Energy without effect, and the wall may not be moved by any force – not
Magic-User 9, Elf 9 even a Wish spell.
Target: one or more living creatures
Range: 120’ The wall must be created where there is room for it. If there are
Duration: instant creatures or objects blocking the wall then it will form around them
This spell can be cast on either a single living (not undead or non- without affecting them.
living) creature or a group of creatures.
Each magical barrier is a different colour, starting with violet – the
If cast on a single creature with 60 or fewer hit points the creature barrier closest to the caster – and ending with red.
dies. If cast on a single creature with 61–100 hit points the creature
is stunned for 1d4x10 minutes. Creatures with 101+ hit points are Any creature trying to pass through the barrier will be affected by
unaffected by the spell. each layer in turn as they move through. A creature with an Anti-
Magic Shell spell active (including the caster) cannot pass through
If cast on a group of up to five creatures, any of them with 20 or the barriers but cannot be affected by them either.
fewer hit points will die, but any with 21+ hit points will be unaf-
fected by the spell. Each barrier has a different effect, and can only be destroyed in
a specific way or by a Wish spell, which will destroy the nearest
The target or targets of this do not get a saving throw unless they three barriers to the caster. In either case, only the barrier closest to
are magic-users or can cast magic-user spells. Even if they can cast the creature trying to destroy it can be destroyed. A barrier in the
such spells, they must make a saving throw vs. spells at a penalty middle of the wall cannot be destroyed even in the listed manner
of –4 in order to avoid the effects of this spell. while there is another barrier between it and the creature trying
to destroy it.
Power Word Stun
Energy The barriers extend into the ethereal plane and have their full effect
Magic-User 7, Elf 7 there as well as on the material plane.
Target: one creature
Range: 120’ Red: This barrier inflicts 12 points of damage (no save allowed) to
Duration: special any creature that crosses it. It blocks all magical missiles, and can
This spell stuns the targeted creature with no saving throw. only be destroyed by taking (any amount of ) magical cold damage.

Creatures with 35 or fewer hit points are stunned for 2d6x10 Orange: This barrier inflicts 24 points of damage (no save allowed)
minutes. Creatures with 36–70 hit points are stunned for 1d6x10 to any creature that crosses it. It blocks all non-magical missiles,
minutes. Creatures with 71+ hit points are unaffected by the spell. and can only be destroyed by taking (any amount of ) magical
lightning damage.
Predict Weather
Druid 1 Yellow: This barrier inflicts 48 points of damage (no save allowed)
Target: caster to any creature that crosses it. It blocks all breath weapons, and
Range: personal can only be destroyed by a Magic Missile spell.
Duration: instant
This spell lets the caster know exactly what the weather will be like Green: This barrier kills any creature that crosses it unless they
for the next 12 hours, over a range of 1 mile per level of the caster. can make a saving throw vs. spells. It blocks all forms of magical
detection, and can only be destroyed by a Passwall spell.
Prismatic Wall
Entropy Blue: This barrier turns any creature that crosses it to stone un-
Magic-User 9, Elf 9 less they can make a saving throw vs. petrification. It blocks all
Target: special poisons, gasses and gaze attacks, and can only be destroyed by a
Range: special Disintegrate spell.
Duration: 1 hour
This spell creates seven magical barriers, each a quarter of an inch Indigo: This barrier transports any creature that touches it to a ran-
apart, that between them form a two-inch thick magical wall. dom outer plane unless they can make a saving throw vs. spells. It
blocks all matter, and can only be destroyed by a Dispel Magic spell.
The wall can either be created as a 10’ radius sphere around the
caster or as a vertical wall of up to 500 square feet within 60’ of Violet: This barrier knocks any creature that crosses it unconscious
the caster. and sends them permanently insane, unless they make a saving
throw vs. spells (only one saving throw is needed to avoid both
effects at once). The insanity can only be cured by a Cureall spell

126
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
or a Wish spell. It blocks all magic, and can only be destroyed by If the caster attacks a creature that is being blocked by this spell
a Continual Light spell. from touching them, that individual creature is no longer blocked.
The to-hit penalty still applies to the creature, however.
Produce Fire
Druid 2 Protection from Evil 10’ Radius
Target: caster Spirit, Antipathy
Range: personal Cleric 4, Druid 4, Magic-User 3, Elf 3
Duration: 20 mins/level Target: 10’ radius
This spell causes a small ball of flame to appear in the caster’s hand. Range: personal
The flame sheds light as a torch, and does not burn the caster. Duration: 2 hours
This spell creates a 10’ radius barrier around the caster’s body that
The caster can cause the flame to disappear or reappear by concen- protects all within it from various creatures.
trating for a round at any time during the duration of the spell.
No creature that is magically summoned, controlled, charmed
The fire can be thrown up to 30’ by the caster and will set fire to or possessed can touch those within the barrier. Neither can any
particularly flammable objects that it hits or do 1d4 damage to a creature that can only be hit by magical weapons. Such creatures
creature. can still throw or shoot things at those within.

In either case, the flame will then disappear, although the caster can Additionally, all attacks against creatures within the barrier are at
make it reappear again (back in their hand) as normal. a –1 penalty to hit and those creatures get a +1 bonus to all saving
throws while inside.
Projected Image
Energy If anyone within the barrier attacks a creature that is being blocked
Magic-User 6, Elf 6, Sorcerer 6 by this spell from touching them, that individual creature is no
Target: special longer blocked from touching anyone inside the barrier. The to-hit
Range: personal penalty still applies to the creature, however.
Duration: 1 hour
This spell causes an illusionary duplicate of the caster to appear Protection from Lightning
within 240’ of the real caster. Druid 4
Target: one creature
For the duration of the spell, the caster can control the image’s Range: touch
actions by concentrating (the caster can have the image walk as Duration: 10 mins/level
they walk) and any spells cast by the caster will appear to be cast by This spell protects the target from lightning damage. The spell will
the image – although the caster must be able to see the targets of stop a total of 1 die of damage (of whatever die type the attack uses)
the spell as normal, the caster cannot see through the image’s eyes. per level of the caster from attacks. In the case of dragon breath,
each hit dice of the dragon counts as a damage die.
The duplicate is armour class 9, but will not be affected by spells
or missile attacks. It will disappear if touched. Dice that are stopped by this spell are removed before rolling the
damage.
Protection from Evil
Spirit, Antipathy Protection from Normal Missiles
Cleric 1, Druid 1, Shaman 1, Magic-User 1, Elf 1, Sorcerer 1 Entropy
Target: caster Magic-User 3, Elf 3
Range: personal Target: one creature
Duration: 2 hours Range: 30’
This spell creates a barrier an inch away from the caster’s body that Duration: 2 hours
protects the caster from various creatures. This spell stops all small non-magical missiles (arrows, bolts, sling
stones, thrown weapons, etc.) from striking the target creature.
No creature that is magically summoned, controlled, charmed or
possessed can touch the caster. Large missiles such as those from siege weaponry and magical mis-
siles are not blocked by this spell.
Neither can any creature that can only be hit by magical weapons.
Such creatures can still throw or shoot things at the caster.

Additionally, all attacks against the caster are at a –1 penalty to hit
and the caster gets a +1 bonus to all saving throws for the duration
of this spell.

127
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Protection from Poison Raise Dead (r)
Druid 3 Vitality/Inertia
Target: one creature Cleric 5, Druid 5
Range: touch Target: one human or demi-human
Duration: 10 mins/level Range: 120’
This spell makes the target completely immune to all non-magical Duration: permanent
poisons, and magical poison spells such as the Cloudkill spell. It This spell raises the body of a human or demi-human from the dead.
also gives the target a +4 bonus to all saving throws against the
poisonous breath weapons that some creatures possess. If the body has been dead for more than four days per level of the
caster above 7th then this spell will not work.
Purify Food and Water
Purity The body must be reasonably whole for this spell to work, and
Cleric 1, Druid 1 severed or missing body parts will still be missing afterwards, pos-
Target: special sibly leading to disability.
Range: 10’
Duration: permanent The target returns to life in a weakened state that lasts until they
This spell will purify spoiled or poisoned food and drink. have had two weeks of bed rest, being unable to move faster than
a walk and unable to attack or cast spells or use class abilities.
It will affect enough fresh food to feed a dozen people, or enough Additionally, the target has only 1 hit point and cannot be cured
preserved food (making it fresh again) for one person, or enough further until they have rested for the two weeks.
water for six people.
A Cureall spell can be used to remove the two week rest period, but
The spell will purify muddy or otherwise dirty water by settling will not do this and also cure the target at the same time.
out the sediment, but will have no effect on water-based creatures.
If a Raise Dead spell is cast on an undead creature with 9 or fewer
Quest (r) hit dice, the creature must make a saving throw vs. spells or be
Despair/Hope destroyed. Vampires are not destroyed by this spell, but forced
Cleric 5, Druid 5 into gaseous form and forced to retreat to their coffins until the
Target: one living creature following night.
Range: 30’
Duration: special If Raise Dead is cast on an undead creature with more than 9 hit
This spell forces the target to perform a specific action. The target dice, the creature takes 3d10 damage, although it can make a saving
may make a saving throw vs. spells to escape the effect. throw vs. spells to take only half damage.

The action must be something that is possible, and can’t be some- When a character becomes an immortal, this spell will not bring
thing suicidal – for example you can’t Quest someone into jumping their former mortal body back to life.
off a cliff.
Reverse: Finger of Death will kill any one living creature within 60’
The target must perform the action, but they are not mind con- unless it can make a saving throw vs. spells. Undead targeted by a
trolled in any way, and they are fully aware that they may only be Finger of Death spell are cured of 3d10 damage.
performing the action in order to avoid the consequences of this
spell. Raise Dead Fully (r)
Vitality/Inertia
If the target goes against the quest, they receive a Curse, as if by the Cleric 7, Druid 7
reversed form of the Remove Curse spell. Neither this curse nor the Target: one dead creature
Quest itself can be dispelled or removed via a Remove Curse spell, Range: 60’
although a Dispel Evil will remove it. The curse will not lift until Duration: permanent
the quest is fulfilled. This spell raises the body of any formerly living creature from the
dead.
This spell cannot affect an immortal, even if cast by another im-
mortal. If the body has been dead for more than four months per level of
the caster above 16th then this spell will not work.
Reverse: Remove Quest will remove an unwanted Quest, although
for each level the caster of the Quest is above the caster of the If the body has been dismembered, eaten or otherwise damaged,
Remove Quest there is a 5% chance of failure. then only a small piece of it – a lock of hair or a sliver of bone –  is
needed to cast this spell, and the whole body will re-form around
that piece. The piece must have been recovered from the body
after death.

128
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
If the target is a human or demi-human, they are raised back up Read Languages
to full health and can immediately use abilities and spells with no Spirit
rest period required. Magic-User 1, Elf 1, Sorcerer 1
Target: caster
If the target is not a human or demi-human, they return to life Range: personal
in a weakened state that lasts until they have had two weeks of Duration: 20 minutes
bed rest, being unable to move faster than a walk and unable to This spell lets the caster read (but not speak or write) any non-
attack or cast spells or use class abilities. Additionally, the target magical written language or code.
has only 1 hit point and cannot be cured further until they have
rested for the two weeks. Read Magic
Spirit
A Cureall spell can be used to remove the two week rest period, but Magic-User 1, Elf 1, Sorcerer 1
will not do this and also cure the target at the same time. Target: caster
Range: personal
If a Raise Dead Fully spell is cast on an undead creature with 7 or Duration: 10 minutes
fewer hit dice, the creature is destroyed with no saving throw. This spell lets the caster read magical runes and writings. Once a
particular magical inscription has been read by this spell, the caster
If a Raise Dead Fully spell is cast on an undead creature with 8–14 can re-read it at any time without needing to cast this spell again.
hit dice, the creature must make a saving throw vs. spells with a –4
penalty or be destroyed. The most common use of this spell is to read magical scrolls.

If Raise Dead Fully is cast on an undead creature with 15+ hit dice, Reincarnation
the creature takes 6d10 damage, although it can make a saving Spirit
throw vs. spells to take only half damage. Magic-User 6, Elf 6, Sorcerer 6
Target: one dead creature
When a character becomes an immortal, this spell will not bring Range: 10’
their former mortal body back to life. Duration: permanent
This spell creates a new body – not necessarily of the same spe-
Reverse: Obliterate will kill any one living creature. cies – to house the life-force of a dead creature. There is no limit
on how long the creature can have been dead for, but the caster
If an Obliterate spell is cast on a living creature with 7 or fewer hit must have part of the creature’s body to cast this spell. If the body
dice or levels, the creature is killed with no saving throw. has been dismembered, eaten or otherwise damaged, then only a
small piece of it – a lock of hair or a sliver of bone –  is needed to
If an Obliterate spell is cast on a living creature with 8–14 hit dice cast this spell, and the new body will re-form around that piece.
or levels, the creature must make a saving throw vs. spells with The piece must have been recovered from the body after death.
a –4 penalty or be killed.
A human who comes back in a human body has the same class
If Obliterate is cast on a living creature with 15+ hit dice or levels, and level as before they died. A demi-human who comes back
the creature takes 6d10 damage, although it can make a saving in a human body has the same experience points as before they
throw vs. spells to take only half damage. died, and will be the class that is closest to their racial class (elf =
magic-user, dwarf = fighter, halfling or lupine = fighter or thief at
If Obliterate is cast on an undead creature, it will cure nearly all the player’s choice).
damage from the target, leaving them with only 1d6 damage – al-
though if the target is already healthier than that it won’t damage A human or demi-human who comes back in a demi-human body
them. has the same experience points as before they died, but now has
the racial class that corresponds to their new race.
Alternatively, the spell can be used on an undead creature as a Re-
move Curse, Cure Disease or Cure Blindness spell, or it can be used A humanoid that comes back in a human or demi-human body
to cure an undead creature of a Feeblemind spell. However, it will will be a normal commoner without a class or levels. A human
only cure one thing per casting. or demi-human that comes back in a humanoid body will be a
normal member of that race and unable to gain further experience.

When a creature is reincarnated, roll 1d8, and consult the list below:

1 to 2 = original race or species


3 to 5 = a close race or species
6 to 7 = a distant race or species
8 = a very distant race or species

129
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
A “close” race is one that is similar in both form and outlook to the that do not normally allow saving throws, with a bonus on the
original race. For example, humans and demi-humans are close to saving throw equal to the caster’s level.
each other, and goblins and hobgoblins are close to each other – but
a human is not close to a goblin. Remove Fear can be cast on a target who is already afraid, and will
either remove or allow an immediate saving throw against the fear as
A “distant” race is one that is similar in either form or outlook, but above. This spell will also remove the terror effect of an immortal’s
not both, to the original race. For example humans and kobolds aura, but only when cast by an immortal.
are distant from each other, as are elves and treants.
Reverse: Cause Fear can be cast on any living creature within 120’
A “very distant” race is one that is similar in neither form nor and will make it flee in terror for 20 minutes unless it can make
outlook, for example humans and badgers. a saving throw vs. spells. If the target is cornered, they will cower
and fight only to defend themselves.
In any case, the exact race or species must be determined by the
Game Master. Resist Cold
Vitality
When a character becomes an immortal, this spell will not bring Cleric 1, Druid 1
their former mortal body back to life. Target: 30’ radius
Range: personal
Remove Curse (r) Duration: 1 hour
Spirit, Hope/Despair This spell protects all creatures in the area from frostbite in freezing
Cleric 3, Druid 3, Shaman 3, Magic-User 4, Elf 4, Sorcerer 4 temperatures, gives each creature a +2 bonus to saving throws made
Target: one creature or item against cold based attacks, and reduces all magical cold damage by
Range: touch one point per die of damage (to a minimum of 1 damage per die).
Duration: permanent In the case of dragon breath, each hit dice of the dragon counts
This spell removes a curse from a creature or item. Some very as a damage die.
powerful curses may not be removable with this spell.
Resist Fire
Reverse: Curse gives the target a curse unless they can make a sav- Vitality
ing throw vs. spells. Cleric 2, Druid 2
Target: one creature
The exact nature of the curse is up to the caster, although the fol- Range: 30’
lowing are typical effects. Duration: 20 minutes
This spell protects the target from being burned by natural fires,
◊ Something that produces up to a –4 penalty to attacks (e.g. Blind- gives them a +2 bonus to saving throws made against fire based
ness) attacks, and reduces all magical fire damage by one point per die
of damage (to a minimum of 1 damage per die). In the case of
◊ Something that produces up to a –2 penalty on saving throws dragon breath, each hit dice of the dragon counts as a damage die.
(such as a susceptibility to poison)
Restore (r)
◊ Something that produces up to a –2 penalty to social interactions Purity/corruption
(such as smelling like a corpse) Cleric 7, Druid 7
Target: one creature
◊ Something that causes a halving of a single ability score (such Range: touch
as withering of a limb). Duration: permanent
This spell restores one level that has been drained from the target
Using the Curse spell to inflict effects other than things in this list by an Energy Drain spell or an energy draining creature. The target
require the Game Master’s permission. is restored to the exact experience total that they had before they
were energy drained. If the target has already gained more experi-
Remove Fear (r) ence than that since the Energy Drain then this spell does not add
Hope/Despair extra experience. Restore can also be used to remove a magical aging
Cleric 1, Druid 1 effect from a creature, restoring them to their normal age (plus any
Target: one living creature time that has passed since the magical aging happened). It will not
Range: touch remove natural aging.
Duration: 20 minutes
This spell makes the touched creature resist fear effects. Any fear Unless the caster of this spell is an immortal, they temporarily lose
effect that allows a saving throw will automatically be resisted by a level when casting this spell as if they had been energy drained
the target. The target is also allowed a saving throw against effects themselves. However, this level is recovered after 2d20 days of rest.

130
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Reverse: Energy Drain drains a single level from the target, who Shield
the caster must touch (make a normal attack), but who gets no Matter
saving throw. Magic-User 1, Elf 1
Target: caster
If an immortal casts Energy Drain at another immortal, the target Range: personal
must make a saving throw vs. power or lose 5pp. Immortals can- Duration: 20 minutes
not lose levels due to Energy Drain, even if they have no power This spell creates a magical barrier an inch away from the caster’s
points left. body that shields the caster from harm.

Reverse Gravity While this spell is in effect, the caster has an armour class of 2
Entropy against missile attacks and an armour class of 4 against all other
Magic-User 7, Elf 7 attacks rather than their normal armour class of 9.
Target: 30’ radius
Range: 90’ This spell also grants the caster a saving throw vs. spells each time
Duration: 2 seconds they would be hit by the missile from a Magic Missile spell. If the
This spell reverses the pull of gravity on all creatures within a 15’ saving throw fails, the missile hits the caster normally. If the sav-
radius of the target point. The creatures will fall upwards for the ing throw succeeds, the missile is blocked, but this spell is ends
duration of the spell, falling a maximum of 65’. Then, at the end immediately.
of the spell’s duration, they will fall back to the floor again.
When cast by an immortal, this spell gives the caster a –4 ac bonus
There is no saving throw against this spell. against missile attacks and a –2 ac bonus against other attacks.

Creatures who hit obstacles on either the upwards or downwards Silence 15’ Radius
fall take 1d6 damage per 10’ fallen. Destruction
Cleric 2, Druid 2
Shapechange Target: 15’ radius
Matter Range: 180’
Magic-User 9, Elf 9 Duration: 2 hours
Target: caster This spell makes it impossible for any noise to be produced in the
Range: personal targeted area. However, noises from outside the area can still be
Duration: 10 mins/level heard from within it.
This spell allows the caster to change their shape into that of other
races or mortal (not exalted) species. The caster can change shape The spell can be cast at an area, in which case the effect is static until
as often as they like during the spell’s duration, with each change the duration ends or it is dispelled, or it can be cast at a creature, in
taking a round. which case the creature must make a saving throw vs. spells. If the
saving throw fails, the spell moves with the creature. If the saving
The caster cannot take the form of a specific individual, only a throw succeeds, the spell still works centred on the creature’s cur-
generic individual of the desired race or species. The caster’s basic rent position; but does not move with the creature.
statistics (armour class, attack rolls, number of attacks) change,
although the caster’s hit points and saving throws do not. Sleep
Spirit
The caster does get the special abilities of the new form (such as the Magic-User 1, Elf 1, Sorcerer 1
breath of a dragon or hellhound, and the regeneration ability of a Target: creatures in a 20’ radius
troll). This applies to flaws of the form as well as benefits. Range: 240’
Duration: 4d4 x 10 minutes
The caster cannot cast spells while shapechanged, unless in the form This spell puts one or more creatures to sleep. Roll 2d8 to see how
of a bipedal humanoid. many hit dice worth of creatures are slept by the effect.

In any case, the caster can only cast their own spells, not spells that Go through all the living (not undead or non-living) creatures
are innate to the form (such as a dryad’s innate Charm Person spell). in the area with fewer than 5 hit dice or levels, starting with the
If the caster is killed while shapechanged, this spell ends and they closest to the target point of the spell. If there are enough hit dice
revert back to their normal shape. It also ends if dispelled. left from the roll, that creature is slept with no saving throw and
their hit dice are taken from the running total. Once there are no
A shapechanged caster cannot pass through a Protection from Evil more creatures left with fewer (or equal) hit dice to the number of
spell or an Anti-Magic Shell spell. hit dice left over, the spell stops.

A shapechanged immortal retains their aura, and can cast spells


regardless of form.

131
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Falling to the ground when slept by this spell will not wake the The spirit of the deceased will always reply in a language known to
target up, and neither will noise. Targets will awaken if kicked, the caster, and must answer the questions truthfully, but a hostile
shaken or otherwise physically disturbed. spirit may equivocate and mislead if it chooses providing it does
not directly lie.
Sleeping creatures are considered to be helpless opponents (see
Chapter 10 – Combat for details). The spirit will only have knowledge of things that it experienced
when it was alive.
Snake Charm
Sympathy Speak with Monsters (r)
Cleric 2, Druid 2, Shaman 2 Sympathy/Antipathy
Target: one or more snakes Cleric 6, Druid 6, Shaman 6
Range: 60’ Target: 30’ radius
Duration: special Range: personal
This spell charms 1 hit dice of snakes per level of the caster, with Duration: 1 rnd/level
no saving throw allowed. This spell lets the caster communicate with any creature for the
duration.
The affected snakes will rise up and sway, and will not attack any
creature unless they are attacked themselves. The depth of communication is limited by the intelligence of the
creature being communicated with, although even unintelligent
If this spell is cast on snakes that are attacking the caster, it lasts creatures which do not normally communicate can do so in a
for 1d4+1 rounds. If cast on snakes that are not attacking the caster, rudimentary fashion if this spell is used.
it lasts for 10 minutes + 1d4 x 10 minutes.
Reverse: Babble causes one target within 60’ of the caster to be
After the spell duration has ended, the snakes return to their normal completely unable to communicate with other creatures for 10
behaviour. minutes per caster level, unless they can make a saving throw vs.
spells with a –2 penalty.
Speak with Animal
Sympathy Any attempt to communicate with others – including hand signals,
Cleric 2, Druid 2, Shaman 2 telepathy and writing will be garbled.
Target: caster
Range: personal The target can still cast spells, but is unable to use magic items that
Duration: 1 hour require command words to activate them.
This spell lets the caster communicate with a single species of ani-
mal for the duration. The species named must be a normal type of Speak with Plants
animal, not a magical or intelligent type. The communication is Sympathy
limited by the intelligence of the animal being communicated with. Cleric 4, Druid 4, Shaman 4
Target: caster
Speak with Dead Range: personal
Inertia Duration: 30 minutes
Cleric 3, Druid 3 This spell allows the caster to talk to plants, which will respond as
Target: one corpse if they were intelligent.
Range: 10’
Duration: 1 rnd/level Normal plants will be friendly to the caster, and are able to move
This spell lets the caster ask three questions to a dead body. slowly while under the influence of this spell in order to obey
simple commands from the caster, such as picking something up
The spirit of the deceased will is summoned and must answer the or leaning out of the way of a path.
questions, although it cannot interact in any other way unless it is
already an undead creature such as a ghost or spectre. The spell also allows the caster to talk to plant-like monsters, al-
though it does not influence them.
The caster must possess a part of the corpse, such as a lock of hair
or a piece of bone. The age of the corpse that can be spoken with Statue
by use of this spell depends on the level of the caster: Matter
Magic-User 7, Elf 7
6th–7th = 4 days Target: personal
8th–14th = 4 months Range: caster
15th–20th = 4 years Duration: 20 mins/level
21st+ = unlimited This spell allows the caster to transform to or from a statue as of-
ten as they like during the duration. Each transformation takes a

132
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
round. The caster can even turn back to normal after having been obey the caster, and then turn back to sticks when either the dura-
petrified by a monster’s attack or a spell, providing this spell was tion ends or they are killed.
already active when the petrification happened.
Stone to Flesh (r)
While in stone form, the caster cannot move or cast spells (but can Entropy
continue to concentrate on spells already cast). The caster is armour Magic-User 6, Elf 6, Sorcerer 6
class –4, and cannot be hurt by non-magical weapons or by cold Target: one creature or object
or fire attacks. The caster does not need to breathe while in statue Range: 120’
form and is immune to poison, drowning, and gas-based attacks. Duration: permanent
This spell turns any one stone object (or a 10’x10’x10’ section of
When this spell is active but the caster is in normal form, the caster stone wall) to flesh. If the stone object is a petrified creature or part
gets a +5 bonus on initiative rolls if their action for the round is of one, then the creature will be restored by this spell (although
to turn to statue form. they may immediately die if there are parts missing).

Steelform If the stone object is not a petrified creature or part of one, then
Matter it turns into a gelatinous mass of shapeless skin, fat and dead flesh
Magic-User 8, Elf 8 with tufts of coarse hair and the occasional eye. The lump of flesh
Target: none has no proper internal structure or bones, and cannot support its
Range: touch own weight. It cannot be raised or reincarnated, since it has never
Duration: permanent had a life-force.
This spell creates a sheet of high quality steel up to 2” thick and
up to 500 square feet in area. The sheet can be created flat or can The meat is edible, although it smells and tastes foul.
be created pre-shaped.
Reverse: Flesh to Stone will permanently turn one living creature
The steel does not appear instantly, but takes time to form, ranging (including all equipment carried) into stone unless the target makes
from a single round for a simple sheet of steel to two hours to create a saving throw vs. petrification.
something with a precise specification, such as a sword.
If an immortal is petrified by this spell, it only lasts for one round
Whatever the complexity of the shape, the steel must form a single per hit dice the immortal has, and the target remains fully aware
piece with no moving parts. of their surroundings while petrified. An immortal whose manifest
form is petrified can still switch to spirit form.
However, the caster can create the steel in a “rough” form, which
can then have the Steelform spell cast on it again in order to either Stoneform
add to the object or reshape it. Matter
Magic-User 6, Elf 6
If the caster does create the steel in rough form, then this spell is Target: none
cast once again to “set” the steel in its final form so that other cast- Range: touch
ers can’t cast this spell on it in order to modify it. Duration: permanent
This spell creates a mass of stone up to 1,000 cubic feet in area. The
Note that whatever shape the sheet takes, it is always a maximum mass can be arranged in any manner the caster desires.
of 2” thick – so that if it is formed into a statue, for example, the
statue would be hollow. The stone does not appear instantly, but takes time to form, ranging
from a single round for a simple stone wall to two hours to create
Once created, the steel is real and cannot be dispelled, and it will something with a precise specification, such as a statue.
last until it is physically or magically destroyed.
The stone created by this spell can be as soft as chalk or as hard
Sticks to Snakes as granite, but cannot be a precious or semi-precious stone. The
Vitality exception to this is that the spell can create clear (or tinted) lead
Cleric 4, Druid 4 crystal of a fine enough quality to be used for windows.
Target: up to 16 sticks
Range: 120’ Whatever the complexity of the shape, the stone must form a single
Duration: 1 hour piece with no moving parts. However, the caster can create the
This spell turns a number of normal sticks into snakes. stone in a “rough” form, which can then have the Stoneform spell
cast on it again in order to either add to the object or reshape it.
Roll 2d8. That many sticks in range turn into small snakes. If the caster does create the stone in rough form, then this spell
is cast once again to “set” the stone in its final form so that other
Each snake has an equal chance to be a pit viper or a racer (see casters can’t cast this spell on it in order to modify it.
Chapter 18 – Monsters for details of these snakes). The snakes

133
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Note that whatever shape the stone takes, it cannot be created in this spell is cast more than once during the same day, a different
the space where another object exists and must be created on a type of elemental must be summoned each time.
surface that can support its weight.
While the caster controls the elemental, they can make it do any-
Once created, the stone is real and cannot be dispelled, and it will thing it is capable of doing, including fighting to the death on the
last until it is physically or magically destroyed. caster’s behalf. The caster can also send the controlled elemental
home.
Striking
Vitality The caster does not need to concentrate to keep controlling the
Cleric 3, Druid 3 elemental.
Target: one weapon
Range: 30’ A summoned elemental is blocked by a Protection from Evil, and
Duration: 10 minutes can be sent home by a Dispel Magic or a Dispel Evil.
This spell temporarily enchants a weapon to do extra damage. It
can only be cast on hand-held weapons or missile weapons, not Summon Object
on the natural weaponry of a creature. Entropy
Magic-User 7, Elf 7
Until the duration ends, the weapon does an extra 1d6 damage to Target: one object in caster’s home
anything it hits, and can hit creatures that are only hit by magi- Range: infinite
cal weapons (although it does not grant the weapon any magical Duration: instant
bonuses to hit). This spell summons a non-living object weighing 50 pounds or
less from the caster’s home to their hand, no matter how great the
Summon Animals distance even if the caster is on another plane, but providing the
Druid 4 caster is in the same celestial sphere as their home. The object must
Target: special be no bigger than a staff or small chest.
Range: 360’
Duration: 30 minutes The caster must know the exact location of the item, and must be
This spell summons one or more animals within range. It only familiar with it.
affects normal, non-magical animals, and not normal insects and
arthropods. The item must also have been prepared beforehand by sprinkling
it with a special powder that costs 1,000 gold pieces per item. The
The caster may specify a particular species or group of animals powder evaporates as part of the preparation process, and does
(but not individual named animals) or may summon any animals not affect the item in any way once the preparation is complete.
in range.
If the item is a container of some sort, it will appear without its
The minimum number of animals that arrive will be none – if contents – even if those contents have been independently prepared.
there are no animals within range – and the maximum number of
animals is a number whose hit dice are equal to the caster’s level. If another creature has taken the object from where the caster
Tiny animals (such as mice, songbirds, frogs, rabbits etc.) count as placed it, the object will not be summoned – but the caster will
a tenth of a hit dice each. know roughly where the object is and who has it.

When the animals arrive, they will understand the caster’s instruc- If an immortal casts this spell while in a mortal form, it will not
tions and help the caster in any way they can, although if they are summon objects from the home of the immortal’s manifest form.
attacked by anything they will not fight to the death but will flee
instead – although if the caster is already in combat when the ani- Summon Weather
mals arrive, they will fight to help the caster unless badly injured. Druid 6
Target: one weather phenomenon
When deciding which animals answer the summons, animals that Range: 5+ miles
the caster can see will be affected first, even if they are currently Duration: 1 hour/level
hostile to the caster. This spell summons a weather phenomenon within range that the
caster is aware of (either by being able to see it or knowing about
Summon Elemental it through a Predict Weather spell or other form or scrying) to the
Druid 7 caster’s current location.
Target: none
Range: 240’ The weather phenomenon must be within 5 miles, plus a mile for
Duration: 1 hour every caster level above 15th.
When this spell is cast, a 16 hit dice elemental (see Chapter 18 –
Monsters for statistics) will appear within 240’ of the caster. If

134
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Particularly powerful weather conditions such as hurricanes, torna- Merely seeing the rune is not enough to make it work, but reading
does, etc. Can only be summoned by a caster of 21st level or higher. the rune aloud will also trigger it with no saving throw.

Survival A character using the Read Magic spell can read a rune safely in order
Matter, Hope to identify which type of rune it is without triggering it.
Cleric 7, Druid 7, Magic-User 9, Elf 9
Target: one creature A Symbol can be triggered any number of times, and will remain
Range: touch active until dispelled.
Duration: 1 hour / level
This spell protects the target from harmful environments. If placed on an object, the Symbol must be exposed for it to work.
A Symbol will not work if it is covered over and hidden.
The target is completely protected from normal heat and cold, and
can survive without air, food, water or sleep. Symbol Of Death: Kills any creature with 75 hit points or fewer.
Creatures with more than 75 hit points are unaffected.
This spell does not protect the target against attacks of any kind,
only the natural environment. It does protect completely from the Symbol Of Discord: Confuses the creature permanently, as if the
environment of other planes, and even the luminiferous aether. Confusion spell had been cast upon them. The confusion can be
cured by a Cureall spell or a Wish spell.
Sword
Energy Symbol Of Fear: Causes the target to flee for 30 rounds.
Magic-User 7, Elf 7
Target: none Symbol Of Insanity: Causes the victim to be driven permanently
Range: 30’ insane and unable to cast spells. The insanity can only be cured by
Duration: 1 rnd/level a Cureall spell or a Wish spell.
This spell creates a glowing sword made from magical force next
to the caster. Symbol Of Sleep: Sends the creature into a magical sleep
for 1d10+10 hours, which they cannot be woken from unless the
The caster can make the sword attack any creature within 30’ by sleep is dispelled.
concentrating. The sword flies to the target and attacks.
Symbol Of Stunning: Stuns any creature with 150 or fewer hit
If the caster stops concentrating, the sword stops attacking, but points for 2d6x10 minutes.
remains in existence and returns to the caster’s side, following
them for the duration. Immortals are immune to the effects of Symbol spells, even if cast
by other immortals.
The sword attacks twice per round, making attacks at the caster’s
base attack bonus for 1d10 damage. The sword has no magical Telekinesis
bonuses to its attack rolls, but can hit any target. Energy
Magic-User 5, Elf 5
The sword cannot be physically damaged in any way, but may be Target: one object or creature
dispelled. Range: 120’
Duration: 6 rounds
Symbol This spell lets the caster move an object or creature weighing up
Entropy to 20 pounds per level of the caster by concentrating on it.
Magic-User 8, Elf 8
Target: special The object can be moved at a speed of 20’ per round.
Range: touch
Duration: permanent If the target is a creature, it can avoid the effect by making a saving
This spell creates a glowing magical rune that can be traced either throw vs. spells.
on an object or surface or even traced in the air.
If the target is an object being held by a creature, such as a weapon
The rune can have one of six different effects, chosen at the time in the creature’s hand, the creature can make a saving throw vs.
of casting. spells with a –2 penalty in order to keep hold of the object – but
if the caster is high enough level to move the weight of both the
Any creature that passes through a rune in the air, or touches the object and creature together, this will result in the creature being
object on which the rune is placed, is affected by the rune imme- dragged along with the object unless they let go.
diately with no saving throw allowed.
If the target is an object being carried (but not held) by a creature,
such as a weapon in the creature’s scabbard, the creature can make

135
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
a saving throw vs. spells with a –5 penalty in order to keep hold Teleport Any Object
of the object. Energy
Magic-User 7, Elf 7
However if the caster is high enough level to move the weight of Target: one object or creature
both the object and creature together, this will result in the creature Range: touch
being dragged along with the object unless they let go. Duration: instant
This spell instantly transports one creature or object that weighs up
If the target is an object being worn by a creature, such as a back- to 50 pounds per level of the caster to another place on the same
pack, it cannot be moved unless the caster is high enough level to plane and within the same celestial sphere. The spell can be used to
move the weight of both the object and creature together, this will transport a 10’x10’x10’ section of rock such as from a wall or floor,
result in the creature being dragged along with the object. but cannot be used in this way to transport only part of a creature.

Teleport The caster can use this spell to transport themselves, and if doing
Energy so there is no chance of error.
Magic-User 5, Elf 5
Target: one living creature The destination can be any distance from the target’s current loca-
Range: 10’ tion, but it cannot be a place occupied by a solid object and must
Duration: instant be a place with a solid ground or floor.
This spell instantly transports a living (not undead or non-living)
creature to another place on the same plane and within the same If the target is unwilling to be teleported, or unwilling to have
celestial sphere. The caster can use this spell to transport themselves. an object that they are holding or carrying teleported, they may
make a saving throw vs. spells with a –2 penalty to avoid the effect.
The destination can be any distance from the target’s current loca-
tion, but it cannot be a place occupied by a solid object and must Unless the caster is teleporting themselves, there is a chance that
be a place with a solid ground or floor. a Teleport spell will result in the target appearing too high or too
low. A character appearing in solid matter (usually because they
If the target is unwilling to be teleported, they may make a saving appeared to low) is instantly killed.
throw vs. spells to avoid the effect.
The chance of failure depends on how familiar the caster is with
There is a chance that a Teleport spell will result in the target ap- the destination:
pearing too high or too low. A character appearing in solid matter
(usually because they appeared to low) is instantly killed. Very Familiar: The caster can see the destination or the caster has
spent several weeks there. Roll 1d100:
The chance of failure depends on how familiar the caster is with
the destination: 01–95 = on target
96–99 = 1d10x10’ too high
Very Familiar: The caster can see the destination or the caster has 00 = 1d10x10’ too low
spent several weeks there. Roll 1d100:
Familiar: The caster has spent more than a day at the destination,
01–95 = on target or has spent several weeks scrying on the destination. Roll 1d100:
96–99 = 1d10x10’ too high
00 = 1d10x10’ too low 01–80 = on target
81–90 = 1d10x10’ too high
Familiar: The caster has spent more than a day at the destination, 91–00 = 1d10x10’ too low
or has spent several weeks scrying on the destination. Roll 1d100:
Unfamiliar: The caster has been to the location but spent less than
01–80 = on target a day there, or the caster is currently scrying the location but has
81–90 = 1d10x10’ too high not studied it. Roll 1d100:
91–00 = 1d10x10’ too low
01–50 = on target
Unfamiliar: The caster has been to the location but spent less than 51–75 = 1d10x10’ too high
a day there, or the caster is currently scrying the location but has 76–00 = 1d10x10’ too low
not studied it. Roll 1d100:

01–50 = on target
51–75 = 1d10x10’ too high
76–00 = 1d10x10’ too low

136
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Timestop The caster can take up to two creatures with them, providing each
Entropy creature is small enough to fit into the plants and each creature
Magic-User 9, Elf 9 is willing.
Target: caster
Range: personal This spell can only be cast once per day.
Duration: 1d4+1 rounds
This spell speeds up the caster so much that from their perspective Travel
time seems to have stopped. Entropy, Vitality
Cleric 7, Druid 7, Magic-User 8, Elf 8
From the caster’s point of view, time has effectively stopped, and Target: special
they have 1d4+1 rounds during which everything else is frozen. Range: personal
Duration: 10 mins/level
The extra rounds that a caster has during this spell are not affected This spell allows the caster, to travel quickly, even from plane to
by Haste and Slow effects that the caster might be under. The caster plane.
always gets the normal one action per round.
The caster can fly at a rate of 120’ per round, and can enter another
During the spell, the caster is still harmed by magical fire, cold, plane (adjacent to the caster’s current plane) by concentrating for a
gas, poison and so on; but not by their non-magical equivalents. round. The caster can only enter one plane per 10 minutes.

The caster can move freely through air and water during the The caster can also use this spell to open up a hole in a celestial
Timestop, but cannot affect creatures or normal objects (other than shell in order to travel from a celestial sphere to the luminiferous
those the caster was carrying when the spell was cast) in any way. aether or vice versa. The hole is 100’ in diameter, and lasts for 10
minutes before closing. Not even a Wish spell can hold such a hole
The caster can cast other spells during the Timestop. Those of instant open for longer.
duration such as a Fireball spell will have no effect on anything
other than the caster, and those with a non-instant duration will The caster can also turn to smoke, and fly at double the normal
not come into effect until the Timestop runs out. rate (240’ per round).

The caster cannot pass through a Protection from Evil or an Anti- While in smoke form the caster cannot use items or cast spells,
Magic Shell during the Timestop. but cannot be hurt by non-magical means. Also, while in smoke
form, the caster cannot pass through a Protection from Evil spell
Immortals within 50’ of the caster when the spell is cast (or whom or an Anti-Magic Shell.
the caster approaches within 50’ during the spell’s duration) are
sped up alongside the caster and can interact with the caster and The caster can bring up to one other creature with them for each
each other normally until they are no longer within 50’. five levels. All passengers must be touching the caster at all times,
and the caster controls the direction and form of travel. Unwilling
Transport Through Plants passengers may make a saving throw vs. spells to avoid the effect.
Druid 6
Target: caster and up to two others The caster must travel with all passengers, they cannot send pas-
Range: touch sengers on while remaining behind.
Duration: instant
This spell allows the caster to magically enter a plant large enough When an immortal is travelling under the effect of this spell, it
to hold them within range that is and emerge from a similar plant costs them 5pp to cross a planar boundary, or 10pp if the planes
at their chosen destination. either side of the boundary are both outer planes. Opening a hole
in a celestial sphere costs an immortal 100pp.
The caster can either specify an exact plant that they wish to emerge
from, or specify a general location; in which case they will emerge Truesight
from a random plant at that location. Truth
Cleric 5, Druid 5
There is no limit to the distance that can be travelled using this Target: caster
spell, although both plants must be alive and both plants must be Range: personal
on the same plane and within the same celestial sphere. Duration: 10 mins + 1 rnd/level
This spell allows the caster to see all ethereal, hidden and invisible
If either plant is dead, or if there is no plant large enough to hold things within 120’. The caster also sees the true form of any dis-
the caster at the specified location, the spell fails. guised, polymorphed and shapechanged creatures.

Finally, the caster can tell the level or hit dice of any creature by
looking at them.

137
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Turn Wood Wall of Iron
Druid 6 Matter
Target: special Magic-User 6, Elf 6, Sorcerer 6
Range: 360’ Target: special
Duration: 10 mins/level Range: 120’
This spell creates an invisible force field 120’ wide and 60’ tall Duration: permanent
anywhere within 30’ of the caster. This spell creates a wall of solid iron, up to 500 square feet in area
and 2’ thick. The entire wall must be within 120’ of the caster.
The field moves away from the caster at 10’ a round until it reaches
a maximum distance of 360’ from the caster. The caster can stop The wall cannot be created in the space occupied by creatures or
the movement of the field at a shorter distance, but if they do so objects, and it must rest on the ground or similar support.
they cannot re-start it again.
The wall is magical and lasts until it is dispelled, disintegrated or
The field pushes all wood and wooden objects, including those held physically destroyed.
by creatures but excluding those securely fastened down, away. The
objects aren’t harmed by the pushing – if pushed against a wall they If the wall is toppled over, it will cause 10d10 damage to those it
won’t be damaged – but can’t be moved back through the field and lands on, and then it crumbles to rust coloured dust and disap-
are therefore probably unusable. pears. Any iron chipped or hacked off the wall also crumbles to
rust coloured dust and disappears.
The caster can cancel the spell at any time, or it can be dispelled.
Otherwise, the force field remains until the end of the duration. Wall of Stone
Matter
Ventriloquism Magic-User 5, Elf 5, Sorcerer 5
Entropy Target: special
Magic-User 1, Elf 1 Range: 60’
Target: one object or location Duration: permanent
Range: 60’ This spell creates a wall of solid stone, up to 500 square feet in
Duration: 20 minutes area and 2’ thick. The entire wall must be within 60’ of the caster.
This spell allows the caster to make the sound of their voice come The wall cannot be created in the space occupied by creatures or
from the targeted object or location rather than from their own objects, and it must rest on the ground or similar support. The wall
mouth. is magical and lasts until it is dispelled, disintegrated or physically
destroyed.
The caster can still cast spells normally while this spell is in effect.
If the wall is toppled over, it will cause 10d10 damage to those
Wall of Fire it lands on, and then it crumbles to sand. Any stone chipped or
Energy hacked off the wall also crumbles to sand and disappears.
Magic-User 4, Elf 4, Sorcerer 4
Target: special Warp Wood
Range: 60’ Druid 2
Duration: concentration Target: one or more wooden weapons
This spell creates a vertical Wall of Fire of any shape with a total Range: 240’
area of up to 1,200 square feet. The entire wall must be within 60’ Duration: permanent
of the caster. The wall cannot be created in the space occupied by This spell causes one or more wooden weapons within range to
creatures or objects. bend and twist and become unusable.

The wall blocks sight, and lasts as long as the caster concentrates. The spell will affect one arrow per level of the caster. Spears, jave-
lins or magical wands count as two arrows each, and clubs, bows,
The wall cannot be pushed through by creatures with less than 4 axe or mace shafts, or staffs count as four arrows each. Weapons
hit dice or levels. Creatures with 4 or more hit dice or levels can wielded by creatures will be unaffected if their holders make a sav-
push through the wall but take 1d6 damage while doing so (cold ing throw vs. spells. Weapons merely carried by creatures get no
based creatures and undead take double damage). Pushing through such saving throw.
does break the wall or leave a hole in it.
Magic items have a 10% chance per magical plus (rolled indepen-
dently of the saving throw, if any) to be unaffected.

138
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Water Breathing To break through or out of the web takes 2d4x10 minutes for
Entropy creatures of human strength. Creatures with giant strength (21+)
Druid 3, Magic-User 3, Elf 3, Sorcerer 3 can break through or out in two rounds, and creatures with ogre
Target: one creature strength (18+) can break through or out in four rounds.
Range: 30’
Duration: 1 day The web is highly flammable and if touched by a flame it will burn
This spell lets the target creature breathe both water and air for away in two rounds doing 1d6 damage to all creatures within it.
its duration and switch between the two automatically even if
unconscious. It does not affect movement in any way. Wind Walker
Sympathy
Weather Control Cleric 6, Druid 6
Entropy Target: none
Druid 7, Magic-User 6, Elf 6 Range: 60’
Target: 720’ radius around caster Duration: 1 day/level
Range: personal This spell summons a wind walker (a type of monster – see Chap-
Duration: concentration ter 18 – Monsters for details) and gives it a specific task. When
This spell allows the caster to control the weather in the surround- the wind walker arrives, the caster must describe a creature or object
ing area. The spell only works outdoors, and lasts as long as the (and can optionally describe its location to make the walker’s task
caster concentrates. easier and more likely to succeed).

The caster may make any of the following conditions, and can The wind walker will then search for the object or creature and do
change the conditions by one minute of concentration: its best (fighting to the death if necessary) to return it to the caster.
It will not be distracted from this task except to defend itself.
◊ Clear: this nullifies any existing weather conditions, and has no
special effect of its own. However, if the duration of the spell runs out before the walker
has returned with the item then the walker will drop the item (if
◊ Fog: reduces visibility to 20’ and halves the movement rate of it already has it) and return immediately to the caster and attempt
all creatures. to slay them unless the caster was an immortal.

◊ Gales: halves the movement rate of all creatures, and makes Wish
missile fire and flying impossible. Gales also speed up the move- Cleric 7, Druid 7, Magic-User 9, Elf 9
ment of sailing ships by 50%. In a desert, sandstorms reduce Target: varies
visibility to 20’. Range: varies
Duration: varies
◊ Heatwave: halves the movement rate of all creatures and after 30 This particularly powerful spell can only be cast by a 36th level
minutes dries up rain, mud and snow. caster with 18 or higher in their spell casting ability score (intel-
ligence for magic-users and elves; wisdom for clerics and druids).
◊ Rain: gives a –2 penalty to attack rolls with missile weapons.
After 30 minutes, the ground turns muddy and non-flying move- The caster speaks a wish out loud and the universe itself – a power
ment is halved. beyond even the immortals, although immortals are certainly ca-
pable of casting this spell – will rearrange matters to make the wish
◊ Snow: visibility is reduced to 20’ and all non-flying creatures come true within limits.
have their movement halved. After 30 minutes, standing water
and slow rivers and streams freeze. When the snow thaws, the If the wish is overly powerful, then it may be only partially granted
ground turns muddy and non-flying movement is halved. or may be granted in a way that fits the caster’s literal wording but
goes against the caster’s intent.
◊ Tornado: treat as a 12 hit dice air elemental (see Chapter 18 –
Monsters for statistics) under the caster’s control. However, usage of this spell should not be allowed to degenerate
into a contest between the player and the Game Master where the
Web player tries to make the wording of the wish as airtight as possible
Matter in order to achieve an effect that the Game Master would otherwise
Magic-User 2, Elf 2, Sorcerer 2 not allow and the Game Master tries their best to find loopholes
Target: 10’x10’x10’ cube in the wording that they can use to mess up the player’s intent.
Range: 10’
Duration: 8 hours Instead, if the Game Master is not happy with the wording of the
This spell creates a mass of sticky web in the area, blocking the area wish because the effect is too powerful they should simply say that
from movement and trapping all those within it. Creatures caught it does not work, and explain what it is about it that they think
in the web can still defend themselves but cannot move. is too powerful.

139
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
The exact limits of this spell are left to the Game Master’s discretion, Wizard Lock
although some default limitations and examples are given below: Entropy
Magic-User 2, Elf 2
◊ A wish can duplicate the effects of any other magic-user spell Target: one portal or other lock
of 8th level or lower, or any other cleric or druid spell of 6th Range: 10’
level or lower. Duration: permanent
This spell magically holds closed any door, gate or other portal; or
◊ A wish cannot give experience points or levels. magically holds locked any lock.

◊ A wish can gain the caster treasure, goods or magic items worth The caster can open the door at any time, but otherwise the door
up to 50,000gp, but at the cost of an equal number of experi- can only be forced open by creatures with at least three more levels
ence points. or hit dice than the caster or by a Knock spell. In either case, the
door re-locks as soon as it is allowed to close, and this spell resumes
◊ A wish cannot hurt or kill another creature (unless it is dupli- until dispelled.
cating a lower level spell that might have that effect), but can
inconvenience them such as by transporting them away. An immortal can always open a door that is being held closed by
a mortal’s casting of this spell.
◊ A wish can change the species or race of an intelligent creature as
if it had been killed and raised by the Reincarnation spell, with Wizardry
the caster choosing the new race. An unwilling target of this can Sympathy
make a saving throw vs. spells at a –4 penalty to avoid this effect. Cleric 7, Druid 7
Target: one magical item
◊ Multiple wishes can permanently raise an ability score by one Range: personal
point, up to a maximum of 18. It takes a number of wishes equal Duration: 10 minutes
to the new value of the ability score, and they must all be cast This spell allows the caster to use one magic item that is normally
within a week by the same caster. useable only by magic-users or elves (e.g. A wand or staff), or read
one scroll containing a magic-user spell of up to third level.
Some other spells, items or abilities specifically say that their effects
can be altered by a wish or that their effects cannot be altered by a If used to read a scroll, the scroll (but not others with the same
wish. Those effects override the limitations and permitted usages spell) is considered “known” to the caster, who can use it at a later
listed here. time after this spell has run out. The caster is treated as if they are
a magic-user of the minimum level needed to cast the spell on
When cast by an immortal, this spell costs the immortal 100,000 the scroll.
experience points, and this spell cannot be used to increase an
immortal’s ability scores. Woodform
Matter
Wizard Eye Magic-User 5, Elf 5
Spirit Target: none
Magic-User 4, Elf 4 Range: touch
Target: one invisible eye Duration: permanent
Range: 240’ This spell creates a mass of wood up to 1,000 cubic feet in area. The
Duration: 1 hour mass can be arranged in any manner the caster desires.
This spell creates an invisible magical eye the size of a human eye.
It can see as well as a human and has the infravision ability of a The wood does not appear instantly, but takes time to form, rang-
demi-human. ing from a single round for a simple wooden wall to two hours to
create something with a precise specification, such as a staircase.
The caster can see through and/or move the eye (40’ per round) by
concentrating, although it remains in existence for the duration Whatever the complexity of the shape, the wood must form a
even while the caster is not concentrating; returning to the caster’s single piece with no moving parts. However, the caster can create
side and following them. the wood in a “rough” form, which can then have the Woodform
spell cast on it again in order to either add to the object or reshape
it. If the caster does create the wood in rough form, then this spell
is cast once again to “set” the wood in its final form so that other
casters can’t cast this spell on it in order to modify it.

Note that whatever shape the wood takes, it cannot be created in


the space where another object exists and must be created on a
surface that can support its weight.

140
Chapter 7 - Spells & Spell Casting
Once created, the wood is real and cannot be dispelled, and it will The caster must have a permanent home for this spell to work,
last until it is physically or magically destroyed. and must have a private bedroom or meditation chamber within
that home.
Word of Recall
Hope The caster automatically wins initiative in the round that they cast
Cleric 6, Druid 6, Shaman 6 this spell, although it cannot be cast in a surprise round.
Target: caster
Range: personal
Duration: instant
This spell instantly teleports the caster and their equipment (but
no other creatures) back to the caster’s home, providing the caster
is on the same plane and within the same celestial sphere.

141
Part 3

Playing the
Game
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
T
hey say that money makes the world go around, and that
applies to the Dark Dungeons world just as much as it ap- Encumbrance
plies to the real world. Trade and commerce are the back- Obviously, characters can only carry so much while moving around
bone of civilisation, and even brave adventurers will need to buy and fighting. However, trying to account for every last item that
things – from food to armour to ships or even siege artillery. is picked up or dropped during an adventure and adjusting move-
ment rates accordingly would be far too fiddly and time-consuming
Money to be fun.
The actual type of money that people use, in terms of the names
and denominations of coins, will vary from campaign setting to Therefore, Dark Dungeons assumes that the bulky armour someone
campaign setting and probably from country to country within is wearing will generally count more towards slowing them down
an individual campaign setting. than whatever equipment they are using, and simply bases the
movement rate of all characters on the armour they are wearing.
However, for simplicity’s sake and consistency’s sake, the Dark Unarmoured characters can move at a speed of 40’ per round; see
Dungeons rules assume a simple gold standard. The standard coin Table 8–3 for the movement rates of armoured characters.
that most prices are measured in is the gold piece (usually abbrevi-
ated to simply gp). The value of a gold piece is – quite literally – its If it really matters how much a person can carry (for example to
weight in gold, rather than any artificial economic value. Complex determine how much gold they can carry out of a dragon’s lair
economic factors such as exchange rates are assumed not to exist. and how much they have to leave behind) a good rule of thumb is
that a person can carry approximately their own weight in items
A gold piece is a large (by real-world standards) gold coin approxi- and treasure without being unduly weighed down, and can stagger
mately 3cm in diameter and 1/3cm in thickness. This amount of slowly while carrying twice that.
gold weighs 1.6 ounces, or 1/10 of a pound. Therefore a pound of
gold is worth 10gp, and 10gp weighs a pound in weight. Developer Commentary
In the original edition of Dark Dungeons (and in the original
Other coins are made from a similar weight of different met- game that Dark Dungeons emulates), the amount of weight that
als – namely copper, silver, electrum (a natural alloy of gold and characters were carrying was tracked down to the level of individual
silver) and platinum. The relative rarity of these metals gives the coins – and movement speeds were based on the exact amount that
different coins their different values relative to gold. was being carried.

1 cp (copper piece) = 1/100 gp In my opinion, this level of detail was too great and required far too
1 sp (silver piece) = 1/10 gp much bookkeeping, so in Darker Dungeons I replaced it with the
1 ep (electrum piece) = 1/2 gp simpler system above in which you simply look at the armour that
1 pp (platinum piece) = 5 gp a character is wearing (which was always the largest contributing
factor to their encumbrance anyway) to determine their movement
Starting Money speed.
Newly created first level characters start with a set of peasant clothes,
and with 3d6x10gp to spend on other items.
Mundane Items
A newly created magic-user or elf character will also start with a Arrows: Arrows are the ammunition used by bows. The same type
spell book containing Read Magic and one other first level spell. of arrows are used in both long and short bows. Arrows are often
broken in use. At the end of a combat, a character will only be
If a character is introduced in the middle of a campaign (to replace able to recover half (round down) of the arrows fired during that
a dead character) then the Game Master should give the character combat. The rest are either lost or unusable.
money and equipment – including magic items – in line with the
amount that the rest of the party have. Backpack: A leather or canvas backpack with shoulder straps for
carrying things while leaving the hands free.
If you’re creating a whole party from scratch at higher level so you
have no “rest of the party” with which to compare, you will need to Belt: A sturdy leather belt.
assign an arbitrary amount of wealth based on the experience total
that at which the characters will be starting. With the assumption Bolts: Bolts are the ammunition used by crossbows. The same
that in the average campaign around 80% of a character’s accumu- bolts are usable in either heavy or light crossbows. Bolts are often
lated experience will come from treasure and the assumption that broken in use. At the end of a combat, a character will only be able
a character will lose/spend around 25% of their treasure over time to recover half (round down) of the bolts fired during that combat.
keeping the rest in the form of accumulated wealth, this would The rest are either lost or unusable.
mean that a reasonable amount of starting wealth for characters
starting above first level would be 60% of their starting experience Boots (plain): Simple yet sturdy hard leather boots for walking
(i.e. 600gp per 1,000xp). or riding in.

145
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–1: Mundane Items Boots (fancy): Ornate boots, possibly with fold-down tops or designs and patterns
Item Weight Cost on the leather.
20 Arrows 1lb 5gp
Bullets: Bullets are the ammunition used by guns. The same bullets are usable in
2 Arrows (silver) 0.1lb 10gp either pistols or smoothbores. Bullets are not recoverable after they have been fired.
Backpack (holds 400cn) 2lb 5gp Those that have not been lost will have been deformed beyond use.
Belt 0.5lb 2sp
Cloak (short): A waist length weatherproof outer garment.
30 Bolts 1lb 10gp
3 Bolts (silver) 0.1lb 15gp Cloak (long): A knee or ankle length weatherproof outer garment.
Boots (plain) 1lb 2gp
Boots (fancy) 1.5lb 5gp Clothes (peasant): Simple clothes that a peasant or manual labourer (or even
slave) would wear.
20 Bullets 0.4lb 2gp
5 Bullets (silver) 0.1lb 25gp Clothes (merchant): High quality clothes that a middle-class artisan or merchant
Cloak (short) 1lb 5sp would wear.
Cloak (long) 1.5lb 1gp
Clothes (noble): Fancy clothing that a minor noble or other rich person would wear.
Clothes (peasant) 2lb 5sp
Clothes (merchant) 2lb 5gp Clothes (royal): Extravagant and ostentatious clothing fit for a king or even an
Clothes (noble) 2lb 20gp emperor.
Clothes (royal) 3lb 50+gp
Grappling Hook: A large iron hook that is tied to the end of a rope and then
5 Darts 8lb 1gp swung over a target such as a wall or tree branch. The hooks catch on the target
Grappling Hook 1lb 25gp and support the weight of someone climbing the rope.
Hammer (small) 0.3lb 2gp
Hammer (small): A working hammer, for hammering nails, spikes or tent pegs.
Hat 0.1lb 2sp
Holy Symbol 0.1lb 25gp Hat: A weatherproof hat made out of waxed linen.
Holy Water (small Vial) 0.5lb 25gp
Holy Symbol: This is a small symbol, usually metal, that represents an icon of the
Iron Spike 3lb 1sp
character’s religion. Most clerics carry holy symbols, although they can operate
Lantern 0.5lb 1gp without one.
Mirror (steel) 1lb 5gp
Oil (flask) 0.6lb 2gp Holy Water (small vial): Water that has been especially prepared by a cleric or
other priest. It is used in some religious ceremonies and can damage some undead
30 Pellets 0.1lb 1gp
monsters.
5 Pellets (silver) 10lb 25gp
Pole (10’) 0.2lb 1gp Iron Spike: A 9” long iron nail. These find a multitude of uses, from wedging
Purse (holds 50cn) 0.5lb 5sp doors open (or shut) or to use as tent pegs. They are most useful if accompanied
by a hammer for driving them into hard surfaces.
Quiver 7lb 1gp
Rations (1 Week’s, Dried) 20lb 15gp Lantern: An oil fired lamp that gives of light within a 30’ radius. A single flask of
Rations (1 Week’s, Fresh) 1lb 5gp oil will last 4 hours.
Red Powder (flask) 5lb 5gp
Mirror (steel): Useful for personal grooming, and also for seeing around corners
Rope (50’) 0.1lb 1gp or fighting creatures without looking at them directly. Fighting in such a manner
Sack (holds 200cn) 0.5lb 1gp gives a –2 penalty to attack rolls.
Sack (holds 600cn) 2.5lb 2gp
Oil (flask): Fine grade lantern oil. If a burning wick is inserted, it can also make
Spell Book 20lb 25gp
an emergency missile weapon, doing 1d8 damage to all within a 5’ radius, with
Tent 1lb 20gp a chance to also set them alight (see Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving for the
Thieves’ Tools 0.5lb 25gp dangers of being set alight).
Tinder Box 2lb 3gp
Pellets: Pellets are the ammunition used by slings. Pellets are easy to lose in use. At
Torch 0.5lb 2sp
the end of a combat, a character will only be able to recover half (round down) of
Waterskin (empty) 3lb 1gp the pellets fired during that combat. The rest are lost.
Waterskin (full, 1 Day’s) 30cn 1gp

146
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Pole (10’): A stout wooden pole often used to probe ahead or to Rope (50’): A strong hemp or silk rope that can support approxi-
prod suspicious looking piles of refuse. mately three people and their equipment.

Purse: A small leather or cloth purse or pouch that ties to a belt. Sack (small): A canvas sack for either carrying in one hand or
loading onto a horse or other beast of burden. Small enough to
Quiver: A leather container that holds 20 arrows or crossbow bolts. be tied around a belt.

Rations (1 Week’s, Dried): Enough dried, smoked, or otherwise Sack (large): A canvas sack for either carrying in two hands or
preserved food to feed a person for a week. The preservation means loading onto a horse or other beast of burden.
that this food will last for two months before going bad.
Spell Book: A large book for a magic-user or elf to write their spells
Rations (1 Week’s, Fresh): Enough fresh food to feed a person for into. A spell book contains 100 pages, and can hold up to 100
a week. The food will go bad after a week. levels worth of spells.

Red Powder (flask): Red powder is a naturally occurring magical Tent: A waxed canvas tent with wooden poles. Although heavy,
substance with unusual properties. In large quantities such as in a such tents are invaluable when travelling through inclement weath-
barrel it is perfectly safe, but in small quantities it becomes danger- er and cold nights.
ously flammable or even explosive.
Thieves’ Tools: A variety of lockpicks, needles, wire, pliers, etc. A
Although it is normally found in large underground deposits with thief cannot pick locks or disarm traps without a set of these tools.
the consistency of talc or other soft rock, it is normally ground up
(in a water bath to stop it igniting) and then sold in powdered form. Tinder Box: A set of fire making equipment in a water resistant
box. Starting a fire with a tinder box takes 1d3 rounds.
Water temporarily suppresses the explosive properties of red powder,
but does not spoil it – it is usable again once it has dried sufficiently. Torch: A 1’ to 2’ length of wood dipped in pitch or tallow. A torch
gives off light in a 30’ radius and burns for one hour. If used in
Red powder is normally used to power guns; a single flask is enough combat, a torch has the same statistics (and uses the same weapons
to power 100 gun shots or a single cannon shot. However, in an feats) as a club.
emergency a full flask can also have a wick or fuse stuck in it and
lit, and then be hurled as a grenade like weapon. In this case it will Waterskin: A waterskin is a flexible bladder that can hold up to
explode for 2d6 damage to all within 10’. Targets that can make a two pints of water or other liquid, enough for a person for one day.
saving throw vs. breath weapon take only half damage.
Weapons
Because of red powder’s unusual self-stabilising property, multiple In all cases, refer to Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats for full details of
flasks cannot be combined in order to make bigger explosions. the weapon. Note that shields are listed along with weapons, since
they are used along with weapons and proficiency with them is
Developer Commentary increased by the use of weapon feats.
Red powder is my own invention, being designed so that I could
have the “flintlock fantasy” aesthetic of characters wielding magic Axe, Battle: A battle axe is a two handed axe 2’–4’ in length, usually
and guns without having to deal with the problems that realistic with a double blade or a spike on the reverse of the blade.
gunpowder would introduce.
Axe, Hand: A hand axe is a one handed axe 1’–2’ in length, usually
By giving red powder the properties that it has, I avoid the issues with a single blade. A hand axe is often thrown while its owner
of characters needing to keep powder dry and of characters using rushes towards melee range.
large amounts of gunpowder to collapse dungeons or blow holes in
castle walls. Blackjack: A blackjack, also known as a cosh, is a small leather
club usually filled with sand.
While these properties don’t really need justification – red powder
can simply be some magical substance placed by the gods – I’ve Blackjacks are too soft to do significant damage, but are very use-
always had it in my mind that red powder is some kind of residue ful for temporarily knocking people unconscious without doing
of luminiferous aether that is deposited on worlds when they are permanent damage.
created in a celestial sphere.
Bolas: A bolas is a set of weights (usually three) on the ends of con-
Having said that, I’ve gone out of my way to make it so that you nected ropes 3’–4’ in length. The bolas is whirled around and then
can simply ignore the existence of red powder and the firearms that thrown at the opponent in order to entangle or even strangle them.
use it if you don’t like the idea of having guns in your fantasy and
doing so won’t affect any other part of the game.

147
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–2: Weapons Bow, Long: A long bow is a 4’–6’ bow, either made from a single piece of wood
Item Weight Cost or a composite of different woods. A long bow requires both hands to fire. Bows
require the use of arrows as ammunition.
Axe, Battle 6lb 7gp
Axe, Hand 3lb 4gp Bow, Short: A short bow is a 3’–4’ bow, either made from a single piece of wood
Blackjack 0.5lb 5gp or a composite of different woods. A short bow requires both hands to fire. Bows
Bolas 0.5lb 5gp require the use of arrows as ammunition.
Bow, Long 3lb 40gp
Cestus: A cestus is a spiked or bladed metal band that may either be worn around
Bow, Short 2lb 25gp the hand or built into a gauntlet. Although only a small weapon, it can be used
Cestus 1lb 5gp without incurring off-hand penalties.
Club 5lb 3gp
Club: A club is a blunt weapon, often crudely made and little more than a roughly
Crossbow, Heavy 8lb 50gp shaped piece of wood, that can be used in one hand. Some war clubs are more
Crossbow, Light 5lb 30gp carefully crafted and weighted or are decorated to distinguish them from their
Dagger 1lb 3gp more crude counterparts. The in-game statistics are the same for both types of club.
Flail 6lb 12gp
Crossbow, Heavy: A heavy crossbow is a large two-handed missile weapon. It has
Halberd 15lb 7gp powerful metal arms and a string that is pulled back using a crank. Crossbows
Hammer, Throwing 2.5lb 4gp require the use of bolts as ammunition.
Hammer, War 5lb 5gp
Crossbow, Light: A light crossbow is a medium sized missile weapon, although it
Javelin 2lb 1gp
still needs two hands to wield. It has powerful metal arms and a string that is pulled
Lance 18lb 10gp back using a lever. Crossbows require the use of bolts as ammunition.
Mace 3lb 5gp
Morning Star 4lb 8gp Dagger: A dagger is a short light blade which is 18” long or less. Daggers are
popular because their small size makes them easy to conceal and they can be either
Net 4lb 4gp thrown or used in melee.
Pike 8lb 3gp
Pistol 2lb 250gp Flail: A flail is a large two-handed melee weapon consisting of a 2’ to 3’ wooden
shaft with two or three 2’ chains attached to the end. Each chain is tipped with a
Poleaxe 12lb 5gp
spiked weight.
Shield, Buckler 2lb 6gp
Shield, Normal 5lb 10gp Halberd: A halberd is a large pole-arm 6’ to 8’ in length, the head of which has a
Shield, Tower 12lb 15gp long spike with an axe blade on one side and a hook on the reverse side.
Sling 2lb 2gp
Hammer, Throwing: A throwing hammer is a one handed hammer from 18” to 2’
Smoothbore 7.5lb 150gp in length that is weighted for throwing. Despite the name, it can also be used in
Spear 3lb 3gp melee.
Staff 4lb 5gp
Hammer, War: A war hammer is a large one handed hammer, usually 2’ to 3’ in
Sword, Bastard 8lb 15gp length. The head of a war hammer is often symmetrical to aid in balance.
Sword, Normal 6lb 10gp
Sword, Short 3lb 7gp Javelin: A javelin is a light one-handed throwing spear. Although primarily used
Sword, Two-handed 10lb 15gp as a thrown weapon, it can also be used in melee.

Trident 2.5lb 5gp Lance: A lance is an extremely long spear, 9’ to 12’ long. It is too unwieldy to use
Whip 10lb 10gp on foot, and can only be used when mounted – in which case it can be used in
one hand despite its length.

Mace: A mace is a one handed melee weapon consisting of a 2’–3’ long shaft with
a heavy metal head. The head can be smooth (round or pear shaped), can contain
flanges or studs, or can even be sculpted into the shape of a fist or skull or other
roundish object.

Morning Star: A morning star is a one handed melee weapon consisting of a 1’
to 2’ shaft with an 18” to 2’ chain attached to the end. The other end of the chain
holds a spiked weight.

148
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Net: Nets designed for use in combat are generally 6’ to 9’ in di- Sword, Normal: A normal sword is a one-handed sword with
ameter, and usually have small weights around their edge to hold a straight or curved blade 2’ to 3’ long. This category of sword
them open when they are flung. This arrangement lets them be encompasses a variety of different styles of sword, ranging from
thrown one-handed if held in their centre. Nets do no damage to scimitars to broadswords and even rapiers.
opponents in combat, but are excellent defensive weapons.
Sword, Short: A short sword is a sword with a straight 18” to 2’
Pike: A pike is an extremely long spear, 7’ to 15’ long. It can only blade. Primarily used as a stabbing rather than slashing weapon,
be wielded using two hands. this small blade can be used in one hand.

Pistol: A pistol is a short gun, 9” to 12” long. It can be fired using Sword, Two-handed: A two-handed sword, sometimes known as
only one hand, but needs both hands to reload. Pistols require both a greatsword, is a large and heavy sword with a 4’ to 5’ blade. It is
bullets as ammunition and red powder to fire them. always used in two hands.

Poleaxe: A poleaxe consists of an axe blade (usually single sided, but Trident: A trident is a short (4’ to 6’) spear which is split at the end
occasionally double sided) with a 6’ to 8’ long shaft. It is wielded into three tines, like a fork. Each tine is usually barbed. A trident
in both hands like a large two-handed axe. is used in one hand either in melee or as a thrown weapon, and is
often used as a fishing spear, since the barbs on the points can lift
Shield, Buckler: A buckler is a small, light shield around 12” to 18” the fish out of the water when the trident is withdrawn.
in diameter that is held in the fist and actively used for parrying
blows. Although it can be used to attack at high levels of skill, at Whip: A whip is a woven leather cord from 5’ to 15’ in length that
lower proficiency levels it is merely used for its defensive properties. is used in one hand. Whips do little damage, and are more often
used for corporal punishment than for serious combat.
Shield, Normal: A normal shield is a medium sized shield around 2’
to 3’ in diameter, although it can come in a variety of shapes. It is Armour
held in the fist and used for deflecting blows. Although it can be Armour is toughened clothing made out of leather or metal that
used to attack at high levels of skill, at lower proficiency levels it is protects its wearer. In game terms, this reduces the armour class
merely used for its defensive properties. of the character wearing it from the default value of 9 to a better
(i.e. Lower) value. This value may be further adjusted by dexterity
Shield, Tower: A tower shield is a large, oblong or rectangular or magical factors.
shield around 2’ wide and up to 5’ tall. Too big to be held in the
fist, it is worn strapped to the arm and is used to passively block Although armour is made from a variety of pieces – from vambraces
blows. Although it can be used to attack at high levels of skill, at and greaves through to helmets and gauntlets – armour in Dark
lower proficiency levels it is merely used for its defensive properties. Dungeons is assumed to come in sets. Two sets of chain mail are
considered to be the same, even if one consists of a chain shirt, chain
Sling: A sling is a long (4’ to 6’) leather cord with a pouch half trews and a coif whereas the other consists of a chain hauberk with
way along. The wielder straps one end of the cord around their leather vambraces and a steel helmet.
wrist and holds the other end in the same hand. They then place a
lead pellet in the pouch and swing the cord over their head. At the Since most people making armour – and especially those making
mid-point of the swing, they let go of the loose end, which releases magical armour – will be doing so for customers of different races,
the pellet. Slings normally require pellets as ammunition, although most armour is made with straps and so forth that can adjust it to
they can be used with stones taken from the ground, albeit with fit wearers of differing size.
a –1 penalty on to-hit and damage rolls.
Therefore all humans and demi-humans can wear the same armour.
Smoothbore: A smoothbore is a long gun, 3’ to 5’ long. It requires Similarly, most humanoids of approximately the same human to
two hands to both fire and reload. Smoothbores require both bullets halfling size range can also wear the same armour.
as ammunition and red powder to fire them.
Banded Mail: This is a suit primarily composed of chain mail with
Spear: A spear is a 5’ to 7’ long shaft with a stabbing blade on the horizontal metal strips fastened into the mail. Banded mail gives a
end. Despite its length, a spear is a well-balanced weapon and can character an armour class of 4. It doesn’t quite have the protection
either be used in melee one-handed or thrown. of plate mail, but is cheaper and lighter.

Staff: A staff is one of the simplest of weapons. It consists of just a Chain Mail: This is a suit primarily composed of small metal rings
length of wood 5’ to 7’ in length, which is wielded in two hands. that are linked together to form a flexible protective material. Chain
mail gives a character an armour class of 5.
Sword, Bastard: A bastard sword, also known as a longsword,
is a sword with a long (3’ to 4’) narrow blade that is used either Leather Armour: This is a suit primarily composed of leather plates
one-handed or two-handed. The same weapon proficiency covers and strips. The leather is often boiled in wax to harden it. Leather
both forms of usage. armour gives an armour class of 7, and because it is made from

149
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–3: Armour
Item Armour Class Weight Cost Movement Rate Notes
Leather Armour 7 20lb 20gp 30’ Useable by druids, mountebanks, and thieves
Scale Mail 6 30lb 30gp 30’
Chain Mail 5 40lb 40gp 30’
Banded Mail 4 45lb 50gp 20’
Plate Mail 3 50lb 60gp 20’
Suit Armour 0 75lb 250gp 20’ See description

natural materials it can be worn by druids. It is also light and quiet the listed speed while doing so. Flying creatures cannot fly when
enough to be worn by thieves. overloaded in this manner.

Plate Mail: This is a suit primarily composed of large metal Animals pulling vehicles use the carrying capacity of the cart or
plates – the largest being the breastplate – linked together with
wagon rather than their own capacity, and cannot be loaded whilst
chain mail. Plate mail gives a character an armour class of 3. hitched to a vehicle in this manner. When pulling a vehicle, an
animal moves at its normal speed when the vehicle is carrying up
It is the best armour that can be bought second hand or looted, to its capacity and at half speed when the vehicle is carrying up to
since suit armour must be custom made. twice its capacity.

Scale Mail: This is a suit primarily composed of leather plates that Banded Barding: This is a suit primarily composed of chain mail
have metal scales or studs sewn onto them for added protection. with horizontal metal strips fastened into the mail. Banded barding
Scale mail gives a character an armour class of 6. gives an animal an armour class of 4, unless the animal’s armour
class is already better than 4.
Suit Armour: This is a suit primarily composed of overlapping
metal plates, with chain mail underneath. Camel: Camels are normally only found in desert or semi-desert
environments where horses don’t fare well.
Also known as jousting plate, suit armour must be specially made
to fit its owner – and is often worn by nobility as a status symbol Cart: A medium sized two-wheeled vehicle pulled by one or more
as much as for protection. horses. A cart is designed for carrying cargo, and may optionally
have a seat for a driver. If there is no seat, the horse must be led.
However, it does provide more protection than any other (non-
magical) armour. Suit armour gives a character an armour class of 0, Chain Barding: This is a suit primarily composed of small metal
and also reduces all damage done to the character by area effect rings that are linked together to form a flexible protective material.
attacks (such as Fireball spells and dragon’s breath) by one point per Chain barding gives an animal an armour class of 5, unless the
die of damage. If the suit armour is magical, it reduces such dam- animal’s armour class is already better than 5.
age by an additional point per two points of enhancement bonus.
Donkey: Donkeys are rarely ridden, but they make a cheap – if
Unfortunately, since suit armour is designed for tourney use and somewhat stubborn and wilful – pack animal.
parades where the wearer spends their time on horseback, it is very
bulky and noisy when worn on foot. When on foot, someone wear- Elephant: Elephants are normally only found in hotter climates,
ing suit armour can be heard moving up to 120’ away, negating although they can be found in any terrain from jungle to desert.
any chance of surprise; and only has a 1 in 6 chance per round of Although popular as beasts of burden because of their immense
being able to stand unaided if knocked prone. strength, elephants are not popular as simple mounts because they
consume so much more food than something smaller like a horse.
Land Transport
Whether trekking across a desert, riding from city to city, or driving Field Barding: This is a suit primarily composed of large metal
a caravan of wagons filled with a dragon’s hoard, adventurers often plates linked together with chain mail. The plates are heavier and
need land transport other than walking. more numerous than normal plate barding. Field barding gives an
animal an armour class of 2, unless the animal’s armour class is
Pretty much all land transport is powered by animals, and the vast already better than 2.
majority of these animals are horses and mules, ranging from the
smallest pony to the largest draft horse. Griffon: Griffons are not normally tameable, nor can they be bred
reliably in captivity. Because of this, they are unavailable to pur-
The speeds listed in Table 8–4 – pack and riding animals are for chase. However, statistics are included here in case a character
the animals when carrying a load up to their listed carrying capacity. (player or non-player) has somehow managed to befriend one and
Animals can carry twice the listed load, but can only move at half acquire it as a mount.

150
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–4: Pack and Riding Animals
Item Carrying Capacity Speed Cost
Camel 300lb 50’/rnd 100gp
Donkey 200lb 30’/rnd 20gp
Elephant 1,200lb 40’/rnd 500gp
Griffon 350lb 40’/rnd (fly 120’) *
Hippogriff 300lb 60’/rnd (fly 120’) *
Horse (draft) 450lb 30’/rnd 40gp
Horse (riding) 300lb 80’/rnd 75gp
Horse (war) 400lb 40’/rnd 250gp
Manticore 350lb 40’/rnd (fly 60’) *
Mule 300lb 40’/rnd 30gp
Pegasus 300lb 80’/rnd (fly 160’) *
Pony 200lb 70’/rnd 35gp
Unicorn 200lb 80’/rnd *
* these creatures cannot normally be bought as mounts, but may have been individually befriended and/or trained by a character.
Table 8–5: Land Transport Equipment
Item Carrying Capacity Weight Cost
Saddle and Tack 20lb 30lb 25gp
Saddle Bags 80lb 10lb 5gp
Trap (1 donkey/mule/pony) 200lb – 50gp
Cart (1 horse or 2 mules/ponies) 400lb – 100gp
Cart (2 horses or 4 mules/ponies) 800lb – 100gp
Wagon (2 Horses) 1,500lb – 200gp
Wagon (4 Horses) 2,500lb – 200gp
Table 8–6: Barding
Item Armour Class Weight Cost
Leather Barding 7 25lb 40gp
Scale Barding 6 40lb 75gp
Chain Barding 5 60lb 150gp
Banded Barding 4 150lb 400gp
Plate Barding 3 300lb 500gp
Field Barding 2 400lb 600gp
Joust Barding 0 500lb 700gp

Hippogriff: Hippogriffs are not normally tameable, nor can they Horse (war): A large horse specially trained to not panic in combat
be bred reliably in captivity. Because of this, they are unavailable to situations.
purchase. However, statistics are included here in case a character
(player or non-player) has somehow managed to befriend one and Joust Barding: This is a suit primarily composed of overlapping
acquire it as a mount. metal plates that completely protect the front of the animal, to
protect it from injury in jousting competitions. The plates are even
Horse (draft): A large powerful horse that sacrifices speed for heavier than field barding. Joust barding gives an animal an armour
strength and can carry heavy loads over long distances. class of 0, unless the animal’s armour class is already better than 0.

Horse (riding): A typical horse, fast and light but easily spooked Leather Barding: This is a suit primarily composed of leather plates
and not suitable for combat situations. and strips. The leather is often boiled in wax to harden it. Leather
armour gives an animal an armour class of 7, unless the animal’s
armour class is already better than 7.

151
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Manticore: Manticores are not normally tameable, nor can they
be bred reliably in captivity. Because of this, they are unavailable to Sea Transport
purchase. However, statistics are included here in case a character For long distance travel, it is much more efficient to travel by boat
(player or non-player) has somehow managed to befriend one and than by land – and depending on the destination, land travel may
acquire it as a mount. not be possible.

Mule: A cross between a donkey and a horse, combining the best If characters are travelling along an established route, they can
features of both. It is larger and stronger than a donkey, but smarter book passage on an existing ship. If not, they may need to buy a
than a horse. ship and hire crew to sail it.

Pegasus: Pegasi are not normally tameable, nor can they be bred All ships and boats need skilled crew to sail them, and some also
reliably in captivity. Because of this, they are unavailable to pur- need unskilled rowers. If more than 5 crew are needed one of them
chase. However, statistics are included here in case a character must be a captain, and if more than 15 crew are needed one of them
(player or non-player) has somehow managed to befriend one and must be a captain and one of them must be a first mate.
acquire it as a mount.
Crew (and troops, if mentioned in the description) do not count
Plate Barding: This is a suit primarily composed of large metal towards a ship’s carrying capacity.
plates linked together with chain mail. Plate barding gives an ani-
mal an armour class of 3, unless the animal’s armour class is already Barque: A barque is a three masted ocean going ship 100’–150’
better than 3. long and 25’–30’ wide, with a draft of 10’–12’. There are raised
decks at the fore and aft, and the ship can be fitted with up to two
Pony: A small light horse that is cheaper to feed and easier to care light catapults or cannons.
for than other breeds of horse, but lacks their strength.
In addition to its crew, a barque may house 50 troops.
Saddle and Tack: A saddle, blanket, bridle and reins – everything
needed to ride a horse safely. It is possible to ride a horse bareback Canoe, River: A canoe is a small boat 15’ long and 3’ wide with a 1’
without these items, but any Dex checks made to control the horse draft. A canoe is normally made of waxed canvas or hides stretched
will be made at a –3 to effective dexterity. over a wooden frame, and has one or two seats.

The 20lb carrying capacity of a saddle and tack does not refer to Canoes are designed for use in rivers and swamps, and can easily
the weight of the rider, but to the weight that can be carried in the be carried across land. A canoe weighs 100lb if carried – but two
bags and pouches that come with it. people can share the weight.

Saddle Bags: Saddle bags are long pairs of sacks sewn together at Canoe, Sea: A sea canoe is a small boat 15’ long and 3’ wide with
the top with a length of material. They are slung over a horse’s sad- a 1’ draft, with one or two floats held out either side for stability.
dle so that one bag hangs down either side of the horse distributing A sea canoe is normally made of waxed canvas or hides stretched
the weight evenly. over a wooden frame, and has one or two seats. Sea canoes are
designed for use in coastal waters, and can be carried across land.
Scale Barding: This is a suit primarily composed of leather plates
that have metal scales or studs sewn onto them for added protec- A sea canoe weighs 300lb when carried – but two to four people
tion. Scale barding gives an animal an armour class of 6, unless the can share the weight.
animal’s armour class is already better than 6.
Galley: A galley is an ocean-going ship 60’–100’ long and 10’–15’
Trap: A small two-wheeled vehicle with two seats, that is pulled wide with a 2’–3’ draft. Because of its small draft, it can travel along
by a single pony, mule or donkey. Although a trap can be used for rivers as long as they are wide enough for it.
transporting cargo, it is primarily designed as a means of personal
transport. The listed speed is for the galley under sail. If becalmed, it can be
rowed at 18mi/day. A galley has a single line of rowers.
Unicorn: Unicorns are not normally tameable, nor can they be
bred reliably in captivity. Because of this, they are unavailable to A galley can be fitted with a light ship’s ram (at a cost of 3,000gp)
purchase. However, statistics are included here in case a character and up to two light catapults or cannons.
(player or non-player) has somehow managed to befriend one and
acquire it as a mount. In addition to its crew, and rowers it will normally house 20 troops.

Wagon: A large four-wheeled vehicle, pulled by a team of horses. Longship: A longship is a single masted boat 60’–80’ long and 10’–
Wagons are mostly used for cargo transport, although some travel- 15’ wide, with a 2’–3’ draft. It is designed for troop transport along
ling people live in them as an alternative to tents. rivers and coasts. The 75 crew normally act as both rowers and
troops when necessary.

152
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–7: Ships and Boats
Item Weight** Capacity Minimum Crew Move per Day Cost
Barque 400 tons 2,000lb 20 crew 90 miles 20,000gp
Canoe, River 100lb 600lb 1 crew 18 miles 50gp
Canoe, Sea 300lb 600lb 1 crew 18 miles 100gp
Galley* 50 tons 1,000lb 10 crew, 60 row 90 miles 10,000gp
Longship* 30 tons 1,500lb 75 crew 90 miles 15,000gp
Passage, Average – 600lb – – 1sp/5 miles
Passage, Basic – 150lb – – 1sp/20 miles
Passage, Luxury – 1,500lb – – 1sp/mile
Passage, Skysailing – 1,500lb – – 1gp/mile
Quinquireme 120 tons 6,000lb 30 crew, 300 row 72 miles 60,000gp
Raft, Professional 500lb 1,000lb – 12 miles 100gp
Raft, Scavenged 500lb 500lb – 12 miles –
River Barge* 10 tons 4,000lb 2 crew, 8 row 36 miles 4,000gp
Rowing Boat*  5,00lb 100lb – 18 miles 1,000gp
Sail of Skysailing 50lb 100 tons 1 spell caster Varies 200,000gp
Skiff* 5 tons 2,000lb 1 crew 72 miles 3,000gp
Sloop* 70 tons 500lb 10 crew 72 miles 5,000gp
Trireme* 80 tons 3,000lb 20 crew, 180 row 72 miles 30,000gp
Troopship 400 tons 3,000lb 20 crew 54 miles 30,000gp
* these ships may be equipped with a sail of skysailing
** 1 ton = 2,000lb

The listed speed is for the longship under sail. If becalmed, it can A quinquirime includes a heavy ship’s ram and fore and aft towers.
be rowed at 18mi/day. It can be fitted with up to three light catapults or cannons. In ad-
dition to its crew, it will normally house 75 troops.
Passage, Average: Average passage includes a small shared cabin
that can hold up to 100lb of luggage plus the character, basic meals, Raft: A raft is a flat platform 10’ long and 10’ wide, with a 3”–6”
and an additional 500lb of hold space. draft. A raft is the most basic of vessels, and is normally limited
to swamps, lakes and slow moving rivers. Up to 12 rafts can be
Passage, Basic: Basic passage includes a bunk in a shared hold with lashed together to make a single larger raft with proportionally
space for 50lb of luggage plus the character, no meals unless the higher carrying capacity.
character brings their own food or pays for ship’s food separately,
and 100lb of hold space. River Barge: A river barge is a flat-bottomed sail-less boat 20’–30’
long and 10’ wide with a 2’–3’ draft. It is normally used for carry-
Passage, Luxury: Luxury passage includes a spacious private cabin ing cargo up and down slow moving rivers.
that can store up to 500lb of luggage plus the character, excellent
meals, and an additional 1,000lb of hold space. Rowing Boat: A rowing boat is a small sail-less boat 20’ long
and 4’–5’ wide, with a 1’–2’ draft. Rowing boats are often stored
Passage, Skysailing: Skysailing passage is passage on a ship on larger ships and used to transport people to and from shore or,
equipped with a sail of skysailing which enables it to fly at great in an emergency, used as lifeboats. Each rowing boat stored in this
speed. This price is for atmospheric travel only. Voidspeed travel manner takes up 500lb of its parent ship’s capacity.
is charged at 100gp/day in addition to the mileage to the edge of
the atmosphere. Sail of Skysailing: A sail of skysailing is a magical sail made chiefly
from the silk of phase spiders. Sails of skysailing can be attached to
Quinquirime: A quinquirime is an ocean-going ship 120’–150’ most boats and ships that weigh 100 tons or less, although some
long and 20’–30’ wide with a 4’–6’ draft. Because of its width, it very small boats such as rafts and canoes are unsuitable as they
cannot usually travel along rivers. have nowhere to fasten it.

The listed speed is for the quinquirime under sail. If becalmed, it When fitted to a new ship for the first time, the sail must be left
can be rowed at 12mi/day by five tiers of rowers. in place for a week in order to attune to that ship. During that

153
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
time, the sail of skysailing slowly changes shape to fit the rigging The listed costs assume that the building is being built as an outpost
of the ship. in a remote but not inaccessible region. If a building is being built
in an inaccessible region, double the costs – and if a building is
Once the attunement has taken place, the sails can be hoist (on being built in a heavily settled region halve the costs.
that individual ship) or stowed repeatedly without losing the at-
tunement. However, a sail of skysailing can only be attuned to one Often a building – particularly one with an unusual purpose such
ship at a time, and cannot be used on a different ship – not even as a temple – will require features of custom size, for example larger
one of the same design – without being re-attuned. doors than normal.

See Chapter 12 – Into the Wider World for detailed rules on The prices of these features should be based on the standard prices
using sails of skysailing to fly a ship. for similar features and increased or decreased proportionally.

Skiff: A skiff is a single masted boat 15’–45’ long and 5’–15’ wide Arrow Slit: A narrow window designed to let defenders shoot out
with a 3’–8’ draft. It is designed for lakes and coastal waters, and whilst not exposing them to returning fire.
can sometimes be too deep keeled for river use.
Barbican: A pair of 30’ tall x 20’ wide towers flanking a 20’ square
Skiffs are commonly used as fishing boats. gatehouse built as a single unit. Price includes iron portcullis.

Sloop: A sloop is a one or two masted ocean going ship 60’–80’ Battlement (100’): 100’ of crenelated wall with a parapet behind
long and 20’–30’ wide, with a draft of 5’–8’. There may be a raised it. The price only includes the crenulations and parapet, not the
deck at the aft. wall that the battlement is on.

In addition to its crew, a sloop may house 25 troops. Building, Stone: A two story stone building, such as a large stone
house, stables, or an inn.
Trireme: A trireme is an ocean-going ship 120’–150’ long and 15’–
20’ wide with a 3’ draft. Because of its small draft, it can travel Building, Wood: A two story wooden building, such as a large
along rivers as long as they are wide enough for it. wooden house, stables, or an inn.

The listed speed is for the trireme under sail. If becalmed, it can be Door (secret): A door that is disguised and hidden so that it will
rowed at 18mi/day by three tiers of rowers. not be noticed unless searched for.

A trireme can be fitted with a heavy ship’s ram (at a cost of 10,000gp) Door, Exterior (iron/stone): A heavy exterior double-door, 7’
and up to two light catapults or cannons. In addition to its crew, it tall by 6’ wide.
will normally house 50 troops.
Door, Interior (iron/stone): A heavy internal door, 7’ tall and 3’
Troopship: A troopship is a three masted ocean going ship 100’– wide.
150’ long and 25’–30’ wide, with a draft of 10’–12’. The hull is the
same as that of a large sailing ship, but the ship has been converted Door, Interior (reinforced): A wooden internal door reinforced
to carry the maximum number of troops. with iron bands, 7’ tall and 3’ wide.

A troopship often has large fold-down doors on its sides so that Door, Interior (wood): A standard wooden internal door, 7’ tall
troops – often including cavalry – can rapidly exit. and 3’ wide.

In addition to its crew, a troopship will normally house 100 troops. Drawbridge: A 10’ wide, 20’ long reinforced wooden bridge that
can be raised or lowered.
Buildings & Dungeons
When characters get to higher levels, they may wish to settle down. Dungeon Corridor: A 10’ x 10’ x 10’ section dug out from rock.
Whether taking over and repairing an existing structure, or starting The cost is multiplied by the depth of the dungeon (in multiples
from scratch; building work is expensive. of 50’), for example digging a 10’ x 10’ x 10’ section at a depth
of 150’ will cost triple the listed price: 1,500gp.
The prices for buildings all include the cost of the unskilled and
semi-skilled labour that does the building, but do not include the Floor, Flagstone: A 10’ x 10’ section of floor covered in flagstones.
cost of skilled architects and engineers.
Floor, Tile: A 10’ x 10’ section of floor covered in tiles.
Buildings take one day per 500gp (or part of 500gp) total cost,
and need one engineer on site to oversee the building process Floor, Wood: A 10’ x 10’ floor covered in polished fitted wood.
per 100,000gp (or part of 100,000gp) total cost.

154
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–8: Buildings Moat, Filled: 100’ length of 10’ deep, 20’ wide canal.
Item Cost
Moat, Unfilled: 100’ length of 10’ deep, 20’ wide ditch.
Arrow Slit 10gp
Barbican 37,000gp Shifting Wall: A 10’ x 10’ wall which has a counterbalance and
Battlement (100’) 500gp mechanism for moving it.
Building, Stone 3,000gp
Shutters (window): Window shutters that provide little military
Building, Wood 1,500gp
defence, but protect against bad weather.
Door (secret) Cost x5
Door, Exterior (iron/stone) 100gp Staircase, Stone: A stone staircase 3’ wide with a 10’ ascent.
Door, Interior (iron/stone) 50gp
Staircase, Wood: A wooden staircase 3’ wide with a 10’ ascent.
Door, Interior (reinforced) 20gp
Door, Interior (wood) 10gp Tower, Bastion: A half-circle tower, 30’ tall and 30’ diameter.
Drawbridge 250gp
Tower, Round Large: A 30’ tall, 30’ diameter round tower.
Dungeon Corridor 500gp
Floor, Flagstone 100gp Tower, Round Small: A 30’ tall, 20’ diameter round tower.
Floor, Tile 100gp
Floor, Wood 40gp Trap Door: A 5’ x 5’ section of false floor with an opening mecha-
nism that allows it to drop anyone standing on it through a hole
Gate, Wooden 1,000gp
in the floor.
Gatehouse 6,500gp
Keep, Square 75,000gp Wall, Castle: 100’ length of 20’ tall and 5’ thick reinforced stone
Laboratory 100,000gp wall, with a walkway and battlements on the top.
Moat, Filled 800gp Wall, Wood: 100’ length of 20’ tall and 5’ thick reinforced wooden
Moat, Unfilled 400gp wall, with a walkway on the top.
Shifting Wall 1,000gp
Window, Barred: A 3’ x 1’ window with bars to prevent ingress
Shutters (window) 5gp
and egress.
Staircase, Stone 60gp
Staircase, Wood 20gp Window, Open: A 3’ x 1’ open window.
Tower, Bastion 9,000gp
Tower, Round Large 30,000gp Developer Commentary
Tower, Round Small 15,000gp The above prices are great for when a player wants to design their
Trap Door Cost x2 own castle or dungeon and fully kit it out. However, many players
just want to be able to buy a “small castle” or fund the building of
Wall, Castle 5,000gp
a “standard temple to thor” or similar.
Wall, Wood 1,000gp
Window, Barred 20gp In such situations, consult the section on public works in CHAPTER 13
Window, Open 10gp - SETTLING DOWN. This section is a new addition to the game and is
designed to allow players whose characters have settled down to rule
Gate, Wooden: A 20’ tall by 10’ wide wooden gate, reinforced and a dominion to have strategic buildings built that will help defend
barred, suitable for putting in a stockade wall. the dominion without needing them to design those buildings room
by room and door by door.
Gatehouse: A 30’ high building 20’x20’ in area. Price includes
iron portcullis. Of course, if you do want to design your own castle, you can do
things the other way around. Design the building and work out its
Keep, Square: A heavily reinforced stone building 80’ tall and 60’ cost using the rules here and then compare the function and cost/size
x 60’ in area. of the building to those in the public works rules to work out what
effect it should have on the confidence level of the populace and on
Laboratory: A room full of magical equipment that allows its any mass combat that might occur.
owner (providing that owner is a spell caster) to create magic items.
Laboratories are very personal things, and a spell caster can only
use a laboratory that they created and stocked themselves.

155
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–9: Hirelings
Services Class and Level Cost per Mission* Class and Level Cost per Mission*
Whether looking for hired help to take out
Commoner 50gp Fighter (3rd) 800gp
a goblin’s lair, or looking for crew to ac-
company you on a sea voyage, or looking Cleric (1st) 150gp Fighter (4th) 1,600gp
for people to manage your estates, or even Cleric (2nd) 300gp Fighter (5th) 3,200gp
looking for a cleric to raise your friend; Cleric (3rd) 600gp Halfling (1st) 200gp
adventurers need the services of others.
Cleric (4th) 1,200gp Halfling (2nd) 400gp
Employees of the characters come in three Cleric (5th) 2,500gp Halfling (3rd) 800gp
types – hirelings, mercenaries and special- Clockwork (1st) 220gp Halfling (4th) 1,600gp
ists. Clockwork (2nd) 440gp Halfling (5th) 3,200gp

Hirelings Clockwork (3rd) 880gp Lupine (1st) 200gp


Hirelings are adventurers (or would-be Clockwork (4th) 1,700gp Lupine (2nd) 400gp
adventurers) willing to temporarily join Clockwork (5th) 3,500gp Lupine (3rd) 800gp
a party for a mission. Druid (1st) 150gp Lupine (4th) 1,600gp
Although hirelings travel with – and ad- Druid (2nd) 300gp Lupine (5th) 3,200gp
venture with – a party, they are not equal Druid (3rd) 600gp Magic-user (1st) 400gp
party members. They view the party as Druid (4th) 1,200gp Magic-user (2nd) 800gp
employers rather than companions, and
Druid (5th) 2,500gp Magic-user (3rd) 1,600gp
may desert or even rebel against their em-
ployers if maltreated or exposed to exces- Dwarf (1st) 220gp Magic-user (4th) 3,200gp
sive danger. See Chapter 10 – Combat Dwarf (2nd) 440gp Magic-user (5th) 6,400gp
for details of morale. Dwarf (3rd) 880gp Mountebank (1st) 120gp
Dwarf (4th) 1,700gp Mountebank (2nd) 240gp
Since parties are prone to argument and
internal disagreements, hirelings are nor- Dwarf (5th) 3,500gp Mountebank (3rd) 480gp
mally employed by – and follow the orders Elf (1st) 250gp Mountebank (4th) 960gp
of – a single designated “party leader”. Elf (2nd) 500gp Mountebank (5th) 2,000gp
This will normally be the party member Elf (3rd) 1,000gp Thief (1st) 120gp
with the highest charisma. That charac- Elf (4th) 2,000gp Thief (2nd) 240gp
ter can retain a number of loyal hirelings Elf (5th) 4,000gp Thief (3rd) 480gp
equal to four plus their charisma modifier.
Fighter (1st) 200gp Thief (4th) 960gp
Hirelings will not normally obey suicidal Fighter (2nd) 400gp Thief (5th) 2,000gp
orders or allow themselves to be used as *or per month of wilderness exploration
“trap detectors” or “cannon fodder”. They
are there to help out in fights and to help in transporting supplies On the other hand there is both a cost consideration and also the
and loot, not to act as monster fodder. consideration that particularly competent adventurers are likely to
be interested in adventuring on their own rather than seeking em-
Example: A party whose leader is fifth level wishes to employ some ployment with an existing group, since that is much more lucrative.
hirelings to accompany them on a mission to drive out an orc en-
campment that has been raiding in the local area. Since the party Although exact details may vary depending on the campaign world,
leader is fifth level, hirelings of up to 2nd level will be available. a useful rule of thumb is that hirelings that are available will range
from commoners to adventurers of half the level of the party leader
A  2nd level thief needs a total of  2,400xp to reach  3rd level, (rounded down, but with a minimum of first level and a maximum
that 2nd level thief would demand payment of a tenth of that in of fifth level).
gold – i.e. 240gp. A 2nd level magic-user, on the other hand, would
need 5,000xp to reach 3rd level, that 2nd level magic-user would They can be hired for a single adventure for a cost in gold of a tenth
demand payment of a tenth of that in gold – i.e. 500gp. of the experience that a character of their class would need for the
level above theirs (or 50gp for a commoner), or for an extended
expedition into the wilderness for that cost per month. The party
Getting the right hirelings can be a tricky business. On the one are expected to provide whatever equipment or mounts are needed
hand a party will want to hire competent help who are likely to by the hirelings, and they will expect half payment in advance.
survive the adventure and prove useful.

156
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–10: Mercenaries
Mercenary Type Human Clockwork Dwarf Elf Goblin Orc
Archer 15gp/season – 30gp/season 6gp/season 9gp/season
Cavalry, Heavy 60gp/season – – – –
Cavalry, Light 30gp/season – 60gp/season – –
Cavalry, Medium 45gp/season – – – –
Crossbowman 12gp/season 18gp/season 18gp/season – – 6gp/season
Footman, Heavy 9gp/season 15gp/season 15gp/season 18gp/season – 45sp/season
Footman, Light 6gp/season – 12gp/season 15sp/season 3gp/season
Horse Archer 45gp/season – 90gp/season – –
Longbowman 30gp/season – 60gp/season – –
Militia 3gp/season – – – –
Pony Crossbowman – 45gp/season 45gp/season – – –
Wolf Rider – – – 15gp/season –

Hirelings do not normally expect a share of treasure or magic items Footman, Light: First level fighters (or racial equivalent) armed
over and above their pay, although if given (or promised) such a with swords and shields and wearing leather armour.
share then their morale will be higher. Hirelings who are given
magic items to test will expect to be allowed to keep those magic Horse Archer: First level fighters (or racial equivalent) armed with
items as payment for the dangers involved in testing them. short bows, riding normal horses.

Mercenaries Longbowman: First level fighters (or racial equivalent) armed with
If characters need an entire army, rather than just a few helpers, longbows and swords and wearing chain mail armour.
they can hire mercenaries. Mercenaries are trained troops that will
work and fight for pay. The cost for mercenaries of different types Militia: Commoners armed with spears.
are listed in Table 8–10. The listed costs are for peacetime guarding
and patrolling duties. For active war-time duties, double all costs. Pony Crossbowman: First level dwarves armed with crossbows
and riding ponies.
When hiring mercenaries, they are assumed to come with captains
and other leaders as part of the cost. Mercenaries provide their Wolf Rider: Goblins armed with spears and wearing leather armour,
own equipment when first hired, but if garrisoned for an extended riding dire wolves.
period their employer is expected to provide armourers and black-
smiths to repair and maintain their equipment. Specialists
Sometimes a character will need the help of a different kind of
Archer: First level fighters (or racial equivalent) armed with short specialist. Maybe they need an engineer to oversee the building of
bows and swords and wearing leather armour. a large castle, maybe they need a scribe to write their memoires, or
maybe they just need a cleric to raise a dead party member.
Cavalry, Heavy: First level fighters armed with swords and lances
and wearing plate armour, riding war horses in plate barding. All of these situations require the character to employ a skilled
specialist of some kind or another.
Cavalry, Light: First level fighters (or racial equivalent) armed with
lances and wearing leather armour, riding war horses in leather Specialists will not expose themselves to danger, and will not ac-
barding. company characters on adventures.

Cavalry, Medium: First level fighters (or racial equivalent) armed The costs for different types of specialists are listed in Table 8–11.
with lances and wearing chain mail armour, riding war horses in Any specialist not on this table (for example a leatherworker or a
chain barding. scribe) should be assumed to have a cost of 5gp/month if skilled
or 2gp/month if unskilled.
Crossbowman: First level fighters (or racial equivalent) armed with
heavy crossbows and wearing chain mail armour. Animal Trainer: An animal trainer domesticates and trains unu-
sual animals. An animal trainer is not required for horses, mules,
Footman, Heavy: First level fighters (or racial equivalent) armed donkeys or dogs, but other animals can only be taught “tricks” by
with swords and shields and wearing chain mail armour. an animal trainer, who can handle up to six creatures of the same
species at a time. The length of time needed to train an animal will
depend on the animal type, but a month is average.

157
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–11: Specialists Castellan: A castellan is usually a fighter (or racial equivalent class)
of 5th to 9th level, and is in overall charge of the military aspects
Specialist Type Cost per Season
of a stronghold.
Animal Trainer 1,500gp
Armourer 300gp Chamberlain: A chamberlain is in charge of cleaning and cooking
Artillerist 2,250gp staff in a stronghold.
Bailiff 15gp Chaplain: A chaplain is a cleric who works full-time at a stronghold
Blacksmith 75gp looking after the chapel and performing religious services. Unlike
Castellan 6,000gp clerics who work in independent temples around a dominion, the
chaplain is salaried rather than living on donations and tithes.
Chamberlain 15gp
Chaplain 1,500gp Chemist: A chemist is a non-spell-caster who studies alchemy, and
Chemist 3,000gp may make potions like a magic-user, but takes twice the time and
Chief Magistrate 6,000gp cost to do so.
Engineer 2,250gp
Chief Magistrate: A chief magistrate is in charge of justice within
Equerry 15gp the dominion of a stronghold, and oversees the common magis-
Guard Captain 12,000gp trates and sheriffs.
Herald 1,200gp
Engineer: An engineer oversees the design and construction of
Magist 9,000gp buildings, roads, bridges, and other large scale structures. One
Marshal 15gp engineer is needed per 100,000gp cost of a building project.
Provost 15gp
Equerry: An equerry is in charge of the stables, and is a specialised
Reeve 1,500gp
form of bailiff.
Rower 6gp
Sage 6,000gp Guard Captain: A guard captain is usually a fighter (or racial
Sailor 30gp equivalent) of 8th level or higher, and is in charge of both the rulers
personal guard and the guarding of the stronghold.
Seneschal 12,000gp
Sheriff 15gp Herald: A herald is in charge of making announcements, and also
Ship’s Captain 750gp in charge of maintaining up to date news about (and coats of arms
Ship’s Nagivator 450gp of ) the rulers of nearby dominions. A herald also acts as an advisor
on matters of etiquette.
Spellcaster for Single Spell Special
Steward 3,000gp Magist: A magist is a magic-user (or racial equivalent class) of 9th
Warden 15gp level or higher who acts as an advisor on magical affairs.

Armourer: An armourer makes and repairs armour. One armourer Marshal: A marshal is a fighter (or racial equivalent class) who is
is needed per 50 troops, whether the troops are conscripted or in charge of recruiting and training troops.
mercenaries.
Provost: A provost collects taxes.
Artillerist: An artillerist is usually a fighter (or racial equivalent
class) of 3rd to 5th level, who is in charge of the placement, main- Reeve: A reeve is in charge of book-keeping and accounts within
tenance and operation of siege weapons. a stronghold.

Bailiff: A bailiff is an official who looks after part or all of a castle, Rower: A rower is an unskilled seaman who rows in a galley.
and makes sure that that part of the stronghold is in good repair.
Sage: A sage is an advisor who specialises in history and lore.
Blacksmith: A blacksmith extracts pure iron from iron ore and
makes steel. Sailor: A sailor is skilled at operating and maintaining ships and
boats.
Sometimes a blacksmith will also make simple metal goods; other
times the blacksmith will simply make ingots of metal that other Seneschal: A seneschal, sometimes called a vizier, is a ruler by
craftsmen will use. proxy who speaks for the actual ruler of the dominion when the
ruler is absent or when the ruler does not wish to bother with a
particular matter.

158
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Sheriff: A sheriff is responsible for law enforcement in an area of Magic-users and elves, on the other hand, tend to set artificially
dominion. high prices in order to not be constantly disturbed with petty
requests. Generally, this will be a cost of 10gp/caster level for each
Ship’s Captain: A ship’s captain is in charge of the wellbeing of a consultation (whether that results in a spell being cast or not).
ship and its crew. Druids set similar prices, but will generally be interested in an
equivalent value of goods, since they have little use for money.
Ship’s Navigator: A ship’s navigator is in charge of ensuring a ship
follows the correct course and getting it back on course if there Developer Commentary
have been problems. As someone who comes from a country with nationalised healthcare,
the idea that clerics would charge extortionate rates for healing
Spellcaster for Single Spell: Sometimes a character doesn’t need spells is alien to me.
to employ a spellcaster over a long term. They simply need a single
spell cast, whether it is to identify a magic item or to raise a dead Since there is a general setting conceit that temples are funded by
companion back to life. tithes, the casting of clerical spells is considered to be “part of the
service” that those tithes pay for, along with weddings, funerals, com-
The issues involved in this vary depending on the type of caster. ing of age ceremonies, and other blessings and services.
Clerics vary from religion to religion. While some secretive cults
will simply refuse to cast spells for outsiders (or will only do so When this is combined with the other great assumption of the set-
if paid in a similar manner to magic-users), the clerics of most ting – that most nobility is medium to high level characters with
mainstream religions are dedicated to good works and spreading adventuring experience – it results in a world where even the poorest
the popularity of their religion. As such, they will generally cast of peasants has access to healing spells and similar.
spells for free, especially if it is for something they consider to be
a good cause. Obviously, this has a large effect on the world. The basic quality of
life is much better than it would be in a “realistic” (i.e. Magic-free)
However, the problem is availability rather than cost – particularly setting, since there is much less disease and far fewer people killed
for healing (and raising) clerical spells or others that would compete or given long-term injury by accident.
for the same spell slots. There may be a waiting list for such spells,
as locals also need them. A few clerics may accept a bribe to push Not all the setting implications are positive, however. With the pros-
adventurers to the front of the queue, but most will not since their pect of being healed or possibly even raised afterwards, people are
own lay members and followers come first. much more willing to fight for what they believe in and conflicts are
much more likely to turn to violence than in the real world.
When trying to get a spell cast by a mainstream cleric, roll 1d8 and
consult the list below:
Steward: A steward is in charge of household affairs at a stronghold,
◊ 0 or Less = there is no cleric who can (or is willing to) cast the including housekeeping, maintaining food supplies, and so forth.
spell at this time.
◊ 1–2 = there is a long queue of people wanting the spell. It will Warden: A warden is a military advisor subordinate to the castellan
be available after 3d6 days. and is responsible for the defences of a particular area within the
◊ 3–4 = there is a queue of people wanting the spell. It will be dominion or stronghold.
available after 1d6 days.
◊ 5–6 = spell is used up or not learned, but will be available the Siege Weaponry
following day. Siege weaponry is, naturally enough, used when besieging a strong-
◊ 7 or More = spell is available immediately. hold. However, it can also be used defensively firing from the
stronghold itself or even used in naval warfare. Full rules for siege
Most of the time, the size of the temple or chapel will not affect combat are found in Chapter 14 – War!
the roll, since larger temples have more (and higher level) clerics
but also serve greater numbers of lay worshippers. Ballista: A ballista is a large crossbow mounted on a sturdy plat-
form. It fires bolts that are the size of spears. It is most commonly
However, if there is a particular reason for a high level cleric to be used to shoot into formations of troops, as the spears are of little
in a small temple, the roll should get a +1 bonus; and if there is a use against fortifications. A ballista on wheels can be pulled by a
particular reason for a large temple to have a shortage of high level single horse, mule or pony.
clerics then the roll should get a –1 penalty.
Battering Ram: A large heavy post or log that is usually used to
Similarly, if the desired spell is 2nd level or lower the roll should break down wooden walls or doors.
get a +1 bonus and if the desired spell is 5th level or higher the
roll should get a –1 penalty with an additional –1 penalty if the If it is mounted inside a belfry or gallery sled, it only needs half
spell is 7th level. the normal crew.

159
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
Table 8–12: Siege Weaponry

Other Crew

Ammo Cost
Artillerists

Hit Points
Fire Rate
Damage
Weight

Range

Cost
Item

Ac
Ballista 600lb – 4 100/200/300 1d10+6 1/2 rnds 4 9 75gp 2,000gp/wk
Battering Ram 300lb – 10 – 1d6+8 1/2 rnds –4 50 100gp –
Belfry 25,000lb – – – – – 0 75 750gp –
Bore 300lb – 10 – 1d6+14 1/2 rnds –4 50 150gp –
Cannon 1,000lb 2 3 250/350/450 1d10+10 1/3 rnds –4 75 1,000gp 12,000gp/wk
Catapult, Heavy 1,800lb 1 7 250/325/400* 1d10+10 1/6 rnds 0 27 250gp 6,000gp/wk
Catapult, Light 1,200lb 1 5 200/250/300* 1d8+8 1/5 rnds 4 18 150gp 4,000gp/wk
Gallery Shed 800lb – 8 – – – 4 40 300gp –
Hoist 1,200lb – 6 – – – 4 15 150gp –
Ladder 90lb – 2 – – – 4 3 3gp –
Mantlet 480lb – – – – – 0 16 16gp –
Light Ship’s Ram – – – – 3d8** – – – 3,000gp –
Heavy Ship’s Ram – – – – 6d6** – – – 10,000gp –
Timber Fort 720lb – – – – – 0 32 32gp –
Trebuchet 2,400lb 1 11 250/400/500* 1d12+13 1/6 rnds 0 50 400gp 8,000gp/wk
*catapults and trebuchets have a minimum range of 150’ **ship’s rams do full damage against other ships.

Belfry: A portable tower 30’ tall with a drawbridge at the top and ram or bore. A gallery shed provides troops inside it with a –12
a door at the bottom, connected by an internal staircase. The belfry bonus to armour class.
is pushed up to the walls of a fortification and then the drawbridge
is lowered so that it rests on top of those walls. Hoist: A hoist is a small platform fastened to a 30’ tall pole which
rests on a mobile base. It is pushed towards the wall of a fortifica-
Troops climb the stairs and cross the drawbridge onto the fortifica- tion, and then elite troops stand on the platform while the crew
tion walls. A belfry needs to be pulled by a team of four horses or pull it to the top of the pole by means of a rope and pulley system.
pushed by 20 humans. A belfry provides troops inside it with a –8 Although it does not offer the protection that a belfry does, it is
bonus to armour class. both cheaper and far more portable.

Bore: A bore is a large drill hung from chains like a battering ram. Ladder: This is simply a 30’ long normal ladder that is put up
It is pushed against the side of a fortification and used to drill into against the wall of a fortification and climbed. Since it is vulnerable
the side of it, weakening it. to being dislodged or broken, it is normally only used for either
stealth attacks or secondary attacks while most defenders are busy
Cannon: A cannon is basically an oversized gun on wheels that trying to fight off belfries and hoists.
shoots large iron balls rather than bullets. Although lighter than
catapults and trebuchets and requiring fewer untrained crew; can- Mantlet: A mantlet is an 8’ long 4’ high wooden palisade on wheels
nons are expensive to make, require more trained crew, and require that up to five troops can use to shield themselves from missile fire
a steady supply of red powder to work. as they advance towards a fortification.

Catapult: A catapult consists of a frame containing a wooden pole A mantlet provides troops behind it with a –4 bonus to armour class.
with a basket or bowl on the end that is pulled back under tension
and then quickly released so that it springs forward within the Ship’s Ram: A ship’s ram is like a battering ram, except fastened to
frame hurling whatever was put in the bowl towards the enemy. the front of a ship below the water line, offset to either side. The
ship attacks by ramming its target with a glancing blow, so that
A light catapult can be towed by a single horse, and a heavy catapult the ship’s itself doesn’t get significantly damaged by impacting the
can be towed by a pair of horses. enemy vessel with force, but the ram scrapes along the enemy’s hull
as the two ships pass. Ship’s rams do full damage to other ships.
Gallery Shed: A gallery shed is a wooden frame with side walls
and a roof but no end walls. It is used to either give cover to troops, Timber Fort: A timber fort is a number of 8’ long and 5’ high
allowing them to get close to a fortification, or to house a battering sections of wooden palisade that can be carried on a wagon and

160
Chapter 8 - Equipping for Adventure
quickly deployed in the field on order to provide cover from mis- Trebuchet: A trebuchet is a long pole with a sling on one end and
siles. Once deployed, it cannot be moved with any great speed. A a heavy weight on the other. The whole thing is mounted on a
timber fort provides troops inside or behind it with a –8 bonus wheeled frame. The pole is pulled down so that the sling is down
to armour class. to the ground and can be loaded, then it is released – at which
time the weight forces the pole to swing and the sling to fire the
ammunition in the direction of the enemy.

161
Chapter 9 - Dungeon Delving
T
he dungeon – whether an actual dungeon beneath a strong- Normal Darkness: This is the default state in the absence of any
hold, an ancient tomb, or a more natural cave system – is natural or magical light. Humans can’t see in this darkness, al-
the heart of the Dark Dungeons experience. though creatures with either the infravision or darkvision abilities
can use them to see.
Dungeon delving is the most straightforward type of adventur-
ing. The sort of dungeons that low level parties explore tend to Normal Light: Light from non-magical sources (e.g. Torches, lan-
be relatively enclosed environments that can often be explored a terns or natural daylight) trumps normal darkness and overrides
room at a time. it. Creatures with the infravision or darkvision abilities cannot use
those abilities in normal light that is stronger than moonlight, but
Time & Movement can see normally. A normal light is blocked by opaque objects and
When exploring dungeons, time is simply measured in straight- casts shadows behind such objects.
forward hours and minutes, as opposed to combat rounds which
last 10 seconds each. Characters in dungeons are assumed to be Light Spells: The Light spell creates a central light source (that
moving slowly and carefully, keeping a look out for danger, and hovers in the air or that moves with an object).
therefore move at a much slower rate than in combat.
That light source radiates magical light that is blocked by opaque
The movement speeds of characters are normally measured in feet objects. Creatures with the infravision or darkvision abilities can-
per round. When exploring a dungeon, characters normally move not use those abilities in the magical light, but can see normally.
at three times their normal movement speed per ten minutes.
Magical light from a Light spell trumps both normal light and
Example: Elfstar is encumbered by her armour and weapons and normal darkness except where blocked.
has a movement speed of 30’/round. When exploring a dungeon, she
will move at 90’ per ten minutes. Aloysius is unencumbered and has Any location within the area of one or more Light spells and also
a movement speed of 40’ per round. When exploring a dungeon he one or more Darkness spells is either lit or darkened depending on
will move at 120’ per ten minutes. which spell it is closest to the centre point of (excluding spells whose
centre points are obscured from the location by opaque cover).

When moving over familiar routes, characters can move at full In the simplest case – of an overlapping Light spell and Darkness
combat rates. spell with nothing to obscure either of them – this will result in
a straight line between the two with everything on one side light
Generally, it is not necessary to switch from general timekeeping to and everything on the other side dark.
round-by-round timekeeping for simple actions such as someone
casting a spell or picking a lock. However, when an encounter hap- Darkness Spells: The reversed form of the Light spell creates a
pens and it looks like a fight is about to break out then you should central source of darkness that hovers in the air or that moves with
start counting off time round by round. an object). That source radiates magical darkness that is blocked
by opaque objects. Creatures with the infravision or darkvision
Special Movement abilities can use those abilities in the magical darkness, but normal
Characters who are climbing or swimming move at half their nor- vision is useless.
mal speed (usually 20’/round).
Magical darkness from a Darkness spell trumps both normal light
Additionally, a character’s armour is counted three times when and normal darkness except where blocked.
determining their swimming speed. Any character whose speed is
reduced to zero or less by this extra encumbrance cannot swim at Any location within the area of one or more Light spells and also
any significant speed but can keep afloat with effort. If a character’s one or more Darkness spells is either lit or darkened depending on
speed is reduced all the way to “cannot move”, then they cannot which spell it is closest to the centre point of (excluding spells whose
even keep their head above water without aid. centre points are obscured from the location by opaque cover).

Light & Darkness In the simplest case – of an overlapping Light spell and Darkness
Light levels in a dungeon will vary tremendously. If the dungeon spell with nothing to obscure either of them – this will result in
is inhabited, it may also be lit; but since many creatures can see in a straight line between the two with everything on one side light
the dark, this is not always the case. and everything on the other side dark.

Similarly, adventurers are likely to bring their own light sources Continual Light: The Continual Light spell creates an area of ambi-
with them. Sometimes adventurers or dungeon denizens may also ent light centred on a point (that hovers in the air or that moves
have magical light sources or even sources of magical darkness. with an object).
These all interact in the following hierarchy:

163
Chapter 9 - Dungeon Delving
The area of effect is completely lit, regardless of opaque objects, In the simplest case – of an overlapping Continual Light spell and
leaving no shadows (although any amount of lead or 6” of stone Continual Darkness spell – this will result in a straight line between
will block the effect). Creatures with the infravision or darkvision the two with everything on one side light and everything on the
abilities cannot use those abilities in the magical light, but can other side dark.
see normally.
Developer Commentary
Magical light from a Continual Light spell trumps both normal light This hierarchy of levels of light and darkness, as well as the different
and normal darkness and also magical light and magical darkness ways that Light and Continual Light work (the first being a point
from a Light or Darkness spell. light source and the second being a region of ambient light) are my
own invention. The original game that Dark Dungeons emulates
Any location within the area of one or more Continual Light spells left the interaction between magical light and darkness somewhat
and also one or more Continual Darkness spells is either lit or ambiguous.
darkened depending on which spell it is closest to the centre point
of (regardless of the presence of opaque cover). Also, the original game that Dark Dungeons emulates divided up
non-combat time into a series of ten-minute “turns”. This was an
In the simplest case – of an overlapping Continual Light spell and unnecessary hold-over from its roots in wargaming, and only served
Continual Darkness spell – this will result in a straight line between to confuse people between the similar terms “turn” and “round”.
the two with everything on one side light and everything on the
other side dark. Dark dungeons simply drops the entire concept of “turns” and non-
combat times are simply described in minutes.
Continual Darkness: The reversed form of the Continual Light
spell creates an area of ambient darkness centred on a point (that
hovers in the air or that moves with an object). The area of effect Noticing Things
is completely dark, regardless of opaque objects (although any Some characters have the ability to spot details that others can’t.
amount of lead or 6” of stone will block the effect). Creatures with The stonelore ability of dwarves, for example, lets them notice
the infravision or darkvision abilities cannot use those abilities in newly built construction, gently sloping floors, traps involving
the magical darkness, and normal vision is also useless. shifting walls or blocks of stone, and secret doors involving mov-
ing stone walls.
Magical darkness from a Continual Darkness spell trumps both
normal light and normal darkness and also magical light and magi- Players do not need to specify that they are using these abilities on
cal darkness from a Light or Darkness spell. every single patch of wall or corridor.

Any location within the area of one or more Continual Light spells If their characters are moving at the normal cautious exploration
and also one or more Continual Darkness spells is either lit or pace, then this includes characters who have these abilities using
darkened depending on which spell it is closest to the centre point them, and the Game Master should automatically roll for such
of (regardless of the presence of opaque cover). abilities when the character comes within 20’ of something that
could be detected by them.

However, such abilities cannot be used if characters are in combat,


running, or otherwise not moving carefully.

Any character can listen for faint sounds echoing through the
dungeon. This is usually done at closed doors, in an attempt to
determine what – if anything – is on the other side of the door.

Characters listening at doors (or down corridors) must stand away


from the rest of the party and even then the party must be being
quiet. It is not possible to listen while there is conversation or
combat going on.

To see if a character other than a thief hears a noise, the Game


Master rolls 1d6. If the character is human (other than a thief ),
they hear a noise if a 1 was rolled. If the character is demi-human,
they hear a noise if a 1–2 was rolled.

To see if a thief character hears a noise, the Game Master makes


a standard check using the thief ’s hear noise ability as the check
bonus.

164
Chapter 9 - Dungeon Delving
In any case, the Game Master should not distinguish between rolls that shift out of the way when a lever is pulled, fireplaces or book-
that failed and rolls that succeeded but in situations where there shelves that rotate, or simply wooden doors that match the wooden
was no noise to hear. panelled walls of a room.

Doors Unless the secret door consists of a shifting stone wall (in which
With the exception of the most basic natural cave lair, almost every case a dwarf has a chance to notice it when simply walking past), a
dungeon contains doors of one type or another separating areas. secret door will not be seen by characters unless they either specifi-
cally search for it or they accidentally trigger its opening method.
Most dungeon doors are made of wood. In well maintained and
occupied dungeons, they are likely to be in a good state of repair Searching for a secret door takes 10 minutes per 10’ section of wall
and may or may not be locked, but in old dungeons and tombs, searched, and each character searching must roll 1d6. Any character
they may be swollen with seeping damp or otherwise stuck. In who rolls a 6 (or any elf who rolls a 5–6) finds the door. Note that
some cases they may have even be magically locked. if characters split up to search a room more efficiently, only one is
likely to search the location of the secret door.
The difficulty of opening a door depends on its state. Obviously
there may be individual situations in some dungeons that are dif- One-way Door: Some doors may be opened freely from one side
ferent – such as metal or stone doors – but usually they fall into but are magically locked from the other, thus allowing access in
one of the following categories. one direction only.

Normal Door: Characters can simply push or pull this door open Traps
and walk through. Traps are a common hazard in dungeons, and always a danger to
adventurers.
The chances of the characters surprising (or being surprised by)
whatever is at the other side of the door are normal. See Chap- The most common types of trap are often the simplest – pits with
ter 10 – Combat for details on surprise. fragile covers that will give way when someone walks over them;
poison needles in locks so that someone trying to pick the lock
Stuck Door: A door that has become stuck must be shoulder- will prick themselves on them; blades or spears that are rigged to
barged open. One character may attempt this per round, and must shoot out of the wall when a flagstone is stepped on; and so on.
roll a strength check in order to do so.
Generally, adventurers will have no chance to accidentally notice
If the first attempt is not successful, then whatever is at the other these traps – although some individual traps that are crude or badly
side of the door will be alerted by the noise and has no chance of made may offer a chance. Traps must instead usually be detected
being surprised. See Chapter 10 – Combat for details on surprise. by magical means or by the find traps ability of thieves and lupines.

Locked Door: A locked door may be barged open in the same way With the exception of large traps involving moving walls – which
that a stuck door can be, although the strength check is made with may be noticed by a dwarf ’s stonelore ability as the dwarf merely
a –4 penalty to effective strength. passes them – traps must be actively searched for. A thief or lupine
does not get to roll for their find traps ability by just walking past
Alternatively, a thief can attempt to pick the lock. Each thief is only an area that happens to contain a trap.
allowed one attempt to pick each lock, and if this fails they must
either give up or try again when they have improved their open Searching a 10’x10’ area for traps takes 10 minutes, just like search-
locks ability. However, a failed attempt to pick a lock will not alert ing for secret doors, and thief or lupine characters can search for
creatures on the other side of the door. both types of thing at the same time.

Barred Door: A door that is heavily barred may be barged open in When a trap is found, adventurers generally have three options.
the same way as a stuck door, although the strength check is made They can try to get past the trap without setting it off. They can
with a –8 penalty to effective strength. A thief cannot use their open try to set off the trap without getting hurt by it. Or they can try
locks ability to open a barred door unless there is a mechanism for to disarm it. Only a thief or lupine has the ability to disarm traps.
lifting the bar from the front of the door.
If the attempt to disarm the trap fails, the trap is set off – although
Magically Locked Door: A magically locked door cannot be the thief or lupine will usually not get hurt by it, depending on the
physically forced open. The magic must be bypassed or dispelled way the trap works. Should the trap be one that can be triggered
in some way (the exact details will vary depending on the specific more than once without needing to be manually reset, the thief or
magic used). lupine may attempt to disarm it a second time.

Secret Door: A secret door is a door that is camouflaged so that


it does not appear to be a door. Typical secret doors include walls

165
Chapter 9 - Dungeon Delving
Example: Black Leaf discovers a trap door rigged to open under Example: The inn that Elfstar is staying in has caught fire. The
the weight of a person and deposit them in a pit. She tries to remove first thing that Elfstar knows about this is when she is awoken by
the trap, and fails. The trap door swings open. Although she was not a burning beam crashing through the ceiling of her room onto her
standing on it and therefore hasn’t fallen in, it is now open revealing bed. In the first round, Elfstar is woken, but takes no damage since
a 10’ wide pit that the party must work out how to cross. the beam missed her.

Later, the party are walking up some stairs when oeric steps on a In the second round, Elfstar takes 1d6 points of damage from being
trapped step and a blade scythes out catching him on the leg. While in the burning bed.
Elfstar heals his wound, Black Leaf attempts to remove the trap so
that it won’t go off again and hurt anyone else. Not having a good She rolls a 4, so takes 4 damage, but doesn’t need to roll for her
day, she fails again. The blades scythe once more, but she is not clothing igniting since this is the first round in which she is in the
standing on the trapped step so they do not hit her. fire. Luckily, Elfstar has unused spells left over from the previous day,
and casts Resist Fire on herself. This will prevent her from taking
Eventually, the party come to a treasure vault containing a pedestal any more damage from non-magical fire sources.
on which sits a golden chalice. Black Leaf discovers that the pedes-
tal is trapped and if the chalice is removed then some gas or liquid In the third round, Elfstar again takes 1d6 points of damage from
will be squirted out of it. She tries to remove the trap and fails yet being in the burning bed. She rolls a 2, but resists the damage because
again. Poisonous gas is ejected from the pedestal and fills the room. of her Resist Fire spell. Since this is now the second round that she has
Unfortunately, since this fills the whole room leaving nowhere safe been in the fire, she has to roll to see if her clothing ignites. The fire
to stand, it will affect Black Leaf. has done a total of 6 damage to her, so her nightshirt has a 6x5%
= 30% chance of igniting. She rolls a 16, and her nightshirt goes
Environmental Damage up in flames. Elfstar quickly leaves the burning bed.
Whether falling down pits, being squirted with burning oil, or be- In the fourth round, Elfstar is no longer in the burning bed, but her
ing trapped in a room that is slowly filling with water; characters can nightshirt is on fire, doing 1d4 damage.
be subject to a variety of harmful environments in a dungeon – not
all of which are the result of traps! She rolls a 4, but doesn’t mind because her Resist Fire spell is still
keeping her safe.
Listed below are a number of common ways that characters can be
hurt by the environment: Elfstar now has a dilemma! does she try to put out the burning
nightdress, taking time? does she throw modesty to the wind and
Falling: Falling in an uncontrolled manner does  1d6 damage simply rip it off while running to rescue the other patrons of the inn
per 10’ fallen. If a character has deliberately jumped down rather from the fire? or does she try to rescue the other patrons of the inn
than simply fallen down, they may make a jumping check as if while still on fire herself?
making a high jump from a standing start. Whatever height they
get on the jumping check is subtracted from the height of the fall
before damage is rolled. Drowning and Suffocating: Characters who suddenly find them-
selves unexpectedly unable to breathe (because they’re being choked
Fire: Being hit with a burning torch will do 1d4 damage. or because they’ve suddenly been fallen into deep water, for exam-
ple) can hold their breath for a number of rounds equal to half
A natural fire the size of a camp fire will do 1d6 damage per round their constitution score. If the character expects the situation and
and each round after the first it has a 5% chance per point of total makes an effort to take deep breaths and hold their breath before
damage done of igniting the target’s hair and/or clothing. entering it, they can hold their breath for a number of rounds equal
to their full constitution score.
Being in a fiercely burning building will do 2d6 damage per round
and each round after the first after the first it has a 5% chance Once the character can no longer hold their breath, they will start
per point of total damage done of igniting the target’s hair and/ gasping uncontrollably and/or drowning; and will be at a –5 pen-
or clothing. alty to all activities (and be unable to cast spells) for 1d6 rounds.

Burning oil, such as a flask of lamp oil that has been lit and thrown,
Finally, the character will fall unconscious for a further 2d6 rounds
will do 1d8 damage and also has a 5% chance per point of damage before dying. If the character is brought to somewhere where they
done of igniting the target’s hair and/or clothing. can breathe during this time, they can be revived by a successful
healing check, or by any magical curing spell (Cure Light Wounds,
Characters whose hair and/or clothing has been ignited will con- Cure Serious Wounds, Cure Critical Wounds or Cureall).
tinue to burn for 1d6 rounds doing 1d4 damage per round, unless
the they have some way of putting out the flames, such as smother- If a magical curing spell is cast on the character at any time before
ing them or dousing them with water. death but without removing them from the situation in which they

166
Chapter 9 - Dungeon Delving
cannot breathe, it will bring them back to the start of the suffoca- Table 9–1: Reaction Rolls
tion or drowning process, as if they had just taken a deep breath.
1d20 Roll Reaction
Wandering Monsters 1–2 Hostile
The adventuring party may not be the only people (or creatures) 3–8 Aggressive
wandering around the dungeon. Some of the monsters that live in 9–17 Cautious
the dungeon will almost certainly move from place to place, and
there may be other creatures or other adventurers that have also 18–19 Neutral
entered the dungeon for reasons of their own; whether looking for 20 Friendly
food, shelter or to loot the place.
When two groups meet suddenly, for example if the party open
These creatures that may be found wandering around the dungeon a door or come round a corner and are suddenly faced with con-
are referred to as “wandering monsters”. fronted with one or more monsters, then the first thing that should
happen is that the game should switch from general timekeeping
The Game Master may decide that particular dungeons (or par- to round-by-round timekeeping, and the Game Master and play-
ticular areas within a dungeon) are more or less likely places for ers should roll for surprise (see Chapter 10 – Combat for details
adventuring parties to find wandering monsters; and may therefore of surprise).
alter the chance and frequency in those areas.
When the monsters have their first action, the Game Master should
The default frequency for wandering monsters in a dungeon setting determine what their reaction is to meeting the player characters.
is for the Game Master to roll 1d6 every twenty minutes of game
time (not real time). If the monsters act before the player characters have acted because
they surprised the players or won initiative, the Game Master will
If the Game Master rolls a 1, then the party will encounter a group either know in advance how the monsters will react based on their
of wandering monsters. personalities and the situation, or can consult Table 9–1. The
results of Table 9–1 are explained in the following paragraphs.
The Game Master may have a pre-prepared list of what monsters
(and how many) may be wandering around the dungeon. If not, ◊ Hostile: the monsters will immediately attack, flee or surrender;
roll on the wandering monster tables in this chapter (Table 9–2 depending on their numbers and strength compared to the ap-
to Table 9–7). parent numbers and strength of the party.

The wandering monster tables are arranged by the estimated dif- ◊ Aggressive: the monsters will not immediately attack, but will
ficulty of the encounters, and the numbers of monsters encountered threaten the party – either verbally or with growls and body
are tailored for this difficulty rather than necessarily matching the language. If the reaction needs to be re-rolled because the party
normal numbers that the monsters are found in. try to parley, the re-roll will take a –4 penalty.

The choice of which difficulty level to use should be based on the ◊ Cautious: the monsters will not immediately attack, but will
subjective difficulty of the dungeon itself. react with suspicion and may verbally challenge the party. They
will ready themselves in case the party attack.
A good guideline is to match the difficulty to the level of characters
that the dungeon was designed for. In any case, these tables are ◊ Neutral: the monsters will not attack, and will react in a neutral
generic and although they can produce a wide variety of monsters, manner; ignoring the party or greeting them in a gruff or formal
they can also produce wildly unrealistic results; indicating monsters (but not overly friendly) manner. They will take precautions in
that have no place in the current dungeon. case of attack by the party, but not in a threatening manner. If
the reaction needs to be re-rolled because the party try to parley,
Game masters are advised to use these tables only when they have the re-roll will have a +4 bonus.
not made a custom table for their dungeon, and to re-roll results
that don’t “fit” the current dungeon. ◊ Friendly: the monsters will greet the party in a friendly manner.

Encounters The party may respond to the monster’s reaction by attempting


As the characters move around the dungeon, they will need to to parley, or the party may act before the monsters and attempt
overcome natural obstacles, but will also meet the various dun- to parley.
geon denizens and need to deal with them. This will often result
in combat, but could also result in diplomacy, trade, or the two When the monsters get a turn, the Game Master will either know
parties simply ignoring each other. how they will react based on the players’ actions, or can roll on
Table 9–1 again with whatever bonus or penalty came from the

167
Chapter 9 - Dungeon Delving
Table 9–2: Wandering Dungeon Monsters (difficulty 1) Table 9–3: Wandering Dungeon Monsters (difficulty 2)
Number Number
1d20 Roll Monster 1d20 Roll Monster
Encountered Encountered
1 Beetle (giant fire) 1d6 1 Beetle (giant bombard) 1d6
2 Centipede (giant) 1d6 2 Cthonic worm 1
3 Ghoul 1d2 3 Ghoul 1d4
4 Goblin 1d6 4 Gnoll 1d4
5 Human (bandit) 1d6 5 Goblin 2d4
6–9 Human (commoner) 1d3 6 Grey ooze 1
10 Kobold 2d6 7 Hobgoblin 1d6
11 Lizard (giant gecko) 1d2 8–10 Human (commoner) 1d3
12 Locust (giant) 1d6 11 Lizard (giant draco) 1
13 Npc party 1 party 12 Lizard man 1d6
14 Orc 1d6 13 Neanderthal 2d4
15 Skeleton 1d10 14 Npc party 1 party
16 Snake (racer) 1d2 15 Orc 1d10
17 Spider (crab spider) 1d2 16 Skeleton 2d6
18 Stirge 1d8 17 Snake (pit viper) 2d6
19 Troglodyte 1d3 18 Spider (black widow) 1
20 Zombie 1d3 19 Troglodyte 1d6
20 Zombie 1d6

Table 9–4: Wandering Dungeon Monsters (difficulty 3) Table 9–5: Wandering Dungeon Monsters (difficulty 4–5)
Number Number
1d20 Roll Monster 1d20 Roll Monster
Encountered Encountered
1 Ape (cave) 1d4 1 Blink dog 1d4
2 Beetle (giant tiger) 1d4 2 Bugbear 1d6+4
3 Bugbear 1d6 3 Caecilian (giant) 1
4 Cthonic worm 1d3 4 Cockatrice 1d2
5 Doppelganger 1d2 5 Gargoyle 1d4+1
6 Gargoyle 1d3 6 Giant (hill) 1
7 Gelatinous cube 1 7 Harpy 1d4+1
8 Ghast 1d4 8 Hellhound (1d3+2 hd) 1d4
9 Harpy 1d3 9 Hydra (5-headed) 1
10–11 Human (commoner) 1d3 10 Medusa 1d2
12 Golem (clay) 1d4 11 Mournwolf 1
13 Medusa 1 12 Mummy 1d3
14 Npc party 1 party 13 Npc party 1 party
15 Ochre jelly 1 14 Ochre jelly 1
16 Ogre 1d3 15 Rhagodessa (giant) 1d3
17 Shadow 1d4 16 Rust monster 1d2
18 Spider (tarantella) 1 17 Scorpion (giant) 1d3
19 Wererat 1d6 18 Troll 1d2
20 Wight 1d3 19 Werewolf 1d4
20 Wraith 1d2

168
Chapter 9 - Dungeon Delving
Table 9–6: Wandering Dungeon Monsters (difficulty 6–7) Table 9–7: Wandering Dungeon Monsters
Number (difficulty 8–10)
1d20 Roll Monster
Encountered Number
1d20 Roll Monster
1 Basilisk 1d3 Encountered
2 Caecilian (giant) 1d4 1 Basilisk 1d6
3 Cockatrice 1d3 2 Black pudding 1
4 Giant (hill) 1d2 3 Chimera 1
5 Giant (stone) 1d2 4 Construct* 1
6 Hellhound (5–7 hd) 1d4 5 Dragon* 1d2
7 Hydra (6–8 headed) 1 6–7 Giant* 1d6
8 Manticore 1 8 Golem* 1d4+1
9 Minotaur 1d4 9 Hydra (7–12 headed) 1
10 Mummy 1d4 10 Npc party 1 party
11 Npc party 1 party 11 Phantom (apparition) 1
12 Ochre jelly 1 12 Purple worm 1
13 Ogre 2d4 13 Rust monster 1d4+1
14 Rust monster 1d3+1 14 Salamander* 1d4
15 Spectre 1d3 15 Snake* 1d4+1
16 Spider (tarantella) 1d3 16 Spectre 1d3
17 Salamander (flame) 1d2 17 Spider* 1d4+1
18 Troll 1d4+1 18 Vampire 1d2
19 Vampire 1 19–20 Werebear 1d6+1
20 Weretiger 1d3

original roll and an additional bonus or penalty based on the cha- the characters would prevent them getting lost far better than the
risma modifier of the party leader or spokesperson. verbal memory of the players remembering the Game Master’s
descriptions will prevent them getting lost.
If the players with to provoke the monsters into a hostile reaction,
treat any charisma bonus that the party leader has as if it were a The players’ map should not be considered an in-character item that
penalty of equal size. can be lost or destroyed. It is an out of character prop to remind
the players of what their characters can remember.
If the result of these opening reactions (whether role played or
rolled for) is that the party and the monsters end up talking, trad- Developer Commentary
ing or otherwise acting in a non-hostile manner towards each other, Most roleplaying groups that play the sort of fantasy games where
then the game can switch back to general timekeeping. dungeon delving is a thing will expect someone to map the dungeon
as they explore it. Dark dungeons is no exception, although it has
If the result is that a fight or chase breaks out, then the game should always struck me that the players’ map and the players’ senses of where
stay in round-by-round timekeeping, and the combat should be their characters are tend to be at the mercy of how well the Game
resolved using the rules in Chapter 10 – Combat. Master is able to describe their surroundings.

Mapping The rule about the map being an out-of-character item rather than
When in dungeons, it is common for one player to draw a map something that the characters themselves are drawing, as well as the
as the party progresses. The Game Master should encourage this, suggestion that the Game Master should help the players make sure
and should help the players to draw such a map quickly and ac- that the map is accurate, are attempts to overcome any discrepancy
curately. Remember that while the players are limited to whatever between what the characters would see and what the players have
description the Game Master gives them, the actual characters can had described to them.
see all around them.

While it is somewhat unrealistic for the Game Master to give exact


dimensions for rooms and corridors, it is nonetheless good prac-
tice, because it helps to offset the fact that the spatial memory of

169
Chapter 10 - Combat

W
hen a fight breaks out, or is about to break out, between and the party are aware of the presence of the monsters, the party
two groups of characters or monsters, timekeeping in cannot be surprised.
the game switches to round-by-round timekeeping and
the rules in this chapter are followed. In some very unusual situations, it is possible that one particular
member of a group may not be surprised while the rest of the group
Although in reality combat is fluid with actions happening simul- are. If that is the case, the unsurprised member will be able to act in
taneously, in Dark Dungeons the action is split into a number of the first round but other members of that group will not be able to.
discrete rounds during which each combatant (usually) gets one
action. Within the round, the action of each combatant is handled The Combat Round
one at a time, in order of their initiative. Each combat round is a period of ten seconds. During this time,
each combatant will normally perform a single action and possibly
Surprise also move. The round is split up into three phases, which are always
When two groups suddenly encounter each other, one or both performed in order:
sides may be surprised.
◊ Statements of intent
Assuming there are no special circumstances, each group rolls 1d6. ◊ Initiative roll
If that group rolls a 1 or 2, the group is surprised and may not act ◊ Actions (in initiative order)
in the first round of combat.
When all phases have been performed, a new round starts with
If both groups are surprised or neither group is surprised, then the first phase again. This continues until there is no more combat
round-by-round time simply starts as normal. or round-by-round action (such as chasing fleeing combatants)
happening.
If one group is surprised and the other group is not, the group
that is not surprised gets a single round in which to act before the Statement of Intent
other group can act. At the start of each round, each player must announce what their
characters are intending to do in the round, and the Game Master
A group that gains the advantage of surprise in this way does not announces what the monsters will do.
need to use it to attack the other side. They can use it to parley or
even to get a head start when fleeing. The statement of intent phase is split into three segments, which
proceed in order.
In some circumstances, one side or the other might not need to
roll for surprise. For example, if a party just spent three rounds ◊ Firstly, players may announce what actions their characters will
trying to break a door down, the monsters at the other side of the be doing this round, if they wish their characters to do such ac-
door cannot be surprised. Similarly, if a thief has scouted ahead tions urgently. If a player announces their character’s action at

171
Chapter 10 - Combat
this time, their character is assumed to be pressing on with that ◊ A player who waited to see what the monsters were doing before
action quickly, and the player will get a +2 bonus on their initia- declaring a statement of intent gets a –2.
tive roll this round. However, the disadvantage of announcing ◊ Halflings get +2.
at this time is that their intent is obvious to their enemies who ◊ All characters add their dexterity modifier to the initiative roll.
may decide how to respond accordingly. ◊ Some spells (e.g. Statue) give bonuses or penalties to the initia-
tive roll.
◊ Secondly, the Game Master announces what actions the monsters ◊ Some monsters get a bonus or penalty to their initiative roll.
will be doing this round, taking into account the fact that the
monsters will be aware of the intentions of the players that have In some cases, an item or ability will specifically indicate that a
already announced such intentions. character or monster will either automatically win initiative or
automatically lose initiative.
◊ Thirdly, players who wish their characters to be fighting in a more
cautious manner must announce what their characters will be If there is only one combatant using such an ability in a round,
doing this round. They have the advantage of not declaring (or then the effect is straightforward. The combatant does not need to
deciding) until after they know what the monsters are doing, but roll for initiative, and instead automatically wins or automatically
pay for this hesitancy by having a –2 penalty on their initiative loses depending on the ability.
roll this round.
If there is more than one combatant who “automatically wins”
When announcing their actions, people must specify whether they initiative then all those combatants will act before everyone else,
are going to attack (including target and whether a special attack but they should roll initiative normally in order to determine the
such as a smash will be used), run (including intended destina- order in which they go in relation to each other.
tion), cast a spell (including which spell and which targets), or do
another action. Similarly, if there is more than one combatant who “automatically
loses” initiative then all those combatants will act after everyone
Developer Commentary else, but they should roll initiative normally in order to determine
This explicit “statement of intent” phase is something that was sup- the order in which they go in relation to each other.
posed to be in the original game that Dark Dungeons emulates,
but due to an editing error the rules for it failed to make it into When two or more combatants roll the same initiative total, their
the published game. However, the idea of urgent actions declaring actions should take place simultaneously with the results of both
first and getting a bonus to the initiative roll while cautious actions actions being resolved after both actions have taken place. Com-
declare last and get a penalty to the initiative roll is my own. mon sense should prevail here, although if both make attacks on
each other, then it should be possible for both to kill each other
The reason for this rule is that otherwise all combatants would need simultaneously.
to decide on their intended actions simultaneously without knowing
what anyone else is intending to do, and doing this fairly in a man- When rolling for initiative, the players should each roll individually
ner in which the person who declares their intent last has the chance for their characters. The Game Master should roll once per type of
to change their mind after hearing the declarations of others would monster that the players are fighting, and roll separately for leaders
require onerous logistics such as writing down actions in secret and and/or other special monsters.
simultaneously revealing them or similar fiddly mechanics.
Actions
By letting the players decide how to balance the advantage of going The following actions are commonly used by combatants during
first against the disadvantage of signalling their characters’ actions to Dark Dungeons combat. The list is not exhaustive, as unusual
the opponents, we bypass the need for having a complex mechanism situations may require unusual actions to be performed, such as
to ensure that simultaneous decision and revealing is fair. breaking down a door.

In these cases, extrapolate from the listed actions in order to de-


termine when the action can be done, how it affects initiative, and
Initiative whether a character can also move in the same round.
Once everyone has announced their actions for the round, everyone
rolls for initiative, in order to see who manages to complete their Activate Magic Item: A combatant who declares that they are
actions first. activating a magic item (such as a wand or scroll) must declare
which item they are activating, which of the item’s powers they
The basic roll for initiative is 1d20, although there are various situ- wish to use, and who the targets are (if any).
ations or abilities that can modify this roll:
Only some magic items need to be activated in this way. See Chap-
◊ A player who declared a statement of intent before the monsters ter 19 – Treasure for more details about magic items.
did gets +2.

172
Chapter 10 - Combat
Example: Elfstar and Aloysius are fighting some zombies. Elfstar A combatant may abandon their activation action entirely (for
has already turned as many as she can, and Aloysius has run out of example if their chosen target is no longer valid or if the activation
spells, so they are both resorting to melee attacks. got disrupted) but may not otherwise change the target, item or
power during their action.
At the beginning of the round, Debbie knows that zombies are slow
and always lose initiative. Therefore during the statement of intent Attack: A combatant who declares that they are making an attack
phase she waits to see what the zombies are doing – knowing that (whether in melee, by throwing something, or by firing a missile
even with the –2 penalty to initiative rolls Elfstar will still act weapon) must declare who they are attacking during the statement
before they do. of intent phase.

Andy, on the other hand, knows that Aloysius’s staff is a two handed A combatant who declares that they are attacking with a two hand-
weapon, and therefore also always loses initiative; so he is going to ed melee weapon automatically loses initiative.
have to roll against the zombies. Wanting to finish off the zombie
that is attacking him before it gets another blow, he declares during A combatant who is attacking can move their normal per-round
the first part of the statement of intent phase that Aloysius is hitting movement distance (40’ for an unencumbered character) before
that zombie with his staff. Because andy declared before the zombies, making the attack, but may not move after the attack.
Aloysius will get a +2 bonus to his initiative roll against them.
Normally a combatant can make only a single attack per attack ac-
The Game Master then gives the statement of intent for the zombies. tion, but some combatants are capable of making multiple attacks.
These multiple attacks occur as part of the same action and on the
The one that is attacking Aloysius will continue to attack him, and same initiative, and the combatant cannot move between attacks.
the two that are attacking Elfstar will continue to attack her. The If a combatant has multiple attacks, then they must declare the
final zombie – which is too far away to attack anyone – will use its target for each attack during the statement of intent phase.
full movement to close to melee range with Aloysius.
If any of the attacks are disarm attacks, this must also be declared
Debbie now gives her statement of intent for Elfstar, which is to during the statement of intent phase.
make a melee attack on one of the zombies.
If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses
Initiative is rolled. Debbie doesn’t bother rolling because everyone from their weapon feats, they may use them at any time during a
except for her automatically loses initiative, so she automatically round in which they have declared an attack action.
acts first.
When taking their action, the combatant must move toward and
Andy and the Game Master both roll  1d20. Andy rolls a  14, attack the target(s) that they declared attacks on. They cannot
which – with his +2 bonus for making an early statement of in- change targets during the round, although they can simply abandon
tent – gives him an initiative of 16. The Game Master rolls a 12 either the movement or the attack or both, and simply not make
for the zombies. one or the other if they choose.

Then everyone takes their actions: Elfstar first, then Aloysius, then the
zombies. Andy hopes that going before the zombie that is attacking Example: During the statement of intent phase, Marcie declares
him will give him the chance to kill it before it attacks. that Black Leaf is going to stab the goblin that is guarding the door.
The Game Master declares that the goblin is going to try to run away.
The combatant is considered to be in the process of activating the
item from the start of the round until their action is resolved. If they When initiative is rolled, Marcie rolls a 1 for Black Leaf and the
take any damage before their turn (because someone who beat their Game Master rolls a 15 for the goblin. Even with Black Leaf ’s
initiative attacked them, for example) the activation is disrupted. initiative bonuses for her high dexterity and for declaring first, the
lucky goblin still beats her initiative roll and acts before her.
If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses
from their weapon feats, they may not use them during a round On the goblin’s action, it runs away from Black Leaf as fast as it
in which they have declared an activate magic item action with- can – which is at three times its normal per-round movement speed
out voluntarily (and immediately) allowing the activation to be (i.e. 3 x 30’ = 90’), shouting for reinforcements to come and help
disrupted if it is not yet complete. fight the adventurers.
If the activation is disrupted, the item still counts as having been On Black Leaf ’s turn, she can move a normal move (40’) towards
used. Depending on the item and power being activated, this may the goblin and attack. She cannot reach the goblin with this move,
result in charges or ‘per day’ usages being used up, or even the but decides to make it anyway. Since she is not within melee range,
destruction of the item if it was a single use item such as a scroll. she cannot make her melee attack so must abandon it.

173
Chapter 10 - Combat
If a combatant abandons the attack, they may not change their A combatant who is concentrating may move up to half their nor-
action. mal per-round movement speed during their action (usually 20’
for an unencumbered character).
Cast Spell: A combatant who declares that they are casting a spell
must declare which spell they are casting and who the targets are The concentration is assumed to last for the entire round, so if
(if any). the combatant who is concentrating takes any damage during the
round they will lose their concentration and the effect that requires
The magical special abilities of monsters are considered spells for concentration to maintain will end.
this purpose, even if they do not exactly match the description of
a standard spell. If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses
from their weapon feats, they may not use them during a round in
In order to cast a spell, a caster must be able to speak and must which they have declared a concentrate action without voluntarily
have at least one hand free to gesture. (and immediately) allowing their concentration to be disrupted.

The caster is considered to be in the process of casting the spell A combatant whose concentration has been disrupted before their
from the start of the round until their action is resolved. If they action may still make their declared movement.
take any damage before their turn (because someone who beat their
initiative attacked them, for example) the spell casting is disrupted. Fighting Withdrawal: This action may only be declared if the
combatant is in melee at the start of the round.
If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses
from their weapon feats, they may not use them during a round This is similar to a normal attack action in that the character can
in which they have declared a cast spell action without voluntarily move their normal per-round movement rate (usually 40’ for an
(and immediately) allowing their spell to be disrupted if casting unencumbered character) and then make one or more attacks.
is not yet complete.
However, instead of being committed to attacking their target, and
If the spell is disrupted, the spell slot is still used up. moving if necessary to reach the target; the combatant is instead
committed to moving away from their target.
A caster may abandon their spell casting action entirely (for example
if their chosen target is no longer valid or if the spell got disrupted) If the target acts before the character doing the fighting withdrawal,
but may not otherwise change the target or spell during their action. the withdrawing character gets their full defences against any at-
tacks the target might do.
Charge: A character can only charge if they are using a weapon
with that ability and if they are mounted. If the target acts after the character doing the fighting withdrawal,
and follows them in order to attack them, the withdrawing char-
A combatant who declares that they are making a charge must acter interrupts the attacking character after movement but before
declare the target during the statement of intent phase. their attack in order to make their own attack.

The character moves up to their mount’s normal per-round move- If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses
ment speed, and makes a single attack against their target the end from their weapon feats, they may use them at any time during a
of the movement. round in which they have declared a fighting withdrawal action.

If the attack hits, it does double the normal damage. Parry: The parry action is only available to some characters who
get it as a class option.
If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses
from their weapon feats, they may use them at any time during a A character who is using the parry action can move up to their nor-
round in which they have declared a charge action. mal per-round movement speed (usually 40’ for an unencumbered
character), but cannot make any attacks.
Concentrate: Some spells or other effects require ongoing con-
centration. During the entire round (both before and after the character’s
initiative), all melee and throwing attacks – but not missile at-
A combatant who declares that they are concentrating to maintain tacks – made against the character are made with a –4 penalty on
an effect must declare what the effect is that they are concentrating their attack rolls.
on, and if the effect is one that can be changed or moved by con-
centration they must also declare how they are changing or moving If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses
it. If the combatant also wishes to move in the round that they are from their weapon feats, they may use them at any time during a
concentrating, they must also declare where they are moving to. round in which they have declared a parry action.

174
Chapter 10 - Combat
Run: A combatant using the run action can move up to three wish to use, and who the targets are (if any). If the combatant also
times their normal per-round movement speed (usually 120’ for wishes to move in the round that they are using the item, they must
an unencumbered character). also declare where they are moving to.

The combatant must declare where they are running to during the Only some magic items can be used without activation in this way.
statement of intent phase – although this may be towards a moving See Chapter 19 – Treasure for more details about magic items.
target such as towards another combatant.
A combatant who is using a non-activatable item can move their
A character who chooses the run action may not change where they normal per-round movement distance (40’ for an unencumbered
are running to, but may stop running at any time short of their character) before using the item, but may not move after using it.
intended destination.
If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses
If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses from their weapon feats, they may use them at any time during a
from their weapon feats, they may not use them during a round round in which they use a non-activatable item.
in which they have declared a run action.
When taking their action, the combatant cannot change targets
Set Spear: A character can only set a spear if they are using a during the round, although they can simply abandon either the
weapon with that ability. movement or the usage or both, and simply not make one or the
other if they choose.
A combatant who declares that they are setting a spear against pos-
sible charges does not need to specify targets. If a combatant abandons the attack, they may not change their
action.
The character braces their weapon against the ground for the whole
round, and waits for incoming attacks. Attack Rolls
When a combatant makes an attack, their base chance to hit an
If, at any point during the round, the combatant is attacked by opponent is determined by adding the defender’s armour class to
someone using the charge action, they may interrupt the charging the attacker’s attack bonus. Either of these may be modified by such
character’s action after movement but before their attack in order things as spells, magical items, and high ability scores. The total of
to make their own attack. these used as the bonus for a standard check.

If this attack hits the charging opponent, it does double damage, If the attacker is a character, their attack bonus is based on their
the effects of which are resolved before the charging opponent class and level. See Chapter 4 – Creating a Character for details
gets their attack. on level based character abilities.

If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses If the attacker is a monster, their attack bonus is based on their hit
from their weapon feats, they may not use them during a round dice. See Chapter 18 – Monsters for details on monster hit dice.
in which they have declared a set spear action.

Smash: The smash action is only available to some characters who Example: A 3rd level fighter has a base attack bonus of +2, and
get it as a class option. has a +3 bonus to hit from various sources. They are attacking a
target that is armour class 6. Therefore the fighter’s to-hit value
A character who declares that they are making a smash action must is 2+3+6 = 11. If the fighter rolls 8 or less on their to-hit roll they
declare the target during the statement of intent phase. will miss their target since 11+8 is less than the 20 that they need.
If the fighter rolls 9 or higher on their to-hit roll they will hit their
A character performing a smash action always loses initiative. target since 11+9=20.
On the character’s action, they make a single melee attack against
their target with a –5 penalty to hit. If the attack hits, the combat- To determine if an attack hits, take the total bonus and add a roll
ant may add their strength score to the damage done by the attack, of 1d20 to it. As with any other check, if the total of the bonus
as well as adding their strength bonus as normal. plus roll is greater than or equal to 20, then the attack hits; oth-
erwise it misses.
If the character has any deflect abilities or armour class bonuses
from their weapon feats, they may not use them during a round However, attack rolls have a couple of differences from normal
in which they have declared a smash action. checks:

Use Non-activatable Item: A combatant who declares that they ◊ Rolling a 1 on the d20 before modifiers (called a “natural 1”) is al-
are using a non-activatable item (such as a ring or potion) must ways a miss, regardless whether the total is greater than 20 or not.
declare which item they are using, which of the item’s powers they

175
Chapter 10 - Combat
◊ Rolling a 20 on the d20 before modifiers (called a “natural 20”) is hit their target by giving a bonus to the to-hit value. Some, such
always a hit regardless whether the total is greater than 20 or not. as the target being invisible, will make it more difficult for the
attacker to hit them.
Example: A 1 hit dice creature has an attack bonus of +1, and is
Attribute Modifier: An attacker adds their relevant attribute modi-
attacking a target that is armour class –8. The monster has no other
fier (whether a bonus or penalty) to attack rolls. Strength is the
bonuses to hit. Therefore the monster has a to-hit value of –7. If the
relevant ability for melee attacks and attacks using hurled melee
monster rolls a 19 or less then it will miss its target since –7+19
weapons. Dexterity is the relevant ability for other thrown weapon
is less than 20. If the monster rolls a 20 then it will hit its target
attacks and missile weapon attacks.
since although –7+20 is also less than 20, a natural 20 always hits.
Cover: If the target of a missile, thrown or hurled attack is partially
Example: A 36th level fighter has a base attack bonus of +23, and
or wholly hidden behind an object (e.g. A parapet or a table, or
a +13 bonus to hit from various sources. When attacking a target
is behind an arrow slit), the attacker gets a penalty as shown on
that is armour class –1, the fighter has a to-hit value of 23+13–1
Cover Soft cover is cover that blocks sight of the
Table 10–2 – Cover.
= 35. If the fighter rolls a 1 on their to-hit roll they will miss their
target but will allow attacks through (such as smoke or a curtain).
target since a natural 1 always misses.
Hard cover is cover that will block both sight and attacks (such as
a wall or an overturned table).
If the fighter rolls 2 or higher on their to-hit roll they will hit their
target since 2+35>20. Since the to-hit value is more than 20 even
Haste/slow: an attacker gains a +2 bonus to hit for every level of
before adding the d20 roll, the fighter will do extra damage on a
speed (either because they are hasted or their target is slowed) that
hit. Specifically, since it is 15 more, the fighter will do +8 damage
they have above their target’s speed. Similarly, an attacker gains
on a hit.
a –2 penalty to his for every level of speed they have below their
target’s speed.

Developer Commentary Magical Weapons: Magical weapons can give an attacker a bonus
In the original game that Dark Dungeons emulates, as well as in the (or very occasionally a penalty in the case of cursed items) on their
very first printing of Dark Dungeons (the one with the red logo - the to-hit rolls. In the case of magical missile weapons, the bonuses on
more common gold logo version is the second printing) attacking the weapon and the ammunition stack.
worked rather differently.
Off Hand: If a combatant is using a weapon in their off hand and
Instead of using a simple formula to work out whether you hit your that weapon does not have the “off hand” ability, all attacks with
opponent or not, there was a big (it took up two full pages) table on that weapon have a –4 penalty on to-hit rolls, and the combatant
which you looked up your attack strength – which was not a numeric is treated for all purposes as having one fewer weapon feat with
bonus – and your opponent’s armour class and it told you what you that weapon than they actually have.
needed to roll on the dice, and then any modifiers you had affected
the dice roll itself. In fact, in the original game there were separate Range: If a ranged attack is made at short range for the weapon,
tables for each type of character and for monsters. the attacker has a +1 bonus to hit with the attack. If it is made at
long range, the attacker has a –1 penalty to hit with the attack. See
The second printing of Dark Dungeons simplified this into the system chapter 6: Weapon feats for weapon ranges.
we see here, where your attack strength is treated as a number, with
most modifiers pre-added, and you add your opponent’s armour Smash Attacks: Smash attacks get a  –5 penalty on their to-hit rolls.
classs to this number before rolling and trying to reach a fixed value.
The simplified system is mathematically identical to the original one Sneak Attacks: When a thief attacks a target who is unaware of
in 99% of cases, and much easier to use. them gets a +4 bonus to hit. This stacks with the normal +2 bonus
for the attack being unseen.
In fact, it was this simplified system that led to the writing of Darker
Dungeons – which, like this game, used the simplified system for Note that the target must be completely unaware of the thief ’s pres-
almost all rolls. ence. It is not enough for the thief to be simply behind their target,
the thief must also have made a move silently check or otherwise
be unknown to the target.
If the bonus for the check is already greater than 20 before adding
the d20 roll, the attack will do extra damage if it hits. Each two Thieves can only make sneak attacks with melee weapons or with
points (round odd points up) that the to-hit value exceeds 20 by missile, thrown or hurled weapons at short range.
means that the attack will do 1 extra point of damage.
If the thief makes multiple attacks in the same action, all such
Attack Modifiers attacks get the +4 bonus.
Various factors will affect the to-hit roll of an attack. Some, such
as the attacker having weapon feats, will make it easier for them to

176
Chapter 10 - Combat
Table 10–1: Cover
Weapon Feats: Some weapons, particularly shields, give their wield-
Type of Cover To-hit Modifier ers bonuses to armour class at higher proficiency levels.
Soft Cover Up to Knees –1
Soft Cover Up to Waist –2 These bonuses may work against all attacks or may only work
against certain types of attack.
Looking Around or
–3
Through Soft Cover The armour class bonuses from high proficiency with a weapon
Fully Behind Soft Cover –4 cannot be used in rounds during which the character is perform-
Hard Cover Up to Knees –2 ing the run, set spear or smash actions, and it can only be used in
rounds during which the character is performing a activate magic
Hard Cover Up to Waist –4
item, cast spell or concentrate action if the character’s action has
Looking Around or already been disrupted or if the character is willing to immediately
–6
Through Hard Cover disrupt their action by using the armour class bonus.
Fully Behind Hard Cover Can’t attack
Missile Weapons in Melee
Unseen Attacks: If an attacker attacks from above or behind their If a character is in melee with other combatants when their action
target, or is invisible, or otherwise can’t be directly seen by the occurs, they cannot use a missile weapon.
target in a combat situation; the attacker gets a +2 bonus to hit.
Thrown and hurled weapons may still be used in this situation.
Unseen Target: If a target is not visible to the attacker for any
reason, the attacker has a –4 penalty to hit with melee attacks, and Haste & Slow
cannot attack with ranged attacks. Characters can be hasted or slowed by the Haste and Slow spell,
and also by other similar effects.
Weapon Feats: The level of weapon proficiency that an attacker
has with the weapon they are using will give anywhere from a +0 Multiple versions of the same hasting or slowing effect do not stack,
bonus to a +8 bonus to hit with the attack. See chapter 6: Weapon but different effects (e.g. A Haste spell and a potion of speed) do
feats for details about the bonuses given to different weapons at stack, to a maximum of double effect.
different levels of proficiency.
The effects of haste and slow on a character are as follows:
Armour Class Modifiers
The armour class of an unarmoured character will normally be 9. Double-slowed: The character moves at a quarter of normal speed,
That is the default value for an average person. Monsters often have and makes attacks at a quarter of their normal rate. They also auto-
better (i.e. lower) armour classes than that because of their tough matically lose initiative (or no longer automatically win initiative
hides, better-than-human agility, or a combination of the two. if they would otherwise do so).

That armour class will be modified either upwards (making the Slowed: The character moves at half normal speed and makes at-
character easier to hit) or downwards (making the character harder tacks at half their normal rate. They also get a –2 penalty on their
to hit) by various things. initiative rolls.

Armour: Characters who are wearing armour will have a better Hasted: The character moves at double normal speed and makes
armour class than 9. This ranges from ac 7 when wearing leather attacks at double their normal rate. They also get a +2 bonus on
armour to ac 0 when wearing suit armour. their initiative rolls.

Only one set of armour may be worn at a time, and adding or Double-hasted: The character moves at four times normal speed,
removing a helmet does not change the armour class granted by and makes attacks at four times their normal rate. They also auto-
armour. matically win initiative (or no longer automatically lose initiative
if they would otherwise do so).
Monsters who wear armour get either their normal armour class or
the armour class granted by the armour they are wearing, whichever Magical actions, such as using magical devices or casting spells are
is better. not affected by haste and slow, and always take the normal time
to perform. However, the character still gets the initiative bonus
Dexterity Modifier: A character must subtract their dexterity or penalty; and if the magical action is one that also allows move-
modifier from their armour class (not add it). Characters with ment in the same round, that movement is affected normally by
high dexterity are harder to hit. the haste or slow.

Small: Because of their small size, halflings get a –2 bonus to ar- Characters may find that they a making half an attack per round or
mour class against attacks from creatures larger than human sized. one and a half attacks per round when slowed. In these cases, the
character’s “half ” attack is made every other round.

177
Chapter 10 - Combat
Remember that characters gain +2 on attack rolls for every level When a monster attacks, the amount of damage it does with each
of speed they are faster than their opponent by, or –2 on attack attack will be listed in the monster’s description.
rolls for every level of speed they are slower than their opponent by.
The amount of damage done by an attack may be changed by
Two Weapon Fighting various things
When a character wields a weapon in either hand, they make one
extra attack with their off-hand weapon in addition to however Hurled Weapons: A weapon with a hurl range is one that is not
many attacks they get with their primary weapon. normally thrown, but with great skill and effort can be hurled at
an opponent.
If the weapon being used in the off hand does not have the “off-
hand” ability, then the attacker is treated as having one fewer Because such weapons are not aerodynamic and do not fly well,
weapon feat with the weapon for all purposes, and there is an opponents who are not surprised by the attack may make a saving
additional –4 penalty to hit. throw vs. death ray in order to take half damage. However, the
first time in each fight that an opponent has the weapon thrown
The additional off hand attack is not modified by the number of at them, they must roll for surprise at normal chances due to the
attacks gained at high level and is not affected by haste or slow unexpected nature of the attack.
conditions.
Magical Weapons: Magical weapons can give an attacker a bonus
Example: Oeric is a 25th level fighter and is fighting a creature that (or very occasionally a penalty in the case of cursed items) to their
he only needs to roll a 2 to hit, and so he normally gets three attacks damage rolls. In the case of magical missile weapons, the bonuses
per round. He is wielding a normal sword in his main hand and on the weapon and the ammunition stack.
a dagger in his off hand. He is a grand master with both weapons.
Smash Attacks: When a character makes a smash attack, they add
He is also hasted. their strength score to the amount of damage they do, in addition
to adding their strength modifier as normal.
Each round, oeric gets 6 attacks with his sword (3 per round doubled
for the Haste spell) plus a single attack with his dagger. The sword Sneak Attacks: When a thief makes an attack that is not only
attacks are done at grand master level, and the dagger attack is done unseen but is against a target that does not know the location of
at master level with an additional –4 penalty to hit. the thief (this will normally require a successful move silently check
to be made by the thief ’s player), the thief does double damage
with that attack.

Damage Thieves can only make sneak attacks with melee weapons or with
When an attack hits, it will usually do damage to its target, reduc- missile, thrown or hurled weapons at close range.
ing the target’s hit points.
If a thief makes a sneak attack with a hurled weapon, the target is
When player characters hit with attacks, the amount of damage automatically considered to be surprised by the attack and cannot
that they do is based on their level of proficiency with the weapon make a saving throw vs. death ray in order to take half damage,
that they are using (see Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats for details). even if the thief has hurled a weapon at them previously in the fight.

178
Chapter 10 - Combat
If the thief makes multiple attacks in the same action, all such at-
tacks have their damage doubled. Helpless Targets
A target who is completely helpless because they are paralysed,
Strength modifier: if a character makes a melee, hurled or thrown sleeping or unconscious may be given a coup de grace with any
attack, they must add their strength modifier to the damage that edged weapon.
the attack does.
This will immediately knock them unconscious (if they weren’t
Characters do not add their strength modifier to attacks made already) and make them start dying as if they had run out of hit
with missile weapons. points, but will not actually cause them to lose any hit points.

Effects of Damage Dying & Death


A combatant who has at least one hit point left can fight on without When a character runs out of hit points, they fall unconscious and
penalty. When a combatant has no hit points left, they are knocked can take no more actions. At the end of the round in which they
unconscious and may die. fell unconscious, the character must make a saving throw vs. death
ray in order to stay alive. If the saving throw fails, the character dies.
There is no such thing as “negative” hit points. A character either
has hit points left or has run out. The saving throw must be repeated at the end of each subsequent
round until either the character dies or they either have their
Hit points are not a direct representation of physical toughness. wounds tended by a character who successfully uses the first aid
They are rather an abstract representation of the ability of a com- skill on them or are given magical healing. However, each saving
batant to fight on. throw after the first gets a cumulative –1 penalty.

Hit points are a mixture of pain, fatigue, luck, and fighting skill., Example: Gretchen and Elfstar are fighting a giant. Unfortunately,
and losing hit points represents a wearing down of all these to the Gretchen only has 7 hit points left, and the giant hits her for 21
point where a combatant is in danger of being killed by the next damage.
blow. Until that point, however, characters taking damage are as-
sumed to be using their fighting skill and luck to avoid direct hits Gretchen now has 0 hit points (the extra damage is ignored) and
from their opponents, taking only light scratches, bruises and nicks falls unconscious.
from attacks at the most; and the hit points they are losing represent
that extreme effort taking its toll on the character. At the end of the round, Gretchen must roll a saving throw vs. death
ray. She makes the roll and survives the round.
Example: In the hands of a moderately proficient user, a normal
sword will do 1d8 damage to someone who is hit by it. That has a The following round, Elfstar is stuck, unable to tend to her friend
better than 50% chance of incapacitating a commoner, resulting because of the giant. Instead she attacks the giant and hurts it badly.
in them being knocked unconscious by the blow and probably start-
ing to bleed to death. Clearly the commoner has taken a nasty stab At the end of the round, Gretchen rolls a second saving throw vs.
wound from the sword that they are unlikely to recover from, perhaps death ray, this time at a –1 penalty. She makes this one too.
a chest wound resulting in a punctured lung or something similar.
In the third round, Elfstar again attacks the giant, and manages
However, if a 10th level character is “hit” by that same sword blow, to kill it.
the 1d8 damage will have no chance of killing them and will only
take away a small proportion of their total hit points. At the end of this round, Gretchen makes her third saving throw
with a –2 penalty this time. Again, she makes it.
This does not mean that the 10th level character is somehow able to
be stabbed in the chest repeatedly and not be killed by such wounds. The fight with the giant is now over, but since Gretchen is in danger
That would be ridiculous. of bleeding to death, the Game Master continues to use round-by-
round timekeeping.
Clearly the character managed to deflect or dodge the blow that
would have killed a lesser combatant, and rather than the sword In the fourth round, Elfstar doesn’t want to risk trying to bandage
stabbing them in the chest it merely scratched them as they twisted to Gretchen’s wounds in case she fails the first aid check, instead she
desperately avoid the worst of the blow. It’s left them a little shaken casts a Cure Light Wounds spell on Gretchen.
and fatigued, but they’ll be able to continue fighting for a while yet.
Debbie, Elfstar’s player, rolls 1d6+1 for the spell, and gets a 4.
If a few more sword blows hit the fighter, taking them down to only a Gretchen is healed back up to 4 hit points, and does not need to
handful of hit points left, then they are clearly exhausted; so battered make any more saving throws to avoid dying.
and worn down that they may be unable to parry or dodge any more
such blows and the next one may hit them squarely and kill them. Now that the immediate danger is over, Gretchen and Elfstar start
to bandage their wounds.

179
Chapter 10 - Combat
Table 10–3: Simple Building/structure Combat Ratings
Type of Structure Armour Class vs. Missile Armour Class vs. Melee Structure Points
Simple Wooden Building –4 6 40
Simple Stone Building –4 6 60
Reinforced Wooden Stockade
–4 6 300
Wall
Barred Wooden Palisade
–8 2 100
Gate
Reinforced Stone Castle Wall –4 6 500
Reinforced Iron Door –10 2 35
Iron Portcullis –4 6 150
Wooden Ship See chapter 12 See chapter 12 See chapter 12

In the case of monsters, each monster listing in Chapter 18 –


Structures in Combat Monsters has a base morale score. In the case of hirelings em-
Sometimes combat will not just involve creatures, but will also ployed by PCs, their base morale score will be eleven plus the
involve structures such as buildings and/or ships taking damage. charisma modifier of the designated party leader. See Table 3–1 for
charisma bonuses and Chapter 8 – Equipping for Adventure
This may be incidental to the fight, or one or both sides in the fight for more information on employing hirelings.
may be deliberately targeting structures.
When a fight appears to be going against an individual or a group,
While a full siege is dealt with in Chapter 14 – War! the following the Game Master may make a morale check for them.
rules can be used when there is a simple attack; such as a tribe of
goblins using a battering ram to break down a town gate, or two A morale check is a standard check made using the morale score
ships exchanging cannon fire. of the individual or group as the check bonus.

Attacking a structure is just the same as attacking a creature – the If the check succeeds then they will continue to fight, but if it fails
attacker rolls a to-hit roll based on their attack bonus and the then they will either flee, surrender, or attempt to halt the fight
structure’s armour class. and parley.

However, damage is handled differently, since structures are much Characters with extremely high charisma modifiers may provide
tougher than creatures but don’t get fatigued. their followers with such a high base morale score that they will
never fail a morale check even with extreme situational penalties.
Normal hand held weapons (including hand held missile weapons)
do no damage to structures. While it’s possible to totally destroy Morale checks should be made at the beginning of the statement
a wooden building with an axe, it’s simply not possible to do it of intent phase of combat, before the monsters or NPCs decide
during the course of a few combat rounds. on their action for the round.

Attacks from ogre sized or larger creatures, siege weapons and magic The exact times when a morale check is needed may vary from fight
spells do affect structures. to fight, but can include such times as:

Wooden structures lose 1 structure point for each 2 hit points of ◊ Opponents start a fight when the group does not wish to fight.
damage done by such attacks, although creatures which eat wood ◊ Opponents display vastly superior magic or fighting ability.
do full damage. ◊ Half the group is slain or incapacitated.
◊ Members of the group have already fled.
Stone structures lose 1 structure point for each 5 points of damage ◊ The group’s leader is slain or incapacitated.
done by such attacks, although creatures who can burrow through ◊ Opponents kill a significant number of the group in a single
rock do full damage. round.
◊ Opponents display willingness to escalate the fight (killing in a
Morale fight that was previously non-lethal).
Although players will always decide whether to stand and fight or ◊ Reinforcements arrive to shore up the opponents’ numbers.
to retreat when a fight seems to be going against them, sometimes ◊ An individual is badly wounded (less than half hit points).
the Game Master needs to quickly determine whether an NPC or ◊ Opponents make an offer to accept a surrender.
a monster will run or fight.
Although there are many possible situations listed above that might
require morale checks, such checks should not be overused. Crea-

180
Chapter 10 - Combat
tures should not be checking morale more than two or three times ◊ The expectation that the enemy will slay incapacitated prisoners
in a fight at the most. if victorious.
◊ The expectation that the enemy will torture prisoners if victorious.
The Game Master should also bear in mind what happens after ◊ The expectation that the enemy will be merciful if victorious.
death in their campaign setting. If the existence of life after death ◊ The knowledge that if the combatant is incapacitated but their
or some other form of continued consciousness is a known fact side wins the fight they will be healed.
in the setting rather than a mere matter of faith then intelligent ◊ The fear of being executed (or worse) for cowardice if they run.
creatures will be more likely to fight to the death than to surrender ◊ A creature is fighting for reasons of desperation (e.g. Extreme
to possible maltreatment or torture. Similarly, intelligent creatures hunger or maddening pain).
who have good reason to think that they will be raised from the ◊ A previous offer to surrender has not been accepted.
dead by their employers or priests will be more inclined to fight
to the death. When an individual or group fails a morale check, it is up to the
Game Master how they behave.
The above factors should be taken into account and should give situ-
ational modifiers to the morale checks made by intelligent creatures. In the case of unintelligent creatures, this will almost always involve
a fighting retreat. Intelligent creatures may retreat or it may try to
Other factors that may give situational modifiers to morale checks stop the fight by either surrendering or otherwise parleying with
for intelligent and/or unintelligent creatures include: the attacking force.

◊ Fighting with no escape route. In extreme cases where intelligent creatures think that escape is
◊ Fighting to defend one’s home or lair. likely to be impossible and that the consequences of losing the
◊ Fighting to defend loved ones or innocents. fight and surviving would be worse than death, it may even include
suicide.

181
Chapter 11 - Getting Better
A
dventuring is dangerous business. Characters can be hurt or
killed in combat or by traps, or maybe an even worse fate Bringing the Dead Back
can befall them and they may have their life drained or they What happens to a character’s soul or life force after death will
may be turned to stone. depend on the individual campaign world that the Game Master
has set up.
Whatever happens, characters can usually get better. They can heal
from even the most grievous wounds given time, and magic can However, the game assumes that death is not the end, and that it is
heal what time cannot. possible to bring people back, providing they are willing – someone
who is happy in their afterlife may not wish to be returned to life,
Additionally, the experience gained by characters when adventuring and cannot be forced back to life even using a Wish spell.
makes them better at what they do. Characters who gain enough
experience increase in level and gain new abilities as well as getting For any of these spells to work, the recipient must actually still be
physically tougher. dead. If the recipient has been reincarnated or otherwise reborn
(whether through magic or as a natural part of the way the cam-
Healing Damage paign world works) then no magic will bring the old body back
There are three things that will heal the normal damage (i.e. Lost to life.
hit points) that a character suffers: time, first aid, and magic.
See Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for full details of these
Time: All characters heal one hit point per day if active, or two individual spells.
hit points per day if resting. If the characters are adventuring over
an extended period, this healing should take place each morning Raise Dead: This is the most limited spell. The spell only works
when the characters wake up. on mostly intact corpses of humans or demi-humans that are days
or a few weeks old at the most.
First Aid: If a character is injured, someone can use the first aid
skill to heal 1d3 points of damage. The skill can only be success- The recipient will also need two weeks of bed rest to recover from
fully used once per injury (a whole fight’s worth of damage counts the ordeal. On the other hand, the spell is the easiest to acquire.
as a single injury for this purpose – there is no need to track each
separate attack individually). Additionally, each character can only Raise Dead Fully: Although a much higher level spell and therefore
attempt first aid once per injury whether successful or not. much more difficult to acquire, this spell is the most flexible when
it comes to the state of the body.
Magic: There are many spells that will heal damage. There is no
limit to how many may be cast on an individual, other than the The body can be anywhere up to a few years old, and does not need
number that are available. Some magic items, such as healing po- to be intact – the caster needs only a small portion (although that
tions, can also heal damage to characters. portion must have been taken from the body after death).

Preventing Dying Reincarnation: This spell has the advantage that it is the only way
Characters who have run out of hit points must make a saving of bringing back someone who has been dead for decades or more,
throw vs. death each round (with a cumulative –1 penalty per although a body part is still needed.
round) to avoid dying.
The problem with the Reincarnation spell is that even if the species
See Chapter 10 – Combat for more detailed rules about dying. and gender of the new body match the old one, it will still look
different and will not be visibly recognisable as the same person.
This process can be stopped by one of the following ways: This can be very upsetting to family and friends, and to the recipi-
ent’s own self-image.
First Aid: A successful use of the first aid skill will stabilise a char-
acter and prevent them from dying. This use of the skill can be Restoring the Petrified
tried multiple times until it succeeds or until the character dies, Some creatures, and some magical effects, are capable of turning
although only one person can apply first aid to a character at once. a person to stone.

Using the first aid skill in this way does not count as having used it People who have been petrified in this manner are not dead, and
to heal the character’s injuries, and it can still be used independently therefore cannot be raised or resurrected. However, they are not
on the same character for that purpose. conscious and will not age.

Magical Healing: Any amount of magical healing (whether from The only way to restore someone who has been petrified is to use
a spell or from a magic item) will immediately and automatically the Stone to Flesh spell.
prevent the character from dying in addition to healing the normal
amount of hit points for the spell or item.

183
Chapter 11 - Getting Better
◊ Income from the sale of magic items.
Restoring Life Energy
Many undead have the ability to drain the energy from the living. In other cases, experience may or may not be awarded for money
This is represented in the game by the loss of experience points and gained at the discretion of the Game Master.
consequent levels. It is a particularly feared ability, since it will not
heal on its own and there are few ways to protect against it. Note that experience points gained for treasure are individual in
nature. If an adventuring party finds treasure collectively, experi-
If someone has had their energy drained and survived the process, ence is gained by each party member separately based on how much
the only way to restore their lost energy is via the Restore spell. they individually receive when the money is shared out (which
However, this spell is very taxing for the caster, giving them a similar may or may not be equal to the amount that other party members
(albeit temporary) condition. receive, depending on how the party decides to share out treasure
and magic items).
However, in the absence of an available cure, further adventuring
will enable a character to overcome their drained energy by the Monsters: The party collectively gain experience for every monster
simple method of re-gaining the experience that has been lost. that is defeated over the course of an adventure. This does not
necessarily mean that the monsters have to be killed. Driving off a
Developer Commentary monster or forcing it to surrender still counts as defeating it.
In the first edition of Dark Dungeons, I added a house rule that a
dead person who was raised using a Raise Dead (or similar) spell Monsters can sometimes be evaded, or successfully dealt with dip-
would be automatically restored to their former level. lomatically, avoiding a fight altogether; or sometimes they can be
“defeated” in other ways such as by the party solving a riddle that
I now consider that this house rule was a mistake, as it made the the monster poses.
Restore spell redundant and resulted in the weird situation of people
killing themselves to be raised in order to cure themselves, so I have Only monsters that were a potential threat to the party should
removed the rule from this new edition. be worth experience for defeating. The party should not be given
experience for “defeating” the high priestess of the local temple just
because they persuaded her to heal a party member, for example.
Gaining Experience
As characters adventure, they gain experience and get better at what See Chapter 18 – Monsters for details of how many experience
they do. This is measured in experience points (often abbreviated to points each monster is worth.
xp). Characters are awarded experience points in various situations,
and these get added to the character’s experience point total. With Unless the adventure is some kind of special solo side quest for
the exception of being caught by an Energy Drain attack, experience an individual character, experience gained for defeating monsters
points are never deducted from a character’s total. should be shared equally between all party members even if not all
took an equal part in the fight (or even if not all party members
There are a variety of things that characters can be given experi- were present and conscious for every fight).
ence points for:
It is usually most convenient to give experience for monsters in a
Treasure: By far the most experience that a character normally gets single lump sum at the end of an encounter or series of encounters
is by gaining treasure. Gaining treasure earns a character experience that take place within a single day of game time.
at a straightforward 1gp = 1xp rate. Treasure from the following
sources should always gain the character experience: Achieving Plot Goals: If the party are taking part in an ongoing
plot, they may be given bonus experience for achieving goals that
◊ Treasure found while adventuring. move the plot towards conclusion, at the Game Master’s discretion.
◊ Money paid as “rewards” or other payment for missions or ad-
ventures. Other: At the Game Master’s discretion, characters can be given
◊ Money stolen from monsters or NPCs (usually by thief char- other miscellaneous experience point awards for such things as good
acters). roleplaying, humour, or even being the only person to remember to
◊ Monthly income from a dominion. bring dice! Whether or not this type of miscellaneous award is used
◊ Income from the sale of gems, jewellery and other valuable items (and how often) will depend heavily on the tone of the campaign.
and goods (except magic items) found while adventuring.
Gaining Levels
The following sources of income should never gain a character Every character class has experience totals needed for each level of
experience: experience from 1 to 36 listed in their class table in Chapter 4 –
Creating a Character. When a character gains enough experi-
◊ Money given to the character by (or stolen from) other party ence points such that their experience total is equal to or higher
members. than that needed for the next level, their level will increase.
◊ Income from plying a mundane trade.

184
Chapter 11 - Getting Better
The level increase will not happen immediately (such as in the Example: Gretchen currently has a basic level of expertise with a
middle of a fight, for example). It will happen the next time the mace, and has recently gone up a level and gained a weapon feat.
character rests for the night and has chance to dwell on the experi- She wishes to use this feat to increase her level of expertise with
ences of the day. maces to skilled.

The following morning, the character will have all the abilities of She hunts for a teacher, and finds a variety in the city, charging
their newly acquired level; including extra hit points and possibly different prices based on their own skill level.
extra spells per day.
Deciding that economy is best, Gretchen goes for a relatively cheap
Weapon feats are not automatically gained, only the empty weapon trainer – a skilled mace trainer who charges 250gp/week.
feat slots are gained. In order to fill those available slots, characters
must train separately. Going from basic expertise to skilled expertise will take two weeks of
training, and will (with this trainer) have a 50% chance of success.
Similarly, although all spell casters gain extra spells per day, magic-
users and elves do not automatically learn new spells when increas- She spends 250gp for the first week of training, and at the end of
ing in level. Any new daily spell slots for spell levels in which the the week her player rolls for success – and gets a 79, which fails.
magic-user or elf does not actually know any spells are useless until
the character learns at least one spell of that level. Gretchen’s trainer takes her to one side and confides in her that
it’s going to take more than the initial two weeks for her to get the
Learning Weapon Feats hang of the new techniques, and asks her if she wants to continue
As characters rise in level, they gain new weapon feats. These feats the training.
are not gained immediately upon increasing in level. Instead, the
character must undergo training in order to spend the feat or feats. Gretchen decides to complete the training, so pays another 250gp
and completes week 2. She now has a +10% bonus next time she
Each weapon feat is spent to increase the level of expertise that the tries to lean skilled proficiency with maces.
character has with a particular weapon. See Chapter 6 – Weapon
Feats for details of the effects of expertise on different weapons. When the training is finished, Gretchen signs up for another two
weeks of training with the same teacher, consoling herself that al-
When a character wishes to spend a weapon feat in order to increase though the training is taking longer than expected, at least four weeks
their level of expertise with a weapon, they must find a trainer. with this trainer isn’t costing her any more than two weeks with a
Ideally this trainer will have a higher level of expertise than the more expensive trainer would have.
character does, but it is possible – providing the character has at
least basic skill with the weapon – for the character to train with At the end of the first week of this new set of training, Gretchen’s
their peer. player rolls again, and gets a 54. This would normally be a failure
since the chance of success is 50%, but the +10% bonus for the
Once the character has found a suitable trainer, they must start completing the previous training turns it into a success.
their training. The length of time that the training must take is
listed on Table 11–1 – learning Weapon Feats, along with the At the end of the second week – her fourth week in total – Gretchen
weekly cost of the training if the trainer is an NPC. becomes skilled with maces, after having spent a total of 1,000gp
and four weeks training.
Table 11–1 also shows the chance of the training being successful.
This check is made half way through the training, at which point In this case, Gretchen re-did the training immediately after the first
it will be apparent to the trainer whether the student is progress- unsuccessful attempt, but even if she had waited weeks or months
ing or not. Unscrupulous trainers may keep quiet and keep taking between attempts she would still have got the +10% bonus on the
money from the student for the rest of the duration anyway, but second roll because she completed the first attempt.
most trainers will warn the student that the training isn’t working
out and give them the choice of continuing the training until the
end or abandoning it at that half way mark (and therefore saving Learning New Spells
the money they would have paid for the second half of the training. Magic-users, mountebanks, and elves do not automatically learn
new spells as they rise in level. Instead they must seek out teachers
In either case, the weapon feat is only considered to have been used who can teach them new spells in much the same way as seeking
if the training was successful. out trainers to teach weapon feats.

If the training was not successful, the character gets a +10% cumu- Depending on the campaign world, there may be organised wizard’s
lative bonus on all future training for the same level of expertise guilds or magical universities that teach magic, or characters may
in the same weapon. have to seek out individual teachers.

185
Chapter 11 - Getting Better
Table 11–1: Learning Weapon Feats
Expertise of Trainer
Desired
Time Needed Basic Skilled Expert Master Grand Master
Expertise
(100gp/week) (250gp/week) (500gp/week) (750gp/week) (1,000gp/week)
Basic 1 week 60% 80% 95% 99% 99%
Skilled 2 weeks 1% 50% 70% 90% 95%
Expert 4 weeks – 1% 40% 60% 80%
Master 8 weeks – – 1% 30% 50%
Grand Master 12 weeks – – – 1% 20%

Table 11–2 Learning New Spells


Level of Teacher
Spell Time
0 1–4 5–8 9–14 15–20 21+
Level Needed
(50gp/week) (100gp/week) (250gp/week) (500gp/week) (750gp/week) (1,000gp/week)
1–2 1 week 1%* 60% 80% 95% 99% 99%
3–4 2 weeks 1%* 50% 70% 90% 95%
5–6 4 weeks – 1%* 40% 60% 80%
7–8 8 weeks – – 1%* 30% 50%
9 12 weeks – – – 1%* 20%
* a teacher of this level cannot teach the spell. This is the chance for individual research done without a teacher

The Game Master should be careful not to make it too hard for However, the teacher does not need to be the same class as the
magic-users and elves to find suitable teachers; since the game as- student. Elves, magic-users and mountebanks can all teach each
sumes that the cost in terms of money and time is enough on its other (although the weak magic of mountebanks makes them poor
own to balance the utility of having more spells. teachers).

The teacher must know, and be able to cast, the spell that the Once the character has found a suitable teacher, they must start
student is trying to learn; and the student must be high enough their study. The length of time that the study must take is listed
level to cast the spell. on Table 11–2 – learning new Spells, along with the weekly
cost of the study if the trainer is an NPC.

Developer Commentary Note that students who have specialised in a particular type of spell
In the original game that Dark Dungeons emulates, spells were treat the spell as if one level lower when trying to learn it, and treat
learned simply by copying them from spell books or scrolls, with no spells of the opposing type to their speciality as if one level higher,
study requirement. just like when preparing such spells.

I never liked this, for two reasons. Firstly it meant that captured Table 11–2 also shows the chance of the study being successful.
enemy spell books were by far the most valuable treasure that could This check is made half way through the study, at which point it will
be found, and secondly it meant that as a Game Master I could never be apparent to the teacher whether the student is progressing or not.
give an enemy spell caster a spell that the players didn’t have without
either them gaining it from the enemy’s spell book after deafeating Unscrupulous teachers may keep quiet and keep taking money from
them or me contriving some reason why the enemy wouldn’t have the student for the rest of the duration anyway, but most teachers
their spell book (despite the fact that player character with spell books will warn the student that the study isn’t working out and give them
are never without them). the choice of continuing the study until the end or abandoning it
at that half way mark (and therefore saving the money they would
By making spells be something that has to be researched, enemy have paid for the second half of the study).
spell books are still vaguely useful (they can be used if no teacher is
available) but they aren’t essential. Most player character spell users If the studying was not successful, the character gets a +10% cu-
will learn their spells from universities or guilds rather than find- mulative bonus on all future study (or research) for the same spell.
ing them,, and this re-inforces the academic feel of such characters.

186
Chapter 11 - Getting Better
Spell Research Example: Aloysius is a 16th level magic-user who does not know
Unlike weapon training, it is possible for a magic-user, mountebank, the 3rd level spell Create Air. Unfortunately, the small town that
or elf to do their own research in order to learn a spell if there is he is in does not have any magic-users other than himself, and he
no teacher available. can’t leave the town for any extended period since he has sworn an
oath to stay there and protect it for the rest of the season – so there
In order to do such research, the magic-user or elf must have ac- is no-one to learn the spell from.
cess to either a scroll of the spell or someone else’s spell book that
contains the spell. He does own a spell book containing the spell though. One that he
once looted from a lich’s tomb and kept.
In the case of individual research, the chance of success is based on
the amount of money that the researcher is prepared to spend per Since he has no teacher, he must try to research the spell on his own.
week on research materials and laboratory usage.
The spell is 3rd level, so Aloysius must spend at least 100gp/week
However, the maximum that a researcher can spend is the equiva- on his research in order to have a chance of learning it, and can
lent of a teacher of one level group lower than the researcher’s spend up to a maximum of 500gp/week on research, since that is
actual level. the equivalent of a level 9–14 teacher – one level group lower than
his own 16th level.
Unlike study with a teacher, characters doing research do not roll
for their success until after the whole research period has finished, Since he knows that he’s going to be in town for a while, he decides
however if their research fails they still get the +10% cumulative that there’s no point throwing excess money at the issue, so he decides
bonus on future research or study of the same spell. to spend the more modest 250gp/week on his research.

Researching a 3rd level spell at 250gp per week is exactly the same
as being taught the 3rd level spell by a teacher of level 5–8 – it will
take two weeks, cost 250gp per week, and have a 50% chance of
success. However, this chance of success is rolled at the end of the two
week period, rather than in the middle of it.

Aloysius spends the two weeks and the 500gp, and at the end of that
period his player rolls a 17. Aloysius now knows the Create Air spell
and can add it to his spell book.

187
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
O
nce adventurers have got some experience under their belts
and they are practised in their chosen professions, they are Overland Movement
likely to start venturing further afield from the civilised Characters travelling overland normally do so either on foot or on
areas that they started in. mounts of some kind.

Sometimes this is due to increased bravery. Sometimes it is due Riding horses are the most common mount, but in desert environ-
to the lure of more lucrative opportunities. Sometimes it is from ments camels may be more suitable – and characters with a lot to
sheer necessity as some task requires a long journey. carry may prefer wagons or other vehicles.

Regardless of the motivation, travelling and exploring in the wil- The distance that a group can move in a day is based on the move-
derness away from civilised areas is a dangerous undertaking. Mer- ment speed of the slowest member of the group.
chants and pilgrims who need to travel long distances tend to do
so in well-guarded caravans; and villages and farms don’t expand On open terrain, a group or individual can move 60% of their
too far from the safety of strongholds. per-round movement speed in miles.

Maps & Hexes For example, the movement rate of an unencumbered human is
Just like dungeons, wilderness is usually mapped out in advance normally 40’ per round.
by the Game Master. How much of this map is known by the
adventurers (and in how much detail) will vary from campaign to Therefore, an unencumbered human can travel 24 miles per day
campaign. However, it is important that the Game Master has a on open terrain.
reasonably accurate idea of where the adventurers are even if they
don’t know themselves. Difficult terrain such as desert, forest, hills, broken ground; or dif-
ficult weather conditions such as snow or heavy rain reduces this
Although maps given to players (to represent the maps that their movement speed by a third, to 40% of their per-round movement
characters have access to) may be anywhere from scratching and speed in miles.
doodles to fully fledged works of art, the master maps that a Game
Master uses are often drawn on hex-paper. For example, the movement rate of an unencumbered human is
normally 40’ per round. Therefore, an unencumbered human can
Drawing maps on hex-paper makes it easier to keep scale consistent travel 16 miles per day on difficult terrain.
from map to map, and also makes it easier to track the adventurers’
movement. Extreme terrain such as mountains, jungle, swamp or glaciers re-
duces the open terrain movement speed by half, to 30% of their
The most common scale for such hex-maps is 8 miles per hex for per-round movement rate in miles.
maps of individual areas or countries, and 24 miles per hex for
larger scale maps of continents and empires. Finally, paved roads increase movement speed by a half, to 90% of
their per-round movement rate in miles, except in snow conditions;
and established but unpaved trails increase movement speed by a

Table 12–1: Overland Movement (miles)


Per-day Movement Rate
Broken Ground
Per-round Desert Glaciers
Movement Rate Road Forest Jungle
Open Terrain
Trail Hills Mountain
Mud Swamp
Snow
10’ 9 miles 6 miles 4 miles 3 miles
20’ 18 miles 12 miles 8 miles 6 miles
30’ (e.g. Draft Horse) 27 miles 18 miles 12 miles 9 miles
40’ (e.g. Human) 36 miles 24 miles 16 miles 12 miles
50’ (e.g. Camel) 45 miles 30 miles 20 miles 15 miles
60’ 54 miles 36 miles 24 miles 18 miles
70’ (e.g. Pony) 63 miles 42 miles 28 miles 21 miles
80’ (e.g. Riding Horse) 72 miles 48 miles 32 miles 24 miles

189
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Table 12–2 Overland Movement (8-mile Hexes)
Per-day Movement Rate (approximate)
Broken Ground
Per-round Desert Glaciers
Movement Rate Road Forest Jungle
Open Terrain
Trail Hills Mountain
Mud Swamp
Snow
10’ 1 hex 1 hex 0.5 hexes 0.5 hexes
20’ 2 hexes 1.5 hexes 1 hex 1 hex
30’ (e.g. Draft Horse) 3.5 hexes 2.5 hexes 1.5 hexes 1 hex
40’ (e.g. Human) 4.5 hexes 3 hexes 2 hexes 1.5 hexes
50’ (e.g. Camel) 5.5 hexes 4 hexes 2.5 hexes 2 hexes
60’ 7 hexes 4.5 hexes 3 hexes 2.5 hexes
70’ (e.g. Pony) 8 hexes 5.5 hexes 3.5 hexes 2.5 hexes
80’ (e.g. Riding Horse) 9 hexes 6 hexes 4 hexes 3 hexes

half, to 90% of their per-round movement rate in miles, except in Example: Black Leaf is leaving town in possession of a treasure
snow or heavy rain conditions. map that she has found. The map shows a site to the north of a
mountain pass.
Table 12–1 shows the movement rates (in miles per day) on each
type of terrain for creatures with base speeds ranging from 10’/ According to the Game Master’s hex map, the place that is marked
round to 80’/round; and Table 12–2 shows the approximate move- on Black Leaf ’s map as the point at which to leave the road and
ment rates in standard 8-mile hexes (rounded to the nearest half start heading north is two and a half hexes away from the town.
hex) for the same creatures.
With Black Leaf ’s normal movement rate of 40’ per round, she can
It is important to remember that the movement rates shown in travel 4.5 hexes per day along the mountain pass (a road), and 1.5
those tables are for completely unencumbered people and are there- hexes per day in the mountains. Since she is travelling two and a
fore unlikely to be reached by actual travellers. half hexes on the road before turning off, the majority of her day’s
journey will be on the road and she therefore travels at her road
Armoured humans will typically move at a speed of 20’ rather speed – 4.5 hexes per day.
than 40’, and unarmoured humans carrying packs containing food
and gear will typically move at a speed of 30’ rather than 40’. However, this would take her along 2.5 hexes of road, followed by 2
hexes of mountains. In a whole day she can only travel across 1.5
Similarly, although rider-less horses can move at 80’, a horse with hexes of mountains, so her movement in the mountain hexes is
a saddle and rider will typically move at a speed of only 40’. limited to this value.
See Chapter 8 – Equipping for Adventure for more details on Therefore at the end of the first day, she has travelled along two and a
how encumbrance affects movement rates. half hexes of road and one and a half hexes of mountain, and camps
Mixed Terrain for the night half way through the second mountain hex.
Someone travelling on a mix of terrain during the same day travels
at a rate governed by the majority of the terrain that they travelled Fatigue
across. Creatures that are travelling long distances must rest for a full day
for every six days that they travel.
The sole exception to this (and this only happens in very rare cir-
cumstances) is that this method can sometimes result in someone Failure to do so results in a cumulative –1 penalty to to-hit and
travelling across more of a particular terrain type in a partial day damage rolls due to long term fatigue per six days (or part of six
than they normally could in a whole day, because they spent the days) of continuous travel after the initial six.
majority of the day travelling on a much less difficult terrain.
This penalty is reduced by 1 for each full day of rest taken.
In this rare case, the person’s travel distance over the more difficult
terrain is limited to the amount they could normally travel on that Getting Lost
terrain in a whole day. It is difficult to get lost following a road or established trail, but
when travelling through the wilderness away from such easy guides
it is remarkably easy to get lost.

190
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Example: Elfstar and Black Leaf are travelling to the capital. Un- The players should not be informed that their characters have be-
fortunately they have no horses, so they are travelling on foot. come lost, and the Game Master should do their best to describe
directions as if the characters were actually going the way they
Although Black Leaf is relatively unencumbered, Elfstar’s armour think they’re going.
means that she moves at only 30’ per round.
Once lost, the leader of the group still makes a navigating check
The city is 240 miles away, and the Game Master is not using a each day. If they keep failing the checks, they will continue to travel
hex map. the way they were travelling the previous day without realising
their error (and the Game Master must roll again to see if they
Given Elfstar’s movement rate, they pair can travel 27 miles per day. veer further off course).
After six days of travelling, they have walked a total of 162 miles.
Once the party leader succeeds in their daily navigating check,
They now have a choice. They still have 78 miles to go, and at their they will realise that they are travelling in the wrong direction (and
walking speed this will take them another three days to walk. which direction they are actually travelling in) and – if they were
intending to travel to a specific location rather than just explor-
They can press on, completing the whole journey in 9 days, but ing – which direction their destination now lies in.
fatiguing themselves with a –1 penalty; or they can rest for a day
before continuing. This will make the journey last an extra day, but Example: Aloysius is travelling through the desert by camel. He has
they will not be fatigued when they arrive. a wisdom of 9, and possesses no navigating skill.

Black Leaf ’s suggestion of a third option – stealing a couple of horses Unfortunately, his local guide has died; and he is trying to find his
and getting there in a day without fatigue (because they only walked way back to the oasis by himself. He knows that it is south of his
for six days and the horses only walked for one day) is vetoed by current location.
Elfstar. But she does agree to see if there are any horses for sale.
On the first day, andy (Aloysius’s player) rolls a navigating check and
fails. Aloysius is, unsurprisingly, not entirely sure that he is heading
Each day that a party travels in wilderness without roads or trails, in the right direction.
the party member who is leading the group (which may be an
NPC guide of some kind) must make a wisdom check using their The Game Master secretly rolls a d6 to see if he gets lost, and a second
navigating skill. The Game Master should give modifiers to the roll d6 to see the direction that he will get turned in if he does get lost.
for things like prominent landmarks or the character living locally
and having local knowledge of the area. The first d6 is a 1, which means that Aloysius will be lost, and the
second d6 is a 4, which means that he will actually spend the day
If the player makes the roll, they are confident of their location and travelling south west, thinking he is travelling south.
the party goes in the direction that they intend to go.
After travelling what he thinks is south for the whole day, Aloysius
If the player fails the roll, the Game Master should secretly roll 1d6. camps for the night.
◊ If the party are in open terrain, then they will get lost on a roll On the second day, he tries a navigating check again, and fails again.
of 1.
The Game Master rolls the two d6s again, and this time the first one
◊ If the party are in swamp, desert or jungle, then they will get comes up with a 5. So Aloysius doesn’t get turned around and carries
lost on a roll of 1–3. on travelling south west (although he – and andy – still thinks he
is travelling south).
◊ If the party are in other terrain, then they will get lost on a roll
of 1–2. After a second day of travelling south west, Aloysius makes another
navigating check on the third morning.
If the party becomes lost, the players should not be informed of this.
This time he succeeds, and realises that he is travelling south west
Instead, the Game Master should roll again to see which direction instead of south. Unfortunately he doesn’t know how long he has been
the party end up going in (it is better for the Game Master to always going in the wrong direction for. However, he does recognise some
make this roll, even if it is not necessary – that way the players don’t landmarks and realises that he needs to head east from his current
know whether or not their characters are lost). location in order to reach the oasis.
If the second roll is 1–3, the party accidentally travel 60° (one hex Cursing his lack of direction sense, and hoping he doesn’t get lost
side if using a hex map) to the left of their intended direction. If again, he turns around and heads east.
the second roll is 4–6, the party accidentally travel 60° (one hex
side if using a hex map) to the right of their intended direction.

191
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Table 12–3: Waterborne Movement & Hull Strength
Movement Rate*
Ship Type Armour Class Structure Points
Miles/day 8-mile Hexes/day Feet/round
River Barge 36 miles 4.5 hexes 60’ 8 20–40
Barque 90 miles 11 hexes 150’ 8 60–90
Canoe, River 18 miles 2 hexes 60’ 9 5–10
Canoe, Sea 18 miles 2 hexes 60’ 9 5–10
Galley 18/90 miles 2/11 hexes 90’/150’ 8 80–100
Longship 18/90 miles 2/11 hexes 90’/150’ 8 60–80
Quinquirime 12/72 miles 1.5/9 hexes 60’/120’ 7 120–150
Raft, Professional 12 miles 1.5 hexes 30’ 9 5–10
Raft, Scavenged 12 miles 1.5 hexes 30’ 9 3–5
Rowing Boat 18 miles 2 hexes 30’ 9 10–20
Skiff 72 miles 9 hexes 120’ 8 20–40
Sloop 72 miles 9 hexes 120’ 7 120–180
Trireme 18/72 miles 2/9 hexes 90’/120’ 7 100–120
Troopship 54 miles 7 hexes 90’ 7 160–220
* when two movement rates are given, the first is for rowing and the second is for sailing.

In either case, if the party member leading the foraging or hunting


Foraging (which may be an NPC guide) succeeds in either a tracking check
Although wise adventurers carry supplies with them, they some- or a nature lore check (they may choose which check to make, but
times prefer to – or need to – supplement their carried food with cannot attempt both), twice as much food is gathered that day.
fresh food, whether hunted or foraged.
It is important to remember that if a party hunts while stationary
Characters who are travelling can gather food while on the move. in order to provide themselves with a food supply that they can
carry with them for use while on the move, such unpreserved food
If the party move at only 2/3 of their normal per-day movement supplies will only last a week before becoming inedible.
rate, they can gather (from hunting and foraging) half of their
day’s food at the same time, meaning they only need to use half of Parties who remain stationary cannot count a day spent gathering
a day’s carried food supply each day. food as a day spent resting for the sake of avoiding or reducing
fatigue.
If the party chooses to remain stationary, they can gather (from
hunting and foraging) a whole day’s food, and don’t need to use At the Game Master’s discretion, some unusual locations might
any of their carried supplies. have an abundance or a dearth of food supplies, so foraging may
be more or less effective in those locations.

Waterborne Movement
Taking to the seas can be an efficient way of travelling long distances.
However, it is not without risk.

Table 12–3 shows the movement rates of various types of ship.


Some ships, such as galleys and longships, are given two movement
rates because they can either sail or be rowed.

Rowing is much harder work than walking over long distances, so


all row powered ships and boats have smaller per-day movement
rates than their per-round movement rates would otherwise indi-
cate. However, this reduced speed takes into account rower fatigue,
so rowed ships and boats do not need to stop every six days for
their crew to recover.

192
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
chance of it breaking up on rocks and sinking and a 25% chance
Wind & Storms of it being able to find a safe haven such as a port or a natural bay.
Sailing ships need wind to be able to travel, and are surprisingly
adept at travelling even upwind by tacking. Lost At Sea
When travelling across the sea, ships can get lost just as land travel-
For the purposes of Dark Dungeons, it is not necessary to track lers can get lost.
the exact wind direction and speed under normal circumstances.
The sailing speeds of the various ships are averaged. Any day that a ship starts out of sight of land (normally this will
be any time it starts a day more than 8 miles, or 1 hex, from land)
However, there are two wind conditions that can affect ships. They there is a chance for it to become lost.
can become becalmed, or they can be lost in storms.
The procedure is the same as for overland travel. The ship’s naviga-
Each day that the party are out at sea (but not when they are sail- tor (which may be a PC or an NPC) rolls a navigating check, and
ing on inland lakes or rivers), the Game Master should roll 2d6. if successful the ship is on course.

◊ If the Game Master rolls a 2, then there is no wind, and ships If the player fails the roll, the Game Master should secretly roll 1d6.
will become becalmed. The party will get lost on a roll of 1–2.

◊ If the Game Master rolls a 12, there is a storm that day. If the party becomes lost, the players should not be informed of
this. Instead, the Game Master should roll again to see which di-
◊ Any other result has no effect on sea travel. rection the party end up going in (it is better for the Game Master
to always make this roll, even if it is not necessary – that way the
Becalmed players don’t know whether or not their characters are lost).
When there is no wind, ships with sails cannot use them to move.
Any such ship must either have the crew row, or must stay where If the second roll is 1–3, the party accidentally travel 60° (one hex
it is for the day. side if using a hex map) to the left of their intended direction. If
the second roll is 4–6, the party accidentally travel 60° (one hex
Ships with both sails and oars, such as galleys and longships, may side if using a hex map) to the right of their intended direction.
still move by rowing while becalmed.
The players should not be informed that their characters have be-
Storms come lost, and the Game Master should do their best to describe
Storms are very dangerous to ships at sea. They can destroy even directions as if the characters were actually going the way they
the largest ship unless the ship can “run before the storm”. think they’re going.

When the dice indicate that there is a storm, the first thing that the Once lost, the leader of the group still makes a navigating check
Game Master must do is to determine the wind direction randomly. each day. If they keep failing the checks, they will continue to travel
the way they were travelling the previous day without realising
If the ship has working sails, the captain must decide whether to their error (and the Game Master must roll again to see if they
run before the storm or to try to weather it. The former is by far veer further off course).
the safest option unless the wind is blowing the ship towards land.
Once the party leader succeeds in their daily navigating check,
If the ship runs before the storm, it moves at triple its normal daily they will realise that they are travelling in the wrong direction (and
movement rate in the direction of the wind. which direction they are actually travelling in), and – if they were
intending to travel to a specific location rather than just explor-
If this does not bring it up against a coastline then the ship is safe. ing – which direction their destination now lies in.
However, if the ship is blown onto the coast when running before
a storm then there is a 75% chance of it breaking up on rocks and Ship to Ship Combat
sinking and a 25% chance of it being able to find a safe haven such When the crew of two ships wish to fight, they can do so in three
as a port or a natural bay. ways.

If the ship’s captain chooses to take down the sails and weather the Firstly, if their ship is equipped with catapults or cannons, it can
storm, of if the ship does not have sails, then the ship will move half keep its distance from the enemy and try to sink it or drive it away.
of its normal daily movement rate in the direction of the wind, and
will have an 80% chance of breaking up in the storm and sinking. Secondly, if the ship has ship’s rams attached, it can try to ram the
enemy ship in order to sink it.
If the ship does not break up, and this movement does not bring it
up against a coastline, then the ship is safe. However, if the ship is And finally, the ship can pull up alongside the enemy and grapple it,
blown onto the coast when weathering a storm then there is a 75% so that the crew can cross between the ships and fight hand to hand.

193
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
All of this combat is done using the normal combat rules found that all terrain is considered to be “road” for purposes of converting
in Chapter 10 – Combat. The captain of each ship declares what per-round movement speeds into daily movement speeds; with the
action the ship will perform, and the ships act in initiative order. exception of heavy rain and snow, which still reduce daily move-
ment rates as normal.
Boarding Actions
If two ships pull alongside each other, (within 50’) either because When travelling on a flying mount or magical device, characters
one is in the process of ramming the other or because the captains have no chance of getting lost. However, characters on flying
wish to grapple and board, then either crew can attempt to grap- mounts and devices are still subject to fatigue if they travel for
ple the other ship. more than six days without taking a rest day.

If both crews wish to grapple, then it is automatically successful. If Character on flying mounts or devices cannot gather food while
only one crew wishes to grapple, then the other crew can roll 1d6; on the move.
and on a 1–4, they manage to repel the grapple attempt by cutting
and casting free the grappling hooks and lines. Skysailing
Ships that are equipped with a sail of skysailing can fly at incredible
If the grapple is successful, both ships are pulled tight together and speeds through the air. However, in order to do this they must be
crew can pass from one to the other in order to fight hand-to-hand. powered by a spell caster.

Any character crossing between the two ships has difficulty ma- If a non-spell user takes the wheel of ship that has a sail of skysail-
noeuvring due to having to climb over rails and ropes, and takes ing, it acts in all ways as a normal ship. However, if a spell user (i.e.
a +2 penalty to armour class and a –2 penalty to all attacks during A magic-user, elf, cleric, druid, mountebank, shaman, or sorcerer)
the round in which they cross. takes the wheel, they may concentrate for a round in order to
activate the sails.
Damage to Ships
Ships that are damaged lose 10% of their speed for every 10% of For the rest of the day, that spell user may - while at the wheel -
their structure points that they have lost. make the ship fly and control its course and speed.

Rowed ships also lose 10% of their speed for every 10% of their Activating the sails drains the spell user of all spells they currently
rowers that are missing. had prepared for the day, as if those spells had been cast.

Once a ship has lost three quarters of its structure points, it is dead The speed of the ship is determined by the effective level of the spell
in the water and can no longer sail under its own power. user who is controlling it. This effective level is based on the actual
level of the spell caster (halved in the case of mountebanks), but
When a ship has lost all of its structure points, it sinks over the reduced by three for each spell they have cast during the day prior
course of the next 1d10 rounds. to activating the sail, to a minimum of first level. See Table 12–4
to see the flying speed of the ship based on the spell user’s effec-
Repairing Ships tive level.
Makeshift repairs can repair up to half the damage that a ship has
taken while at sea, providing there are at least five crew assigned to
repair duty; with one structure point being repaired per ten minutes.
Multiple five-person crews can repair a ship simultaneously.

These jury rigged repairs will only last for 6d6 days before coming
irreparably apart.

To permanently and fully repair a ship it must either be docked or


magic must be used.

Airborne Movement
There are a variety of ways that characters can travel by air. They
may have mounts that can fly, such as pegasi, hippogriffs or even
dragons. They may have magical flying devices such as brooms of
flying or flying carpets. Or they may have a flying ship equipped
with a sail of skysailing.

Mounts & Devices


Travelling by riding a flying mount or magical device uses the same
movement rules as overland movement. The only difference being

194
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Table 12–4: Skysailing Speeds

Effective Spell Caster Cruising Speed


Manoeuvring Speed
Level* Feet per Round Miles per Day 8-mile Hexes per Day
1 20’/round 400’/round 400 miles 50 hexes
2 20’/round 400’/round 400 miles 50 hexes
3 20’/round 400’/round 400 miles 50 hexes
4 20’/round 400’/round 400 miles 50 hexes
5 20’/round 400’/round 400 miles 50 hexes
6 40’/round 800’/round 800 miles 100 hexes
7 40’/round 800’/round 800 miles 100 hexes
8 40’/round 800’/round 800 miles 100 hexes
9 60’/round 1,200’/round 1,200 miles 150 hexes
10 60’/round 1,200’/round 1,200 miles 150 hexes
11 60’/round 1,200’/round 1,200 miles 150 hexes
12 60’/round 1,200’/round 1,200 miles 150 hexes
13 80’/round 1,600’/round 1,600 miles 200 hexes
14 80’/round 1,600’/round 1,600 miles 200 hexes
15 80’/round 1,600’/round 1,600 miles 200 hexes
16 80’/round 1,600’/round 1,600 miles 200 hexes
17 100’/round 2,000’/round 2,000 miles 250 hexes
18 100’/round 2,000’/round 2,000 miles 250 hexes
19 100’/round 2,000’/round 2,000 miles 250 hexes
20 120’/round 2,400’/round 2,400 miles 300 hexes
21 120’/round 2,400’/round 2,400 miles 300 hexes
22 120’/round 2,400’/round 2,400 miles 300 hexes
23 120’/round 2,400’/round 2,400 miles 300 hexes
24 140’/round 2,800’/round 2,800 miles 350 hexes
25 140’/round 2,800’/round 2,800 miles 350 hexes
26 140’/round 2,800’/round 2,800 miles 350 hexes
27 160’/round 3,200’/round 3,200 miles 400 hexes
28 160’/round 3,200’/round 3,200 miles 400 hexes
29 160’/round 3,200’/round 3,200 miles 400 hexes
30 160’/round 3,200’/round 3,200 miles 400 hexes
31 180’/round 3,600’/round 3,600 miles 450 hexes
32 180’/round 3,600’/round 3,600 miles 450 hexes
33 180’/round 3,600’/round 3,600 miles 450 hexes
34 180’/round 3,600’/round 3,600 miles 450 hexes
35 200’/round 4,000’/round 4,000 miles 500 hexes
36 200’/round 4,000’/round 4,000 miles 500 hexes
*see text for reductions to effective spell caster level

195
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Table 12–5: Wilderness Encounter Chances
Chance of Encounter (1d12)
Take Off & Landing
Terrain The incredible flight speeds of ships equipped with a sail of sky-
Day Night sailing can only be maintained in a roughly straight line, and are
Barren Lands 1–4 1–2 therefore only usually used at high altitude. When travelling at a
City 1–4 1–2 low altitude, or taking off and landing, ships must drop to ma-
noeuvring speed. This is much slower, but allows the ship to make
Clear 1–2 1 significant heading changes and to do fine manoeuvres in order to
Desert 1–4 1–2 land in a harbour or dry-dock.
Flying (any Terrain) 1–4 1–2
A ship can be flown at cruising speed at low altitude, but doing so
Forest 1–4 1–2
is often suicidally dangerous.
Grasslands 1–2 1
Hills 1–4 1–2 Switching from manoeuvring speed to cruising speed (or vice versa)
Jungle 1–6 1–3 takes 1d8 rounds of concentration.
Mountains 1–6 1–3
A ship equipped with a sail of skysailing can land and take off nor-
Ocean 1–4 1–2 mally on water, or from a specially constructed frame resembling
River 1–4 1–2 a dry-dock where ships are built. Taking off in either situation
Settled 1–2 1 requires 1d8 rounds of concentration in order to start the ship
moving.
Swamp 1–6 1–3
The spell user must remain at the wheel of the ship for the dura- If a ship is forced to land in a controlled manner on normal ground,
tion of the flight. Leaving for more than 10 minutes stops the it will not be damaged, but it will roll onto its side. It will not be
ship, and it starts sinking to the ground at a rate of 50’ per round able to take off again unless it is righted and held upright for the
(5’ per second). duration of the take-off.

If this causes the ship to crash in water deep enough to hold it then Leaving the Planet
it will be fine (assuming it is not damaged beyond seaworthiness, Ships equipped with sails of skysailing have no upper altitude limit.
of course). If it lands on the ground it will take damage equal Providing they have an adequate air supply, they may leave the
to 1d100% of its structure points. planet completely and fly through space at speeds dwarfing even the
fastest air speed to get to other planets and moons – or even leave
Control of the ship may be regained by any spell user who spends a the celestial sphere completely and fly through the luminiferous
round re-activating the ship. Remember, however, that the original aether to other spheres.
spell user will have used all their spells the first time they controlled
it, so if they re-establish control they will be effectively first level. See Chapter 15 – Out of this World for detailed rules about
flying outside the atmosphere.
A single spell user can fly a ship for 8 hours without a problem (and
the daily movement rates in Table 12–4 are based on an 8-hour Skysailing Combat
travelling day). The spell caster can pull a ‘double shift’ at the wheel, Because of the speed of skysailing, combats and encounters are rare
lasting for up to 16 hours, but for the second 8-hour shift they when a ship is flying at cruising speed.
only have an effective level of one; and they will not regain spells
the following morning, but must rest for a full day before they can Most natural creatures can’t keep up with one, and the speeds mean
regain spells or re-activate the sail. that two ships won’t even be in missile range of each other for a
whole round before zooming off in different directions.
Although the speed and heading of the ship are controlled by the
spell user at the wheel, the ship still needs a full complement of However, a ship that is travelling at manoeuvring speed is much
crew to be controlled. Without a full complement of crew, the more vulnerable to – and capable of – attack.
spell user at the wheel can make the ship rise and hover in place,
but cannot make it fly in a straight line. Any attempt at horizontal Flying ships in combat are treated just like normal ships in combat,
movement will be at the mercy of the winds. and can grapple, board and ram each other.

However, ships such as galleys that are normally supplemented by Like normal ships they lose 10% of their speed for each 10% of
rowers do need them while flying. They do, however, need them their structure points that are missing, and when they have lost 75%
if the land on water and wish to sail normally. of their structure points they are reduced to manoeuvring speed.

When a ship has lost 100% of its structure points, it can no longer


fly and will fall to the ground.

196
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Table 12–6: Wilderness Encounters
Barren
Clear
1d8 Roll Mountains City Desert Jungle
Grassland
Hills
1 Animal Human Animal Animal Animal
2 Dragon Human Animal Animal Animal
3 Dragon Human Dragon Dragon Dragon
4 Flyer Human Flyer Flyer Flyer
5 Human Human Human Human Human
6 Humanoid Human Humanoid Human Humanoid
7 Humanoid Humanoid Insect Humanoid Insect
8 Unusual Undead Unusual Undead Insect
1d8 Roll Ocean River Settled Swamp Woods
1 Dragon Animal Animal Dragon Animal
2 Flyer Dragon Animal Flyer Animal
3 Human Flyer Castle* Human Dragon
4 Swimmer Human Dragon Humanoid Flyer
5 Swimmer Humanoid Flyer Insect Human
6 Swimmer Insect Human Swimmer Humanoid
7 Swimmer Swimmer Human Undead Insect
8 Swimmer Swimmer Humanoid Undead Unusual
*see Text for Details of Castle Encounters

The number of creatures encountered is not given on the encounter


Wilderness Encounters tables. Instead it is found in the monster descriptions in Chap-
Unlike dungeon situations, where there tend to be fixed structures ter 10 – Monsters.
with fixed creatures living in them, adventuring in the wilderness
is a lot more random. In the monster descriptions in that chapter, two numbers are given
for each monster – a lair group and a wandering group.
While there may be particular fixed locations that the Game Mas-
ter has marked on their map as being the lairs of monsters or the The Game Master is free to select whether the party have come
territories of particular races; most of the time it is not feasible to across a wandering group of the monsters or whether they have
work this out in advance for every square mile of the country or come across the monsters’ lair. When selecting this, the Game
even planet that the players might want to explore. Master should take into account both the party’s current activity
(exploring, travelling along a well-worn road, or stationary) and
In the same way that characters may encounter wandering monsters what type of lair the monsters are likely to have.
in dungeons (see Chapter 9 – Dungeon Delving for details),
they may also encounter wandering monsters. The Game Master If the Game Master wishes, they can replace these tables with tables
should check twice per 24-hour period; once during the day and specific to the areas of their own worlds – for example a particular
once during the night. The chance of an encounter occurring is mountain range might not contain kobolds, but might be known
based on the type of terrain that the party is travelling through, to contain lots of orcs. A replacement table could be made for that
and can be found on Table 12–5. mountain range with the “kobold” entries swapped for additional
“orc” entries.
If the party is travelling through terrain that fits more than one
category (e.g. Wooded hills), or is travelling through more than Castles
one type of terrain during the day, then the Game Master should The “settled” column of Table 12–6 has an entry labelled “castle”.
pick whichever type is most suitable. Unlike the other entries on that table, this entry does not link to
another table.
Once the type of encounter has been determined, the exact en-
counter can either be determined by the Game Master’s wishes or If the Game Master already has a detailed map of the area, and there
rolled randomly using 1d12 on the relevant table. is no such castle, then this entry should be re-rolled. Otherwise,
it means that the party has arrived at a castle or other stronghold.

197
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Table 12–7: Animals
1d12 Roll Barren Clear Desert Grassland Hills
1 Animal (herd) Animal (herd) Animal (herd) Animal (herd) Animal (herd)
2 Ape (cave) Ape (rock baboon) Animal (herd) Ape (rock baboon) Ape (cave)
3 Ape (rock baboon) Boar Camel Boar Ape (rock baboon)
4 Ape (snow) Cat (lion) Camel Cat (lion) Ape (snow)
5 Bear (cave) Donkey Cat (lion) Donkey Bear (cave)
6 Bear (grizzly) Elephant Cat (lion) Elephant Bear (grizzly)
7 Cat (mountain lion) Ferret (giant) Lizard (giant gecko) Ferret (giant) Cat (mountain lion)
Lizard
8 Mule Ferret (giant) Ferret (giant) Mule
(giant tuatara)
9 Snake (pit viper) Horse (riding) Snake (pit viper) Horse (riding) Snake (pit viper)
10 Snake (rattler) Lizard (giant draco) Snake (rattler) Lizard (giant draco) Snake (rattler)
11 Wolf (dire) Snake (pit viper) Spider (black widow) Snake (pit viper) Wolf (dire)
12 Wolf (normal) Snake (rattler) Spider (tarantella) Snake (rattler) Wolf (normal)
1d12 Roll Jungle Mountains River Settled Woods
1 Animal (herd) Animal (herd) Animal (herd) Animal (herd) Animal (herd)
2 Boar Ape (cave) Boar Animal (herd) Boar
3 Cat (panther) Ape (rock baboon) Cat (panther) Boar Cat (panther)
4 Lizard (giant draco) Ape (snow) Cat (tiger) Cat (tiger) Cat (tiger)
5 Lizard (giant gecko) Bear (cave) Crab (giant) Ferret (giant) Lizard (giant gecko)
Lizard
6 Bear (grizzly) Crocodile Horse (riding) Lizard (giant draco)
(giant horned)
7 Rat (giant) Cat (mountain lion) Crocodile (large) Rat (giant) Lizard (giant tuatara)
8 Shrew (giant) Mule Fish (giant rockfish) Shrew (giant) Snake (pit viper)
9 Snake (pit viper) Snake (pit viper) Leech (giant) Snake (racer) Spider (crab spider)
10 Snake (rock python) Snake (rattler) Rat (giant) Snake (pit viper) Unicorn
Snake
11 Wolf (dire) Shrew (giant) Spider (tarantella) Wolf
(spitting cobra)
12 Spider (crab spider) Wolf (normal) Toad (giant) Wolf Wolf (dire)

To generate a random castle, first roll 1d20 to see who the owner The Game Master should also roll 1d6, to determine what allegiance
of the castle is: the castle’s owner has to the rulers of the country:

1–3 = cleric Obviously, this allegiance will not usually be openly displayed to
4 = dwarf a passing adventuring party.
5 = elf
6–11 = fighter Encounter Balance
12 = halfling The encounters listed on the following pages vary tremendously in
13 = lupine strength, ranging from simple kobolds to mighty dragon queens.
14–16 = magic-user
17–18 = mountebank Some encounters may be very easy for the party to overcome, and
19–20 = thief others may well be nigh impossible to overcome in any way other
than the party simply hiding or fleeing from the creature(s) that
This owner will be a level 1d20+8 character of that class. they have encountered.

1–2 = fanatically loyal This variation is an essential part of the game – it is dangerous out
3–5 = reasonably loyal in the wilderness and low level parties venture away from settled
6 = disloyal areas at their own risk – and therefore the Game Master shouldn’t

198
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Table 12–8: Humans
1d12 Roll Clear Desert Grassland Hill Jungle
1 Adventurer Adventurer Adventurer Adventurer Adventurer
2 Bandit Cleric Bandit Bandit Adventurer
3 Bandit Dervish Bandit Berserker Bandit
4 Berserker Dervish Berserker Berserker Berserker
5 Brigand Fighter Brigand Brigand Brigand
6 Cleric Magic-user Cleric Cleric Brigand
7 Fighter Merchant Fighter Fighter Brigand
8 Magic-user Noble Magic-user Magic-user Cleric
9 Merchant Nomad Merchant Merchant Fighter
10 Merchant Nomad Merchant Neanderthal Magic-user
11 Noble Nomad Noble Neanderthal Merchant
12 Nomad Nomad Nomad Neanderthal Neanderthal
1d12 Roll Ocean River Settled Swamp Woods
1 Adventurer Adventurer Acolyte Adventurer Adventurer
2 Buccaneer Bandit Adventurer Adventurer Bandit
3 Buccaneer Buccaneer Bandit Bandit Bandit
4 Merchant Buccaneer Bandit Bandit Berserker
5 Merchant Buccaneer Cleric Berserker Brigand
6 Merchant Cleric Fighter Brigand Brigand
7 Merchant Cleric Magic-user Cleric Cleric
8 Merchant Fighter Merchant Fighter Druid
9 Pirate Magic-user Noble Magic-user Druid
10 Pirate Merchant Npc party Merchant Fighter
11 Pirate Merchant Trader Npc party Magic-user
12 Pirate Npc party Veteran Trader Merchant

199
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Table 12–9: Humanoids
City
1d12 Roll Barren Clear Desert Grassland
Settled
1 Dwarf Bugbear Dwarf Giant (fire) Bugbear
2 Giant (frost) Elf Elf Goblin Elf
3 Giant (hill) Giant (hill) Giant (hill) Goblin Giant (hill)
4 Giant (stone) Gnoll Gnome Hobgoblin Gnoll
5 Giant (storm) Goblin Goblin Hobgoblin Gnoll
6 Gnome Halfling Halfling Ogre Halfling
7 Goblin Hobgoblin Hobgoblin Ogre Lupine
8 Kobold Lupine Lupine Ogre Lupine
9 Kobold Ogre Ogre Orc Ogre
10 Orc Orc Orc Orc Orc
11 Troglodyte Pixie Pixie Pixie Pixie
12 Troll Troll Sprite Sprite Troll
Hill
1d12 Roll Jungle River Swamp Woods
Mountain
1 Dwarf Bugbear Bugbear Gnoll Bugbear
2 Giant (frost) Cyclops Elf Goblin Cyclops
3 Giant (hill) Elf Gnoll Hobgoblin Dryad
4 Giant (stone) Giant (fire) Hobgoblin Lizard man Elf
5 Giant (storm) Giant (hill) Lizard man Lizard man Elf
6 Gnome Gnoll Lizard man Lizard man Giant (hill)
7 Goblin Goblin Nixie Nixie Goblin
8 Kobold Lizard man Ogre Ogre Hobgoblin
9 Kobold Ogre Orc Orc Lupine
10 Orc Orc Orc Troglodyte Ogre
11 Troglodyte Troglodyte Sprite Troll Orc
12 Troll Troll Troll Troll Troll

feel that they have to re-roll encounters that are unsuitable for the On the other hand, it is important for the Game Master to be fair
party’s level. to the players. There’s no fun in a low level party leaving town and
getting eaten by a dragon on the first night.
The players should not get the feeling that the world is “levelling up”
as they do, and that the Game Master is simply selecting monsters The Game Master should therefore ensure that overwhelming fights
of an appropriate difficulty. can be avoided, whether that is through the party spotting the en-
counter before it spots them and hiding or avoiding it, or whether
it is through the encounter not necessarily being hostile.

200
Chapter 12 - Into the Wider World
Table 12–10: Other Wilderness Encounters
1d12 Roll Dragons Flyers (mountain) Flyers (desert) Flyers (other) Insects
1 Chimera Bee (giant) Gargoyle Bee (giant) Ant (giant)
2 Dragon (black) Gargoyle Gargoyle Cockatrice Bee (giant)
Beetle (giant
3 Dragon (blue) Griffon Griffon Gargoyle
bombard)
4 Dragon (gold) Harpy Harpy Griffon Beetle (giant fire)
5 Dragon (green) Hippogriff Insect swarm Hippogriff Beetle (giant tiger)
6 Dragon (red) Insect swarm Lizard (giant draco) Lizard (giant draco) Insect swarm
7 Dragon (white) Manticore Manticore Pegasus Rhagodessa (giant)
8 Dragon queen (any) Pegasus Manticore Pixie Robber fly (giant)
9 Hydra Robber fly (giant) Manticore Robber fly (giant) Scorpion (giant)
Spider
10 Hydra Roc (small) Roc (small) Roc (small)
(black widow)
11 Wyvern Roc (large) Roc (large) Sprite Spider (crab spider)
12 Wyvern Roc (giant) Roc (giant) Stirge Spider (tarantella)
Swimmers
1d12 Roll Swimmers (ocean) Swimmers (swamp) Undead Unusual
(river/lake)
1 Crab (giant) Giant (storm) Crab (giant) Ghoul Basilisk
2 Crocodile Hydra (sea) Crocodile Ghoul Blink dog
3 Crocodile (large) Hydra (sea) Crocodile Ghast Centaur
4 Fish (giant bass) Hydra (sea) Crocodile (large) Mummy Gorgon
5 Fish (giant sturgeon) Merman Crocodile (large) Skeleton Medusa
6 Leech (giant) Snake (sea) Leech (giant) Skeleton Mournwolf
7 Leech (giant) Snake (sea) Leech (giant) Spectre Treant
8 Lizard man Snake (sea) Leech (giant) Wight Werebear
9 Lizard man Snake (sea) Lizard man Wraith Wereboar
Termite
10 Merman Lizard man Vampire Wererat
(giant water)
Termite Termite
11 Nixie Zombie Weretiger
(giant water) (giant water)
Termite Termite Termite
12 Zombie Werewolf
(giant water) (giant water) (giant water)

201
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
W
hen characters have come to the attention of the rulers Viscount is therefore the highest possible title for (non-royal) nobil-
of their land, usually by performing the sort of deeds ity who are yet to prove themselves as war leaders.
that only heroes can manage, they may be granted titles
of nobility and land grants. The title “lord (name)” is used for male viscounts, and “lady (name)”
is used for female viscounts. Male viscounts are addressed as “your
This will vary from campaign to campaign depending on the pref- lordship” and female viscounts are addressed as “your ladyship”.
erences of the players and the Game Master. As a rough guide-
line, it should happen when the party are somewhere between 9th Count: A viscount who conquers a third dominion belonging
and 15th level – although some groups or some individual players to one of their ruler’s enemies and adds it to their ruler’s country
may wish their characters to continue the life of a travelling adven- will be granted the title of count. A count will therefore rule at
turer rather than taking on the responsibility of ruling. least three dominions, at least one of which was won by military
conquest.
The area of land ruled by a noble (whether a player character or
otherwise) is called a dominion. This applies whether or not the Note that the “enemy” may not necessarily be a human coun-
noble is given their title by a ruler or the noble strikes out on their try – but a distinction is made between the military capture of
own and simply claims land and assumes a title. A single dominion a domain formerly ruled by an organised goblin nation, and the
consists of a stronghold and all the surrounding land that is ruled annexing by an adventuring party of terrain formerly populated
from and protected by the stronghold. If a ruler had more than one by a few sparse orc tribes, for example. The dominions ruled by a
stronghold (except for when one is simply a garrison) then each count are collectively referred to as a county.
one and its land is considered a separate dominion.
Like a viscount, a count may delegate the rule of some or all of their
Titles of Nobility dominions to barons, and may remain at court. A count may grant
Although there may be local and cultural variations specific to parts the title of baron, although etiquette demands that this is normally
of the campaign setting, this chapter assumes that the following not done without at least checking with the king or queen first.
titles of nobility are in use (in ascending order of rank).
The title “count (name) of (county)” is used for male counts, and
Knight: A knight is the lowest title of nobility. A grant of knight- the title “countess (name) of (county)” is used for female counts.
hood does not come with a dominion, and a knight does not nor- Male counts are addressed as “your lordship” and female counts
mally rule such land. The children of nobles of all non-royal blood are referred to as “your ladyship”.
are normally knighted as a matter of course when they come of age,
receiving a greater title when (or if ) they gain their inheritance. Marquis: A count who continues to add dominions to their ruler’s
lands (either by conquest or expansion into unclaimed land) may be
The title “knight” applies to both sexes, although it is not used in given the title of marquis. Although a marquis has greater station
the name of the noble. and influence at court than a “mere” count, there is little practical
difference between the two.
Instead, male knights are referred to as “sir (name)” and female
knights are referred to as “dame (name)”. Male knights are ad- The title “the marquis of (county)” is used for male marquises and
dressed as “sir” and female knights are addressed as “ma’am”. the title “the marquise of (county)” is used for female marquises.
Male marquises are addressed as “your lordship” and female mar-
Baron: A grant of baroncy comes with a single dominion. It is the quises are addressed as “your ladyship”.
lowest form of landed nobility, and may be granted by a count or
higher. A baron is granted a single domain, which is called a barony. Duke: The highest rank of non-royal nobility is the duke. The
title of duke is granted to marquises who have served their ruler
The title “baron (name)” is used for male barons, and “baroness well and continued to add dominions to their rule. The collected
(name)” is used for female barons. Male barons are addressed as dominions of a duke are referred to as a “duchy”. It is rare (but not
“your lordship”, and female barons are addressed as “your ladyship”. unheard of ) for a duke to actually reside in one of the strongholds
in their duchy.
Viscount: If a baron is granted a second dominion, or conquers a
second dominion belonging to their ruler’s enemy and adds it to Dukes normally stay at court except in times of war or emergency.
their ruler’s country, they will likely be granted the title of viscount. A duke may grant any lesser title (assuming the candidate has
This title and all higher titles may only be granted by a duke or achieved the necessary status), although etiquette demands that
higher. The viscount may rule directly from one of the strongholds the king or queen be informed before such grants happen.
and allow an allied baron to rule the other, or may remain at court
and allow allied barons to rule both their dominions. The title “the duke of (duchy)” is used for male dukes, and “the
duchess of (duchy)” is used for female dukes. Both male and female
A viscount who is granted more dominions by their ruler or who dukes are addressed as “your grace”.
gains them by expanding into unclaimed land remains a viscount.

203
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
Archduke: The title of archduke is given to members of the royal Being a crown prince is a risky business, since there are often many
family who are also dukes. other potential heirs keen to see one fail or die, as well as foreign
powers keen to cause internal strife.
Some archdukes may by minor royalty who were originally granted
baronies and have genuinely worked to gain their dominions, but The title “crown prince (name) is used for male princes, and “crown
others may be princes or other high ranking royals who have been princess (name)” is used for female princes, although occasionally
granted archdukedoms for reasons of nepotism rather than ability. (depending on the rules of succession in the country in question)
only princes of one sex will be eligible to be crown princes. Both
While archdukes appointed via royal fiat do technically have the male and female crown princes are addressed as “your royal high-
status and responsibility that their position entails, they are often ness”.
not taken seriously and are side-lined when it comes to important
councils of war and so forth. However, it can be dangerous to Imperial Prince: An imperial prince is a prince who is the heir to
underestimate them completely. After all, they are close relatives an empire. An imperial prince is almost always a prince by birth.
of the king or queen, and do have their ears; as well as an array of Only if an emperor or empress is childless would it be possible
lesser nobles (and their armies) at their disposal. to adopt someone as an imperial prince without causing outright
rebellion amongst nobility.
It is possible (although rare) for someone to first become a duke
and then be adopted into the royal family to become an archduke. Like crown princes, imperial princes tend to be active nobles. Be-
On very rare occasions, this will happen to an enemy duke who cause of their future responsibilities they tend to have the most
“defects” from their former ruler bringing their lands with them. preparation – and are therefore the most likely to work their way
Such defections cause much political turbulence, and can often up from baroncy rather than just have higher titles awarded to them.
be the start of major wars.
Being an imperial prince is even more dangerous than being a
The title “the duke of (duchy)” is used for male archdukes, and “the crown prince, since there are often many more interested parties
duchess of (duchy)” is used for female archdukes. Both male and keen to see one fail or die.
female archdukes are addressed as “your grace”.
The title “imperial prince (name) is used for male princes, and
Prince: A prince is the child of a king or queen (or emperor), or “imperial princess (name)” is used for female princes, although
the child of a crown prince or imperial prince. This may be by occasionally (depending on the rules of succession in the empire
birth, or it may be by adoption – such as the adoption that turns in question) only princes of one sex will be eligible to be imperial
a duke into an archduke. princes. Both male and female imperial princes are addressed as
“your imperial highness”.
A prince will always be at least a baron, although in many cases
their title is a technicality and no actual domains are ruled. How- King: A king is the ruler of an entire country. The title is passed
ever, many rulers encourage their offspring to go out and actively down in an hereditary manner, and therefore the only way to
rule – partly to keep them occupied and reduce internecine squab- become a king (if one is not already heir to a throne) is to declare
bling, and partly to “toughen them up” and get them used to yourself the king of an area and get away with it by having enough
responsibility. military and political support.

A prince may not appoint lesser nobles unless entitled to do so In some countries, being the spouse of a king or queen makes one
by their own rank of nobility. The collective dominion held by a a king or queen yourself. This depends upon the rules of succession
prince is called a principality. for the country in question.

The title “prince (name) is used for male princes, and “princess In theory, a king has absolute power over their country. In practice,
(name)” is used for female princes. Both male and female princes however, the king is reliant on the income and military might
are addressed as “your highness”. provided by their nobles; and it therefore is a foolish king indeed
that does not take advice from those nobles.
Crown Prince: A crown prince is a prince who is the heir to the
throne. A crown prince is almost always a prince by birth. Only if a The title “king (name)” is used for male kings, and the tile “queen
king or queen is childless would it be possible to adopt someone as (name)” is used for female kings. Both male and female kings are
crown prince without causing outright rebellion amongst nobility. addressed as “your majesty”.

Although it would seem that crown princes would be the most Emperor: An emperor is the king of a country that has taken over
pampered of princes, the opposite is true. Because of their future (and had surrender to it) one or more other countries; but rather
responsibilities they tend to have the most preparation – and are than simply expand to cover the whole area, the countries that
therefore the most likely to work their way up from baroncy rather have been taken over are allowed to remain autonomous (although
than just having higher titles awarded to them. sometimes their kings are deposed and replaced with more friendly
kings). These countries become client countries as part of a larger

204
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
empire, and the king of the country that is doing the taking over area of wilderness and proclaim themselves the ruler of it using
becomes the emperor of the entire empire. whatever title they feel like. Depending on the location they choose
and the title they adopt, this may be met with anything from in-
The heirs of an emperor will take on the title of emperor themselves difference to derision to downright hostility by other local rulers.
without necessarily taking over more countries than the founder
of the empire did. While it may be attractive to not have a ruler to pay salt tax to, the
independent dominion runs the constant risk of invasion – not
The kings of the client countries mostly run their states as before, only by monsters (since it has no allies to back it up) but also by
although they may have policies dictated by the emperor – par- neighbouring countries who may wish to add the land to their own.
ticularly foreign policies, and they may have to pay a yearly tribute
to the emperor. While some lucky independents – usually those in the most iso-
lated areas away from other states – are able to grow from a single
Depending on the size of the tribute and the policies imposed, the stronghold to a whole country, the vast majority soon become part
empire may be seen as a useful and benevolent thing to have (espe- of a neighbouring country; either by being taken over militarily
cially if it brings peace between previously antagonistic countries or by the political expedient of the independent ruler accepting a
that have now become client states), or it may be seen as an oppres- title of nobility from the royalty of a nearby country and swearing
sive force that the client countries would overthrow if they could. allegiance to that country in order to avoid a war they cannot win.

In many cases, client countries lose control of their armies and find And, of course, some simply disappear; struck by plague or famine
them replaced by a single “imperial army” which is paid by – and or worse.
loyal to – the empire.
However, claiming wilderness and declaring oneself to be an in-
Empires have a tendency to be too big to be stable, and rarely last dependent ruler is always an option for a particularly desperate or
more than three or four generations before disintegrating; although adventurous character who wishes to own a dominion without
the disintegration often causes utter chaos and anarchy and the for- having to impress someone else enough to grant them one.
mer kingdoms that made up the empire rarely survive the break up.
Building a Stronghold
The title “emperor (name)” is used for male emperors, and “em- No dominion can survive without a stronghold of some sort. The
press (name)” is used for female emperors. Both male and female stronghold provides not only an administrative centre for the do-
emperors are addressed as “your imperial majesty”. minion, but also a secure place to store the dominion’s wealth and
to retreat to in times of war.
Rogue States
Of course, it is entirely possible for player character (or non-player The area of land covered by a dominion is measured in fiefs. A
character) to ignore this whole hierarchy and simply claim some single fief is an area of about 12 miles radius. If using hex maps,
this translates to a single 24-mile hex that contains the stronghold,
Developer Commentary or a cluster of nine 8-mile hexes.
There is a major setting assumption entwined in the above descrip-
tions of ranks of nobility, and that is the assumption that in a world Usually, a dominion will consist of a single fief, with the stronghold
as dangerous as the average game world there is a need for rulers roughly in the centre so that no point is too far away for easy access.
to be experienced and knowledgeable. A ruler who is only in their
position because of an accident of birth is likely to fall prey to any A large stronghold with several external troop garrisons can increase
number of assassins, doppelgangers, curses, vampires, and other forces the effective dominion to anything up to seven fiefs (one con-
that would strip them of their will or life. taining the stronghold and another six surrounding it). However,
the increased travel time needed for either troops to get from the
Because of this, there is a need for rulers to be toughened and worldly stronghold to an outlying village or for the villagers from that vil-
wise. In game terms, this is represented by them needing to be at lage trying to seek refuge in the stronghold limits the maximum
least 9th level in an adventuring class before they’d be considered size of the dominion to no larger than this.
competent to rule.
If someone wishes to clear out more land and enlarge their domin-
This has a major effect on the setting. Not only does it mean that ion beyond this size then they must build another stronghold to
the nobles and rulers that an adventurer encounters will be high protect the newly cleared land – and this then becomes the centre
level, but it also means that adventuring is an established means of a second dominion.
of social mobility.
Before a stronghold can be built, the surrounding area must first
Nobles act as patrons to low level adventurers, giving them tasks and be cleared of monsters that would threaten the builders. This job
monitoring their carreers looking for those who show potential to be is ideally suited to adventuring parties.
brought into the nobility themselves. Similarly, adventurers develop
relationships with potential patrons in the hope of future position.

205
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
Mountains fiefs with over 1,000 families become settled only if
populated by dwarves, and forest and jungle fiefs with over 1,000
families become settled only if populated by elves.

This has two effects. Firstly, settled terrain uses different columns
on wilderness encounter tables than other terrain types (see Chap-
ter 12 – into the wilderness for details about wilderness en-
counters). Secondly, the change to settled terrain may change the
civilisation level of the fief, with a corresponding increase in the
maximum number of families that the fief can contain.

The change in civilisation level of the fief may have a knock-on ef-
fect on other nearby fiefs, since they may now be within 72 miles
(three 24-mile hexes or nine 8-mile hexes) of a civilised fief.

Any fief that loses enough population that it no longer has 1,000


families also loses its settled type, and reverts back to its normal
terrain type. Again, this may have a knock-on effect on other fiefs;
which may no longer be within 72 miles of a civilised fief, and
therefore may drop in civilisation level themselves.

Example: One of lady Gretchen’s dominions consists of a castle and


its fief. The entire area is mountains, and is well away from other
civilised lands. When the castle is first built, the fief is therefore at
Once the area is clear, the stronghold itself can be designed and the wilderness level of civilisation.
built. The building costs (in both money and time) for the different
components of a stronghold are listed in Chapter 8 – Equipping After a few years, the population of her fief grows to 1,033 families.
for Adventure. Because lady Gretchen’s people are primarily dwarves, that fief is
now considered to be settled rather than mountains, and therefore
Terrain & Resources becomes borderlands and can support a higher population.
In order to determine the resources available to a dominion, the
terrain of each fief must be determined. Another of lady Gretchen’s dominions is in the hills closer to the
rest of the kingdom. It is also not within 144 miles of a city or
If you are using 24-mile hexes, this is straightforward, as a single within 72 miles of a civilised fief, but two of the fiefs adjacent to it
map hex will equal a single fief. If you are using 8-mile hexes or are within 72 miles of a civilised fief.
maps without hexes then you will have to classify each fief accord-
ing to its predominant terrain type. Those two fiefs (which belong to allied barons) are therefore consid-
ered to be borderland hills and lady Gretchen’s fief is considered to
Each fief is classified as either civilised, borderlands or wilderness, be wilderness hills.
according to Table 13–1, depending on the terrain type of the fief
and how close it is to a major city or to other civilised fiefs. Note After a few years, one of the adjacent borderlands fiefs reaches 1,014
that the other civilised fiefs don’t necessarily need to belong to the families. It is now considered to be settled terrain rather than hills.
same dominion or even the same country, as long as there are trade This changes the civilisation level of the fief to civilised. This change
links between them and the fief in question (which will usually be in civilisation level means that lady Gretchen’s fief is now within 72
the case, barring embargoes). miles of a civilised fief, and its civilisation level is now upgraded
from wilderness to borderlands accordingly.
This civilisation level of the fief determines both the number of
families that will be attracted to settle the area when the stronghold
is built and also the maximum number of families that the fief can Should this cause the maximum population of a fief to drop be-
support. See Table 13–2 for details. low its current population, the population of that fief will reduce
by 20% per season until it is no longer unsupportable.
Settled Terrain
Any clear, forest, grasslands, hills or woods fief that is has over 1,000 Material Resources
families living in it is considered to be of terrain type settled rather Each fief of the dominion will produce between one and four re-
than its basic terrain type. sources that may be exploited to generate income for the dominion,
determined by rolling a d10 and consulting the following list:

1 = one resource

206
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
Table 13–1: Dominion Fief Classification
More Than 144 Miles from a
Not Near a City or Civilised
Terrain Type Within 144 Miles of a City City But Within 72 Miles of
Fief
a Civilised Fief
Barren Lands Borderlands Wilderness Wilderness
Clear* Civilised Borderlands Wilderness
Desert Borderlands**** Wilderness Wilderness
Forest** Civilised Borderlands Wilderness
Grasslands* Civilised Borderlands Wilderness
Hills* Civilised Borderlands Wilderness
Jungle** Borderlands Wilderness Wilderness
Mountains*** Borderlands Wilderness Wilderness
Ocean Wilderness Wilderness Wilderness
Settled Civilised Civilised Borderlands
Swamp Borderlands Wilderness Wilderness
Woods* Civilised Borderlands Wilderness
*fiefs of this type can become settled if populated by anyone
**fiefs of this type can become settled if populated by elves
***fiefs of this type can become settled if populated by dwarves
****fiefs containing oases are considered to be civilised

2–7 = two resources Example: When lady Gretchen was granted her land and built her
8–9 = three resources castle, the Game Master rolled for resources for the fief. He rolled
10 = four resources that the fief had three resources: Two mineral and a vegetable.
Although the actual resources available can be very varied, for game Jim discussed what those three resources could be with the Game
purposes they are simply split into three categories: animal, veg- Master, and between them they decided that there was a silver seam
etable and mineral. that could be mined, a source of granite that could be quarried,
and – because the mountain fief is in a warm region and on the
For each resource found, roll 1d10 to see which type it is: edge of the mountain range – olive groves in the valleys and foothills.
1–3 = animal
4–8 = vegetable To be specific, the population change and the economy (the in-
9–10 = mineral come and expenditure for the dominion) are handled on a seasonal
basis, and the level of satisfaction – or unrest – of the populace is
The Game Master or players may wish to go into further detail usually handled on a yearly basis but may need to be checked in
about exactly what types of resources these are; for example a min- exceptional circumstances.
eral resource could be a gold seam or a source of strong stone for
building or a source of fine clay or any one of dozens of other Seasonal Economy Check
types of mineral. Each game season, the ruler of the dominion, along with the Game
Master, needs to check the economy and tally up the income and
This detail may enhance role playing, particularly if the players like expenditure for the season.
doing trade negotiations, but it does not affect the dominion rules.
Developer Commentary
In the example above, although gold is far more expensive than The original game that Dark Dungeons emulates, as well as the
building stone, there will also be far less of it and the relative income original edition of Dark Dungeons, tracks dominions on a monthly
for a gold mine or a quarry in a fief will be similar. basis rather than a seasonal basis.

Ruling a Dominion It is changed to a seasonal basis in this edition of Dark Dungeons


In Dark Dungeons, ruling of a dominion takes place in the time- for the simple reason that it cuts down on the amount of work that
scale of seasons and years, dropping down to a day-to-day basis the players need to do. Obviously, the numbers have been adjusted so
only during unusual situations. that the new seasonal changes match the old monthly changes when
it comes to total income and population growth per year.

207
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
Table 13–2: Civilisation Levels Service: Each family in the dominion brings in the equivalent of
Level Settling Families Max Families income worth 25gp per season in service, such as building works,
growing food, tending animals, and so forth. Unlike other sources
Wilderness 1d10x10 1,500
of income, this is not actually received by the ruler of the domin-
Borderlands 2d6x100 3,000 ion as money. However, it can be used to offset expenses such as
Civilised 1d10x500 6,000 holidays, tithes, salt tax, and the paying of armies (mercenary or
otherwise). Any service income that is not used is wasted and
Population Change cannot be stored.
Each season, the number of families in each fief of the dominion
will change due to a variety of factors. Usually, this will be an Developer Commentary
increase due to new settlers joining the fief. Rather than try to The original game that Dark Dungeons emulates, as well as the
account for each individual factor, Dark Dungeons abstracts the original edition of Dark Dungeons, made you assign each family
whole population change for the season into a single check. in the fief to an exact resource that they would work to exploit in
some kind of stalinist planned economy, with penalties for leaving
At the beginning of each season, roll 2d4 plus an extra d4 per resources un-exploited and penalties for having too many families
thousand families in the fief. Multiply the dice total by 10, and engaged in mining. It then had different resources providing differ-
that is the number of extra families that join the fief. ent amounts of income.

Income The problem with this was threefold. Firstly it was too controlling in
Seasonal income comes from four sources: terms of the dominion ruler micromanaging the lives of their popu-
lace instead of letting them (and market forces) dictate what jobs the
◊ Resource income workers would do. Secondly there was a single obviously optimum
◊ Service income solution (in terms of maximum income for minimum penalties)
◊ Poll tax for each particular combination of resources with no random fac-
◊ Salt tax tor involved, so it wasn’t interesting to do. And thirdly splitting the
families up and working out the income involved a large amount
of number crunching.
Example: When lady Gretchen builds her castle, the fief is wilder-
ness. Therefore it attracts 1d10x10 families as settlers. Jim rolls a 7,
For these three reasons, this edition of Dark Dungeons vastly simpli-
so 70 families settle the fief.
fies resource income by simply having you roll for an overall income
per family. The end result is (on average) around the same amount
After a season, Jim checks the fief for population growth. There are
of income that you would have got from the complex system, but
fewer than 1,000 families, so there is an increase of 2d4x10 families.
without all the work.
Jim rolls 5 on his 2d4, so an additional 50 families join his fief for
a total of 120 families.
Poll Tax: Each family in the dominion normally pays 3gp per
season in poll tax. This is actual money-in-the-coffers tax paid in
Resources: Each fief of the dominion will have between 1 and 4 coinage.
types of resource in it. These resources provide income for the
dominion ruler. The ruler of the dominion can set the tax rate higher or lower if
they desire. For each extra 1gp that is paid per family, there is a –10
Theoretically, different resources will provide different revenue penalty to the dominion’s confidence rating per year. For each 1gp
streams, and these will vary seasonally as well as varying depend- less that is paid per family, there is a +5 bonus to the dominion’s
ing on fluctuations in supply and demand. In practice, it is neither confidence rating per year.
desirable nor feasible to track this kind of minutiae, since it would
bog the game down into an exercise in accounting. Additionally, when the ruler increases the tax rate, this gives an
instant –25 penalty to the dominion’s confidence rating and forces
The variance in resource income each season is represented by roll- an immediate confidence check. Similarly, decreasing the tax rate
ing 3d4. The result is the amount (in gp) of resource income that gives an instant +10 bonus to the dominion’s confidence rating.
is gained per family that is working in the fief. Multiply the result
by the total number of families in the fief to work out the total Salt Tax: If the ruler of the dominion has other nobles who have
resource income for the season. sworn fealty to them, they are given 20% of the total income of
each lesser noble’s dominion. This income is normally paid in the
Any fief that brings in a seasonal resource income of 15,000gp form of services, and therefore doesn’t actually arrive as coinage.
or more will attract corruption, black markets and bandits. Un- However, like other service income it can be used to offset expendi-
less that fief contains the stronghold from which the dominion is ture. Like service income, this income cannot be stored, and must
ruled, 1d10x10% of the potential resource income will be lost to be used or wasted.
such forces.

208
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
Expenditure Failure to provide the full amount of tithes results in the churches
Castle Staff and Maintenance: With the exception of recruiting (and possibly the gods or immortals associated with them, depend-
armies, which must be accounted for, the cost of castle staff and ing on the setting) being angered, and they make their anger known
routine maintenance is assumed to already be covered by the service to the populace.
income of the dominion.
The net result of this is that any year in which tithes are not paid
Example: After a couple of years of growth, lady Gretchen has 447 in full gives a –50 penalty to the dominion’s confidence rating.
families living in the fief.
If tithes are short-changed for more than one year in a row, there is
Jim is calculating the seasonal income for the fief. a 25% chance each year that an extra “disaster” event will happen
that year as the immortals show their displeasure. If such an event
The resource income for the fief is therefore (3d4) x 447. Jim rolls is going to happen, it will be preceded by omens and prophetic
a 6 on his 3d4, and therefore gets 6x447 = 2,682gp. dreams.

The service income of the fief is simply ten times the population, Salt Tax: In just the same way that the dominion may receive salt
which is (25x447) = 11,175gp. tax from subservient dominions, it must also pay twenty percent
of its gross income (income before any expenditure has been taken
Lady Gretchen has not set taxes higher or lower than the stand- out) to the noble or royal that the ruler of the dominion has sworn
ard 3gp/family, so in poll tax she receives (3x447) = 1,341gp. fealty to.

Therefore, for this fief, lady Gretchen receives a total of 4,023gp in Salt tax may be paid with either service income or money, or a
cash and 11,175gp in services that can offset expenditure. combination of the two.

The Game Master then instructs Jim to add 1,920gp of extra service Festivals and Holidays: Some days during the year are declared
income for the salt tax paid to lady Gretchen by the baron who looks as festivals or holidays. These may have been declared by the ruler
after her second dominion. of the country, or by one of the major religions of the country, or
the ruler of the dominion may declare their own.

However, extraordinary expenses such as rebuilding works in the The overall cost of a holiday is 5gp per family. This represents both
wake of a siege or a monster attack must be paid for out of the the expenditure for celebrations and also the lost income because
ruler’s pocket. Service income may be used to pay for these expenses. people are not working. This cost may be paid with either service
income or money, or a combination of the two.
Troops: Whether a full time standing army, a “special forces” unit
of adventurers, or a group of mercenaries; troops must be paid for. If the holiday was a religious one declared by the temples, its cost
can be recouped from the tithes paid to the church.
Armies and mercenaries can be paid for with service income, based
on their costs in Chapter 8 – Equipping for Adventure, but Similarly, if the holiday was a national one declared by the ruler
adventurers usually only work for cold hard cash. of the country, its cost can be recouped from the salt tax paid to
that ruler.
In times of dire need, a peasant militia can be formed from the
local populace. However, if the cost of the holiday is too great to be covered by the
tithes or salt tax (or if the holiday was declared by the dominion
Up to 10% of the families in an area can provide “poor” ranked ruler rather than by a higher power) the dominion ruler must pay
peasant militia (providing an average of 2.5 troops per family). the remaining cost themselves.
A further 10% of the families in an area can provide “untrained”
ranked peasant militia (providing an average of 2.5 troops per Under normal circumstances, there will be two religious festivals
family). per season (not necessarily the same two each season), and the
populace will expect these to be held regularly.
If either are called up, the families providing militia will not pro-
duce income of any type during the seasons in which the militia Each time a regular holiday or festival that the populace are expect-
is active. ing is cancelled, a –5 penalty is applied to the dominion’s confi-
dence rating, and an immediate confidence check must be made.
Tithes: One tenth of all gross income (income before any expendi-
ture has been taken out) must be given in tithes to the various Each time an extraordinary holiday or festival day is announced, a
churches and temples that are followed throughout the dominion. +2 bonus is applied to the dominion’s confidence rating.

Tithes may be paid with either service income or money, or a Entertaining Visitors: Etiquette demands that visiting nobles and
combination of the two. royalty are entertained according to their station.

209
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
The following costs apply whenever a noble (and their retinue) Example: Lady Gretchen has a total income from her dominion for
are visiting: the season (including salt tax from her second dominion) of 4,023gp
in cash, and 13,095gp worth of services.
knight = no extra cost
baron = 100gp/day Firstly, she takes 30% of that out (20% in salt tax to the queen
viscount = 150gp/day and 10% in tithes to the church). She ends up paying 2,619gp to
count = 300gp/day the queen and 1,310gp to the church for a total of 3,929gp.
marquis = 400gp/day
duke = 600gp/day The 3,929gp is all paid out of service income, leaving her with:
archduke = 700gp/day
prince = as nobility + 100gp/day 13,095–3,929 = 9,166gp left.
king = 1,000gp/day
emperor = 1,500gp/day There was a religious festival for two days during the month. Since
the population of her dominion is 447 families, this costs her:
Experience for Income
When calculating the amount of experience the ruler of a dominion 447x10 = 4,470gp
gets from their seasonal income, there are two rules that must be
applied. Since these were religious festival days, she can use tithes to help
fund them. She should be paying 1,310gp in tithes, so that leaves:
Firstly, only cash income (i.e. Resources and poll tax) provide ex-
perience points. Service income and income from salt tax of lesser 4,470–1,310 = 3,160gp to pay.
nobles does not provide experience points.
She pays the 3,160gp out of her remaining service income, leaving
Secondly, experience points are derived from the gross income of her with:
cash (income before any expenditure has been taken out). Even
if all the income is spent due to heavy expenditure and the ruler 9,166–3,160 = 6,006gp left
ends up making a net loss, they will still receive full experience.
Out of this 6,006gp, she pays for her standing army consisting of 300
Example: Lady Gretchen received 4,023gp in cash and 13,095gp heavy dwarven infantry (costing 15gp each per season) and 100
of services this month. She gets experience for all of the cash even dwarven crossbowmen (costing 18gp each per season).
though she had to spend some of it, but does not get money for the
services. Lady Gretchen therefore gains 4,023xp this month. These troops cost her:

(300x15)+(100x18) = 6,300gp
Public Works
Each season, any spare service income that would otherwise be She can pay 6,006gp of this wage bill using services, leaving her:
wasted can be used to start (or continue) building a public work
such as a keep, temple or castle. The ruler of the dominion may 6,300–6,006 = 294gp to pay
supplement the service income being used to build the public work
with their own money in order to finish a public work more quickly. She pays the 294gp out of her 4,023gp cash income, leaving her:

Additionally, if the ruler of the dominion (or an acquaintance) is 4,023–294 = 3,729gp


a spell caster with access to the stone shape, Stoneform, Woodform
and/or Wall of Stone spells and is willing to cast those spells regu- Having balanced her finances for the season, lady Gretchen discov-
larly for free, they may double all building progress (both service ers that she has managed to pay most of her expenses out of service
and cash). Hiring an outside spell caster to cast those spells does income, but she considers cutting back on troop numbers, since she’s
not double progress, since it is assumed to cost a similar amount having to dip into real cash in order to pay them.
of cash for the long term hiring of the spell caster as that which
would be otherwise saved. She keeps the remaining 3,729gp cash and puts it in her coffers.

When a public work is first started, the fiefdom gets an immediate


confidence boost. This boost is then given a second time when the An existing keep can be upgraded into a small castle, and either
public work is finished. If the building of a public work is aban- of those can be upgraded into a large castle. In each of these cases,
doned (i.e. A season passes without any progress being made on it) the cost and confidence boost is found by taking the difference
then the confidence immediately drops by an amount equal to the between that of the existing structure and that of the new structure.
boost given for starting the project. The confidence boosts and other
effects of public works are shown in Table 13–3 – public works.

210
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
Table 13–3: Public Works
Confidence
Building Cost Other Effects
Boost
Fortified Manor House 6,000gp +0 A quarter fewer casualties when defending in battle
Temple 25,000gp +30 25% disaster avoidance
Mage’s Tower 150,000gp +0 Half casualties when defending in battle; includes a laboratory
Keep 75,000gp +20 Half casualties and x2 troop multiplier when defending in battle
Small Castle 150,000gp +40 Half casualties and x3 troop multiplier when defending in battle
Large Castle 250,000gp +50 Half casualties and x4 troop multiplier when defending in battle

It is important to remember that although the confidence rating


Developer Commentary may change frequently, the confidence level only changes when a
Neither the first edition of Dark Dungeons nor the original game confidence check is made – even if the rating moves into a different
that it emulates have the concept of public works. They are a new range between checks.
addition in this game.
Yearly Confidence Check
The idea is to provide a simple way for players to manage the At the beginning of each year, the Game Master checks the cur-
building of fortified structures that doesn’t require them to use the rent confidence rating on Table 13–3 in order to determine the
full rules in CHAPTER 8 - EQUIPPING FOR ADVENTURE to design a confidence level of the dominion.
building from sxratch.
This confidence check may also be required as a result of certain
actions by the dominion ruler (e.g. When an expected holiday is
Confidence Level cancelled) or as a result of a disaster striking the dominion.
Each dominion has a confidence rating. This is a number that rep-
resents the general state of content (or discontent!) of the populace. Descriptions of the various confidence levels and their effects on
the dominion are given below:
There is a single confidence rating for the whole dominion – dif-
ferent fiefs do not have separate ratings. Turbulent (49 or Less): 95% of families will form a peasant militia
(providing an average of 2.5 troops per family).
When a dominion is first established, the initial confidence rating
is set to the sum of the ability scores of the ruler plus 150 plus an No income of any kind may be collected, except by force.
additional d100 roll.
A –10 penalty is applied to the confidence rating.
In addition to the confidence rating, a dominion also has a con-
fidence level. The confidence level is based on the rating, and pe- The confidence rating cannot rise above 100 until the ruler of the
riodically a “confidence check” is made. Whenever a confidence dominion is removed.
check needs to be made, look up the current confidence rating on
Table 13–4 and this will indicate the new confidence level. All trade caravans and travelling officials will be attacked by bandits.

Any of the dominion ruler’s troops that move or deploy within the
dominion will be attacked by peasant militia, deserters, bandits or
Table 13–4: Confidence Levels
enemy agents.
Confidence Rating Confidence Level
49 or Less Turbulent One or more enemy states will provide the peasant militia with
50 to 99 Belligerent military support.
100 to 149 Rebellious
Belligerent (50–99): In each fief that has fewer troops than one
150 to 199 Defiant half of the number of families, half the families will form a peasant
200 to 229 Unsteady militia (providing an average of 2.5 troops per family).
230 to 269 Average
No poll tax can be collected.
270 to 299 Steady
300 to 349 Healthy A quarter of normal service income can be collected in areas with-
350 to 399 Prosperous out a peasant militia, but none can be collected in areas with a
peasant militia.
400 to 449 Thriving
450 or Higher Ideal

211
Chapter 13 - Settling Down

A quarter of normal resource income can be collected in areas militia (providing an average of 2.5 troops per family). However,
without a peasant militia, but none can be collected in areas with these militia will not attack unless provoked.
a peasant militia.
No poll tax can be collected.
A –10 penalty is applied to the confidence rating.
A half of normal service income can be collected in areas without
All trade caravans and travelling officials will be attacked by bandits. a peasant militia, but only a third can be collected in areas with a
peasant militia.
Any of the dominion ruler’s troops that move or deploy within the
dominion will be attacked by peasant militia, deserters, bandits or A half of normal resource income can be collected in areas without
enemy agents. a peasant militia, but only a third can be collected in areas with a
peasant militia.
There is a 50% chance that an enemy state will provide the peasant
militia with military support. Unsteady (200–229): There is a 20% chance that a –10 penalty
will apply to the confidence rating.
Rebellious (100–149): In each fief that has fewer troops than one
third of the number of families, half the families will form a peasant Average (230–269): The dominion is running smoothly. There are
militia (providing an average of 2.5 troops per family). However, no special conditions or effects.
these militia will not attack unless provoked.
Steady (270–299): There is a 25% chance per agent that enemy
No poll tax can be collected. agents working in the dominion will be exposed.

A third of normal service income can be collected in areas without Healthy (300–349): All income is 10% greater than normal.
a peasant militia, but only a quarter can be collected in areas with
a peasant militia. There is a 25% chance per agent that enemy agents working in the
dominion will be exposed.
A third of normal resource income can be collected in areas without
a peasant militia, but only a quarter can be collected in areas with Prosperous (350–399): All income is 10% greater than normal.
a peasant militia.
There is a 25% chance per agent that enemy agents working in the
A –10 penalty is applied to the confidence rating. dominion will be exposed.

Defiant (150–199): In each fief that has fewer troops than one If a random check indicates that a disaster will occur during the
third of the number of families, half the families will form a peasant coming year, there is a 25% chance that it will not happen.

212
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
Table 13–4: Dominion Events players’ decisions have a real impact on the way their dominions
D100 Roll Event type prosper or struggle.
01–05 Major positive event
Types of event and their effects are listed below:
06–20 Minor positive event
25–40 Neutral event Major Positive Event: A major positive event will benefit the
41–75 Minor negative event dominion greatly. It may result in a bonus to the confidence rating
of up to +25, up to a doubling of income for a season, a popula-
76–95 Major negative event
tion increase of up to +25%, or some combination of the above.
96–00 Disaster Depending on the nature of the event, the ruler may need to get
involved personally in order to get the best results – but there
Thriving (400–449): All income is 10% greater than normal. should be some positive results even if the ruler does nothing.

There is a 50% chance per agent that enemy agents working in the Examples: new resource type found, ancient treasure found, an
dominion will be exposed. immortal decides to become the patron of the dominion, a clan
of demi-human refugees joins the dominion.
If a random check indicates that a disaster will occur during the
coming year, there is a 25% chance that it will not happen. Minor Positive Event: A minor positive event will benefit the
dominion, or at the very least not harm it. It may result in a bonus
Ideal (450 or Higher): All income is 10% greater than normal. to the confidence rating of up to +15, up to 50% extra income for
a season, a population increase of up to +15%, or some combina-
There is a 75% chance per agent that enemy agents working in the tion of the above. The ruler may need to get involved personally in
dominion will be exposed. order to get the benefits – but there should be no negative results
even if the ruler does nothing.
If a random check indicates that a disaster will occur during the
coming year, there is a 25% chance that it will not happen. Examples: a new trade route is proposed, a hostile tribe of human-
oids moves away from the dominion, passing adventurers clear out
A +25 bonus is applied to the confidence rating. local bandits without needing to be hired to do so, a druid moves
into the area.
The confidence rating cannot drop below 400 before the next con-
fidence check. Neutral Event: A neutral event may benefit the dominion or harm
it, depending on how it is dealt with.
Events
Each year, 1d4 random events will happen in the dominion. Due It may result in a change to the confidence rating of up to +/–10,
to the huge variety of events that can occur, it is not possible to up to 25% extra or less income for a season, a population change
list them here. However, they can be roughly classified into types of up to +/–10%, or some combination of the above.
of event.
Whether the event works out positively or negatively should depend
For each event that occurs, roll on Table 13–4 to determine the on how the ruler handles it.
type of event.
Examples: a vip visitor arrives unexpectedly, comets or other omens
Although this table is random, the Game Master should be fair to are seen in the sky, heresy is discovered in a local church, a local
the players and should not let players’ dominions be wiped out by tribe of humanoids is displaced by a different tribe.
a few bad rolls which indicate disaster after disaster.
Minor Negative Event: A minor positive event will harm the do-
If the dice seem to be against the players, then the Game Master minion, or at the very least not benefit it. It may result in a penalty
should introduce plot elements or potential adventures into the to the confidence rating of up to +15, up to 50% less income for
game that can mitigate the worst situations. a season, a population decrease of up to –15%, or some combina-
tion of the above. The ruler may need to get involved personally
Similarly, if the dice are favouring the players and they are getting in order to avoid the harm – but there should be no significant
bored just raking in the money every season without challenge, the positive results no matter how well the ruler handles the situation.
Game Master should introduce plot elements or adventures that
can cause additional problems. Examples: bandits start raiding, an official is assassinated, low level
wandering monsters arrive in the area, a disease breaks out.
However, in either case the Game Master should be careful not to
railroad the players and make them feel that the status quo is being Major Negative Event: A major negative event will harm the do-
forcibly maintained. The Game Master should make sure that the minion greatly. It may result in a penalty to the confidence rating

213
Chapter 13 - Settling Down
of up to –25, up to 75% less income for a season, a population Disaster: A disaster event will harm the dominion greatly in a
decrease of up to –25%, or some combination of the above. similar way to a major negative event. It may result in a penalty to
the confidence rating of up to –25, up to 75% less income for a
Depending on the nature of the event, the ruler may need to get season, a population decrease of up to –25%, or some combination
involved personally in order to get the least bad results – but there of the above. It will also result in an immediate confidence check.
should be some negative results no matter how well the ruler han- Depending on the nature of the event, the ruler may need to get
dles the situation. involved personally in order to get the least bad results – but there
should be seriously negative results no matter how well the ruler
Examples: one of the fief ’s resources runs out, an epidemic strikes, handles the situation.
a high level wandering monster enters the dominion, agitants fo-
ment rebellion against the ruler, a major fire breaks out. Examples: an extremely high level monster attacks the dominion,
plague strikes, a hurricane, tornado or avalanche sweeps the do-
minion, an earthquake strikes, an immortal smites the dominion.

214
Chapter 14 - War!
T
here are times when relations between two factions have ◊ Do at least 20% of the army have magical abilities (breath weap-
broken down to the point where war is the only answer. on, poison, regeneration, gaze attacks, etc.)?
Such a war could be between the armies of rival dominions, ◊ Does 100% of the army have magical abilities (breath weapon,
or between the collected armies of rival countries. It could even poison, regeneration, gaze attacks, etc.)?
be between two other humanoid races. Whoever the sides are, the ◊ Are at least 5% of the army spell casters?
result is one or more battles between armies. ◊ Are at least 20% of the army spell casters?

The combat system described in Chapter 10 – Combat is designed Rank


for small numbers of combatants. For large battles with hundreds The rank of an army is a measure of how skilled it is. This counts
or even thousands of combatants on either side, the system would for both how skilled each individual creature in the army is and
be completely unworkable due to the amount of time and book- also how well practised the army is at fighting as a unit. There are
keeping involved. eight named ranks: untrained, poor, below average, fair, average,
good, excellent, and elite. For the standing armies of fiefdoms it
Therefore this chapter presents rules for battles between armies. is based on how much is spent hiring and maintaining the army.
The battle system in this chapter is not designed for detailed simu- For monsters, it is based on their hit dice, as shown in Table 14–1.
lation of a battle with the complexity of a war game, and lots of Note that special abilities and asterisks are not counted here, be-
cardboard chits or counters (representing squads or units) being cause they will be taken into account separately in the capability
moved around the battlefield. Such simulations are slow and rely score and battle rating.
on the tactical skill of the players.
Table 4–1: Army Ranks
Instead, each clash between two armies is resolved in a single roll. Cost Hit Dice
Rank
(hired Armies) (monsters)
Armies x¼ Less than 1 Untrained
Armies have their effectiveness in battle represented by two scores:
their size and their battle rating. The size of an army is simply x⅓ 1 Poor
the number of creatures it contains. The battle rating of the army x½ 1+ to 2 Below average
is a measure of how good at fighting (on average) each creature
x¾ 2+ to 3 Fair
in the army is. Note that these two measures are independent of
each other – an army does not get a bonus to its battle rating for x1 3+ to 5 Average
being large. x1½ 5+ to 7 Good
x2 7+ to 9 Excellent
Calculating the size of an army is trivial – it’s simply the number
x3 9+ and higher Elite
of creatures in it. Calculating the battle rating of an army is done
by working out two values: the army’s capability score and its
rank – and then looking them up on a table.
Developer Commentary
Capability Score In the original game that Dark Dungeons emulates, calculating army
The capability score of an army is a measure of what the creatures rank required a large number of factors, which the Game Master
within the army are capable of doing. There are fourteen tests was unlikely to have for armies not controlled by players.
that you apply to the army measuring different capabilities that
it might have and it gains a point of capability score for each test The first edition of Dark Dungeons simplified this tremendously,
that applies. Therefore the capability score of an army is always a but still required you to track how long each army had been train-
value from 0–14. The fourteen tests are: ing together and it was still overly complex to add recruits to an
existing army.
◊ Are at least 20% of the army mounted?
◊ Are at least 50% of the army mounted? This edition of Dark Dungeons swaps the experience-based rank
◊ Can at least 1% of the army fly? for a cost-based rank, which makes everything much easier from a
◊ Can at least 20% of the army fly? game point of view.
◊ Is the average movement rate of the army at least 35’ per round?
◊ Do at least 20% of the army have missile weapons? From an in-character point of view, think of it as the extra cost not
◊ Do at least 20% of the army have missile weapons with a range only paying for better training and equipment but also providing
of at least 100’? better pay which will attract a higher calibre of recruits.
◊ Do at least 50% of the troops have an armour class of 4 or lower?
◊ Do at least 50% of the troops have attacks capable of doing 8+
damage per round?
◊ Do at least 1% of the army have magical abilities (breath weapon,
poison, regeneration, gaze attacks, etc.)?

215
Chapter 14 - War!

Battle Rating should be somewhere between half a mile and a mile across. An
To find the battle rating of the army, look up the army’s rank and area can only hold one army, and armies attack by invading the
capability score on the Table 14–2. area occupied by another army.

Battles Battle Turns


When armies are going to clash in a location, you should prepare a Time during a battle is measures in battle turns. Each battle turn
rough map of that location split into areas. This can be done using is much longer than a combat round. It can last anywhere from
hexes or it can be done by simply dividing the location into rough half an hour to two hours depending on the battle. At the start of
geographical regions (e.g. “the woods”, “the west side of the village”, each battle turn, all armies that are adjacent to an enemy army are
“the fields north of the bridge”, “the hill”, and so forth). Each area considered to be engaged with that enemy army.

Table 14–2: Battle Ratings


Below
Capability Untrained Poor Fair Average Good Excellent Elite
Average
0 2 6 9 12 15 18 22 28
1 2 7 10 13 17 20 24 31
2 2 7 11 14 18 22 26 34
3 3 8 12 16 20 23 29 36
4 3 8 13 17 21 25 31 39
5 3 9 14 18 23 27 33 42
6 3 10 14 19 24 29 35 45
7 3 10 15 20 26 31 37 48
8 4 11 16 22 27 32 40 50
9 4 11 17 23 29 34 42 53
10 4 12 18 24 30 36 44 56
11 4 13 19 25 32 38 46 59
12 4 13 20 26 33 40 48 62
13 5 14 21 28 35 41 51 64
14 5 14 22 29 36 43 53 67

216
Chapter 14 - War!
When armies clash during a battle turn, the clash is resolved by Table 14–3: Battlefield Bonus for Relative Size
calculating a battlefield bonus for each army based on three factors:
Outnumbering Battlefield Bonus
◊ The tactics that each army is using. More than 50:1 +32
◊ The relative size of each army. More than 40:1 +30
◊ Miscellaneous situational factors. More than 30:1 +28
How well each army does in the clash is then determined by adding More than 20:1 +26
their battlefield bonus to their battle rating, and adding a d20. The More than 15:1 +24
army that gets the highest total “wins” the clash. More than 10:1 +22
More than 8:1 +20
Moving
Armies are resolved in order from the smallest to the largest. If an More than 7:1 +18
army is not engaged, it may move up to two areas, but must end its More than 6:1 +16
movement if it becomes adjacent to an enemy army after moving More than 5:1 +14
its first area. Armies can’t move through other armies.
More than 4:1 +12
Splitting and Merging More than 3:1 +9
During its movement an army can split into two or more smaller More than 2:1 +6
armies of the same type which can move in different ways. Each More than 1.5:1 +3
of the smaller armies must comprise of at least 20% of the troops
in the army that is splitting. An army that is engaged may split in 1.5:1 or Less +0
this manner, but at least one of the smaller armies into which it
splits must be left behind. Similarly, two armies comprised of the Situational Factors
same type of troop can merge into a single larger army by simply Finally, each side gets additional battlefield bonuses as follows:
moving into the same area.
◊ +2 if the army is in their home territory.
Combat Splits ◊ +2 if the army have beaten this enemy before.
Once all armies have moved, each army that is engaged with an- ◊ +2 if the rank of the army is at least two higher than that of
other army (i.e. all armies that are adjacent to at least one enemy their enemy.
army) must fight all armies with which it is engaged. If an army is ◊ +6 if ambushing an enemy while the enemy is unprepared.
engaged with more than one enemy army, it must temporarily split ◊ –2 if any allied force has routed.
into enough smaller armies to fight each of them individually. As ◊ +4 if the battle is at night and the entire army has darkvision.
with movement, the split may not result in any armies with a size ◊ +4 if attacking or defending from higher ground or a town.
smaller than 20% of the whole army (unless the army is totally ◊ –4 for mounted troops in mountains, woods, or at a stronghold.
surrounded and is engaged with more than five opponents at once!) ◊ –4 for combat in difficult terrain unless at least half the army
can fly.
This temporary split last only for the duration of the fight, and at ◊ +2 if the army is defending.
the start of the next battle turn the smaller armies (if they are still ◊ +10 if defending a bridge, narrow pass, or gorge.
in the same area) will re-join to form a single army once more. ◊ +8 if defending and the attacker must cross deep water.
◊ +6 if the army has more (by value) siege weaponry than its en-
Combat Merges emy does.
When two armies are merged into a single one (or when a group ◊ +5 if at least 10% of the army is resistant to at least 80% of the
of new recruits are added to an existing army to increase its size), enemy’s attacks.
the rank of the combined army is calculated as follows: ◊ +5 if the whole army is resistant to at least 80% of the enemy’s
attacks.
◊ Start with the higher of the ranks of the two armies. ◊ +10 if the whole army is immune to at least 80% of the enemy’s
attacks.
◊ For each 20% of the combined army that comes from the less ◊ –2 if the army has medium fatigue.
good troops, reduce the rank by one level. ◊ –6 if the army has severe fatigue.

◊ The rank can never be reduced below the lower of the ranks of Relative Size
the two armies. In each fight, the larger of the two armies in the fight gets a bat-
tlefield bonus based upon the ratio of their size to their opponent’s
Remember that if the two armies have different capabilities you size as shown in Table 14–3:
may need to re-calculate the capability score of the combined army
as well.

217
Chapter 14 - War!
Table 14–4: Tactics Comparison
Enemy Enemy Enemy Enemy Enemy Enemy
Your Tactic
Advances Charges Envelops Holds Lures Withdraws
–4 +2
+10% +10% +10%
Advance Battlefield – Battlefield
Casualties Casualties Casualties
Bonus Bonus
+2 +4
+20% +20% +20% +20%
Charge Battlefield Battlefield
Casualties Casualties Casualties Casualties
Bonus Bonus
–2 +4 +2
+10% –10%
Envelop Battlefield – Battlefield Battlefield
Casualties Casualties
Bonus Bonus Bonus
–5
–10% +20% No –10% No
Hold Battlefield
Casualties Casualties Combat Casualties Combat
Bonus
+2 +4 –4 –4
–10%
Lure Battlefield Battlefield Battlefield Battlefield –
Casualties
Bonus Bonus Bonus Bonus
+20% +30% –10% No –10% No
Withdraw
Casualties Casualties Casualties Combat Casualties Combat

Note that if an army is defending a stronghold (a fortified manor Charge: This is an all-out attack, charging the enemy and attempt-
house, keep or castle) it may apply a multiplier to its troops before ing to punch through the front ranks to attack the more vulnerable
looking on this table based on the type of stronghold it is defending. troops. It is great for punching a hole through troops that are try-
ing to envelop you or for running down troops that are trying to
Tactics withdraw, but it can be a costly tactic in terms of casualties. This
The commander of each army that is engaged must choose a tactic is a type of attack.
that the army will use against its enemy. All tactics for all armies are
chosen in secret and revealed simultaneously (it’s best to do this by Envelop: The army tries to surround the enemy and attack from
writing them on paper and revealing the papers simultaneously). all sides. It is particularly effective against enemies who are hold-
The six possible tactics are: ing position, but leaves the attacking army vulnerable to direct
counterattacks and charges. This is a type of attack.
Advance: The army tries to advance in a controlled manner into its
enemy’s area, staying in formation if it has one. Although effective Hold: The army tries to hold position (and formation if they have
against withdrawing or holding armies, armies using this tactic one), letting the enemy come to them and engaging them when
can find themselves suffering if the enemy tries to envelop them they do. This tactic is a good defence against a normal advance or
or lure them into a trap. However, overall it is still one of the less an attempt to lure the armies into a trap, but it is easily enveloped
risky tactics. This is a type of attack.

218
Chapter 14 - War!
Table 14–5: Battle Results
Winner Loser
Difference
Casualties Movement Fatigue Casualties Movement Fatigue
0 10% None None 10% None None
1 0% None None 10% Retreat None
2–3 0% None None 20% Retreat None
4–5 10% None None 20% Retreat Medium
6–7 10% None None 30% Retreat Medium
8 20% Retreat Medium 40% Retreat Severe
9–10* 0% None None 30% Retreat Severe
11–13 20% Advance Medium 50% Retreat Severe
14–16 30% Advance Medium 60% Retreat Severe
17–18 10% Advance None 50% Retreat Severe
19–20 0% Advance None 30% Breach Rout
21–30 10% Advance None 70% Breach Rout
31+ 10% Advance None 100% Breach Rout
* maximum result possible if the winner chose a defensive tactic.

and can be counterproductive when the enemy tries to charge the Whichever army gets the higher total is the winner. Subtract the
holding army. This is a type of defence. loser’s score from the winner’s score and look up the results on the
Table 14–5 – battle results.
Lure: The army tries to lure the enemy into making costly lunges
and flanking manoeuvres, before attacking those troops committed The number of casualties each side suffers may be modified by the
to such manoeuvres. This tactic is effective against attacking troops tactic they are using, and further modified if they are defending
and can be devastating against troops that are trying to charge you; a stronghold.
but is very weak against armies that are reluctant to engage directly,
such as those trying to hold position or withdraw from combat Movement is based on the areas in which the armies were at the
completely. This is a type of defence. start of the fight:

Withdraw: This is simply an attempt to leave the area with as little None: The army finishes the fight where it started. If the army
fighting as possible. It is a risky manoeuvre against enemies which chose the “withdraw” tactic, this result is treated as a “retreat” result.
are attacking, but can often avoid a fight completely if the enemy
is holding position. This is a type of defence. Retreat: The army must retreat to an adjacent empty area (one not
containing another army) of their choice. If there is no available
An army that is using the advance, charge or envelop tactic is adjacent empty area (or if the army is defending a stronghold) then
considered to be attacking. An army that is using the hold, lure or the army stays where it is.
withdraw tactic is considered to be defending. This might mean
that in a given clash both armies may be attacking, both may be Advance: The army advances into the area vacated by the losing
defending, or one may be attacking and one may be defending. army. If the losing army was unable to retreat, this result is treated
as a “none” result.
Once all tactics have been revealed, the tactics of each pair of armies
that are engaged are compared on Table 14–4 (note that both Breach: If the army is defending a stronghold, the stronghold’s
armies look on the table to get their respective bonus or penalty defences have been breached and it will provide no further bonuses
based on their chosen tactic; you don’t just look once for the pair): until it is mended. Otherwise treat this as a “retreat” result.

Resolving the Clash Fatigue: Medium or severe fatigue has no immediate effect, but
The commander of each army rolls the following: gives a penalty of future battles held in the same day. A rout result
means that the army ceases to exist, with its individual members
◊ Battle rating + battlefield bonus (from tactics, numbers and either fleeing or surrendering, unless it is defending a stronghold.
situation) + d20

219
Chapter 15 - Out of This World
T
he mundane world with its castles, cities and forests is not forever. The solar system is inside a giant sphere known as a celestial
the sum total of existence. While it may seem so to the sphere. The celestial sphere is hundreds of millions of miles across,
average commoner, seasoned adventurers know that there capable of fitting the orbits of all the planets inside it.
are a multitude of other places out there, from other planets to
alternate realities. The celestial sphere appears to be made of a dark, smoky crystal or
glass that is completely impervious to any physical force. Dotted
High level adventurers will likely have fought or dealt with creatures about the sphere are huge transparent “windows” which let in light.
from such places, and may well – with the right magic – visit those
places themselves. These windows are visible from the surface of the planets inside the
sphere as stars. These windows, however, are just as impervious as
This chapter is reliant on Game Master’s discretion more than most. the rest of the sphere.
Things like the number of planets orbiting the sun and the number
of outer planes (both of which are described in this chapter) are Huge though it is, the sphere is not the only nearby “place”. There
very dependent on the campaign setting, and therefore this chapter are also parallel realities called planes.
must be necessarily vague about such things.
The normal world is often called the prime plane, since it is the
Developer Commentary only one which is infinite in size, and it is the plane on which all
Because of the restrictions of the open game license, the first edition others are anchored, directly or indirectly.
of Dark Dungeons was not able to emulate the setting of the game
it was based on, only the mechanics. However, I couldn’t simply not The other planes are split into two categories – inner planes and
provide a cosmology for the game because the presence of immortals outer planes.
demanded one (immortals interact with the cosmology on a regular
basis), so I had to provide my own. The inner planes are truly parallel to the prime plane, or at least to
the celestial sphere. Each inner plane is exactly the same size as the
Rather than come up with one from scratch, I decided to take inspi- sphere, and has a sun and planets in the exact same positions and
ration from the cosmology of a popular supplement for the second orbits as those in the prime plane sphere. There are five of these
edition of the original game instead - one with celestial spheres and inner planes – four elemental planes (fire, earth, air and water) and
magical flying ships. an ethereal plane. These planes have a one-to-one correspondence
with the prime plane in that every point on the prime plane has a
The cosmology presented in this chapter (and the accompanying corresponding point on each of the five inner planes. If you travel
skysailing rules) are based on that supplement, but adapted to fit from the prime plane to the elemental plane of water, then sail 20
the mechanics of this game. They are also designed to be modular in miles, and then travel back to the prime plane; you’ll end up 20
that you can drop the celestial spheres and space travel and still use miles from where you started.
the planar cosmology if it’s not to your taste and you can similarly
drop the skysailing if you don’t like having that in your game. Outer planes, on the other hand, are different. These planes are
created by immortals, and can be as varied as their creators’ whims
Dropping the planar cosmology is trickier because if you don’t have dictate.
an alternative to replace it with you’ll struggle to do high level and
immortal level play. One thing they have in common, however, is that each one has a
single point where it is “anchored” onto another plane (often the
prime plane, but theoretically any plane will do). The anchor point
is the only point with a fixed correspondence to the plane that it
Overview is anchored to. If you travel to an outer plane at the anchor point
The planet that adventurers live on is just that – a planet. It flies and then walk, fly or sail 20 miles, you simply won’t be able to
through the void as it orbits the sun. Like many planets, it’s basically travel back without either returning to the anchor point or using
a big rock surrounded by air and a bit of water. At least, that’s the magic such as a Gate spell.
assumption that these rules make. Individual game masters can set
campaigns on very different planets if they want to. And that is not all...

Of course, the adventurers do not live on the only planet out there. The celestial sphere itself can be penetrated with powerful magic.
Dark dungeons assumes that there are a few planets orbiting the Outside the sphere is a strange glowing substance, if substance is the
sun. This being a magical world and not our real world, some of right word, called the luminiferous aether. Sail or fly through this
these planets are almost always inhabitable (although not always for long enough and you’ll encounter other celestial spheres – each
inhabited). of which will contain its own unique set of planets and will have
its own inner and outer planes attached.
The whole solar system sits in the void – an empty nothingness
much like our real-world space – but the void does not stretch

221
Chapter 15 - Out of This World
However, all planes are attached to the prime plane inside celestial Example: The Game Master has decided that the campaign is
spheres. In the luminiferous aether there are no other planes. primarily set on a planet the size of earth – a spherical planet of
approximately 8,000 miles diameter. In theory, the gravity envelope
The rest of this chapter looks at these different locations and phe- of this planet would therefore also be spherical and stretch 8,000
nomena, how to survive in them, and how to travel to and through miles in every direction. However, gravity envelopes cannot be more
them. than 50 miles deep, so instead it spherical and stretches 50 miles
The Void in every direction.
The void is the empty space between worlds. As the name suggests, The party are travelling through the void in the black swan – a
it is completely empty, not even containing air. skiff that has been equipped with sails of skysailing. The black swan
is 45’ long, 15’ wide and 8’ tall. The gravity envelope of this ship is
Gravity therefore an area 135’ long, 45’ wide and 24’ tall. In theory, there
There is no gravity in the void away from large masses, so any is a thin bit of the envelope that sticks up in the middle where the
unsecured object will simply drift randomly. Because of the lack mast of the ship sticks up, but practically that can be ignored for
of air, creatures with wings will find it impossible to fly; although most purposes.
magical flight still works.

Any mass in the void, from the smallest pebble to the largest planet towards a point in the centre of the object. This means that it is
or sun will have its own gravity. However, unlike our world this possible to walk all round the sphere without falling off.
gravity does not always pull in the direction of the centre of the
mass and is not directly proportional to the mass of the mass(es) If the object responsible for the gravity field is roughly cylindrical,
involved. then throughout the gravity field gravity pulls towards the central
line of the cylinder. This means that it is possible to walk all around
Instead, the strength of the gravity around an object or group of the cylinder without falling off, but it is possible to fall off either
objects is always the same; the distance over which that gravity acts end of the cylinder. Anyone doing so would oscillate back and forth
is limited and based on the size of the object or group of objects; until they settled next to the end of the cylinder lined up with the
and the direction of the gravity is based on the shape of the object. mid-point. The gravity envelope would prevent them from “falling”
further, but there would be nothing to stop them drifting away in
Strength: The strength of gravity is always simply the normal a direction perpendicular to the cylinder’s end.
strength of gravity that is found on the real-world earth. Within the
gravity envelope of a planet, big or small, things fall just as expected. If the object responsible for the gravity envelope is roughly flat,
such as a ship, then throughout the gravity envelope gravity pulls
Distance: The distance away from an object to which its grav- towards a plane that cuts through the middle of the object. This
ity extends is based on the width of the object in the direction means that it is possible to walk around on the upper deck(s) of
in which the distance is being measured. That’s less complicated the ship without falling off, and it is also possible to walk around
than it sounds. Basically it means that the gravity envelope for an on the underneath of the ship’s hull without falling off. However,
object stretches as far above the object as the object is tall, as far to it is still possible to fall off the side of the ship, and someone doing
either side of the object as the object is wide, and as far in front of so would oscillate back and forth until they settled next to the side
and behind the object as the object is deep. The gravity envelope of the ship lined up with the mid plane of the ship. The gravity
is therefore the same shape as the object but three times the size envelope would prevent them from “falling” further, but there
(and 27 times the volume). would be nothing to stop them drifting either along or away from
the ship whilst staying on that same plane.
However, there is a limit to the size of the gravity envelope produced
by an object. The envelope will never be more than fifty miles deep In the case of large objects with unusual shapes, these may have
no matter how large the width of the object is. different gravity directions at the Game Master’s discretion. For
example a large hollow sphere might have gravity pointing towards
Direction: The direction of gravity within a gravity envelope is the middle of its thickness, meaning that the inside and outside
determined by the shape of the object that is responsible for the of the sphere can both be walked on; or a large doughnut shaped
envelope. Each gravity envelope will have a consistent direction of object might have gravity pointing to a ring through its centre, so
gravity throughout, and if the shape of the object responsible for that it can be walked around without falling off.
the envelope changes there may be a sudden flip from one gravity
direction to another. Different parts of the gravity envelope will If in doubt, use the direction of gravity that seems the most sensible
never have different directions. and convenient.

The three most common directions are point, plane and line gravity. In any case, when a small object enters the gravity envelope of a
larger object, the smaller object takes on the gravity envelope of
If the object responsible for the gravity field is roughly spherical, the larger object.
such as a planet, then throughout the gravity field gravity pulls

222
Chapter 15 - Out of This World
Example: The black swan, like most ships, is roughly flat; so its size of the object and many other factors; it is best abstracted by the
gravity points in the direction of its central plane. People can stand following (particularly for ships equipped with sails of skysailing):
on both its deck and the underneath of its hull without falling off.
For each ton of weight of the object, it’s air envelope will last one
When the ship approaches a planet in order to land, it will take person 120 days. Horses and large creatures use the same amount
on the gravity envelope of the planet. The safest way for Aloysius to of air as two people (or even more in the case of extremely large
manage this transition without everyone falling off is to manoeuvre creatures).
the ship so that its hull is facing the planet. That way gravity will
still be pointing “down” through the hull and people on the decks Example: The party travelling in the black swan consists of four
will not fall off. people. The ship weighs 5 tons (it’s a skiff), and can thus support 5
x 120 = 600 person-days. Therefore it will take 600 / 4 = 150 days
Air and Breathing for the air to become fouled and a further 150 days for the air to
The void itself contains no air of any kind. However, the objects become dead. The ship cannot safely travel for more than 300 days
within the void will normally be surrounded by an envelope of (with this crew) before landing on a planet to refresh its air supply.
air that clings to them because of their gravity envelope. The air
envelope is generally the same size as the gravity envelope.
The Create Air spell always maintains fresh air within its area of
Unfortunately for travellers, the air around a creature or object will effect for the duration of the spell, but once the duration runs out,
go “bad” and become unbreathable if it is not replenished regularly. the air returns to its former fouled or dead state.
Large planets don’t have this problem – partly because of the sheer
size of the air envelope around them and partly because they have A person under the effects of a Survival spell does not suffer the
whole ecosystems constantly replenishing the air. effects of foul or dead air for the duration of the spell.

Air quality is divided into three levels of quality: fresh, fouled, and Movement & Travel
dead. Getting to the void is easy. It can be done by simply flying up for
long enough to reach the edge of the planet’s air & gravity envelope.
◊ Fresh Air: fresh air is healthy and normal. Creatures can survive
and operate in it without problem. However, assuming that the campaign is set on an earth sized planet,
this envelope will be 50 miles deep; so while creatures flying under
◊ Foul Air: foul air is unhealthy, humid and smells bad. Creatures their own power may be able to fly that distance they are unlikely
can survive in it, but will often be short of breath and take a –2 to fly that high by accident.
penalty to all actions that require rolls.
Ships equipped with sails of skysailing can easily fly such distances.
◊ Dead Air: dead air can no longer support creatures at all. Crea- However, they cannot necessarily fly at full cruising speed since
tures trapped in dead air will suffocate to the point of uncon- they are fighting gravity all the way. It takes a ship a full hour to
sciousness over the course of 2d6 rounds and then die in an- reach the edge of the gravity envelope regardless of the effective
other 1d4 minutes. Before unconsciousness sets in, creatures in level of the pilot.
dead air take a –4 penalty to all actions that require rolls.
While doing such a take-off or landing, the ship can do other navi-
A character who is about to knowingly enter an area of dead air can gation at the same time. It can travel around the planet at normal
hold their breath for a number of rounds equal to their constitution cruising speed while ascending or descending.
before symptoms start.
Once outside of a gravity envelope, any form of magical flight will
The exact time it takes for a creature to foul its own air envelope work as normal, although winged flight will not unless the crea-
to the point where it drops a level in quality (if drifting in the ture’s description specifically says that it can fly through the void.
void) depends on a multitude of factors and variables; and is best Winged creatures that do fly high enough to reach the edge of the
abstracted to a roll of 2d10x10 minutes. Larger creatures take gravity and air envelopes will be able to feel that they have reached
more air with them, but also use more air; so the result is the same. the edge and non-intelligent ones will instinctively go no higher.

Undead, constructs, golems, and immortals (unless they in mortal Once in the void, the main difficulty with travelling through it is
form) do not foul the air that they carry around, since they do that the distances are so immense. The distance from one planet
not need to breathe, and they also take no penalties for being in to another may be anywhere from 36 million miles to 3.5 billion
fouled or dead air. miles or more; and the radius of a celestial sphere can be up to 7
billion miles. Getting from planet to planet is therefore only pos-
In the case of people on a rock or on a ship, the object that they sible with magic designed for that purpose. Normal magical flying
are on will provide a much bigger air envelope, so it will last much effects or items are far too slow to even attempt the journey. Even a
longer before becoming foul. Although the amount of air in the en- simple trip to a planet’s moon is likely to be at least 200,000 miles.
velope would be most accurately determined by the exact shape and

223
Chapter 15 - Out of This World
Ships equipped with sails of skysailing are one of the few commonly In either case, the radius of the sphere will always be at least twice
found magical effects designed for such long distance travel. the radius at which the outermost planet orbits.

The speeds listed for such ships in Chapter 12 – Into the Wider Example: If the campaign was set on a planet like earth (third
World are the speeds within a gravity envelope. Once a skysailing planet of nine from the sun, if we include pluto), the radius of the ce-
ship has escaped the gravity envelopes of nearby planets and is in lestial sphere should be at least twice the radius at which pluto orbits.
the open void, it can accelerate to voidspeed. Unlike the speeds
achieved in atmosphere, voidspeed is not dependent on the effec- Pluto orbits at a radius of 3.6 billion miles from the sun, so there-
tive level of the pilot of the ship. It is fixed at 100 million miles per fore the sphere would have a radius of at least 7.2 billion miles. At
standard 8-hour travel day. As with air travel, the pilot of the ship standard voidspeed, it would take a ship 72 days to reach the edge
can do a “double shift” if the need arises. See Chapter 12 – Into on average.
the Wider World for more details.
Obviously, if you wanted travel to the edge of the celestial sphere to
This immense voidspeed can only be maintained in a straight line. be quicker and easier, you would place fewer planets in your setting
Any need to manoeuvre will cause the ship to drop to normal air or put them closer together.
speed. Similarly, entering the gravity envelope of another object
will cause the ship to drop to normal air speed. Dotted around the sphere are glowing points of light that can be
seen as stars from the various planets in the sphere. These are a
No encounters are normally had in the void, since the distances and part of the sphere, and cannot be moved or damaged in any way.
speeds involved are so huge that the odds of two ships actually com- However, they are useful for navigation, and provide a dim light
ing close enough to even detect each other are astronomically low. in the absence of a sun.

When travelling from planet to planet, it is not necessary to cal- Astronomical Bodies
culate the exact orbits of each planet in order to find out the exact The astronomical bodies – planets and sun(s) – in the sphere can
distance between them. Instead, simply use a standard “average” be loosely categorised into four types, corresponding to the four
distance between each planet. states of matter:

Example: Aloysius is piloting the black swan home after visiting Gaseous Body: A gaseous body is a gas planet. The body of the
another planet. The two planets are the same distance apart as the planet is made of air or some similar gas, and it is not usually pos-
earth and mars – about 50 million miles. sible to tell where the air envelope stops and the planet itself starts.
A gaseous body may have a small core at the centre, composed
Aloysius flies the black swan straight towards home at voidspeed, of debris that has accumulated there, but generally it is entirely
and arrives at the edge of the gravity envelope (50 miles above the composed of air. A gaseous planet usually has extremely violent
surface) in 4 hours. He then manoeuvres the ship so that its hull weather patterns.
is facing the planet, and lowers it into the atmosphere. The time
taken to descend through atmosphere is always 1 hour, so it takes a Solid Body: A solid body is a solid planet like our own earth. It
further hour to bring the black swan down to within a few hundred will be primarily composed of rock, and have a normal atmosphere.
feet of the ground. Dark dungeons assumes that the campaign is set on a solid body.

While descending, Aloysius checks on his maps to see whereabouts Radiating Body: A radiating body is a sun. There is usually one
on the planet he is, and then sets off at cruising speed to get to the per sphere, and it is often in the centre. A sun provides light for
skyport of his choice. When he has both arrived and finished descend- the whole sphere; without a sun the sphere is dark and lit only by
ing (whichever takes longer) he will switch to manoeuvring speed the stars. However, a sun is not necessary to provide heat in the
in order to land carefully. void. A sphere without a sun will be cold enough to freeze water,
but will still be warm enough to survive in.

The Celestial Sphere If the gravity and air envelope of a radiating body is entered, treat
Although incredibly huge, the void is not endless. It is bounded by it as if on the elemental plane of fire, with the exception that there
a shell of crystalline material called the celestial sphere. is no ground. The planet is usually fire all the way to the centre,
since any debris that would accumulate there will typically burn up.
The sphere is impervious to any physical or magical damage, even
from immortals. Liquid Body: A liquid planet is basically a large blob of water or
a similar liquid, forming a planet that is entirely sea. It may have
Assuming your campaign world is not terribly unusual, the sphere a small core made of debris, and may also have small islands of
will contain either a sun in the centre with a number of planets floating debris, possibly even with settlers or refugees living on
orbiting it, or a central planet that is orbited by a sun and one or them. The atmosphere of a water planet is normal.
more other moons and planets.

224
Chapter 15 - Out of This World
In a sphere without a sun, a liquid planet will be a frozen ball of Example: Black Leaf is scouting well ahead of the rest of the party
ice and snow rather than liquid water. when she triggers a trap. The door to the room she is in slams shut
The Inner Planes and spikes protrude from the ceiling, which then starts inexorably
lowering.
Inside the celestial sphere, there is not just the mundane world
(known as the prime plane). There are also parallel worlds that take After failing to pick the lock on the door, Black Leaf decides that it’s
up the same space as the mundane world. Such parallel worlds are too risky to wait and see if the rest of the party can rescue her, and she
called planes, and the five that always take up the same space as drinks a potion of ethereality that she has been saving for emergencies.
the inside of a sphere are referred to as the inner planes. Each of
them is finite in size and surrounded by the same crystalline sphere. Black Leaf enters the ethereal plane, and finds herself in what appears
to be the same room with the same descending spiked ceiling, except
There is an exact mapping between the inner planes and the prime that everything is made out of ectoplasm. The ectoplasmic ceiling
plane, in that each inner plane has its own copies of the astronomi- continues to descend, following the descent of the real ceiling on the
cal bodies contained in the prime plane, and these bodies contain prime plane, but Black Leaf simply pushes through it unharmed.
the same rough geographical features (mountain ranges, seas, etc.)
as those on the prime plane. However, artificial structures and Satisfied that she has escaped danger, she wades slowly through the
vegetation will not be mirrored. ectoplasm back to the door. The real door is still locked, but once
again she can push through the ectoplasmic copy of it and emerge
The correspondence between the planes extends to movement as back outside in the corridor.
well. If someone travels from the prime plane to the ethereal plane,
travels north for a mile, and then returns to the prime plane; they Black Leaf then returns to the prime plane, and appears unharmed
will arrive one mile north of their starting position. in the corridor outside the room. To any observers who can’t see
The Ethereal Plane invisible creatures, she would have apparently disappeared when
drinking the potion and then reappeared outside a minute or so later.
The ethereal plane is the plane most often visited by adventurers. It
directly touches the prime plane at all points, which makes travel Creatures who could see invisible would have been able to see her
relatively easy (for example an adventurer under the influence of shadowy form as she moved around on the ethereal plane.
a Travel spell can move between the ethereal and prime planes at
any location).
Air and Breathing
Everything on the ethereal plane is made from ether, which is a Although there is no actual air or water on the ethereal plane, both
kind of sticky grey ectoplasm that looks like dense smoke and feels air and water breathers alike can breathe the etheric ectoplasm
cold and clammy to the touch. Ether can only exist on the ethereal with no ill effect.
plane. If it is brought off that plane onto any other plane it simply
evaporates and vanishes leaving no trace. Movement & Travel
Getting to the ethereal plane usually requires a Travel spell (the
The ethereal plane is constantly lit by a dim light, although visibility ethereal plane is adjacent to the prime plane) or a Gate spell. How-
is equivalent to shadowy torchlight. There are no actual shadows, ever, there are certain magic items that provide a specialised form
since the light penetrates the entire plane, but any ability that re- of the Travel spell that allows access to the ethereal plane but no
quires shadows to work will work in the dimly lit ethereal. There other planes.
is no colour in the ethereal plane as the ether is all grey; although
denser ether is more whitish. The only colours that can be seen are Movement in the ethereal plane is tricky at best, since even the
on objects or creatures that have entered the ethereal plane from most solid “ground” still gives. Walking is possible, but can only be
other planes. This often makes such creatures and objects stand done at half speed, since walking on the soft ether is like trudging
out vividly despite the low light. through loose sand.

While all the inner planes touch the prime plane, the ethereal plane However, this softness does have its advantages. It is possible for a
actually overlaps to some extent. The ether is attracted to matter on solid being visiting the ethereal plane to push through the ethereal
the prime plane, and becomes more dense in the ethereal equivalent representations of solid prime plane objects. Pushing through dense
of the location, being least dense where there is void on the prime ether in this way reduces movement speed to one quarter of normal.
plane and most dense where there is metal.
Flying (both winged and magical) can be done in the ether at nor-
Because of this effect, it is possible to “see” the shapes of things mal rates through the less dense ether that corresponds to prime
that are on the prime plane from the ethereal plane by seeing the plain water air or void, and can be done at half speed through the
patches of dense ether that correspond to them. denser ether that corresponds to solid prime plane matter.

A second consequence of the overlap between the prime plane


and the ethereal plane is that creatures able to see invisible things

225
Chapter 15 - Out of This World
(whether through an innate ability or through a Detect Invisible noses with scarves or wraps to avoid choking. Even without choking
spell) can see creatures or objects on the ethereal plane. on the dust, it still cannot be breathed, so travellers need to either
be able to go without air or to have some means of creating air.
The Elemental Planes
In addition to the ethereal plane, there are four elemental planes The seas on the elemental plane of earth are composed of a fine
touching the prime plane within the celestial sphere. These are the silty sand that behaves much like a liquid. Needless to say, it is just
elemental planes of air, earth, fire and water. as inhospitable to air (and water) breathers as the atmosphere is.

As with the ethereal plane, there is a direct mapping between all The sun and other large natural fire sources are composed of shin-
points on each of these planes and the corresponding points on ing crystals, which – although they glow brightly – do not give
the prime plane. out appreciable heat.

Each elemental plane contains void just like the prime plane, and The biggest problem for travellers to the elemental plane of earth
contains copies of the same astronomical bodies as the prime plane. is breathing. Other than that, the plane is relatively safe to explore.
However, unlike the prime plane versions of these bodies, all matter
in an elemental plane is composed of only a single element, in dif- Fire: The elemental plane of fire is naturally extremely hot. The
ferent states that simulate the other elements as far as possible. In all ground is made from red hot glowing coals and ash, and the seas
cases however, the elemental version of the void is still simply void. are made of runny lava with swirls of molten metal through it. The
lava is soft enough to swim in (assuming you can take the heat)
Each of these elemental versions of the astronomical bodies has but neither air nor water breathers can breathe it.
the same basic geographic features (mountains, rivers, seas and
so on) as the equivalent prime body; but vegetation and artificial The atmosphere of the elemental plane of fire is comprised entirely
structures are not represented. of flame. Although the flame will scorch the lungs of any who try
to breathe it, those who are protected from the heat find that it is
Example: Elfstar is standing by her house, which is by a stream in actually breathable by air breathers.
a forest clearing. She casts a Survival spell followed by a Travel spell
and moves to the elemental plane of water. The sun and other large natural fire sources are, of course, simply
white hot fire.
When she arrives, she is standing on ice rather than soil, and neither
the house nor the trees are there. At first glance, the elemental plane of fire appears to be the least
hospitable of the elemental planes. However, once the problem
The stream is still there, however, and through the water vapour that of heat is overcome by some kind of magical protection, it is not
makes up the sky Elfstar can see a brightly shining white sun that too bad. The atmosphere can be breathed, and the ground is solid.
appears to be made of steam.
Water: On the elemental plane of water, the ground is primarily
made of ice and snow. Seas and rivers are made of clear fresh water.
The elemental equivalents of the other elements are as follows:
The atmosphere in the elemental plane of water is comprised of
Air: The ground is made from soft but solid clouds, which halve pure water vapour, and air breathing creatures who try to breathe
the movement rates of any land based creature. However, these it will drown. Water breathers can breathe it with no difficulty.
clouds are solid enough that they can’t simply be pushed through.
The sun and other large natural fire sources are made from glowing
The atmosphere is clear air, and bodies of water are made from a clouds of steam. These steam clouds are warm to the touch, but
smoky vapour that settles in depressions like liquid. The “liquid nowhere near as hot as real fire.
air” is viscous like water, and will support swimming creatures – al-
though it can be breathed by air breathing creatures (but not water Providing travellers can breathe water, and wrap up well to survive
breathing creatures) without drowning. the cold, the elemental plane of water is a fairly safe place to explore;
although the constant moisture can make travellers feel incredibly
The sun and other large natural fire sources are made from balls uncomfortable after a while.
of lightning.
Air and Breathing
The soft nature of the ground and the fact that air breathing crea- On the elemental plane of air, breathing can be done normally,
tures cannot drown in the seas and rivers actually makes the el- even in the smoky vapour that passes for liquid in the plane’s seas.
emental plane of air a fairly safe place.
Breathing on the elemental plane of earth requires both a Create
Earth: The ground is, naturally, normal earth and rock. The at- Air spell or the equivalent and also blocking of the nose and mouth
mosphere is made entirely of floating dust motes, which force most with cloth to prevent choking on the dust.
travellers from the prime plane to have to cover their mouths and

226
Chapter 15 - Out of This World
Example: The Game Master has decided that the celestial sphere Unlike the elemental planes which mirror the structure of the
in which the campaign is set contains a sun (radiating body), two prime plane, each outer plane has been deliberately created by
normal “earth-like” worlds (solid bodies), a water world (liquid one or more immortals for a reason, and therefore there is no fixed
body) and three gas giant planets (gaseous bodies). structure to them.

The corresponding elemental plane of air contains the same seven Having said that, most outer planes have the same sorts of matter
astronomical bodies, except that the sun is made of lightning; the and rules of gravity and so on as the prime plane. Even immortals
earth-like worlds are made of solid clouds (with atmospheres and find comfort in familiarity, after all.
seas); the water world is made of vaporous smoke (also with an
atmosphere); and the gas giants are basically big blobs of air. The outer planes do not map exactly to the prime plane. Instead,
there is a single location (with a radius of about 100’ or so) on each
On the elemental plane of fire, the same bodies also exist. This time outer plane which is its anchor point. This anchor point maps to
the sun is much like the prime plane’s sun; the earth-like worlds a similar sized region on another plane – which can be any other
are large balls of cinder and coals surrounded with an atmosphere plane; prime, inner or outer.
made of flames; the water world is made of lava and molten metals
and has a similar flaming atmosphere; and the gas giants are simply Within that region, Travel spells will work between the outer plane
large balls of fire. and the plane that it is attached to, and the usual behaviour of
mapped planes is exhibited (i.e. Travelling from the base plane to
the attached outer plane, walking 50’ to the left, and then returning
Trying to breathe in the elemental plane of fire requires a Resist to the base plane will bring you to 50’ left of where you started).
Fire spell or the equivalent in order to prevent taking 2d6 damage
per round from the heat. Outside of that region, however, Travel spells will not work, and
the only way to move to other planes is via a Gate or the equivalent.
Providing that protection is in place, the fiery atmosphere of the
plane can be breathed without problem. Since outer planes can be anchored onto other outer planes, it is
possible for a whole “tree” of outer planes to end up being attached
Breathing in the elemental plane of water requires either a Water to the prime plane in a given location.
Breathing or Create Air spell or the equivalent. However, either
of those spells will allow breathing both in the water vapour that Example: After becoming immortals, five characters work together
makes up the atmosphere and also the seas and rivers of the plane. to create a single plane and anchor it to the prime plane. Each of
them then also moves their home plane so that it is anchored to their
Movement & Travel shared plane. Finally, one of the immortals wishes to experiment with
All four of the elemental planes touch the prime plane at all points, creating new types of undead so she creates another plane in which
so a Travel spell can take you from the prime to any one of the she can perform her experiments and anchors it to her home plane.
four or vice versa.
If someone wanted to travel from the prime plane to the plane where
Because of the direct mapping between the planes, travelling to one the experiment is being conducted using a Travel spell, they would
of them and walking a mile north before returning will return you have to first locate the anchor point of the shared plane and then
to the prime plane one mile north of where you left. cross over onto that plane. From there, they would have to explore
that shared plane until they find the anchor point of the immortal’s
Travelling to the elemental planes while underground is emphati- home plane, and cross over once again. Finally they would have
cally not recommended, since whatever tunnels have been dug on to explore the immortal’s home plane until they found the anchor
the prime plane are highly unlikely to have also been dug on the point of the plane where the experiment is being conducted and
elemental planes, and the unwary traveller is likely to appear in cross over a third time.
solid rock (or the equivalent) and be instantly killed.
If it were one of the other immortals trying to get to the plane from
Once on the elemental planes, movement and travel is usually no their own home, they wouldn’t be able to travel directly there either.
different to travelling on the prime plane. The only exception being They too would have to go to the anchor point of their home plane
that land movement is slowed to half normal rates on the elemental and cross over to the shared plane, then find and cross the other two
plane of air due to the soft nature of the ground. anchor points from there.

The Outer Planes


Outer planes, sometimes referred to as demi-planes, are small planes
that sit outside the normal prime-ethereal-elemental plane structure. Much as some immortals may like to hide away, all outer planes
must have an anchor point connecting them to an existing plane,
Each outer plane is unique, although they can be no bigger than the and “circular” anchors are not possible (i.e. It is not possible to
size of a large planet plus atmosphere, and most are much smaller, anchor plane a to a location on plane b, then anchor plane b to a
down to the size of a large house or inn. location on plane c, then anchor plane c to a location on plane a).

227
Chapter 15 - Out of This World
All outer planes must be anchored – directly or indirectly – to the Since the inner planes are attached within each celestial sphere,
prime plane or one of the inner planes. they do not extend out into the luminiferous aether and cannot
be reached from there.
Needless to say, most anchor points are well guarded on one side
or the other, and traffic at those points is either forbidden or moni- Similarly, no outer plane can be anchored in the luminiferous aether
tored carefully. and no Gate spell will reach it.

However, there are many outer planes that have been abandoned Commune and contact other plane spells cannot be used in the lu-
or simply forgotten. Such forgotten planes may well be unguarded, miniferous aether, and those spells will not contact creatures who
but the things they contain may be dangerous in their own right. are there when cast from within celestial spheres.

Since travelling from adjacent plane to adjacent plane can be time Air & Breathing
consuming and difficult, it is common for an immortal to create Breathing within the luminiferous aether is not possible except for
a permanent Gate between planes that they travel between often. within the air envelope of an object; much as in the void. Similarly,
Gate spells can link any two planes for one-way or two-way travel- the rules for foul air apply.
ling.
However, any living creature that runs out of air in the luminifer-
The planes don’t have to be adjacent to one another; they can even ous aether does not suffocate. Instead, the luminiferous aether itself
be anchored to two different celestial spheres. However, Gate spells supports them in some strange way. The creature loses conscious-
still go from only a single fixed point on one plane to a single ness and turns to a stone like substance. The creature remains that
fixed point on the other plane. This can be either an advantage or way until they are in an area with breathable air, at which point
a disadvantage, since it is even easier to defend a Gate than it is to they return to normal.
defend an anchor point.
This effect only happens to living creatures. Dead bodies, and un-
Luminiferous Aether dead creatures (as well as non-breathing things like golems) are
The celestial sphere is not the entire universe. Beyond the sphere’s unaffected.
edge lies an expanse of a glowing swirling substance called luminif-
erous aether. The luminiferous aether is also incredibly flammable. Any spark will
immediately burst into a 1’ radius ball of fire doing 1d6 damage. If
The luminiferous aether is chaotic mix of raw elemental matter this catches other items alight, then take the normal damage done
and ether. It has no actual density or substance to it, and perme- by such an object when burning and do three times the damage
ates everything outside the celestial sphere. However, it can only in an area three times the size of the object. For magical fires like
exist outside of a celestial sphere. If a ship with sails of skysailing a Fireball spell, use a similar guideline – although such spells will
goes through the sphere and into the aether, it will take its air and always explode around the caster as they are cast, rather than going
gravity envelopes with it; but the air – while breathable – will off once they reach the desired target point.
be mixed with luminiferous aether. If the ship then re-enters the
celestial sphere, it will bring its air envelope with it but leave the Strangely, the luminiferous aether has the same inhibiting effect on
luminiferous aether outside the sphere. red powder as large quantities of red powder has on itself. While in
the luminiferous aether, red powder simply will not burn or explode.
Sages and philosophers – after discussion with immortals capable
of creating entire celestial spheres – have concluded that when a Movement & Travel
celestial sphere is created the inside of the celestial sphere becomes Getting to the luminiferous aether is relatively straightforward. It
a region of order where the luminiferous aether cannot exist in its can be reached from any celestial sphere by simply flying to the
raw chaotic state. Instead, within the confines of the sphere, the edge of the sphere and then opening it in some manner.
luminiferous aether is split into its constituent parts – the four ele-
ments plus ether – and these parts are sorted into their own planes A Travel spell will open a temporary hole in the crystal of the sphere
leaving the inside of the celestial sphere full of void. wall that will last long enough to fly a ship through; or for creatures
travelling without a ship, a Dimension Door or Magic Door spell
Whether this is true or not, luminiferous aether does have prop- will allow passage through the crystal of the sphere wall.
erties similar to each of the four elements, and it is true that lu-
miniferous aether can never be brought into a celestial sphere. It Once in the luminiferous aether, travel is handled in a similar man-
simply ceases to exist. ner to in the void. Creatures cannot fly using winged flight, but all
forms of magical flight work as normal.
The luminiferous aether may be infinite in size. At least, no-one has
ever reached any kind of edge to it. It is dotted with innumerable However, the problem of distances is even more pronounced in
celestial spheres, each of which has its own set of astronomical the luminiferous aether than in the void. In fact, because of the
bodies and its own set of inner and outer planes. immense distances involved, the lack of landmarks, and the fact
that the celestial spheres drift around and do not stay static, dis-

228
Chapter 15 - Out of This World
tance is a largely meaningless concept for anything other than Unfortunately, the rivers twist and bend over a period of time;
short range flight. so while it is possible to map out which spheres are connected to
which other spheres (and whether such connections are single or
For long range travel, simply striking out in a random direction is bi-directional), it is not possible to map any kind of meaningful
completely pointless. It may take years or even centuries of travel length or distance for a river, since this will change over time (and
to find another celestial sphere. by how well the navigator manages to keep to the centre of the
river where the flow is strongest).
However, the celestial spheres are naturally tied together by “rivers”
of flowing luminiferous aether that wind through three dimensional The time taken to travel along a river is therefore wildly unpre-
paths. These rivers are huge things, around a thousand miles across, dictable. It will take 10d10 days to travel the length of a river at
and always both start and end at particular spheres. voidspeed in the direction of its flow, although that may include
one or more stops when another gravity mass is encountered such
They may flow in a single direction or flow in both directions with as a particularly large piece of flotsam or another ship.
the two flows twisting around each other.
Travelling against the flow is difficult but not impossible, provid-
By travelling along a river, a ship flying at voidspeed can both know ing one sticks to the outer edge of the river where the flow is least
that it is travelling towards another sphere and also take advantage strong. Travelling against the flow in this manner makes a journey
of the river’s flow to get there quicker. from sphere to sphere take five times the normal duration.

As far as anyone knows, there are no “orphan” spheres with no rivers The Game Master is encouraged to create a “sphere map” for the
flowing to them, and there are no “dead end” spheres with rivers region of space around the world on which their campaign starts,
flowing towards them but not away from them. showing what spheres exist, and how they are connected.

The rivers also have a secondary advantage – the flow of the river No-one knows how many spheres there are in total. There even be
will attract debris that would otherwise simply drift randomly. This an infinite number of them. Some immortals have spent centuries
is particularly the case for debris and objects that are lost from a exploring and have never managed to run out of new things to find
ship that is travelling the river, and means that on well-travelled and new places to see.
rivers a lost object has a much greater chance of being found than
if it were simply drifting through the vast sea of luminiferous aether.

229
Chapter 16 - Questing for Immortality
T
he ultimate goal of many characters is to reach the lofty
heights of immortality. Immortality doesn’t just mean not dy- What Is an Immortal?
ing – although immortals are incredibly resilient – it actually On the one hand, immortals are powerful spiritual beings that can
means transcending flesh and transforming into a purely spiritual create entire planes and species and move planets around.
being of great power.
On the other hand, immortals are simply people.
Since immortals are so different from mortal characters, and so
much more powerful, an immortal level campaign will be very For all their great power, immortals still have the desires, goals and
different in tone from a mortal level one. Most immortals don’t personalities that they had when they were mortal. Dark dungeons
simply go out and kill monsters; and they certainly don’t hoard assumes that all immortals are in fact former mortals, although
and spend treasure like mortal adventurers do. Instead, immortal since it is normally only possible to become an immortal by being
level campaigns tend to centre on political rivalries, machinations, sponsored by an existing immortal, this raises the question of where
and plotting. the first immortal(s) came from.

The Game Master and players should take this difference into ac- It is up to the Game Master to decide what the answer to that
count when deciding whether or not to continue a campaign into question is in their campaign. Maybe the first immortals were
the immortal levels. Many players may simply prefer to have their created by true gods (if they exist in the setting). Maybe the first
characters retire and die peacefully as mortals – or maybe use the immortals simply spontaneously appeared. Maybe the first mortals
gaining of immortality as the campaign finale rather than continue were able to become immortals even without sponsors. Or maybe
to play their characters once immortality is reached. it was something completely different.

Whether you decide to include the immortal levels in your cam- Given that immortals are former mortals who have been given
paign or not, it should be the result of a conscious decision; not great power, what they do with that power (and what they do with
the result of a “lucky” (or unlucky) die roll. their endless time – since immortals no longer age) is as varied as
mortality itself.
Suddenly finding yourself in an immortal level campaign that you
weren’t prepared for can be bewildering to both the players and the Some explore the universe. Some look after the mortals and pro-
Game Master and is likely to kill the campaign if not prepared for. tect them. Others play with mortals to amuse themselves, or play
Similarly, being all geared up for an immortal level campaign and decadent political games with one another. Others are easily cor-
then discovering that one or more of the PCs doesn’t make the rupted by the power and enjoy spoiling the plans of their peers
transition because their players rolled badly is equally unsatisfying. and making life hard for mortals.

The personalities of immortals are as varied as those of mortals; and


Developer Commentary
even though they have great power, they do not necessarily have
The original game that Dark Dungeons emulates was first released as
the wisdom that comes with great age. Some may well be as dumb
a set of five boxed sets, the last of which covered immortals, and then
as a bag of rocks, despite their power.
later released as a single book with a separate immortals supplement.

The immortals rules from both those releases were rather different
The Three Forms
The natural form of an immortal is an intangible glowing ball
from each other. Although they shared come common elements, there
of light 2’ in diameter. This is referred to as the immortal’s spirit
were significant differences in detail that had a large impact on
form. This spirit form has no material needs, and can live forever.
how immortals work in play - particularly when it comes to their
It is also incredibly difficult to harm, being immune to anything
vulnerabilities and how they can be killed.
a mortal opponent would be able to throw at it; although it is not
entirely indestructible to the determined efforts of other immortal
The first version of Dark Dungeons had immortals rules that closely
level beings.
emulated the latter of the two releases of the original game. This
version has rules that are more of a blend between the two differ-
However, this spirit form is able to affect the world in an extremely
ent sets of the original rules, taking inspiration from both sets and
limited manner. Because of this, immortals create physical bod-
blending them together.
ies called vessels and inhabit those as an avatar. An immortal can
inhabit multiple avatars at once and these avatars may be either
The other big difference between this version of Dark Dungeons and
made of flesh and blood (usually referred to as a “mortal form”) or
the first version is that this version uses avatars as a standard rule.
made of pure immortal power (usually referred to as an “embodied
Both releases of the original game had avatars as an optional rule,
form”). Both types have their own advantages and disadvantages,
but the first Dark Dungeons didn’t include it. This version includes
and are discussed in more detail in Chapter 17 – Immortals.
it by default, although if you think it overcomplicates things it’s easy
to house-rule that an immortal can only have one avatar at a time.
When inhabiting one or more avatars as either a mortal form or
embodied form, an immortal is capable of far more than when they

231
Chapter 16 - Questing for Immortality
are in their spirit form alone; but the fact that these avatars are Appearing in an embodied form avatar and blasting the armies of
physical is a double-edged sword. On the one hand, it means that their worshippers’ enemies), in most campaign settings there will
they can interact with the world in a physical manner, but on the be large groups of immortals who “police” the prime plane (or at
other hand it also means that they are also subject to physical harm. least a particular celestial sphere) to prevent this. Experience shows
time and again that unrestricted shows of immortal power on the
Although sturdy, the physical forms of an immortal can be damaged prime plane all too quickly lead to tit-for-tat wars and wholesale
or even destroyed. This does not harm the immortal but it does in- destruction of entire planets.
convenience them, since if an avatar is destroyed the vessel of which
it a physical manifestation is also destroyed the immortal can no For this reason, most immortals restrict their work on the prime
longer use it and must expend more of its power create a new one. plane to a series of churches, mortal forms and agents. Immortals
therefore often show a large interest in high level adventuring par-
See Chapter 17 – Immortals for more details on the exact abilities ties, since they make useful agents – willing to risk great danger if
of the three immortal forms. the prize of potential immortality is dangled in front of them, and
able to do things on the prime plane that the immortal cannot do
Becoming an Immortal themselves because it would be too blatant.
Becoming an immortal is deceptively straightforward. All a char-
acter needs to do is to find an immortal who is willing to sponsor Of course, while some immortals may be very open and business-
them and to create them their first embodied vessel. Their sponsor like about a “work for me and I’ll make you an immortal too” deal,
casts the Grant Immortality spell on them and zap! They’re now others couch it in terms of sending the mortals on “quests” or
an immortal. “tests” in order to determine their “worthiness” to join the ranks
of the immortals.
Of course, it isn’t really that easy.
These quests are not all theatrics, however. They serve three im-
Firstly, only the strongest of life-forces can become an immortal. portant purposes. Firstly, they test the candidate’s commitment to
A character needs to have at least 3,000,000 experience points to joining immortal society. Secondly, they confirm that the candidate
do this. is indeed strong enough to survive the transition. And thirdly, they
give the sponsor a chance to get to know the candidate and see them
If the character doesn’t have at least 3,000,000 experience points, in action. Immortality is a long time to spend with someone who
then they simply can’t be made into an immortal. Their life force you don’t get on with, and just because the candidate is capable of
is just not robust enough to survive the transition. becoming an immortal doesn’t mean the sponsor will necessarily
want to spend the next few millennia with them.
Secondly, the Grant Immortality spell takes energy  –  and life
force – to cast, and the sponsoring immortal must pay this. It costs Of course, the candidate isn’t necessarily going to be told all this.
the sponsoring immortal 1,000,000 experience points to cast the Usually they’re led to believe that the quests are an integral part of
spell on the prospective new immortal and transform them into the process of becoming immortal, because that’s a good motivator.
an immortal spirit form capable of inhabiting an avatar.
Once the sponsor is satisfied that the candidate is ready for immor-
Of course, no immortal is going to spend such a large amount of tality, they take the candidate to the outer plane that will serve as
their own experience points on a whim. their home plane (usually one that the sponsor has just created) and
actually make the transition. The location of the plane is normally
So although becoming an immortal is a very straightforward pro- near that of the sponsor’s own home plane, but once the new im-
cess, getting strong enough to be able to go through the process mortal is established they will be able to move it should they desire.
and finding an immortal willing to significantly weaken themselves
in order to take you through the process are not so straightforward.
Example: Having reached 3,0000,000 experience, Elfstar is now
The reasons why an immortal may be willing to sacrifice some powerful enough to become an immortal.
of their own life force to create another like themselves can be
varied. Some may do it for companionship or even love. Others Diana, the immortal who Elfstar serves, visits her in a dream. She
may help their own descendants become immortal out of a sense tells Elfstar that she has been a loyal servant and that now she is ready
of familial duty. to be rewarded with the real power of being an immortal. However,
because Elfstar is such a prominent member of her church, she can’t
Others have more prosaic reasons. They do it to gain immortal afford to lose her talents straight away.
allies, or as a significant reward for mortals who have served their
interests well. Diana tells Elfstar that in order to be given her reward, she must
first train up a successor to carry on her good work.
In the case of adventuring parties, this last reason is probably the
most common. Although there is nothing to physically prevent
immortals from acting in a blatant manner on the prime plane (e.g.

232
Chapter 16 - Questing for Immortality
The transition itself is fairly unremarkable and anticlimactic. Basi- (house sized) outer plane anchored on their own home plane for
cally, the sponsor gifts the candidate with some of their immortal the new immortal and give them their immortality there.
life force, and this destroys the candidate’s body utterly, leaving
them as an immortal in spirit form. As part of the donation of Creating such a tiny plane with the alter reality spell (see Chap-
power, the sponsor also creates the new immortal’s first exalted ter 17 – Immortals for details) costs only 200,000xp.
vessel. Unlike future exalted vessels that the new immortal might
later create for themselves, which can have the appearance and That way, the new immortal can, once they are more experienced,
powers of their choice, this first exalted form is moulded by the expand and/or alter their home plane or move it to a new location
transitioning immortal’s subconscious. Its appearance and abilities of their choosing.
will conform to their idealised self-image.
An immortal’s home plane is their seat of power. When on their
The whole process, significant and life changing though it is, actu- home plane an immortal is treated as if five levels higher than their
ally only takes a few seconds from start to finish. Sometimes it’s actual level for all purposes other than power reserve.
done with great pomp and circumstance as the culmination of an
elaborate ceremony, and sometimes it’s done in a straightforward Example: Elfstar has trained up her replacement and is in the
manner and followed by a party. It all depends on the personalities process of investing her with her new role when Diana, not wanting
of the candidate and sponsor. to miss the chance to impress her followers, appears in her embodied
form as the investiture rite is finishing.
Worshippers
There is another wrinkle in becoming an immortal – and it is one Normally an immortal simply showing up on the prime plane in
that existing immortals don’t like to talk about. Immortals cannot embodied form would alarm the other immortals who are watching
exist without the worship of free-willed mortals. No-one knows the prime plane for direct interference, but Diana has informed
exactly why this is, but an immortal that goes for over a year with- them in advance that she is going to appear to her worshippers in
out worshippers dies. This is why even in campaigns that have this way so while they keep watch, they don’t interfere.
pantheons of gods, immortals still act as their intercessors. They
need the worship of their god’s followers. Diana blesses Elfstar’s replacement and then wanders through the
assembled crowd of worshippers dispensing healing and advice.
The actual number of worshippers doesn’t matter; even having a
single one is good enough (although most immortals naturally try Finally, she takes Elfstar by the hand and returns with her to her
to have as many worshippers as possible for safety’s sake). home plane leaving no doubt in the minds of her worshippers that
Elfstar has been invited to join her pantheon.
It also doesn’t matter if the worship is done out of love or fear, as
long as it is done. This is a one-way dependency, in that although Once on the home plane that Diana shares with the rest of her
immortals need worshippers to survive, the worshippers get nothing pantheon, Elfstar stays as a guest in Diana’s palace for three days
out of it – at least by default. while Diana explains all about immortality to her.

Smart immortals know that looking after their worshippers and At the end of that time, Elfstar is ready and has decided that in order
helping them with the occasional omen or answered prayer is a to attract worshippers of her own – and not to compete for them too
great way to keep them interested. much with the rest of Diana’s pantheon – she is going to be an emis-
sary of youth and innocence (which won’t surprise people who knew
Likewise, investing clerics who can go around healing and helping her during her life, since she was always chaste). Subconsciously her
(or terrorising if that’s what you prefer) the populace can gain and first embodied vessel will reflect this way in which she sees herself.
keep large numbers of worshippers.
Debbie decides that Elfstar’s embodied form should look like she did
An immortal without worshippers is fully aware of that state at when she was still a young teenager, and decides to give it the pow-
all times, so there is no danger of an immortal – not even a new ers of call other, detection suite, improved saving throws (vs mental
one – accidentally losing their last worshipper and not noticing attacks), and turn undead.
until a year is up and it is too late.

Home Plane Appearance


The plane on which an immortal is first created is forever afterwards When an immortal creates a new embodied vessel for themselves,
considered to be their home plane. This must be an outer plane. they must decide exactly what that form will look like, and what
It is not possible to bestow immortality on someone on the prime powers it will have.
plane or an inner plane.
However, when an immortal is first created, their subconscious
In some cases where there is an established pantheon of immortals automatically creates their first embodied vessel as an idealised
who share a single home plane, new immortals may also be created version of their mortal body. Similarly, the powers a new immor-
on that plane. In most cases, however, the sponsor will create a tiny

233
Chapter 16 - Questing for Immortality
tal’s first embodied vessel receives are based on their subconscious Dragon Breath
desires and their personality rather than being consciously chosen. The immortal can spend 50 power points to use the breath weapon
of any of the normal types of dragon or dragon queen, doing dam-
In practice, the choice for exactly what that first form looks like age equal to their current hit points.
and what powers it has should be given out of character to the im-
mortal’s player, for the same reason that players get to choose the The immortal can only use the breath weapon of each type of
character class of a new mortal character they create even though dragon once per day.
the character themselves may have been apprenticed out and not
had a choice in their career (and certainly not in their race). If the immortal also has the dragon form power, these breath attacks
may be used in addition to the breath attacks granted by that power.
Since immortals don’t age, and any apparent age has no effect on
their abilities, some immortals subconsciously prefer to look young Dragon Form
and virile as they did (or at least as they imagine they did) in their This power costs two power choices.
youth, while others prefer to look older and more worldly wise.
Many simply continue to appear as they did at the point when The immortal’s embodied form is that of a huge dragon. The im-
they became an immortal. mortal has a movement rate of 60’ on foot or 140’ flying.

Embodied Form Powers The immortal gets nine attacks per round regardless of experience
Regardless of its look, an embodied form will have four powers level. These are two bites for 6d8 damage each; and two claws,
from the following list. Normally when an immortal creates a new two wing strikes, two kicks and a tail swing, for 2d8 damage each.
embodied vessel they can choose which powers to give it. For an Strength bonuses apply to each of these.
immortal’s first embodied vessel they are subconsciously chosen.
Additionally, the immortal must choose either a single colour or a
Animal Control mix of two colours for their scales. They can spend 50 power points
The immortal is able to control animals as if a 36th level druid. to use the breath weapon of a dragon or dragon queen of either of
their colours, doing damage equal to their current hit points. The
Call Other immortal can only use the breath weapon twice per day, but each
The immortal can spend 10 power points in order to make a mental time may be from the same or a different type of dragon.
call for help back to their home plane.
If the immortal also has the dragon breath power, these breath
If any other immortals share the same home plane and are on that attacks may be used in addition to the breath attacks granted by
plane at the time of the call, there is a chance based on the level that power.
of the calling immortal that one of them (chosen randomly) will
hear the call: Enhanced Reflexes
This power may be taken more than once.
level 1–6 = 15%
level 7–12 = 30% The immortal gets a +2 bonus on their surprise and initiative rolls.
level 13–18 = 45%
level 19–24 = 60% Extra Attacks
level 25–30 = 75% This power may be taken more than once.
level 31–36 = 90%
The immortal gets one extra attack per round, over and above the
The immortal hearing the call will know the identity of the calling normal number of attacks granted by their level or other powers.
immortal, but not the circumstances in which the call is being
made. They may choose to either ignore the call or to immediately Fighter Options
spend 50 power points to open and step through a temporary Gate The immortal can perform the smash and parry actions in combat.
to the calling immortal’s location.
Groan
Control Undead Once per ten minutes, the immortal can spend 20 power points
The immortal may speak with all intelligent undead, and may to make a horrible noise (although the power is called “groan” the
control undead as if they were a 33+ hit dice undead liege. See noise does not actually have to be a groan – it could be a different
Chapter 18 – Monsters for details about undead lieges. type of noise).

Detection Suite All creatures (including other immortals) within 180’ must make a
The immortal gains all the special detection powers of the elf and saving throw. In the case of mortal creatures, this is a saving throw
dwarf classes. vs. spells with a –2 penalty.

234
Chapter 16 - Questing for Immortality
In the case of undead creatures, this is a saving throw vs. spells Whenever the immortal must make a saving throw of that type
with no penalty. In the case of immortals, this is a saving throw vs. to avoid taking damage, success means that the immortal only
mental attacks with a +4 bonus. takes a quarter of the normal damage from the attack, and failure
means that the immortal takes a half of the normal damage from
Any creature that fails the saving throw is paralysed for ten minutes. the attack. If the attack is an all-or-nothing effect rather than an
effect that does damage, then success means that the immortal is
Any creature that makes the saving throw can only move at half completely unaffected by the attack and failure means that the
their normal speed for ten minutes. immortal takes the full effect.

Multiple groans from different immortals have no additional effect If this power is taken more than once, it must apply to a different
on a creature already affected by this power. saving throw each time.

Height Decrease Increased Damage


The immortal’s embodied form can grow and shrink anywhere from This power may be taken more than once.
normal human-sized to as small as three inches tall.
The immortal increases the damage done by each physical attack
It takes 10 minutes for the immortal to change size, although they by one die of the type done by the attack. This power does not
can remain at any given size indefinitely. increase the damage done by spells cast by the immortal.

Changing size does not affect the immortal’s other abilities or pow- Increased Movement Rate
ers. This power may be taken more than once.

An immortal may have both the height decrease and height increase The immortal moves at double normal speed in all modes of travel
powers. except when flying in at voidspeed in spirit form.

Height Increase If this power is taken more than once, the multiplier increases by
The immortal’s embodied form can grow and shrink anywhere from one for each additional time the power is taken; so an immortal
normal human-sized to as large as twenty two feet tall. who has taken this power three times moves at four times their
normal movement speeds.
It takes 10 minutes for the immortal to change size, although they
can remain at any given size indefinitely. Changing size does not Leech
affect the immortal’s other abilities or powers. The immortal may suck the life force out of creatures they touch,
including other immortals. This power must be consciously
An immortal may have both the height decrease and height increase used – the immortal won’t accidentally kill people when shak-
powers. ing their hands – and requires a successful attack roll against an
unwilling target.
Howl
The immortal may make a terrifying sound (although this power When used on a mortal creature, the touch will drain three levels
is called “howl”, the sound does not actually have to be a howl – it of experience from the victim.
could be a different type of sound).
There is no saving throw against this drain, and the victim will not
All creatures (including other immortals) within 180’ must make a even notice that the drain has happened unless they can make a
saving throw. In the case of mortal creatures, this is a saving throw saving throw vs. death ray at a  –2 penalty. The immortal using the
vs. spells with a –2 penalty. In the case of undead creatures, this is attack gains 3d4 hit points from the drained life force.
a saving throw vs. spells with no penalty.
When used on an immortal, the victim must make a saving throw
In the case of immortals, this is a saving throw vs. mental attacks vs. power attacks. If the victim fails the saving throw then they
with a +4 bonus. lose 100,000 experience points.

Any creature that fails the saving throw must flee in terror for 3d6 This loss can cause the victim to lose a level, but cannot reduce
rounds. them below 3,000,000 experience (i.e. It cannot reduce them be-
low 1st level).
Improved Saving Throws
This power may be taken more than once. If the victim makes the saving throw then they lose 10 power
points. The immortal using the attack gains 10 power points from
The immortal is particularly good at resisting a certain type of effect. the drained life force.
When this power is taken, the player must choose one of the types
of immortal saving throws.

235
Chapter 16 - Questing for Immortality
If the attacking immortal gains more hit points or power points If they succeed they take 3d6 damage and are blinded until cured
than their normal maximum, the excess disappear after ten minutes. by a Neutralise Poison spell cast by an immortal.

Lupine Form Immortal victims must make a saving throw vs. physical attacks.
This power costs three power choices. If they fail they take 3d6 damage and are blinded for 2d10 rounds
or until they receive a Neutralise Poison spell. If they succeed then
The immortal has the natural attacks, damage, and special abilities the attack has no effect.
of a 36th level lupine.
Summon Weapons
Poison This power may be taken more than once.
This power can be taken twice.
The immortal must designate one or two weapons as their chosen
The immortal has a poisonous bite or a poisonous stinger. If this weapons when they take this power. Those weapons must be hidden
power is taken twice, then the immortal has both. in a secure place on the immortal’s home plane.

If the immortal makes a successful attack with either a bite or a At any time, the immortal can summon one or both weapons to
sting, the victim must make a saving throw. their hand instantly (this happens during the statement of intent
phase in combat and does not affect initiative or actions).
Mortal victims must make a saving throw vs. poison with a –4
penalty. If they fail the saving throw then they die instantly. If If either of the weapons is dropped by the immortal, either de-
they make the saving throw then they take 6d6 damage and can liberately or accidentally, then they immediately return to their
do nothing but writhe in agony for a full day, being unable to hiding place.
even think clearly.
If either of the weapons is ever stolen from its hiding place, it may
Immortal victims must make a saving throw vs. physical attacks. not be summoned until it is found and returned to that place.
If they fail the saving throw then they take 6d6 damage and are in
such pain that they cannot speak, fight, cast spells or use powers Swoop
for a full day. Turning to spirit form will ease the pain, but turning The immortal can make a swoop attack while flying. This attack
back to an embodied form will make it return and turning to a is treated as a charge action, even though the immortal is not
mortal form will cause that form to instantly die. If they make the mounted.
saving throw, they are unaffected.
This power can only be used once every three rounds.
If a mortal is slain by the poison (either from failing their saving
throw or from the 6d6 damage), their blood remains poisonous Thief Abilities
enough that it can be used as twelve doses of normal save-or-die The immortal gains the special abilities of a 36th level thief, with
poison; although the poisonous blood will not poison the blood the exception of the backstab ability.
of its victims in turn.
Turn Undead
Snap The immortal is able to turn undead as if a 36th level cleric.
The immortal can stretch out a body part (hair, tongue, arms, ten-
tacles or some other part chosen when the power is chosen) to a Weapon Expertise
distance of 20’ and make an attack with it. This power may be chosen more than once.

If the attack hits its target, the target is grabbed and pulled to the The immortal has the grand master level of expertise with three
immortal who can then make a normal melee attack against the types of weapon chosen at the time the power is chosen.
victim. If the snap attack was made by surprise, the resulting melee
attack does double damage. Favoured Domains
Upon reaching immortality, a character will acquire from one to
Once the melee attack has been made, the victim is no longer three favoured domains for purposes of clerical spell casting, with
grappled by the snapping body part. the corresponding opposed domains.

Spit Poison See Chapter 7 – Spells and Spell Casting for details of the
The immortal may spit poison into the eyes of any target within 30’. clerical domains and how these affect the preparation and casting
No attack roll is needed, but the target gets a saving throw. of spells.

Mortal victims must make a saving throw vs. poison at a –2 penalty. Whenever the immortal uses the Cast Mortal Magic spell in order
If they fail then they die instantly. to cast a cleric spell, the number of power points used is based on
the spell’s modified level, adjusted according to whether they are in

236
Chapter 16 - Questing for Immortality
a favoured or opposed domain in the same way as when a mortal Unlike the embodied form powers that an immortal has, they do
cleric prepares them. not make an in character choice about which domains to favour
and oppose. Instead, their favoured and opposed domains are
Similarly, when the immortal uses the Invest Cleric spell to create dictated by their personality.
a mortal cleric, the mortal cleric inherits the same favoured and
opposed domains that the immortal has, and their spell preparation In practice, the choice of favoured and opposed domains should
must also take this into account. be made by agreement between the Game Master and the player
of the newly immortal character, as should the number of them
See Chapter 18 – Immortals for more details about the Cast (from one to three).
Mortal Magic and Invest Cleric spells.

237
Chapter 17 - Immortals
O
nce characters become immortals, they no longer have the Lost Souls
character class (or even race) that they had in mortal life. A lost soul is an immortal who is trapped in their spirit form and
Immortals, regardless of appearance, are a single class to is unable to create any vessel to use as an avatar because they do
themselves with thirty six levels just like any other class. not have enough power to do so. This is a pitiable situation to be
in, since the immortal is effectively impotent. They can wander the
When a character becomes an immortal, they retain the experience multiverse forever but have almost no means of affecting anything
total that they had in life. This means that a character becoming in their intangible spirit form.
an immortal may begin their immortality at a level higher than 1st.
The only escape from this fate of being a perpetually impotent
Since the immortal has a completely new body which is fundamen- observer is to somehow gain enough power to be able to create a
tally different to that of a mortal, the player of a new immortal vessel once more. Basically, the immortal must earn enough power
character should not be surprised if some aspects of their character to do so from a position where all they can do is advise others.
appear to have got worse since they became an immortal. For exam-
ple, a 1st level immortal may have fewer hit points than they had Of course, given the need for worshippers, it very possible that a
as a 32nd level fighter. This appearance can be deceptive, however, lost soul will lose its last worshipper while powerless. Should this
since immortals are significantly better than mortals in a number happen, the lost soul only has a year to gain a new worshipper
of ways and this makes direct comparisons of a single ability or before they die, and with no power to help anyone or to invest a
score somewhat misleading. cleric the immortal will find it extremely difficult to do that.

Immortality & Death Level & Experience


Although the term “immortal” is used for characters, they are not Compared to mortals, immortals need huge numbers of experience
truly immortal. They can still die. points to increase in level.

When an immortal dies, they are permanently dead. There is no However, immortals don’t get experience for the same things that
way to bring them back, raise them, reincarnate them, or even turn mortal level characters do. Immortals never gain experience for
them into undead. When they’re gone, they’re gone. gaining treasure, and should only rarely – if ever, at the Game
Master’s discretion – gain experience for killing mortal level mon-
Consequently, and somewhat ironically, immortals tend to be far sters. Doing such things are simply not significant to an immortal.
more paranoid about death than they ever were when mortal.
The only experience immortals should get for killing monsters is if
Loss of Worshippers the monsters pose a significant threat to the immortals.
All immortals need worshippers. Even those who wish to simply
wander around having a good time rather than meddling in mortal Instead, the vast majority of experience gained by immortals will be
affairs still need at least some worshippers. Theoretically, an im- for achieving plot goals. The Game Master is advised to give such
mortal can survive with only a single worshipper, but most prefer rewards much more frequently in an immortal level campaign than
to have as many worshippers as possible for safety’s sake. in a mortal level campaign, and to make them large enough that the
characters will advance in level at a rate the group finds reasonable.
If an immortal loses their last worshipper, they will immediately
feel it; it is not possible for an immortal to accidentally lose all their Immortals in their home plane are considered to be five levels higher
worshippers and not notice. than their actual level, to a maximum of 36th level for purposes of
level-dependent abilities (e.g. Hit points and power reserve). This
An immortal can survive for a year without worship. After that effective level increase does not change the immortal’s experience
point, they die. total or their power reserve.

Aura Combat Spending Experience


The second way that an immortal can die is that it can have the Unlike mortals, immortals have various powers and spells that they
last of its power stripped in aura combat. For this to kill the im- must spend experience points to use. They are literally powering
mortal, it must happen while the immortal is in spirit form on its these abilities by using up their own life force.
home plane. See the section on aura combat later in this chapter
for more details. If spending experience points in this manner would reduce an
immortal’s level, the immortal cannot spend the experience and
Physical Destruction cannot use the power or spell.
When an immortal is in its natural spirit form, there is no way to
physically harm it so physical destruction is not an issue. Similarly, The only exception to this is if an immortal is the victim of the
when an immortal is inhabiting one or more avatars physical de- leech power (see Chapter 16 – Questing for Immortality for
struction of those avatars will not harm the immortal. In short, it details). Experience drained by the use of this power may reduce
is not possible to physically destroy an immortal. an immortal’s level; although the immortal can never be drained

239
Chapter 17 - Immortals
Table 17–1: Immortal Abilities by Level
Saving Throws

Strike to Kill Damage

Improve Ability Cost


Base Attack Bonus

Max Ability Score


Weapon Damage

Power Reserve
Armour Class

Physical Attacks

Mental Attacks
Anti-magic
Experience

Power Attacks
Hit Points

Spell Attacks
Hit Dice

Attacks
Skills
Level

1 3,000,000 15 75 +12 12 0 2 2d6 – +9 300 25 100,000 +0 +5 +2 +3


2 3,250,000 16 80 +13 12 0 2 2d6 – +9 325 25 100,000 +0 +5 +2 +3
3 3,500,000 17 85 +13 12 0 2 2d6 – +9 350 25 100,000 +0 +5 +2 +3
4 3,750,000 18 90 +14 12 0 2 2d6 – +9 375 25 100,000 +0 +5 +2 +3
5 4,000,000 19 95 +14 13 0 2 2d6 – +9 400 25 100,000 +0 +5 +2 +3
6 4,500,000 20 100 +15 13 0 2 2d6 – +9 450 25 100,000 +0 +5 +2 +3
7 5,000,000 21 110 +15 13 –1 2 2d6 – +9 500 25 100,000 +0 +6 +3 +4
8 6,000,000 22 120 +16 13 –1 2 2d6 – +9 600 25 100,000 +0 +6 +3 +4
9 7,000,000 23 130 +16 14 –2 2 2d6 – +9 700 25 100,000 +1 +7 +4 +5
10 8,000,000 24 140 +17 14 –2 2 2d6 – +9 800 25 100,000 +1 +7 +4 +5
11 9,000,000 25 150 +17 14 –3 2 2d6 – +9 900 25 100,000 +2 +8 +5 +6
12 10,000,000 26 160 +18 14 –3 2 2d6 – +9 1,000 25 100,000 +2 +8 +5 +6
13 12,000,000 27 180 +18 15 –4 3 3d6 +1 die +11 1,200 50 200,000 +3 +9 +6 +7
14 14,000,000 28 200 +19 15 –4 3 3d6 +1 die +11 1,400 50 200,000 +3 +9 +6 +7
15 16,000,000 29 220 +19 15 –5 3 3d6 +1 die +11 1,600 50 200,000 +4 +10 +7 +8
16 18,000,000 30 240 +20 15 –5 3 3d6 +1 die +11 1,800 50 200,000 +4 +10 +7 +8
17 20,000,000 31 260 +20 16 –6 3 3d6 +1 die +11 2,000 50 200,000 +5 +11 +8 +9
18 22,000,000 32 280 +21 16 –6 3 3d6 +1 die +11 2,200 50 200,000 +5 +11 +8 +9
19 25,000,000 33 300 +21 16 –7 3 3d6 +1 die +13 2,500 75 400,000 +6 +12 +9 +10
20 30,000,000 34 330 +22 16 –7 3 3d6 +1 die +13 3,000 75 400,000 +6 +12 +9 +10
21 35,000,000 35 360 +22 17 –8 3 3d6 +1 die +13 3,500 75 400,000 +7 +13 +10 +11
22 40,000,000 36 390 +23 17 –8 3 3d6 +1 die +13 4,000 75 400,000 +7 +13 +10 +11
23 45,000,000 37 420 +24 17 –9 3 3d6 +1 die +13 4,500 75 400,000 +8 +14 +11 +12
24 50,000,000 38 450 +25 17 –9 3 3d6 +1 die +13 5,000 75 400,000 +8 +14 +11 +12
25 55,000,000 39 500 +26 18 –10 4 4d6 +2 dice +15 5,500 100 800,000 +9 +15 +12 +13
26 60,000,000 40 550 +27 18 –10 4 4d6 +2 dice +15 6,000 100 800,000 +10 +15 +12 +13
27 70,000,000 41 600 +28 18 –11 4 4d6 +2 dice +15 7,000 100 800,000 +11 +16 +13 +14
28 80,000,000 42 650 +29 18 –12 4 4d6 +2 dice +15 8,000 100 800,000 +12 +16 +13 +14
29 90,000,000 43 700 +30 19 –13 4 4d6 +2 dice +15 9,000 100 800,000 +13 +17 +14 +15
30 100,000,000 44 750 +31 19 –14 4 4d6 +2 dice +15 10,000 100 800,000 +14 +17 +14 +15
31 110,000,000 45 800 +32 19 –15 4 4d6 +2 dice +17 11,000 100 1,600,000 +15 +18 +15 +16
32 120,000,000 46 900 +33 19 –16 4 4d6 +2 dice +17 12,000 100 1,600,000 +15 +18 +15 +16
33 130,000,000 47 1,000 +34 20 –17 4 4d6 +2 dice +17 13,000 100 1,600,000 +15 +18 +15 +16
34 140,000,000 48 1,250 +35 20 –18 4 4d6 +2 dice +17 14,000 100 1,600,000 +15 +18 +15 +16
35 150,000,000 49 1,500 +36 20 –19 4 4d6 +2 dice +17 15,000 100 1,600,000 +15 +18 +15 +16
36 160,000,000 50 2,000 +37 20 –20 4 4d6 +2 dice +17 16,000 100 1,600,000 +15 +18 +15 +16

240
Chapter 17 - Immortals
below 3,000,000 experience (i.e. they can never be drained be- One final advantage to mortal-form vessels is that they are useful
low 1st level) even by this means. if the immortal wishes to visit the prime plane. Immortals are able
to detect the use of immortal level power – including the presence
Power Reserve of immortals who are in spirit form or manifest form - on the
In addition to being able to spend experience points to use powers, prime plane, but they are not able to detect an immortal who is
immortals also have a power reserve based on their level, as shown in a mortal form.
on Table 17–1. This is a pool of points that can be spent on minor
or temporary powers and abilities. Developer Commentary
Immortals in their natural spirit form are sexless. They have no
Note that an immortal’s power reserve is always based on their physical body at all and no primary or secondary sex characteristics
actual level. When an immortal is on their home plane and ef- other than possibly the sound of their voice.
fectively five levels higher than normal this does not increase their
power reserve. However, immortals can take physical forms, and these forms can be
of either physical sex. Most immortals have a preferred gender and
Although immortals don’t get physically tired and require sleep feel anything from mild discomfort to strong revulsion while in a
(unless they’re in a mortal form, of course) they still get mentally physical form that has a different gender to that of their self-image.
fatigued and require rest in order to regenerate their power points. This is simlar to an “uncanny valley” effect in that taking a physical
An immortal’s power reserve refreshes after a night’s rest, except form that is a completely different body shape or layout to the one
for those power points currently in lesser avatars, and any power that the immortal is used to does not produce the same discomfort
points left unused are wasted. that being in a similar-but-not-quite-right form does.

Skills There are no game mechanics to represent this. It is left up to indi-


First level immortals start with a number of skill points equal to 12 vidual players how much (if at all) they wish to roleplay it.
plus their Int bonus, and this increases to a maximum of 20 plus
their Int bonus at 36th level. Skills for immortals work in exactly While on the subject of sex and the single immortal, it is not possible
the same way as skills for mortals. However, the higher ability scores for immortals in spirit form to engage in any kind of reproductive
of immortals can sometimes make skill and ability checks unneces- activity since they have no physical presence. Immortals in a manifest
sary unless there are very large penalties to the effective ability score. form are capable of physically performing (and enjoying) sexual acts,
but such as their bodies are not made of flesh and blood such acts
While most physical skills can only be used in a manifest form, never result in pregnancy.
some mental or social skills can also be used in spirit form.
Immortals in a mortal form are able to reproduce just like other mor-
When in a mortal form, the immortal does not have access to tals, and their offspring will be normal mortals who derive no special
their full range of skills, and only has access to the skills that the powers or abilities from their immortal parentage (and, indeed, may
mortal form has. be completely unaware that they have immortal parentage).

Vessels, Avatars, and Forms


Although the default form of an immortal is their intangible spirit Greater and Lesser Avatars
form, immortals find it convenient to take on physical forms since An immortal who is in spirit form can spend an action to pour
their spirit form is so limited in the ways in which it can interact some or all of their power points into one of their vessels in order
with the world. An immortal can’t just take on any physical form to create a physical form called an avatar. An immortal has two op-
it desires. It must first create a vessel. tions when doing this. They can either just pour a limited number
of power points into the vessel, in which case the vessel appears
A vessel is a potential physical form that the immortal can inhabit. adjacent to the immortal’s spirit form and becomes a lesser avatar;
When creating a vessel, the immortal may choose whether the vessel or they can choose to also inhabit the vessel with their spirit form,
should be a potential mortal form or a potential manifest form. Ei- in which case the vessel appears around the spirit form, merging
ther type has its own advantages and disadvantages. A mortal-form with it to become a greater avatar.
vessel is cheaper to create than a manifest one, and the resulting
mortal form can travel amongst mortals incognito. However, it has When creating a lesser avatar, an immortal can pour any number
all the needs and vulnerabilities of a normal mortal body; so it is of power points into it, from a single point to all the immortal’s
much more easily damaged or destroyed. A manifest-form vessel currently remaining points (although few will ever pour the last of
is more expensive to create but it is also much sturdier and able to their power points into a lesser avatar because it leaves their spirit
withstand things that would kill a mortal body. It is also necessary form devoid of power points and therefore extremely vulnerable
to be in a manifest form to use most of the immortal level spells. to being killed in aura combat).
However, it is not possible to disguise a manifest form in order
to go incognito. A manifest form is always visibly recognisable as When creating a greater avatar, an immortal automatically pours
being that of an immortal. all its remaining power points into the avatar as its spirit form
becomes part of the avatar.

241
Chapter 17 - Immortals
In this way an immortal can exist in multiple places at the same Example: Elfstar is a first level immortal in spirit form with 350
time. The immortal can have one greater avatar (or spirit form) and power points. She pours 200 of her power points into a manifest-
a number of lesser avatars in existence and although these will start form vessel in order to create a lesser avatar. The manifest body of
in the same location they can move around independently. However, the avatar appears next to her spirit form.
this is limited by the number of vessels that the immortal has. An
immortal can only have one avatar in existence at once (whether Next she pours her remaining 150 power points into a mortal-form
greater or lesser) for any given vessel that they have created. If an vessel, choosing to form it around her spirit form and merge with
immortal wants to have two identical avatars existing at the same it. This creates a greater avatar which replaces Elfstar’s spirit form.
time, they must make two identical vessels.
During the course of the day, each of Elfstar’s avatars spends 30
Avatars of an immortal all have the full intelligence and memories power points on various things before deciding to rest for the night
of the immortal, although they count as having separate minds for on her home plane.
the purposes of anything that might affect minds. An immortal’s
avatars have a constant mental link regardless of where they are Elfstar’s lesser avatar has 170 power points at the start of the rest (its
(even if they are on different planes in different celestial spheres) original 200 minus the 30 that it has spent). Even though it is on
and they all share each other’s memories. If one avatar is asleep or Elfstar’s home plane, it does not regain any power points since it is
unconscious while others are active, upon waking it will remember only a lesser avatar. It finishes the night with the same 170 power
everything that has happened to the others even though it wasn’t points that it started with.
conscious at the time.
Elfstar’s greater avatar has 120 power points at the start of the rest
It is important to remember that whether an avatar is a lesser one (its original 150 minus the 30 that it has spent). Because Elfstar is
or a greater one is not dependent on how much power points it resting for the night, she should theoretically start the following morn-
has. It only depends on whether or not it is inhabited by the im- ing with her full complement of 350 power points. However, 170 of
mortal’s spirit form. For example, a first level immortal with 300 these are still in the lesser avatar, so instead she recovers only the 60
power points could pour 200 of those power points into one of power points that her two avatars spent between them, bringing her
its manifest-form vessels to create a lesser avatar and then pour its up to 180 power points.
remaining 100 power points into a mortal-form vessel, inhabit-
ing it to transform into a greater avatar. That the lesser avatar is
a powerful manifest form while the greater one is a much weaker
mortal form and the lesser one has more power points than the Developer Commentary
greater one is irrelevant. The first avatar is lesser because it only got The above rules for avatars theoretically allow an immortal player
some of the immortal’s power points and was therefore created as character to be in hundreds of places at once (assuming they have
a separate body, whereas the second avatar is greater because it was made sufficient avatars), which sounds like it will be an absolute
created around the immortal’s spirit form, which merged with it. nightmare for the Game Master.

Both lesser and greater avatars have the same physical abilities and However, in practice, (and in playtesting), it’s very unlikely that an
the same access to the immortal’s powers. The only differences immortal will want to be in more than two or three places at the
between lesser and greater avatars are in the way that they handle same time. In fact the most common scenario is that the immortal
power points and in what happens if they’re killed. keeps their spirit form at home and sends a single mortal or manifest
form out as a lesser avatar to do things. Only occasionally will an
Lesser Avatars immortal want to be in more than two places simultaneously.
A lesser avatar has a limited number of power points, given to it
when it is created. These power points will not regenerate. When If you do find that player characters having multiple avatars is too
a lesser avatar runs out of power points after either spending them much, or that the rules for creating avatars are too complex for
on immortal abilities or losing them in aura combat the avatar your tastes, simply disallow the creation of lesser avatars. That way
simply winks out of existence. This does not harm the immortal, an immortal player character will only ever be in a single place at
and the vessel from which the lesser avatar was created is still avail- once, and the creation of greater avatars can be simplified into the
able for future use. immortal just shifting forms in place.

The power points that are held by a lesser avatar are unavailable Greater Avatars
to the immortal’s greater avatar or spirit form. However, if an A greater avatar is formed when an immortal pours all of their
immortal’s lesser avatar is within 5’ of that immortal’s spirit form remaining power points into a vessel, forming it around their spirit
or greater avatar, the immortal can spend an action to voluntarily form. The spirit form of the immortal merges into the greater avatar,
withdraw all the power points from the lesser avatar, recovering inhabiting it. Because this greater avatar is the “true” form of the im-
them for itself. This is an all-or-nothing affair in that the immortal mortal, it regenerates power points as normal. However, any power
can’t withdraw only a portion of the power points held in its lesser points that the immortal currently has held in lesser avatars won’t
avatar. Naturally, withdrawing the power points from a lesser avatar be regenerated until the lesser avatars have used that power points.
in this manner causes it to disappear.

242
Chapter 17 - Immortals
As an action, the immortal can withdraw all the power points from physical presence. This lack of physical presence also means that
its greater avatar, transforming back into its spirit form. Once again, the immortal does not have a gravity or air envelope when in the
this is an all-or-nothing affair. An immortal can’t withdraw only void or in the luminiferous aether.
part of the power points that its greater avatar has.
Finally, while in spirit form an immortal can speak and understand
When a greater avatar runs out of power points, either by spending any language, and can speak telepathically with any creature. The
it all on immortal abilities or losing it as a result of aura combat, immortal can also control the dreams of all dreaming mortal crea-
the immortal automatically transforms back to their spirit form ture sleeping within 180’ of the immortal’s spirit form, and can
and can’t create another greater avatar until they have regained do this to mortals on the prime plane while the spirit form of the
some power points. If the last power points were lost due to aura immortal is on the ethereal plane.
combat rather than voluntarily spent, the immortal’s spirit form
is also sent back to their home plane. In either case, the immortal Mortal Form
is unharmed and the vessel from which the avatar was created is When in a mortal form, the immortal as no special abilities. An
still available for future use. immortal in a mortal form simply is mortal for all intents and
purposes. The immortal cannot use any immortal level spells, but
Forms & Abilities can use normal mortal magic if the mortal form is able to do so.
Immortals have a variety of special abilities. Unless specified oth-
erwise, the following abilities can be used only when the immortal The immortal in mortal form is still able to use aura combat.
is in a manifest form.
No magical detection – not even the ESP spell or other forms of
In either a mortal form or their spirit form, the immortal only has telepathy – can detect that the mortal form is anything other than
a subset of these abilities, as detailed below. a normal mortal.

Spirit Form Any equipment that was created as part of the mortal form vanishes
When in their natural spirit form, an immortal is insubstantial and when the immortal withdraws power from the mortal form and
can travel freely through any mundane substance or any substance the form itself vanishes. Mundane items carried by the mortal form
created by mortal level magic. This also means that the spirit form do not disappear in this manner.
cannot interact with the mundane world in any way. For example,
it cannot pick objects up or attack creatures. Manifest Form
When in a manifest form, immortals are at their most powerful.
The spirit form is also completely immune to any form of damage, The manifest form is tough and durable (although not invulner-
attack, or magic, with the exception of aura combat and the im- able) and is far more capable of interacting with the world than
mortal spells Probe, Probe Shield and Detect Immortal Power. the spirit form.

The spirit form is always translucent and it glows gently (with a The manifest forms of an immortal are always based on their current
strength anywhere from a candle to a campfire) and cannot be level (including the effective five level bonus if the manifest form is
made to appear invisible or solid, but the immortal may change currently on the immortal’s home plane). If the immortal increases
the shape of their spirit form at will between: or decreases in level, the manifest forms increase or decrease with
it. An immortal does not need to re-create a manifest form at a
◊ A 2’ diameter ball of light higher level to gain the benefits of a level increase.
◊ A transparent version of one of their manifest forms
◊ A glowing version of the holy symbol used by their religion Hit Dice & Hit Points
Manifest forms have a number of hit dice based on their level (see
An immortal in spirit form may not use any immortal level spells Table 17–1). However, the immortal’s hit points are based directly
with the exception of the Detect Immortal Power, Probe, and Probe on their level rather than on their hit dice. An immortal does not
Shield spells, although it may engage in aura combat as normal. get to add their Con bonus to this hit point total.

An immortal in spirit form may not use the Cast Mortal Magic spell Manifest forms heal quicker than mortals do. An immortal in a
to cast mortal level magic, with the exception of movement and manifest form regains 1d4 hit points per day, or 1d8 hit points
travel spells such as Teleport, Travel, Dimension Door and so forth. per day if resting.

Without using such spells, an immortal in spirit form can fly at 240’ Attack Bonus & Weapon Feats
per round while paying attention to their surroundings. If the im- As with mortal characters, an immortal character in a manifest
mortal is in a hurry and not worried about noticing details around form has a base attack bonus based on their level.
them, they can fly at 24 miles per round or even voidspeed.
Manifest forms have basic proficiency with all weapons and attacks,
Immortals in spirit form do not need to eat, drink or breathe; and have no restrictions on the weapons that they are allowed to
in fact they are incapable of doing these things as they have no use. Immortals do not normally gain extra weapon feats, but may

243
Chapter 17 - Immortals
have higher proficiency levels in some weapons because they have mortal level Force Field spell. However, it does not stretch to the
chosen the weapon expertise power as part of their manifest form. mundane non-magical creations of such spells. An immortal cannot
see or walk through a Wall of Stone cast by a mortal.
Armour Class & Defences
The armour class of an immortal in a manifest form works just Additionally, immortals in manifest form have partial immunity
like that of a mortal creature, and it is modified by Dex bonus in to mortal level magic cast by other immortals. See Chapter 18 –
exactly the same manner. Monsters for full details on how anti-magic works.

However, the armour class of a manifest form is not modified by Even if a spell cast by an immortal level caster using Cast Mortal
armour and shields that are worn unless they are magical; in which Magic gets through the immortal’s anti-magic, the immortal may
case only the magical bonuses apply, not the base armour class still make a saving throw versus that spell where applicable. If the
normally granted by the armour. spell is mind-affecting, the immortal may make a saving throw vs.
mental attacks, otherwise the immortal makes a saving throw vs.
In addition to their armour class, immortals in manifest form have spell attacks.
further defences against mundane damage.
Other Immunities
In the case of physical damage done by mortals, immortals in a Immortals in manifest form are immune to disease, aging (includ-
manifest form are only hurt by +5 weapons or better. Even then, ing magical aging), mortal level poison, and mundane environ-
the immortal takes only minimum damage from each attack. If a mental effects such as fire, cold, lightning and so on.
mortal attacks an immortal with a smash attack (see Chapter 10 –
Combat for details), the mortal does not add their entire strength Immortals are not immune to immortal level poisons.
to the damage done – they only add their strength bonus instead.
However, even such powerful venoms will be delayed for a number
Physical attacks from other immortal level creatures do full damage of rounds equal to the immortal’s constitution bonus before taking
to an immortal in manifest form, unless the immortal can make a effect; hopefully giving the immortal chance to cast a Neutralise
saving throw vs. physical attacks. If this saving throw is successful, Poison or similar before it is too late.
the immortal only takes half damage from the attack.
While in a manifest form, immortals do not need to breathe, eat or
Attacks & Damage drink – although they can do all three for pleasure if they choose.
Immortals who are in a manifest form may make more than one
attack per round, as shown on Table 17–1. Movement
An immortal in a manifest form can walk or swim at 50’ per round.
Like lupines, immortals may strike to kill in unarmed combat with
their natural attacks in order to do more damage instead of hav- Immortals can also naturally fly at 120’ per round when in a mani-
ing the chance to stun or knock out opponents. The strike to kill fest form, regardless of whether or not that form has wings.
damage done by immortals is listed on Table 17–1.
Senses and Communication
As with lupines, they must choose whether to strike to kill or to While in a manifest form an immortal can speak and understand
stun during the statement of intent at the beginning of a round. any language, and can speak telepathically with any creature.
Unlike lupines, immortals are not necessarily striking with teeth or
claws. They may make killing attacks with fists, horns, tail swipes, Immortals in a manifest form possess infravision similar to that of
or whatever features their manifest form has. dwarves and elves, although they do not possess the other enhanced
senses of those races unless they chose their manifest form to have
Additionally, immortals of 13th level and higher do additional the detection suite power.
damage when striking with weapons. This damage is based on the
type of damage normally done by the weapon at the immortal’s Developer Commentary
level of expertise with that weapon, and this increased damage does In the first edition of Dark Dungeons, and the original game that
apply to unarmed strikes to stun, but does not apply to unarmed Dark Dungeons emulates, the manifest form of an immortal was
strikes to kill. the “default” form and the spirit form was an alternate form into
which the immortal could transform if it wanted to.
Anti-Magic
Immortals in a manifest form are completely immune to all mor- This new edition of Dark Dungeons makes the spirit form the default
tal level magic cast by mortals, including such magical effects as form for two reasons. Firstly, it emphasises that the immortal has
dragon breath from mortal level dragons and Energy Drain from undergone a change to a higher form of being rather than having
mortal level undead. just got tougher; and secondly having the spirit form as the default
form works better with the rules for avatars (which were very vague
This immunity stretches to the magical creations of existing mortal in the original game and which i’ve made more explicit here).
level spells. For example an immortal can walk straight through a

244
Chapter 17 - Immortals

Aura Aura Combat


Immortals radiate an aura of immense power when in their spirit Immortals in any form are able to fight by directly attacking op-
form or in a manifest form. This aura is always visible, and under ponents using their aura. This can be done even when the immortal
normal circumstances it unmistakably marks the immortal as being is in a mortal avatar that does not normally have a visible aura.
an immortal but has no other effect. These attacks manifest as intangible arcs of light emitted from the
attacker’s aura that coalesce into glowing shapes that form around
This aura is too powerful to be completely extinguished or hidden, the target. An immortal can attack any creature that they can per-
even if the immortal becomes invisible, but it can be suppressed ceive and that is on the same plane as the attacker. The perception
to a low enough level to make communication with mortals easy doesn’t have to be physical, it can be through magical scrying.
or flared up to affect mortals in a number of ways.
Attacking in this way can be done once per round, as an action. It
Aura Flares requires no movement or verbal component, and can therefore be
Once per round (as an action), an immortal in manifest form can done even when the immortal is incapacitated or even paralysed.
cause their aura to flare up. This will affect a number of mortal
creatures equal to the immortal’s Int and Wis bonuses added to- An immortal in any form instinctively knows when it is being
gether; providing all the targets are within 60’ of the immortal. attacked in aura combat and may react to this attack by simultane-
Mortal creatures with no mind (such as unintelligent undead) are ously make a counter-attack. This counter-attack is made on the
affected by these aura attacks. attacker’s turn and does not count as the defender’s action. Like
the attack itself, it requires no movement or verbal component
The immortal must decide whether the desired effect of the aura and can therefore be done when the immortal is incapacitated or
is terror, awe, or beauty. paralyzed. The immortal that is counter-attacking does not need
to be able to perceive their attacker, since the counter-attack tracks
Terror: Each target will flee in terror for 30 minutes unless they back along the path of the original attack.
can make a saving throw vs. spells. If the target is cornered, they
will cower and fight only to defend themselves. An immortal can only initiate one aura combat attack per round,
but it can counter-attack against any number of incoming attacks
Awe: Each target will stand paralysed for 30 minutes unless they providing they have the spare power points to do so.
can make a saving throw vs. spells.
Mechanics of Aura Combat
Beauty: Each target will consider the immortal to be their best There are five types of attack that can be used in aura combat, each
friend, and treat them accordingly. It does not make them fanati- of which has its own special effect if it is successful. When an attack
cally loyal and will not make them attack their other friends. is made, the attacker and the target (who is counter-attacking) each
secretly choose one of the attack types and select how much power
All targets get a saving throw vs. spells to avoid the effect. points to power it with, with a minimum of 10 power points and
a maximum of 500 power points.
If a target fails its saving throw, then it gets another one periodically
to throw off the beauty effect. The frequency of the saving throw The attack types are then compared to see which wins. Each of the
is based on the creature’s intelligence: attack types has two other types that it automatically beats, and two
other types that it loses against. If the attack and counter-attack
0 Int = save every 240 days are both of the same type, then the stronger of the two (the one
1 Int = save every 180 days powered by the most power points) wins. In the unlikely event
2 Int = save every 120 days that the attack and counter-attack are not only the same type but
3 Int = save every 90 days if the target of the initial attack does not counter-attack, either
4–5 Int = save every 60 days because it is mortal and therefore not able to do so; it does not
6–8 Int = save every 30 days have enough power points to do so; or it chooses not to, then the
9–12 Int = save every 14 days attack automatically “wins”.
13–15 Int = save every 6 days
16–17 Int = save every 48 hours Each combatant pays the power points to power their attack, and
18 Int = save every 16 hours the combatant whose attack was beaten by their opponent’s attack
19 Int = save every 6 hours loses additional power points equal to twice the amount that pow-
20 Int = save every 2 hours ered the winning attack. If the loser can make a saving throw vs.
21–29 Int = save every 20 minutes power attacks, they lose only half of these additional power points.
30+ Int = save every 2 rounds
In addition to the loss of power points, the loser also takes an ad-
If the immortal behaves in an overtly hostile manner to the target ditional effect based on the type of attack that they were beaten by.
that is charmed by their beauty, such as attacking it or ordering Note that all these effects will even affect an immortal in spirit form.
others to attack it, then the charm is broken.

245
Chapter 17 - Immortals
Because aura attacks are designed to work on other creatures with by any means, mundane or magical, it moves with you; and you
power points, they are less effective on mortal creatures that do not are considered to be blinded.
possess them. If a mortal target of an attack makes a saving throw
vs. death ray, they are unaffected by the attack. However, until the end of your next turn any incoming aura attack
of any type (including the one that you are responding to, if any)
Types of Attack is automatically blocked, even if they are techniques that would
Bind: The attacker wraps and ties their opponent with chains of normally beat shroud when it is used as an attack. The attacker only
energy. If you lose to a bind attack, you are paralyzed until the end pays 5 power points instead of the full cost of the attack, and you
of your next action (remember that both attacking and counter- lose only 10 power points per incoming attack keeping the shield
attacking in aura combat can still be done while you are paralysed, strengthened. If you can make a saving throw vs. power attacks,
even though normal actions and movement can’t be done). A bind you lose only 5 power points. You do not suffer the additional ef-
attack automatically wins against a shroud or thrust, but loses fects of the attacks, even if they are of types that would normally
against a dispel or pin. automatically beat a shroud, but you can neither counter-attack
against them nor make attacks yourself until the end of the round
Dispel: The attacker probes their opponent with tendrils of en- when your shroud ends.
ergy that disrupt magic. If you lose to a dispel attack, the attacker
becomes aware of what spells you currently have active upon you, Lack of Power Points
and may choose any one of them to be dispelled (no roll required). Normally, the loser in a round of aura combat loses power points.
Additionally, you are unable to cast spells (either mortal or im- However, sometimes the loser will lose the last of their power points
mortal level spells) until the end of your next turn. A dispel attack or not have any to lose. The effects of this depend on the nature
automatically wins against a bind or shroud, but loses against a of the loser.
pin or thrust.
Mortals: Mortal creatures have no power points to lose, and there-
Pin: The attacker uses spikes of energy to pin their opponent in fore can’t counter-attack against aura attacks and always lose against
place. If you lose to a pin attack, you may not change your location. them. When a mortal creature should lose power points as the result
You may still move around in place and take actions as normal, but of aura combat (remember, mortal creatures can make a saving
you may neither move from your current location nor be moved throw vs. death ray to be unaffected by an aura attack), it loses an
from it by any physical or magical means. This includes teleporta- equal number of hit points instead. If the mortal creature loses all
tion and planar or movement. You may make a saving throw vs. its hit points, it starts dying, just as if its hit points had been lost
power attacks at the end of each round to escape the pin. A pin in physical combat.
attack automatically wins against a bind or dispel, but loses against
a shroud or a thrust. Exalted Creatures: If an exalted creature loses the last of its power
points, any remaining loss is carried over to its hit points as if it were
Shroud: The attacker surrounds their opponent in a cocoon of mortal. Further attacks will treat it as if it were a mortal creature
energy. If you lose to a shroud attack, all your senses (sight, hearing, until it has had chance to recover some power points.
smell, magical detection) are blocked until the end of the round. If
you attempt to move out of the cocoon by any means, mundane Avatars: When an immortal is using a vessel as an avatar, and that
or magical, it moves with you. Note that you are still aware of any avatar loses the last of its power points due to an aura attack, the
incoming aura combat attacks and are still able to counter-attack vessel disappears in the same manner as when the immortal runs
in response to them. A shroud attack automatically wins against a out of power points voluntarily. If the avatar was a lesser one, then
pin or a thrust, but loses against a bind or a dispel. there is no further effect. If the avatar was a greater one, then the
immortal’s spirit form is sent back to their home plane if it is not
Thrust: The attacker uses a hand or fist formed of energy to push already there.
their opponent. If you lose to a thrust attack you are pushed 60’ in
a straight line in a direction of your attacker’s choosing. A thrust Immortals in Spirit Form: When an immortal in spirit form runs
attack automatically wins against a dispel or a pin, but loses against out of power points due to an aura attack they are sent back to
a bind or a shroud. their home plane. If they are already on their home plane when
this happens, they die. This is the only way that an immortal can
Shroud as a Defence be truly killed, other than dying from lack of worshippers, and
It is possible to use the shroud technique on yourself in order to immortals who suffer this fate are irrevocably dead and gone. There
protect yourself from aura attacks. You can do this on your turn is no power in the multiverse, mortal or immortal, that can bring
instead of making an aura attack, or you can do it as a response back an immortal once they have been killed.
to an incoming attack instead of making a counter-attack. Using
shroud on yourself costs the minimum of 10 power points, and Aura Combat and Magic
means that you suffer the effects of being shrouded – that is, all your Aura combat is not magic; it is the direct manipulation of the
senses (sight, hearing, smell, magical detection) are blocked until immortal’s life force. Because of this, the effects of aura combat
the end of the round; if you attempt to move out of the cocoon (for example the chains binding someone after a bind attack) can’t

246
Chapter 17 - Immortals
be dispelled or disrupted by anti-magic. Similarly, immortals are being cast (remember that the level of some mortal level spells
capable of using aura combat even in anti-magic areas. will be adjusted up or down based on the favoured and opposed
domains of the caster).
Immortal Level Spells
With the exception of Probe, Probe Shield, and Detect Immortal Casting this spell is done at the same time as casting the mortal
Power, which can be cast by an immortal in spirit form, these spells level spell that it accompanies, and the immortal level spells Reduce
may only be cast by immortals while in a manifest form. Immortals Saving Throw and Increase Spell Duration can also be cast at the
in spirit form can also cast Cast Mortal Magic, but only to cast same time to enhance the mortal level spell.
mortal level movement spells, not any other spells.
Some mortal level spells have additional or altered effects when
These spells are not stored in spell books and it is not possible to cast by an immortal using this spell. If this is the case, this will be
write these spells onto scrolls or make magic items that duplicate indicated in the descriptions of those spells in Chapter 7 – Spells
their effects. and Spell Casting.

Immortal level spells can be either lesser or greater. Lesser spells Unlike mortal magic cast by mortals (or immortals in a mortal
generally have temporary effects and cost the immortal power form), spells cast using Cast Mortal Magic can affect an immortal
points to cast; whereas greater spells generally have permanent in a manifest form.
effects and cost the immortal experience points to cast.
However, even if a spell cast by an immortal level caster using Cast
All immortals can cast all of these spells, and there is no need to Mortal Magic gets through the immortal’s anti-magic, the target
prepare them in advance. immortal may still make a saving throw versus that spell where
applicable. If the spell is mind-affecting, the immortal may make
There is no limit to how often an immortal can cast any of these a saving throw vs. mental attacks, otherwise the immortal makes
spells other than their cost in experience and power points. a saving throw vs. spell attacks.

None of these spells can be dispelled by either mortal or immortal Unlike most immortal level spells, this spell can be cast by an im-
casters. mortal in spirit form. However, when cast by an immortal in spirit
form it can only be used to cast the following movement spells, and
Bestow (r) (with the exception of Gate) the immortal must target themselves
Greater immortal spell with the spell cast:
Cost: 50,000xp per ability bestowed
Range: 60’ ◊ Dimension Door
Duration: permanent ◊ Gate
The Bestow spell grants one or more permanent abilities to a mortal ◊ Pass Plant
creature. ◊ Teleport
◊ Teleport any Object
An ability can be either a +1 bonus to an ability score or the equiva- ◊ Transport Through Plants
lent of a mortal spell between 1st and 7th level having been cast on ◊ Travel
the mortal and made permanent by a Permanence spell. ◊ Word of Recall

However, unlike an actual Permanence spell, this bestows the power Conceal Magical Nature
on the mortal as an innate ability which cannot be dispelled. Lesser immortal spell
Cost: 10pp
Reverse: Diminish removes one or more abilities from a mortal Range: 60’
creature. An ability can be one granted by this spell or an innate Duration: one year, or until item used
ability such as infravision, or it can result in a –1 penalty to one This spell will cause a single magical object (including an artifact)
of the mortal’s ability scores. to fail to show up on Detect Magic, Detect Evil, Know Alignment,
and Truesight spells.
The mortal gets a saving throw vs. spells with a –2 penalty in order
to avoid the effects of a Diminish spell. This concealment of the item’s magical nature will last for one year
or until the item is used; at which point this spell is cancelled and
Cast Mortal Magic the item’s magical nature will become apparent once more.
Lesser immortal spell
Cost: 1pp per level of the mortal spell This spell does not work on living creatures, and multiple castings
Range: self are not cumulative in duration.
Duration: instant
This spell allows the caster to cast any single mortal level spell from
any class. It has a cost of 2pp per level of the mortal level spell

247
Chapter 17 - Immortals
Create Artifact The caster may cast Create Mundane Object in conjunction with
Greater immortal spell this spell in order to create clothing and equipment for their new
Cost: varies mortal form. Any equipment created in this manner will appear
Range: touch on the mortal form when the caster inhabits it as an avatar and will
Duration: permanent disappear when the caster withdraws power and the avatar vanishes.
This spell creates an artifact – an extremely powerful magical item.
An immortal can have as many mortal forms as they like, and may
See Chapter 20 – Artifacts for more details about the creation use any one of them as an avatar, but may only have one avatar of
and use of artifacts. each vessel at one time.

Create Manifest-Form Vessel Create Mundane Object


Greater immortal spell Greater immortal spell
Cost: 1,000,000xp Cost: 1xp per 1gp value of the object
Range: self Range: 10’
Duration: permanent Duration: permanent
This spell creates a new manifest-form vessel for the caster that can This spell creates a mundane object out of nothingness. It can cre-
be used as an avatar. ate any non-magical object or any magic item; but cannot create
artifacts.
The new manifest form can have any combination of four manifest
form powers, and will look as the caster wishes. This spell can create complex items such as buildings complete
with fixtures and fittings, providing the immortal pays for the total
See Chapter 16 – Questing for Immortality for details on value of the object.
manifest form powers.
If the immortal chooses, they can make temporary items that
An immortal can have as many manifest-form vessels as they like, disappear after either 24 hours or when the immortal switches
and may use any one of them as an avatar, but may only have one out of manifest form whichever comes sooner. Temporary items
avatar of each vessel at any given time. do not cost experience points to create, but cost 1 power point
per 10,000gp of value created (rounded up).
Normally, like most other immortal level spells, this spell can only
be cast by an immortal in a manifest form. However, if an immortal Create Species
is left with no manifest-form vessels because they have all been Greater immortal spell
killed and they have become a lost soul, they can cast this spell Cost: varies
while in spirit form – but only to re-create the original manifest- Range: 10’
form vessel that they acquired when they first became an immortal. Duration: permanent
Each casting of this spell creates a single creature, which may be
Create Mortal-form Vessel intelligent.
Greater immortal spell
Cost: 50,000xp The creature created does not have to be from an existing species or
Range: caster race; the immortal can simply invent a new species by casting this
Duration: permanent spell, and if they cast the spell repeatedly to create the same type of
This spell creates a new mortal-form vessel for the caster. creature they can create a breeding population of this new species.

The new mortal form can be of any race, class or monster species It is up to the Game Master (and the actions of the immortal in
(other than an exalted monster species); but its abilities are limited protecting, teaching and guiding their new species) to determine
to those that a normal member of that race, class or monster spe- whether the new species will thrive or die out. This is how many
cies would have. of the humanoid species in the world started.

The caster chooses whether the mortal form will age as a normal The immortal has no direct control over creatures created by this
member of its species or whether it will remain the same age. The spell, but they will usually be grateful for existence and worship
former is more realistic if the form is going to be used repeatedly the immortal.
to interact with the same mortals, but has the disadvantage that it
will eventually become so old that it “dies” of old age and can no This spell costs the immortal 100,000 experience points to cast, plus
longer be used to create an avatar. an additional 100,000 experience points for each special ability of
the creature created.
The caster can, of course, simply create a new mortal form that
is identical to a previous one in order to give the appearance of At the Game Master’s discretion, having a high number of hit dice
restored youth to an aged one or give the appearance that a dead may count as one or more special abilities in its own right.
one has been raised.

248
Chapter 17 - Immortals
Intelligent creatures created by this spell cannot take on human When cast on a mortal with fewer than 3,000,000 experience points,
character classes, but can potentially become sorcerers or shamans. this spell will fail. If the mortal has at least 3,000,000 experience
points then casting this spell on them will make them become an
The player and Game Master may optionally create a custom racial immortal with the same number of experience points that they
character class for the new species, similar to the racial character had as a mortal; and whose home plane is the plane on which this
classes that exist for clockworks, dwarves, elves, lupines, and hal- spell was cast on them.
flings.
As part of the process of becoming immortal, the target of this spell
Detect Immortal Power will create for themselves a manifest-form vessel that they can use as
Lesser immortal spell an avatar. The appearance and powers of this vessel will be guided by
Cost: 10pp the subconscious of the target rather than being consciously chosen
Range: one astronomical body on the prime plane (although if the target is a player character then the player should
Duration: 1 day be given choice of what their character’s subconscious creates).
This spell will scan one astronomical body (on the prime plane only)
for immortal activity. A particularly large or complex astronomical See Chapter 16 – Questing for Immortality for details on
body may require more than one Detect Immortal Power spell to manifest form powers.
cover it, at the Game Master’s discretion.
Grant Power
Each round that an immortal is on the planet in manifest form, Greater immortal spell
there is a 5% cumulative chance that this spell will detect their pres- Cost: varies
ence. If the immortal in manifest form uses immortal level spells Range: touch
then this becomes a 10% cumulative chance per round. There is Duration: permanent
also a 1% cumulative chance per round that this spell will detect This spell allows the immortal so simply give away experience points.
the active use of an artifact, either by a mortal or by an immortal.
The immortal can spend any number of experience points when
The use of aura combat will not be detected by this spell, but an casting this spell (providing they can afford to spend them without
aura flare will always be detected. losing a level).

The spell will not reveal the identity of the immortal, or even The target of the spell will gain the same number of experience
whether it was triggered by an immortal or an artifact, but it will points that the immortal has spent.
reveal the location that the immortal power was detected at.
The experience can be given to a mortal, or it can be given to an-
In most campaign settings, the major planets where the campaign other immortal who has fewer experience points than the caster.
takes place will normally have some kind of rules set up by the However, it cannot give enough experience points to bring the
most powerful immortals that prohibit direct immortal activity target’s experience total higher than the caster’s.
except for particular prescribed activities (such as investing clerics
or sending omens to worshippers). Hear Prayers
Lesser immortal spell
This is for the safety of those living on the planet, because it is Cost: 5pp
relatively simple for a dispute between immortals to destroy huge Range: everywhere
areas of civilisation. Of course, not all immortals will obey such Duration: 30 minutes
rules, so there is often a council of high level immortals on “guard This spell allows the immortal to hear all prayers that were made
duty” using this spell to monitor events and prepared to step in to them over the previous day.
and stop any unauthorised direct meddling.
It does not grant the immortal any special ability to answer those
This spell will not detect immortals in spirit form, nor will it detect prayers, but most immortals are aware that the occasional interven-
immortals in mortal form. tion is a great way to keep worshippers loyal.

Unlike most immortal level spells, this spell can be cast by an im- This spell is also an ideal way for an immortal to keep up to date on
mortal who is in spirit form. the actions of their agents and minions – assuming those minions
report those actions in prayer.
Grant Immortality
Greater immortal spell
Cost: 1,000,000xp
Range: touch
Duration: permanent
This spell transforms the target, who must be a willing mortal, into
an immortal.

249
Chapter 17 - Immortals
Immortal Eye Invest Cleric (r)
Lesser immortal spell Greater immortal spell
Cost: 5pp Cost: 50,000xp
Range: anywhere Range: touch
Duration: 1 hour Duration: permanent
This spell allows the immortal to create an invisible magical eye This spell will either turn a willing human mortal into a cleric of the
in any location that they have previously visited, whether on the caster or a willing non-human mortal into a shaman of the caster.
same plane or a different plane. The eye is detectable by a Detect In the case of a human cleric, the cleric will inherit the immortal’s
Magic spell cast in its location, but is will not show up on a Detect favoured and opposed domains.
Immortal Power spell directed at the location.
If the target already has a character class then this class is lost and
The caster can move the eye at a speed of 240’ per round by con- replaced with the cleric class (but the character’s experience total
centrating, and when they stop concentrating the eye will remain remains unchanged).
in place. At the end of the spell’s duration, the caster can spend an
additional 5 power points in order to extend it for another hour. The mortal neither gains nor loses experience, so a normal com-
moner will become a first level cleric with no experience points
Improve Ability but an experience adventurer may become a higher level cleric
Greater immortal spell with the same amount of experience points that they had in their
Cost: see Table 17–1 previous class.
Range: caster
Duration: permanent Reverse: Excommunicate cleric removes the clerical or shaman class
This spell permanently improves one of the ability scores of the from a mortal worshipper of the caster.
caster. The score is improved in all manifest forms (and in the case
of mental ability scores, also in spirit form). The target of the spell immediately loses their cleric class and be-
comes a fighter with the same amount of experience points that
The cost to improve an ability score and the maximum value to they had in the cleric class.
which an ability score can be raised depend on the caster’s level,
and can be found on Table 17–1. There is no saving throw against this excommunication, but it can
only be used on clerics or shamans who are worshippers of the
Increase Spell Duration caster. It cannot be used to neutralise the clerics or shamans of rivals.
Lesser immortal spell
Cost: 1pp per increase Probe
Range: - Lesser immortal spell
Duration: - Cost: 5pp
This spell is cast at the same time as the caster casts Cast Mortal Range: 720’
Magic in order to cast a mortal level spell. Duration: instant
This spell informs the caster of the level, hit dice, power points,
For each power point spent on this spell, the mortal level spell hit points, and anti-magic of the creature (which, of course, will
will have its duration extended by an amount equal to its normal also inform the caster indirectly whether the creature is mortal or
duration. immortal).

If the caster spends 1pp on this spell, for example, the mortal spell it The spell can be cast on any creature, including another immortal,
is cast with will have its duration doubled. If the caster spends 2pp, and gives the caster information about that creature. There is no
the mortal spell it is cast with will have its duration tripled. If the saving throw against the spell, and anti-magic does not apply.
caster spends 3pp, the mortal spell it is cast with will have its dura-
tion quadrupled. And so forth. The spell will also inform the caster of the name of the target, al-
though this additional information can be blocked by the target’s
Both this spell and the Reduce Saving Throw spell can be cast at the anti-magic or by the target making a saving throw (vs spells at
same time on the same mortal level spell. a –2 penalty in the case of mortals, or vs. mental attacks in the
case of immortals).
This spell cannot be cast with other immortal level spells.
When cast at an immortal who is in a mortal form, this spell only
reveals the details (including name) of that mortal form, not the
details and name of the immortal.

When cast on an immortal who is in a manifest form, this spell


will reveal whether the manifest form is a greater or lesser avatar.

250
Chapter 17 - Immortals
Unlike most immortal level spells, this spell may be both cast by caster’s choosing either around the centre of the crystal sphere or
or target an immortal who is in spirit form. around an existing body in the sphere.

Probe Shield It is possible to create a stationary body in the exact centre of a


Lesser immortal spell sphere with this spell.
Cost: 5pp
Range: caster When a body is created using this spell, four equivalent bodies are
Duration: 10 minutes also created in the four elemental planes and an ethereal copy of
This spell makes the caster immune to the Probe spell. Anyone the body is created in the ethereal plane. See Chapter 15 – Out
casting the Probe spell at the caster during the duration of this of this World for details on how the elemental and ethereal
spell will only detect that the Probe Shield is active and will get no planes work.
other information – although they may infer from the presence of
the Probe Shield that the caster is an immortal. The orbit of the body created must not take it more than half way
from the centre of the sphere to its edge.
Unlike most immortal level spells, this spell can be cast by im-
mortals in spirit form. When created, a body will have no plant or animal life, although
such life can be taken there. It will, however, be created with an
Reduce Saving Throw air and gravity envelope of its own.
Lesser immortal spell
Cost: 1pp per –1 penalty per target When an immortal uses this spell to create a body, they will become
Range: - aware of the danger of the body colliding with other bodies, and
Duration: - therefore no immortal will accidentally cause such a collision by
This spell is cast at the same time as the caster casts a mortal level using this spell. However, a malicious immortal could use this spell
spell. to deliberately set up a collision if they desired.

For each power point spent on this spell, one mortal target of the The bodies created by this spell will normally be spherical, but the
mortal level spell will get a –1 penalty on its saving throw against caster may create them in other shapes such as rings or flat discs
the spell. if they desire.

If the caster spends 5pp on this spell, for example, a single mortal The cost to create a body depends on the diameter of the body in
could be given a –5 penalty. If the caster spends 15pp, a single miles:
mortal could be given a –15 penalty or one mortal could be given
a –10 penalty and a second one given a –5 penalty, or fifteen mor- asteroid (50mi) = 50,000xp
tals could be given a –1 penalty each. And so forth. small moon (500mi) = 100,000xp
large moon (1,000mi) = 200,000xp
Both this spell and the Increase Spell Duration spell can be cast at small planet (2,000mi) = 400,000xp
the same time on the same mortal level spell. medium planet (4,000mi) = 600,000xp
large planet (10,000mi) = 800,000xp
This spell cannot be cast with other immortal level spells, and can- small sun (100,000mi) = 1,200,000xp
not penalise the saving throws of immortal level creatures. large sun (500,000mi) = 1,400,000xp
unusual shape = +200,000xp
Shape Reality
Greater immortal spell Move a Body: The spell can also be used to move an existing
Cost: varies astronomical body. Moving an existing body has the same rules
Range: special as creating one – the body must be moved to an orbit around the
Duration: permanent centre of the sphere or around an existing body, and the immortal
This spell allows the immortal to reshape reality. The spell can be cannot accidentally create a situation where two bodies will collide.
used to create or move astronomical bodies, planes or even crystal
spheres. A group of immortals can cast this spell together, sharing The elemental and ethereal equivalents of the body are moved
the experience cost of the casting equally between them. with it.

Create a Body: This spell can be used to create an astronomical This spell cannot move a body out of the crystal sphere that contains
body of any size. The body must be created on the prime plane it. Nor can it move a body out of the prime plane.
within a crystal sphere.
The cost to move a body depends on its diameter in miles:
The body can be of any of the four basic types (gaseous body, solid
body, radiating body, liquid body), and will take on an orbit of the asteroid (50mi) = 10,000xp
small moon (500mi) = 20,000xp

251
Chapter 17 - Immortals
large moon (1,000mi) = 40,000xp The plane will always be roughly spherical, and the geographic edge
small planet (2,000mi) = 80,000xp of the plane is similar to the crystal of a celestial sphere, except
medium planet (4,000mi) = 120,000xp that it is not possible for anything to move through the crystal
large planet (10,000mi) = 160,000xp in any way.
small sun (100,000mi) = 240,000xp
large sun (500,000mi) = 280,000xp The cost to create an outer plane depends on the size of the plane:

Create a Celestial Sphere: An immortal with enough experience dwelling = 200,000xp


to spend can use this spell to create an empty celestial sphere. The town = 300,000xp
immortal must be in the luminiferous aether to use this function island/asteroid = 400,000xp
of the spell. continent/moon = 800,000xp
planet = 1,600,000xp
There is no chance of the new sphere colliding with an existing
sphere, since the spheres will repel each other. The caster can choose the (initial) contents of the plane from any
of the possibilities that can be chosen when altering an outer plane.
The newly created sphere can be from 3–9 billion miles in radius,
and will be full of void and contain no astronomical bodies, al- However, regardless of the options chosen, outer planes never con-
though it will have stars embedded in it. However, creating the tain void. They are always full of atmosphere.
sphere will also create a matching set of inner planes (elemental
planes of air, earth, fire and water; and an ethereal plane). A newly created plane will not contain any plant or animal life.

If the immortal is not in an existing river of aether when they cast Move an Outer Plane: If an immortal is at the anchor point of
this spell, a bi-directional river will spontaneously form to connect an outer plane, they can cast this spell to move that anchor point.
the new sphere to the nearest other sphere, and there is a 25% This is only possible if the plane is not the home plane of an un-
chance that a bi-directional river will also form to connect the new willing immortal.
sphere to another “nearby” sphere at the Game Master’s discretion.
When the immortal casts this spell, the anchor point of the plane
If the immortal is in an existing river of aether connecting two is folded up into a glowing sphere about the size of a grapefruit in
existing spheres when they cast this spell, roll 1d8 and interpret the immortal’s hand.
the results as follows:
The immortal then moves to the location that they wish to move
◊ 1–4 = bi-directional rivers form to both existing spheres. The old the anchor point to, and lets go of it. The anchor point of the outer
river between the existing spheres still exists. plane is then fixed in the new location.

◊ 5–6 = single direction rivers form to one of the existing spheres If the immortal’s manifest form disappears for any reason (run-
and from the other (chosen randomly). The old river between ning out of power, being killed), the anchor point is immediately
the existing spheres still exists. dropped in the current location.

◊ 7 = a bi-directional river forms to one of the existing spheres The anchor point can be carried through a Gate, and can be trans-
(chosen randomly). The old river between the existing spheres ferred to another plane via the Travel spell or a similar ability. How-
still exists. ever, it cannot be carried directly (or indirectly) into the luminifer-
ous aether. Attempting to do so will cause the spell to fail and the
◊ 8 = the existing river is split into two rivers, each of which keeps anchor point of the plane to revert to its previous location.
the direction of flow that it had before the sphere was created. It
is no longer possible to travel directly between the two existing Similarly, it is not possible to use this spell create a “loop” of outer
spheres without going via the new sphere. planes by taking the anchor point into the plane that is being
moved or into any plane that is anchored (directly or indirectly)
Creating a celestial sphere costs 6,400,000 experience points. onto that plane. Attempting this will also cause the spell to fail
and the anchor point of the plane to return to its previous location.
Create an Outer Plane: An immortal who is inside a celestial
sphere (or inside any of the inner or outer planes attached to that While the anchor point of the plane is being carried, it cannot be
sphere) can use this spell to create a new outer plane. crossed using Travel spells or similar abilities. Gates to and from
the plane being moved remain fully functional, and Travel spells
The new plane will be anchored at the immortal’s current location. can still be used to pass between the plane being moved and planes
If this location is on an orbiting astronomical body, the anchor that are anchored to it.
point of the plane will stay is position relative to the rotation and
movement of the body. See Chapter 15 – Out of this World The cost to move the anchor point of an outer plane depends on
for more details on outer planes and their anchor points. the size of the plane:

252
Chapter 17 - Immortals
dwelling = 50,000xp Transform
town = 75,000xp Greater immortal spell
island/asteroid = 100,000xp Cost: 50,000xp
continent/moon = 200,000xp Range: 60’
planet = 400,000xp Duration: permanent
This spell changes the form of a mortal creature in a similar manner
Alter an Outer Plane: An immortal can also use this spell to alter to a Polymorph Other spell. However, the change is non-magical
the characteristics of an existing outer plane. The plane must be ei- and therefore cannot be detected by a Detect Magic spell or undone
ther the immortal’s home plane or a plane that the immortal created. by a Dispel Magic spell.

If the plane is also the home plane of another immortal, that im- Once the change has happened, the target is a normal non-magical
mortal must be willing for the alteration to take place. creature of the appropriate type. However, a Probe spell cast at the
target will reveal their “true” pre-transform identity as well as their
Each casting of the spell can alter one of the following facets of post-transform identity.
the plane:
The caster decides whether the target keeps their old mind; has their
The basic conditions and matter can be altered to match either the mind changed along with their body but keeps their memories;
prime plane or one of the elemental planes. or has their mind changed along with their body and has their
memories replaced with fake ones suitable for the new body. If the
The magical laws of the plane can be changed to one of the follow- memories of the target are suppressed, the caster may optionally
ing selections: all magic works; all mortal-level spells are considered set a command word that will restore them.
to be x levels higher than normal; mortal level magic only works
when cast by immortals using the Cast Mortal Magic spell; only The target may make a saving throw vs. spells with a –2 penalty to
immortal level spells work; no magic works. avoid the effect, although a willing target does not need to make
this saving throw.
The appearance of the plane and the native matter within it can be
altered (e.g. Pink sky, or everything appears to be made of wood). This spell can be used to change the race and/or class of a mortal,
and it can also be used to lower the amount of experience that they
The type of “body” on the plane can be changed to any one of the have. It cannot raise the experience that the target has unless the
following types: air body, earth body, fire body, water body. spell is being used to restore them to their prior form.

The matter in the plane can be changed to any one of the follow- If this spell is cast on someone who has already been transformed
ing types: a single round astronomical body in the centre of the by a previous application of this spell, the caster can choose to
plane; a set of tiny flat astronomical bodies floating in the plane; a revert the target back to their original form without necessarily
hemispherical astronomical body filling half of the plane. knowing what that form is.

The gravity on the plane can be changed to any one of the following
types: pulling in a constant “down” direction; pulling towards the
centre of the plane; pulling towards each body the plane contains
as if those bodies were in the void.

Note that changing the properties of an inhabited plane can be very


dangerous to those inhabitants. Also, no matter how restricted the
magic is on a plane, immortals in spirit form from can always use
their equivalent of the Travel spell to exit the plane at its anchor
point, and the Shape Reality spell can still be used to change the
restriction on magic.

The cost to alter a single facet of a plane depends on the size of


the plane:

dwelling = 5,000xp
town = 7,500xp
island/asteroid = 10,000xp
continent/moon = 20,000xp
planet = 40,000xp

253
Part 4
Mastering the
Game
Chapter 18 - Monsters
T
he Dark Dungeons world is full of a variety of creatures, from Lair Group
the harmless to the terrifying. Collectively these creatures This contains a number range which shows how many monsters of
are referred to as monsters, even though some of them are this type typically live together in a shared lair or home. In the case
mundane animals or even people. of civilised creatures, this indicates the size of a typical village or
camp, not the size of a whole city. This number range is followed
Similarly, just because a creature is referred to as a monster, it doesn’t by a letter in parentheses, which indicates the type of treasure (see
necessarily mean that the creature will be hostile to the player char- Chapter 19 – Treasure) that the group has in total in their lair,
acters. Monsters can also be allies or friends, or merely neutral or in addition to any treasure that might be carried by individuals.
disinterested parties which may be negotiated with.
Move
Within this chapter, monsters are described in alphabetical order, This shows the movement per round of the monster. If the monster
described in a standard format. has unusual forms of movement, such as being able to fly or swim,
these will also be listed.
Monster Format
Each monster description contains a stat block containing some Armour Class
or all of the following entries: This shows the armour class of the monster. If there is an asterisk
next to the armour class value then the monster has immunities
◊ Type: to some attacks. See the monster description for details of such
◊ Habitat: immunities.
◊ Wandering Group:
◊ Lair Group: Hit Dice
◊ Move: This shows the number of dice to roll in order to calculate the
◊ Armour Class: monster’s hit points. It may include a modifier, which should be
◊ Hit Dice: added to the hit point total.
◊ Attack Bonus:
◊ Attacks: For example “3+1” indicates that the monster has 3d8+1 hit dice.
◊ Weapon Expertise: This value is followed by a second number in parentheses which
◊ Power Reserve: indicates the average hit points that a monster of this type will
◊ vs. Death/Poion: have. The hit dice total may be followed by one or more asterisks.
◊ vs. Wand: Each asterisk indicates that the monster has a special ability that
◊ vs. Paralyse/Petrify: makes it tougher than a normal monster with the same number
◊ vs. Dragon Breath: of hit dice. Monsters with asterisks are worth more experience
◊ vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: points than normal.
◊ Intelligence:
◊ XP value: If you are inventing your own monsters or modifying monsters
then you will need to judge which special abilities of the monster
Type are worth asterisks. Generally only special abilities that give the
This contains one or more keywords that describe the monster’s monster an offensive bonus in combat are worth asterisks, with a
basic type; such as “animal”, “undead” and so forth. Some of these rough guideline to power being that each two spell levels that a
keywords are merely descriptive, but many of them are relevant creature can cast or each two levels of weapon expertise that it has
when it comes to the way certain spells or items work. is worth an asterisk and each special ability such as Energy Drain
or paralysis is also worth an asterisk.
For example, a Protection from Evil spell keeps out any creatures
with the enchanted keyword. Attack Bonus
This shows the attack bonus that the monster uses for its attacks.
Habitat This may be followed by a modifier, which is the normal to-hit
This contains one or more habitats where the monster can be found, modifier that the monster gets on attacks. For example “+3 {+2}”
along with the monster’s rarity in each of those habitats. indicates that the monster attacks using attack bonus +3 and has
a +2 bonus on its to-hit rolls from weapon expertise.
Wandering Group
This contains a number range which shows how many monsters The attack bonus of a monster is based on its hit dice. It has already
of this type are typically encountered when wandering away from been calculated for all the listed monsters, but if you are inventing
their lair or home. This number range is followed by a letter in a new monster or modifying a monster then look up the monster’s
parentheses, which indicates the type of treasure (see Chapter 19 – hit dice on Table 18–1 in order to find out its attack bonus.
Treasure) that each individual is likely to be carrying with them.

257
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Attacks Monsters can only spend their power points on the things listed
This shows the number and type of attacks that the monster gets in their description. Unless listed, they cannot spend their power
each round. points on immortal level spells.

Unless a monster description says otherwise, all attacks are resolved Saving Throws
on the monster’s initiative, and multiple attacks may be split be- These show the monster’s chances to make saving throws of each
tween valid targets. of the five different types.

Each attack will be followed by a number range in parentheses. This The monsters listed here have their saving throw chances pre-calcu-
number range indicates the damage done by that attack. lated. When inventing your own monsters or modifying monsters,
the saving throw chances of intelligent humanoid monsters should
Weapon Expertise normally be the same as those of a character of the most suitable
Some monsters use weapons, and they can have levels of expertise class to match the monster’s abilities and of a level equal to the
in those weapons, just like player characters who have bought number of hit dice the monster has.
weapon feats. The bonuses that a monster gets for its weapon ex-
pertise are listed {in brackets} as part of its normal listing. These Other monsters should usually have saving throw chances that
bonuses are based on the monster using its listed weapon against are the same as those of a fighter with a level equal to half the
armed opponents. monster’s hit dice.

If you wish to use a monster with weapon expertise but change the Some very powerful monsters have the same four types of saving
type of weapon it is using, then you can swap the bonuses for the throw as immortals, rather than the normal five types. (see Chap-
equivalent bonuses for having the same level of weapon expertise ter 17 – the Immortals for details about immortal defences.)
but with the new weapon.
Just like immortals, these monsters are immune to poison, disease,
If you are inventing your own monsters or modifying monsters Energy Drain, aging, and magic cast by mortals, and can make
then weapon using monsters should be given a maximum level of saving throws vs. physical attacks to take half damage from physi-
expertise based on their hit dice,: cal attacks.

up to 2+hd = basic However, unlike immortals they do not take minimum damage
3 to 5+hd = skilled from mortal level physical attacks and are not immune to physi-
6 to 8+hd = expert cal attacks from mortals using less than +5 weapons unless their
9 to 10+hd = master description specifically says that they do.
11hd and up = grandmaster
Intelligence
Power Reserve This shows the average intelligence of this type of monster. In the
Some very powerful monsters have a power reserve like immortals case of sapient monsters, the intelligence of individuals will vary
do (see Chapter 17 – Immortals for details about power reserve from this average; but in the case of non-sapient monsters this is
and power points). a fixed score.

258
Chapter 18 - Monsters
Table 18–1: Base Monster Abilities Table 18–1: Base Monster Abilities (continued)
Attack Base Experience Attack Base Experience
Hit Dice Hit Dice
Bonus Experience per * Bonus Experience per *
< 1 +1 5 1 35+ to 36 +23 6,250 5,750
1 +1 10 3 36+ to 37 +24 6,500 6,000
1+ +2 15 4 37+ to 38 +25 6,750 6,250
2 +2 20 5 38+ to 39 +26 7,000 6,500
2+ +3 25 10 39+ to 40 +27 7,250 6,750
3 +3 35 15 40+ to 41 +28 7,500 7,000
3+ +4 50 25 41+ to 42 +29 7,750 7,250
4 +4 75 50 42+ to 43 +30 8,000 7,500
4+ +5 125 75 43+ to 44 +31 8,250 7,750
5 +5 175 125 44+ to 45 +32 8,500 8,000
5+ +6 225 175 45+ to 46 +33 8,750 8,250
6 +6 275 225 46+ to 47 +34 9,000 8,500
6+ +7 350 300 47+ to 48 +35 9,250 8,750
7 +7 450 400 48+ to 49 +36 9,500 9,000
7+ +8 550 475 49+ to 50 +37 9,750 9,250
8 +8 650 550 50+ to 51 +38 10,000 9,500
8+ +9 775 625 51+ to 52 +38 10,250 9,750
9 +9 900 700 52+ to 53 +39 10,500 10,000
9+ to 10 +10 1,000 750 53+ to 54 +39 10,750 10,250
10+ to 11 +10 1,100 800 54+ to 55 +40 11,000 10,500
11+ to 12 +11 1,250 875 55+ to 56 +40 11,250 10,750
12+ to 13 +11 1,350 950 56+ to 57 +41 11,500 11,000
13+ to 14 +12 1,500 1,000 57+ to 58 +41 11,750 11,250
14+ to 15 +12 1,650 1,050 58+ to 59 +42 12,000 11,500
15+ to 16 +13 1,850 1,100 59+ to 60 +42 12,250 11,750
16+ to 17 +13 2,000 1,150 60+ to 61 +43 12,500 12,000
17+ to 18 +14 2,125 1,350 61+ to 62 +43 12,750 12,250
18+ to 19 +14 2,250 1,550 62+ to 63 +43 13,000 12,500
19+ to 20 +15 2,375 1,800 63+ to 64 +43 13,250 12,750
20+ to 21 +15 2,500 2,000 64+ to 65 +43 13,500 13,000
21+ to 22 +16 2,750 2,250 65+ to 66 +44 13,750 13,250
22+ to 23 +16 3,000 2,500 66+ to 67 +44 14,000 13,500
23+ to 24 +17 3,250 2,750 67+ to 68 +44 14,250 13,750
24+ to 25 +17 3,500 3,000 68+ to 69 +44 14,500 14,000
25+ to 26 +18 3,750 3,250 69+ to 70 +44 14,750 14,250
26+ to 27 +18 3,500 3,500 70+ to 71 +45 15,000 14,500
27+ to 28 +19 3,750 3,750 71+ to 72 +45 15,250 14,750
28+ To29 +19 4,500 4,000 72+ to 73 +45 15,500 15,000
29+ to 30 +20 4,750 4,250 73+ to 74 +45 15,750 15,250
30+ to 31 +20 5,000 4,500 74+ to 75 +45 16,000 15,500
31+ to 32 +21 5,250 4,750 75+ to 76 +46 16,250 15,750
32+ to 33 +21 5,500 5,000 76+ to 77 +46 16,500 16,000
33+ to 34 +22 5,750 5,250 77+ to 78 +46 16,750 16,250
34+ to 35 +22 6,000 5,500 78+ to 79 +46 17,000 16,500

259
Chapter 18 - Monsters
Table 18–1: Base Monster Abilities (continued) The monsters listed in this chapter already have experience values
Attack Base Experience pre-calculated. If you are inventing your own monsters or modify-
Hit Dice ing monsters then look up the monster’s hit dice on Table 18–1
Bonus Experience per *
in order to find out its experience value.
79+ to 80 +46 17,250 16,750
80+ to 81 +47 17,500 17,000 For each hit dice over 110, simply add 250 xp plus another 250
80+ to 82 +47 17,750 17,250 xp per * to the monster’s experience value.
82+ to 83 +47 18,000 17,500
Special Abilities
83+ to 84 +47 18,250 17,750
Some monsters have special or unusual abilities that need more
84+ to 85 +47 18,500 18,000 detailed description than that which is provided in their individual
85+ to 86 +47 18,750 18,250 monster text. Further details of these abilities are described in this
86+ to 87 +47 19,000 18,500 section:
87+ to 88 +47 19,250 18,750 Anti-Magic
88+ to 89 +47 19,500 19,000 Some creatures have an anti-magic ability listed, either as a personal
89+ to 90 +47 19,750 19,250 ability or occasionally as an area effect ability.
90+ to 91 +48 20,000 19,500
Anti-magic is usually listed with bonus (e.g. “+11 anti-magic”).
91+ to 92 +48 20,250 19,750 In cases where it is not, assume that it is automatically successful.
92+ to 93 +48 20,500 20,000
93+ to 94 +48 20,750 20,250 In an anti-magic area, all existing magic has a chance of not work-
ing. Each magical effect that is brought into the area causes a check
94+ to 95 +48 21,000 20,500
to be made using the anti-magic bonus. If this check is successful
95+ to 96 +48 21,250 20,750 (remember – anti-magic with no listed bonus is automatically suc-
96+ to 97 +48 21,500 21,000 cessful) then the magical effect is temporarily suppressed while in
97+ to 98 +48 21,750 21,250 the area and ceases to work. Existing magic with a duration still
has its duration counted while in the area, even if it is not working.
98+ to 99 +48 22,000 21,500 Existing magic brought into an anti-magic area and suppressed
99+ to 100 +48 22,250 21,750 will resume functionality (assuming its duration has not run out)
100+ to 101 +49 22,500 22,000 once it leaves the area.
101+ to 102 +49 22,750 22,250
Example: Oeric, using a +2 sword of flaming and under the influ-
102+ to 103 +49 23,000 22,500 ence of a potion of flying, is attacking a floating horror. The horror
103+ to 104 +49 23,250 22,750 turns its anti-magic ray in his direction.
104+ to 105 +49 23,500 23,000
Since the anti-magic ray of a floating horror is not given a check
105+ to 106 +49 23,750 23,250
bonus, it is assumed to be automatically successful and no check is
106+ to 107 +49 24,000 23,500 made. Oeric’s +3 sword of flaming goes out, and is now a normal
107+ to 108 +49 24,250 23,750 sword. Similarly, oeric falls to the ground as his potion of flying is
108+ to 109 +49 24,500 24,000 suppressed.
109+ to 110 +49 24,750 24,250 Two rounds later, the floating horror looks away. Oeric’s sword im-
> 110 +49 25,000 24,500 mediately bursts into flame again and regains its +2 bonus, and
oeric can now fly again. The two rounds that he spent unable to fly
Non-sapient monsters can have an intelligence score of up to 5 if still count towards the duration of his potion.
they are particularly good at problem solving – although this doesn’t
mean that they are the intellectual equals of sapient creatures with
a similar score. Additionally, while in an anti-magic area, any spell cast or any
magical ability used will also fail to work if the check for the area
Xp Value is successful. In this case, the spell or ability will not suddenly kick
This shows the amount of experience points that a party should get in after the area is left, and the spell or ability does count as having
shared between them for defeating a monster of this type. Note been used for purposes of charges or uses-per-day.
that defeating does not necessarily mean that the monster must be
killed. See Chapter 11 – Getting Better for more details about If the anti-magic is a personal ability rather than an area effect, it
gaining experience from defeating monsters. is simpler.

260
Chapter 18 - Monsters
The creature with the ability simply has that percentage chance Such spell immunity not only covers the listed spells when cast by
of being unaffected by the magic. The magic will still function a spell caster, but also similar abilities from items or monsters that
normally other than not affecting the creature. mimic those spells.

Example: Aloysius casts a Fireball spell from an artefact that he A creature with spell immunity can voluntarily lower it in order
owns at a marilith and the trolls that are accompanying her. Because to allow beneficial spells to affect them, but it is an all-or-nothing
the Fireball is from an artefact, it gets past the marilith’s immunity lowering of the immunity and while it is lowered, any spell or spell
to mortal level magic. However, her anti-magic still applies. like effect that it normally covers is allowed through.

The marilith has a +4 anti-magic bonus against immortal level Developer Commentary
magic, so the Game Master rolls for the Fireball and gets a 17. The “exalted” type, immortal-style saving throws, and power reserve
Since 17+4 is 21, the anti-magic check succeeds. have proved to be somewhat confusing for people in the first edition
of Dark Dungeons, as attested by various questions I have received
The Fireball goes off as normal, hurting all the trolls. However, the from players, so some clarification is in order.
marilith stands in the middle of it totally unaffected by the magic
and totally undamaged. The exalted type means that a monster’s physical attacks can hurt
immortals. It does *not* mean that it takes minimum damage from
physical attacks from mortals and neither does it mean that it has
Energy Drain immunity to mortal magic.
Some creatures, mostly undead, have the Energy Drain ability.
Immortal-style saving throws mean that a monster is immune to
Anyone hit by an Energy Drain immediately loses one level or hit mortal magic unless cast via the Cast Mortal Magic immortal-level
die. spell and that they may make saving throws vs. physical attacks to
take half damage from physical attacks. It does *not* mean that they
In the case of characters, the character’s experience total is lowered take minimum damage from physical attacks from mortals.
to the mid-point of the previous level (e.g. A 7th level character is
lowered to an experience total mid-way between level 6 and level 7). A power reserve means that a monster has power points and can use
them in aura combat and possibly also to power certain immortal
For all purposes, the creature is considered to now have the lower spells or powers (which will be listed in the monster’s description).
level or hit dice. It does *not* mean that they can create avatars.

The character or monster’s attack bonus and saving throws are These three are separate abilities, and a given monster can have
reduced to those of the lower level, as are the number of spells that any combination of them or none of them. A monter having one
the character can prepare. If the character has now more prepared of these three abilities does not automatically mean that it also has
spells than they should have, the excess are lost. However, it is not the other two.
necessary to reduce the hit points, skills, or weapon feats that a
character has. Characters do not “forget” these abilities. Undead Lieges
With the exception of mindless skeletons and zombies, undead
When a character regains lost experience levels, they only regain creatures can control lesser undead creatures.
the things that were lost. They do not gain extra hit points, skills
or weapon feats. An undead with three or more hit dice can try to take control of
lesser undead in the same way that clerics can try to turn undead.
Exalted
Immortals normally only take minimum damage from mortal level Normally, an undead creature can only try to take control of a lesser
physical attacks and are immune to magic cast by mortals. undead if it has at least twice as many hit dice (or levels in the case
of a lich) as the lesser undead.
Exalted monsters (monsters with the exalted keyword) are not im-
mortal themselves, but may affect immortals with spells and with Table 18–2 gives the bonus when making a standard check in
magic as if they are immortal. order to control the lesser undead based on the hit dice of the
liege. If the check succeeds then the liege has successfully taken
However, immortals may still use their anti-magic against spells control of the lesser undead. Unlike a cleric turning undead, this
cast by exalted monsters, and may still save vs. physical attacks to control is permanent until broken by an outside force or until the
take half damage from their physical attacks. liege is destroyed.

Spell Immunity Undead lieges that can cast spells add +4 to their rolls, and if the
Some monsters are immune to low level spells, for example a lich lesser undead is already the minion of a different undead liege,
is immune to spells of level 3 or lower. then the liege will immediately recognise this and will get a –8
penalty to the roll.

261
Chapter 18 - Monsters
Table 18–2: Controlling Undead by Liege Hit Dice It can also see and hear through any of its
minions’ senses by concentrating. If the

Phantom
Hit Dice

Skeleton

Vampire
Mummy
liege desires, it can totally control the ac-
Zombie

Spectre
Wraith

Haunt
Wight
Ghoul

Spirit
tions of its minions (no saving throw is al-
lowed) to the extent of forcing them to kill
themselves.
3–4 +11 +5 +2 – – – – – – – –
5–6 +16 +11 +5 +2 – – – – – – – This link and control only extends as far as
the direct minions of a liege. In the example
7–8 +18 +16 +11 +5 +2 – – – – – –
above with the lich and the spectre, the lich
9–10 C +18 +16 +11 +5 +2 – – – – – could see through the eyes of the spectre
11–13 C C +18 +16 +11 +5 +2 – – – – and control it, but cannot see through the
14–16 C C C +18 +16 +11 +5 +2 – – – eyes of the skeletons or control them. The
closest it can manage is to command the
17–19 C C C C +18 +16 +11 +5 – – –
spectre to relay commands to the skeletons.
20–23 C C C C C +18 +16 +11 +2 – –
24–27 C C C C C C +18 +16 +5 +2 – Monster Leaders
28–32 C C C C C C C +18 +11 +5 +2 Many humanoid monsters live in tribes or
clans, and are led by their strongest mem-
33+ C C C C C C C C +16 +11 +5 bers.
If Table 18–2 shows a ‘c’ rather than a number, then taking control
is automatically successful. These particularly powerful chieftains (and their bodyguards and
enforcers) should be given one to three more hit dice than the listed
There are two exceptions to this rule. value for the monster type.

Firstly, any undead that creates creatures similar to itself by draining Remember that when giving monsters extra hit dice in this way,
the life from victims (e.g. A spectre or a vampire) can automatically this will change their attack bonus and may change the level of
take control of those new undead as soon as they rise, even though proficiency that they have with their chosen weapons.
they have more than half the number of hit dice that the liege has.
Shamans & Sorcerers
Secondly, if an undead creature has the power to summon other Some monsters are capable of spell casting by becoming either
undead, the summoned undead are automatically controlled by shamans or sorcerers. In these cases, the individual monster descrip-
the liege, even if they have more than half its hit dice. tions will say what level of spell casting such monsters can achieve.

In any of these situations, an undead liege may only control lesser The levels given are the maximum levels that the monster type can
undead with a total number of hit dice less than or equal to double achieve, and not all sorcerers or shamans will be that level.
its own hit dice or level. However, an undead liege can release previ-
ously controlled minions in order to make room for the new ones. Shamans and sorcerers are tougher than their normal counterparts.
For each level of shaman or sorcerer casting ability, the monster
Undead that are the minions of a liege can themselves be lieges gains two additional hit points. These extra hit points can take the
with minions of their own. For example, a lich could be a liege monster over the normal maximum for its hit dice.
with a spectre minion, and the spectre itself could be the liege of
a number of skeleton minions. The extra hit dice do not increase the attack bonus of the monster,
nor do they give it extra proficiency with their chosen weapons.
An undead liege has a telepathic link to all of its minions and can
talk to them at will. See Chapter 7 – Spells & Spell Casting for details of shaman
and sorcerer spells and how they acquire and cast them.

262
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Adamant Angel
Type: exalted Type: exalted
extraplanar extraplanar
construct Habitat: extraplanar (rare)
Habitat: extraplanar (rare) Wandering Group: 1d2 (see below)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Lair Group: 1d2 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (nil) Move: 40’ (fly 120’)
Move: 0’ Armour Class: –6* {–4 vs 3}
Armour Class: –15* Hit Dice: 20****** (90hp)
Hit Dice: 100******** Attack Bonus: +15 {+8}
(1,000hp) Attacks: sword {2d6+8}
Attack Bonus: +48 Weapon Expertise: grand master
Attacks: nil {deflect x3}
Power Reserve: 5,000 {disarm at –4}
vs. Spell Attack: +8 {hurl 5/10/15}
vs. Physical Attack: +14 vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Mental Attack:: see below vs. Wand: +14
vs. Power Attack:: +12 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13
Intelligence: 20 (see below) vs. Dragon Breath: +12
Morale: +19 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11
XP Value: 196,775 Intelligence: 16
Morale: +18
XP Value: 13,175

An adamant is a type of construct created Adamants can use the Cast Mortal Magic If a mortal comes to the attention of an
by immortals to imprison other immortals spell, and can use aura combat, but have immortal patron, but dies without reach-
or similarly powerful entities. Adamants no other way of using power points (see ing immortality themselves, their patron
do not breed, and are always created for Chapter 17 – Immortals for details about may make them into an angel, a powerful
a purpose. power reserve and power points). creature of order and peace.

An adamant usually looks like a cell, sar- As constructs, they are immune to all mind Angels serve as the emissaries and servants
cophagus or other prison made of what affecting spells even if cast by immortals, of their patron, and also work to slay their
appears to be black volcanic glass, the and they do not naturally heal – although patron’s enemies, although such tasks are
exact shape and size of an adamant is they can cure themselves using magic. given sparingly since sending an angel to
up to the immortal who creates it, but kill the followers of a rival immortal pretty
it must be somewhere between  5’x5’x5’ Normally, an adamant will use power attack much escalates any disagreement between
and 100’x100’x100’. An adamant is not on its prisoner immediately the prisoner the immortals into outright war.
sapient, and can only react instinctively to regains any power points, in order to pre-
fulfil its purpose – although it will attempt vent its prisoner from assuming spirit form Angels are always winged humanoids, and
to fulfil the spirit of its purpose rather than or from using any immortal level magic of they appear as the original mortal did in the
the exact letter. their own. prime of their life.

Usually this purpose will be to prevent a Angels are immune to all spells of 4th level
particular being from escaping from it and or lower, and are immune to fire and poison.
prevent any other beings from rescuing its
prisoner. An adamant will react to threats Angels can cast spells as a 12th level cleric,
intelligently, but will not normally respond and in addition they can cast the Teleport
lethally; trying to stop rather than kill. spell at will.

Like immortals, adamants are immune Once per day, an angel can fire a bolt of
to mortal level magic and take minimum peace, which is the same size and shape as
damage from physical attacks from mor- a Lightning Bolt spell, and which causes all
tals. They also make saving throws against creatures hit by it to be incapable of vio-
attacks as immortals do (see Chapter 17 – lence or malice for 2d6x10 minutes (no sav-
Immortals for details about immortal de- ing throw allowed).
fences).

263
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Animal (Herd) Animated Object (L)


Type: animal Type: enchanted
Habitat: any (common) construct
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Habitat: any (rare)
Lair Group: 3d10 (nil) Wandering Group: 0
Move: 80’ Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Armour Class: 7 Move: 30’
Hit Dice: 2 (9hp) Armour Class: 4
Attack Bonus: +2 Hit Dice: 5 (23hp)
Attacks: butt (1d4+1) Attack Bonus: see below
vs. Death/Poison: +8 Attacks: bash (2d8)
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +9
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Morale: +7 Intelligence: 0
XP Value: 20 Morale: +19
XP Value: 175

Angels are usually provided with magical Herd animals, ranging from sheep and goats Animated objects are objects that have been
swords by their patrons, and regardless of to elks and bison, exist in most parts of the brought to life by the 6th level Animate
the type of sword that they wield they can world. They are normally found in extended Objects spell.
make them burst into flame once per day. family groups and small herds, but occa-
This lasts for 30 minutes, and increases the sionally a lone male will be found wander- Animated objects have no intelligence, and
sword’s damage to 4d8. ing on its own. mindlessly perform whatever task their crea-
tor sets them to.
Animal herds are not normally aggressive
and will usually run from any perceived When fighting, an animated object uses the
danger, although some of the larger types same attack bonus as their creator.
may be provoked into circling defensively
and protecting their young against the at-
tacks of potential predators.

264
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Animated Object (M) Animated Object (S) Animated Object (T)


Type: enchanted Type: enchanted Type: enchanted
construct construct construct
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (rare)
Wandering Group: 0 Wandering Group: 0 Wandering Group: 0
Lair Group: 2 (nil) Lair Group: 4 (nil) Lair Group: 8 (nil)
Move: 30’ Move: 30’ Move: 20’
Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 8 Armour Class: 10
Hit Dice: 3 (14hp) Hit Dice: 1 (5hp) Hit Dice: ½ (3hp)
Attack Bonus: special Attack Bonus: special Attack Bonus: special
Attacks: bash (1d8) Attacks: bash (1d4) & Attacks: bash (1d2)
vs. Death/Poison: +8 bash (1d4) vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Intelligence: 0 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 0
Morale: +19 Intelligence: 0 Morale: +19
XP Value: 35 Morale: +19 XP Value: 5
XP Value: 15

Animated objects are objects that have been Animated objects are objects that have been Animated objects are objects that have been
brought to life by the 6th level Animate brought to life by the 6th level Animate brought to life by the 6th level Animate
Objects spell. Objects spell. Objects spell.

Animated objects have no intelligence, and Animated objects have no intelligence, and Animated objects have no intelligence, and
mindlessly perform whatever task their crea- mindlessly perform whatever task their crea- mindlessly perform whatever task their crea-
tor sets them to. tor sets them to. tor sets them to.

When fighting, an animated object uses the When fighting, an animated object uses the When fighting, an animated object uses the
same attack bonus as their creator. same attack bonus as their creator. same attack bonus as their creator.

265
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Ant (Giant) Ape (Cave) Ape (Rock Baboon)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: underground (rare) Habitat: underground (rare) Habitat: hills (common)
desert (common) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) grassland (common)
Wandering Group: 2d4 (u) Lair Group: 2d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 2d6 (u)
Lair Group: 14d6 (see below) Move: 40’ Lair Group: 5d6
Move: 60’ Armour Class: 6 Move: 40’
Armour Class: 5 Hit Dice: 4 (18hp) Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 4* (18hp) Attack Bonus: +4 Hit Dice: 2 (9hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attacks: claw (1d4) & Attack Bonus: +2
Attacks: bite (2d6) claw (1d4) Attacks: club (1d6) &
vs. Death/Poison: +8 -or- bite (1d3)
vs. Wand: +7 rock (1d6) vs. Death/Poison: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
Intelligence: 1 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Morale: +11 or 12 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 2
XP Value: 125 Intelligence: 2 Morale: +13
Morale: +11 XP Value: 20
XP Value: 75

Giant ants are large black ants, about 5’–7’ Cave apes are large gorilla-like apes that Rock baboons are large omnivorous apes.
long. Unlike their smaller cousins who live have lived underground for generations, They are far more aggressive than most other
in colonies of thousands, giant ants live in and have lost their colouring – leaving them apes, and are also more intelligent  –  al-
colonies of about 14d6 individuals, 10d6 white with pink eyes. though their use of tools is limited to pick-
of which will be out gathering food at any ing up branches for use as rudimentary
given time and the remaining 4d6 will be They are generally peaceful creatures, con- clubs.
guarding the nest. tent to scavenge for fungus and mushrooms,
and will flee from any strangers unless the Rock baboons will go out of their way to
The morale of giant ants that are scavenging strangers approach their lair. scare off anyone intruding into their terri-
is 7, but when defending the nest and the tory, and won’t hesitate to resort to violence
(non-combatant) queen, their morale is 12 Cave apes will noisily threaten any who if intruders don’t leave quickly enough.
and they will fight to the death without any come too close to their lair, and if the
self-preservation instinct. threats fail they will throw rocks at the in-
truders until they either leave or get close
Giant ants are nocturnal omnivores, al- enough to fight in melee.
though they will not normally attack live
prey unless they outnumber it greatly. They Cave apes are considerably less intelligent
prefer to scavenge corpses and vegetable than the gorillas they descended from, al-
matter. though they are often tamed by neander-
thals and used as pets and guards.
For some reason, giant ants are sometimes
attracted to shiny objects, and they will grab
them and return them to their lair. They are
even known to sometimes dig gold, and
there is a 30% chance that their lair will
contain 1d10x1,000gp worth of gold nug-
gets.

266
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Ape (Snow) Athach Basilisk


Type: animal Type: giant Type: monster
Habitat: mountains (rare) Habitat: woods (rare) Habitat: underground (rare)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) mountain (rare) woods (rare)
Lair Group: 2d6 (k) Wandering Group: 1d3 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil)
Move: 30’ Lair Group: 1d6 (i) Lair Group: 1d6 (f )
Armour Class: 6 Move: 60’ Move: 20’
Hit Dice: 3+1 (14hp) Armour Class: 0 Armour Class: 4
Attack Bonus: +4 Hit Dice: 14* (63hp) Hit Dice: 6+1** (28hp)
Attacks: club (1d6) & Attack Bonus: +12 Attack Bonus: +6
hug (2d6) Attacks: bash (2d12) & Attacks: bite (1d10) &
vs. Death/Poison: +9 bash (2d12) & gaze (petrify)
vs. Wand: +8 bash (2d12) & vs. Death/Poison: +11
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 bite (2d10 + vs. Wand: +10
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 poison) v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Death/Poison: +14 vs. Dragon Breath: +8
Intelligence: 4 vs. Wand: +14 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7
Morale: +11 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13 Intelligence: 2
XP Value: 50 vs. Dragon Breath: +12 Morale: +16
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11 XP Value: 950
Intelligence: 8
Morale: +11
XP Value: 2,500

Snow apes are a (barely) sapient species of An athach is an 18’ tall hideously deformed A basilisk is an 8’–12’ long snake with a
ape with long white fur. giant with three arms, their third arm pro- crown like crest on its head. Often called
truding from their chests. the “king of snakes”, it is feared for its
Their fur makes them extremely difficult deadly gaze.
to spot in snowy terrain, allowing them to Athachs are rather stupid and very bad tem-
surprise opponents on a 1–4. pered, and will normally kill and eat anyone The bite of a basilisk is not poisonous, but
they meet who does not give them gems any creature meeting its gaze must make
Although sapient, snow apes have no spo- and jewellery. Athach families are violent a saving throw vs. petrify or be turned to
ken language, communicating only by sign affairs, and only the strongest and meanest stone.
language. They have no material culture, children survive into adulthood – where-
living out in the open and using no tools upon they almost always end up killing their The gaze of a basilisk must be direct, seeing
more advanced than a club. aging and weakening parents. its reflection is not enough to have a chance
of being turned to stone. However, a basi-
Snow apes are very kind and caring to their Athachs normally attack by simply bashing lisk is not immune to its own gaze attack,
own species, but violently xenophobic to all their opponents with whatever comes to and if presented with a mirror, there is a 1
other species. They only consider creatures hand (rocks, tree stumps, and so on) and in 6 chance per round that it will see its
that can communicate with them to be biting with their poisonous tusks. Anyone reflection and must make the saving throw
intelligent, dismissing the speech of other bitten by an athach must make a saving to avoid petrifying itself. This is the only
humanoid races as just “animal noises”. throw vs. poison or be helpless for 1d6 x 10 circumstance in which its gaze is effective
minutes. through a mirror.
Snow apes are very strong, and if one suc-
ceeds with a hug attack, it will hold on to Any character surprised by a basilisk auto-
its victim automatically doing 2d6 damage matically meets its gaze and must make the
per round. saving throw, and in combat each charac-
ter attacking the basilisk without actively
avoiding the gaze must also make the saving
throw each round.

Characters trying to fight the basilisk blind-


folded or otherwise averting their gaze will
not be affected but must attack with a –4
penalty to hit and the basilisk gets a +2
bonus against characters using such tactics.

267
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Bat Bat (Giant)


Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: underground Habitat: underground
(common) (common)
Wandering Group: 1d100 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d10 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d100 (nil) Lair Group: 1d10 (nil)
Move: 3’ Move: 10’
Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 1/4 (1hp) Hit Dice: 2 (9hp)
Attack Bonus: +0 Attack Bonus: +2
Attacks: special Attacks: bite (1d4)
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2
Morale: +9 Morale: +13
XP Value: 5 XP Value: 20

A character using a mirror to attack in melee Bats are normally inoffensive and will not Giant bats can be as tall as a human and can
(the mirror takes one hand, so the character attack anything larger than a small insect. grow up to a 25’ wingspan.
cannot use an off-hand weapon or a shield
at the same time) takes only a –2 penalty However, when either panicking or con-
to hit and the basilisk gets no bonus against trolled by another creature, a flock of bats
them. can be very confusing as they fly around
an opponent.
Basilisks are not normally aggressive, eating
only small animals which they must hunt Any character with ten or more bats at-
by taking them by surprise in order to avoid tacking them will be bewildered and suffer
accidentally turning them to stone. a –2 penalty on both to-hit rolls and saving
throws. Additionally, a bewildered character
may not cast spells.

268
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Bat (Giant, Vampire) Bear (Black) Bear (Cave)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: underground Habitat: woods (common) Habitat: underground (rare)
(common) Wandering Group: 1d4 (u) Wandering Group: 1d2 (v)
Wandering Group: 1d10 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Lair Group: 1d2 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d10 (nil) Move: 40’ Move: 40’
Move: 10’ Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 5
Armour Class: 6 Hit Dice: 4 (18hp) Hit Dice: 7 (28hp)
Hit Dice: 2* (9hp) Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +7
Attack Bonus: +2 Attacks: claw (1d3) & Attacks: claw (2d4) &
Attacks: bite (1d4 + paralyse) claw (1d3) & claw (2d4) &
vs. Death/Poison: +8 bite (1d6) bite (2d6)
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +9
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Morale: +13 Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2
XP Value: 25 Morale: +11 Morale: +16
XP Value: 75 XP Value: 450

Giant vampire bats are similar to other giant Black bears are about 6’ tall and live in for- Cave bears are large and particularly aggres-
bats except that they have a paralysing bite ests where they survive on an omnivorous sive bears that can be 15’ tall when standing.
which allows them to drink blood. diet, particularly favouring fish.
Unlike most bears they are exclusively car-
Anyone bitten by a giant vampire bat must They are inquisitive creatures and will often nivorous, and are active hunters.
make a saving throw vs. paralysis or be raid camps looking for food.
paralysed for 1d10 rounds. Giant vampire If a cave bear hits with both claw attacks, it
bats can drain blood (for 1d4 damage per If a black bear hits with both claw attacks, will hug the victim for an additional 2d8
round) from paralysed creatures, but will it will hug the victim for an additional 2d8 damage.
only start to do so when all their opponents damage.
are paralysed in this manner.

Creatures slain by a giant vampire bat must


make a saving throw vs. spells or return as
an undead 24 hours later. The type of un-
dead should be determined by rolling 1d6
and consulting the following list:

1–3 = zombie
4–5 = ghoul
6 = wight

269
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Bear (Grizzly) Bear (Polar) Bee (Giant)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: hills (common) Habitat: arctic (rare) Habitat: hills (rare)
woods (common) Wandering Group: 1 (u) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil)
Wandering Group: 1 (u) Lair Group: 1d2 (nil) Lair Group: 5d6 (see below)
Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Move: 40’ Move: 50’
Move: 40’ Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 7
Armour Class: 8 Hit Dice: 6 (27hp) Hit Dice: ½* (3hp)
Hit Dice: 5 (23hp) Attack Bonus: +6 Attack Bonus: +1
Attack Bonus: +5 Attacks: claw (1d6) & Attacks: sting (1d3+poison)
Attacks: claw (1d8) & claw (1d6) & vs. Death/Poison: +8
claw (1d8) & bite (1d10) vs. Wand: +7
bite (1d10) vs. Death/Poison: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Wand: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Wand: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 Intelligence: 0
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Morale: +16 (see below)
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Intelligence: 2 XP Value: 6
Intelligence: 2 Morale: +13
Morale: +17 XP Value: 275
XP Value: 175

Grizzly bears are large (up to 9’ tall) brown Polar bears are white furred carnivorous Giant bees are large insects, up to 1’ long.
bears, commonly found in forested areas. bears that can reach 11’ tall. They are normally peaceful when out col-
They have a widely varied omnivorous diet, lecting pollen and fruit, and will ignore
preferring fruit and fish; although they will Their normal diet consists of fish and seals, creatures that do not molest them, fight-
also hunt small animals. and they encounter humanoids rarely ing only in self-defence.
enough that they have no fear of them and
They won’t attack humanoids for food, al- see them as another source of food. However, any creature that comes with-
though they are notoriously short tempered in 30’ of their hive will be attacked by every
and territorial, and will chase and fight bee in the hive and the colony will fight to
those who come too near, particularly in the death.
the spring after the females emerge from
hibernation and give birth. The ferocity of When a giant bee stings an opponent, the
mother grizzly bears protecting their cubs opponent must make a saving throw vs.
is legendary. poison or die. However, the attacking bee
is always killed by the attack, as the stinger
comes loose and sticks in the wound.

A character with a giant bee sting in them


continues to lose one hit point per round
until they spend an action removing the
stinger, although they need not make fur-
ther saving throws vs. poison after the initial
sting.

The hive will contain a non-combatant


queen bee, and her 1d4+2 drones, each of
which has 1 hit dice (5hp, 13xp).

A giant bee hive will contain about two


pints of honey, which can be distilled down
into a single potion of healing.

270
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Beetle (Bombard) Beetle (Fire) Beetle (Tiger)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: underground Habitat: underground Habitat: underground
(common) (common) (common)
Wandering Group: 1d8 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d8 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil)
Lair Group: 2d6 (nil) Lair Group: 2d6 (nil) Lair Group: 2d4 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ Move: 50’
Armour Class: 4 Armour Class: 4 Armour Class: 3
Hit Dice: 2* (9hp) Hit Dice: 1+2 (7hp) Hit Dice: 3+1 (15hp)
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +4
Attacks: bite (1d6) & Attacks: bite (2d4) Attacks: bite (2d6)
special vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 0 Intelligence: 0
Intelligence: 0 Morale: +11 Morale: +16
Morale: +13 XP Value: 15 XP Value: 50
XP Value: 25

Giant bombard beetles are 3’ long beetles Giant fire beetles are 2’–3’ in length, and Giant tiger beetles are 4’ long black beetles
that live underground and eat detritus. have glowing red spots above their eyes that with large (2’ long) mandibles that they use
give off normal (non-magical) light within to bite prey.
When surprised or attacked, a giant bom- a 10’ radius, about the strength of a single
bard beetle will respond by squirting a hot candle. They will not normally attack creatures
acid at a foe within 5’ (it can only do this larger than themselves unless they are either
once per combat, and will do so at the ear- If removed, the glands will continue to glow cornered or starving.
liest opportunity). This acid is not enough for 1d6 days before fading.
to cause significant damage, but it is highly
irritant and causes the target to take a –2
penalty to attack rolls and ability checks
for the next 24 hours or until the victim is
cured by a Cure Light Wounds spell.

271
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Black Pudding Blackball


Type: ooze Type: extraplanar
Habitat: underground exalted
(common) Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (see below) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (see below) Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Move: 20’ Move: 10’
Armour Class: 6* Armour Class: 9*
Hit Dice: 10* (45hp) Hit Dice: see below
Attack Bonus: +10 Attack Bonus: +28
Attacks: touch (3d8) Attacks: touch
vs. Death/Poison: +10 (see below)
vs. Wand: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +18
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 vs. Wand: +18
vs. Dragon Breath: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +18
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +18
Intelligence: 0 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +18
Morale: +19 Intelligence: see below
XP Value: 1,750 Morale: +19
XP Value: 7,500

A black pudding is a large dark coloured Blackballs may be the most enigmatic and Blackballs are utterly immune to everything
ooze anywhere from 5’ to 30’ across. Black powerful of creatures, and even immortals and cannot be controlled or harmed in any
puddings have no intelligence or instinct are afraid of them. Or they may not be way except that they are subject to the Tel-
other than to absorb and digest anything creatures at all. No-one knows for certain. eport spell.
they can get to. They will always attack and
fight to the death, and do such unintelligent A blackball is a 5’ diameter featureless flying
things as moving straight through fire to sphere that is pure black in colour (no light
get to an opponent rather than avoiding it. is reflected from it).

Despite their size, black puddings can Anything a blackball touches simply dis-
squeeze their bulk through holes as small appears utterly (no saving throw) leaving
as an inch in diameter (although doing so absolutely no trace, although this ability
will be very slow, taking 10 minutes. Their appears to be at least somewhat controlled,
corrosive slime can also corrode through a since a blackball can travel through air or
wood or metal object the size of a normal water without destroying them.
door in 10 minutes, but cannot eat through
stone. Blackballs can spend centuries or even
millennia simply sitting motionless in one
Black puddings can move along walls or place. Then for no explicable reason one
ceilings as easily as floors. may suddenly start moving – eating its way
through rock and metal and even Force Field
Black puddings are very resilient, and fire spells without slowing down. It will travel
is the only thing that can kill them. Oth- for miles, and even cross planes through
er attacks will simply break the pudding gates or natural boundaries, until it gets
into 2hd chunks that do only 1d8 damage. to a specific creature or object; and then it
These smaller puddings cannot be further destroys that target and lays dormant again.
damaged apart from by fire.
Although their behaviour while moving ap-
Black puddings do not carry treasure, but pears to be intelligent, no-one has ever been
the area around them may contain indigest- able to communicate meaningfully with a
ible gemstones (the only remains of those blackball, and no magic is able to read (or
that have been eaten by the pudding). even detect) its mind.

272
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Blink Dog Boar Boar (Great)


Type: monster Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: clear (common) Habitat: woods (common) Habitat: woods (rare)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d6+3 (c) Lair Group: 1d6 (nil) Lair Group: 1d6 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 30’ Move: 30’
Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 3
Hit Dice: 4* (18hp) Hit Dice: 3* (13hp) Hit Dice: 7* (32hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +7
Attacks: bite (1d6) Attacks: tusk (2d4) Attacks: tusk (2d8)
vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +10
vs. Wand: +8 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +9
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +7
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6
Intelligence: 9 Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2
Morale: +9 Morale: +16 Morale: +16
XP Value: 125 XP Value: 50 XP Value: 1,750

Blink dogs are intelligent wild dogs with the Boars are the larger wild relatives of pigs. Great boars look and behave like their nor-
ability to teleport from place to place. They They are notoriously bad tempered and mal cousins, except that they can stand 8’
are smaller than wolves, and more jackal- territorial, and will often attack even large at the shoulder.
like in appearance. opponents at the slightest provocation.
Like a normal boar, a great boar can do a
Blink dogs have their own language, but A boar can do a charge action in combat. charge action in combat. If it charges for 20’
unfortunately their mouths are shaped If it charges for 20’ or more it does double or more it does double damage on its at-
wrongly for speaking humanoid tongues, damage on its attack, but is vulnerable to tack, but is vulnerable to people doing set
although they often understand them. people doing set spear actions. spear actions.
Blink dogs are friendly towards humans
and demi-humans, and will often live near
rural villages for mutual benefit.

Although blink dogs can teleport at will,


their teleports (or “blinks”) are only short
range (40’ at the most). They will instinc-
tively avoid teleporting into objects. In
combat, their preferred tactic is teleport
up to a victim, bite them, and then im-
mediately teleport 1d4x10’ away.

273
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Bugbear Caecilian (Giant) Camel


Type: humanoid Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: hills (common) Habitat: grassland (rare) Habitat: desert (common)
woods (common) Wandering Group: 1d3 (nil) Wandering Group: nil (nil)
Wandering Group: 2d8 (p+q) Lair Group: 1d3 (b) Lair Group: 2d4 (nil)
Lair Group: 5d4 (b) Move: 20’ Move: 50’
Move: 30’ Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 7
Armour Class: 5 Hit Dice: 6* (27hp) Hit Dice: 2 (9hp)
Hit Dice: 3+1 (14hp) Attack Bonus: +6 Attack Bonus: +2
Attack Bonus: +5 {+2} Attacks: bite (1d8) Attacks: bite (1) &
Attacks: spear {1d6+2}+1 vs. Death/Poison: +9 kick (1d4)
Weapon Expertise: skilled vs. Wand: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +8
{set vs. charge} v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Wand: +7
{throw vs. Dragon Breath: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
range 20/40/60} vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Death/Poison: +9 Intelligence: 0 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Wand: +8 Morale: +16 Intelligence: 2
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 XP Value: 500 Morale: +11
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 XP Value: 20
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Intelligence: 7
Morale: +16
XP Value: 50

Bugbears are large and strong creatures re- Much like their smaller cousins, caecilians Camels are large domesticated beasts of
lated to goblins. are carnivorous amphibians that burrow burden that are well adapted for desert en-
into damp soil and earth and hunt by am- vironments.
They stand about 8’ tall and have brown bushing smaller creatures that walk over
furred bodies, with round orange heads that them. Camels have one or two distinctive “humps”
look remarkably like carved pumpkins. on their back which are full of fat deposits.
Giant caecilians grow to about  30’ long, These humps can allow the camel for travel
Despite this appearance, they are stealthy and can swallow whole any creature human for long periods without needing to eat or
and surprise opponents on a 1–3. sized or smaller that they bite if they roll an drink.
unmodified 19 or 20 and the attack hits.
Bugbears are not the smartest of humanoids, Swallowed creatures take 1d8 damage per Camels are commonly used by desert tribes
and their technology is limited to simple round until they or the caecilian are killed. for meat, milk and transport.
spears and knives. They live as hunters, and
will often raid farms for livestock. Some-
times bugbears will live with goblins as
hired muscle, although they rarely lead gob-
lin tribes as the goblins can out-think them.

The most intelligent bugbears can become


shamans (up to level 6) or sorcerers (up to
level 4).

274
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Cat (Lion) Cat (Mountain Lion) Cat (Panther)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: grassland Habitat: mountains Habitat: jungle (common)
(common) (common) Wandering Group: 1d2 (u)
Wandering Group: 1d4 (u) underground (rare) Lair Group: 1d6 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d8 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (u) Move: 70’
Move: 50’ Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Armour Class: 4
Armour Class: 6 Move: 50’ Hit Dice: 4 (18hp)
Hit Dice: 5 (23hp) Armour Class: 6 Attack Bonus: +4
Attack Bonus: +5 Hit Dice: 3+2 (16hp) Attacks: claw (1d4) &
Attacks: claw (1d4+1) & Attack Bonus: +4 claw (1d4) &
claw (1d4+1) & Attacks: claw (1d3) & bite (1d8)
bite (1d10) claw (1d3) & vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Death/Poison: +9 bite (1d6) vs. Wand: +7
vs. Wand: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 Intelligence: 2
Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Morale: +13
Morale: +16 Intelligence: 2 XP Value: 75
XP Value: 175 Morale: +13
XP Value: 50

Lions are big cats up to 8’ long that live in Mountain lions, also known as pumas or Panthers are dark furred cats, about  6’
small family groups called prides. cougars, are smaller and less muscled than long. They are agile, quick and lithe, and
their plains dwelling cousins, although they are excellent climbers. A favourite hunting
Male lions have a distinctive mane, and are reach similar lengths. strategy is to hide in a tree and leap down
relatively inactive. Although they are very knocking prey to the ground.
territorial towards other male lions, they Mountain lions hunt alone, and will ag-
will often ignore non-lion creatures unless gressively attack human sized creatures only Panthers hunt either alone or as a mated
threatened. if cornered or starving. However, they are pair.
inquisitive creatures who love to explore
Female lions are active hunters, and work (including cave systems) and are easily at- Unlike many other cats, they are also strong
well together. Some will lie in ambush while tracted to camp sites by the smell of cook- swimmers, and will readily chase prey into
others chase potential prey towards them. ing food. water.

Mountain lions are often trained by dwarves


and fulfil the roles that guard and hunting
dogs fill for humanoid species that live in
lowlands.

275
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Cat (Sabretooth) Cat (Tiger) Catoblepas


Type: animal Type: animal Type: monster
Habitat: grasslands Habitat: woods (common) Habitat: swamp
(very rare) Wandering Group: 1 (u) (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1d4 (v) Lair Group: 1d3 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Move: 50’ Lair Group: 1d3 (c)
Move: 50’ Armour Class: 6 Move: 20’
Armour Class: 6 Hit Dice: 6 (27hp) Armour Class: 7*
Hit Dice: 8 (36hp) Attack Bonus: +6 Hit Dice: 7** (32hp)
Attack Bonus: +8 Attacks: claw (1d6) & Attack Bonus: +7
Attacks: claw (1d8) & claw (1d6) & Attacks: tail (1d6) &
claw (1d8) & bite (2d6) gaze (special)
bite (2d8) vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Wand: +8 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Wand: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2
Intelligence: 2 Morale: +16 Morale: +13
Morale: +17 XP Value: 275 XP Value: 1,250
XP Value: 650

Sabretooth tigers are normally found only Tigers are heavily built cats up to 8’ long. A catoblepas is a horrible beast about the
in “lost world” areas. They are very large They are easily recognised for their distinc- size of a hippopotamus, but with a long
and strong cats (up to 12’ long) with over- tive orange and black striped markings. neck and tail. Its head is boar shaped, al-
sized canine teeth, which give them their though its tusks are small and not useful
name. These markings provide remarkably effec- in combat.
tive camouflage in wooded surroundings,
The fangs of the sabretooth tiger are present causing the tiger to surprise their opponents Catoblepes are generally peaceful creatures
in both sexes, and are used for hunting. on a 1–4 on 1d6. that live in swamps and eat all kinds of poi-
sonous plants. They are slow moving and
Sabretooth tigers are built for strength Unlike other cats, tigers are keen swimmers. rather ungainly, and would rather simply
rather than speed, and their usual hunting be left alone than seek out fights; but if
tactic is to stalk their prey and leap at it threatened they will attack in self-defence
from ambush. They will not usually bother by lashing with their long tails.
to chase fleeing prey unless it is obviously
injured or weak. The catoblepas’ most dangerous weapon is
its gaze. Anyone who a catoblepas gazes at
must make a saving throw vs. death ray or
be slain instantly. Unlike the gaze of a basi-
lisk or medusa, it doesn’t matter whether the
victim has their eyes closed or is facing away
from the catoblepas – it is the catoblepas
gazing at the victim that causes the death,
not the other way around.

276
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Centaur Centipede (Giant)


Type: monster Type: animal
Habitat: woods (common) Habitat: woods (rare)
clear (common) underground
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) (common)
Lair Group: 2d10 (a) Wandering Group: 2d4 (nil)
Move: 60’ Lair Group: 1d8 (nil)
Armour Class: 5 {–1 vs 1} Move: 20’
Hit Dice: 4* (18hp) Armour Class: 9
Attack Bonus: +4 {+1} Hit Dice: 1/2* (3hp)
Attacks: hoof (1d6) & Attack Bonus: +0
hoof (1d6) or Attacks: bite (special)
bow {1d8+1} vs. Death/Poison: +7
Weapon Expertise: skilled vs. Wand: +6
{delay s/m} v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +5
{missile range vs. Dragon Breath: +4
90/150/220} vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +3
vs. Death/Poison: +9 Intelligence: 0
vs. Wand: +8 Morale: +11
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 XP Value: 6
vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Intelligence: 10
Morale: +13
XP Value: 125

Luckily for most victims, the catoblepas’ Centaurs have the body and legs of a horse, Giant centipedes are larger cousins of nor-
heavy head and weak neck mean that it only with a human torso (plus head and arms) mal centipedes that can reach 1’ in length.
has a 1 in 4 chance per round of being able rising up where the neck would be. They They have a segmented body with many
to successfully gaze at a single target. How- are as intelligent as normal humans, and pairs of legs, and a pair of large mandibles
ever, if a catoblepas gains surprise in combat, primarily live in woods and forests. with which they can deliver a poisonous
then it will always have the opportunity to bite.
use its gaze during the surprise round. A clan of centaurs will often ally with elves
or with human druids, although they can Giant centipedes normally hide in crevices
Catoblepes are immune to all poisons, en- produce spell casters of their own. or rotten wood and wait for small animals
ergy drains, death rays, and all attacks and to come within reach; then they lunge and
spells that cause an instant death, including Centaurs can reach 8th level as either sha- deliver a poisonous bite to the intruding
Disintegrate spells and the gaze attacks of mans or sorcerers. animal.
other catoblepes.
Centaurs will occasionally trade with hu- Although giant centipede poison is strong
man villages outside of their woods, but are enough to kill a rat or similar sized creature,
very reluctant to allow humans to encroach it will not kill a person. However, it will
on what they see as their lands. cause sickness.

Anyone bitten by a giant centipede must


make a saving throw vs. poison or be sick-
ened for 10 days, during which time they
can only move at half normal speed and
cannot perform any other action.

277
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Chimera Cockatrice Construct (Blood)


Type: monster Type: monster Type: enchanted
Habitat: mountains Habitat: any (very rare) construct
(very rare) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Habitat: any (rare)
hills (very rare) Lair Group: 2d4 (d) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
barren (very rare) Move: 30’ (fly: 60’) Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil) Armour Class: 6 Move: 30’
Lair Group: 1d4 (f ) Hit Dice: 5** (23hp) Armour Class: 9*
Move: 40’ (fly: 60’) Attack Bonus: +5 Hit Dice: 8* (36hp)
Armour Class: 4 Attacks: beak Attack Bonus: +8
Hit Dice: 9** (41hp) (1d6+special) Attacks: hug
Attack Bonus: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +10 (2d6 + special)
Attacks: claw (1d3) & vs. Wand: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +12
claw (1d3) & v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 vs. Wand: +11
butt (2d4) & vs. Dragon Breath: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10
bite (1d10) & vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +9
bite (3d4) & Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
breath (3d6) Morale: +11 Intelligence: 4
vs. Death/Poison: +13 XP Value: 425 Morale: +19
vs. Wand: +12 XP Value: 1,200
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11
vs. Dragon Breath: +9
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
Intelligence: 6
Morale: +16
XP Value: 2,300

A chimera, as the name implies, appears to A cockatrice is a magical creature that looks A construct is an artificial creature created
be a strange combination of other beasts. like a drab grey cockerel with a snake’s tail. by a high level spell caster. Constructs dif-
fer from golems in that golems are made
Chimerae have the rear body of a goat, the A cockatrice is normally peaceful, and is from a single piece of material whereas
front body of a lion, the wings and tail of content to scavenge bits of detritus and constructs are made from material from
a dragon, and three heads – goat, lion and plant material and be left alone. multiple sources.
dragon.
However, should it be attacked it has a very A blood construct is a human sized and
Chimerae are extremely territorial, and will powerful defence mechanism. Any living shaped form made entirely from the blood
aggressively chase intruders away from their (non-plant) creature that touches or is of many creatures held together by magical
lair. Their dragon head is capable of breath- touched by a cockatrice must make a sav- enchantments. Although it is made from
ing fire three times per day in a cone 50’ ing throw vs. petrify or be turned to stone. the blood of dead creatures, it is not an
long and 10’ wide at the end. undead.
Creatures attacking the cockatrice using
Although sapient, chimerae are not terribly natural weapons (including adventurers Blood constructs can only be damaged by
smart, and can often be tricked or bullied using unarmed attacks) must make a sav- magical weapons, and they are immune to
into working for a more powerful creature. ing throw each time they hit, and anyone sleep, charm, and hold spells, and to all
successfully hit by the cockatrice’s attack gasses.
must also make a saving throw.
A blood construct attacks by trying to
smother its victim. Once it hits, it contin-
ues to do 2d6 damage per round without
needing to hit again.

278
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Construct (Clockwork) Construct (Crystal) Construct (Forge)


Type: enchanted Type: enchanted Type: enchanted
construct construct construct
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 60’ Move: 80’
Armour Class: 2* {–2 vs 2} Armour Class: 6* Armour Class: 0*
Hit Dice: 6** (27hp) Hit Dice: 10* (45hp) Hit Dice: 20** (90hp)
Attack Bonus: +6 {+4} Attack Bonus: +10 Attack Bonus: +15
Attacks: sword {2d8} & Attacks: claw (2d6) & Attacks: hammer fist
sword {2d8} & claw (2d6) & (3d10) &
sword {2d8} & bite (2d10) special
sword {2d8} vs. Death/Poison: +10 vs. Death/Poison: +13
Weapon Expertise: skilled vs. Wand: +9 vs. Wand: +12
{deflect x2} v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11
{disarm at –1} vs. Dragon Breath: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +10
vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9
vs. Wand: +8 Intelligence: 4 Intelligence: 4
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 Morale: +19 Morale: +19
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 XP Value: 1,750 XP Value: 5,975
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Intelligence: 4
Morale: +19
XP Value: 725

A construct is an artificial creature created A construct is an artificial creature created A construct is an artificial creature created
by a high level spell caster. Constructs dif- by a high level spell caster. Constructs dif- by a high level spell caster. Constructs dif-
fer from golems in that golems are made fer from golems in that golems are made fer from golems in that golems are made
from a single piece of material whereas from a single piece of material whereas from a single piece of material whereas
constructs are made from material from constructs are made from material from constructs are made from material from
multiple sources. multiple sources. multiple sources.

Clockwork constructs are humanoid figures Crystal constructs are made from a vari- A forge construct is a huge (18’ tall) human-
made from a mass of whirring and clicking ety of crystals magically fused and welded oid with a red-hot skin of riveted iron plates
cogs and mechanisms. They have four arms, together, and are usually used as guards. and a fiery inside. Its two hands are formed
each of which wields a weapon with cold They are normally constructed in the form into a hammer and tongs, and if given a
precision. of huge (7’ tall) crystalline wolves or lions. supply of metal it can make weapons and
armour autonomously by opening its chest
Clockwork constructs normally wield a Crystal constructs can see invisible creatures cavity and using itself as a forge.
sword in each hand, but some may have within 60’ and are excellent trackers.
other weapons; either 2 two-handed or 4 Anyone hit by a forge construct takes an
one-handed weapons. Whatever the weap- Crystal constructs can only be damaged extra 1d10 fire damage from the heat inside
on combination, they are part of the con- by magical weapons, and they are immune it, and anyone who hits a forge construct
struct’s form, so it cannot be disarmed; but to sleep, charm, and hold spells, and to all with an edged weapon must make a saving
neither can it throw or hurl the weapons. gasses. throw vs. death ray or take 2d6 fire damage
from the fire and molten metal that spurts
Clockwork constructs can only be damaged from the wound.
by magical weapons, and they are immune
to sleep, charm, and hold spells, and to all Forge constructs can only be damaged by
gasses. magical weapons, and they are immune to
sleep, charm, and hold spells, and to all gas-
ses. Forge constructs are also immune to
fire-based attacks.

279
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Construct (Manikin) Construct (Scarecrow) Crab (Giant)


Type: enchanted Type: enchanted Type: animal
construct construct Habitat: ocean (rare)
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (rare) river (rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 1d6 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ Move: 20’
Armour Class: 3* {–2 vs 3} Armour Class: 7* Armour Class: 2
Hit Dice: 6** (27hp) Hit Dice: 2+2 (11hp) Hit Dice: 3 (14hp)
Attack Bonus: +6 {+4} Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +3
Attacks: staff {1d8+2} Attacks: fist (1d8) Attacks: claw (2d6) &
Weapon Expertise: expert vs. Death/Poison: +8 claw (2d6)
{deflect x2} vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Death/Poison: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Wand: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 Intelligence: 4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Morale: +19 Intelligence: 2
Intelligence: 4 XP Value: 35 Morale: +11
Morale: +19 XP Value: 35
XP Value: 725

A construct is an artificial creature created A construct is an artificial creature created Giant crabs are large versions of normal
by a high level spell caster. Constructs dif- by a high level spell caster. Constructs dif- crabs, up to 8’ in diameter.
fer from golems in that golems are made fer from golems in that golems are made
from a single piece of material whereas from a single piece of material whereas Unlike normal crabs, giant crabs are actively
constructs are made from material from constructs are made from material from carnivorous and will attack most things
multiple sources. multiple sources. smaller than them that they encounter.

A manikin construct is a large (8’ tall) hu- A scarecrow construct is an animated hu- Giant crabs are normally aquatic, but can
manoid figure made of jointed wooden man sized figure comprised of a set of survive on land for up to half an hour be-
pieces, similar to a string-less puppet. clothes (usually with a sack for a head) fore having to return to the water.
stuffed with straw. Their creators usually
Although not truly intelligent, manikin put heavy weights in their gloves, which Giant crabs do not swim but walk along the
constructs can speak and can be instructed gives them an unbalanced comical lurching bottom of the water.
to perform specific actions or say specific gait, but packs more power behind their
phrases in response to other phrases. This wildly swinging punches.
ability allows them to be used as messengers
or guards for password protected doors. Unfortunately, their stiff movement gives
them a –1 penalty to initiative, and their
Manikin constructs can only be damaged straw burns easily giving them a –2 penalty
by magical weapons, and they are immune to all saving throws against fire-based at-
to sleep, charm, and hold spells, and to all tacks and causing them to take +1 point of
gasses. fire damage per die in the attack.

Scarecrow constructs can only be damaged


by magical weapons, and they are immune
to sleep, charm, and hold spells, and to all
gasses.

280
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Crocodile Crocodile (Giant) Crocodile (Large)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: river (common) Habitat: swamp Habitat: ocean (rare)
swamp (common) (very rare) river (rare)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d8 (nil) Lair Group: 1d3 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (nil)
Move: 30’ (swim: 30’) Move: 30’ (swim: 30’) Move: 30’ (swim 30’)
Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 1 Armour Class: 3
Hit Dice: 2 (9hp) Hit Dice: 15 (68hp) Hit Dice: 6 (27hp)
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +12 Attack Bonus: +6
Attacks: bite (1d8) Attacks: bite (3d8) Attacks: bite (2d8)
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +12 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +11 vs. Wand: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +9 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2
Morale: +11 Morale: +16 Morale: +11
XP Value: 20 XP Value: 1,350 XP Value: 275

Crocodiles are reptiles up to 10’ long that Giant crocodiles are similar to their nor- Large crocodiles tend to be found in salt
live in rivers and swamps. They are air mal cousins, but grow to almost 50’ long water rather than fresh water. Unlike their
breathers, and usually float on the surface and are normally only found in “lost world” freshwater kin they can grow up to 20’ long.
with their nostrils exposed. areas.
Crocodiles come onto land to sun them-
Crocodiles come onto land to sun them- Crocodiles come onto land to sun them- selves, and to lay their eggs, although they
selves, and to lay their eggs, although they selves, and to lay their eggs, although they are less agile on land and do their hunting
are less agile on land and do their hunting are less agile on land and do their hunting in the water, where they are particularly at-
in the water, where they are particularly at- in the water, where they are particularly at- tracted to the smell of blood and by seeing
tracted to the smell of blood and by seeing tracted to the smell of blood and by seeing creatures thrash around.
creatures thrash around. creatures thrash around.

281
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Cthonic Worm Cyclops


Type: monster Type: giant
Habitat: underground Habitat: hils (rare)
(common) mountains (rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d4 (b) Lair Group: 1d4 (e + 5,000gp)
Move: 40’ Move: 30’
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 5
Hit Dice: 3+1* (15hp) Hit Dice: 13* (65hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +9
Attacks: 8 x tentacle Attacks: club (3d10)
(special) or Weapon Expertise: basic
bite (1 point) vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +14
vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +12
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 9
Intelligence: 0 Morale: +16
Morale: +16 XP Value: 2,300
XP Value: 75

A cthonic worm is a hideous creature that A cthonic worm will not try to eat paralysed A cyclops is a giant, usually round 18’ tall,
looks like a cross between a worm and a victims while there are still mobile ones ac- with a single eye in the centre of its forehead.
squid. Its 9’ long worm-like body is thick tively fighting it.
at the front and tapers off towards the rear. Despite their great power, cyclopes are very
The front of the creature has no visible sen- slow-witted and peaceful creatures who are
sory organs, only a beak-like mouth sur- content to herd goats and sheep and be left
rounded by a ring of 5’ long slime-covered alone by others. They are quick to anger,
tentacles. however, and if provoked they are likely to
attack with huge clubs (with which they
Despite the lack of visible sensory organs, have nothing more than basic mastery) or
cthonic worms do have eyes under their by throwing rocks.
skin and use normal vision to detect their
prey. Cyclopes can throw rocks with a range of
(60/130/200) feet, for 3d6 damage.
Cthonic worms will eat anything organic,
and will normally attack victims with their All attacks by cyclopes take a –2 penalty due
tentacles attempting to paralyse them with to their poor depth perception.
their poisonous slime.
Cyclopes can become shamans of up to 4th
Anyone hit by a tentacle must make a level, and (incredibly rarely) sorcerers of up
saving throw vs. paralyse or be paralysed to 2nd level.
for 2d5x10 minutes. The beak of a cthonic
worm is weak, and will not be used for at-
tack except in emergencies (for example in
self-defence against creatures immune to
paralysis) or to eat paralysed victims.

282
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Demon (Balor) Demon (Glabrezu) Demon (Hezrou)


Type: exalted Type: exalted Type: exalted
extraplanar extraplanar extraplanar
Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d2 (g) Lair Group: 1d3 (e) Lair Group: 1d3
Move: 20’ (fly: 60’) Move: 60’ (fly: 20’) Move: 60’ (fly 20’)
Armour Class: 0* Armour Class: 0* Armour Class: 0
Hit Dice: 25********** Hit Dice: 16********** Hit Dice: 13**********
(113hp) (72hp) (59hp)
Attack Bonus: +17+5 {+6} Attack Bonus: +13 Attack Bonus: +11
Attacks: sword {3d6+2}+5 Attacks: pincer (2d6) & Attacks: claw (1d3) &
whip {1d3+3}+5 pincer (2d6) & claw (1d3) &
Weapon Expertise: grand master horn (1d8) & bite (2d8+2)
{deflect x3} horn (1d8) & Power Reserve: 100
{entangle at –4} bite (1d6) vs. Spell Attack: +0
{stun} Power Reserve: 200 vs. Physical Attack: +5
Power Reserve: 300 vs. Spell Attack: +0 vs. Mental Attack: +2
vs. Spell Attack: +0 vs. Physical Attack: +5 vs. Power Attack: +3
vs. Physical Attack: +5 vs. Mental Attack: +2 Intelligence: 20
vs. Mental Attack: +2 vs. Power Attack: +3 Morale: +16
vs. Power Attack: +3 Intelligence: 25 XP Value: 10,850
Intelligence: 30 Morale: +16
Morale: +16 XP Value: 12,850
XP Value: 33,500

Demons are incredibly powerful creatures Demons are incredibly powerful creatures Demons are incredibly powerful creatures
created by immortals from the souls of created by immortals from the souls of created by immortals from the souls of
mortals as agents of chaos and destruction. mortals as agents of chaos and destruction. mortals as agents of chaos and destruction.
All demons are immune to magic cast by All demons are immune to magic cast by All demons are immune to magic cast by
mortals and have anti-magic of +4 against mortals and have anti-magic of +4 against mortals and have anti-magic of +4 against
magic cast by immortals. magic cast by immortals. magic cast by immortals.

Balors stand 12’ tall, and have horned heads A glabrezu is a  9’ tall humanoid with a Hezrou are large (7’ tall) humanoid toads.
and leathery wings. They always use a two- horned wolf ’s head and two pairs of arms. They prefer to use undead as minions and
handed sword of slicing +5 (which they can The lower pair are normal, but the upper agents wherever possible, and will usually
wield in one hand) and a whip of draining pair are oversized and end in large pincers. act through such agents rather than in per-
+5. Balors can only be hit by +2 or better son where possible.
weapons. Glabrezu can spend their power points
on the Cast Mortal Magic spell, and have Hezrou can spend their power points on the
Balors can spend their power points on the the call other, control undead, enhanced Cast Mortal Magic spell, and have the call
Cast Mortal Magic spell, and have the call reflexes, and howl powers. They may also other, control undead, enhanced reflexes,
other, enhanced reflexes, howl, and sum- use aura attacks. and snap powers. They may also use aura
mon weapons powers. They may also use attacks.
aura attacks. Glabrezu can be hit only by silvered or
magical weapons.
Balors are highly charismatic, will rarely
attack by surprise even if given the chance, Glabrezu delight in fire magics and burning
and prefer to see their opponents acknowl- things. When dealing with mortals, they
edge their superiority and surrender with- prefer bribery to outright threats; often giv-
out a fight. ing riches in exchange for service to their
(often un-named) patron.

283
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Demon (Marilith) Demon (Nalfeshnee)


Type: exalted Type: exalted
extraplanar extraplanar
Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d2 (f ) Lair Group: 1d3 (e)
Move: 40’ (fly: 50’) Move: 30’ (fly: 40’)
Armour Class: 0* {–4 vs 3} Armour Class: 0*
Hit Dice: 22********** Hit Dice: 19**********
(99hp) (86hp)
Attack Bonus: +16 {+8} Attack Bonus: +14
Attacks: sword {2d8+8} Attacks: claw (1d8) &
sword {2d8+8} claw (1d8) &
sword {2d8+8} bite (2d4+poison)
sword {2d8+8} Power Reserve: 200
sword {2d8+8} vs. Spell Attack: +0
sword {2d8+8} vs. Physical Attack: +5
tail (2d8) vs. Mental Attack: +2
Weapon Expertise: grand master vs. Power Attack: +3
{deflect x3} Intelligence: 26
{disarm at –4} Morale: +16
{hurl range XP Value: 17,750
5/10/15}
Power Reserve: 300
vs. Spell Attack: +0
vs. Physical Attack: +5
vs. Mental Attack: +2
vs. Power Attack: +3
Intelligence: 28
Morale: +16
XP Value: 25,250

Demons are incredibly powerful creatures Demons are incredibly powerful creatures Nalfeshnee like to give the impression that
created by immortals from the souls of created by immortals from the souls of they are dumb thugs, taking advantage of
mortals as agents of chaos and destruction. mortals as agents of chaos and destruction. their brutish appearance to hide their intel-
All demons are immune to magic cast by All demons are immune to magic cast by lect and scheming nature.
mortals and have anti-magic of +4 against mortals and have anti-magic of +4 against
magic cast by immortals. magic cast by immortals.

Mariliths have a six-armed female human A nalfeshnee is a large (10’ tall) and bulky
body on top of a 15’ snake tail, and are hit creature with the body and arms of a power-
only by magical weapons. ful ape and goat-like legs with hoofed feet.
Their heads are like those of boars, but with
Mariliths can spend their power points bat like ears. Nalfeshnee have feathered
on the Cast Mortal Magic spell, and have wings on their back that look ridiculously
the call other, control undead, enhanced small for their size.
reflexes, and spit poison powers. They may
also use aura attacks. Nalfeshnee are hit only by magical weapons.

Mariliths relish combat more than any oth- Nalfeshnee can spend their power points
er type of demon, and respect those – even on the Cast Mortal Magic spell, and have
enemies – who fight well. the call other, control undead, enhanced
reflexes, and groan powers. They may also
use aura attacks.

284
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Demon (Succubus) Demon (Vrock)


Type: exalted Type: exalted
extraplanar extraplanar
Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (i x 2) Lair Group: 1d3 (b)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ (fly: 60’)
Armour Class: 0* Armour Class: 0
Hit Dice: 10********** Hit Dice: 10**********
(45hp) (45hp)
Attack Bonus: +10 Attack Bonus: +10
Attacks: none Attacks: claw (1d4) &
Power Reserve: 100 claw (1d4) &
vs. Spell Attack: +0 talon (1d8) &
vs. Physical Attack: +5 talon (1d8) &
vs. Mental Attack: +2 beak (1d6)
vs. Power Attack: +3 Power Reserve: 100
Intelligence: 12 vs. Spell Attack: +0
Morale: +16 vs. Physical Attack: +5
XP Value: 8,500 vs. Mental Attack: +2
vs. Power Attack: +3
Intelligence: 16
Morale: +16
XP Value: 8,500

Demons are incredibly powerful creatures Succubi are master seducers, and usually Demons are incredibly powerful creatures
created by immortals from the souls of charm their way into getting what they created by immortals from the souls of
mortals as agents of chaos and destruction. want. They avoid combat, relying on their mortals as agents of chaos and destruction.
All demons are immune to magic cast by leech power and on spells if pressed; but All demons are immune to magic cast by
mortals and have anti-magic of +4 against would much rather talk their way out of a mortals and have anti-magic of +4 against
magic cast by immortals. potential fight. Because of their great charm magic cast by immortals.
and charisma, succubi prefer to handle is-
The least monstrous of the demons, succubi sues directly rather than rely on agents, and Vrock are tall (8’) yet scrawny humanoids
appear to be attractive humans of either sex are thus the most commonly encountered with vulture heads, feet and wings.
with wings and vestigial horns. They are type of demon.
only hit by +2 weapons or better. Vrocks can spend their power points on the
Cast Mortal Magic spell, and have the call
Succubi can spend their power points other, control undead, enhanced reflexes,
on the Cast Mortal Magic spell, and have and swoop powers. They may also use aura
the call other, control undead, enhanced attacks.
reflexes, and leech powers. They may also
use aura attacks. Vrocks are the least powerful and the least
subtle of all the demons. They tend to get
bored easily by plotting and scheming and
prefer to simply fly around having fun – al-
though since “having fun” includes killing
people, this doesn’t make them much less
dangerous than other demons.

285
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Dinosaur (L Aquatic) Dinosaur (S Aquatic)


Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: ocean (rare) Habitat: ocean (common)
Wandering Group: 1 (u+v) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Lair Group: 2d8 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 30’
Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 7
Hit Dice: 16 (72hp) Hit Dice: 4 (18hp)
Attack Bonus: +13 Attack Bonus: +4
Attacks: bite (3d6) Attacks: bite (1d6)
vs. Death/Poison: +12 vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Wand: +11 vs. Wand: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +9 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2
Morale: +16 Morale: +11
XP Value: 2,000 XP Value: 75

Other demons often consider vrocks to be Although the term “dinosaur” is rather Although the term “dinosaur” is rather
a liability for drawing too much attention, specific, these statistics can be used for any specific, these statistics can be used for any
but are happy to deploy them when such large prehistoric creature likely to be found large prehistoric creature likely to be found
attention will be a suitable diversion from in a “lost world” area. in a “lost world” area.
their real plans.
In this case, these statistics are for a large In this case, these statistics are for a (rela-
aquatic creature such as a plesiosaur or tively) small aquatic creature such as an
mosasaur. ichthyosaur.

286
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Dinosaur (L Carn) Dinosaur (S Carn) Dinosaur (L Herb)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (u+v) Wandering Group: 2d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 2d6 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d2 (nil) Lair Group: 2d6 (nil) Lair Group: 3d10 (nil)
Move: 50’ Move: 40’ Move: 20’
Armour Class: 4 Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 5
Hit Dice: 20 (90hp) Hit Dice: 3 (14hp) Hit Dice: 25 (113hp)
Attack Bonus: +15 Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +17
Attacks: claw (2d6) & Attacks: claw (1 point) & Attacks: tail (2d8) or
claw (2d6) & claw (1 point) & trample (4d8)
bite (5d8) bite (1d8) vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Death/Poison: +13 vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Wand: +14
vs. Wand: +12 vs. Wand: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +12
vs. Dragon Breath: +9 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Intelligence: 2
Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 4 Morale: +11
Morale: +16 Morale: +16 XP Value: 3,500
XP Value: 2,375 XP Value: 35

Although the term “dinosaur” is rather Although the term “dinosaur” is rather Although the term “dinosaur” is rather
specific, these statistics can be used for any specific, these statistics can be used for any specific, these statistics can be used for any
large prehistoric creature likely to be found large prehistoric creature likely to be found large prehistoric creature likely to be found
in a “lost world” area. in a “lost world” area. in a “lost world” area.

In this case, these statistics are for a large In this case, these statistics are for a (rela- In this case, these statistics are for a large
carnivorous land creature such as a tyran- tively) small carnivorous land creature such herbivorous land creature such as a sauro-
nosaur or a spinosaur. as a deinonychus or a dimetrodon. pod.

Large herbivorous dinosaurs can make


trample attacks. Treat these attacks as if
doing the charge action.

287
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Dinosaur (S Herb) Djinni (Greater) Djinni (Lesser)


Type: animal Type: monster Type: monster
Habitat: any (common) Habitat: desert (very rare) Habitat: desert (rare)
Wandering Group: 2d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 3d10 (nil) Lair Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ (fly: 120’) Move: 30’ (fly: 80’)
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: –2* Armour Class: 5*
Hit Dice: 4 (18hp) Hit Dice: 15** (68hp) Hit Dice: 7+1* (33hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +12 Attack Bonus: +8
Attacks: horn (2d4) Attacks: fist (3d10) & Attacks: fist (2d8)
vs. Death/Poison: 12 fist (3d10) vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Wand: 13 vs. Death/Poison: +17 vs. Wand: +14
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: 14 vs. Wand: +17 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13
vs. Dragon Breath: 15 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +17 vs. Dragon Breath: +12
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: 16 vs. Dragon Breath: +16 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11
Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +18 Intelligence: 14
Morale: +16 Intelligence: 14 Morale: +19
XP Value: 75 Morale: +18 XP Value: 1,025
XP Value: 4,800

Although the term “dinosaur” is rather Greater djinn are the rulers of their lesser Djinn are desert dwelling spirits. They ap-
specific, these statistics can be used for any cousins. They appear as 9’ tall blue skinned pear as 6’ tall blue skinned humans. They
large prehistoric creature likely to be found humans. They are highly magical, and can are magical creatures, and can only be hurt
in a “lost world” area. only be hurt by +2 weapons or better. De- by magical weapons. Despite being crea-
spite being magical creatures of chaos, djinn tures of chaos, djinn are normally good
In this case, these statistics are for a (rela- are normally good natured and friendly. natured and friendly.
tively) small herbivorous land creature such
as a triceratops or ankylosaur. A greater djinni can transform in a single A djinni can transform over the course of
round into a whirlwind 120’ tall and 10’ in five rounds into a whirlwind 70’ tall and 10’
Small herbivorous dinosaurs can perform diameter at the base. While in this form, the in diameter at the base. While in this form,
charge actions. greater djinni can move at a rate of 80’, and the greater djinni can move at a rate of 40’,
any creature it engulfs takes 3d12 damage. and any creature it engulfs takes 2d6 dam-
Creatures of less than 5 hit dice must make age. Creatures of less than 2 hit dice must
a saving throw vs. death ray or be slain. make a saving throw vs. death ray or be
swept aside.
In either form, a greater djinni regenerates 3
hit points per round. A djinni can cast the following spells (as
a 7th level caster if appropriate):
A greater djinni can cast the following spells
(as a 15th level caster if appropriate): ◊ Create Food 3xday
◊ Woodform or Clothform 3xday
◊ Create Food 3xday ◊ Stoneform or Ironform 3xday
◊ Woodform or Clothform 3xday ◊ Invisibility 3xday
◊ Stoneform or Ironform 3xday ◊ Phantasmal Force 3xday
◊ Invisibility 3xday
◊ Phantasmal Force 3xday
◊ Grant another’s Wish 1xday
◊ Cloudkill 1xday
◊ Weather Control 1xday

288
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Dolphin Donkey Doppelganger


Type: animal Type: animal Type: monster
Habitat: ocean (common) Habitat: grassland (common) Habitat: any (rare)
river (rare) desert (common) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil) Lair Group: 1d6 (e)
Lair Group: 1d20 (nil) Lair Group: 2d12 (nil) Move: 30’
Move: 60’ Move: 40’ Armour Class: 5
Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 7 Hit Dice: 4* (18hp)
Hit Dice: 3* (14hp) Hit Dice: 1+1 (6hp) Attack Bonus: +4
Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +2 Attacks: “weapon” (1d8)
Attacks: ram (2d4) Attacks: kick (1d3) vs. Death/Poison: +12
vs. Death/Poison: +11 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +11
vs. Wand: +10 vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +9
vs. Dragon Breath: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 9
Intelligence: 15 Intelligence: 3 Morale: +13
Morale: +17 Morale: +9 XP Value: 125
XP Value: 50 XP Value: 15

Dolphins are sapient aquatic mammals re- Donkeys are hoofed mammals related to Doppelgangers are strange creatures which
lated to whales. horses. Although smaller and less strong look like skinny hairless, genderless, feature-
than horses, they are more intelligent. less humanoids in their natural shape.
Although aquatic, dolphins still breathe air,
and need to return to the surface every 15 Unfortunately, this intelligence often makes A doppelganger is able to “imprint” on a
minutes to breathe. them less popular as pack animals, since humanoid target, and then take on the exact
while mostly generally docile they are also shape of that target; mimicking equipment
Dolphins have their own language of clicks very stubborn. and clothing. The doppelganger becomes
and whistles. Dolphins and humanoids can single-mindedly obsessed with their target
learn to understand each others’ languages, However, if treated gently, donkeys can be and tries to find a way to kill the target and
but cannot speak them without magical as- more loyal than horses, require less feeding, take over their identity.
sistance because of the differences in mouth handle rough terrain better, and make good
shape. companions. Doppelgangers seem to have some kind of
limited telepathic bond with their target
Dolphins can Detect Magic underwater with once they have imprinted on them, and
a 360’ range. gain all the target’s memories. Even spells
such as ESP reveal that the doppelganger
Some dolphins can become shamans (of genuinely believes itself to be the target
up to 10th level) or sorcerers (of up to 8th rather than an imposter.
level).
Should a doppelganger successfully take
Dolphins are generally friendly to humans over a target’s identity, it will remain in that
and demi-humans, although their different identity for 2d6 days before the imprint
culture and environment causes there to be wears off and it returns to its normal form
little interaction between the two groups and hides until it sees a new target.
and no trade – something which dolphins
have no concept of. Doppelgangers are immune to sleep and
charm spells and effects.

289
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Dragon
Type: dragon
Habitat: any (rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d4 (varies)
Move: 40’ (fly: 50’)
Armour Class: varies
Hit Dice: varies
Attack Bonus: varies
Attacks: claw (varies) &
claw (varies) &
bite (varies)
vs. Death/Poison: varies
vs. Wand: varies
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: varies
vs. Dragon Breath: varies
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: varies
Intelligence: 5 or 15
Morale: +16
XP Value: varies

Dragons are great winged lizards that are Dragons of either gender can live for hun- Dragon queens each have an additional
known for their great power, their treasure dreds of years, and continue to grow for breath weapon that they can use instead of
hoarding, and for terrorising large areas of most of their life, although even a newly their primary one, although they may still
countryside around their lairs. hatched dragon is still a formidable foe. only use three breath attacks per day.

In fact, this behaviour is limited to male Dragons come in a variety of colours; black, Crystal: This breath does normal cold dam-
dragons which are relatively vicious, bes- blue, green, red and white. All colours of age, but additionally all unattended non-
tial and territorial creatures. Female drag- dragon can interbreed, and the colour of living items (as well as those worn or carried
ons – called dragon queens – are both more children is inherited from the father. by creatures who failed their saving throws)
powerful and more intelligent than the in the area of the breath are turned to ice
males, although they are also much rarer. A dragon is able to use a breath weapon for a period of one hour.
three times per day, each time doing an
Dragon queens are able to change shape at amount of damage equal to the dragon’s This ice will not melt, but may be broken or
will into human form; are able to talk and current hit points. The shape of the breath shattered. Any weapon or armour turned to
cast spells (in either form); and have more weapon and the type of damage it does de- ice will shatter when struck if a 1–5 is rolled
varied breath weapons (which can also be pend on the dragon’s colour. on 1d6. Weapons that shatter do minimum
used in either form). They are still aloof damage and are useless thereafter. Armour
and arrogant in temperament, but they are Line shaped breath attacks (from black or that shatters falls off and becomes useless.
also social creatures who enjoy entertaining blue dragons) affect an area 200’ long by 5’
visitors and travelling around exploring hu- wide. Darkness: This breath does normal acid
man civilisations. damage, but any victim who fails their sav-
Cloud shaped breath attacks (from green ing throw is also surrounded by a darkness
Every twenty years, a female dragon enters dragons) affect an area with a  50’ diam- spell with a 15’ radius that lasts for 1 round
a six-month long breeding frenzy, during eter and 30’ height in front of the dragon’s per hit die of the dragon (or until dispelled).
which her mind reverts to a bestial nature mouth. Cone shaped breath attacks (from The dragon can see through this darkness
comparable to that of a male dragon and red and white dragons) affect a conical normally.
she flies around visiting all the males she area 150’ long and 30’ wide at the end.
can find. At the end of this period, she will Disease: This breath does normal poison
return to her home (and to her normal Any creature in the area of the breath attack damage, but any target who fails their sav-
outlook) and lay a clutch of eggs – each of takes full damage unless it can make a sav- ing throw against it is also afflicted with a
which will have a different father – and raise ing throw vs. breath weapon in which case rotting disease. The target loses 1 hit point
the young for the first five to ten years of it only takes half damage. per 10 minutes, and is unaffected by healing
their lives before they leave her lair to find spells until this disease is cured.
their own homes.

290
Chapter 18 - Monsters
Table 18–3: Dragon Abilities by Age
Damage Queen Xp
Armour Attack
Age Hit Dice Save As Magic-user Treasure
Class Bonus Claw Bite Normal Queen
Level
Very Young 6**
3 +6 1d4 2d8 Fighter 6th 2nd H 950 1,075
(1–5 Years) (27hp)
Young 8**
1 +8 1d6 3d8 Fighter 8th 3rd H 2,300 2,850
(6–15 Years) (36hp)
Sub-adult 11**
–2 +10 2d4 6d6 Fighter 11th 5th 2xh 3,500 5,100
(16–25 Years) (50hp)
Young Adult 14***
–3 +12 1d10+1 4d8+4 Fighter 28th 7th 3xh 3,500 5,500
(26–50 Years) (63hp)
Adult 16****
–3 +13 1d10+2 3d8+8 Fighter 36th 10th 3xh 6,250 9,550
(51–100 Years) (72hp)
Old 18****
–4 +14 1d10+3 3d10+8 Fighter 36th 12th 3xh, i 7,525 11,575
(101–200 Years) (81hp)
Very Old 20****
–5 +15 1d12+2 4d8+8 Fighter 36th 15th 3xh , 2xi 9,575 16,775
(201–400 Years) (90hp)
Ancient 22****
–6 +16 4d4 6d6+8 Fighter 36th 18th 3xh,2xi 14,000 23,000
(401+ Years) (99hp)
Any non-metal items on a target who failed form for ten minutes per hit dice of the
their saving throw (or any unattended non- breathing dragon. Such vaporised items
metal items breathed on) will rot away and creatures are invisible and are unable
in 1d6x10 minutes unless a Cure Disease to make any noise or affect any solid object.
spell is used on them. Living creatures can move at a speed of 20’
per round if they concentrate.
Melt: This breath does normal fire damage
but additionally any items carried or worn In any of the above cases, a successful Dispel
by creatures that fail their saving throw (or Magic (with the dragon’s hit dice as the cast-
any unattended items breathed on) will er level) will remove the effect prematurely.
begin to melt or burn. Paper is destroyed
instantly; cloth and leather is destroyed in All dragons are immune to breath weapons
one round; other non-metal items in two of their own type, and automatically make
rounds; metal items in three rounds; and saving throws (if applicable) to any damage
magic items of all types in four rounds (plus of the same basic type as their own breath
one round per point of magical “plus” in weapon.
the case of weapons and armour). Magical
items that bestow fire resistance take twice Any dragon that is flying can perform a
as long to melt. The melting of items can swoop manoeuvre in combat which is iden-
only be stopped by cooling them – either tical to a charge manoeuvre except that the
with water or magically. attack does not have to come at the end of
the move.
Vaporise: This breath does normal light-
ning damage, but additionally any creatures
that fail their saving throw (or any unat-
tended items breathed on) turn to a gaseous

Table 18–4: Dragon Breath


Dragon Colour Normal Breath Queen Breath Breath Shape
Black Acid Darkness Line
Blue Lightning Vaporise Line
Green Poison gas Disease Cloud
Red Fire Melt Cone
White Cold Crystal Cone

291
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Dragon Turtle Dragonian Dragonian (Elemental)


Type: dragon Type: enchanted Type: enchanted
Habitat: ocean (rare) dragon dragon
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (rare)
Lair Group: 1 (h) Wandering Group: 1d4 (2xv) Wandering Group: 1d4 (2xv)
Move: 10’ (swim: 30’) Lair Group: 1d4 (e) Lair Group: 1d4 (e)
Armour Class: –2 Move: 40’ (fly: 10’) Move: 40’ (fly: 10’)
Hit Dice: 30* (135hp) Armour Class: 0* Armour Class: 0*
Attack Bonus: +20 Hit Dice: 4*** (18hp) Hit Dice: 6**** (27hp)
Attacks: claw (1d8) & Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +6
claw (1d8) & Attacks: claw (1d2) & Attacks: claw (1d3) &
bite (10d6) claw (1d2) & claw (1d3) &
vs. Death/Poison: +14 bite (1d8) bite (1d8+2)
vs. Wand: +14 vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +11
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13 vs. Wand: +8 vs. Wand: +10
vs. Dragon Breath: +12 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +8
Intelligence: 5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +10
Morale: +17 Intelligence: 10 Intelligence: 10
XP Value: 9,000 Morale: +13 Morale: +16
XP Value: 225 XP Value: 1,175

Dragon turtles are aquatic relations of true Dragonians are lesser cousins of true drag- Dragonians are lesser cousins of true drag-
dragons. Although not sapient, they are still ons. They are much smaller than true drag- ons. They are much smaller than true drag-
rather cunning and have the dragons’ love ons, being only the size of a human, and ons, being only the size of a human, and
of treasure. stand upright. stand upright.

A dragon turtle is shaped like a huge sea Unlike their larger cousins, dragonians have Unlike their larger cousins, dragonians have
turtle, but with the head of a dragon. Three no magic use or breath weapon. However, no magic use or breath weapon. However,
times per day it can breathe a cloud of scald- they are immune to all magic spells of 4th they are immune to all magic spells of 4th
ing steam in a 50’ diameter sphere. This level or lower. They can voluntarily drop level or lower. They can voluntarily drop
cloud of steam does damage equal to the this immunity by concentrating, for exam- this immunity by concentrating, for ex-
dragon turtle’s current hit point total to all ple to receive a cure spell. ample to receive a cure spell. Additionally,
within it, unless they can make a saving elemental dragonians can only be hit by
throw vs. breath weapon in which case they Dragonians can change shape at will into an magical weapons.
only take half damage. elf form, and in that form have the abilities
of a 5th level thief. Elemental dragonians can change shape at
Dragon turtles normally live in deep water will into an elemental of a particular type,
amongst the treasure laden wrecks of ships; Dragonians have little interest in human and in that form have the abilities of a 6 hit
occasionally rising up to sink a new ship to and demi-human society, but they are often die elemental of that type.
add to their collection. found interacting with it as servants of true
dragons; especially dragon queens. Dragonians have little interest in human
and demi-human society, but they are often
found interacting with it as servants of true
dragons; especially dragon queens.

292
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Dragonian (Greater) Dragonian (Lesser) Dryad


Type: enchanted Type: enchanted Type: humanoid
dragon dragon Habitat: woods (rare)
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (rare) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Wandering Group: 1d4 (2xv) Wandering Group: 1d4 (2xv) Lair Group: 1d6 (d)
Lair Group: 1d4 (e) Lair Group: 1d4 (e) Move: 40’
Move: 40’ (fly: 10’) Move: 40’ (fly: 10’) Armour Class: 5
Armour Class: 0* Armour Class: 0* Hit Dice: 2* (9hp)
Hit Dice: 5*** (23hp) Hit Dice: 3*** (14hp) Attack Bonus: +2
Attack Bonus: +5 Attack Bonus: +3 Attacks: staff {1d6}
Attacks: claw (1d2) & Attacks: claw (1d2) & Weapon Expertise: basic
claw (1d2) & claw (1d2) & vs. Death/Poison: +11
bite (2d4) bite (1d6) vs. Wand: +9
vs. Death/Poison: +10 vs. Death/Poison: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9
vs. Wand: +9 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
vs. Dragon Breath: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 Intelligence: 14
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 Morale: +9
Intelligence: 10 Intelligence: 10 XP Value: 25
Morale: +13 Morale: +13
XP Value: 550 XP Value: 225

Dragonians are lesser cousins of true drag- Dragonians are lesser cousins of true drag- Dryads are forest spirits who live inside
ons. They are much smaller than true drag- ons. They are much smaller than true drag- trees. Although dryads are technically asex-
ons, being only the size of a human, and ons, being only the size of a human, and ual, they always appear as beautiful females
stand upright. stand upright. when they leave their trees.

Unlike their larger cousins, dragonians have Unlike their larger cousins, dragonians have A dryad can merge with or leave her tree at
no magic use or breath weapon. However, no magic use or breath weapon. However, will, and can take others with her. Inside a
they are immune to all magic spells of 4th they are immune to all magic spells of 4th dryad tree is a softly lit extra-dimensional
level or lower. They can voluntarily drop level or lower. They can voluntarily drop space the size of a cottage (usually with
this immunity by concentrating, for exam- this immunity by concentrating, for exam- furniture made of wood and soft leaves).
ple to receive a cure spell. ple to receive a cure spell. People inside the tree can see out through
windows, but there is no door and the win-
Greater dragonians can change shape at will Lesser dragonians can change shape at will dows are not apparent from the outside.
into a dwarf form, and in that form have into a human form, and in that form have
the abilities of a 5th level thief. the abilities of a 5th level thief. Dryads are usually peaceful and non-violent
unless severely provoked. Their main de-
Dragonians have little interest in human Dragonians have little interest in human fence is their ability to cast a Charm Person
and demi-human society, but they are often and demi-human society, but they are often spell at will (with a –2 penalty to saving
found interacting with it as servants of true found interacting with it as servants of true throws). They will normally charm attack-
dragons; especially dragon queens. dragons; especially dragon queens. ers and persuade them to go off and do
some deed that will help the dryad’s forest.
Occasionally, a dryad will take a liking to a
mortal and charm them into living in the
tree with them and becoming their servant.

A dryad is inherently bound to her tree, and


can only survive for ten minutes if taken
more than 240’ away from it. Similarly, kill-
ing the tree will kill the dryad.

293
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Dwarf Efreeti (Greater) Efreeti (Lesser)


Type: demi-human Type: monster Type: monster
Habitat: mountains (common) Habitat: desert (very rare) Habitat: desert (rare)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (q+s) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 5d8 (g) Lair Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Move: 20’ Move: 40’ (fly: 120’) Move: 30’ (fly: 80’)
Armour Class: 4 Armour Class: –2* Armour Class: 3
Hit Dice: 1 (5hp) Hit Dice: 20*** (90hp) Hit Dice: 10* (45hp)
Attack Bonus: +1 Attack Bonus: +15 Attack Bonus: +10
Attacks: hammer (1d6) Attacks: fist (3d10) & Attacks: fist (2d8)
Weapon Expertise: basic fist (3d10) vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Death/Poison: +12 vs. Death/Poison: +18 vs. Wand: +14
vs. Wand: +11 vs. Wand: +18 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +18 vs. Dragon Breath: +12
vs. Dragon Breath: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +18 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +18 Intelligence: 14
Intelligence: 10 Intelligence: 14 Morale: +19
Morale: +17 Morale: +18 XP Value: 1,750
XP Value: 10 XP Value: 7,775

Dwarves are slightly shorter than humans Greeter efreet are the rulers of their less- Efreet are desert dwelling spirits. They ap-
but are similar in weight due to their stock- er cousins. They appear as muscular and pear as muscular and horned 12’ tall red
ier build. Skin and hair colour shows the horned 30’ tall red skinned humans. They skinned humans. As magical creatures of
same range as humans, although both male are highly magical, and can only be hurt by chaos, efreet are cruel and domineering.
and female dwarves tend to have slightly +2 weapons or better. As magical creatures
more facial and body hair than humans and of chaos, efreet are cruel and domineering. An efreeti can transform over the course
both sexes usually sport beards. of five rounds into a pillar of flame 12’ tall
A greater efreeti can transform in a single and 5’ in diameter at the base. While in this
Traditionally, dwarves live in mountainous round into a pillar of flame 30’ tall and 5’ in form, the efreeti ignites all flammable ob-
areas near humans, where they live under- diameter at the base. While in this form, the jects within 5’ and does an additional 1d8
ground and use their mining and metal- greater efreeti ignites all flammable objects fire damage with its fist attacks.
working skills to make goods and tools that within 15’ and does an additional 2d8 fire
they can trade with the humans for food damage with its fist attacks. An efreeti can cast the following spells (as
and textiles. a 10th level caster if appropriate):
In either form, a greater efreeti regenerates 2
Dwarves are an inherently non-magical hit points per round. ◊ Create Food 3xday
race, and possess no magic-users or clerics ◊ Woodform or Clothform 3xday
of their own – not even being able to pro- A greater efreeti can cast the following spells ◊ Stoneform or Ironform 3xday
duce the lesser shamans that goblins and gi- (as a 20th level caster if appropriate): ◊ Invisibility 3xday
ants – their traditional enemies – are able to ◊ Wall of Fire 3xday
field in battle. However, this lack of magical ◊ Create Food 3xday
ability makes dwarves much more resilient ◊ Woodform or Clothform 3xday
and able to resist magical attacks. ◊ Stoneform or Ironform 3xday
◊ Invisibility 3xday
◊ Wall of Fire 3xday
◊ Grant another’s Wish 1xday
◊ Explosive Cloud 1xday
◊ Fireball 1xday

294
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Eldritch Abomination
Type: exalted
extraplanar
Habitat: void (very rare)
aether (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 0 (nil)
Move: 6 miles (or voidspeed)
Armour Class: –20*
Hit Dice: 150*******
(675hp)
Attack Bonus: +49
Attacks: 40 x tentacle (1d100)
Power Reserve: 4,500
vs. Spell Attack: 12
vs. Physical Attack: 6
vs. Mental Attack: 9
vs. Power Attack: 8
Intelligence: 100
Morale: +18
XP Value: 202,500

An eldritch abomination is a creature of Although an abomination is capable of Immortals fight an intermittent war with
absolutely staggering size. It is a shifting making 40 attacks per round, it is unable to the eldritch abominations; driving them
horror of up to 25 miles across. Although bring more than 20 attacks to bear against away from populated celestial spheres.
the above statistics list the attack type of a single opponent at once. Some immortals have tried to communicate
eldritch abominations as being via tenta- with eldritch abominations rather than fight
cles, eldritch abominations are remarkably Eldritch abominations come from some them, but report that communication is
varied in appearance and make-up, and other part of the universe, where they seem difficult beyond such simple ideas as “leave
may actually be striking with body parts to fulfil the same role that immortals do in or die” as there is little in terms of a com-
other than tentacles. For example, some are the local environment. They have all the mon frame of reference to use as a basis for
clouds of smoky gas-like material; others abilities (to create avatars so forth) that im- communication.
appear crystalline or metallic; still others mortals have. The statistics here are for an
appear to be simply patches of colour of an eldritch abomination in a manifest form. It is not known what the home of eldritch
indescribable hue. In truth, eldritch abomi- The mortal forms of eldritch abominations abominations is like. Immortals guess that
nations are simply not made of the same are varied, but tentacles usually play a large they have something similar to celestial
sort of matter that we are, and our senses are part. spheres (but which splits the luminiferous
only able to approximate their true forms. aether up in a completely different way to
Eldritch abominations seem to be somehow the ether/air/fire/earth/water split that we
Eldritch abominations are incredibly rare, offended or repulsed by celestial spheres and are used to) and that they maybe even have
and are almost never found within a ce- the matter that comes from them, and will something similar to outer planes – but no-
lestial sphere. In fact the merest detection often try to destroy such things. However, one has ever returned with reports of seeing
of an eldritch abomination near an inhab- they will usually completely ignore mortal such things.
ited sphere is enough to mobilise all the level creatures that they encounter, as such
immortals into action to try to defeat it or small fry are completely below their notice
drive it away. (to the extent of simply ploughing through
a ship and destroying it rather than moving
Eldritch abominations can spend their out of the way).
power points on all immortal level spells.
However, some mad souls have very occa-
As exalted creatures they are immune to sionally been known to make contact with
mortal level magic, and require +5 or bet- an eldritch abomination and get themselves
ter weapons to be hit. Additionally they made into clerics in exchange for promises
have a 99% anti-magic against immortal to aid the abomination in destroying the
level magic. cleric’s world.

295
Chapter 18 - Monsters
Table 18–5: Elementals by Size
Elemental Armour Attack
Type: enchanted Hit Dice Damage Save As Xp Value
Class Bonus
extraplanar
Habitat: any (rare) 2 (9hp) 5 +3 1d2 Fighter 2nd 20
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) 4 (18hp) 4 +4 1d4 Fighter 4th 75
Lair Group: 1 (nil) 6 (27hp) 3 +6 1d6 Fighter 6th 275
Move: varies
Armour Class: varies 8 (36hp) 2 +8 1d8 Fighter 8th 650*
Hit Dice: varies 10 (45hp) 1 +10 2d6 Fighter 10th 1,000
Attack Bonus: varies 12 (54hp) 0 +11 2d8 Fighter 12th 1,250**
Attacks: bash (varies)
14 (63hp) –1 +12 2d10 Fighter 14th 1,500
vs. Death/Poison: varies
vs. Wand: varies 16 (72hp) –2 +13 3d8 Fighter 16th 1,850***
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: varies 18 (81hp) –3 +14 3d10 Fighter 18th 2,125
vs. Dragon Breath: varies 20 (90hp) –4 +15 4d8 Fighter 20th 2,375
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: varies
22 (99hp) –5 +16 5d8 Fighter 22nd 2,750
Intelligence: 9
Morale: +17 24 (108hp) –6 +17 6d8 Fighter 24th 3,250
XP Value: varies 26 (117hp) –7 +18 7d8 Fighter 26th 3,750
28 (126hp) –8 +19 8d8 Fighter 28th 4,250
30 (135hp) –9 +20 9d8 Fighter 30th 4,750
32 (144hp) –10 +21 10d8 Fighter 32nd 5,250
40*** (180hp) –11* +27 8d12 Fighter 36th 27,500
50*** (225hp) –12* +37 9d12 Fighter 36th 37,500
60*** (270hp) –13* +42 10d12 Fighter 36th 47,500
70*** (315hp) –14* +44 11d12 Fighter 36th 57,500
80*** (360hp) –15* +46 12d12 Fighter 36th 67,500
* size of elemental conjured by staff
** size of elemental conjured by device
*** size of elemental conjured by spell
Elementals are sapient creatures made of cannot cross water that is wider than their
When an elemental is hit by damage from
elemental matter from one of the elemental height. A fire elemental does an extra 1d8a source that it takes double damage from,
planes. Elementals of all sizes exist on the damage to any cold-based creature. it can make a saving throw vs. spells to
elemental planes, but they all have common only take normal damage instead. Al-
statistics. A water elemental appears as a wave of wa- though elementals of each type are shown
ter 1’ tall per two hit dice and 1’ wide per on Table 18–6 as taking normal damage
An air elemental appears as a whirlwind that hit dice. from their own element, this applies only
is 2’ tall per hit die and 1’ in diameter per to magical damage or attacks from other
two hit dice. Any creature of 2 hit dice or Water elementals cannot move more elementals, and does not apply to mundane
less that it hits in combat must make a sav- than 60’ from a body of water. A water el- environmental damage.
ing throw vs. death ray or be swept away. emental does an extra 1d8 damage to any
An air elemental does an extra 1d8 damage creature it hits that is in water.
to any flying creature that it hits.

An earth elemental appears as a humanoid


figure made of soil and gravel that is 1’ tall
per hit die. Earth elementals cannot cross Table 18–6: Elementals by Element
water that is wider than their height. An Damage
earth elemental does an extra 1d8 damage Element Move
to any creature it hits that is on the ground. Double Normal Minimum
Air Fly: 120’ Earth Air, fire Water
A fire elemental appears as a roughly conical Earth 20’ Fire Earth, water Air
bonfire 1’ tall per hit die and 1’ in diam-
Fire 40’ Water Fire, air Earth
eter at the base per hit die. Fire elementals
Water 20’ (swim: 60’) Air Water, earth Fire

296
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Elephant Elephant (Prehistoric)


Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: grassland Habitat: grassland (rare)
(common) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 2d8 (nil)
Lair Group: 3d8 (nil) Move: 40’
Move: 40’ Armour Class: 3
Armour Class: 5 Hit Dice: 15 (68hp)
Hit Dice: 9* (41hp) Attack Bonus: +12
Attack Bonus: +9 Attacks: tusk (2d6) &
Attacks: tusk (2d4) & tusk (2d6) or
tusk (2d4) or trample (4d8)
trample (4d8) vs. Death/Poison: +12
vs. Death/Poison: +10 vs. Wand: +11
vs. Wand: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +9
vs. Dragon Breath: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6 Intelligence: 2
Intelligence: 2 Morale: +13
Morale: +13 XP Value: 1,650
XP Value: 1,600

Elementals are ruled by massive emperors Elephants are large mammals with prehen- Prehistoric elephants are large elephants
of at least 40 hit dice. These rulers are ex- sile trunks. with long woolly hair that are primarily
alted beings that can only be affected by found in “lost world” areas.
+4 or better weapons or 6th level or higher While normally peaceful, elephants do not
spells. They are immune to poison, charm hesitate to defend themselves or their young While normally peaceful, prehistoric ele-
and hold effects, illusions, and any spell that from potential attack. phants do not hesitate to defend themselves
would cause instant death. or their young from potential attack.
Although elephants have no listed treasure,
Elemental rulers are twice the size that their the tusks of an adult (of either sex) can be Although prehistoric elephants have no list-
hit dice would otherwise indicate, and any sold for approximately 1,000gp. ed treasure, the tusks of an adult (of either
creature hit by one must make a saving sex) can be sold for approximately 1,500gp.
throw vs. death ray or be crushed and killed Elephants are capable of making charge at-
by the blow. tacks in combat. Prehistoric elephants are capable of making
charge attacks in combat.

297
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Elf Face Stealer


Type: demi-human Type: monster
Habitat: woods (common) Habitat: barren (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1d4 (s+t) Wandering Group: 1d3 (nil)
Lair Group: 4d12 (e) Lair Group: 0 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 60’
Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: –4
Hit Dice: 1/2* (3hp) Hit Dice: 10* (45hp)
Attack Bonus: +1 Attack Bonus: +10
Attacks: staff {1d6} Attacks: touch (special)
Weapon Expertise: basic vs. Death/Poison: +13
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +12
vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +10
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Intelligence: 10
Intelligence: 13 Morale: +18
Morale: +13 XP Value: 1,750
XP Value: 6

Elves are more slender and graceful than hu- Face stealers are athletic and acrobatic mon- Smell: The face stealer swaps nose with
mans, but they are approximately the same keys, about the size of a human child. the victim. The victim can no longer smell.
height. Although elves show a similar range This makes the victim immune to effects
of skin colours to those of humans in terms Although apparently sapient, they are that rely on smell (such as the effect of foul
of shade, the hue of their skin tends to be completely manic and rarely stop leaping odours) but also gives them a –1 penalty
more yellow-brown than that of humans around and screaming incoherently when to surprise rolls.
giving them a colouration resembling that in the presence of other sapient creatures.
of wood anywhere from light pine through Hearing: The face stealer swaps ears with
to dark ebony. The ears of elves are pointed. Face stealers get their name from their the victim. The victim is now deaf.
unique ability to steal the senses (and fa-
Elves have no body or facial hair, although cial features) of other humanoids. When Touch: The face stealer swaps fingers with
the hair on their heads is luxuriant, and a face stealer touches a humanoid, it will the victim. The victim loses their sense of
changes colour throughout their life like steal one of their senses. The relevant fea- touch and their dexterity drops by 4 points.
the colours of leaves change through sea- ture of the face stealer’s face or hands will
sons – starting a light green and slowly dark- change to match that of the victim and the Sight: The face stealer swaps eyes with the
ening, as the elf matures before changing to victim’s feature will change to that formerly victim. The victim is now blind.
brown, gold and red in old age. of the face stealer. If the victim can make a
saving throw vs. spells then the transforma- Sixth Sense: The face stealer swaps skin
Elves are naturally magical creatures, and all tion only lasts for 2d6 rounds, otherwise the colour with the victim. The victim may no
elves are capable of casting at least one 1st transformation will be permanent until the longer use ESP, crystal balls, or telepathy
level spell. victim receives a Restore spell. effects.

Despite their inherent magic elves are un- The sense stolen will be random, but a face Once a face stealer has gained a full set of
able to become clerics or shamans. stealer will not steal a sense and feature that senses it will flee combat. Killing the face
it already has a (temporary or permanent) stealer has no effect on swapped body parts
copy of. and lost senses. A Restore spell will recover
them regardless of whether or not the face
The senses and features that a face stealer stealer is still alive.
can steal are:

Taste: The face stealer swaps mouth with


the victim. The victim can no longer taste
anything.

298
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Faerie Ferret (Giant) Fireslime


Type: humanoid Type: animal Type: ooze
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: woods (common) Habitat: underground
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d8 (nil) (very rare)
Lair Group: 5d8+20 (nil) Lair Group: 1d12 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d3 (nil)
Move: 40’ (fly: 80’) Move: 50’ Lair Group: 2d4 (nil)
Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 5 Move: 30’
Hit Dice: 1+1* (6hp) Hit Dice: 1+1 (6hp) Armour Class: 5
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +2 Hit Dice: 9 (41hp)
Attacks: dagger {1d4} Attacks: bite (1d8) Attack Bonus: +9
Weapon Expertise: basic vs. Death/Poison: +8 Attacks: bash (special) &
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +7 bash (special) &
vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 bash (special)
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Death/Poison: +13
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Wand: +12
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Intelligence: 2 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11
Intelligence: 13 Morale: +13 vs. Dragon Breath: +10
Morale: +16 XP Value: 15 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9
XP Value: 19 Intelligence: 0
Morale: +19
XP Value: 900

Faeries are 2’ tall, lightly built winged hu- Giant ferrets are slender mammals with Fire slime is a bright red/orange glowing
manoids that live in natural places. brown or creamy fur that reach about 3’ gelatinous ooze that is incredibly hot.
long.
Faeries are naturally invisible, and can eas- As it is semi-liquid, it is able to pass through
ily see other invisible creatures. They can Giant ferrets are inquisitive and friendly small cracks and fissures. It can sense move-
turn into gaseous form (as the potion) at creatures that are generally omnivorous ment within 60’ and will mindlessly attack
will, and can create minor weather effects (although they particularly like eating gi- any creatures it detects.
(fog, breeze, drizzle, even light snow) in ant rats). However, if not treated well they
a 10’ radius. rapidly become frustrated and angry, and The fireslime bashes with pseudopodia that
this makes them less suitable as companion do 4d6 physical damage to creatures struck
Faeries usually prefer to simply fly around animals or pets. plus leave a layer of hot slime on the target.
and bask in the sun (despite their invisibil- This layer of slime does 3d6 fire damage per
ity); although they can sometimes be either round for a further 1d4 rounds.
helpful or mischievous to strangers as the
mood takes them. If the fireslime hits a target again before
the previous slime has burnt out then the
Faeries are often found around small vil- fire damage does not stack but the duration
lages where the peasants leave them food before it burns out does.
and drink in exchange for their perform-
ing small tasks, but they avoid larger towns Fireslime is immune to fire and to all mental
and cities. attacks, but takes double damage from all
cold-based attacks.

299
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Fish (Giant Bass) Fish (Giant Stonefish) Fish (Giant Sturgeon)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: river (common) Habitat: ocean (common) Habitat: river (rare)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) ocean (rare)
Lair Group: 2d4 (nil) Lair Group: 2d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 60’ Lair Group: 2d10 (nil)
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 7 Move: 60’
Hit Dice: 2 (9hp) Hit Dice: 5+5* (28hp) Armour Class: 0
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +6 Hit Dice: 10+2 (47hp)
Attacks: bite (1d6) Attacks: spine Attack Bonus: +10
vs. Death/Poison: +8 (1d4 + poison) Attacks: bite (2d10)
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +10
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +8 vs. Wand: +9
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +7
Intelligence: 1 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6
Morale: +13 Intelligence: 1 Intelligence: 1
XP Value: 20 Morale: +13 Morale: +16
XP Value: 400 XP Value: 1,900

Giant bass are common in rivers, although Stonefish are spiked fish that look remark- Giant sturgeons are aggressive fish which
they are rarely aggressive against creatures ably like rocks and coral when still. There will attack swimmers.
larger than a halfling. is a 70% chance of such misidentification.
If a giant sturgeon hits an opponent of hu-
They hunt by waiting in ambush and then man size or less with a natural roll of 18 or
snapping at other small fish, and will not better, the opponent is swallowed.
attack larger creatures.
Swallowed opponents take 2d6 damage per
However, anyone who stands on the “rock” round, and must make a saving throw vs.
that is actually the stonefish will be auto- death each round to be able to attack the
matically struck by four of the fish’s poison- fish from the inside for that round.
ous spines. Each spine does 1d4 damage
and the victim must make a saving throw
vs. poison or die.

If pressed and unable to escape, the fish will


actively try to hit a target with one of its
spines at normal to-hit chances.

300
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Floating Horror
Type: monster
Habitat: underground
(very rare)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (l, n, o)
Move: 10’
Armour Class: special
Hit Dice: 11***** (special)
Attack Bonus: +10
Attacks: bite (2d6) &
special
vs. Death/Poison: +10
vs. Wand: +9
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10
vs. Dragon Breath: +7
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +10
Intelligence: 16
Morale: +19
XP Value: 5,100

A floating horror is a strange creature. It The spell-like powers of the lesser mouths The beak is armour class 2 and has 20 hit
consists of ten tentacles in a rough ball are: points. Removing all these hit points will
shape about the size of a human. Each ten- prevent the floating horror from using its
tacle ends with lipless mouth, and there is ◊ Charm Person anti-magic but will not kill it.
another beak-like mouth in the centre of ◊ Charm Monster
the creature. A floating horror has no visible ◊ Sleep The tentacles are armour class 7 and have 12
eyes or means of locomotion, although it is ◊ Telekinesis hit points each. Removing all the hit points
able to see and able to levitate and fly. The ◊ Flesh to Stone from one tentacle will prevent the floating
flight of a floating horror is not magical, ◊ Disintegrate horror from using that tentacle’s spell like
and is not affected by anti-magic or any ◊ Cause Fear effect. However, attacks targeting tentacles
kind of dispel. ◊ Slow will always hit a random tentacle.
◊ Cause Serious Wounds
Floating horrors are domineering creatures ◊ Death Spell Area effect attacks will always do damage
who seem to delight in power over others to the body.
for its own sake. A floating horror can speak Each mouth can project its spell once per
in a multitude of simultaneous voices, but round, although even by twisting its body,
will rarely do so other than to order min- a floating horror can only get a maximum
ions about. of four mouths to point at any given target
at once. None of the spell effects from the
Although a floating horror can bite with its lesser mouths can affect creatures directly in
main mouth, its main attacks are the rays front of the floating horror, since the anti-
that it can project from its various mouths. magic ray from its main mouth suppresses
them.
The main mouth projects an anti-magic ef-
fect to a range of 60’ in front of the creature. When attacking a floating horror, a charac-
Each of the other mouths on the end of a ter can choose to attack the body, the beak,
tentacle projects a different kind of spell- or a tentacle.
like effect.
The body is armour class 0 and has 50 hit
points. Removing all these hit points will
kill the floating horror.

301
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Fl. Undead Horror


Type: undead
monster
Habitat: underground
(very rare)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (lx2,nx2,ox2)
Move: 20’
Armour Class: special
Hit Dice: 20******* (special)
Attack Bonus: +15
Attacks: bite (2d10) &
special
vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Wand: +13
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +14
vs. Dragon Breath: +11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +15
Intelligence: 16
Morale: +19
XP Value: 14,975

It is not known how floating horrors be- The lesser mouths of a floating undead hor- The beak is armour class –2 and has 30 hit
come undead, but they can do so – and the ror can project the following effects: points. Removing all these hit points will
result is even more horrific. prevent the floating undead horror from
◊ Animate Dead using its reflection ability but will not kill it.
A floating undead horror can only be hit ◊ Charm Monster
by +2 weapons or better, and is immune to ◊ Continual Darkness The tentacles are armour class 3 and have 20
all charm, hold, and sleep effects as well as ◊ Death Spell hit points each. Removing all the hit points
illusions, death rays and poison. A floating ◊ Energy Drain (1 level) from one tentacle will prevent the floating
undead horror is turned as if a nightshade. ◊ Energy Drain (2 levels) undead horror from using that tentacle’s
◊ Paralysis (as a ghoul) spell like effect. However, attacks targeting
A floating undead horror can turn into gase- ◊ Animate object tentacles will always hit a random tentacle.
ous form at will, in which state it cannot ◊ Dispel Magic
attack or use its spell like abilities but it ◊ Telekinesis Area effect attacks will always do damage
can only be hurt by magical abilities that to the body.
affect air. Each mouth can project its spell once per
round, although even by twisting its body, a
A floating undead horror regenerates  3 floating undead horror can only get a maxi-
hit points per round, and when its body mum of four mouths to point at any given
is reduced to 0 hit points it is forced into target at once. None of the spell effects from
gaseous form until it can rest in complete the lesser mouths can affect creatures di-
darkness for at least one hour. Any further rectly in front of the floating horror, since
damage done to the floating undead horror the anti-magic ray from its main mouth
during this time (which can only be done suppresses them.
by spells that affect air) will kill it.
When attacking a floating undead horror, a
The main beak of a floating undead horror character can choose to attack the body, the
projects a cone of reflection. Any spell or beak, or a tentacle.
turn undead attempt that is cast within this
cone will be reflected back on its caster. The body is armour class –4 and has 90 hit
points. Removing all these hit points will
In the case of turn undead attempts, the force the floating undead horror into gase-
turning cleric must make a saving throw ous form.
vs. spells or flee in terror for 2d6 rounds.

302
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Gargoyle Gelatinous Cube Ghast


Type: enchanted Type: ooze Type: undead
construct Habitat: underground Habitat: barren (very rare)
Habitat: ruins (rare) (common) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (v) Lair Group: 1d10 (c)
Lair Group: 2d4 (c) Lair Group: 0 (nil) Move: 40’
Move: 30’ (fly: 50’) Move: 20’ Armour Class: 6
Armour Class: 5* Armour Class: 8* Hit Dice: 3** (14hp)
Hit Dice: 4** (18hp) Hit Dice: 4* (18hp) Attack Bonus: +3
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +4 Attacks: claw
Attacks: claw (1d3) & Attacks: touch (1d3 + paralyse) &
claw (1d3) & (2d4 + paralysis) claw
bite (1d6) & vs. Death/Poison: +8 (1d3 + paralyse)
horn (1d4) vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Death/Poison: +12 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Wand: +11 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +9 Intelligence: 0 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 Morale: +19 Intelligence: 6
Intelligence: 5 XP Value: 125 Morale: +17
Morale: +18 XP Value: 65
XP Value: 175

Of all the types of construct, gargoyles are A gelatinous cube is exactly what the name A ghast is a stronger, quicker and more dan-
the most intelligent and the most prone to implies, a large blob of transparent oozing gerous version of a ghoul. They are turned
gaining free will if left without an owner. slime. Although not naturally cubic, these as if they are wights.
oozes feed by scraping detritus from the
A gargoyle is usually made of stone and floor, walls and ceiling, and therefore often Ghasts look just like ghouls, and have been
looks like a winged and horned humanoid end up in a cubic shape as they press into known to lead packs of ghouls due to their
figure. Despite their weight, they can fly the corners of a corridor. When filling a intelligence.
clumsily yet quickly. corridor like this, gelatinous cubes are often
hard to see, and surprise opponents on a rollAny ogre-sized or smaller creature touched
Because gargoyles are usually created as of 1–4 on a d6. by a ghast must make a saving throw vs. pa-
guards, they are prone to be very territo- ralysis or be paralysed for 2d4x10 minutes.
rial when rogue, attacking anyone who ap- A gelatinous cube will attack any creatures Elves are immune to this paralysis.
proaches their lair. it encounters, bashing them with pseudo-
podia that paralyse anyone hit for 2d4x10 Although ghasts have more intelligence
A gargoyle is immune to sleep and charm minutes unless they can make a saving than ghouls and more memories of when
spells, and can only be hit by magical weap- throw vs. paralysis. The cube will keep at- they were alive, they are still primarily mo-
ons. tacking until either it is dead or all enemies tivated by hunger, and still do not speak.
are dead, and then it will roll over the para-
lysed victims and start digesting them. Their constant hunger compels them to
kill and eat, although they have been seen
Although unintelligent, a gelatinous cub to show remorse for their actions, and can
will often have bits of indigestible treasure sometimes be found wailing and crying at
embedded in it. their fate.

Gelatinous cubes are immune to cold and Ghasts regenerate 1 hit point per round
lightning based attacks. until slain.

303
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Ghoul Giant (Cloud) Giant (Fire)


Type: undead Type: giant Type: giant
Habitat: barren (common) Habitat: mountains (rare) Habitat: mountains (rare)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil)
Lair Group: 2d8 (b) Lair Group: 1d3 (e+5,000gp) Lair Group: 1d3 (e+5,000gp)
Move: 30’ Move: 40’ Move: 40’
Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 4 {–4 vs 3} Armour Class: 4 {–4 vs 3}
Hit Dice: 2* (9hp) Hit Dice: 13*** (59hp) Hit Dice: 11+2*** (52hp)
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +11 {+8} Attack Bonus: +11 {+8}
Attacks: claw Attacks: mace (6d6) or Attacks: sword (5d6) or
(1d3 + paralyse) & rock (3d6) rock (3d6)
claw Weapon Expertise: grand master Weapon Expertise: grand master
(1d3 + paralyse) & {hurl range: {deflect x 3}
bite 10/20/30} {disarm at –4}
(1d3 + para- vs. Death/Poison: +14 {hurl range:
lyse) vs. Wand: +14 5/10/15}
vs. Death/Poison: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13 vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +12 vs. Wand: +13
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +12
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 Intelligence: 16 vs. Dragon Breath: +11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Morale: +17 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +10
Intelligence: 3 XP Value: 4,200 Intelligence: 13
Morale: +16 Morale: 19
XP Value: 25 XP Value: 3,875

Cloud giants are fierce and territorial hu- Fire giants stand 16’ tall and have dark red
A ghoul is an undead creature that eats car- manoids 20’ tall with white skin and hair skin and black hair. They live in or near
rion and rotten meat. As an undead, they and keen senses. They live on top of moun- volcanoes, and are immune to fire and fire
are immune to sleep and charm spells. tains above the cloud line, and often keep based attacks. Fire giants usually keep hy-
small rocs (1d6) or dire wolves (6d6) as pets. dras (1d3) or hellhounds (3d6) as pets.
Ghouls look like zombies when standing
still, although they are much more agile, ca- Cloud giants have keen senses, and are only They can throw rocks (range: 60/130/200)
pable of climbing and running at full speed. surprised on a roll of 1 on 1d6. They can at opponents who are outside melee range.
throw rocks (range: 60/130/200) at oppo-
Any ogre-sized or smaller creature touched nents who are outside melee range. Fire giants love to fight and make war, usu-
by a ghoul must make a saving throw vs. pa- ally against their frost giant rivals, but of-
ralysis or be paralysed for 2d4x10 minutes. Cloud giants tend to be loners, and dislike ten against each other. When not actually
Elves are immune to this paralysis. being disturbed – although they don’t au- fighting, fire giants show great hospitality,
tomatically attack intruders into their ter- carousing and partying with visitors and
Ghouls have a level of animal cunning ap- ritory they will usually hint strongly that guests.
proximately equal to that of dogs, although such intruders should leave as soon as they
they have only vague memories of their lives are able. Fire giants are excellent blacksmiths, and
and they cannot speak. will often trade metal goods – particularly
Cloud giants can be shamans (to 10th level) arms and armour – with their neighbours
A ghoul’s normal hunting tactic is to ignore or sorcerers (to 10th level). when not at war with them.
paralysed opponents until there are no more
moving ones left, and then kill all the para- Fire giants can be shamans (to 8th level) or
lysed victims and leave their corpses to rot sorcerers (to 6th level).
into an edible state.

304
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Giant (Frost) Giant (Hill) Giant (Stone)


Type: giant Type: giant Type: giant
Habitat: mountains (rare) Habitat: hills (common) Habitat: mountains (rare)
Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d4 (e+5,000gp) Lair Group: 1d4 (e+5,000gp) Lair Group: 1d6 (e+5,000gp)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ Move: 40’
Armour Class: 4 Armour Class: 4 {–2 vs 2} Armour Class: 4 {–2 vs 2}
Hit Dice: 10+2** (46hp) Hit Dice: 8* (36hp) Hit Dice: 9* (41hp)
Attack Bonus: +10 {+4} Attack Bonus: +8 {+2} Attack Bonus: +9 {+2}
Attacks: axe (4d6) or Attacks: club (2d8) or Attacks: club (3d6) or
rock (3d6) rock (3d6) rock (3d6)
Weapon Expertise: master Weapon Expertise: expert Weapon Expertise: expert
{delay} {deflect x 1} {deflect x 1}
{stun} {hurl range: {hurl range:
{hurl range: –/15/25} –/15/25}
–/5/10} vs. Death/Poison: +12 vs. Death/Poison: +13
vs. Death/Poison: +13 vs. Wand: +11 vs. Wand: +12
vs. Wand: +12 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11 vs. Dragon Breath: +9 vs. Dragon Breath: +10
vs. Dragon Breath: +10 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9 Intelligence: 7 Intelligence: 10
Intelligence: 14 Morale: +13 Morale: +16
Morale: +16 XP Value: 1,200 XP Value: 1,600
XP Value: 3,875

Frost giants stand 18’ tall and have pale blue Hill giants are 12’ tall, hairy and rather dim Stone giants are 14’ tall and have grey skin
skin and white or yellow hair. They live in witted. They live in roughly made cottages and no hair. They live in cave systems inside
mountains above the snow line and in polar in hills, and tend to wear animal skins and mountains, and often use stalactites as clubs.
regions, and are immune to cold and cold use natural clubs. They often have cave bears (1d4) as pets.
based attacks. Frost giants usually keep po-
lar bears (3d6) or wolves (6d6) as pets. They can throw rocks (range: 30/60/100) They can throw rocks (range: 100/200/300)
at opponents who are outside melee range. at opponents who are outside melee range.
They can throw rocks (range: 60/130/200)
at opponents who are outside melee range. Hill giants are cantankerous and belligerent, Stone giants are calm and patient, and rarely
and often take to minor banditry or raiding, get involved with outsiders unless provoked.
Frost giants try to be empire builders, since they haven’t the patience for farming They often mine gems, and show surprising
dominating all the other races in their area. and herding. dexterity for their size when it comes to
Providing visitors show the deference that cutting and polishing them.
they think is due to them, frost giants are However, they love flattery and tributes
welcoming. They love to show off their pres- (particularly of alcohol); and this will often Stone giants can be shamans (to 8th level)
tige and power. keep them pacified and away from trouble. or sorcerers (to 6th level).

Frost giants can be shamans (to 8th level) Hill giants can be shamans (to 8th level) or
or sorcerers (to 6th level). sorcerers (to 6th level).

305
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Giant (Storm) Gnoll Gnome


Type: giant Type: humanoid Type: humanoid
Habitat: mountains (rare) Habitat: hill (common) Habitat: clear (common)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) barren (common) Wandering Group: 1d8 (p)
Lair Group: 1d3 (e+5,000gp) Wandering Group: 1d6 (p) Lair Group: 5d8 (c)
Move: 50’ Lair Group: 3d6 (d) Move: 20’
Armour Class: 2 {–4 vs 4} Move: 30’ Armour Class: 5
Hit Dice: 15**** (68hp) Armour Class: 5 Hit Dice: 1 (5hp)
Attack Bonus: +12 {+8} Hit Dice: 2 (9hp) Attack Bonus: +1
Attacks: staff (8d6) or Attack Bonus: +2 Attacks: hammer (1d6) or
rock (3d6) Attacks: sword (1d8) pistol (1d6)
Weapon Expertise: grand master vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +9
{deflect x 4} vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Death/Poison: +14 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Wand: +14 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +4
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +12 Intelligence: 7 Intelligence: 11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11 Morale: +13 Morale: +13
Intelligence: 18 XP Value: 20 XP Value: 10
Morale: +17
XP Value: 6,250

Storm giants stand an impressive 22’ tall, Gnolls are fierce tribal humanoids with Gnomes are small (3’ to 4’) humanoids dis-
and have bronze skin and red or yellow hair. furred bodies and the heads (and mark- tantly related to dwarves. They look like
They live on the highest mountain peaks ings) of hyenas. Gnolls are constantly hun- small humans with long noses and beards
and keep griffons (2d4) as pets. gry, and will eat almost anything; including but bald heads. Like dwarves, the women
each other. have beards like the men, and all gnomes
Storm giants can summon a storm, taking have infravision.
ten minutes for it to form, and if in a storm Gnolls are bullies and respect only strength.
(either a summoned one or a natural one) They practically never trade, taking what- Gnomes are excellent miners, specialising
they can throw lightning bolts once per five ever weapons and livestock they can steal in mining gems and red powder.
rounds. Each lightning bolt does damage instead.
equal to the giant’s current hit points, but Gnomes are excellent tinkerers and inven-
anyone who makes a saving throw vs. spells While not the brightest of humanoids, they tors, and love anything mechanical. They
will take only half damage. Storm giants are are smart enough to mostly keep away from are very proud of the fact that guns are a
immune to lightning and lightning damage. civilised areas and to keep their raids of such gnomish invention.
areas to a minimum.
They can throw rocks (range: 150/300/450) Unlike their dwarven cousins, gnomes are
at opponents who are outside melee range, Some exceptional gnolls can become sha- very magical. They may use any magic
if no lightning is available. mans (to 6th level) or sorcerers (to 4th level). item (even those normally only usable by a
particular class) and may become shamans
Storm giants are cultured and civilised, and (to 12th level) or sorcerers (to 12th level).
tend to be friendly to those who visit them
and freely offer advice and wisdom. They
rarely get visitors, due to the inaccessible
locations they live in. Storm giants can
be shamans (to  10th level) or sorcerers
(to 10th level).

306
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Goblin Golem (Clay) Golem (Iron)


Type: humanoid Type: enchanted Type: enchanted
Habitat: woods (common) construct construct
hills (common) Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (common)
mountains Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil)
(common) Lair Group: 1d6 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (nil)
Wandering Group: 2d6 (r) Move: 30’ Move: 10’
Lair Group: 6d10 (c) Armour Class: 4 Armour Class: 2*
Move: 30’ Hit Dice: 3 (14hp) Hit Dice: 4* (18hp)
Armour Class: 6 Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +4
Hit Dice: 1–1 (4hp) Attacks: bash (1d6) & Attacks: bash (1d8) &
Attack Bonus: +1 bash (1d6) bash (1d8)
Attacks: sword (1d6) vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Death/Poison: +7 vs. Wand: +8 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Wand: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +3 Intelligence: 7 Intelligence: 7
Intelligence: 9 Morale: +18 Morale: +18
Morale: +11 XP Value: 35 XP Value: 125
XP Value: 5

Goblins are small (3’–4’ tall) green human- Clay golems are enchanted constructs made Iron golems are enchanted constructs made
oids with pointed ears and noses. Their red from a humanoid figure sculpted from clay. from a humanoid figure sculpted from iron
eyes glow softly when there is no light, giv- A stationary clay golem cannot be distin- or steel. A stationary iron golem cannot be
ing them infravision. However, in daylight guished from a terracotta statue. distinguished from an iron or steel statue.
they have a –1 penalty on all actions be-
cause of the brightness. Because of this light As constructs, they are immune to sleep and As constructs, they are immune to sleep and
sensitivity, goblins are nocturnal. charm spells. charm spells.

Goblins tend to be cowardly, whiny and Golems are the most commonly encoun- Golems are the most commonly encoun-
snivelling, and are easily bullied; but will tered type of construct, and are somewhat tered type of construct, and are somewhat
take every opportunity to be the bullies more intelligent than most other constructs, more intelligent than most other constructs,
themselves. and while unable to speak; they are able to and while unable to speak; they are able to
follow more complex orders. follow more complex orders.
Goblins can make excellent shamans (to
level 8) and sorcerers (to level 6). These gob- When an iron golem is struck with a non-
lin spell casters usually rule a goblin tribe by magical metal weapon, the attacker must
exploiting the fear that the rest of the tribe make a saving throw vs. spells or the weap-
have of their magic. on will be become stuck in the golem. A
stuck weapon cannot be removed until the
golem is destroyed. Should the golem not
be destroyed, the weapon will be absorbed
into the golem’s body over a period of time.

307
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Golem (Stone) Gorgon Green Slime


Type: enchanted Type: monster Type: ooze
construct Habitat: clear (very rare) Habitat: underground
Habitat: any (common) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil) (common)
Wandering Group: 1d3 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (e) Wandering Group: 1 (p+s)
Lair Group: 1d3 (nil) Move: 40’ Lair Group: 1 (b)
Move: 20’ Armour Class: 2 Move: 1’
Armour Class: 4 Hit Dice: 8* (36hp) Armour Class: special*
Hit Dice: 5* (23hp) Attack Bonus: +8 Hit Dice: 2** (9hp)
Attack Bonus: +5 Attacks: horn (2d6) or Attack Bonus: +2
Attacks: squirt (2d6) & special Attacks: special
squirt (2d6) or vs. Death/Poison: +12 vs. Death/Poison: +8
bash (2d6) & vs. Wand: +11 vs. Wand: +7
bash (2d6) v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Death/Poison: +10 vs. Dragon Breath: +9 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Wand: +9 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 Intelligence: 1 Intelligence: 0
vs. Dragon Breath: +7 Morale: +13 Morale: +11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6 XP Value: 1,200 XP Value: 30
Intelligence: 7
Morale: +18
XP Value: 300

Stone golems are enchanted constructs Gorgons are magical creatures that look like A green slime is an ooze of a virulent green
made from a humanoid figure sculpted bulls with iridescent metal scales. They have colour. It can crawl up walls and along ceil-
from stone. A stationary stone golem can- a bull-like temperament, normally ignor- ings, and will often drop from ceilings in a
not be distinguished from a normal stone ing creatures it sees but not hesitating to surprise attack.
statue. attack anything that looks threatening or
gets too close. Green slime can be automatically hit by any
As constructs, they are immune to sleep and attack, although it can only be harmed by
charm spells. Gorgons may either attack with their horns fire and cold attacks. A Cure Disease spell
(they may do a charge action) or by breath- will kill a green slime with no saving throw.
Golems are the most commonly encoun- ing out a cloud of vapour which is 60’ long
tered type of construct, and are somewhat and 10’ wide. Green slime is highly caustic, and can dis-
more intelligent than most other constructs, solve leather or cloth in a single round, or
and while unable to speak; they are able to All those within the cloud must make a sav- wood or metal in six rounds.
follow more complex orders. ing throw vs. breath weapon or be turned
to stone. Green slime attacks by attaching itself to a
A stone golem attacks by squirting magma victim, and then dissolving its way through
from its fingertips at opponents within 20’, Gorgons are immune to their own breath the victim’s clothing or armour until it
or simply bashing those that come within weapons and to any other attack which reaches the victim’s flesh. Once on the vic-
melee range. turns its victim to stone. tim’s flesh, it will dissolve the victim in 1d4
rounds turning it into more green slime.

Once a green slime is attached to a victim,


any fire or cold attack done to it will do half
damage to the slime and half damage to the
victim. Attacks with an area of effect (for
example Fireball spells) will do full damage
to both slime and victim.

308
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Gremlin Grey Ooze Griffon


Type: monster Type: ooze Type: monster
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: underground Habitat: mountains (rare)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) (common) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Lair Group: 2d8 (e)
Move: 40’ Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Move: 40’ (fly: 120’)
Armour Class: 7* Move: 3’ Armour Class: 5
Hit Dice: 1** (5hp) Armour Class: 8* Hit Dice: 7 (32hp)
Attack Bonus: +1 Hit Dice: 3* (14hp) Attack Bonus: +7
Attacks: special Attack Bonus: +3 Attacks: claw (1d4) &
vs. Death/Poison: +8 Attacks: special claw (1d4) &
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +8 bite (2d8)
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
Intelligence: 9 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
Morale: +19 Intelligence: 0 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
XP Value: 16 Morale: +19 Intelligence: 2
XP Value: 50 Morale: +13
XP Value: 450

Gremlins are small (3’ to 4’) green human- A grey ooze looks like a blob or boulder of A griffon is a creature with the head, wings
oids that bear a striking resemblance to gob- wet stone until it moves. and front claws of a giant eagle, and the
lins, although they are rarely found together. body, back legs and tail of a lion.
It attacks anything that comes close, trying
Gremlins radiate an aura of chaos with- to engulf its victim. Griffons are predators and will eat almost
in 20’. Within that area, anyone who takes anything. However, their favourite food is
any kind of physical action (e.g. using a If the grey ooze hits, it starts to dissolve the horse. A griffon – even a tamed one – with-
skill, or casting a spell, or making an attack) victim’s clothing and armour. Non-magical in  120’ of a horse must make a morale
must make a saving throw vs. spells or have clothing or armour can be dissolved in a check. If it fails, it will attack the horse and
the action fail. single round, but a grey ooze cannot eat try to eat it.
through magical clothing or armour. If it
Gremlins are mischievous pranksters who finds itself engulfing a victim that it can’t
find the effect of their aura of chaos hilari- digest, it will release the victim and try to
ous. engulf a different one.

Anyone who tries to attack a gremlin and Once a grey ooze has dissolved its victims
fails (whether due to the gremlin’s chaos armour or clothing, its acid will do 2d8
aura or not) must re-roll their attack against points of damage per round to the victim.
themselves. Similarly, anyone trying to cast
a spell on a gremlin who fails is affected by Grey oozes are immune to fire or cold dam-
their own spell. age, but may be harmed by normal weapons.

Gremlins may be shamans (to 4th level) or


sorcerers (to 8th level) although they will
not attack directly with spells except in the
most dire self-defence situations.

309
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Hag (Night) Hag (Sea) Halfling


Type: humanoid Type: humanoid Type: demi-human
Habitat: woods (very rare) Habitat: ocean (very rare) Habitat: hills (common)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) clear (common)
Lair Group: 1 (c) Lair Group: 1 (g+m) Wandering Group: 3d6 (p+s)
Move: 50’ (swim: 20’) Move: 40’ (swim: 50’) Lair Group: 5d8 (b)
Armour Class: 4 Armour Class: 4* {–2 vs 2} Move: 30’
Hit Dice: 15***** (68hp) Hit Dice: 8**** (36hp) Armour Class: 7
Attack Bonus: +12 Attack Bonus: +8 {+4} Hit Dice: 1–1 (4hp)
Attacks: claw Attacks: dagger {2d4} & Attack Bonus: +1
(1d4 + poison) & touch (special) Attacks: sword (1d6) or
claw Weapon Expertise: expert bow (1d6)
(1d4 + poison) or {double damage vs. Death/Poison: +12
spell 19–20} vs. Wand: +11
vs. Death/Poison: +14 {throw range v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10
vs. Wand: +13 20/30/45} vs. Dragon Breath: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +12 vs. Death/Poison: +12 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
vs. Dragon Breath: +10 vs. Wand: +11 Intelligence: 11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 Morale: +13
Intelligence: 12 vs. Dragon Breath: +9 XP Value: 5
Morale: +17 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
XP Value: 6,9000 Intelligence: 12
Morale: +17
XP Value: 2,850

Night hags are a cannibalistic humanoids Sea hags are foul humanoids who appear Halflings are a demi-human race, much
who appear to be ugly female humans with to be incredibly ugly female humans with shorter and lighter than humans, standing
warty blue-black skin and black hair. yellow-green skin and green hair. Sea hags only 3’ tall. They are of a proportionally
They live in isolation in small cottages deep are so disgusting and filth encrusted that similar build to humans, with the exception
in forests, where they surround themselves anyone who sees one or who approaches of their feet – which are large and covered
with undead minions. A night hag can cast within 10’ of one must make a saving throw in hair. The soles of halflings’ feet are tough
spells as a 15th level cleric, and can control vs. spells with a –6 penalty to avoid fleeing and resilient, and halflings often travel bare-
undead as if a 30 hit dice undead liege. in fear for 1d20+5 rounds. footed.

Night hags are immune to all the special Sea hags live underwater in coastal area, al- Halflings’ skin tone has a similar range to
abilities of undead creatures. though they can come onto the land for up that of humans, as does their hair colour.
to three hours at a time. Halflings do not grow beards or moustaches,
The claws of a night hag are extremely poi- but the sideburns of adult males tend to be
sonous, and anyone struck by one must A sea hag can control undead as if a 16 hit longer than those of humans.
make a saving throw vs. poison with a –4 dice undead liege, and is immune to all
penalty or die. the special abilities of undead creatures. A Halflings are very gregarious and can be
sea hag can only be hit by silver or magic commonly found living amongst humans
Night hags are incredibly anti-social but weapons. and other demi-humans. If left to them-
will often make a pretence at friendliness selves, they form small villages in grasslands
in order to trap potential victims. The touch of a sea hag acts as both an En- and hills where they excel at farming.
ergy Drain of one level and a Cause Disease.
There is no saving throw against either effect. Halfling food production and the halfling
love of cookery and brewing make them
very popular amongst the other races.

310
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Harpy Haunt (Banshee) Haunt (Ghost)


Type: monster Type: undead Type: undead
Habitat: mountain (rare) Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 2d4 (c) Lair Group: 1 (e, n, o) Lair Group: 1 (e, n, o)
Move: 20’ (fly: 50’) Move: 20’ Move: 30’
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: –3* Armour Class: –2*
Hit Dice: 3* (14hp) Hit Dice: 13**** (59hp) Hit Dice: 14**** (63hp)
Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +11 Attack Bonus: +12
Attacks: claw (1d4) & Attacks: touch (special) & Attacks: touch (special) &
claw (1d4) & gaze (special) gaze (special)
special vs. Death/Poison: +14 vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Death/Poison: +11 vs. Wand: +14 vs. Wand: +14
vs. Wand: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9 vs. Dragon Breath: +12 vs. Dragon Breath: +12
vs. Dragon Breath: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 Intelligence: 12 Intelligence: 13
Intelligence: 7 Morale: +16 Morale: +18
Morale: +11 XP Value: 5,150 XP Value: 5,500
XP Value: 50

Harpies look like large eagles with the headsA banshee is an undead spirit that protects A ghost is an undead spirit that tries to fulfil
(and breasts in the case of female harpies) an outdoor location that it had a connec- a task it left unfinished in life.
of beautiful elves. tion to in life from all intruders.
A ghost can only be harmed by +2 weapons
The singing of a harpy of either gender acts A banshee can only be harmed by +2 weap- or better, and is immune to all spells except
as a Charm Person spell, and harpies use ons or better, and is immune to all spells those that specifically target evil or undead.
this charm to lure travellers into ambushes. except those that specifically target evil or A ghost can make a saving throw vs. spells to
Any character that makes their saving throw undead. A banshee can make a saving throw avoid a ‘d’ or ‘D’ result when being turned.
against the singing of a harpy is immune to vs. spells to avoid a ‘d’ or ‘D’ result when
that particular harpy’s song for the rest of being turned. The touch of a ghost ages its target
the encounter. by 1d4x10 years (no save) and the gaze of
The touch of a banshee ages its target a ghost paralyses its target for 2d4 rounds
Harpies usually nest near mountain paths, by 1d4x10 years (no save) and the gaze of unless the target can make a saving throw
and try to pick off lone travellers. If they a banshee paralyses its target for 2d4 rounds vs. spells.
encounter a large or heavily armed group, unless the target can make a saving throw vs.
they will usually hide or try to use their spells. Three times per day, a banshee can A ghost can use the Magic Jar spell once
charm ability in self-defence. wail, causing all in 60’ to save vs. death or per ten minutes, and will often use this to
die. A banshee will often wail while out of possess a target and use the target’s body to
Harpies can be shamans (to 6th level) or range as a warning to potential intruders. fulfil its task, either with or without permis-
sorcerers (to 4th level). sion of the target.
Banshees can move to the ethereal plane
three times per day, and can leave it at any Ghosts can move to the ethereal plane three
time. They can also secrete a web of ecto- times per day, and can leave it at any time.
plasm tendrils around themselves in a 10’ They can also secrete a web of ectoplasm
radius that takes three rounds to form tendrils around themselves in a 10’ radius
(while taking other actions). Anyone who that takes three rounds to form (while tak-
enters the radius once formed must save vs. ing other actions). Anyone who enters the
spells or be transported to the ethereal plane. radius once formed must save vs. spells or
be transported to the ethereal plane.

311
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Haunt (Poltergeist) Hellhound Hippogriff


Type: undead Type: monster Type: monster
Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: mountains (rare) Habitat: mountains (rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) underground (rare) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (e, n, o) Wandering Group: 2d4 (nil) Lair Group: 2d8 (nil)
Move: 20’ Lair Group: 2d4 (c) Move: 60’ (fly: 120’)
Armour Class: –1* Move: 40’ Armour Class: 5
Hit Dice: 12**** (54hp) Armour Class: 4* Hit Dice: 3+1 (15hp)
Attack Bonus: +11 Hit Dice: 3** (14hp) Attack Bonus: +4
Attacks: throw Attack Bonus: +3 Attacks: claw (1d6) &
(1d4 + special) & Attacks: bite (1d6) or claw (1d6) &
throw special bite (1d10)
(1d4 + special) vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Death/Poison: +14 vs. Wand: +8 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Wand: +13 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +12 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +11 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +10 Intelligence: 12 Intelligence: 3
Intelligence: 13 Morale: +16 Morale: +13
Morale: +18 XP Value: 65 XP Value: 50
XP Value: 4,750

A poltergeist is the undead spirit of a dead Hellhounds are wolf-like creatures with A hippogriff is a creature with the head,
child. It is naturally invisible, even when reddish-brown fur and glowing red eyes wings and front claws of a giant eagle, and
attacking. that can grow to about 5’ tall. They live the body, back legs and tail of a horse.
in or near volcanoes, and are immune to
A poltergeist can only be harmed by +2 non-magical fire. Hippogriffs are predators and scavengers
weapons or better, and is immune to all that normally take only small live prey or
spells except those that specifically target Despite their appearance as little more than chase other creatures off to steal their kills.
evil or undead. A ghost can make a saving dogs, hellhounds are sapient, and are as in- However, hippogriffs have a fierce hatred of
throw vs. spells to avoid a ‘d’ or ‘D’ result telligent as humans. Their acute senses allow pegasi and will attack them on sight to drive
when being turned. them to constantly Detect Invisible. them away. A hippogriff – even a tamed
one – within 120’ of a pegasus must make
A poltergeist can throw small objects around, A hellhound may breathe fire at a single op- a morale check. If it fails, it will attack the
and any target hit by one of these objects ponent within 10’. This fire breath does 3d6 pegasus and try to kill it or drive it off.
will be aged by 10 years unless they can damage, although the target may make a
make a saving throw vs. spells. A poltergeist saving throw vs. dragon breath to take half
is normally more mischievous than aggres- damage.
sive and will deliberately miss targets with
its thrown objects, although it will react
angrily to any insult or any attempt to get
rid of it and try to kill the offender.

Poltergeists can move to the ethereal plane


three times per day, and can leave it at any
time. They can also secrete a web of ecto-
plasm tendrils around themselves in a 10’
radius that takes three rounds to form
(while taking other actions). Anyone who
enters the radius once formed must save vs.
spells or be transported to the ethereal plane.

312
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Hobgoblin Horse (Draft) Horse (Pony)


Type: humanoid Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: woods (common) Habitat: settled (common) Habitat: settled (common)
hills (common) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
mountains Lair Group: 0 (nil) Lair Group: 5d10 (nil)
(common) Move: 30’ Move: 70’
Wandering Group: 1d6 (q) Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 7
Lair Group: 4d6 (d) Hit Dice: 3 (14hp) Hit Dice: 2 (9hp)
Move: 30’ Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +2
Armour Class: 6 Attacks: bite (1d3) Attacks: kick (1d4) &
Hit Dice: 1+1 (6hp) vs. Death/Poison: +8 kick (1d4)
Attack Bonus: +2 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +8
Attacks: sword (1d8) v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 Morale: +9 Intelligence: 7
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 XP Value: 35 Morale: +9
Intelligence: 10 XP Value: 20
Morale: +13
XP Value: 15

Hobgoblins are larger and stronger cousins Draft horses are large horses bred for Ponies are small horses that are mainly do-
of goblins. They look like goblins, but can strength and stamina rather than speed. mesticated but also occur in the wild.
reach 6’ tall and are more muscular. They are normally used to pull carts and
wagons. Because of their small size, ponies are popu-
Their red eyes glow softly when there is lar mounts for halflings and dwarves.
no light, giving them infravision. Unlike Draft horses are a totally domesticated spe-
goblins, hobgoblins are at no penalty in cies, and do not occur in the wild.
daylight, although they still prefer darkness.

Hobgoblins do not have their own spell


casters, and this often puts them in a pre-
carious relationship with goblin tribes, as
the hobgoblins are naturally more powerful
than most of the goblins but cannot domi-
nate them completely because they both
fear and need the goblin spell casters.

313
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Horse (Riding) Horse (War) Human (Bandit)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: humanoid
Habitat: settled (common) Habitat: settled (common) Habitat: any (common)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 2d4 (u)
Lair Group: 10d10 (nil) Lair Group: 0 (nil) Lair Group: 2d10 (a)
Move: 80’ Move: 80’ Move: 30’
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 2 (9hp) Hit Dice: 3 (14hp) Hit Dice: 1 (5hp)
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +1
Attacks: kick (1d4) & Attacks: kick (1d6) & Attacks: sword (1d8)
kick (1d4) kick (1d6) vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 11
Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2 Morale: +13
Morale: +11 Morale: +16 XP Value: 10
XP Value: 20 XP Value: 20

Riding horses are domesticated horses com- War horses are strong, heavy horses bred The statistics given here are for typical sorts
monly used for riding. These statistics can for their courage and willingness to fight. of robber, brigand pirate and bandit that
also be used for wild horses. might be met. Bandit leaders are likely to
They are purely a domesticated breed, and be higher level characters with the same
do not exist in the wild. character classes and abilities that player
characters have.
War horses can do the charge action in
combat, but cannot attack at the end of it.
However, if a war horse does a charge ac-
tion then its rider gets the double-damage
benefit.

Anyone using the set spear action against a


charging war horse can choose to either hit
the horse or its rider.

314
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Human (Berserker) Human (Commoner) Human (Noble)


Type: humanoid Type: humanoid Type: humanoid
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (common)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (p) Wandering Group: 1d4 (p) Wandering Group: 1 (vx3)
Lair Group: 3d10 (b) Lair Group: 3d20 (u) Lair Group: 2d6 (d+b)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ Move: 20’
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 9 Armour Class: 2 {–2 vs 1}
Hit Dice: 1+1* (6hp) Hit Dice: 1–1 (4hp) Hit Dice: 5* (23hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +0 Attack Bonus: +5 {+2}
Attacks: axe (1d8) Attacks: spear (1d6) Attacks: sword {1d12}
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +7 Weapon Expertise: skilled
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +6 {deflect x 1}
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +5 {disarm at +0}
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +4 vs. Death/Poison: +10
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +3 vs. Wand: +9
Intelligence: 9 Intelligence: 10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8
Morale: +19 Morale: +9 vs. Dragon Breath: +7
XP Value: 19 XP Value: 5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6
Intelligence: 10
Morale: +13
XP Value: 400

Berserkers are tribal warriors who are The statistics given here are for a normal These statistics are for a minor non-landed
known for their ferocity in battle. human with no combat experience, such noble such as a knight. Such a noble will
as peasants, artists, servants or townsfolk. have extensive combat training, but little
Although no more likely to be hostile than practical experience.
any other human, when involved in a fight
berserkers are overtaken with a frenzy which More experienced nobles who are in charge
causes them to fight to the death, never re- of fiefdoms and are proven in battle are like-
treating, surrendering or taking prisoners. ly to be at least 9th level characters with
the same character classes and abilities that
While in their frenzied state, berserkers player characters have.
never need to make morale checks and get
a +4 bonus to all saving throws against fear
effects.

315
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Human (Veteran) Hydra Ice Spider


Type: humanoid Type: monster Type: monster
Habitat: any (common) Habitat: swamp (rare) Habitat: arctic (very rare)
Wandering Group: 2d4 (u) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) ocean (very rare)
Lair Group: 4d10 (a) Lair Group: 1 (b) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Move: 30’ Move: 40’ Lair Group: 1 (f )
Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 5 Move: 20’ (swim: 60’)
Hit Dice: 2 (9hp) Hit Dice: varies Armour Class: 2*
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: varies Hit Dice: 7** (31hp)
Attacks: sword (1d8) Attacks: varies Attack Bonus: +7
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: varies Attacks: claw (1d10) &
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: varies claw (1d10) or
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: varies special
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: varies vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: varies vs. Wand: +14
Intelligence: 11 Intelligence: 2 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13
Morale: +17 Morale: +18 vs. Dragon Breath: +12
XP Value: 20 XP Value: varies vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11
Intelligence: 9
Morale: +16
XP Value: 1,250

These statistics can be used for squads of Hydras are huge creatures with 30’ long Ice spiders are large intelligent spiders
soldiers or mercenary companies who have snake-like bodies that split into between 5 with 8’ bodies that are entirely made of ice.
seen plenty of real action (as opposed to and 12 necks and heads. See Table 18–7 for Ice spiders are coldly logical creatures that
merely training) and are somewhat battle- the statistics of hydras that vary by number show no compassion or mercy to others
hardened. of heads. who get in their way, and seem to have no
imagination.
The leaders of such groups are likely to be Each head of a hydra can operate indepen-
dently, and can make a single bite attack in Ice spiders can only be hit by magical weap-
higher level characters, usually fighters, with
the same character classes and abilities thatcombat for 1d10 damage. ons, and are immune to first and second
player characters have. level spells and all fire based attacks.
Damage to a hydra’s heads is not tracked
independently, but for each 8 damage that An ice spider can cast the following spells
the hydra takes from any source, one head as if a 9th level caster:
will cease to function and no longer be able
to attack. ◊ Detect Invisible at will
◊ Detect Magic at will
Hydras are very territorial and aggressive ◊ Web at will
creatures, and will attack any who approach ◊ Dispel Magic at will
the swamp or lake where they live. ◊ Ice Storm/wall at will
◊ Water to ice (exactly like a Dissolve spell
but substituting solid ice for rock and
slush for mud) three times per day.
Table 18–7: Hydra Abilities by Number of Heads ◊ Ice to water (exactly like a Harden spell
Number of but substituting slush for mud and solid
Hit Dice Attack Bonus Save As Xp ice for rock) three times per day.
Heads
5 5 (23hp) +5 Fighter 5th 175
6 6 (27hp) +6 Fighter 6th 275
7 7 (32hp) +7 Fighter 7th 450
8 8 (36hp) +8 Fighter 8th 650
9 9 (41hp) +9 Fighter 9th 900
10 10 (45hp) +10 Fighter 10th 1,000
11 11 (50hp) +10 Fighter 11th 1,100
12 12 (54hp) +11 Fighter 12th 1,250

316
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Insect Swarm Invisible Stalker Iron Urchin


Type: animal Type: enchanted Type: monster
Habitat: any (rare) extraplanar Habitat: underground
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Habitat: extraplanar (very rare)
Lair Group: 1d3 (nil) (very rare) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil)
Move: 10’ (fly: 20’) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 10d100 (nil)
Armour Class: 7 Lair Group: 0 (nil) Move: 80’
Hit Dice: 2* (9hp) Move: 40’ Armour Class: 2*
Attack Bonus: – Armour Class: 7 Hit Dice: 9* (41hp)
Attacks: special Hit Dice: 8* (36hp) Attack Bonus: +9
vs. Death/Poison: +7 Attack Bonus: +8 Attacks: spike (1d12) &
vs. Wand: +6 Attacks: bash (4d4) spike (1d12) &
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +5 vs. Death/Poison: +12 spike (1d12)
vs. Dragon Breath: +4 vs. Wand: +11 vs. Death/Poison: +17
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +3 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 vs. Wand: +14
Intelligence: 0 vs. Dragon Breath: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +14
Morale: +18 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +14
XP Value: 25 Intelligence: 11 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +14
Morale: +19 Intelligence: 10
XP Value: 1,200 Morale: +16
XP Value: 1,600

An insect swarm is a multitude of tiny Invisible stalkers are extraplanar creatures Iron urchins are strange creatures that live
insects acting as a single creature. Some that are naturally invisible. When viewed deep underground. They have the appear-
insects swarm naturally, but others only under a Detect Invisible effect, they appear ance of a central ball 2’ in diameter sur-
swarm when commanded by the magical to be roughly humanoid in shape with a rounded on all sides by 3’ spikes, all made
power of another creature. curiously “melted” appearance. of iron.

A swarm fills a 10’x10’x30’ area, and au- Invisible stalkers are often summoned to An iron urchin has no visible sensory organs,
tomatically hits any creature in the area the prime plane to perform tasks. They hate mouth or other features, and feeds by ab-
each round for 2 points of damage (if the such service, and will often try to go against sorbing mineral nutrients directly from the
creature is ac 5 or better) or 4 damage (if the spirit of their instructions to the detri- earth through its skin. They communicate
the creature is ac 6 or worse). This damage ment of the person summoning them, while solely by telepathy, and are usually friendly
represents many stings and bites. still being forced to obey the letter of them. to outsiders unless provoked.

Any creature in the area whose action for Invisible stalkers can surprise opponents Iron urchins can only be hit by magical
the round is either to run from the area or on a roll of 1–5 on 1d6, unless those op- weapons, and are immune to first and sec-
to swat the insects with a weapon or torch ponents can see invisible creatures. ond level spells and poison. An iron urchin
will take only 1 damage. can cast the following spells as if a 9th level
An invisible stalker remains invisible even caster:
Attacking the swarm by swatting insects when attacking. See Chapter 8 – Combat
with a melee weapon will only do a sin- for the effect of invisibility on combat. ◊ Detect Invisible at will
gle point of damage to it. Swarms are not ◊ Detect Magic at will
harmed by missile weapons. Fire and cold ◊ Haste at will
attacks or area effect attacks do full damage ◊ Dispel Magic at will
to a swarm. ◊ Ice Storm/wall at will
◊ Earth to air (exactly like a Dissolve spell
but substituting air for mud) three times
per day.
◊ Air to earth (exactly like a Harden spell
but substituting air for mud) three times
per day.

317
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Kobold Leech (Giant) Lich


Type: humanoid Type: animal Type: undead
Habitat: hills (common) Habitat: swamp (common) Habitat: any (very rare)
mountains (common) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
underground Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Lair Group: 1 (hx4)
(common) Move: 30’ Move: 30’
Wandering Group: 4d4 (p) Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: varies
Lair Group: 6d10 (j) Hit Dice: 6 (27hp) Hit Dice: varies
Move: 30’ Attack Bonus: +6 Attack Bonus: varies
Armour Class: 7 Attacks: bite (1d6) Attacks: touch
Hit Dice: 1/2 (3hp) vs. Death/Poison: +9 (1d10 + special) or
Attack Bonus: +1 vs. Wand: +8 weapon (varies) or
Attacks: hammer (1d6–1) v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 spell
or vs. Dragon Breath: +6 Weapon Expertise: grand master
pistol (1d6) vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Death/Poison: varies
vs. Death/Poison: +8 Intelligence: 0 vs. Wand: varies
vs. Wand: +7 Morale: +17 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: varies
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 XP Value: 275 vs. Dragon Breath: varies
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: varies
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 18+
Intelligence: 5 Morale: +17
Morale: +16 XP Value: varies
XP Value: 5

Kobolds are small (3’ tall) hairless human- Giant leeches are 3’–4’ long parasitic worm- A lich is a human magic-user or cleric who
oids with heads shaped like those of hounds. like creatures that suck blood from prey has used a forbidden arcane ritual to turn
Their skin is soft and dry like that of a snake, larger than themselves. themselves into an undead creature. Al-
with patchy yellowish brown pigmentation. though theoretically a lich can have any
Kobolds do not have tails. If a giant leech hits a target, it will hold personality, it is normally only the most
on to that victim and automatically do 1d6 depraved or desperate individuals who are
Kobolds have infravision and keen senses. damage per round until it is killed or its willing to perform the ritual.
Although not too bright in general, kobolds victim dies.
have an innate genius for trap building A lich will have all the abilities of a magic-
user or cleric of level 21 or higher, plus the
Kobolds usually live underground in clans following:
in well-guarded lairs. They are keen and
gregarious, if unscrupulous and immoral, A lich’s skeletal form is armour class 0 (un-
opportunists; easily convinced to work with less wearing better armour) and is immune
other races on some common scheme. to charm, sleep, cold, lightning, polymorph,
Feeblemind, and Death Spells. They are also
Kobolds prefer not to fight at all, letting immune to non-magical weapons and to all
traps do the work for them. If forced to spells of level 3 or lower.
fight, their preferred method is ambush and
hit-and-run tactics, combining surprising Any living creature with fewer than 5 hit
bravery with practical self-preservation. dice will flee in terror (no saving throw)
from a lich for 2d6 rounds.
Kobolds can be shamans (to 6th level) or
sorcerers (to 4th level). The touch of a lich does 1d10 cold damage
and paralyses any living creature for 1d100
days unless the creature can make a saving
throw vs. paralysis. The paralysis can be re-
moved by a Dispel Magic spell.

318
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Lizard Man Lizard (Giant Draco)


Type: humanoid Type: animal
Habitat: river (common) Habitat: jungle (common)
swamp (common) Wandering Group: 1d4 (u)
Wandering Group: 2d4 (nil) Lair Group: 1d8 (nil)
Lair Group: 6d6 (d) Move: 40’ (glide: 50’)
Move: 20’ (swim: 40’) Armour Class: 5
Armour Class: 5 Hit Dice: 4+2 (20hp)
Hit Dice: 2+1 Attack Bonus: +5
Attack Bonus: +3 Attacks: bite (1d10)
Attacks: spear (1d6+1) vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 2
Intelligence: 6 Morale: +11
Morale: +19 XP Value: 125
XP Value: 25

Because liches are so intelligent, the Game Lizard men are humanoid crocodilians, of- Giant draco lizards are 6’ long lizards with
Master should put thought and preparation ten found in swamps or along rivers. flaps of skin between their front and rear
into their motivations and tactics, in par- legs that let them glide through the air.
ticular the potential for them to have cast Although not particularly evil or intelligent,
the Permanence and Contingency spells on lizard men are cannibalistic and particularly They are carnivorous, and hunt by leap-
themselves. A lich will not simply be ran- like to eat any other intelligent humanoid ing out of tall trees and gliding down at
domly encountered and get into a pointless if given the chance. their prey. The initial glide attack should
fight where it has a chance of dying. be treated as a charge action.
When swimming, lizard men look just like
A lich can summon undead by concentrat- crocodiles.
ing, although it does not know what type of
undead will turn up. Each time a lich sum- Lizard men live a simple hunter-gatherer
mons undead, roll 1d20 to determine what existence, and have no technology beyond
type of undead arrive in 1d100 rounds: a basic spear or club. Surprisingly, they don’t
bite in combat. Although they have power-
1–5 = 2d4 spectres ful jaws, their shape and stance prevents
6–9 = 1d6 vampires them from being effective in a fight while
10–12 = 1d3 phantoms on land.
13–15 = 1d2 ghosts
16 = 1d2 poltergeists Lizard men often find themselves in uneasy
17 = druj truces with other races who provide them
18 = revenant tributes of food (the only thing they value)
19 = nightshade in order to prevent them raiding.
20 = flt. Undead horror
In addition, a lich will be accompanied by
undead minions that it controls as an un-
dead liege, and often by other servants or
minions. A lich is treated as if it had hit
dice equal to its level for the purposes of
experience value, plus the equivalent of five
asterisks if a cleric, or six if a magic-user.

319
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Lizard (Giant Gecko) Lizard (Giant Horned) Lizard (Giant Tuatara)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (common) Habitat: desert (common)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (u) Wandering Group: 2d4 (u) Wandering Group: 1d2 (v)
Lair Group: 1d10 (nil) Lair Group: 1d6 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ Move: 30’
Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 2 Armour Class: 4
Hit Dice: 3+1 (15hp) Hit Dice: 5* (23hp) Hit Dice: 6 (27hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +5 Attack Bonus: +6
Attacks: bite (1d8) Attacks: bite (2d4) & Attacks: claw (1d4) &
vs. Death/Poison: +8 horn (1d6) claw (1d4) &
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +9 bite (1d6)
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
Morale: +11 Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
XP Value: 50 Morale: +11 Intelligence: 2
XP Value: 300 Morale: +9
XP Value: 275

Giant geckos are 5’ long carnivorous lizards Giant horned lizards are 7’ long and can Giant tuatara lizards are heavily built  8’
that hunt halfling sized or smaller creatures change colour to match their surroundings, long lizards with lumpy armoured skin.
by climbing up above them and dropping surprising prey on a 1–5 on 1d6. They look somewhat like elongated toads.
on them.
A horned lizard can shoot its tongue 10’. Tuatara have infravision which they use to
Giant geckos can walk on any surface, in- Anyone human-sized or smaller hit by hunt at night.
cluding smooth glass walls and ceiling. the tongue is immediately pulled into the
horned lizard’s mouth and bitten for 2d4
damage.

Horned lizards favour hunting giant insects,


but will hunt other creatures if hungry.

320
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Locust (Giant) Manta Ray Manticore


Type: animal Type: animal Type: monster
Habitat: underground Habitat: ocean (common) Habitat: mountains (rare)
(common) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil)
Wandering Group: 2d10 (nil) Lair Group: 1d3 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (f )
Lair Group: 0 (nil) Move: 40’ Move: 40’ (fly: 60’)
Move: 20’ (jump: 60’) Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 4
Armour Class: 4 Hit Dice: 4* (18hp) Hit Dice: 6+1* (28hp)
Hit Dice: 2** (9hp) Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +4
Attack Bonus: +2 Attacks: tail Attacks: claw (1d4) &
Attacks: bite (1d2) or (1d8 + special) claw (1d4) &
jump (1d4) or vs. Death/Poison: +8 bite (2d4) or
special vs. Wand: +7 special
vs. Death/Poison: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Death/Poison: +11
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Wand: +10
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 Intelligence: 2 vs. Dragon Breath: +8
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Morale: +11 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7
Intelligence: 0 XP Value: 125 Intelligence: 3
Morale: +7 Morale: +16
XP Value: 30 XP Value: 650

Giant locusts live underground and eat Manta rays are flat fish up to 7’ long that are A manticore is a strange creature with the
fungus and moulds of all types. They are related to sharks. Their bodies are shaped body of a lion, the wings of a bat, a human
immune to poisons and the dissolving at- with distinctive “wings”, with which they face, and a spike covered tail. Despite the
tacks of oozes. glide along the sea bed. human seeming face, manticores are not
sapient.
Although giant locusts can give a nasty When a manta ray settles, it covers itself in
bite, they prefer to flee by jumping away sand until it is completely invisible. A manticore has 24 tail spikes, and can shoot
from intruders. Unfortunately, their pan- six of them per round (range: 50/100/150),
icked jumping is 50% likely to be straight A manta ray will normally eat only small even when it is flying. Spikes are re-grown
at their targets, in which case they should fish, and ignore large targets. However, if at a rate of two per day.
roll a jump attack against a random target. trodden on, a manta ray will attack with
the poisonous sting on its tail. Manticores are aggressive hunters, and will
If cornered and unable to jump away, a gi- attempt to kill and eat even well-armed
ant locust will make a piercing scream, and Anyone struck by the tail of a manta ray groups of travellers.
spit a blob of goo at an attacker within 10’. must make a saving throw vs. paralysis or
be paralysed for 2d4x10 minutes.
If it hits, the goo does no damage, but
the attacker must make a saving throw vs.
poison or be able to do nothing but retch
for  10 minutes due to the smell. Once
the 10 minutes has passed, the victim of
the goo attack is used to the smell, but other
characters coming within 5’ of them are
subject to the same retching unless they
can make a saving throw vs. poison. Giant
locust spittle can be washed off with water.

321
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Medusa Merfolk
Type: humanoid Type: humanoid
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: ocean (common)
Wandering Group: 1d3 (v) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d4 (f ) Lair Group: 1d20 (a)
Move: 30’ Move: 40’
Armour Class: 8 Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 4** (18hp) Hit Dice: 1 (5hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +1
Attacks: snakebite Attacks: spear (1d6)
(1d4 + special) & vs. Death/Poison: +8
special vs. Wand: +7
vs. Death/Poison: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Wand: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 Intelligence: 12
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 Morale: +13
Intelligence: 9 XP Value: 10
Morale: +13
XP Value: 175

A medusa appears to be a human with Characters trying to fight the medusa blind- Merfolk, usually referred to as mermen and
snakes instead of hair. Male medusae are folded or otherwise averting their gaze will mermaids, are water breathing humanoids
rarely seen, and many people mistakenly not be affected but must attack with a –4 with a fishlike tail instead of legs. Merfolk
think that the race is entirely female. Al- penalty to hit and the medusa gets a +2 can only stay out of water as long as they
though the faces of medusae are normally bonus against characters using such tactics. can hold their breaths – which is just like a
beautiful, their beauty is deceptive and their normal human holding their breath.
gaze can turn people to stone. A character using a mirror to attack in melee
(the mirror takes one hand, so the character Merfolk society is similar to human society.
The bite of a medusa’s snakes is poisonous, cannot use an off-hand weapon or a shield They live in underwater cities and keep do-
and anyone bitten must make a saving at the same time) takes only a –2 penalty to mesticated animals.
throw vs. poison or die. Additionally, any hit and the medusa gets no bonus against
creature meeting its gaze must make a sav- them. Merfolk communities often trade with land
ing throw vs. petrify or be turned to stone. based creatures, and are usually on good
Although medusae are feared by other races terms with human countries.
The gaze of a medusa must be direct, see- for their gaze, the personalities of individual
ing its reflection is not enough to have a medusae are as varied as those of humans, In theory, any merfolk can be a shaman
chance of being turned to stone. However, although they do have a tendency to be lon- (to 8th level) or sorcerer (to 8th level), al-
a medusa is not immune to its own gaze ers and to value their privacy greatly. though their society teaches that shamanism
attack (although it is immune to the gaze is an exclusively male role and sorcery is an
of other medusae), and if presented with a Medusae can be shamans (to 8th level) or exclusively female role. Consequently, most
mirror, there is a 1 in 6 chance per round sorcerers (to 8th level). human contact is with mermaid sorcerers
that it will see its reflection and must make capable of casting Water Breathing (which
the saving throw to avoid petrifying itself. allows them to breathe air).
This is the only circumstance in which its
gaze is effective through a mirror.

Any character surprised by a medusa auto-


matically meets its gaze and must make the
saving throw, and in combat each charac-
ter attacking the medusa without actively
avoiding the gaze must also make the saving
throw each round.

322
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Minotaur Mournwolf Mujina


Type: humanoid Type: monster Type: monster
Habitat: underground Habitat: clear (rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
(common) woods (rare) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (e)
Lair Group: 1d8 (c) Lair Group: 1d4 (d) Move: 40’
Move: 40’ Move: 50’ Armour Class: 4
Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 4 Hit Dice: 8** (36hp)
Hit Dice: 6* (27hp) Hit Dice: 6* (27hp) Attack Bonus: +8 {+2}
Attack Bonus: +6 {+2} Attack Bonus: +6 Attacks: sword {2d8+2} &
Attacks: gore (1d6) & Attacks: bite (2d6) sword {2d8+2}
bite (1d6) or vs. Death/Poison: +11 Weapon Expertise: expert
axe {1d8+4}+2 vs. Wand: +10 {stun}
Weapon Expertise: expert v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9 {deflect x 2}
{delay} vs. Dragon Breath: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +12
{hurl –/5/10} vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 vs. Wand: +11
vs. Death/Poison: +11 Intelligence: 3 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10
vs. Wand: +10 Morale: +13 vs. Dragon Breath: +9
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9 XP Value: 500 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
vs. Dragon Breath: +8 Intelligence: 10
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 Morale: +16
Intelligence: 5 XP Value: 1,750
Morale: +19
XP Value: 500

Minotaurs are 8’ tall humanoids with the Mournwolves are oversized wolves with a Mujina are a strange humanoid race. They
heads of bulls. They are incredibly aggres- magical ability to howl and wail in a confus- appear similar to humans, except that they
sive and will attack most other creatures ing manner. Mournwolves usually stay with have no features on their heads. Their heads
on sight in an attempt to kill and eat them. their own kind, but occasionally a single are just smooth ovals. However, they can
one will become pack leader of a group of mask this with an illusion that makes their
Minotaurs love to live and hunt in maze- normal wolves. head look like whatever they like, including
like tunnel systems and are expert at both a copy of someone else’s face.
finding their way through mazes and While mourning, which can be done in
tracking. Because of this familiarity with combat, all opponents are disoriented by A mujuna can drop its illusion at any time,
labyrinths, they are treated as if having 18 the echoing sound (no saving throw) and and anyone seeing the true blankness of
intelligence for purposes of the Maze spell. all attacks against the mournwolf take a –2 the mujina’s face must run in terror for 1d3
penalty on their to-hit rolls. Additionally, rounds. Creatures with 5 or more hit dice
Although barely sapient, some of the calmer the mournwolf gets a +2 bonus on all sav- may make a saving throw vs. wands to avoid
and more level-headed minotaurs can be- ing throws against any effects cast by diso- this effect.
come shamans (to level 4) or even sorcerers riented foes.
(to level 2). Mujina are incredibly strong, and can wield
The mourning effect can be blocked by a a two handed weapon in either hand with-
Silence 15’ Radius spell. out penalty.

For some reason, mournwolves hate blink Mujina all have absolutely identical per-
dogs and attack them on sight. sonalities, and no sense of individualism.
They hate all creatures that show diversity of
personality; especially humans, who show
the most diversity of all races.

323
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Mule Mummy Neanderthal


Type: animal Type: undead Type: humanoid
Habitat: settled (common) Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (rare)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d10 (nil)
Lair Group: 2d12 (nil) Lair Group: 1d12 (d) Lair Group: 4d10 (c)
Move: 40’ Move: 20’ Move: 40’
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 3* Armour Class: 8
Hit Dice: 2 (9hp) Hit Dice: 5+1** (24hp) Hit Dice: 2 (9hp)
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +5 Attack Bonus: +2
Attacks: kick (1d4) Attacks: touch (1d12 Attacks: club (1d6+1)
vs. Death/Poison: +8 + special) vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +10 vs. Wand: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6 Intelligence: 7
Morale: +13 Intelligence: 6 Morale: +11
XP Value: 20 Morale: +19 XP Value: 20
XP Value: 575

Mules are domestic cross-breeds between Mummies are re-animated corpses that have Neanderthals are closely related to humans,
donkeys and horses. been specially prepared and wrapped so that although they are squat and ape-like, with
they will become undead. sloping brows.
They are commonly used as pack animals,
since they combine the strength of a horse Mummies are normally placed as tomb They mostly live in “lost world” areas, where
with the stamina and patience of a donkey. guardians, but occasionally one or more they have a peaceful hunter gatherer exist-
will wander from its tomb and wreak hav- ence.
Mules will allow themselves to be led into oc – especially if the tomb has already been
underground areas. looted. Neanderthals fear fire, and have never de-
veloped cooking and metalworking skills,
Anyone seeing a mummy must make a sav- although they are expert at making weapons
ing throw vs. paralysis or be paralysed in and tools from hides or stone such as flint.
fear until the mummy is no longer in sight.
Neanderthals often keep cave apes or dire
The touch of a mummy rots flesh, do- wolves as pets.
ing 1d12 damage and causing the victim
to contract mummy rot (no saving throw). Neanderthals can be shamans (to 4th level)
Mummy rot prevents its victim from being or sorcerers (to 2nd level).
healed by mortal level magic, and makes
all natural healing take ten times as long as
normal to occur. It can be cured by a Cure
Disease effect.

Mummies cannot be hurt by non-magical


weapons, and are immune to sleep, charm,
and hold effects. Attacks from sources other
than fire only do half damage to mummies.

324
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Nightcrawler
Type: undead
Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Move: 40’
Armour Class: –4*
Hit Dice: 27***** (122hp)
Attack Bonus: +18
Attacks: bite (2d10
+ special) &
sting (2d4
+ special)
vs. Death/Poison: +16
vs. Wand: +16
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +15
vs. Dragon Breath: +16
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +15
Intelligence: 19
Morale: +19
XP Value: 21,500

Nightcrawlers are a type of nightshade, Nightcrawlers can cast the following spells, The bite of a nightcrawler does 2d10 dam-
incredibly powerful undead. They appear as if 21st level casters: age, and the victim must make a saving
to be huge rotting maggots or worms 100’ throw vs. poison or die. Additionally, if the
long and 10’ wide that can burrow through ◊ Detect Magic (constant) attack roll is a natural 19–20, a human size
the earth. Despite their bestial appearance, ◊ Detect Invisible (constant) victim will be swallowed whole. Swallowed
nightcrawlers are extremely intelligent. Be- ◊ Cause Disease (at will) victims lose one level per round due to an
cause they know that they are so conspicu- ◊ Charm Person (at will) Energy Drain unless protected by a Protec-
ous that operating openly would attract the ◊ Cloudkill (at will) tion from Evil spell.
attention of all the most powerful foes, they ◊ Confusion (at will)
usually remain hidden and work through ◊ Darkness (at will) The sting of a nightcrawler does 2d4 dam-
their minions as an undead liege. Night- ◊ Dispel Magic (at will) age, and the victim must make a saving
crawlers desire to completely eradicate the ◊ Finger of Death (at will) throw vs. poison or die. Even if the saving
living and make everyone undead, and work ◊ Haste (at will) throw is successful, there is a 1 in 8 chance
towards that end, although they do not co- ◊ Hold Person (at will) that the poison will kill the victim anyway.
operate well with others in anything other ◊ Invisibility (at will) A nightcrawler has a gaze attack that it can
than a relationship of absolute dominance. use instead of physically attacking or cast-
Any creature touching a nightcrawler must ing spells, that will magically shrink one
Nightcrawlers are only hit by +3 weapons make a saving throw vs. poison or die. This opponent per round within 60’ down to 1’
or better, and are immune to spells of 5th poison does not travel through weapons, so in height unless that opponent can make
level or lower, charm, hold, illusions, wands, melee attacks with weapons are safe. a saving throw vs. spells. The nightcrawler
poison, petrification and cold effects. They gains a +4 bonus to hit that opponent, and
take only half damage from breath weapons. Nightcrawlers emanate a distinctive chilling can swallow it on a 15–20 rather than just
aura within 120’ which spoils all consuma- a 19–20. The shrinking effect is permanent
Nightcrawlers are resistant to being turned, bles (no save), including food, potions, and until dispelled.
and may make a saving throw vs. spells to even holy water. Spoiled consumables are
ignore an attempt to turn them. If the turn not poisonous, but are inedible and useless.
result is a ‘d’, then they may make a second This aura usually prevents the nightcrawler
saving throw to reduce it to a ‘t’. from surprising opponents.

325
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Nightwalker
Type: undead
Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Move: 50’ (fly: 20’)
Armour Class: –6*
Hit Dice: 23***** (104hp)
Attack Bonus: +16
Attacks: bash (3d10
+ special) &
bash (3d10
+ special)
vs. Death/Poison: +16
vs. Wand: +15
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +15
vs. Dragon Breath: +15
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +14
Intelligence: 19
Morale: +19
XP Value: 15,500

Nightwalkers are a type of nightshade, in- Nightwalkers can cast the following spells, The blows of a nightwalker do 3d10 damage
credibly powerful undead. They appear to as if 21st level casters: and the target must make a saving throw vs.
be 20’ tall rotting giants who never wear poison or die. Additionally, these blows are
clothes or carry items. Nightwalkers are ◊ Detect Magic (constant) so powerful that they have a 50% chance of
extremely intelligent. Because they know ◊ Detect Invisible (constant) destroying their foe’s armour or shield. This
that they are so conspicuous that operating ◊ Cause Disease (at will) chance is reduced by 10% per magical “plus”
openly would attract the attention of all ◊ Charm Person (at will) of the item. Check for armour being de-
the most powerful foes, they usually remain ◊ Cloudkill (at will) stroyed only if the foe is not using a shield.
hidden and work through their minions ◊ Confusion (at will)
as an undead liege. Nightwalkers desire to ◊ Darkness (at will) A nightwalker has a gaze attack that it can
completely eradicate the living and make ◊ Dispel Magic (at will) use instead of physically attacking or cast-
everyone undead, and work towards that ◊ Finger of Death (at will) ing spells that will magically curse one op-
end, although they do not co-operate well ◊ Haste (at will) ponent per round within 60’ unless that
with others in anything other than a rela- ◊ Hold Person (at will) opponent can make a saving throw vs. spells.
tionship of absolute dominance. ◊ Invisibility (at will) A cursed character takes a –4 penalty on
all attack rolls and saving throws, until the
Nightwalkers are only hit by +3 weapons Any creature touching a nightwalker must curse is removed by either a Dispel Evil cast
or better, and are immune to spells of 5th make a saving throw vs. poison or die. This by anyone or a Remove Curse cast by a spell
level or lower, charm, hold, illusions, wands, poison does not travel through weapons, so caster of at least 25th level.
poison, petrification and cold effects. They melee attacks with weapons are safe.
take only half damage from breath weapons.
Nightwalkers emanate a distinctive chilling
Nightwalkers are resistant to being turned, aura within 120’ which spoils all consuma-
and may make a saving throw vs. spells to bles (no save), including food, potions, and
ignore an attempt to turn them. If the turn even holy water. Spoiled consumables are
result is a ‘d’, then they may make a second not poisonous, but are inedible and useless.
saving throw to reduce it to a ‘t’. This aura usually prevents the nightwalker
from surprising opponents.

326
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Nightwing
Type: undead
Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Move: 10’ (fly: 80’)
Armour Class: –8*
Hit Dice: 19***** (104hp)
Attack Bonus: +14
Attacks: bite (1d6+6
+ special)
vs. Death/Poison: +15
vs. Wand: +15
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +14
vs. Dragon Breath: +14
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +13
Intelligence: 19
Morale: +19
XP Value: 10,000

Nightwings are a type of nightshade, in- Nightwings can cast the following spells, as The bite of a nightwing does 1d6+6 damage,
credibly powerful undead. They appear to if 21st level casters: and the victim must make a saving throw vs.
be giant rotting bats with a 50’ wing span. poison or die. If the victim survives, they
Nightwings are extremely intelligent. Be- ◊ Detect Magic (constant) must also make a saving throw vs. spells or
cause they know that they are so conspicu- ◊ Detect Invisible (constant) be polymorphed into a giant bat. Any oppo-
ous that operating openly would attract the ◊ Cause Disease (at will) nent turned into a bat becomes a loyal serv-
attention of all the most powerful foes, they ◊ Charm Person (at will) ant of the nightwing until the polymorph
usually remain hidden and work through ◊ Cloudkill (at will) is dispelled.
their minions as an undead liege. Night- ◊ Confusion (at will)
wings desire to completely eradicate the liv- ◊ Darkness (at will) A nightwing has a gaze attack that it can use
ing and make everyone undead, and work ◊ Dispel Magic (at will) instead of physically attacking or casting
towards that end, although they do not co- ◊ Finger of Death (at will) spells, that will magically curse one oppo-
operate well with others in anything other ◊ Haste (at will) nent’s weapon, shield or armour per round
than a relationship of absolute dominance. ◊ Hold Person (at will) within 60’ unless that opponent can make
◊ Invisibility (at will) a saving throw vs. spells. A cursed item tem-
Nightwings are only hit by +3 weapons porarily loses one point of magical “plus”,
or better, and are immune to spells of 5th Any creature touching a nightwing must until the curse is removed by either a Dispel
level or lower, charm, hold, illusions, wands, make a saving throw vs. poison or die. This Evil cast by anyone or a Remove Curse cast
poison, petrification and cold effects. They poison does not travel through weapons, so by a spell caster of at least 25th level.
take only half damage from breath weapons. melee attacks with weapons are safe.

Nightwings are resistant to being turned, Nightwings emanate a distinctive chilling


and may make a saving throw vs. spells to aura within 120’ which spoils all consuma-
ignore an attempt to turn them. If the turn bles (no save), including food, potions, and
result is a ‘d’, then they may make a second even holy water. Spoiled consumables are
saving throw to reduce it to a ‘t’. not poisonous, but are inedible and useless.
This aura usually prevents the nightwing
from surprising opponents.

327
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Nixie Nuckalavee Ochre Jelly


Type: humanoid Type: monster Type: ooze
Habitat: river (rare) Habitat: ocean (very rare) Habitat: underground
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) (common)
Lair Group: 2d20 (b) Lair Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ (swim: 120’) Lair Group: 0 (nil)
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 4* Move: 10’
Hit Dice: 1* (5hp) Hit Dice: 11*** (50hp) Armour Class: 8
Attack Bonus: +1 Attack Bonus: +10 Hit Dice: 5* (23hp)
Attacks: dagger (1d4) or Attacks: claw (3d8 Attack Bonus: +5
special + special) & Attacks: touch (2d6)
vs. Death/Poison: +8 claw (3d8 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Wand: +7 + special) vs. Wand: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +14 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Wand: +13 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +12 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Intelligence: 13 vs. Dragon Breath: +11 Intelligence: 0
Morale: +9 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +10 Morale: +19
XP Value: 13 Intelligence: 9 XP Value: 300
Morale: +17
XP Value: 3,500

Nixies are 3’ tall water spirits that take the A nuckalavee appears similar to a centaur An ochre jelly is an orange-brown amoeba-
appearance of small human women. They with transparent skin, so that all the mus- like ooze.
are bound to their river or lake in the same cles and organs can be seen. Nuckalavees
way that dryads are bound to their tree, and are amphibious, and live in coastal waters. Ochre jellies can only be harmed by fire or
can only survive for 10 minutes if taken cold. Other attacks do no damage but split
more than 240’ away from their water. Nuckalavees are immune to fire and poison, the ochre jelly into 1d4+1 smaller (2 hit
and regenerate 3 hit points per round until dice, attack bonus +3, 1d6 damage) jellies.
Ten nixies working together can cast a slain.
Charm Person spell, and they will often use An ochre jelly can dissolve wood, leather or
this to persuade intruders to stay with them A nuckalavee has an aura with a 120’ range cloth in one turn, but cannot eat through
as companions. Nixies can each cast Water that kills all small insects, birds, rodents, metal.
Breathing once per day, and this lasts for 24 and other similar creatures with 2 hit points
hours. or less. Within 50’ all creatures must make
a saving throw vs. paralysis or flee in terror
Occasionally, nixies can be shamans (to 6th for 2d6 rounds. This saving throw must be
level) or sorcerers (to 4th level). made each round.

Anyone struck by a nuckalavee must make


a saving throw vs. death ray or die. Addi-
tionally, a nuckalavee can breathe a cone of
cold 60’ long and 10’ wide at the end that
does damage equal to its current hit points
(save vs. breath weapons for half damage).

Although not undead themselves, nuckala-


vee are friendly with undead creatures and
can act as an undead liege.

328
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Ogre Orc Owlbear


Type: humanoid Type: humanoid Type: monster
Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (common) Habitat: woods (common)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (sx10) Wandering Group: 2d4 (p) underground
Lair Group: 2d6 (sx100 + c) Lair Group: 10d6 (d) (common)
Move: 30’ Move: 40’ Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil)
Armour Class: 5 {–1 vs 2} Armour Class: 6 Lair Group: 1d4 (c)
Hit Dice: 4+1 (19hp) Hit Dice: 1 (5hp) Move: 40’
Attack Bonus: +5 {+1} Attack Bonus: +1 Armour Class: 5
Attacks: club {1d6+1}+2 Attacks: sword (1d8) Hit Dice: 5
Weapon Expertise: skilled vs. Death/Poison: +8 Attack Bonus: +5
{deflect x 1} vs. Wand: +7 Attacks: claw (1d8) &
vs. Death/Poison: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 claw (1d8) &
vs. Wand: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 bite (1d8)
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 Intelligence: 7 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Morale: +13 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
Intelligence: 6 XP Value: 10 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
Morale: +17 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
XP Value: 125 Intelligence: 2
Morale: +16
XP Value: 175

Ogres are 9’ tall heavily built humanoids. Orcs are pig-headed humanoids with pink An owlbear is a large bear-like creature with
Ogres are rather dull witted, and will usu- skin. the head of an owl.
ally try to bully others to serve them rather
than hunt for themselves. When this does They usually live underground and only Owlbears are bad tempered carnivores, and
not work, they will often work as hired mus- come out at night, since they take a  –1 will often attack even when not hungry.
cle for other creatures. For an ogre, knowing penalty to attack rolls in strong daylight.
where the next meal is coming from and If an owlbear hits the same opponent with
having shiny coins to count are life’s great- Orcs have strong tribal structures, and both claw attacks, it can squeeze for an ad-
est luxuries. tribes often fight each other and raid each ditional 2d8 damage.
other for slaves. It is not unknown for a
Ogres are not particularly evil or malicious, slave rebellion in an orc community to end
but have no qualms about doing unpleasant up with the previous masters as the new
or immoral tasks if paid to do so. They sim- slaves and the previous slaves forming a new
ply don’t think about what they are doing. tribe. Orcs will also use goblins, kobolds, or
even humans as slaves if they can get them.
Ogres can occasionally be found working
in human settlements, although their ten- Despite their loose social structures, orcs
dency to break things can often mean that are very industrious and can often be found
they are more trouble than they are worth. making weapons and armour for other races.
Orcish designs emphasise simplicity and
Some particularly bright ogres can be sha- efficiency over decoration and art.
mans (to  4th level) or sorcerers (to  2nd
level). Although orcs sometimes trade with hu-
mans, relations are always strained because
of the orcs’ slaving tendencies.

329
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Pegasus Phantom (Apparition) Phantom (Shade)


Type: monster Type: undead Type: undead
Habitat: clear (rare) Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (rare)
hills (rare) Wandering Group: 1 (l) Wandering Group: 1 (l, n, v)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Lair Group: 1 (n, o) Lair Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d12 (nil) Move: 60’ Move: 40’
Move: 80’ (fly: 160’) Armour Class: 0* Armour Class: 0*
Armour Class: 6 Hit Dice: 10*** (45hp) Hit Dice: 11*** (49hp)
Hit Dice: 2+2 (11hp) Attack Bonus: +10 Attack Bonus: +10
Attack Bonus: +3 Attacks: claw (1d6+2) & Attacks: dagger (3d4)
Attacks: kick (1d6) & claw (1d6+2) vs. Death/Poison: +11
kick (1d6) vs. Death/Poison: +10 vs. Wand: +10
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11
vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 vs. Dragon Breath: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9 Intelligence: 10
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 11 Morale: +16
Intelligence: 4 Morale: +17 XP Value: 3,500
Morale: +13 XP Value: 3,250
XP Value: 25

Pegasi are winged horses. They are more An apparition is a transparent (but visible) A shade is a transparent (but visible) in-
intelligent than normal horses (although incorporeal undead creature. corporeal undead creature. A shade always
not sapient) and cannot be domesticated, stays indoors during the day, only ventur-
although they may befriend an individual Anyone seeing an apparition within 120’ ing outside at night to quickly move from
and allow themselves to be ridden by that must run in fear and be unable to approach building to building.
individual. the apparition any closer than this radius.
Creatures with more than 3 hit dice may Anyone seeing a shade within 120’ must run
make a saving throw vs. spells to avoid this in fear and be unable to approach the shade
effect. any closer than this radius. Creatures with
more than 3 hit dice may make a saving
An apparition can only be hit by magical throw vs. spells to avoid this effect.
weapons, and can resist turn attempts. If
an apparition is turned with anything other A shade can only be hit by magical weapons,
than a ‘d’ result, it can make a saving throw and can resist turn attempts. If an appari-
vs. spells to reflect the turn back on the tion is turned with anything other than a ‘d’
cleric, who must then save vs. spells or be result, it can make a saving throw vs. spells
paralysed for 2d6 rounds. to reflect the turn back on the cleric, who
must then save vs. spells or be paralysed
An apparition can surround itself with a 20’ for 2d6 rounds.
radius of swirling mist. All who enter the
mist must make a saving throw vs. spells A shade can perform the charge action in
or be paralysed for 12 rounds. The appari- combat. If it does so, it does not make a
tion will usually attack paralysed targets first, normal dagger attack at the end of the
gaining a +4 to hit. charge, but dashes up to its target’s face
screaming. The target must make a saving
Any human or demi-human killed by an throw vs. death ray or immediately drop
apparition will fade away and become one dead from fear.
in a week (even if raised) unless a Dispel Evil
is cast on them. A shade normally attacks by charging
through a wall or door, surprising its op-
ponents on a 1–5 on a d6.

330
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Phantom (Vision) Phoenix (Greater) Phoenix (Lesser)


Type: undead Type: monster Type: monster
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (l, n, o) Lair Group: 1d2 (vx2) Lair Group: 1d2 (v)
Move: – Move: 50’ (fly: 150’) Move: 30’ (fly: 120’)
Armour Class: 0* Armour Class: –2* Armour Class: 2*
Hit Dice: 12*** (54hp) Hit Dice: 18***** (81hp) Hit Dice: 9***** (81hp)
Attack Bonus: +11 Attack Bonus: +14 Attack Bonus: +9
Attacks: special Attacks: claw (2d6) & Attacks: claw (1d6) &
vs. Death/Poison: +13 claw (2d6) & claw (1d6) &
vs. Wand: +12 bite (4d6) bite (2d6)
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11 vs. Death/Poison: +15 vs. Death/Poison: +13
vs. Dragon Breath: +9 vs. Wand: +15 vs. Wand: +12
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +14 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11
Intelligence: 9 vs. Dragon Breath: +14 vs. Dragon Breath: +10
Morale: +19 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +13 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9
XP Value: 3,875 Intelligence: 6 Intelligence: 6
Morale: +17 Morale: +17
XP Value: 8,875 XP Value: 4,400

A vision is a composite undead creature, A greater phoenix is a red-orange eagle like A lesser phoenix is a red-orange eagle like
consisting of the transparent forms of 2d4 bird with a 25’ wing span, surrounded by bird with a 10’ wing span, surrounded by
creatures. a halo of fire. Phoenixes are never hostile a halo of fire. Phoenixes are never hostile
unless attacked, but will fight to the death unless attacker, but will fight to the death
Anyone seeing a vision within 120’ must to defend themselves. to defend themselves.
run in fear and be unable to approach the
vision any closer than this radius. Creatures Greater phoenixes can only be hit by +3 or Lesser phoenixes can only be hit by +3 or
with more than 3 hit dice may make a sav- better weapons, and are immune to charm better weapons, and are immune to charm
ing throw vs. spells to avoid this effect. and hold spells and all fire based attacks. and hold spells and all fire based attacks.

A vision can only be hit by magical weapons, All creatures within 20’ of a greater phoenix All creatures within 10’ of a lesser phoenix
and can resist turn attempts. If an appari- take 6d6 fire damage per round. take 3d6 fire damage per round.
tion is turned with anything other than a ‘d’
result, it can make a saving throw vs. spells When a greater phoenix is destroyed, it When a lesser phoenix is destroyed, it ex-
to reflect the turn back on the cleric, who explodes into an 18d6 Fireball with a 20’ plodes into a 9d6 Fireball with a 20’ radius.
must then save vs. spells or be paralysed radius. Creatures in the area may save vs. Creatures in the area may save vs. breath
for 2d6 rounds. If a vision is successfully breath weapon to take half damage, but re- weapon to take half damage, but resist-
turned, it disappears for 1d6 hours. sistances or immunities to fire do not reduce ances or immunities to fire do not reduce
the damage. the damage.
A vision will cry and howl when met. All
within 90’ who hear this must make a sav- The greater phoenix will rise from its own The lesser phoenix will rise from its own
ing throw vs. spells or collapse in despair ashes one round later, and flee from its at- ashes one round later, and flee from its at-
and spend 1d10+10 rounds curled up and tackers if possible. tackers if possible.
crying for the lost souls.
There is no way short of a Wish to keep a There is no way short of a Wish to keep a
The figures of the vision will then attack phoenix dead permanently. phoenix dead permanently.
with melee weapons, with each figure at-
tacking independently and able to move 40’
per round but unable to leave the area. A
vision has a single collective set of hit points,
and when these run out all figures are de-
stroyed.

331
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Pixie Pterosaur (Large) Pterosaur (Medium)


Type: humanoid Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: woods (rare) Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 2d4 (r+s) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 4d10 (nil) Lair Group: 1d2 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (nil)
Move: 30’ (fly: 60’) Move: 60’ Move: 90’
Armour Class: 3 Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 1*** (5hp) Hit Dice: 10 (45hp) Hit Dice: 5 (23hp)
Attack Bonus: +1 Attack Bonus: +10 Attack Bonus: +10
Attacks: dagger (1d4) Attacks: bite (3d6) Attacks: bite (1d12)
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +10 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +9 vs. Wand: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Intelligence: 14 Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2
Morale: +11 Morale: +16 Morale: +13
XP Value: 19 XP Value: 1,000 XP Value: 175

Pixies are 1’ tall elf-like creatures with but- Pterosaurs are flying reptiles found in “lost Pterosaurs are flying reptiles found in “lost
terfly wings. world” areas. They are closely related to world” areas. They are closely related to
dinosaurs. dinosaurs.
They are naturally invisible at all times, even
when attacking, but they can make them- Pterosaurs are carnivorous, and eat mostly Pterosaurs are carnivorous, and eat mostly
selves visible when they want to. small animals and fish. small animals and fish.

Pixies are not strong fliers, and can only fly These statistics are for a pterosaur with a These statistics are for a pterosaur with a
for half an hour before having to rest. wingspan of over 50’. wingspan of 10’ to 50’.

Pixies are generally on friendly terms with


both humans and elves, although they hate
orcs and goblins and do their best to drive
them from their woods.

Pixies can be shamans (to 6th level) or sor-


cerers (to 4th level).

332
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Pterosaur (Small) Purple Worm Rat


Type: animal Type: monster Type: animal
Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (common)
Wandering Group: 2d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil) Wandering Group: 5d10 (nil)
Lair Group: 2d4 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (d) Lair Group: 5d10 (l)
Move: 60’ Move: 20’ Move: 20’ (swim: 10’)
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 9
Hit Dice: 1 (5hp) Hit Dice: 15* (68hp) Hit Dice: 1 hit point
Attack Bonus: +1 Attack Bonus: +12 Attack Bonus: +0
Attacks: bite (1d3) Attacks: bite (2d8) & Attacks: special
vs. Death/Poison: +8 sting vs. Death/Poison: +7
vs. Wand: +7 (1d8 + special) vs. Wand: +6
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Death/Poison: +12 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Wand: +11 vs. Dragon Breath: +4
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +3
Intelligence: 2 vs. Dragon Breath: +9 Intelligence: 2
Morale: +13 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 Morale: +7
XP Value: 10 Intelligence: 0 XP Value: 2
Morale: +17
XP Value: 2,700

Pterosaurs are flying reptiles found in “lost A purple worm is a huge (100’ long) slimy Rats are omnivorous rodents, who are adept
world” areas. They are closely related to worm like creature. Purple worms tunnel at learning and have a very well developed
dinosaurs. through the earth, and rise to the surface direction sense.
to feed.
Pterosaurs are carnivorous, and eat mostly Normally, rats will not attack large creatures
small animals and fish. If a purple worm bites an opponent of hu- unless magically controlled.
man sized or smaller, and its to-hit roll is
These statistics are for a pterosaur with a at least 4 more than it needs to be to hit, In combat, rats should be split into groups
wingspan of less than 10’. or is a natural 20, then it will swallow the of  5–10 individuals. Each group will at-
victim whole. tack a single target, and can collectively bite
for 1d6 damage. If enough rats are killed
Swallowed creatures take 3d6 damage per that a group is no longer viable, those rats
round until the purple worm is killed. will disperse.

Anyone stung by the stinger must make a Rat bites have a 1 in 20 chance of transmit-
saving throw vs. poison or die; although ting a disease. If this is the case, the victim is
if the purple worm is encountered under- affected as if by a Cause Disease spell (com-
ground it is likely that it cannot use its plete with saving throw).
stinger in combat as it will not have room
to manoeuvre.

333
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Rat (Giant) Rhagodessa (Giant) Robber Fly (Giant)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: any (common) Habitat: woods (rare) Habitat: any (rare)
Wandering Group: 3d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (u) Wandering Group: 1d6 (u)
Lair Group: 3d10 (nil) Lair Group: 1d6 (nil) Lair Group: 2d6 (nil)
Move: 40’ (swim: 20’) Move: 50’ Move: 30’ (fly: 60’)
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 1/2 (3hp) Hit Dice: 4+2 (20hp) Hit Dice: 2 (9hp)
Attack Bonus: +1 Attack Bonus: +5 Attack Bonus: +2
Attacks: bite (1d3) Attacks: leg (special) & Attacks: bite (1d8)
vs. Death/Poison: +7 bite (2d8) vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Wand: +6 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +5 vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +4 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +3 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 0
Morale: +13 Intelligence: 0 Morale: +13
XP Value: 5 Morale: +16 XP Value: 20
XP Value: 125

Giant rats are 3’ long scavenging rodents. A giant rhagodessa is an arachnid similar to A giant robber fly is a 3’ long insect with
They are as smart as normal rats, although a spider or scorpion, but the size of a horse. yellow and black stripes. Although it closely
more aggressive. They will attack human They are nocturnal hunters that will attack resembles a giant bee or wasp, it is not re-
sized creatures if they outnumber them. any prey smaller than themselves. lated to those and has no sting.

Giant rat bites have a 1 in 20 chance of Rhagodessas do not have stings or create Giant robber flies mostly prey on giant bees,
transmitting a disease. If this is the case, the webs, but their front legs end in suckers and are immune to the poison of giant bees.
victim is affected as if by a Cause Disease for holding prey.
spell (complete with saving throw). When they encounter larger creatures, they
Anyone hit by a leg will be automatically will usually hide. If their hiding place is
pulled to the rhagodessa’s mouth and bitten disturbed, they will leap out and attack the
in the next round. intruder, surprising on a 1–4 on 1d6.

334
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Roc (Giant) Roc (Large) Roc (Small)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: mountains (rare) Habitat: mountains (rare) Habitat: mountains (rare)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1 (i) Lair Group: 1d8 (i) Lair Group: 1d12 (i)
Move: 20’ (fly: 160’) Move: 20’ (fly: 160’) Move: 20’ (fly: 160’)
Armour Class: 0 Armour Class: 2 Armour Class: 2
Hit Dice: 36 (162hp) Hit Dice: 12 (54hp) Hit Dice: 6 (27hp)
Attack Bonus: +23 Attack Bonus: +11 Attack Bonus: +6
Attacks: claw (3d6) & Attacks: claw (1d8) & Attacks: claw (1d4+1) &
claw (3d6) & claw (1d8) & claw (1d4+1) &
bite (8d6) bite (2d10) bite (2d6)
vs. Death/Poison: +15 vs. Death/Poison: +11 vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Wand: +14 vs. Wand: +10 vs. Wand: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +14 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +13 vs. Dragon Breath: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +12 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2
Morale: +17 Morale: +16 Morale: +13
XP Value: 6,250 XP Value: 1,250 XP Value: 275

A roc is a huge eagle-like bird. A roc is a huge eagle-like bird. A roc is a huge eagle-like bird.

Rocs are very territorial, and will chase other Rocs are very territorial, and will chase other Rocs are very territorial, and will chase other
large predators out of their areas. large predators out of their areas. large predators out of their areas.

The statistics here are for a roc with a 50’ The statistics here are for a roc with a 15’– The statistics here are for a roc with less than
wingspan or more. 50’ wingspan. a 15’ wingspan.

335
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Rockroach Rust Monster Salamander (Flame)


Type: monster Type: monster Type: monster
Habitat: underground Habitat: underground Habitat: mountains
(common) (rare) (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1d4 (v) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4+1 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Lair Group: 2d4 (f )
Move: 20’ Move: 40’ Move: 40’
Armour Class: 2 Armour Class: 2 Armour Class: 2*
Hit Dice: 3+1* (15hp) Hit Dice: 5* (23hp) Hit Dice: 8* (36hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +5 Attack Bonus: +8
Attacks: bite (1d6) & Attacks: touch (special) Attacks: claw (1d4) &
special vs. Death/Poison: +9 claw (1d4) &
vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Wand: +8 bite (1d8)
vs. Wand: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +12
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Wand: +11
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Intelligence: 2 vs. Dragon Breath: +9
Intelligence: 2 Morale: +11 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
Morale: +11 XP Value: 300 Intelligence: 1
XP Value: 75 Morale: +13
XP Value: 1,200

Rockroaches are squat creatures about 3’ tall A rust monster appears like a 5’ tall arma- Fire salamanders are 15’ long bright red am-
with a hard stony carapace like that of a dillo with a long tail and two feathery an- phibians that radiate great heat. Most fire
horseshoe crab. When motionless they look tennae on its head. salamanders live in volcanoes and lava just
exactly like boulders. as normal salamanders live in water.
Rust monsters normally eat rusted metal or
Rockroaches are peaceful creatures that pre- metal ores. They are particularly attracted Flame salamanders radiate a great amount
fer to live in natural caverns near water and to the smell of refined metal, and usually of heat, doing 1d8 points of fire damage to
eat the mosses, fungi and lichens that grow attempt to rust and eat it. all creatures within 20’.
there. If they are disturbed they will lift up
their carapace to reveal glowing eyes. The antennae of a rust monster will rust any A flame salamander is immune to fire, and
metal they contact. A successful attack on to non-magic weapons.
Once per round, a rockroach can gaze at a a target with a metal weapon or shield or
target and cause that target to be paralysed wearing metal armour means that one of
for 2d4 rounds unless they can make a sav- those items has been touched and will im-
ing throw vs. paralysis. If the rockroaches mediately crumble to powdered rust. A rust
manage to paralyse all opponents, or the monster will normally try to rust weapons
opponents retreat, the rockroaches will back first, to minimise the danger to itself.
off themselves.
If an item is magical, it has a 10% chance
However, if the opponents continue to at- per magical “plus” of resisting the effect.
tack, rockroaches will defend themselves by
biting and continuing to attempt to para- If well treated and regularly fed, rust mon-
lyse foes. If forced into self-defence like this, sters can be trained to attack only strangers.
rockroaches will not simply leave paralysed Such trained rust monsters are sometimes
opponents to recover, but will kill them. kept by tribes or individuals who fear armed
attack by others.

336
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Salamander (Frost) Sasquatch Scorpion (Giant)


Type: monster Type: humanoid Type: animal
Habitat: arctic (very rare) Habitat: mountains Habitat: desert (rare)
Wandering Group: 1d3 (nil) (very rare) Wandering Group: 1d6 (v)
Lair Group: 1d3 (e) woods Lair Group: 1d6 (nil)
Move: 40’ (very rare) Move: 50’
Armour Class: 3* Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Armour Class: 2
Hit Dice: 12* (54hp) Lair Group: 1d10 (nil) Hit Dice: 4* (18hp)
Attack Bonus: +11 Move: 50’ Attack Bonus: +4
Attacks: claw (1d4) & Armour Class: 6 Attacks: claw (1d10) &
claw (1d4) & Hit Dice: 5* (23hp) claw (1d10) &
claw (1d4) & Attack Bonus: +5 sting
claw (1d4) & Attacks: claw (2d4) & (1d4 + special)
bite (2d6) claw (2d4) or vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Death/Poison: +14 boulder (2d8) vs. Wand: +7
vs. Wand: +13 vs. Death/Poison: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +12 vs. Wand: +9 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +11 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +10 vs. Dragon Breath: +7 Intelligence: 0
Intelligence: 1 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6 Morale: +18
Morale: +16 Intelligence: 6 XP Value: 125
XP Value: 2,125 Morale: +9
XP Value: 300

Frost salamanders are six legged amphibians Sasquatches are 8’ tall powerfully built ape- Giant scorpions can grow up to 8’ in length,
that grow to 20’ long. like humanoids with long fur that changes and are aggressive hunters.
from brown to white depending on the
Frost salamanders live in arctic areas or season. A giant scorpion hunts by grasping creatures
other intensely cold waters. in its claws and stinging them. If either claw
Sasquatches are not normally aggressive ex- attack hits an opponent, the giant scorpion
In combat, a frost salamander will rear up cept in self defence, and have been known gets a +2 bonus to hit that same opponent
onto its back two legs and attack with all to rescue lost travellers and guide them to with its stinger.
four front and middle legs. safety.
Anyone stung by a giant scorpion must
Frost salamanders radiate an intense cold When enraged, a sasquatch will attack with make a saving throw vs. poison or die.
that does  1d8 damage per round to all its claws, and if both claws hit the same
within 20’. Frost salamanders are immune opponent it will hug the opponent for 4d6
to cold attacks and can only be hit by magi- damage.
cal weapons.
Sasquatches can also throw boulders
(range: 50/75/100) for 2d8 damage each.

337
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Scorpion Man Shadow Shark (Bull)


Type: monster Type: monster Type: animal
Habitat: desert (rare) Habitat: woods (rare) Habitat: ocean (common)
Wandering Group: 1d8 (v) underground Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 2d10 (j,k,mx2) (rare) Lair Group: 3d6 (nil)
Move: 80’ Wandering Group: 1d8 (nil) Move: 60’
Armour Class: 1 {–2 vs 1} Lair Group: 1d12 (f ) Armour Class: 4
Hit Dice: 8*** (36hp) Move: 30’ Hit Dice: 2* (9hp)
Attack Bonus: +8 {+4} Armour Class: 7 Attack Bonus: +2
Attacks: poleaxe {1d10+6} Hit Dice: 2+2* (11hp) Attacks: bite (2d4)
& sting Attack Bonus: +3 vs. Death/Poison: +18
(1d10 + special) Attacks: touch vs. Wand: +7
Weapon Expertise: expert (1d4 + special) v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
{deflect x 1} vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Death/Poison: +12 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Wand: +11 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 Intelligence: 2
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 Morale: +11
vs. Dragon Breath: +9 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 XP Value: 25
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 Intelligence: 4
Intelligence: 8 Morale: +19
Morale: +17 XP Value: 35
XP Value: 2,300

Scorpion men are xenophobic and isola- Shadows are dark and incorporeal barely Bull sharks are 8’ long brown sharks.
tionist humanoids that live in remote de- sapient creatures that lurk in corners and
serts. They are similar to centaurs, having a cellars. Bull sharks can make a charge attack, which
human body with arms and head coming does no damage but forces their opponent
forth from the body of a giant scorpion. A shadow looks very much like a real shad- to make a saving throw vs. paralysis or be
ow, although it is difficult to see and can stunned for three rounds.
Anyone stung by a scorpion man must surprise opponents on a roll of 1–5 on 1d6.
make a saving throw vs. poison or die. Even
if the saving throw is made, any creature not Anyone touched by a shadow loses 1 point
immune to paralysis or poison will still be of strength. This weakness lasts for an hour.
paralysed for 1d8–1 rounds. If an opponent is drained to zero strength,
they immediately become a shadow them-
Scorpion men can be shamans (to  13th selves.
level) or sorcerers (to 8th level).
Despite their appearance, shadows are not
undead and cannot be turned.

338
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Shark (Great White) Shark (Mako) Shrieker


Type: animal Type: animal Type: plant
Habitat: ocean (very rare) Habitat: ocean (very rare) Habitat: underground
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) (common)
Lair Group: 1d4 (nil) Lair Group: 2d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Move: 60’ Move: 60’ Lair Group: 1d8 (nil)
Armour Class: 4 Armour Class: 4 Move: 3’
Hit Dice: 8 (36hp) Hit Dice: 4 (18hp) Armour Class: 7
Attack Bonus: +8 Attack Bonus: +4 Hit Dice: 3 (14hp)
Attacks: bite (2d10) Attacks: bite (2d6) Attack Bonus: +3
vs. Death/Poison: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +8 Attacks: special
vs. Wand: +8 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 2 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Morale: +11 Morale: +11 Intelligence: 0
XP Value: 650 XP Value: 75 Morale: +19
XP Value: 35

Great white sharks are among the biggest Mako sharks are blue-grey sharks that Shriekers are large toadstool-like fungi that
of sharks, reaching 30’ long. reach 12’ long. They are notoriously unpre- live underground and slowly move around
dictable, attacking or changing opponents looking for detritus to eat.
They are sometimes known to attack small without apparent reason.
boats. When disturbed by light within  60’ or
movement within  30’, shriekers emit a
piercing scream which lasts for 1d3 rounds.

The scream of a shrieker will stun animals


of rat size or smaller, which the shrieker will
then engulf and eat.

Because their shrieking unwittingly makes


them into very effective guards, shriekers
are often deliberately cultivated by under-
ground races.

339
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Skeleton Skeleton Dragon Snake (Pit Viper)


Type: undead Type: undead Type: animal
Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (common)
Wandering Group: 3d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d8 (nil)
Lair Group: 3d10 (nil) Lair Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 1d8 (nil)
Move: 20’ Move: 40’ (fly: 80’) Move: 30’
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: –3* Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 1 (5hp) Hit Dice: 20***** (90hp) Hit Dice: 2* (9hp)
Attack Bonus: +1 Attack Bonus: +15 Attack Bonus: +2
Attacks: sword (1d8) Attacks: claw (2d6) & Attacks: bite
vs. Death/Poison: +8 claw (2d6) & (1d4 + special)
vs. Wand: +7 bite (1d20+10) vs. Death/Poison: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 or vs. Wand: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 special v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Death/Poison: +13 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
Intelligence: 1 vs. Wand: +12 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Morale: +19 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +11 Intelligence: 2
XP Value: 10 vs. Dragon Breath: +10 Morale: +11
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9 XP Value: 25
Intelligence: 3
Morale: +19
XP Value: 11,375

Animated skeletons are the weakest and A skeleton dragon is the undead form of a Pit vipers are 5’ long greyish green poison-
most basic of undead creatures, and often dragon. Despite its skeletal nature, it can ous snakes. They have pits in their head
work as servants and minions to more pow- still fly and still has a breath weapon. which grant them infravision.
erful undead or spell casters.
Skeleton dragons can see invisible things Pit vipers are very quick and always win
Although unintelligent, skeletons do have and are immune to sleep, charm, hold and initiative.
basic instincts, and can react to novel situ- all mind affecting spells, as well as fire, cold,
ations. poison and all gases. They are also immune Anyone bitten by a pit viper must make a
to any spell of less than 5th level, and are saving throw vs. poison or die.
As undead, skeletons are immune to sleep only hit by +3 or better weapons.
and charm effects.
Three times per day, a skeleton dragon can
breathe a 20’x20’x20’ cloud of poisonous
gas. Any within the cloud must make a sav-
ing throw vs. poison or die.

Because of their powerful nature, skeleton


dragons cannot be destroyed using a Dispel
Magic spell, and are very resistant to be-
ing turned. Skeleton dragons use the spirit
entry on Table 4–2b, and if a cleric gets a
‘d’ result, the skeleton dragon may make a
saving throw vs. spells to avoid the effect.
If a cleric gets a normal turning result, the
turn effect only lasts for 1d4 rounds before
the skeleton dragon recovers.

340
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Snake (Racer) Snake (Rattler) Snake (Rock Python)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: animal
Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (common)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d3 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d8 (nil) Lair Group: 1de (nil) Lair Group: 1d3 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ Move: 30’
Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 2 (9hp) Hit Dice: 4* (18hp) Hit Dice: 5* (22hp)
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +5
Attacks: bite (1d6) Attacks: bite Attacks: bite
vs. Death/Poison: +8 (1d4 + special) & (1d4 + special)
vs. Wand: +7 bite vs. Death/Poison: +9
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 (1d4 + special) vs. Wand: +8
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Death/Poison: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
Intelligence: 2 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Morale: +11 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 Intelligence: 2
XP Value: 20 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Morale: +11
Intelligence: 2 XP Value: 300
Morale: +11
XP Value: 125

Racer snakes are 4’ long, but not poisonous, Rattlers are known for their warning dis- Rock pythons are 30’ long non-poisonous
relying on their fast speed to catch small plays which involve shaking their tails and snakes that squeeze their prey to death.
prey. making a distinct rattling sound.
A rock python will attempt to bite its prey,
A racer will bite larger opponents in self- A rattler is very fast and can attack twice and if successful, it will coil around the vic-
defence, but is not normally aggressive. per round. Anyone bitten by a rattler must tim and squeeze for 2d4 points of damage.
make a saving throw vs. poison or become
ill and die after 1d6x10 minutes. The snake will then cease biting, and auto-
matically squeeze for 2d4 damage per round
until slain.

341
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Snake (Sea Snake) Snake (Spitting Cobra) Spectral Hound


Type: animal Type: animal Type: enchanted
Habitat: ocean (common) Habitat: any (common) extraplanar
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) Habitat: any (very rare)
Lair Group: 1d8 (nil) Lair Group: 1d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil)
Move: 30’ Move: 30’ Lair Group: 1d6 (nil)
Armour Class: 6 Armour Class: 7 Move: 50’
Hit Dice: 3* (14hp) Hit Dice: 1* (5hp) Armour Class: –2
Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +1 Hit Dice: 5** (23hp)
Attacks: bite (1 + special) Attacks: bite Attack Bonus: +5
vs. Death/Poison: +8 (1d3 + special) or Attacks: bite
vs. Wand: +7 spit (special) (2d6 + special)
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +10
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +9
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8
Intelligence: 2 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +7
Morale: +11 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6
XP Value: 50 Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 3
Morale: +11 Morale: +19
XP Value: 13 XP Value: 425

Sea snakes are 6’ long snakes that live in Spitting cobras are 3’ long grey snakes. Spectral hounds are ghostly dogs with dark
the sea and rarely if ever venture onto land. eyes. Although they may appear similar to
If disturbed, they can spit a stream of ven- undead, they are from somewhere outside
A sea snake will bite a victim – the bite goes om up to 10’ into a target’s eyes. The target the known multiverse, possibly the same
un-noticed 50% of the time – and then must make a saving throw vs. poison or be place that blackballs are from.
patiently follow it until it dies. blinded until cured.
Any creature bitten by a spectral hound
The bite of a sea snake only does a single The bite of a spitting cobra is also venom- takes 2d6 damage and must make a sav-
point of damage, but injects a poison that ous, causing the victim to sicken and die ing throw vs. spells. A failed saving throw
takes 1d4+2x10 minutes to work. If the in 1d10x10 minutes unless they can make means that the victim begins to fade away.
victim fails a saving throw vs. poison, they a saving throw vs. poison. This process takes 24 hours, by which point
will fall sick and die over that time period. the victim is completely faded and incor-
poreal (treat as if having drunk a potion of
gaseous form).

This fading is permanent, although a faded


character is likely to starve to death – being
unable to eat solid food – in only a few days.

The only way to counteract the fading once


it has started is with a Dimension Door spell.
The faded victim can walk through the door
into the real world again.

Spectral hounds may only be hit by magi-


cal weapons, and they are immune to fire
and cold.

342
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Spectre Sphinx Spider (Black Widow)


Type: undead Type: monster Type: animal
Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: desert (rare) Habitat: woods (rare)
Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d3 (u)
Lair Group: 1d8 (e) Lair Group: 1d4 (e) Lair Group: 1d3 (nil)
Move: 50’ (fly: 100’) Move: 60’ (fly: 120’) Move: 20’ (in web: 40’)
Armour Class: 2* Armour Class: 0* Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 6** (27hp) Hit Dice: 12***** (54hp) Hit Dice: 3* (14hp)
Attack Bonus: +6 Attack Bonus: +11 Attack Bonus: +3
Attacks: touch (special) Attacks: claw (3d6) & Attacks: bite
vs. Death/Poison: +11 claw (3d6) & (2d6 + special)
vs. Wand: +10 bite (2d8) vs. Death/Poison: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9 vs. Death/Poison: +16 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +8 vs. Wand: +15 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +15 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
Intelligence: 8 vs. Dragon Breath: +15 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Morale: +18 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +14 Intelligence: 0
XP Value: 725 Intelligence: 13 Morale: +13
Morale: +17 XP Value: 50
XP Value: 5,625

Spectres are incorporeal undead creatures Sphinxes are large winged lions with hu- Giant black widow spiders are 6’ long and
that appear as translucent humanoid figures man faces. are black with a distinctive red hour-glass
with glowing eyes. shaped marking.
All sphinxes are powerful spell casters: fe-
Spectres can only be hit by magical weap- male sphinxes can cast spells as a 12th level The web of a giant black widow spider
ons, and are immune to sleep, charm, and cleric, and males as a 12th level magic-user. should be treated as if a web spell.
hold spells. All saving throws made against spells cast
by sphinxes have a –4 penalty. Anyone bitten by a black widow spider must
Anyone touched by a spectre takes  1d8 make a saving throw vs. poison or die in 10
points of damage and is subject to a double Twice per day, a sphinx can roar instead minutes.
strength Energy Drain that drains them of of attacking. All within 120’ must save vs.
two levels (no saving throw). spells with a –4 penalty of flee in terror
for 1d6x10 minutes. All within 60’ must
Anyone slain by a spectre will rise the fol- additionally save vs. paralysis or be stunned
lowing night as another spectre unless raised. for 1d6 rounds. All within 10’ must make
both saving throws and also take 6d6 dam-
age and are deafened for 1d10x10 minutes
(no save).

Sphinxes are immune to non-magical weap-


ons and to spells lower than 4th level.

Sphinxes love riddles, puzzles and trivia;


and can often be dissuaded from attacking
by trading them new bits and pieces that
they have not heard before.

343
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Spider (Crab Spider) Spider (Tarantella) Spider (Phase)


Type: animal Type: animal Type: extraplanar
Habitat: underground (rare) Habitat: woods (rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1d4 (u) Wandering Group: 1d3 (u) Wandering Group: 2d6 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d4 (u) Lair Group: 1d3 (nil) Lair Group: 3d6 (nil)
Move: 40’ Move: 40’ Move: 60’
Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 5 Armour Class: 6
Hit Dice: 2* (9hp) Hit Dice: 4* (18hp) Hit Dice: 5** (23hp)
Attack Bonus: +2 Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +5
Attacks: bite Attacks: bite (1d8 Attacks: bite
(1d8 + special) + special) (2d6 + special)
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +10
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +9
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +7
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6
Intelligence: 0 Intelligence: 0 Intelligence: 12
Morale: +11 Morale: +13 Morale: +16
XP Value: 25 XP Value: 125 XP Value: 425

Giant crab spiders are 5’ long spiders with Tarantellas are 7’ long hairy spiders resem- Phase spiders are 5’ long intelligent and
a grey colour that can blend into stone bling tarantulas. magical spiders. They can shift between the
surfaces. prime plane and the ethereal plane at will.
They do not use webs, but are mobile and
Giant crab spiders don’t build webs, but aggressively hunt. In combat, a phase spider will appear in
hide in corners and drop or leap out in am- the prime plane immediately after the state-
bush of prey, surprising on a 1–4 on 1d6. Anyone bitten by a tarantella must make ment of intent phase, and then disappear
a saving throw vs. poison or start to have back to the ethereal plane once it has made
Anyone bitten by a giant crab spider must painful spasms which resemble dancing. its attack on its initiative. It is therefore only
make a saving throw vs. poison with a +2 vulnerable to attacks from people who both
bonus or die in 1d4x10 minutes. Anyone seeing this dance must make a sav- beat its initiative and were able to correctly
ing throw vs. spells or join in, dancing in predict where it would appear (possibly by
the same manner. delaying their statement of intent until after
the spider’s statement of intent).
Dancing characters have a  –4 on attack
rolls and give their opponents +4 on their Anyone bitten by a phase spider must save
attack rolls. vs. poison or die, although the spider can
withhold its venom if it chooses.
The dance can be stopped with a Dispel
Magic spell, or it will wear off in 2d6x10 Phase spiders are as varied in personality as
minutes. However, dancers will drop from humans. They can become shamans (to 9th
exhaustion after 50 minutes of dancing. level) or sorcerers (to 9th level).

344
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Spirit (Druj)
Type: undead
Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (i, o, v)
Lair Group: 0 (nil)
Move: 30’
Armour Class: –4*
Hit Dice: 14**** (63hp)
Attack Bonus: +12
Attacks: special
vs. Death/Poison: +14
vs. Wand: +14
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +13
vs. Dragon Breath: +12
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +11
Intelligence: 14
Morale: +18
XP Value: 5,500

A druj spirit takes the form of an animated Once per night, a druj can split itself into Skull: A skull druj flies at an opponent
body part; either a skeletal hand, an eye four identical copies. Each of these has the causing them to have to make a saving
or a skull. physical capabilities of the druj, but only throw vs. spells or be paralysed with fear
one has the spell casting capabilities. for 2d6 rounds. The skull will then bite
A druj travels from place to place by night, the paralysed target (automatically hitting)
as it is powerless during the day. If the spell casting copy of the druj is slain, for 2d4 damage (+ poison) each round.
one of the other copies becomes the new
The chilling aura around a druj is enough “master” copy and gains the ability to cast
to spoil consumable items within 30’, in- spells.
cluding food potions and even holy water.
Spoiled goods are no longer edible but are If a druj is turned by a cleric while split, the
not poisonous. Plants and insects in the pieces must immediately rejoin and cannot
area are paralysed (and therefore cannot be split again until the following night.
magically controlled) and will die if in the
aura for more than an hour. The physical attacks of a druj depend on
what body part it is.
Drujes are only hurt by +2 or better weap-
ons, and are immune to spells below 4th Eye: An eye druj flies about trying to touch
level. (and therefore poison) targets. In addition
to its touch attack, it may gaze at one op-
Drujes can use the following spells as if ponent per round within 30’, who must
a 16th level caster: make a saving throw vs. paralysis or be
paralysed for  1d4x10 minutes. The druj
◊ Detect Invisible (constant) can automatically touch paralysed oppo-
◊ Darkness (at will) nents, although they still get saving throws
◊ Silence 15’ Radius (at will) against the poison.
◊ Cause Disease (at will)
◊ Animate Dead (at will) Hand: A hand druj claws at targets for 1d4
◊ Finger of Death (at will) damage (plus poison). Once it has hit, it
holds on to its victim automatically doing
The touch of a druj is poisonous. Anyone damage equal to the armour class of the
touching one must make a saving throw vs. victim (ignoring dexterity bonus) +  1d4
poison or die. damage. If the adjusted armour class bonus
is negative, the druj still does 1d4 damage
(plus poison) per round.

345
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Spirit (Odic) Spirit (Revenant)


Type: undead Type: undead
Habitat: any (very rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
Wandering Group: 1 (i, o, v) Wandering Group: 1 (i, o, v)
Lair Group: 0 (nil) Lair Group: 0 (nil)
Move: special Move: 40’
Armour Class: –4* Armour Class: –3*
Hit Dice: 16**** (72hp) Hit Dice: 18**** (81hp)
Attack Bonus: +13 Attack Bonus: +14
Attacks: special Attacks: claw
vs. Death/Poison: +15 (2d4 + special) &
vs. Wand: +14 claw
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +14 (2d4 + special) &
vs. Dragon Breath: +13 bite
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +12 (1d4+2 + special)
Intelligence: 12 vs. Death/Poison: +15
Morale: +19 vs. Wand: +14
XP Value: 6,250 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +14
vs. Dragon Breath: +13
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +12
Intelligence: 13
Morale: +17
XP Value: 7,525

An odic spirit travels incorporeally each day, The odic can, however, use the tree’s branch- A revenant spirit travels incorporeally each
settling into a plant (preferably a tree) at es to physically attack anyone who comes day, settling into a plant (preferably a tree)
night. close, for  1d12 damage (and the odic’s at night.
poison).
The chilling aura around an odic is enough The chilling aura around a revenant is
to spoil consumable items within 30’, in- Odics can use the following spells as if enough to spoil consumable items with-
cluding food potions and even holy water. a 16th level caster: in 30’, including food potions and even
Spoiled goods are no longer edible but are holy water. Spoiled goods are no longer
not poisonous. Plants and insects in the ◊ Detect Invisible (constant) edible but are not poisonous. Plants and
area are paralysed (and therefore cannot be ◊ Darkness (at will) insects in the area are paralysed (and there-
magically controlled) and will die if in the ◊ Silence 15’ Radius (at will) fore cannot be magically controlled) and
aura for more than an hour. ◊ Cause Disease (at will) will die if in the aura for more than an hour.
◊ Animate Dead (at will)
Odics are only hurt by +2 or better weapons, ◊ Finger of Death (at will) Revenants are only hurt by +2 or better
and are immune to spells below 4th level. weapons, and are immune to spells be-
The odic can make up to 6 leaves, needles, low 4th level.
The touch of an odic (or the plant it is pos- flowers, or other plant parts fly at 30’ per
sessing) is poisonous. Anyone touching one round for up to 1 mile from the plant in Revenants can use the following spells as if
must make a saving throw vs. poison or die. search of victims. Each of these can touch a 16th level caster:
(attack bonus +4) a creature causing it to
When an odic possesses a plant, the plant make a saving throw vs. spells or be en- ◊ Detect Invisible (constant)
immediately dies, and radiates a purplish tranced and attempt to reach the odic’s ◊ Darkness (at will)
glow in a 20’ radius. Anyone entering this plant host; suffering a  –4 on the saving ◊ Silence 15’ Radius (at will)
glow must make a saving throw vs. spells throw against the plant’s level draining aura. ◊ Cause Disease (at will)
or be affected by an Energy Drain. Because of the seemingly innocuous nature ◊ Animate Dead (at will)
of the plant parts, they surprise victims on ◊ Finger of Death (at will)
Once an odic has chosen its plant, it can a 1–5 on 1d6.
no longer move until morning; when it will The touch of a revenant is poisonous. Any-
leave in incorporeal form to find another one touching one must make a saving throw
plant. vs. poison or die.

346
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Sprite Stirge
Type: humanoid Type: monster
Habitat: woods (common) Habitat: woods (common)
Wandering Group: 3d6 (s) underground (common)
Lair Group: 5d8 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d10 (nil)
Move: 20’ (fly: 60’) Lair Group: 3d12 (l)
Armour Class: 5 Move: 10’ (fly: 60’)
Hit Dice: 1/2 (3hp) Armour Class: 7
Attack Bonus: +1 Hit Dice: 1* (5hp)
Attacks: special Attack Bonus: +1
vs. Death/Poison: +8 Attacks: bite (1d3)
vs. Wand: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
Intelligence: 14 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Morale: +11 Intelligence: 1
XP Value: 6 Morale: +16
XP Value: 13

A revenant appears much like a zombie, al- Sprites are  8” tall winged fey, related to Stirges are flying creatures that look like a
though it moves much more quickly and pixies. cross between a giant mosquito and a crow.
may leap up to 60’ once per 10 minutes. Stirges feed on blood, and attack by attach-
Sprites are rather shy, but are very curious ing themselves to creatures and sucking it
A revenant attacks by clawing and biting and have a keen sense of humour and enjoy out through their long pointed beak.
its victims, and each of its attack causes its playing practical jokes. Once a stirge’s bite attack has succeeded, it
victim to save vs. poison or die. will remain attached to its victim sucking
Five sprites working together can cast a blood for 1d3 damage per round.
When first encountered, a revenant will curse spell, although the effects will always
pretend to be a zombie, and then suddenly be funny rather than dangerous. The spell Stirges get +2 to hit on their initial attack,
make a surprise leap attack. This attack will can be removed as normal by a Remove because of their quick diving flight.
surprise its opponents on a 1–3 on 1d6, and Curse, or the sprites can remove it at will.
if the target of the leap is surprised then all
three attacks automatically hit. Sprites never fight. If threatened, they will
flee.
Once per night, a revenant can sum-
mon 1d4 spectres to its aid. They arrive Sprites can be very kind and helpful when
within 1d6+2 rounds of being summoned. not being silly, and will often look after
children who get lost in woods and protect
Revenants are particularly resistant to be- them from danger.
ing turned. If a cleric gets a ‘d’ result when
turning a revenant, the revenant may make
a saving throw vs. spells to avoid the effect.
If a cleric gets a normal turning result, the
turn effect only lasts for 1d4 rounds before
the revenant recovers.

347
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Termite (Giant Water) Toad (Giant) Treant


Type: animal Type: animal Type: plant
Habitat: ocean (common) Habitat: river (common) Habitat: woods (rare)
Wandering Group: 0 (nil) underground (common) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d6+1 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Lair Group: 1d8 (c)
Move: 60’ Lair Group: 1d6 (nil) Move: 20’
Armour Class: 5 Move: 30’ Armour Class: 2
Hit Dice: 4 (18hp) Armour Class: 7 Hit Dice: 8* (36hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Hit Dice: 2+2 (11hp) Attack Bonus: +8
Attacks: bite (1d6) Attack Bonus: +3 Attacks: branch (2d6) &
vs. Death/Poison: +9 Attacks: bite (1d4+1) branch (2d6)
vs. Wand: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +12
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +11
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +9
Intelligence: 0 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
Morale: +18 Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 11
XP Value: 75 Morale: +9 Morale: +16
XP Value: 25 XP Value: 1,200

Giant water termites are around 5’ long, Giant toads are around 4’ long, with mot- A treant is an intelligent and mobile tree,
and appear like normal termites except for tled skin that makes them hard to see in usually about 18’ tall. Its trunk is split into
an elastic abdomen that fills up with water poorly lit situations. In such areas, they two legs with rooty feet.
and then propels them forward by squeez- surprise opponents on a roll of 1–3 on 1d6.
ing a jet out. Treants care for the trees and animals of
Giant toads can shoot their tongues  15’ their forest, and are allies to most forest
Giant water termites are not normally ag- and anything dwarf sized or smaller hit by creatures.
gressive towards swimmers, but they will the tongue will be dragged into the toads
attack ships or rafts made of wood. mouth and automatically bitten. A treant can animate two normal trees with-
in 60’ to move and fight as treants. The
The bite of a giant water termite does full treant may choose to change which trees it
damage to ships, piers, and other wooden is animating each round.
structures.
Treants can only be distinguished from nor-
mal trees from distances of less than 90’,
and even then the treant can suprise op-
ponents on a 1–3 on 1d6.

Treants can be shamans (to 12th level).

348
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Troglodyte Troll Undine


Type: humanoid Type: humanoid Type: monster
Habitat: underground Habitat: any (rare) Habitat: any (very rare)
(rare) Wandering Group: 1d8 (nil) Wandering Group: 1 (nil)
Wandering Group: 1d8 (nil) Lair Group: 1d8 (d) Lair Group: 1 (nil)
Lair Group: 5d8 (a) Move: 40’ Move: 30’ (swim: 80’)
Move: 40’ Armour Class: 4 Armour Class: 4*
Armour Class: 5 Hit Dice: 6+3* (30hp) Hit Dice: 8*** (36hp)
Hit Dice: 2* (9hp) Attack Bonus: +6 Attack Bonus: +8
Attack Bonus: +2 Attacks: claw (1d6) & Attacks: bash (2d8) or
Attacks: claw (1d4) & claw (1d6) & constrict (1d10)
claw (1d4) & bite (1d10) vs. Death/Poison: +15
bite (1d4) vs. Death/Poison: +11 vs. Wand: +14
vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Wand: +10 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +14
vs. Wand: +7 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9 vs. Dragon Breath: +13
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 vs. Dragon Breath: +8 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +12
vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 Intelligence: 10
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 Intelligence: 6 Morale: +16
Intelligence: 10 Morale: +17 XP Value: 2,300
Morale: +16 XP Value: 650
XP Value: 25

Troglodytes are intelligent humanoid am- Trolls are loathsome 8’ tall asexual human- An undine is an amorphous creature made
phibians with short tails and crests on their oids made of a gelatinous yellow-green of water. It normally takes the form of a 15’
heads and arms. They live underground slime. The slime is semi-transparent and long snake (on land) or an eel (in the water),
near lakes and rivers. a stone heart can be seen in the middle of but can form tentacles, hands, and other
a troll’s chest. features as it wishes. Undines are immune
Troglodytes have the ability to change the to non-magical weapons, poisons, spells
colour of their skin to blend into back- Trolls are carnivorous, and love to eat other of less than 3rd level, and fire attacks. Un-
grounds, and can surprise opponents intelligent races. Despite their slimy compo- dines are playful and compassionate crea-
on 1–4 on 1d6. Troglodytes can also pro- sition, their claws and teeth are very sharp. tures, who are easily upset by seeing other
duce a nauseating stench that affects those mistreated.
within melee range of them. Any creature When trolls are damaged, their slime bod-
in melee range must make a saving throw ies repair themselves with cuts sealing up Undines can use the following spells as if
vs. poison or take a –2 penalty to to-hit rolls and even lost limbs being regrown or re- a 9th level caster:
until they are no longer near a troglodyte. attached. Because of this ability, trolls re-
generate 3 hit points per round. ◊ Detect Invisible at will
Troglodytes dislike all other races, and will ◊ Detect Magic at will
try to drive out all intruders from their ter- Fire or acid will actually destroy a troll’s ◊ Web (as the normal spell, but made of ice
ritory; using diplomacy, then stench, then slime, and damage from these sources can- and therefore melts rather than burning)
violence, depending on how persistent the not be regenerated. at will
intruders are. ◊ Dispel Magic at will
Once a troll has run out of hit points, it ◊ Ice Storm/Wall of Ice three times per day
will stop regenerating, but is not completely
dead. Over a period of days, the troll’s heart An undine normally bashes opponents with
can produce enough new slime to rebuild a tentacle for 2d8 damage, and if that hits,
its entire body. Only by burning the troll’s the tentacle will wrap around the opponent
heart can it be permanently killed. and constrict it for an automatic 1d10 dam-
age per round.

349
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Unicorn Vampire
Type: monster Type: undead
Habitat: woods (rare) Habitat: any (rare)
Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d8 (nil) Lair Group: 1d6 (f )
Move: 80’ Move: 40’ (fly: 60’)
Armour Class: 2 Armour Class: 2
Hit Dice: 4* (18hp) Hit Dice: 8** (36hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +8
Attacks: kick (1d8) & Attacks: touch
kick (1d8) & (1d10 + special)
horn (1d8) vs. Death/Poison: +12
vs. Death/Poison: +12 vs. Wand: +11
vs. Wand: +11 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 vs. Dragon Breath: +9
vs. Dragon Breath: +9 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +8 Intelligence: 10
Intelligence: 4 Morale: +18
Morale: +11 XP Value: 1,750
XP Value: 125

Unicorns appear to be slender horses with Vampires are undead creatures that drink This touch attack is optional, and the vam-
a single horn on their forehead. They are the blood of the living. Of all the undead, pire does not have to use it (if pretending
always beautiful and graceful. they are the ones that are most likely to be to still be alive, for example). A vampire can
able to pass for living creatures, since other also cast a Charm Person spell at will, with
Unicorns are shy creatures, and only the than their fangs they do not look different a –2 penalty on the saving throw.
gentlest and most patient of people can win from when they were alive. They are im-
their trust. If a unicorn does come to trust a mune to sleep, charm, and hold spells, and A vampire may summon animals to its
person and let them ride it, at the first sign can only be hit by magic weapons. aid, but the animals will only respond if
of cruelty or aggression from its companion within 300’ of the vampire. The animals
(to any creature not just the unicorn itself ), A vampire may take the form of a human, can be either rats, bats or wolves. Giant or
the unicorn will leave and never return. dire wolf, giant bat, or cloud of smoke. Re- dire versions of the above will also answer
gardless of form, it regenerates 3 hit points the summons.
A unicorn can teleport up to 360’ (with a per round.
rider) once per day. Vampires need to drink the blood of the
If a vampire is reduced to 0 hit points, it can living, and usually do so to charmed victims.
no longer regenerate and must change to The amount of blood actually drunk is not
smoke form and return to its coffin where enough to cause harm to the victim, and the
it will revert to human form and be uncon- act of drinking does not break the charm.
scious for a full day.
Any human or demi-human killed by a
When in the form of a dire wolf or giant vampire will rise in three days’ time as a
bat, the vampire’s movement, attacks and vampire themselves, unless they have a Dis-
damage are the same as that of the animal. pel Evil cast on them or they are raised.
In gaseous form, the vampire cannot attack
but can fly and is immune to all weapons. Vampires cannot approach within 10’ of a
strongly presented holy symbol, even from
In human form, a vampire can touch to a non-cleric; although they can attack from
inflict 1d10 points of damage and a double a different angle. They are repulsed by the
strength Energy Drain, causing the target to smell of garlic, and must make a saving
lose two levels. throw vs. poison to come within 10’ of it.

350
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Werebear Wereboar
Type: enchanted Type: enchanted
monster monster
Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (common)
Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d4 (c) Lair Group: 2d4 (c)
Move: 40’ Move: 50’
Armour Class: 2 (human: 8) Armour Class: 4 (human: 9)
Hit Dice: 6* (27hp) Hit Dice: 4+1* (19hp)
Attack Bonus: +6 Attack Bonus: +4
Attacks: claw (2d4) & Attacks: gore (2d6)
claw (2d4) & vs. Death/Poison: +9
bite (1d8) vs. Wand: +8
vs. Death/Poison: +11 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Wand: +10 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +9 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +8 Intelligence: 10
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +7 Morale: +16
Intelligence: 10 XP Value: 200
Morale: +17
XP Value: 500

Vampires must sleep in their coffins during A werebear is a type of lycanthrope – a hu- A wereboar is a type of lycanthrope  –  a
the day, taking 2d6 damage (that can’t be man who involuntarily changes into an ani- human who involuntarily changes into an
regenerated) each time they miss a day. They mal form (in this case a bear) during the animal form (in this case a large boar) dur-
cannot cross running water except in their four nights around the full moon. ing the four nights around the full moon.
coffins or over a bridge.
Lycanthropy is a magical disease which is Lycanthropy is a magical disease which is
A vampire can be killed by driving a stake contracted from the bites of existing ly- contracted from the bites of existing ly-
through its heart (not possible in combat, canthropes. Any human who loses more canthropes. Any human who loses more
but possible when the vampire is sleeping than half their hit points to a lycanthrope than half their hit points to a lycanthrope
or unconscious in its coffin) or by immers- becomes a lycanthrope of the same type becomes a lycanthrope of the same type
ing it in running water for 10 minutes. If a within 2d12 days. Non-humans who con- within 2d12 days. Non-humans who con-
vampire has no coffin to sleep in, it can be tract the disease are killed by it in the same tract the disease are killed by it in the same
killed by the 2d6 damage per day reducing time. Symptoms start to show after half the time. Symptoms start to show after half the
it to 0 hit points. duration, and can only be cured by a Cure duration, and can only be cured by a Cure
Disease cast by an 11th level or higher caster. Disease cast by an 11th level or higher caster.
A vampire that is exposed to direct sunlight
must make a saving throw vs. death ray each A werebear can summon 1d2 bears to help A wereboar can summon 1d2 boars to help
round or turn to ash. it once per day. it once per day.

Unlike most lycanthropes, werebears retain Wereboars are very belligerent and aggres-
most of their intelligence and personality sive, even in human form. In human form
while in animal form, and can sometimes they act as berserkers.
be reasoned with.
Wereboars are only hurt by silver weapons
If both of a werebear’s claws hit the same while in boar form.
target, the werebear can hug the target for
an extra 2d8 damage. While in bear form, a
werebear can only be hit by silver weapons.

351
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Wererat Weretiger Werewolf


Type: enchanted Type: enchanted Type: enchanted
monster monster monster
Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (common) Habitat: any (common)
Wandering Group: 1d8 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil)
Lair Group: 2d8 (c) Lair Group: 1d4 (c) Lair Group: 1d4 (c)
Move: 40’ Move: 50’ Move: 40’
Armour Class: 7 (human: 9) Armour Class: 3 (human: 9) Armour Class: 5 (human: 9)
Hit Dice: 3* (14hp) Hit Dice: 5* (23hp) Hit Dice: 4* (18hp)
Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +5 Attack Bonus: +4
Attacks: bite (1d4) or Attacks: claw (1d6) & Attacks: claw (1d4) &
sword (1d6) claw (1d6) & claw (1d4) &
vs. Death/Poison: +9 bite (2d6) bite (2d4)
vs. Wand: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +10 vs. Death/Poison: +9
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Wand: +9 vs. Wand: +8
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +8 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +7 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
Intelligence: 10 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +6 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Morale: +13 Intelligence: 10 Intelligence: 10
XP Value: 50 Morale: +16 Morale: +13
XP Value: 300 XP Value: 300

A wererat is a type of lycanthrope – a hu- A weretiger is a type of lycanthrope  –  a A werewolf is a type of lycanthrope  –  a
man who involuntarily changes into an ani- human who involuntarily changes into an human who involuntarily changes into an
mal form (in this case a 3’ tall humanoid animal form (in this case a tiger) during the animal form (in this case a 7’ tall humanoid
rat) during the four nights around the full four nights around the full moon. wolf ) during the four nights around the
moon. full moon.
Lycanthropy is a magical disease which is
Lycanthropy is a magical disease which is contracted from the bites of existing ly- Lycanthropy is a magical disease which is
contracted from the bites of existing ly- canthropes. Any human who loses more contracted from the bites of existing ly-
canthropes. Any human who loses more than half their hit points to a lycanthrope canthropes. Any human who loses more
than half their hit points to a lycanthrope becomes a lycanthrope of the same type than half their hit points to a lycanthrope
becomes a lycanthrope of the same type within 2d12 days. Non-humans who con- becomes a lycanthrope of the same type
within 2d12 days. Non-humans who con- tract the disease are killed by it in the same within 2d12 days. Non-humans who con-
tract the disease are killed by it in the same time. Symptoms start to show after half the tract the disease are killed by it in the same
time. Symptoms start to show after half the duration, and can only be cured by a Cure time. Symptoms start to show after half the
duration, and can only be cured by a Cure Disease cast by an 11th level or higher caster. duration, and can only be cured by a Cure
Disease cast by an 11th level or higher caster. Disease cast by an 11th level or higher caster.
A weretiger can summon 1d2 tigers to help
A wererat can summon 3d10 rats to help it once per day. A werewolf can summon 1d2 wolves to help
it once per day. it once per day.
Weretigers are rather curious and inquisi-
Wererats have full intelligence in rat form, tive while in tiger form, although they are Werewolves are the most common lycan-
although their personality changes to that quick to become aggressive if disturbed. thropes, and the most bestial when in ani-
of an amoral scavenger, and can speak in They are excellent at quietly stalking prey, mal form. They retain none of their human
that form. Only their bite carries the disease, and can ambush opponents surprising on intelligence – being unable to even recog-
not their weapons. a 1–4 on 1d6. nise friends and family members – and be-
come psychotic killers.
Wererats are only hurt by silver weapons Weretigers are only hurt by silver weapons
while in rat form. while in tiger form. Werewolves are only hurt by silver weapons
while in wolf form.

352
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Whale (Killer) White Hart Wight


Type: animal Type: monster Type: undead
Habitat: ocean (common) Habitat: woods Habitat: barren (common)
Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil) (very rare) Wandering Group: 1d6 (nil)
Lair Group: 0 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil) Lair Group: 1d8 (b)
Move: 80’ Lair Group: 1 (b) Move: 30’
Armour Class: 6 Move: 50’ Armour Class: 5
Hit Dice: 6 (27hp) Armour Class: 3 Hit Dice: 3* (14hp)
Attack Bonus: +6 Hit Dice: 11** (50hp) Attack Bonus: +3
Attacks: bite (2d10) Attack Bonus: +10 Attacks: touch (special)
vs. Death/Poison: +9 Attacks: antler (2d8) or vs. Death/Poison: +9
vs. Wand: +8 special vs. Wand: +8
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Death/Poison: +13 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 vs. Wand: +12 vs. Dragon Breath: +6
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +10 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5
Intelligence: 4 vs. Dragon Breath: +8 Intelligence: 5
Morale: +17 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +9 Morale: +19
XP Value: 275 Intelligence: 12 XP Value: 50
Morale: +17
XP Value: 2,700

Killer whales are 25’ long seagoing mam- A white hart is a magical beast that looks Wights are undead that look much like they
mals that are shaped like fish and have dis- like a large (8’ tall) stag that is pure white did in life, but shrivelled and with hollow
tinctive black and white markings. in colour. eyes.
They are very intelligent hunters, and will
often co-operate with other sea creatures White harts are intelligent guardians of the Wights have little memory of their life, but
such as merfolk. woods, and often ally with local druids. may recognise a friend or family member
Killer whales can swallow creatures of hal- They can speak most languages. and temporarily refrain from attacking
fling size or smaller whole if they roll a them as they are confused by their memo-
natural 20 on their to-hit roll. Swallowed Despite their colour, white harts can blend ries.
creatures take 1d6 damage per round and into their surroundings while concentrat-
may drown (see Chapter 9 – Dungeon ing, effectively becoming invisible. When Wights cannot be hurt by normal weapons,
Delving for drowning rules). attacking from this state, white harts sur- only silver or magical ones.
prise their foes on a 1–5 on 1d6.
The touch of a wight does an Energy Drain
Once per day, a white hart can use a breath to the victim, draining a single level. Any
weapon in a 10’10’10 cloud that acts as a humanoid killed by a wight in this manner
Polymorph Other spell to all in the radius will become a wight themselves in 1d4 days
turning them into small woodland animals unless a Dispel Evil is cast on them or they
like squirrels and hedgehogs. The change is are raised.
permanent, unless the targets can make a
saving throw vs. breath weapons in which
case it only lasts 24 hours. Targets cannot
make a saving throw to avoid the effect
completely.

White harts will often be shamans (to lev-


el 8) or sorcerers (to level 8).

353
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Wind Walker Wolf Wolf (Dire)


Type: enchanted Type: animal Type: animal
extraplanar Habitat: woods (common) Habitat: woods (rare)
Habitat: any (very rare) Wandering Group: 2d6 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil)
Wandering Group: 1 (nil) Lair Group: 3d6 (nil) Lair Group: 2d4 (nil)
Lair Group: 0 (nil) Move: 60’ Move: 50’
Move: 80’ (fly: 240’) Armour Class: 7 Armour Class: 6
Armour Class: 0 Hit Dice: 2+2 (11hp) Hit Dice: 4+1 (19hp)
Hit Dice: 16** (72hp) Attack Bonus: +3 Attack Bonus: +5
Attack Bonus: +13 Attacks: bite (1d6) Attacks: bite (2d4)
Attacks: bash (4d8) or vs. Death/Poison: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +8
grab (special) vs. Wand: +7 vs. Wand: +7
vs. Death/Poison: +15 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Wand: +14 vs. Dragon Breath: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +14 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Dragon Breath: +13 Intelligence: 2 Intelligence: 4
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +12 Morale: +13 Morale: +13
Intelligence: 12 XP Value: 25 XP Value: 125
Morale: +16
XP Value: 4,050

Wind walkers are 10’ tall humanoid clouds Wolves are wild cousins of dogs. They are Dire wolves are larger and more intelligent
of dense fog. They are rarely encountered intelligent carnivores and hunt using pack cousins of normal wolves that can reach 6’
on the prime plane except when they have tactics. long.
been summoned by use of the Wind Walker
spell in order to fetch an object or creature Although not domesticated like dogs, They are most commonly found in “lost
for the caster. wolves are sometimes reared by humanoid world” areas where they hunt in packs like
races as guard or hunting animals. their smaller cousins, although they are oc-
Wind walkers resent being summoned in casionally found outside such areas.
this manner, and if given chance will attack
the caster of the spell. Outside “lost world” areas, dire wolves are
sometimes used by goblins as mounts.
The speed and transparency of wind walkers
makes them surprise foes on a 1–5 on 1d6,
although they will not normally engage in
combat unless their opponents are stopping
them from fulfilling their mission.

A wind walker will only use its grab attack


against a creature that it has been asked to
fetch. If the attack hits, the wind walker
will fly off with the creature back to its sum-
moner. A grabbed creature has a percentage
chance equal to its hit dice or level to escape
the grab each round. Because of this, a wind
walker will normally pummel a persistently
struggling creature into unconsciousness
(pulling its blows in order to not kill it).

354
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Wraith Wyvern Yellow Mould


Type: undead Type: monster Type: plant
Habitat: barren (rare) Habitat: mountains (rare) Habitat: underground
Wandering Group: 1d4 (nil) Wandering Group: 1d2 (nil) Wandering Group: 0 (nil)
Lair Group: 1d6 (e) Lair Group: 1d6 (e) Lair Group: 1d4 (nil)
Move: 40’ (fly: 80’) Move: 30’ (fly: 80’) Move: –
Armour Class: 3 Armour Class: 3 Armour Class: special
Hit Dice: 4** (18hp) Hit Dice: 7* (32hp) Hit Dice: 2* (9hp)
Attack Bonus: +4 Attack Bonus: +7 Attack Bonus: +2
Attacks: claw Attacks: bite (2d8) & Attacks: spores (special)
(1d6 + special) sting vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Death/Poison: +9 (1d6 + special) vs. Wand: +7
vs. Wand: +8 vs. Death/Poison: +9 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Wand: +8 vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Dragon Breath: +6 v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 vs. Dragon Breath: +6 Intelligence: 0
Intelligence: 7 vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +5 Morale: +19
Morale: +18 Intelligence: 3 XP Value: 25
XP Value: 175 Morale: +16
XP Value: 850

Wraiths are incorporeal undead, appearing Wyverns are large (20’ long) winged reptil- Yellow mould is a fungus that grows viru-
as semi-transparent hooded figures with no ian creatures with two legs and a long neck lently in damp underground environments.
visible faces or legs, but with skeletal hands and tail. They vaguely resemble dragons, Each “monster” represents a 10’x10’ area of
emerging from their robes. and may be mistaken for them when fly- mould, and more than one may be found
ing at a distance, but the two are not related. next to each other.
Wraiths can only be hit by silver or magical
weapons, and are immune to sleep, charm Wyverns are carnivorous, and in combat Yellow mould looks like a bright yellow
and hold spells. they use both their bite and the stinger on slimy fibrous growth, with many small
their tail, which is flexible enough to reach ball shaped fungal pods in it. These pods
The claw of a wraith does 1d6 damage and around in front of them. are reproductive organs and contain the
does an Energy Drain to the target, causing spores that yellow mould uses to grow and
them to lose one level of experience. Anyone stung by a wyvern must make a colonise new areas.
saving throw vs. poison or die.
Anyone killed by a wraith will rise as a Yellow mould can only be killed by burning
wraith themselves the following night un- it. However, if touched by anything (in-
less a Dispel Evil or Raise Dead is cast on cluding flame) there is a 50% chance that
them. the mould will release a cloud of spores in
a 10’x10’x10’ area around itself. Any crea-
ture caught in the area will take 1d6 damage
and must make a saving throw vs. death ray
or choke to death in 6 rounds.

A Cure Disease spell will kill the spores in


a person’s throat and lungs, stopping their
choking, but will not kill a fully grown
patch of mould.

355
Chapter 18 - Monsters

Zombie
Type: undead
Habitat: any (common)
Wandering Group: 2d4 (nil)
Lair Group: 4d6 (nil)
Move: 30’
Armour Class: 8
Hit Dice: 2 (9hp)
Attack Bonus: +2
Attacks: claw (1d8)
vs. Death/Poison: +8
vs. Wand: +7
v s. Paralyse/Petrify: +6
vs. Dragon Breath: +5
vs. Rod/Staff/Spell: +4
Intelligence: 1
Morale: +19
XP Value: 20

Zombies are mindless undead created by an


Animate Dead spell.

Although tougher than skeletons, zombies


are slower and more mindless, following
orders literally with absolutely no sense of
self preservation.

Zombies are slow fighters, and always lose


initiative.

As undead, zombies are immune to sleep,


charm and hold spells, although they can
be hit by normal weapons.

356
Chapter 19 - Treasure
W
hile some adventurers go out and do heroic deeds purely Remember that the average value is an indication of the likely
through a sense of altruism and honour, others do it results from the rest of the table, and is not supposed to be given
for the money. However, even the most pure and noble as well as rolling on the rest of the table.
adventurer will smile when they discover that the rampaging dragon
that they have just killed happened to have a huge hoard of treasure Items of Value
which is now theirs for the taking (or re-distributing to the poor if The treasure table gives three types of valuable item other than
they’re that way inclined). coins: gems, jewellery and special items. When the treasure table
indicates that one or more of these items is present, check each
Dragons aren’t the only creatures that have treasure. Most sapient item in turn to find out its value.
creatures know the value of gold and silver and use it to trade in
whatever economies they are part of; and many non-sapient crea- If there are many items of the same basic type, they may be checked
tures will collect shiny baubles and things that capture their interest. in batches or small groups to save time.

Even completely mindless creatures may incidentally end up with Gems


treasure – as the inedible stuff their victims were carrying accu- The value of each gem can simply be determined by rolling on
mulates in their lairs. Table 19–2. The table also gives examples of the types of gem that
are likely to be worth the given value.
Treasure Types
Treasure in Dark Dungeons generally comes in three catego- If the monster whose treasure is being determined has less than 9
ries – coins and gems; jewellery; and magic items. hit dice, subtract 10 from the roll, treating results less than 01 as
if they were 01.
However, not all creatures will possess all those types of treasure in
equal measure. For example a dragon’s hoard will be very different In terms of weight and size, each gem is roughly equivalent to a
to the contents of a goblin’s belt pouch. coin; and therefore it is extremely unlikely that gems will be sig-
nificant when it comes to weighing a character down.
Dark dungeons handles this by having twenty two treasure types
labelled from ‘A’ to ‘V’. The first fifteen of these (a-o) usually rep- Jewellery
resent large treasure caches found in the lairs of creatures. The To determine the value of a piece of jewellery, roll on Table 19–3a.
other seven (p-v) represent small amounts of treasure carried by If the monster whose treasure is being determined has less than 9
individual creatures. hit dice, subtract 10 from the roll, treating results less than 01 as
if they were 01.
The monster descriptions in Chapter 18 – Monsters show the
treasure type that each type of creature may have either individu- Once the value of the piece of jewellery has been determined, roll
ally or in its lair. on Table 19–3b to determine the exact form of the piece.

When checking for a group of monsters, lair treasure should be In terms of encumbrance, jewellery will vary tremendously. A good
checked once for the whole group but individual treasure should rule of thumb is that common jewellery has negligible weight,
be checked for each monster separately. uncommon jewellery weighs about 1lb and rare jewellery weighs
around 5lb to 10lb.
In the case of lair treasure, the treasure may not all be in one
place. Some or all of it (especially magic items) may be distributed Special Items
amongst the creatures rather than simply in a vault or spoil heap. Special items are other potentially valuable goods in the possession
of the monsters.
Once you know the treasure type that you are checking, check the
actual contents of the treasure by looking it up on Table 19–1. They may be works of art, rare books, trade goods such as spices or
The table shows the percentage chance of each type of coin being silks, expensive perfumes and incenses, furs, or almost anything else.
present, along with the number of coins of that type that there will
be if they are present. Since these items can be so varied, it is not possible to create an
exhaustive list or table of possibilities.
Similarly, the table also has columns for gems, jewellery, special
treasures (which are miscellaneous items of value), and magic items. Simply roll 1d100 x 10 to find out the value (in gold pieces) of each
special item, and then decide what that value represents.
For the larger lair treasures, the table also shows the average mon-
etary value gained from the treasure type (excluding magic items) Encumbrance will vary wildly depending on the item. A 500gp
as a guideline for if you are in a hurry and want to simply assign statue may be anywhere from 6” to 6’ tall. Similarly 1,000gp of
a value rather than roll for each type of coin and item separately. trade goods might be a single sack of rare spices or might be a
whole cart full of fine clothing.

357
Table 19–1: Treasure Types
Treasure Copper Electrum Platinum Special
Silver Pieces Gold Pieces Gems Jewellery Magic Items Average Value
Type Pieces Pieces Pieces Treasure
25% 30% 20% 35% 25%
A 50% (6d6) 50% (6d6) 10% (1d2) 30% (any 3) 17,000gp
(1d6x1,000) (1d6x1,000) (1d4x1,000) (2d6x1,000) (1d2x1,000)
50% 25% 25% 35% 10% (1 sword, misc
B – 25% (1d6) 25% (1d6) – 2,000gp
(1d8x1,000) (1d6x1,000) (1d4x1,000) (1d3x1,000) weapon, or armour)
20% 30% 10%
C – – 25% (1d4) 25% (1d4) 5% (1d2) 10% (any 2) 750gp
(1d12x1,000) (1d4x1,000) (1d4x1,000)
10% 15% 60%
D – – 30% (1d8) 30% (1d8) 10% (1d2) 15% (any 2, 1 potion) 4,000gp
(1d8x1,000) (1d12x1,000) (1d6x1,000)
Chapter 19 - Treasure

5% 30% 25% 25%


E – 10% (1d10) 10% (1d10) 15% (1d2) 25% (any 3, 1 scroll) 2,500gp
(1d10x1,000) (1d12x1,000) (1d4x1,000) (1d8x1,000)
30% (1 potion, 1
10% 20% 45% 30%
F – 20% (2d12) 10% (1d12) 20% (1d3) scroll, 3 any but 7,600gp
(2d10x1,000) (1d8x1,000) (1d12x1,000) (1d3x1,000)
weapons)
50% 50%
G – – – 25% (3d6) 25% (1d10) 30% (1d3) 35% (any 4, 1 scroll) 25,000gp
(1d4x10,000) (1d6x1,000)
25% 50% 50% 50% 25% 15% (any 4, 1
H 50% (1d100) 50% (1d4x10) 10% (1d2) 60,000gp
(3d8x1,000) (1d100x1,000) (1d4x10,000) (1d6x10,000) (5d4x1,000) potion, 1 scroll)

358
30%
I – – – – 50% (2d6) 50% (2d6) 5% (1d2) 15% (any 1) 7,500gp
(1d8x1,000)
25% 10%
J – – – – – – – 25gp
(1d4x1,000) (1d3x1,000)
30% 10%
K – – – – – – – 250gp
(1d6x1,000) (1d2x1,000)
40% 50%
L – – – 50% (1d4) – – – 225gp
(2d4x1,000) (3d10x1,000)
M – – – – – 55% (5d4) 45% (2d6) – – 50,000gp
N – – – – – – – 10% (1d2) 40% (2d4 potions)
O – – – – – – – 10% (1d3) 50% (1d4 scrolls)
P 100% (3d8) – – – – – – – –
Q – 100% (3d6) – – – – – – –
R – – 100% (2d6) – – – – – –
S – – – 100% (2d4) – 5% (1) – – –
T – – – – 100% (1d6) 5% (1) – – –
U 10% (1d100) 10% (1d100) – 5% (1d100) – 5% (1d2) 5% (1d4) 2% (1) 2% (any 1)
V – 10% (1d100) 5% (1d100) 10% (1d100) 5% (1d100) 10% (1d2) 10% (1d2) 5% (1) 5% (any 1)
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Table 19–2: Gems Table 19–3a: Jewellery Value
D100* Value Examples D100* Value Jewellery Type
01–03 10gp Agate, quartz, turquoise 01 100 Common
04–10 50gp Jasper, onyx 02–03 500 Common
11–25 100gp Amber, amethyst, garnet, jade 04–06 1,000 Common
26–46 500gp Aquamarine, pearl, topaz 07–10 1,500 Common
47–71 1,000gp Carbuncle, opal 11–16 2,000 Common
72–90 5,000gp Emerald, ruby, sapphire 17–24 2,500 Common
91–97 10,000gp Diamond, jacinth 25–34 3,000 Common
Flawless or unusually cut gem, 35–45 4,000 Uncommon
98–00 X2
roll again for type 46–58 5,000 Uncommon
* if the monster whose treasure this is has less than 9 hit dice, 59–69 7,500 Uncommon
subtract 10 from the roll.
70–78 10,000 Uncommon

Magic Items 79–85 15,000 Rare


Not all treasure has purely monetary value. Many items have potent 86–90 20,000 Rare
magical powers that will aid an adventurer. 91–94 25,000 Rare
95–97 30,000 Rare
When the treasure table indicates that one or more magical items
98–99 40,000 Rare
are present, it may also indicate the type of magical item or items.
If the type of a magic item is not predetermined, roll on Table 19–4 00 50,000 Rare
to find out what type of magic item each one is. Unlike gems and * if the monster whose treasure this is has less than 9 hit dice,
jewellery, magic items should be rolled for individually rather than subtract 10 from the roll.
in groups.
Table 19–3b: Jewellery Form
Unlike the gem and jewellery tables, there are no specific guidelines 1d10 Common Uncommon Rare
in the magic item tables for high or low level creatures, except for
weapons and armour. This means that in theory a bunch of goblins 1 Anklet Armband Amulet
are as likely to have come across a ring of wishes as an angel is. The 2 Beads Belt Crown
Game Master has the option to reject a rolled item if they think 3 Bracelet Collar Diadem
it is too out-of-place or too powerful for the party of adventurers.
4 Brooch Earring Medallion
However, being too stingy and rejecting any kind of useful item 5 Buckle Heart Orb
can be very frustrating for the players. 6 Cameo Leaf Ring
7 Chain Necklace Scarab
Remember, for example, that when it comes down to it, the dif-
8 Clasp Pendant Sceptre
ference between a +1 sword and a +3 sword is fairly insignificant
compared to even a single increase in weapon expertise level. 9 Locket Rabbit’s foot Talisman
10 Pin Torc Tiara
Restricted Items
Many magical items can be used by any character. However, some Mountebanks have the ability to use any magic item, regardless of
may only be used by characters of certain classes. These are marked the above restrictions.
as follows:
Magic Item Costs
(c) = clerics only Each magic item is shown with a cost. This will usually be a fixed
(dr) = druids only cost, but in some cases where there is variation in an item (such as
(e) = elves only a spell scroll having different levels of spell or a staff of an element
(m) = magic-users only possibly being attuned to multiple elements) the cost may vary with
(n) = non-spell casters only the exact item. Similarly, the listed cost for magic items that are
(s) = spell casters only found with a variable number of charges assumes that the item is
(ss) = one type of spell caster only fully charged. An item with fewer charges will have a correspond-
ingly lower price. This cost for magic items has four purposes.
These indicators may be combined; for example an item marked
with (c, dr) can be used by clerics or druids. Firstly, although the general assumption is that most magic items
will be found during adventuring rather than bought; some groups

359
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Table 19–5: Potions Table 19–5: Potions
D100 Potion Cost D100 Potion Cost
01–02 Blending 100gp 54 Freedom 300gp
03–06 Delusion 100gp 55–57 Heroism 300gp
07–12 Healing 100gp 58–59 Invulnerability 300gp
13 Human control 100gp 60–63 Speed 300gp
14–15 Levitation 100gp 64–65 Strength 300gp
16–17 Speech 100gp 66–67 Water breathing 300gp
18 Animal control 200gp 68–70 Antidote 400gp
19–20 Climbing 200gp 71 Dragon control 400gp
21–22 Diminution 200gp 72 Elasticity 400gp
23–24 ESP 200gp 73–75 Gaseous form 400gp
25–27 Fire resistance 200gp 76 Giant control 400gp
28–29 Growth 200gp 77–79 Giant strength 400gp
30–32 Invisibility 200gp 80 Merging 400gp
33–34 Plant control 200gp 81–83 Poison 400gp
35–37 Swimming 200gp 84–86 Polymorph self 400gp
38 Treasure finding 200gp 87 Undead control 400gp
39–40 Agility 300gp 88–89 Dreamspeech 500gp
41–42 Bug repellent 300gp 90 Luck 500gp
43–44 Clairaudience 300gp 91–92 Sight 500gp
45–46 Clairvoyance 300gp 93–95 Super healing 500gp
47–48 Defence 300gp 96 Ethereality 800gp
49–51 Flying 300gp 97–98 Elemental form 900gp
52–53 Fortitude 300gp 99–100 Longevity 5,000gp
prefer campaigns where characters can buy magic items. How this is rolling for treasure. Knowing the value of the items you have just
is implemented will depend on the campaign – ranging from spe- rolled gives you a broad idea of its general power level and whether
cialist brokers to auctions or even simple shops where items can be or not it is suitable for the party to find.
bought. Whether the buying of magic items is possible in a given
campaign setting is up to the Game Master to decide. Developer Commentary
Neither the first edition of Dark Dungeons nor the original game
Secondly, even if magic items can’t be bought, the nature of adven- that it emulates provided costs for magic items, at least not directly.
turing means that characters will end up with cast-off items that
they can’t use or that they no longer need because they’ve found The original game did include some generic rules for making magic
better. That +1 sword that the party were excited about finding at items, which included a cost – although these rules were rather fiddly.
second level isn’t much use any more when the party are fifteenth You basically needed to get out a calculator each time you wanted
level and wielding +3 swords of speed. The listed costs can be used to work out how much a specific magic item cost to make and what
as a guide for how much selling an unwanted magic item can fetch. the chance of success of making such an item was for a character
As with buying magic items, how easy it is to sell a magic item will of given level and ablity scores. And there was no guidance about
depend on the campaign. The default assumption is that finding how to use any of that in terms of how much a generic magic item
a buyer in a major city will be easy to do, and that an item can be should sell for when found (or should cost to buy if the Game Master
sold for half of its listed cost. allows them to be bought).

Thirdly, immortals can use the Create Mundane Item spell to create For this edition of Dark Dungeons, i’ve pre-calculated a cost for
items from nothing, and the cost of casting this spell is based on all the standard magic items on the treasure tables using a slightly
the value of the item being created. If an immortal creates a magic tweaked version of that original cost-to-make calculation. Even if
item using this spell, the cost of the item can be used to determine the Game Master decides that buying and selling magic items isn’t
the cost of the spell. something that’s possible in their campaign setting (although the
default assumption is that it is) the standard costs will still be use-
Finally, while the cost of an item is not an exact measure of how ful for immortals creating items and for judging the relative value
useful it is, it is good as a general guideline when the Game Master of items at a glance when deciding what treasure should be found.

360
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Bug Repellent: Any normal or giant bug (an insect, spider, scor-
Potions pion, centipede, or other arthropod) will completely ignore the
A potion is a magical liquid, usually contained in a vial that must drinker unless magically controlled.
be drunk for its magical effect to take place.
If the bugs have been magically controlled to attack the drinker, the
Normally, this involves drinking the entire potion – meaning that drinker gets a +4 bonus to any saving throws against the control-
each potion can only be used once. ling effect that allow the damage done by the insects to be reduced.

Unlike most magic items, potions do not need to be identified Clairaudience: While concentrating, the drinker may listen as if
with an Analyse spell. A potion can be identified by taking a small at any point within 60’ of their current location.
sip – although this does run the risk of it being poison.
Clairvoyance: While concentrating, the drinker may see as if at
Drinking a potion in combat or feeding it to an unconscious person any point within 60’ of their current location.
requires a use non-activatable item action.
Climbing: The drinker may walk on walls and ceilings as if a spider.
Unless otherwise indicated, the magical effect of a potion lasts
for 1 hour + 1d6 x 10 minutes, and (if applicable) will be as if cast Defence: This potion only lasts 10 minutes. The drinker gets a
by a 6th level spell caster. The drinker of the potion will have no bonus to their armour class based on the power of the potion. To
advance warning of exactly when it will run out. determine the power of the potion, roll 1d10:

If someone drinks a potion while an existing potion is in effect, they 1–3 = +1


will become sick and unable to take any actions for 30 minutes (no 4–5 = +2
save), and neither potion will have its effect. 6–7 = +3
8–9 = +4
Potions that allow the drinker to control others require the drinker 10 = +5
to be able to see all controlled creatures and concentrate for the
duration. Delusion: This potion will have no effect when drunk. However, if
tasted it will falsely give the taster the impression that it is another
Controlled creatures cannot be made to kill themselves. Targeted type of potion from this list. Multiple tasters will all get the same
creatures may make a saving throw vs. spells in order to avoid be- impression. An Analyse spell will correctly identify this potion as
ing controlled, but the drinker can simply try the control again one of delusion rather than as the type it tastes like.
the following round.
Diminution: The drinker shrinks down to 6” in height. While in
Agility: The drinker’s dexterity score becomes 18 for the duration this state they cannot hurt creatures larger than 1’ tall with physical
of the potion. attacks, and have a 90% chance of being able to hide. If this po-
tion is drunk while a potion of growth is in effect, they will simply
Animal Control: The drinker may control one or more animals cancel each other rather than making the drinker sick.
with a total hit dice of 3d6 or less. When the effect of the potion
wears off, the animals will flee. Dragon Control: The drinker of this potion can control up to
three dragons of sub-adult or younger. The dragons do not get
Antidote: The drinker becomes immune to all poisons of up to a saving throws, but older dragons are not affected.
certain strength for the duration of the potion.
Each potion of dragon control will only control one type of dragon.
The strength of the potion should be determined by rolling 1d10: Roll 1d10 to see which type of dragon is affected:

1–4 = poison from 3hd creatures 1–2 = black


5–7 = poison from 7hd creatures 3–4 = blue
8–9 = poison from 15hd creatures 5–6 = green
10 = all poison 7–8 = red
9–10 = white
Poison from non-creature sources (e.g. a potion of poison) should
be considered to be as if from a 7hd creature. The controlled dragons will do anything that is commanded (other
than suicidal commands) although if dragon queens, they are not
Blending: The drinker may change colour to blend in with their capable of casting spells.
surroundings. When hiding, the drinker will have a 90% chance
to go unnoticed unless the viewer can see invisible creatures. When the control ends, the dragons will become hostile to the
drinker and will either flee or attack depending on their impression
of the drinker’s power.

361
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Dreamspeech: This potion only lasts for 10 minutes. The drinker Freedom: The drinker is immune to paralysis and to all forms of
can speak to one paralysed, petrified or sleeping creature within 30’ hold spell or effect.
(only one creature can be spoken with per potion) and can hear the
responses of the creature via ESP. The drinker will automatically Gaseous Form: The drinker’s body transforms to a cloud of gas
understand the language of the target, but the target is under no for up to 1 hour, causing all their equipment and carried items to
compulsion to speak the truth (or even respond at all) if they do fall to the floor.
not wish to.
The drinker keeps control of their body, and can move through
Elasticity: This potion only lasts for 10 minutes. The drinker may any non-airtight barrier.
stretch and deform themselves and their equipment to fit through
gaps as small as 1” and reach as far as 30’. While in gaseous form, the drinker cannot attack, but has an ar-
mour class of –2 and can only be hit by magical weapons.
The drinker cannot cast spells or attack while stretched, and items
carried cannot be used or dropped unless they are in normal form. Giant Control: The user may control up to four giants of a certain
However, while stretched the drinker only takes half damage from type, but each one gets a saving throw. The giants will normally
blunt and bashing attacks. be hostile once control ends. To determine the type of giant af-
fected, roll 1d6:
Elemental Form: This potion only lasts for 10 minutes. For the
duration of the potion, the drinker may transform to an elemental 1 = cloud
of a certain type and back. Each transformation takes 1 round. 2 = fire
3 = frost
The drinker’s hit points do not change while in elemental form, 4 = hill
but their other abilities become the same as an elemental with the 5 = stone
same number of hit dice as the drinker’s level. 6 = storm

Roll 1d4 to determine the type of elemental that the potion allows Giant Strength: The drinker gains the strength of a giant, and
the drinker to change to: can do double damage with melee weapons or throw rocks
(range: 60/130/200) for 3d6 damage. This potion does not stack
1 = air with other strength enhancing items such as gauntlets of ogre power.
2 = earth
3 = fire Growth: The drinker grows to twice normal size, and be able to do
4 = water double damage with melee attacks. If this potion is drunk while
a potion of diminution is in effect, they will simply cancel each
ESP: This potion has the same effect at the spell of the same name. other rather than making the drinker sick.

Ethereality: This potion gives the drinker the ability to shift from Healing: This potion will either cure 1d6+1 hit points of damage
the prime plane to the ethereal plane. The drinker may shift at any to the drinker or cure their paralysis. This potion has an instant
time before the potion’s duration runs out, and may then spend up effect, rather than a duration.
to 24 hours on the ethereal plane before shifting back.
Heroism: This potion will not affect a cleric, druid, elf, magic-user
Once the drinker has shifted to the ethereal plane and back, the or lupine. However, a commoner, fighter, thief, dwarf or halfling
potion’s duration immediately expires. who drinks it will temporarily gain one or more levels as follows:

Fire Resistance: The drinker becomes immune to normal fire, gains commoner = gains 4 (fighter) levels
a +2 bonus on all saving throws against fire or heat based attacks, 1–3 = gains 3 levels
and takes –1 point of damage per die (to a minimum of 1 point 4–7 = gains 2 levels
per die) from magical fire attacks. 8–10 = gains 1 level
11+ = no effect.
Flying: This potion has the same effect as the spell of the same
name. All damage (including energy drains) is taken from the extra levels
and hit points first.
Fortitude: The drinker’s constitution score becomes 18 for the
duration of the potion, possibly giving them extra hit points. When Human Control: The drinker may control up to 6 levels (com-
the drinker takes damage, it comes off these extra hit points first. moners count as half a level each) of humans, similar to a Charm
Damage already taken before the extra hit points were applied Person spell. The targets can only be controlled while within 60’ of
remains unless cured. the drinker, and the effect lasts only for the duration of the potion.

362
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Invisibility: This potion has the same effect as the spell of the Super Healing: This potion will either cure 3d6+3 hit points of
same name. damage to the drinker.

Invulnerability: The drinker gains a +2 bonus to armour class and This potion has an instant effect, rather than a duration.
all saving throws for the duration of the potion. If a second potion
of invulnerability is drunk within a week, the only effect is sickness. Swimming: This potion lasts for 8 hours. The drinker floats on
top of water or other liquid, and can’t be weighed down unless
Levitation: This potion has the same effect as the spell of the by over 300lb of weight. Additionally, the drinker can swim at a
same name. speed of 60’ per round.

Longevity: The drinker immediately becomes 10 years younger. Treasure Finding: When the drinker concentrates, they can de-
The effect is an instant one rather than an ongoing one, and there- tect the distance and direction to the largest amount of treasure
fore cannot be dispelled. This potion will not reduce the age of the within 360’. The drinker gains no insight about the nature of the
drinker below 15 years old. treasure or how to get to it.

Luck: This potion lasts only for 1 hour. The potion makes the Undead Control: The drinker can control up to 18hd in total of
drinker extremely lucky. undead creatures of 9hd or less. The undead will be hostile when
the duration ends.
The player of the drinking character may choose any one roll that
they make on behalf of the drinking character within the duration Water Breathing: This potion lasts for four hours, and has the
and simply place the dice on the result of their choice rather than same effect as the spell of the same name.
having to actually roll them.
Scrolls & Maps
Merging: This potion allows the drinker to merge other creatures A scroll is a piece of parchment or paper with magical writings on
into their own body. The drinker can merge up to seven other crea- it. The scroll is used by unrolling it and reading aloud the writing.
tures, and both the drinker and the other creatures must be willing. If used in combat, this takes an activate magic item action, and
Creatures simply step “into” the drinker and disappear along with requires there to be enough light to read by.
their items and equipment. While merged with the drinker, the
creatures do not take damage if the drinker is hit, and they cannot Scrolls and maps normally do not need to be identified with an
take any actions other than speaking. The merged creatures can Analyse spell. They can be identified simply by reading them. How-
step “out of ” the drinker at any time. ever, while a scroll containing spells can be identified as such by
reading, the actual spells themselves may need a Read Magic spell
Plant Control: The drinker may control all mundane plants and to identify them.
all plant-like creatures in a 30’x30’ area up to 60’ away. Mundane
plants may entangle creatures in their area, but cannot otherwise This section also contains maps that may be found in treasure. These
attack. are not magical, and are not usually used in combat.

Poison: This potion looks like any other, but it is poisonous. Any- Some scrolls can be used by anyone, but others can only be used
one taking even a taste of the potion must save vs. poison or die. by certain types of character. Scrolls marked with an (s) can only
be used by spell casters.
Polymorph Self: This potion has the same effect as the spell of
the same name. Communication: This is a pair of matching scrolls. Any message
(of up to 100 words) that is written on one scroll will also appear
Sight: This potion lasts for 10 minutes. While this potion is in on the other, providing they are on the same plane as each other.
effect, the drinker can temporarily see despite any blindness condi-
tions. Additionally, the drinker may see invisible things. This scroll can be re-used, but each time the writing is erased and
replaced by a different message there is a 5% chance that the magic
Speech: The drinker can understand all languages that they hear, will stop working.
and can respond in those same languages. This potion does not
give the drinker the power to speak a language unless they first Creation: Once per day, the owner of this scroll can draw an item
hear it spoken. on it, and then pick up the drawing off the paper and it will become
a real item that lasts for 24 hours. The item can be up to 10’x5’x1’
Speed: The drinker may move at double normal speed and attack in size, and cannot weigh more than 500lb or be worth more
twice per round. See Chapter 10: Combat for full details about than 500gp. Magical or living items may not be created.
the effect of haste and speed on combat.
Curse: Anyone who reads this scroll, even only glancing to check
Strength: The drinker’s strength score becomes 18 for the duration what is on it, is immediately cursed with no saving throw allowed.
of the potion.

363
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Table 19–6: Scrolls & Maps Illumination: If the writing on this scroll is read out and the scroll
D100 Scroll or Map Cost is rolled up tightly, it will burst into flame and act as a torch. It will
burn for a total of 6 hours per day, and the torch flame will not
01–04 Map to normal treasure –
harm the scroll – although it will set light to other things.
05–07 Map to magical treasure –
08–09 Map to combined treasure – If the scroll is unrolled, the torch flame will immediately go out.
10 Map to special treasure – Otherwise, no amount of wind or rain will put it out, although it
will go out if immersed in water.
11–35 Spells (ss) 100gp*
36 Repetition (ss) 200gp* Mage’s (s): A mage’s scroll may only be used by a spell caster. Once
37–44 Curse 300gp per day, its user may command it to identify a magical effect. The
45 Delay (ss) 300gp* name of the effect and the caster level will appear on the scroll.
46–47 Trapping 500gp If the magical effect is a non-standard one, the Game Master
48–53 Protection from elementals 600gp should invent an informative name for it; but should not give a
54–61 Protection from lycanthropes 600gp full description of exactly what the effect does unless it is extremely
straightforward.
62–65 Protection from magic 600gp
66–72 Protection from undead 600gp Map to Treasure: These non-magical scrolls are simply treasure
73–74 Illumination 2,300gp maps indicating the location of some kind of treasure.
75–76 Mage’s (s) 2,300gp
Mapping: Once per day, this scroll may be called upon to draw
77–79 Communication 4,000gp
its surrounding area.
80–82 Mapping 7,000gp
83–84 Seeing 7,000gp The scroll will reproduce an accurate map of everything within
85–86 Shelter 7,000gp a 100’ radius. Each secret door has a 1-in–6 chance of being drawn,
although the presence of some secret doors may be inferred by what
87–88 Truth 7,000gp is drawn behind them.
89–91 Equipment 8,100gp
92–93 Questioning 9,300gp Portals: Twice per day, this scroll can be placed on a wall and com-
manded to create a Passwall effect like the spell of the same name.
94–96 Spell catching 10,000gp*
The scroll will then disappear, and the Passwall tunnel will last
97–98 Portals 12,000gp for 30 minutes, before the tunnel closes and the scroll re-appears.
99–100 Creation 14,000gp
* per total level of spells Protection from Elementals: This scroll can only be used once.
When read aloud, it produces a 10’ radius zone of protection. El-
For typical curses, check the reversed version of the Remove Curse ementals cannot enter the zone, but can use missile and spell attacks
spell. against those inside the zone. The zone lasts for 20 minutes, or
until someone inside the zone attacks an elemental in hand-to-
The curse lasts until removed by a Remove Curse spell. hand combat.

Delay (ss): This is a spell scroll containing a single spell. However, Protection from Lycanthropes: This scroll can only be used once.
when the spell is cast from the scroll, the caster may choose to delay When read aloud, it produces a 10’ radius zone of protection. Ly-
the effects of the spell anywhere from 0 to 12 rounds. canthropes cannot enter the zone, but can use missile and spell
attacks against those inside the zone. The zone lasts for 60 minutes,
If the caster still has the scroll when the spell goes off, the caster or until someone inside the zone attacks a lycanthrope in hand-
chooses whatever parameters are needed by the spell (e.g. Targets) to-hand combat.
at the time it goes off. If the caster has let go of the scroll when the
spell goes off, it goes off affecting the location of the scroll itself or Protection from Magic: This scroll can only be used once. When
the nearest valid targets (within the normal spell range). read aloud, it produces a 10’ radius zone of protection. Mortal
level magic (whether from spells or items) cannot enter or leave
Equipment: This scroll has the names of six mundane items writ- the zone. The zone lasts for 60 minutes, and can only be broken
ten on it. When any of the names is read aloud, the name vanishes by a Wish spell.
and the item appears. The item will remain for 24 hours, and then
disappear, with the name reappearing on the scroll at the same time. Protection from Undead: This scroll can only be used once. When
read aloud, it produces a 10’ radius zone of protection. Undead
No more than three items can be brought forth per day. cannot enter the zone, but can use missile and spell attacks against

364
Chapter 19 - Treasure
those inside the zone. The zone lasts for 60 minutes, or until some- scroll. If this saving throw is successful, the spell does not have its
one inside the zone attacks an undead in hand-to-hand combat. normal effect, but is caught on the scroll instead.

Questioning: This scroll enables the user to ask questions of in- The scroll can only contain one spell at a time, and once a spell is
animate objects and receive answers. The objects will answer as if in the scroll it works just like a normal spell scroll until the spell
they were living beings with normal human senses. The user can has been cast from it.
ask three questions per day.
Anyone can use the scroll to catch a spell, but casting the caught
This scroll cannot be used to question living beings or magical spell from the scroll has the normal restrictions that a spell scroll
objects. containing the same spell would have.

Repetition (ss): This scroll appears to be a scroll of spells contain- Spells (ss): A spell scroll will contain one or more spells. Use Ta-
ing a single spell. However, ten minutes after the spell is cast from ble 19–7 to determine the exact contents of the scroll.
the scroll, it will cast itself a second time, centred on the scroll or
affecting the nearest valid target (within normal spell range). Firstly find out which type of spell is on the scroll, then how many
spells, then for each spell roll a random level and randomly deter-
Seeing: Once per day, this scroll can be commanded to draw the mine which spell of that level is on the scroll.
creatures that are within 100’ of the user within a single direction.
The scroll will draw up to four types of creature, starting with the A spell scroll can be identified as such by simple reading, but the
largest and working its way smaller. type and identity of the spells on it can only be recognised by casters
of the correct type. Additionally, magic-users and elves will be able
Shelter: This scroll contains a drawing of a 10’ square room with to recognise that the spells on a scroll are magic-user/elf spells but
two beds, a table and two chairs. The table is shown laden with will not be able to read those spells without using a Read Magic spell.
food, and there are swords and shields hung on the wall.
Each spell on the scroll can only be used once, and they may only
Once per day, the scroll can be placed against a vertical surface it be used by characters of a class that can cast the spell (elves, magic-
will grow to life-size, and the room can be entered. users and mountebanks share the same type of scrolls and clerics
and druids share the same type of scrolls with the exception that
Anyone walking into the room disappears and a drawn version of clerics cannot cast druid-only spells).
them appears on the scroll.
If the character is high enough level to cast the spell, the spell will
To people in the scroll, the items in the room are all mundane and automatically work, but if the character is not high enough level to
usable, although none of them can be removed from the room. cast the spell then there is a 10% chance that the spell will misfire.
Offensive spells that misfire will go off centred on the caster and
The scroll will stay in place for 12 hours, or until it is taken down other spells will simply fizzle and be wasted.
by someone.
Thieves of 10th level an above may decipher spell scrolls containing
If the scroll is taken down, anyone still in the room is trapped inside magic-user/elf spells, but is always considered to be of insufficient
it. The air and food replenish themselves, and the room is a com- level to cast the spell and therefore always has the 10% chance of
fortable – although boring – place to live for an extended period. the spell misfiring.

While the scroll is not in place, the only way out of the room is Spells cast from scrolls are always treated as having a caster of the
via a Wish spell. minimum level needed to cast the spell, not as having a caster of
the reader’s level.
Spell Catching: This scroll can be used to catch spells cast at its
user. It can only cast actual spells cast by spell casters or from scrolls. When each spell is cast from the scroll it will fade and disappear,
It can’t catch the spell-like effects produced by items. leaving part of the scroll blank.

Roll 1d10 to determine the exact level of spell that the scroll can Trapping: This scroll can only be used once. It is placed against a
catch: smooth hard surface, and the writing on it is read out.

1–4 = 1st–2nd level spells If it was placed on a floor, it will disappear and be replaced by
5–7 = 1st–4th level spells a 10’x10’ covered pit 20’ deep with poison spikes.
8–9 = 1st–6th level spells
10 = 1st–8th level spells If it was placed on a ceiling, it will disappear and be replaced by a
poisoned blade held ready to scythe down.
The user of the scroll must make a saving throw vs. spells with a
+4 bonus when a spell is cast at them in order to catch it in the

365
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Table 19–7a: Spell Scroll Type An unwilling subject may make a saving throw vs. spells to avoid
D100 Type of Spells having the answer drawn from them, in which case the scroll will
remain blank, but may not give a false answer.
01–70 Magic-user/elf
71–95 Cleric Wands, Staves & Rods
96–00 Druid Wands, staves and rods are magical devices that contain spell-like
enchantments.
Table 19–7b: Spell Scroll Number
D100 Number of Spells Wands are normally thin sticks around 18” long. They can only be
used by magic-users or elves. A wand will hold 2d10 charges, and
01–50 1
each time it is used one charge will be used up. Once all the charges
51–83 2 are used up, a wand is simply a non-magical stick.
84–00 3
Rods are larger than wands, often 2’–3’ long, and usually made
Table 19–7c: Spell Scroll Cleric/druid Spell Level of metal with some kind of protrusion on the end like a sceptre.
D100 Spell Level Most rods can be used by anyone. Unlike wands and staves, most
rods do not use charges.
01–34 1
35–58 2 Staves are the bigger cousins of wands. They are normally 5’–6’
59–76 3 long, and made of wood. Staves tend to be more versatile and
powerful than wands, although they still use charges. A staff will
77–88 4
have 3d10 charges when found, and each use of the staff may use
89–95 5 one of more of these charges. Staves are often restricted in terms
96–99 6 of who can use them.
00 7
A magical staff can be used in melee as if a quarterstaff. However,
Table 19–7d: Spell Scroll Magic-user/elf Spell Level unless otherwise noted, it will not give the user a bonus to attack
or damage rolls, although it will still count as a magical weapon
D100 Spell Level
for purposes of whether it can damage certain creatures.
01–28 1
29–49 2 As with wands, when a staff runs out of charges it is just a stick.
50–64 3 This applies even if the staff formally had powers that did not use
charges (such as acting as a magical weapon).
65–75 4
76–84 5 Activating a wand, staff or rod requires the speaking of a command
85–91 6 word and the use of an activate magic item action. The functions
of a wand, staff or rod, and the command words to activate those
92–95 7
functions, can be discovered by an Analyse spell.
96–99 8
00 9 Unless otherwise noted, for purposes of dispelling treat the effects
produced by all wands, staffs and rods to be as if made by a 6th
If it was placed on a wall, it will be replaced by a dart trap that level caster.
fires poisoned darts.
Saving throws against spells and effects created by wands, staves
In each case, the trap is non-magical once created, and can be and rods are always made vs. wands unless the description of the
detected and disarmed with normal chances. item says otherwise.

If any of the traps are set off, they will do 2d6 damage to their Wand of Cold (e): Each time a charge is expended, this wand cre-
victim, plus if the victim fails a saving throw vs. poison then the ates a cone of cold, 60’ long and 30’ wide at the end. All creatures
victim will be killed. within the cone must take 6d6 damage.

Truth: Once per day, the user of this scroll can ask a question of If they can make a saving throw vs. wands, they take only half
any sapient being within 30’. damage.

The complete and true answer to the question (or at least what the Wand of Enemy Detection (e): Each time a charge is expended, all
subject thinks is the complete and true answer to the question) creatures with hostile intent towards the user within 60’ will glow
will be read from the subject’s mind via ESP and will appear on as if on fire. This includes invisible or hidden enemies; in which
the scroll.

366
Chapter 19 - Treasure
case the glow may give away their positions. The glow lasts for 10 Table 19–8: Wands, Staves & Rods
minutes before fading. D100 Wand, Staff or Rod Cost
01–02 Rod of cancellation 500gp
Wand of Fear (e): Each time a charge is expended, this wand cre-
ates a cone of fear, 60’ long and 30’ wide at the end. All creatures 03–07 Wand of enemy detection (m) 2,000gp
within the cone must make a saving throw vs. wands or flee in 08–11 Wand of fear (m) 2,000gp
terror for 5 minutes. 12–16 Wand of magic detection (m) 2,000gp
17–21 Wand of metal detection (m) 2,000gp
Wand of Fireballs (e): Each time a charge is expended, this wand
creates a Fireball up to 240’ away. Anyone in the area of effect 22–25 Wand of secret door detection (m) 2,000gp
takes 6d6 damage. If they can make a saving throw vs. wands they 26–29 Wand of trap detection (m) 2,000gp
take only half damage. 30–33 Wand of illusion (m) 4,000gp
Wand of Illusion (e): Each time a charge is expended, this wand 34–38 Wand of fireballs (m) 6,000gp
creates a Phantasmal Force as the spell of the same name. The caster 39–43 Wand of lightning bolts (m) 6,000gp
must concentrate to maintain the illusion. 44–47 Wand of negation (m) 6,000gp
48–52 Wand of paralysation (m) 6,000gp
Wand of Lightning Bolts (e): Each time a charge is expended,
this wand creates a Lightning Bolt up to 240’ away and then ex- 53–55 Snake staff (c, dr) 6,000gp
tending 60’ from that point. Anyone in the path of the lightning 56–60 Wand of cold (m) 8,000gp
takes 6d6 damage. If they can make a saving throw vs. wands they 61–65 Wand of polymorphing (m) 8,000gp
take only half damage.
66–66 Rod of dominion 8,700gp
Wand of Magic Detection (e,m): Each time a charge is expended, 67–68 Staff of dispelling 9,000gp
all magical items and active spells within a 20’ radius will glow 69–71 Staff of striking (s) 9,000gp
for 6 rounds (1 minute). 72–72 Staff of commanding (s) 12,000gp
Wand of Metal Detection (e): Each time a charge is expended, 73–73 Rod of health (c) 13,000gp
the wand will point towards a type of metal named by the user if 74–75 Staff of harming (c) 15,000gp
there is at least 100lb (the amount found in 1,000 coins or the 76–82 Staff of healing (c) 15,000gp
equivalent) of it within 20’.
83–83 Rod of victory 20,000gp
Wand of Negation (e): Each time a charge is expended, this wand 84–85 Staff of withering (c) 24,000gp
will cancel the effects of another wand or staff. If the effect that is 86–86 Staff of power (m) 26,000gp
being negated is an effect with a duration, it will be negated for 87–88 Rod of inertia (n) 29,000gp
a single round.
89–91 Staff of an element (m) 33,000gp*
Wand of Paralysation (e): Each time a charge is expended, this 92–92 Rod of the wyrm 40,000gp
wand creates a cone 60’ long and 30’ wide at the end. All crea- 93–93 Staff of wizardry (m) 44,000gp
tures within the cone must make a saving throw vs. wands or be 94–94 Rod of parrying 62,000gp
paralysed for 1 hour.
95–97 Staff of the druids (dr) 63,000gp
Wand of Polymorphing (e): Each time a charge is expended, this 98–100 Rod of weaponry (n) 98,000gp
wand produces the effect of either a Polymorph Self on the user * per element
of the wand or a Polymorph Other on a target that the wand is
pointed at. Unwilling targets may make a saving throw vs. wands user to act as if they had drunk a potion of animal control, potion
to avoid the effect. of human control or potion of plant control. However, unlike
the potions, this gives the user only a single attempt to establish
Wand of Secret Door Detection (e): When this wand is activated, control per use.
it will point the user towards all secret doors within 20’. This ex-
pends one charge per secret door revealed. Staff of Dispelling: This staff is usable by any character. When the
staff is used and a charge is expended, it will cast Dispel Magic as if
Wand of Trap Detection (e): When this wand is activated, it will by a 15th level caster, except with a range of only touch.
point the user towards all traps within 20’. This expends one charge
per trap revealed. The staff can be used to dispel magic items. When it is used against
an item and a charge is expended it will automatically destroy any
Staff of Commanding (s): This staff can be used by any spell caster. potion or scroll; and will cause any other magic item to temporarily
When the staff is activated and a charge is expended, it allows the cease working for 1d4 rounds.

367
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Note that magic weapons and armour still work as mundane weap- magical device such as a similar staff or two charges if it was sum-
ons and armour even when their magical properties are temporarily moned by a spell.
suppressed.
The staff also counts as a +2 staff.
Staff of the Druids (dr): This staff may only be used by druids.
If a druid activates the staff and expends a charge while preparing Finally, if the staff is taken to an elemental plane other than that
their spells for the day, they will be able to prepare an extra spell of the staff’s element, it will immediately explode doing 20 points
of each level that they can cast. Additionally, this staff counts as a of lightning damage plus 1d8 damage per charge remaining to all
+3 weapon when wielded by a druid. creatures within a 60’ radius.

Staff of an Element (e): This staff may only be used by elves. The wielder of the staff gets no saving throw, but other creatures
Roll 1d100 to discover the type of staff: in the area can make a saving throw vs. spells with a –4 penalty to
take half damage.
01–21 = staff of air
22–42 = staff of earth Staff of Harming (c, Dr): This staff may only be used by clerics
43–63 = staff of fire and druids. Whenever a creature is struck by the staff, the wielder
64–84 = staff of water may expend one charge to inflict an additional 1d6+1 damage to
85–91 = staff of air and water the creature in addition to the normal damage that the staff does.
92–98 = staff of earth and fire
99–00 = staff of all elements This use of the staff does not require the normal activate magic item
action, but is done as part of the attack action.
When the wielder of the staff is on the prime plane, the staff confers
the following powers to its wielder: The wielder of the staff can also activate it as normal to use any of
the following effects as if casting the reverse of the curing spells
+4 to saving throws against attacks based on the staff’s element. (using up a variable number of charges):

Immunity to attacks by elementals of the staff’s element. 2 charges = cause blindness


2 charges = Cause Disease
One charge can be expended per day to summon an 8 hit dice 3 charges = Cause Serious Wounds
elemental of the staff’s element. 4 charges = Create Poison

One charge can be expended to cast one of the following spells as Staff of Healing (c, Dr): This staff can only be used by clerics and
if a 10th level spell caster: druids. The wielder may activate the staff to cure 1d6+1 damage
to a target. This does not use a charge, but each target can only be
air = Lightning Bolt, Cloudkill cured once per day by the staff.
earth = Web, Wall of Stone
fire = Fireball, Wall of Fire The staff can also be activated to cure other things, although this
water = Ice Storm / Wall of Ice uses charges as follows:

When the wielder of the staff is on the elemental plane correspond- 1 charge = Cure Blindness
ing to the staff’s element, the staff instead has the following powers: 1 charge = Cure Disease
2 charges = Cure Serious Wounds
Prevents environmental damage from the plane such as burning 2 charges = Neutralise Poison
or choking on dust (but does not provide air for the wielder to
breathe). Staff of Power (e): This staff can only be used by elves. Whenever a
creature is struck by the staff, the wielder may expend one charge to
Allows the wielder to fly and swim at a speed of 40’ per round. inflict an additional 2d6 damage to the creature in addition to the
normal damage that the staff does. This does not require the normal
Allows the caster to speak and understand the languages used by activate magic item action, but is done as part of the attack action.
natives of the plane.
The wielder of the staff can also activate it as normal and expend
Gives the caster a +4 bonus to armour class against natives of the a single charge to use any of the following effects as if casting the
plane. spells as a 6th level caster:

Additionally, a summoned elemental of a type not matching the ◊ Fireball


staff’s element can be dismissed back to its home plane (with no ◊ Lightning Bolt
saving throw) at the cost of one charge if it was summoned by a ◊ Ice Storm
◊ Continual Light

368
Chapter 19 - Treasure
◊ Telekinesis (up to 240lb) ◊ Passwall
◊ Web
Snake Staff (c, Dr): This staff can only be used by clerics and ◊ Conjure Elemental
druids. The staff is a +1 weapon.
The user may also use the staff as if it were a wand of paralysation.
Whenever a creature is struck by the staff, the wielder may com-
mand the staff to turn into a snake and coil around and hold the Additionally, the wielder may choose to break the staff to cause an
target. This does not require the normal activate magic item action, explosion that does 8 points of damage per charge remaining in
but is done as part of the attack action. the staff to all within 30’. The wielder of the staff gets no saving
throw, but other creatures in the area can make a saving throw vs.
The snake will hold any target that is human-sized or smaller, unless wands to take half damage.
the target can make a saving throw vs. wands to avoid the effect.
The target will be held for 1d4x10 minutes, or until the wielder Rod of Cancellation: This rod may be used by any character, but
orders the snake to release the target. may only be used once. When activated, it will permanently drain
any magical item (except an artefact) that is touched by it of all
If the snake fails to hold the target, or when the target escapes or power.
is released, the snake will attempt to return to the wielder of the
staff and return to staff form. The Game Master may require an attack roll to touch a magic
item carried or worn by another creature, normally against armour
Should it be attacked before this happens, it has an armour class class 9.
of 5, 3 hit dice (20 hit points), and moves at 20’ per round. The
snake will neither attack nor attempt to defend itself, being con- If an item with a +5 bonus is being wielded or worn by a creature,
cerned only with returning to its owner. that creature may make a saving throw vs. wands for their item to
resist the effect. If the item resists, the rod of cancellation is not
Once the snake returns to staff form, any damage it may have expended and may be used again.
taken is healed.
Rod of Dominion: This rod may be used by any character. If the
The staff neither has nor uses charges, but if the snake is killed ruler of a dominion carries it while parading around the dominion,
before it can return to staff form the staff is ruined. it will give a bonus to the dominion’s confidence rating. This rod
does not have charges, but it can only be used once per year.
Staff of Striking (s): This staff can only be used any spell caster.
Whenever a creature is struck by the staff, the wielder may expend To determine the effect of the rod, roll 1d100 each time it is paraded
one charge to inflict an additional 2d6 damage to the creature in to see what proportion of the population view it, and therefore
addition to the normal damage that the staff does. This does not what bonus it gives:
require the normal activate magic item action, but is done as part
of the attack action. 01–50 = +10
51–75 = +20
Staff of Withering (c, Dr): This staff is usable only by clerics and 76–90 = +30
druids. The wielder of the staff may activate the staff and expend 91–99 = +40
a charge to touch a target and cause the target to make a saving 00 = +50
throw vs. wands or age 10 years. This staff does not work on undead.
Rod of Health (c, Dr): This rod is only usable by clerics and dru-
Staff of Wizardry (e): This staff is only usable by elves. Whenever a ids. The rod functions as a staff of healing, except that none of the
creature is struck by the staff, the wielder may expend one charge to functions use charges. However, the rod can only heal a creature
inflict an additional 2d6 damage to the creature in addition to the once per day regardless of the type of healing bestowed.
normal damage that the staff does. This does not require the normal
activate magic item action, but is done as part of the attack action. Rod of Inertia (n): This unusually long rod is only usable by non-
spell casters. It has a blade on its end and is weighted for throwing,
The wielder of the staff can also activate it as normal and expend and can therefore be wielded in combat as if a +3 javelin.
a single charge to use any of the following effects as if casting the
spells as a 6th level caster: The wielder of the rod may give it a command at any time to stop,
and the rod will instantly become completely immobile, and can-
◊ Fireball not be moved by any means short of a Wish spell.
◊ Lightning Bolt
◊ Ice Storm When the wielder gives a second command, the rod will continue
◊ Continual Light moving on its original trajectory as if nothing had happened.
◊ Telekinesis (up to 240lb)
◊ Invisibility

369
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Commanding the rod to stop or start can be done very quickly If the dragon is ever killed, it cannot be raised and cannot be turned
and does not require an action in combat. The wielder can, for back to rod form.
example, command the rod to stop while they are falling and then
hang on to the rod. Rings
Magical rings are usually either constant in effect or are activated
Rod of Parrying: This rod may be used by any character. The rod by a use non-activatable item action.
is heavy and sceptre-like, and can be used in melee as if it were a
+5 mace. When the wielder of the rod declares a parry action, the A magical ring must be worn on a finger or thumb to operate, and
rod provides its +5 magical bonus to the wielder’s armour class. a character can only wear one magical ring per hand. If a second
This is in addition to the normal –4 penalty to the attacker’s to-hit ring is put on the same hand as an existing ring, neither ring will
roll caused by the parry action. function (with the exception of a ring of weakness).

Rod of Victory: This rod may be used by any character. When the Animal Control: This ring may be used once per turn. It acts
wielder of the rod commands an army in battle, the rod gives the as if the wearer had drunk a potion of animal control with the
army a +25 bonus to their roll for the battle, and prevents them exception that the wearer only gets a single attempt to control
from losing the battle roll by more than 100 points. creatures per use.

Any loss greater than this is treated as a 100-point loss when deter- Delusion: This ring will appear to function as a different type of
mining casualties and post-battle tactical positioning. ring if an Analyse spell is used on it. Once the ring is worn, it will
be completely non-functional, but cannot be removed without a
Rod of Weaponry (n): This rod can be used by any non-spell caster. Remove Curse being cast on it.

Upon command, this rod will extend into a +5 staff or retract back Djinn Summoning: Once per week, the wearer of this ring can
into rod form. summon a djinn, who will serve them for a day. If the djinn is
killed, the ring loses its magical power.
While in staff form, the wielder may also command the +5 staff to
split into two +2 staves, and each of those may be commanded to Ear: Three times per day this ring can be removed from its wearer’s
split into two +1 staves. finger and placed against any surface. Until the wearer recovers the
ring, they will be able to hear everything that happens around the
The staves will not split accidentally, and they can be re-joined by ring as if their ear were in the ring’s location.
simply placing them together.
Elemental Adaption: To determine the exact type of ring found,
Rod of The Wyrm: This rod may be used by any character. roll 1d100:

The rod has a carved dragon’s head on top, making it look some- 01–21 = air
what reminiscent of a hobby-horse. This head will be of a random 22–42 = earth
colour, rolled on 1d10: 43–63 = fire
64–84 = water
1–2 = black 85–91 = air and water
3–4 = blue 92–98 = earth and fire
5–6 = green 99–00 = all elements
7–8 = red
9–10 = white The wearer of the ring is protected from environmental hazards
in the elemental plane that matches the elemental alignment of
The rod will function as a +5 mace in combat. the ring, and is able to breathe in those planes despite lack of air.

When the wielder commands it, the rod will turn into a young Fire Resistance: This ring makes its wearer immune to natural
dragon of the same colour as its head. This dragon can only be hit fire, gives a +2 bonus to all saving throws against magical fire, and
by magical weapons. reduces all magical fire damage done to the wearer by one point
per die (to a minimum of one point per die).
The dragon will serve the wielder of the rod as a messenger, steed
or bodyguard to the best of its ability; and will sacrifice itself for Holiness (c, Dr): This ring can only be used by a cleric or druid.
the wielder if necessary. When worn by a cleric or druid, the wearer will be able to prepare
an extra spell of each level from one to three. The ring will not
The dragon is not healed by being returned to rod form and will allow the wearer to learn spells of a level that is too high for them
not heal or age naturally, but may be healed as normal by spells to learn without it.
and potions.
If the ring is removed, the extra spells are immediately lost.

370
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Table 19–9: Rings Life Protection: This ring will protect its wielder from 1d6 levels
D100 Ring Cost worth of Energy Drain. If overloaded (for example if it has only a
single level of protection left and the wearer is drained two levels)
01–02 Safety 2,000gp
then it will successfully protect the caster and then turn to dust. If
03–04 Truthlessnesss 2,300gp it is exactly used up without being overloaded, it will become a ring
05–07 Truthfulness 4,700gp of protection +1 once its levels of protection have been used up.
08–11 Truth 5,000gp
Memory (s): This ring can only be used by a spell caster. Once per
12–13 Animal control 5,000gp
day, the caster may activate it to recover one spell that they have
14–19 Delusion 5,000gp cast within the previous ten minutes. That spell will be available
20–23 Elemental adaption 5,000gp* for casting again as if freshly prepared.
24–29 Fire resistance 5,000gp
Plant Control: This ring may be used once per turn. It acts as if the
30 Human control 5,000gp wearer had drunk a potion of plant control with the exception that
31–35 Protection +1 5,000gp the wearer only gets a single attempt to control creatures per use.
36–38 Life protection 5,400gp
Protection: This ring gives a bonus to its wearers armour class
39–42 Quickness 7,000gp
and to all saving throws equal to its magical bonus. If a character
43–45 Remedies 7,000gp wears a ring of protection on either hand, only the larger of the
46–47 X-ray vision 8,100gp two bonuses applies.
48–50 Spell eating 9,300gp
Quickness: Once per day, the wearer of this ring can move and
51–55 Invisibility 10,000gp
attack at double speed for ten minutes. See Chapter 10 – Combat
56–57 Plant control 10,000gp for the effects of haste on combat.
58–62 Water walking 10,000gp
63–67 Weakness 10,000gp Regeneration: The wearer of this ring will recover 1 hit point per
ten minutes, and can slowly re-grow lost body parts. A limb will
68–71 Ear 15,000gp re-grow over the course of a week, whereas a finger or ear would
72–74 Seeing 16,000gp re-grow over the course of a single day.
75–77 Holiness (c, dr) 17,000gp
This ring will not stop working when the wearer is on 0 hit points,
78 Djinn summoning 17,000gp
and will not prevent the wearer from dying. It will also not heal
79–81 Protection +2 20,000gp damage from fire or acid (although will re-grow limbs lost to fire
82–85 Survival 20,000gp or acid).
86–88 Memory (s) 21,000gp
Remedies: Once per day, this ring will duplicate the effect of a Cure
89–90 Spell storing 24,000gp
Blindness, Cure Disease, Remove Curse or Neutralise Poison spell as
91–92 Spell turning 25,000gp if cast by a 25th level cleric. The spell can be cast on the wearer or
93 Regeneration 25,000gp on a target that the wearer touches.
94–95 Telekinesis 30,000gp
Safety: This ring acts like a potion of luck except that it has 1d4
96–97 Protection +3 45,000gp charges and uses up a charge each time a die is placed instead of
98 Protection +4 80,000gp rolled. Once all the charges have been used up, this ring becomes
99–100 Wishes 140,000gp non-magical.
* per element
Seeing: Once per day this ring allows the wearer to see as if they
Additionally, if worn by a cleric, the ring gives a +1 bonus to all had cast a Truesight spell which lasts 30 minutes.
rolls to turn undead, both the rolls for success and the rolls for the
number of hit dice of undead creatures turned. Spell Eating: This ring appears to Analyse spells to be a ring of spell
turning and operates as one.
Human Control: This ring may be used once per turn. It acts as if
the wearer had drunk a potion of human control with the exception However, if the wearer of the ring casts a spell themselves, the ring
that the wearer only gets a single attempt to control people per use. immediate “eats” all the remaining prepared spells that the caster
has. The ring can then no longer be removed except by the use of
Invisibility: This ring may only be used once per turn. When a Remove Curse cast by a 25th level caster.
activated it affects the wearer as if they had cast an Invisibility spell
on themselves. Once the curse has been activated, the wearer can prepare new
spells as normal, but will lose them again when they next cast one.

371
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Spell Storing: This ring will contain 1d6 different spells (deter- Water Walking: This ring allows its wearer to walk on the surface
mined randomly as if spells on a spell scroll) when found. The of any liquid without sinking.
wearer of the ring can cast these spells once each, even if not a
spell caster. Weakness: 1d6 rounds after this ring is worn, it will immediately
lower its wearer’s strength score to 3. The ring cannot be removed
The spells will always be cast as if by a caster of the minimum level until it has had a Remove Curse spell cast on it.
needed to cast them, even if the wearer of the ring is a caster of
higher level. Wishes: This ring will grant from one to four wishes (as the Wish
spell) before crumbling into dust. To determine the number of
Each spell can be recharged by having a spell caster cast it directly wishes contained in the ring, roll 1d10:
into the ring. The ring cannot “catch” spells generally cast at the
wearer; the spells must be cast directly at the ring with the purpose 1–4 = 1
of recharging it. 5–7 = 2
8–9 = 3
Spell Turning: Each day, this ring will reflect the first 2d6 spells 10 = 4
(roll each day) cast at the wearer back at their casters. This only
affects actual spells, not the spell-like powers of monsters or magic X-ray Vision: The wearer of this ring can see up to 30’ through
items. stone or up to 60’ through wood. It cannot be used to see through
metal.
Once it has absorbed as many spells as it can, the ring has no other
powers until the following day. To use the ring, the wearer must stand still and concentrate, and
can view a 10’x10’ area per use. It takes 10 minutes to scan such
Survival: This ring will contain 1d100+100 charges when found. an area, and the ring can only be used once per hour.
Each charge spent will allow the wearer to go for 24 hours without
food and drink or for 1 hour without breathing. Wondrous Items
Amulet of Scrying Protection: This item protects its wearer from
When the ring is down to its last five charges, it will turn black; being scried on via a crystal ball, and makes them immune to all
and when it runs out of charges it will crumble to dust. types of ESP.

Telekinesis: This ring can be activated to produce an effect identi- Bag of Devouring: This bag looks like a normal sack, but any
cal to the Telekinesis spell, capable of moving objects weighing up non-living item placed entirely within it disappears from view and
to 200lb. weighs nothing while in the bag. It will hold items up to 1,000lb in
weight, providing the items fit wholly within it (i.e. they are 5’x1’x1’
Truth: Three times per day, this ring can be activated to telepathi- or smaller).
cally warn its wearer whether a spoken statement that they have
just heard is true in the opinion of the speaker. Note that there is Items placed within the bag can be found by touch by anyone
a difference between the speaker being untruthful and the speaker reaching into the bag and can be withdrawn.
merely being honestly wrong about something.
However, any item left in the bag for more than two hours will
Truthfulness: This ring appears to be a ring of truth when ex- vanish completely. This will not affect living creatures that are
amined with an Analyse spell, and will work as a ring of truth. stuffed into the bag.
However, once worn it cannot be removed except by a Remove
Curse spell cast by a 26th level caster, and it compels its wearer to Bag of Holding: This bag looks like a normal sack, but any non-
always speak the truth. living item placed entirely within it disappears from view and
weighs nothing while in the bag. It will hold items up to 1,000lb in
The wearer may not knowingly lie while wearing the ring (but the weight, providing the items fit wholly within it (i.e. they are 5’x1’x1’
ring doesn’t prevent them from accidentally being wrong). or smaller).

Truthlessnesss: This ring appears to be a ring of truth when ex- Items placed within the bag can be found by touch by anyone
amined with an Analyse spell, and will work as a ring of truth. reaching into the bag and can be withdrawn.
However, once worn it cannot be removed except by a Remove
Curse spell cast by a 26th level caster, and it compels its wearer to Boat, Undersea: This boat can be operated as a fully functional
always speak lies. The wearer may not knowingly make any true skiff. However, when a command word is given, it will dive under
statement while wearing the ring (but the ring does not prevent the water while simultaneously radiating a Water Breathing effect
them from making a statement that is accidentally true if they that protects all passengers who are touching the boat. The pilot of
genuinely don’t know that it is). the boat can control its movement underwater as if on the surface.

372
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Table 19–10: Wondrous Items Table 19–10: Wondrous Items
D100 Wondrous Item Cost D100 Wondrous Item Cost
01–03 Egg of wonder 300gp 61 Stone of earth elementals 9,300gp
04–08 Ointment 300gp 62–63 Bag of devouring 10,000gp
09–11 Quill of copying (s) 2,300gp 64–65 Boots of levitation 10,000gp
12–13 Nail, finger 2,500gp 66–67 Displacer cloak 10,000gp
14–16 Slate of identification (s) 3,000gp 68–69 Gauntlets of ogre power 10,000gp
17–19 Pouch of security 4,700gp 70–72 Muzzle of training 10,000gp
20–21 Scarab of protection 4,800gp 73–74 Talisman of travel (e, m, dr) 12,000gp
22–26 Bag of holding 5,000gp 75–76 Crystal ball (e,m) 15,000gp
27–29 Boots of leaping 5,000gp 77–79 Boat, undersea 15,000gp
30–32 Chime of time 5,000gp 80–81 Broom of flying 15,000gp
33 Drums of panic 5,000gp 82 Flying carpet 15,000gp
34–35 Elven boots 5,000gp 83–84 Medallion of ESP (30’ range) 15,000gp
36–37 Helm of reading 5,000gp 85–87 Wheel of floating 15,000gp
38–40 Lamp of long burning 5,000gp 88 Mirror of life trapping 16,000gp
41–44 Rope of climbing 5,000gp 89 Efreeti bottle 16,000gp
45–47 Wheel, square 5,800gp 90 Crystal ball with clairaudience (e) 17,000gp
48 Horn of blasting 6,000gp 91 Crystal ball with ESP (e) 20,000gp
49–50 Boots of speed 7,000gp 92 Helm of telepathy 20,000gp
51–52 Helm of blindness 7,000gp 93–94 Hurricane lamp 22,000gp
53–55 Nail of pointing 7,000gp 95 Medallion of ESP (90’ range) 23,000gp
56–57 Elven cloak 7,500gp 96–97 Girdle of giant strength 25,000gp
58 Bowl of water elementals 9,300gp 98 Helm of teleportation (e) 25,000gp
59 Brazier of fire elementals 9,300gp 99–100 Amulet of scrying protection 40,000gp
60 Censer of air elementals 9,300gp The broom can also carry a passenger, but in this case its speed is
reduced to 60’ per round.
Boots of Leaping: The wearer of these boots can make leaps of up
to 10’ vertically and up to 30’ horizontally. Censer of Air Elementals: Once per day, this censer can be filled
with incense and used to cast a Conjure Elemental spell except
Boots of Levitation: The wearer of these boots may Levitate as that it will only conjure a 12 hit dice air elemental. Conjuring the
per the spell of the same name. There is no limit to the duration elemental takes 10 minutes.
of the levitation.
Chime of Time: This simple metal chime can be commanded to
Boots of Speed: When travelling overland, the wearer of these keep track of time. It will sound every hour until commanded to
boots travels at the speed of a riding horse. However, the wearer can stop, and can be clearly heard within a 60’ radius.
only move at this speed for a single day and then must rest for a day.
If the chime is in a Silence 15’ Radius spell when it is time to chime,
Bowl of Water Elementals: Once per day, this bowl can be filled it will automatically dispel the spell as it chimes.
with water and used to cast a Conjure Elemental spell except that
it will only conjure a 12 hit dice water elemental. Conjuring the The chime can also be used like a sand-timer. If commanded, it
elemental takes 10 minutes. will slowly change colour from one end to the other taking exactly
one hour to do so.
Brazier of Fire Elementals: Once per day, this brazier can be
lit and used to cast a Conjure Elemental spell except that it will Crystal Ball (e,m): A crystal ball is a scrying device that can only
only conjure a 12 hit dice fire elemental. Conjuring the elemental be used by an elf or by a magic-user. The crystal ball can be used
takes 10 minutes. three times per day to see any place or object that they desire; and
a current image of that place or object will appear and last for 10
Broom of Flying: This broom will carry its owner through the air at minutes.
a speed of 80’ per round. The owner of the broom must concentrate
to move, and the broom will hover if the owner stops concentrating.

373
Chapter 19 - Treasure
The clarity of the image will be based on the familiarity that the Elven Cloak: This cloak is just like a ring of invisibility except that
user has with the object or area. its invisibility is not perfect. When the wearer is in the presence of
creatures that might notice them, their faint outline will be seen
Crystal Ball with Clairaudience (e): This works just as a normal if a 1 is rolled on 1d6.
crystal ball, except that by concentrating the user can hear what is
going on at the far end as if through the ears of any living creature Flying Carpet: This carpet will carry one passenger at a speed
shown in the ball. Only an elf can use this item. of 100’ per round, two at a speed of 80’ per round, three at a
speed of 60’ per round, four at a speed of 40’ per round, or five at
Crystal Ball with ESP (e): This works just as a normal crystal a speed of 20’ per round.
ball, except that by concentrating the user can read the thoughts
of the main subject of the vision if it is a living creature. Only an The owner of the carpet must concentrate to make it move, and
elf can use this item. the carpet will hover in place if the owner stops concentrating.

Displacer Cloak: This item makes the wearer appear to be 5’ from Gauntlets of Ogre Power: The owner of these gauntlets has a
their actual position. strength of 18 while wearing the gauntlets, but taking them off
return’s the owner’s strength back to its normal value.
This makes all attacks against the wearer take a –2 penalty to their
to-hit rolls, and gives the wearer a +2 bonus to all saving throws vs. Girdle of Giant Strength: Anyone who wears this girdle does
spells, vs. wands, staves and rods, and vs. petrification. double damage with whatever melee attacks they make.

Drums of Panic: These are a pair of large kettle drums. When Helm of Blindness: Anyone wearing this helmet is immediately
played, they have no effect on creatures within 10’ of them, but made blind. The blindness cannot be cured until the helmet has
creatures from 10’ to 240’ from them must make a saving throw been removed, and the helmet cannot be removed without a Re-
vs. spells or flee in terror for 30 minutes. move Curse spell being cast on it.

Efreeti Bottle: This 3’ tall heavy jug contains an efreeti. The stop- Helm of Reading: This helmet allows the wearer to read any lan-
per may be opened once per day, and the efreeti will come forth guage or cipher, and allows them to identify magical scrolls. How-
and serve the opener. If the efreeti is slain, the bottle becomes ever, it does not allow the wearer to use spell scrolls if they are not
non-magical. normally able to do so.

The efreeti is reluctant to serve, and will do its best to use loopholes This helmet is rather delicate, and has a 10% chance of being broken
in the commands that it is given in order to cause harm to the each time its wearer is struck in combat.
owner of the bottle.
Helm of Telepathy: The wearer of this helmet can transmit their
Egg of Wonder: This is a painted hollow eggshell. When dropped thoughts to any creature within 60’. The target creature will under-
or throw (up to 60’) it will break and an animal will emerge and stand the thoughts of the wearer despite language differences. The
grow to full size. wearer may also use the ESP spell to read the thoughts of others.

For the next hour, the animal will obey the user of the egg to the Helm of Teleportation (e): This helm is only usable by elves. The
best of its ability; and then it will disappear. wearer of the helm may use the Teleport spell as often as they like
to teleport themselves, with the normal chances of failure.
To determine the type of animal that is summoned, roll 1d12:
The wearer may also use the helm to teleport another creature
1 = ape (rock baboon) (again, as if casting the spell). However, doing this discharges the
2 = bat (giant) helmet and it can no longer be used for any teleporting until it is
3 = bear (black) recharged by having a Teleport spell cast into it.
4 = bear (grizzly)
5 = boar Horn of Blasting: This horn can be blown once per ten minutes.
6 = cat (mountain lion) When it is blown, it creates a cone of sound 100’ long and 20’ wide
7 = cat (panther) at the end. Everyone in the area must take 2d6 damage and make
8 = ferret (giant) a saving throw vs. spells or be deafened for ten minutes. Buildings
9 = lizard (giant gecko) and ships in the area of effect take 1d8 damage.
10 = lizard (giant draco)
11 = snake (racer) Hurricane Lamp: When this lamp is opened for the first time in
12 = wolf a day, a hurricane of wind and rain emerge.

Elven Boots: These boots give their wearer a move silently ability Everyone within 30’ of the lamp is knocked to the floor for three
of 75%, like a thief. rounds, and must make a saving throw vs. spells to avoid having all

374
Chapter 19 - Treasure
loose items or items held or carried by them (including weapons, After that first instance, there is a 25% chance each time the per-
but not including clothing) is scattered throughout the area. son tries to go un-noticed that the hand will re-appear. This will
continue to happen until the victim has a Remove Curse spell cast
Once the hurricane has ended, the lamp may be used as a lamp of on them.
long burning, although the hurricane will re-set each day and must
be triggered again before the lamp can be used. Nail of Pointing: This appears to be a simple 6” iron nail. Once
per day, it can be commanded to point to a mundane (not magical
Lamp of Long Burning: This lamp must be filled with oil and lit or living) object, and for the next ten minutes the nail will point
like any other lantern, but it will burn forever without using any at the closest instance of that type of object (distance is irrelevant).
of the oil that it contains.
Ointment: This creamy white salve is normally found in small jars.
The lamp can be put out and re-lit repeatedly like any other lamp.
To use the ointment, the whole jar must be applied to someone’s
If the lamp is ever completely submerged in water while lit, it will skin. When the ointment is applied in this manner, it will have a
immediately stop working and lose its magical properties. random effect, rolled on 1d6:

Medallion of ESP: This medallion allows the wearer to use the 1 = the user gets a +2 bonus to armour
ESP spell at will, with a range as given in the item listing (either 30’ class and saving throws for the
or 90’). next ten minutes.
2 = the user is healed 2d6+2 points
However, each time it is used, there is a 1 in 6 chance that instead of damage.
of letting its wearer read minds, it will broadcast its all of its wearer’s 3 = the user must make a saving throw
thoughts out loud for the next ten minutes. vs poison or die.
4 = the user takes 2d6 points of acid
Mirror of Life Trapping: If the owner of this mirror presents it damage.
to a creature of human size or smaller and activates it, the creature 5 = the user is cured of all burn
must make a saving throw vs. spells or be sucked into the mirror, damage, whether magical or
complete with everything they are wearing and carrying. normal.
6 = the user’s skin turns bright orange
The mirror can hold up to 20 creatures, who exist in a state of for the next 1d4 months.
suspended animation while in the mirror, not needing food, drink
or air and completely unable to take any actions. Pouch of Security: If this large sack is stolen, it will shout “help!
I am being stolen!” in common repeatedly for the next hour. The
Anyone looking into the mirror can see the reflections of the faces sack’s owner can command it to be quiet before the end of the
of all those trapped inside, and can wake any of them up tem- duration.
porarily to talk with them. No special communication powers
are granted, so the viewer and victim need to share a common Quill of Copying (s): When supplied with 1,000gp worth of rare
language to talk in. inks, any spell user can command this quill to copy a spell scroll
containing one or more spells of a type that they can cast onto a
If the mirror is broken, all the creatures inside are instantly freed. blank parchment.
However, the only way to free a single creature without breaking
the mirror is to use a Wish spell. There is a 75% chance that the spells will be copied correctly, creat-
ing two identical spell scrolls, and a 25% chance that the quill will
Muzzle of Training: This muzzle will automatically reshape and burst, becoming useless and depositing its ink over both parch-
resize itself to fit any creature with a mouth. When put on a crea- ments (both ruining the original and failing to make a copy).
ture and locked with a command word, the creature is magically
prevented from biting, talking and casting spells; but it can still Rope of Climbing: On command, this 50’ rope will wriggle along
eat, drink and breathe normally. the ground like a snake, and even up walls and on ceilings. It can
fasten itself onto any solid protrusion on a surface that it is climb-
The owner of the muzzle can unlock it with a second command ing up, and will support up to 1,000lb of weight.
word, but otherwise it is locked with the equivalent of a Wizard
Lock cast by a 15th level caster. A second command will cause the rope to loosen itself and re-coil.

Nail, Finger: This appears to be a nail of pointing if checked with Scarab of Protection: This charm has 2d6 charges. Each time a
an Analyse spell. However, when someone tries to use it as such it curse is placed on the wearer, it will immediately target the wearer
will disappear. The next time that person tries to be unnoticed (by with a Remove Curse as if by a 36th level caster. Each Remove Curse
disguise, invisibility or hiding), an illusion of a large glowing hand uses up one charge.
will appear above their head pointing them out.

375
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Additionally, it will block any Finger of Death or Obliterate spell Although these wheels will keep the vehicle above water, they do
(the reverse of the Raise Dead and Raise Dead Fully spells) cast at not affect whatever animal or animals are pulling the vehicle.
the wearer; and this also uses up one charge.
Wheel, Square: This wheel is the size of a wagon or cart wheel, but
When the scarab has run out of charges, it crumbles to dust. is square rather than round.

Slate of Identification (s): This 3’ square framed sheet of slate is It cannot be used on normal terrain, but when fitted to a wagon
used to identify magic items. or cart it will allow the cart to travel over desert or mountain as if
being pulled along a road.
The slate has ten charges per day, and is used by placing it on a hori-
zontal surface and then placing a magic item on it. When activated, Armour & Shields
the slate will identify the magic item (if it has enough charges left Magic armour and shields will have a numerical bonus from +1
to do so) and chalk writing will appear on the slate indicating type to +5. This bonus applies to the wearer’s armour class when the
of magic item and what command words it has (if any). armour or shield is worn.

If asked to identify an artefact, the slate will shatter. In the case of shields, this bonus applies only towards attacks that
the shield normally gives an armour class bonus towards (based
However, the slate is incapable of identifying cursed items, even on the wearer’s proficiency level with the shield). It does not apply
those that fail to fool an Analyse spell (such as a potion of poison). to attack rolls or damage done by the shield, although the shield
will still count as a magical weapon for purposes of whether it can
If it is asked to identify a cursed item, the slate will identify it as damage certain creatures.
being a random type of similar but useful item.
Like other armour class bonuses, the bonus is subtracted from the
The number of charges needed to identify different types of item are: armour class of the wearer, not added to it.

potion = 2 charges The magical bonuses of armour and shields stack with each other
scroll = 3 charges if both are used.
ammunition = 3 charges
wand = 4 charges Some magical armour or shields also have additional powers beyond
staff = 5 charges a simple bonus to armour class. If these powers require activation
weapon = 6 charges in combat, then the wearer must take an activate magic item action.
armour or shield = 7 charges
ring or rod = 8 charges When found, a piece of magical armour or a magical shield may
wondrous item = 9 charges be cursed. The chance of the item being cursed is 10%. If an item
is cursed, this will be revealed by an Analyse spell.
Stone of Earth Elementals: Once per day, this stone can be buried
in the earth and used to cast a Conjure Elemental spell except that A cursed set of armour or cursed shield will add its bonus to the
it will only conjure a 12 hit dice earth elemental. Conjuring the wearer’s armour class rather than subtracting it – i.e. it will make
elemental takes 10 minutes. the wearer’s armour class worse. Additionally, the extra property
of cursed armour will not function.
Talisman of Travel (e, M, Dr): This talisman allows the wearer
to cast either a Conjure Elemental or Summon Elemental spell in The wearer of cursed armour or a cursed shield is compelled to
reverse. Instead of the spell summoning an elemental to the caster, always use the item in a combat situation, even though they may
the reversed spell will transport the caster to the elemental plane know that other armour would be better for them. Similarly, if the
of their choice. cursed item is taken away from them they are compelled to do their
best to retrieve the item – even being prepared to kill friends if the
While the caster continues to wear the talisman, they are protected friends are withholding it.
from environmental damage on the elemental plane, such as chok-
ing or burning, and can breathe normally. A Remove Curse spell will break the compulsion, although if the
character wears or uses the item again then the curse will return.
Wheel of Floating: When put on a cart or wagon, this wheel will al-
low the cart to be pulled on the surface of water rather than sinking. If the Remove Curse spell is cast by a caster of 26th level or higher,
it will remove the curse from the item completely, causing it to act
A single wheel of floating will hold up a vehicle of up to 1,000lb as normal magical suit or armour or shield.
in weight, with every additional wheel of floating adding 500lb
to that weight. Absorption: If the wearer of this item or shield is struck by an En-
ergy Drain, the item will absorb it. The wearer will still take normal
physical damage (if any) from the attack, but will not lose any levels.

376
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Table 19–11b: Armour or Shield Type Gaseous Form: Once per day, the wearer of this armour or shield
D100 Armour or Shield may activate it in order to turn into gaseous form for up to one
hour, including all their equipment and carried items. The wearer
01–13 Leather armour
keeps control of their body, and can move through any non-airtight
14–22 Scale mail barrier.
23–38 Chain mail
39–50 Banded mail While in gaseous form, the wearer cannot attack, but has an armour
class of –2 and can only be hit by magical weapons.
51–64 Plate mail
65–72 Suit armour Haste: Once per day, the wearer of this armour or shield may acti-
73–00 Shield vate it and it will cast a Haste spell on them that lasts for 10 minutes.

Table 19–11b: Armour and Shields Reflection: If any Light or Continual Light spell (or their reverse)
D100 Armour or Shield Cost is cast at the wearer of this armour or shield, the spell is reflected
back to the caster.
01–54 +1 3,000gp
55–56 +1 of shocking 10,000gp Additionally, the wearer of this armour or shield may use it as if
57–74 +2 12,000gp it were a mirror in order to either attempt to reflect the gaze of
75 +1 of reflection 13,000gp a creature with a gaze attack (such as a basilisk) or to fight such
a creature without meeting its gaze (in which case the normal –2
76–78 +1 of curing 15,000gp penalty for fighting while using a mirror does not apply).
79 +2 of gaseous form 19,000gp
80–81 +2 of curing 24,000gp Remove Curse: This armour or shield will never be cursed when
found. Additionally, it has three charges, and can be activated to
82–89 +3 27,000gp
expend a charge in order to cast a Remove Curse on the wearer as
90–91 +3 of absorption 29,000gp if from a 36th level caster.
92 +3 of remove curse 34,000gp
93–96 +4 48,000gp Shocking: The wearer of this armour or shield can activate it, caus-
ing it to charge with energy. The next creature to attack the wearer
97 +4 of flying 55,000gp
in melee will be hit for 6d6 lightning damage, unless it can make
98 +4 of haste 55,000gp a saving throw vs. spells to take half damage.
99 +5 75,000gp
100 +5 of ethereality 89,000gp If the creature striking the wearer is using a melee weapon rather
than striking with natural weaponry then it gets a +4 bonus to the
Each time this item absorbs an Energy Drain, it loses one point of saving throw.
magical “plus” (i.e. after absorbing one Energy Drain the item will
only have a +2 bonus; after absorbing a second it will only have The armour can be activated and de-activated as often as the wearer
a +1 bonus). desires, but can only release its charge once per day. Once the
charge has been released, the armour deactivates and cannot be
When the item has absorbed three energy drains it will crumble re-activated until the following day.
to dust.
Weapons & Ammunition
Curing: Once per day, the wearer of this armour or shield may Magic weapons and ammunition will have a numerical bonus
activate it in order to heal half of the damage that they have cur- from +1 to +5. This bonus applies both to the wearer’s to-hit roll
rently taken. when using the weapon or ammunition and to the damage done
by the weapon.
Ethereality: Once per day, the wearer of this armour or shield can
activate it in order to move from the prime plane to the ethereal The magical bonuses of missile weapons and their ammunition
plane. stack with each other if both are used.

Additionally, once per day the wearer of this armour or shield can Some magical weapons or ammunition also have additional pow-
activate it in order to move from the ethereal plane to the prime ers beyond a simple bonus to attack and damage. If these powers
plane. require activation in combat, then the wearer must take an activate
magic item action.
Flying: Once per day, the wearer of this armour or shield may
activate it, and it will cast a Fly spell on them that lasts for 2 hours. When a magical weapon or some magical ammunition is found,
roll on the relevant Table 19–12 in order to see exactly what type
of weapon or ammunition it is, and then in order to find out

377
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Table 19–12a: Missile Weapons & Ammunition Type Table 19–12c: Miscellaneous Weapon Type
D100 Type D100 Type
01–30 Arrows 01–09 Axe, battle
31–48 Bullets 10–15 Axe, hand
49–59 Quarrels 16–17 Axe, hand (returning)
60–70 Sling stones 18–20 Blackjack
71–72 Blowgun 21–22 Bolas
73–79 Bow, long 23 Bolas (returning)
80–83 Bow, short 24–28 Club
84–85 Crossbow, heavy 29–40 Dagger
86–87 Crossbow, light 41–43 Dagger (returning)
88–91 Pistol 44–45 Halberd
92–94 Smoothbore 46–55 Hammer, war
95–00 Sling 56–58 Hammer, war (returning)
59–61 Javelin
Table 19–12b: Sword Type
62 Javelin (returning)
D100 Type
63–66 Lance
01–65 Normal sword
67–78 Mace
66–84 Short sword
79–80 Net
85–92 Two-handed sword
81 Net (returning)
93–00 Bastard sword
82–84 Poleaxe
85–94 Spear
what magical bonuses or other properties it has, either roll on
Table 19–13a if it is ammunition or roll on Table 19–13b if it is 95–97 Spear (returning)
a weapon (including a missile weapon). 98–00 Whip

When found, a magical weapon (but not magical ammunition) Magical ammunition can only be used for a single shot, and is then
may be cursed. The chance of the weapon being cursed is 10%. If broken, bent or otherwise useless. However, such ammunition is
an item is cursed, this will be revealed by an Analyse spell. normally found in groups rather than as single items. Table 19–13a
shows the number of pieces of ammunition that are found together.
A cursed weapon will subtract its bonus from the wearer’s to-hit and The cost given for magical ammunition is based on the maximum
damage rolls rather than adding it – i.e. It will make the wearer’s number found, and should be reduced accordingly for fewer pieces.
to-hit and damage worse. Additionally, the extra property of a
cursed weapon will not function. Some of the thrown weapons on Table 19–12c are listed as (return-
ing). These weapons will magically return to their owner’s hand
The wielder of a cursed weapon is compelled to always use the after being thrown.
item in a combat situation, even though they may know that other
weapons would be better for them. In the case of a bolas or net, if the weapon successfully entangles an
opponent it will not return to its owner until after the opponent
Similarly, if the cursed item is taken away from them they are com- has freed themselves.
pelled to do their best to retrieve the item – even being prepared
to kill friends if the friends are withholding it. Biting: When a piece ammunition of biting hits an opponent, it
turns into a snake which bites the target. In addition to the normal
A Remove Curse spell will break the compulsion, although if the damage done by the attack, the target must also make a saving
character wears or uses the item again then the curse will return. throw vs. poison or die.

If the Remove Curse spell is cast by a caster of 26th level or higher, Disarming: When this ammunition hits a target that is wielding an
it will remove the curse from the item completely, causing it to act item in their hand, the target must make a saving throw vs. spells
as a normal magical weapon. or drop the item. If the target is holding an item in either hand,
their primary hand will be the one affected.
Some weapons have a bonus that varies depending on the type of
creature that is being attacked.

378
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Table 19–13a: Ammunition Table 19–13b Weapons
D100 Ammunition Cost D100 Weapon Cost
01–54 +1 (2d10 pieces) 2,000gp 01–54 +1 2,000gp
55 +1 of disarming (2d10 pieces) 4,000gp 55–56 +1 of light 4,300gp
56–58 Of speaking (2d10 pieces) 6,000gp 57–59 +1 of watching 7,000gp
59–60 Of seeking (2d10 pieces) 8,000gp 60–61 +1, +3 vs. undead 8,000gp
61–78 +2 (2d6 pieces) 8,000gp 62–63 +1, +3 vs. animals 8,000gp
79–80 +2 of screaming (2d6 pieces) 9,200gp 64–65 +1, +3 vs. lycanthropes 8,000gp
81 +2 of dispelling (2d6 pieces) 12,000gp 66–77 +2 8,000gp
82–89 +3 (2d4 pieces) 18,000gp 78 +1 of finding 9,000gp
90–91 +3 of sinking (2d4 pieces) 20,000gp 79 +2 of silence 10,000gp
92 +3 of biting (2d4 pieces) 20,000gp 80–81 +2 of flaming 18,000gp
93–96 +4 (1d4 pieces) 32,000gp 82–83 +2, +4 vs. undead 18,000gp
97 +4 of stunning (1d4 pieces) 33,000gp 84 +2, +4 vs. giants 18,000gp
98 +4 of teleporting (1d4 pieces) 34,000gp 85–89 +3 18,000gp
99 +5 (1 piece) 50,000gp 90 +3 of hiding 23,000gp
100 +5 of slaying (1 piece) 51,000gp 91–92 +3 of speed 25,000gp
93 +3, +5 vs. dragons 32,000gp
Dispelling: When this ammunition hits a target, it immediately
casts a Dispel Magic effect centred on the target as if cast by a 15th 94–96 +4 32,000gp
level caster. 97 +4 of flying 37,000gp
98 +4 of slowing 39,000gp
Finding: Once per day, the wielder of this weapon may activate it
99 +5 50,000gp
to cast a Locate Object spell.
100 +5 of slicing 64,000gp
Flaming: The wielder of this weapon can activate it at will and it
will burst into flames that burn without fuel until the weapon is again, but the touch of any other creature (whether intelligent or
deactivated again. not) will.

The flaming weapon has an additional +2 bonus against trolls and Light: Once per day, this weapon can be activated to cast a Light
against feathered creatures; and an additional +3 bonus against spell lasting 1 hour.
creatures made of wood or undead. If a creature comes under more
than one of these categories, these bonuses do not stack. Screaming: When this ammunition is fired, whether it hits or
misses its target, it will emit a piercing shriek causing all opponents
Flying: If a melee weapon has this power, once per day it will at- within 30’ of its path to make a saving throw vs. spells or retreat
tack by itself. The weapon must be wielded in combat for at least in fear for 1d8 rounds.
one round, then its wielder can let go of it and it will continue to
attack the same opponent for three rounds, as if its wielder were Seeking: This ammunition will not hit a living creature. However,
still wielding it. After three rounds (or when its wielder commands, it will unerringly hit whatever object (a button, a lever, a trip-wire,
whichever is sooner) the weapon will return to its wielder’s hand. etc.) it is fired at.

If a missile weapon has this power, then it never needs reloading If fired at an object held by a creature, treat the ammunition as
and never runs out of ammunition. Whenever it is fired, it will being +1 ammunition of disarming.
create its own ammunition (and red powder if it is a gun). How-
ever, the wielder may still choose to load the weapon with magical Silence: Once per day, this weapon can be activated to cast a
ammunition if they prefer. Silence 15’ Radius spell.

Hiding: Once per day, this weapon can be activated to cast an Sinking: This ammunition causes 1d10+10 structure points of
Invisibility spell on its wielder. damage to any ship or wooden structure that it hits.

Additionally, three times per day, the weapon can be activated to Slaying: Whatever is hit by this ammunition is affected as if hit
cast an Invisibility spell on itself. If the weapon turns itself invisible by a Disintegrate spell.
while being carried, the touch of its wielder will not turn it visible

379
Chapter 19 - Treasure
Slicing: This property can only be found on edged melee weapons Speed: Once per day, this weapon can be activated in order to cast
such as swords, axes or pole arms. a Haste spell that affects only its wielder.

Whenever a living creature (not a construct or undead) is hit by Stunning: Any creature hit by this ammunition must make a saving
the wielder of this weapon’s player rolling a natural 19 or 20, it throw vs. spells or be stunned for 1d6 rounds.
must make a saving throw vs. death or have its head cut off. This
will normally kill the creature, unless it is a hydra or other multi- A stunned opponent cannot attack or cast spells and can only move
headed creature. at 1/3 normal speed. Stunned opponents also have a +2 penalty to
armour class and a –2 penalty to all saving throws.
If the creature makes its saving throw, it still takes triple damage
from the attack. Teleporting: Any creature hit by this ammunition must make a
saving throw vs. spells or be teleported 1d100 miles in a random
Slowing: Once per day, after hitting a creature with this weapon, direction. The target will always land safely after the teleport.
the wielder may activate it (this doesn’t take an action) in order
to affect the creature as if hit by a Slow spell (the reverse of the Watching: Once per day, the wielder of this weapon can com-
Haste spell). The creature may make a saving throw vs. spells to mand it to watch for a particular type of creature. The weapon will
avoid the effect. continue to watch for that type of creature until commanded to
watch for a different type.
Speaking: This ammunition may be given any message of twenty
words or less, and then given a target which may be any location If any creature of the specified type comes within 60’ of the weapon,
or object (but not a creature) within ten miles. it will glow softly and vibrate to alert its wielder.

When fired, the ammunition will automatically hit the object or The wielder must name a race or type of monster, not the name of
land on the floor in the location, and then speak its message out a specific individual.
loud twice.

380
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
A
rtifacts are powerful magical items that only immortals can probably have magical plusses when used in combat. Alternately
create. Unlike normal magic items, which come in fairly it might be shaped like any other object.
standard types, artifacts are all unique.
Regardless of its form, an artifact can be detected with a Detect
Immortals create artifacts by using the Create Artifact spell. This Magic spell and identified with an Analyse spell. However, an Analyse
spell enables them to put part of their life force into an object and spell will only describe the powers of an artifact, not its handicaps
make it into an artifact level magical item. and penalties. The handicaps and penalties of the artifact must be
found out by trial and error.
While this is much more expensive for the immortal doing the creat-
ing than simply using the Create Mundane Object spell to create a Once an artifact has been identified, any character can use it un-
normal magic item, artifacts are much more powerful than normal less it is in the shape of armour or a weapon or shield that the
magic items. In fact artifacts are so powerful that they cannot be character can’t use.
safely used by mortals. Their power is simply too great for mortals
to be able to control. Each artifact has a power reserve just like an immortal, and this
power reserve is the source of power points that fuel the artifact’s
This danger doesn’t stop mortals from actually using them, of course. powers.

Finding an Artifact The wielder of the artifact can activate any of its powers by taking an
Given the rare and unique nature of artifacts, they do not appear activate magic item action; and if the artifact has enough remaining
in the standard treasure tables. Basically, if the Game Master wants power points then the power will function.
the party to find an artifact, the Game Master first needs to spend
time using the rules in this chapter designing the artifact, and then An artifact’s power reserve refreshes each morning.
decide where it will be found.
Any powers of an artifact that duplicate spell effects work as if cast
When designing it, the Game Master should have an idea of who by a 40th level mortal caster; and artifacts can affect immortals.
created it and why they did. Creating an artifact is a significant
thing to do, and not something that most immortals would do An immortal hit by a weapon shaped artifact takes normal damage
on a whim. (unless they can save vs. physical attacks) rather than minimum
damage, and an immortal hit by a spell cast from an artifact will
On the other hand; once created, artifacts hang around for a long be affected normally as if the spell had been cast by another im-
time. An artifact that might have been created and specially placed mortal (although they still get their anti-magic and their save vs.
for a mortal to find may have been found and used by that mortal. spell attacks).
And then it might have been lost, or stolen, or otherwise changed
hands many times. An artifact that has run out of power points keeps its weapon,
shield or armour bonus.
While immortals often try to keep track of artifacts that they have
made, they can’t be everywhere at once; and artifacts do sometimes Destroying an Artifact
end up being simply lost or end up sitting in a dragon’s hoard for Artifacts are incredibly hard to destroy. They are immune to most
centuries on end. damage, and will very rarely be accidentally destroyed.

Unless the immortal happens to be watching via a Detect Immortal An artifact has an armour class of –20 and a number of hit points
Power spell when an artifact gets used (and gets lucky), they may equal to its power reserve. It can only be damaged by +5 weapons,
never find it again. or spells of 5th level and higher; and makes saving throws as if
a 36th level fighter.
From the point of view of player characters; unexpectedly finding
an artifact is a mixed blessing. Notwithstanding the inherent danger Although artifacts are not intelligent, they do have a basic self-
involved in using such a powerful item, the characters can never defence mechanism. An artifact will ignore accidental damage
be sure that the find was truly accidental. and simply repair itself, but if an artifact is deliberately attacked
directly it will use whatever power points it has left to instinctively
Was the artifact genuinely lost, or was it put there specifically for use its offensive powers against its attacker and use its movement
them to find as part of some immortal’s plot? or worse – was it put powers to escape if it can.
there specifically for someone else to find as part of some immortal’s
plot, and now they’re getting in the way? A damaged artifact can repair itself at a cost of 1 power point per
hit point regained.
Using an Artifact
An artifact will normally have a basic form. That form might be When an artifact is destroyed, the power used to create it is lost
that of a weapon, shield or armour, in which case the artifact will forever. There is no way to recover it, although if the creator of the

381
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
artifact is that upset with its loss they can always simply create a Example: An artifact that is in the form of a +5 dagger will cost:
new artifact with an identical form and powers.

Creating an Artifact 100xp because a dagger is worth 3gp.


20,000xp because a dagger does 1d4
An immortal creates an artifact by casting the Create Artifact spell. damage.
This will cost them experience points based on the artifact created. 50,000xp because a dagger can be thrown.
There is no chance for error, and creating the artifact takes only a 500,000xp because it is a +5 weapon
single round (although making the decisions about exactly what it = 570,100xp in total.
should do and what it should look like can take far longer).
An artifact that is a suit of chain mail +3 will cost:
The amount of experience it costs to create an artifact depends on
both the physical form and the amount of power reserve that the 100xp because chain mail is worth
artifact will have. 40gp.
40,000xp because chain mail provides a
Physical Form base armour class of 5.
The physical form of an artifact must be created as part of the 300,000xp because it is +3 chain mail.
creation process. This form may be something relatively mundane, = 340,100xp in total.
like a simple wooden bowl; something ostentatious, like a golden
crown; or something practical like a sword. An artifact that is a +4 normal shield will cost:
The basic cost for this physical form is 1 experience point per 1 gold 100xp because a normal shield is worth
piece value of the form – with a minimum cost of 100xp; so in the 10gp.
examples above the bowl would cost the minimum of 100xp, as 10,000xp because it is a shield.
would the sword. The crown could cost anywhere from 1,000xp to 400,000xp because it is a +4 shield.
around 50,000xp depending on how big and valuable it is. = 410,100xp in total.
If the physical form is a weapon, there is an additional cost based An artifact that is a large flawless ruby (worth 15,000gp) will cost:
on its other statistics:
15,000xp because the ruby is worth
◊ +10,000xp per two points of weapon damage done by the form 15,000gp.
using basic weapon expertise. = 15,000xp in total.
◊ +30,000xp if the form a missile weapon.
◊ +50,000xp if the form is a commonly thrown weapon. reserve. The immortal creating the artifact is free to choose these
◊ +100,000xp per magical “plus” the weapon has. powers from the lists in this chapter.

Similarly, if the physical form is a shield or a suit of armour there An artifact does not have to have as many powers as it can, in fact
is an additional cost based on its other statistics: it doesn’t have to have any powers at all. However, since it doesn’t
cost the creating immortal any extra experience to put more powers
◊ +10,000xp per point of base armour class below 9 if the form in, most artifacts are created with the maximum number of powers
is armour. that their power reserve will allow.
◊ +10,000xp if the form is a shield
◊ +50,000xp per magical “plus” the armour or shield has. Similarly, Table 20–1 also shows how many handicaps and penal-
ties an artifact will have based on its power reserve. These handicaps
Power Reserve and penalties do not manifest when an immortal uses an artifact,
Additionally, the immortal must pay 10,000 experience points for only when a mortal uses it. They are a side-effect of the mortal
each point of power reserve that the artifact is intended to have. using such a powerful device, and as such they are not chosen by
the immortal creating the artifact.
An artifact must be given a power reserve of at least 50 points, and
can be given a power reserve of up to 750 points. Handicaps and penalties are instead chosen by the Game Master.
When choosing handicaps and penalties, the Game Master should
As well as determining the number of power points that the artifact try to be fair and both try to choose those that fit the “feel” or
can spend each day on powers, the amount of power reserve an “theme” of the artifact (if there is one) and also try not to choose
artifact is given also determines how many hit points the artifact those that would render the artifact useless by completely going
will have and how many powers and drawbacks it will have. against its purpose (again, if there is one).

Table 20–1 – artifact power levels shows the maximum number Artifact Powers
of powers of each type that an artifact can have based on its power There are many, many powers that an artifact can have, and these
powers are chosen by the immortal creating the artifact.

382
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–1: Artefact Power Levels
Maximum Maximum Maximum
Power Maximum Number of Handicap Number of
Attack Transform Defence
Reserve Misc. Powers Handicaps Duration Penalties
Powers Powers Powers
50–100 2 2 3 1 1 30 days 1
101–250 3 2 4 2 2 60 days 3
251–500 4 3 4 3 3 120 days 5
501–750 4 5 5 4 4 240 days 8

Each power has a cost in power points which must be spent when to make a saving throw vs. death in order to escape. The power to
the artifact is used. If the artifact does not have enough power make these hugs lasts for 10 minutes.
points left to use the power, it will not function. However, even an
artifact with no power points left will still function as its basic form, Blasting: When this artifact is activated, it produces a cone of
including any magical plusses that form may have as a weapon, sound  60’ long and  20’ wide at the end. All within the blast
shield or suit of armour. take 2d6 damage and must make a saving throw vs. spells or be
deafened for 10 minutes. Building and ships in the area take 1d8
The possible artifact powers are listed in Table 20–2 to Table 20–5. damage.

Most of these powers are simply duplications of mortal level spells, Blend with Surroundings: When activated, the wielder will blend
and are cast as if by 40th level mortal spell casters (with the excep- with their surroundings, making them completely undetectable ex-
tion that immortals’ immunity to mortal level magic does not work cept via touch or via magical means. The wielder can move around
against them). However, some of them are unique powers – and while blended and stay hidden, but if they attack or cast a spell
those powers are explained below. they will become temporarily visible for the round.

Ability Score Bonus: When activated, one or more of the wielder’s Bug Repellent: When activated, any normal or giant bug (an insect,
randomly determined ability scores become 18, with all attendant spider, scorpion, centipede, or other arthropod) will completely
bonuses, for a period of one hour. ignore the wielder unless magically controlled.

Acid Breath: When activated, the wielder breathes an acid breath If the bugs are magically controlled to attack the wielder, the wielder
weapon 30’ long and 5’ across which does damage equal to one gets a +4 bonus to any saving throws against the controlling effect
half of the wielder’s current hit points (to a maximum of 70 dam- that allow the damage done by the insects to be reduced.
age). Creatures hit may make a saving throw vs. breath weapon to
take half damage. The protection lasts for 8 hours.

Anti-magic: When activated, the wielder gains anti-magic at the Buoyancy: When activated, the artifact, wielder, and anything the
noted percentage for one hour. See Chapter 18 – Monsters for wielder holds will float on any liquid providing they do not weigh
a full description of how anti-magic works. more than the given weight.

Anti-magic Ray: When activated, the artifact projects an anti- The wielder is not given any special power to move across the
magic ray identical to that of a floating horror. The ray lasts until the surface of the liquid.
wielder stops concentrating or for 10 minutes, whichever is sooner.
The buoyancy lasts for 4 hours.
Armour Class Bonus: When activated, the wielder gains the given
bonus to their armour class for 1 hour. Burrowing: When activated, the wielder gains the ability to bur-
row through loose sand or earth at 60’ per round, or through hard
Attack Roll Bonus: When activated, the wielder gains the given packed earth at 30’ per round, or through solid rock at 10’ per
bonus to all attack rolls for 10 minutes. round for the next hour. The wielder cannot burrow through metal,
and the tunnel they leave closes after an hour.
Automatic Healing: When activated, the artifact produces a Cure-
all spell on either its wielder or a creature that the wielder touches. Calm: When activated, this artifact produces a wave of calmness
If the wielder’s hit points reach 0 and the artifact has enough power that soothes the tensions of up to 40 hit dice of creatures with-
left, it will automatically activate itself. in 120’. Creatures subjected to the calming effect must make an
immediate reaction roll, with a +4 bonus.
Bearhug: When activated, the artifact gives the user the power to
make an attack with either arm (the user must be unarmed) that Change Odours: When activated, this artifact will change the
does no damage. However, if both attacks hit, the wielder can odours and smells in an area of 30’x30’x30’.
squeeze the target for 2d6 damage per round until the target is able

383
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–2a: Attack Powers (direct Physical) Table 20–2b: Attack Powers (direct Mental)
Power Cost (pp) Power Cost (pp)
Cause Light Wounds 10 Cause Fear 10
Magic Missile 15 Sleep 15
Flaming* 20 Charm Person 20
Cause Disease 25 Confusion 25
Cause Serious Wounds 30 Charm Monster 30
Extinguishing* 30 Calm* 30
Cause Critical Wounds 35 Control Plants* 35
Bearhug* 35 Feeblemind 40
Poison 40 Charm Plant 45
Dispel Evil 40 Geas 50
Electricity* 40 Control Animals* 60
Cloudkill 45 Control Lesser Undead* 70
Ice Storm 45 Mass Charm 75
Death Spell 50 Open Mind 80
Finger of Death 50 Control Giants* 85
Poison Gas Breath* 50 Control Greater Undead* 90
Slicing* 50 Control Dragons* 95
Fireball 55 Control Humans* 100
Fire Breath* 60 *see description in this chapter
Ice Breath* 60 answer, taking into account the likely results of those actions over
Lightning Bolt 60 the next 10 minutes.
Acid Breath* 65
The artifact will not communicate anything beyond the simple
Delayed Blast Fireball 65
choice, and will use no criteria other than the one given by the
Explosive Cloud 75 wielder. It can see no further into the future.
Disintegrate 80
Power Word Kill 85 Climb Walls: When activated, the wielder gains the climb walls
ability of a thief at the given chance of success. This ability lasts
Obliterate 90
for 2 hours.
Meteor Swarm 100
*see description in this chapter Communication, Greater: When activated, the wielder of the
artifact may concentrate on any living or undead creature, regard-
Poisonous vapours in the area will have their scent masked but will less of distance.
still be effective. The odours will fade in 1d6 x 10 minutes indoors,
or 1d6 rounds outdoors. The target is made aware of the wielder’s desire to communicate,
and – if willing – may accept contact and may converse telepathi-
Change Tastes: When activated, this artifact will change the taste cally with the wielder of the artifact for 10 minutes.
of any quantity of food or liquid within 20’. Poisonous foods or
liquids will have their taste masked but will still be effective. If the target is not willing to communicate, the wielder may not try
to contact the same target until 24 hours have passed.
The change is permanent.
Communication, Lesser: As communication, greater except that
Choose Best Option: When activated, the wielder can think of the only creature that can be contacted is the immortal who made
two possibilities of action and ask the artifact which is the “best” the artifact.
of those two.
Container: This power may not be given to the same artifact as
The criteria for “best” is up to the wielder, and can be “fastest” or the life trapping or shelter powers.
“least dangerous” or “likely to gain me the most money” or any
other criteria the wielder decides on. The artifact will reveal the When activated, the artifact can store non-living items that are
not artifacts and are not being touched by any living being. Any

384
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–2c: Attack Powers (trapping) Table 20–2d: Attack Powers (bonuses)
Power Cost (pp) Power Cost (pp)
Web 10 Bless 10
Hold Animal 15 Weapon Damage Bonus +2* 15
Hold Person 20 Attack Roll Bonus +2* 20
Slow 25 Turn Undead Bonus +2* 20
Hold Monster 35 Leap 30’ (+2 Bonus)* 25
Turn Wood 45 Weapon Damage Bonus +3* 25
Flesh to Stone 50 Weapon Strength Bonus +1* 25
Power Word Stun 60 Attack Roll Bonus +3* 30
Dance 75 Spell Damage Bonus +1* 30
Power Word Blind 85 Striking 30
Life Trapping* 100 Weapon Damage Bonus +4* 35
Maze 100 Attack Roll Bonus +4* 40
Immortal Life Trapping* 500 Turn Undead Bonus +4* 40
*see description in this chapter Weapon Strength Bonus +2* 40
Weapon Damage Bonus +5* 45
combination of items up to the given weight may be stored inside
Attack Roll Bonus +5* 50
the artifact by touching the artifact to them and giving a command
word. A second word will bring an item back out of the artifact Leap 60’ (+2 Bonus)* 50
into the wielder’s hand. Spell Damage Bonus +2* 55
Weapon Strength Bonus +3* 55
This power lasts for six hours when activated, and at the end of
Attack Roll Bonus +6* 60
that time the wielder has the choice of either activating the power
again or allowing all the objects currently being stored to re-appear. Weapon Damage Double* 70
Weapon Strength Bonus +4* 70
Control Animals: When activated, this affects the wielder as if Leap 90’ (+6 Bonus)* 75
they had drunk a potion of animal control, except that the dura-
tion is 3 hours. Spell Damage Bonus +3* 80
Smash Attack* 85
Control Dragons: When activated, this affects the wielder as if Weapon Strength Bonus +5* 85
they had drunk a potion of dragon control of a type of the wielder’s
Weapon Damage Triple* 90
choosing, except that the duration is 3 hours.
Spell Damage Bonus +4* 100
Control Giants: When activated, this affects the wielder as if they *see description in this chapter
had drunk a potion of giant control of a type of the wielder’s choos-
ing, except that the duration is 3 hours. Create Magical Aura: When activated, the artifact will bestow a
magical aura on one object or one area of up to 40’x40’x40’. The
Control Greater Undead: When activated, this affects the wielder aura will cause the object or area to show up on Detect Magic spells
as if they had drunk a potion of undead control, except that the for the next 30 minutes.
duration is 3 hours.
Create Normal Objects: When activated, the artifact will create
Control Humans: When activated, this affects the wielder as if they a non-magical object with a maximum weight of 100lb and a
had drunk a potion of human control, except that the duration maximum value of 500gp. The object can be any mundane item
is 3 hours and up to 40hd of humans can be controlled, as long as that the wielder desires, and will last for 24 hours before vanishing.
no individual is over 7hd.
Defending: When activated, the wielder of this artifact can apply
Control Lesser Undead: When activated, this affects the wielder its magical bonus to either to-hit rolls and damage or armour class
as if they had drunk a potion of undead control, except that the for the next hour. The wielder can move the bonuses back and forth
duration is 3 hours and up to 40hd of undead can be controlled. each round during the statement of intent phase.

Control Plants: When activated, this affects the wielder as if they This power only can only be given to artifacts if their form is that
had drunk a potion of plant control, except that the duration is 3 of a weapon with a magical bonus.
hours.

385
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–2e: Attack Powers (other) Table 20–3a: Transform Powers (creations & Summonings)
Power Cost (pp) Power Cost (pp)
Blight 10 Produce Fire 15
Darkness 15 Create Water 20
Light 20 Summon Animals 30
Set Normal Trap 50%* 20 Create Food 35
Turn Undead (6th Level)* 20 Create Normal Animals 40
Curse 25 Create Normal Monsters 45
Disarm Attack* 25 Animate Dead 50
Continual Darkness 30 Animate Objects 50
Pick Pockets 50%* 30 Sword 70
Draining (1 Level)* 35 Create Normal Objects* 75
Set Normal Trap 70%* 40 Clone 80
Silence 15’ Radius 40 Create Magical Monsters 90
Polymorph Other 45 Create Any Monster 100
Turn Undead (12th Level)* 45 *see description in this chapter
Babble 50
Flying* 50
Unlike a dwarf, the wielder does not have to roll. The ability is
Dispel Magic 55 automatically successful.
Pick Pockets 75%* 55
Appear 60 Detect Slopes: When activated, the wielder of the artifact gains
the dwarven ability to detect gently sloping stonework for the
Set Normal Trap 90%* 65
next 6 hours.
Draining (2 Levels)* 70
Turn Undead (24th Level)* 70 Unlike a dwarf, the wielder does not have to roll. The ability is
Polymorph Any Object 75 automatically successful.
Pick Pockets 100%* 80 Disarm Attack: When activated, the wielder of this artifact gains
Anti-magic Ray* 90 the ability to make disarm attacks with whatever weapon they are
Blasting* 100 using. See Chapter 6 – Weapon Feats for details of disarm attacks.
De-power* 250
Dodge Any Missiles: When activated, the artifact grants the wield-
*see description in this chapter er the power to dodge missiles for the next 10 minutes.

De-power: This power can only be placed on an item if at least Any missiles can be dodged, including missile weapons, thrown
five immortals of 31st level or higher create the artifact together. weapons, siege missiles and even Magic Missile spells.
Similarly, it can only be activated if at least five immortals of 31st
level or higher all activate it at once. To dodge missiles, the wielder must take a use non-activatable
item action, and may then dodge up to 6 missile attacks during
When activated, the artifact can be held against an immortal and the round by making a saving throw vs. wands against each one.
that immortal will be drained of 1,000,000 experience points per
round with no saving throw allowed. If the target runs out of Dodge Directional Attacks: When activated, the artifact grants
experience points, they die. the wielder the power to dodge missiles, rays, breath attacks and
other cone-shaped attacks for the next 10 minutes.
Artifacts with the de-power ability are incredibly rare, and are
usually used to punish immortals who have severely broken the To dodge attacks, the wielder must take a use non-activatable item
social rules of immortal society by openly meddling on the prime action, and may then dodge up a single attack during the round
plane or murdering other immortals or a similarly heinous crime. by making a saving throw vs. wands against it.

Detect New Construction: When activated, the wielder of the This saving throw is in addition to any normal saving throw that
artifact gains the dwarven ability to detect newly constructed stone- the wielder might get against the attack.
work and traps and secret doors that involve moving blocks of stone
for the next 6 hours.

386
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–3b: Transform Powers (static Changes) Table 20–3c: Transform Powers (dynamic Changes)
Power Cost (pp) Power Cost (pp)
Purify Food and Water 10 Open Locks 60%* 10
Repair Normal Objects* 10 Warp Wood 15
Change Odours* 10 Growth of Animal 20
Change Tastes* 10 Knock 20
Hold Portal 20 Growth of Plants 25
Remove Traps 50%* 30 Heat Metal 25
Wizard Lock 30 Open Locks 70%* 25
Create Magical Aura* 35 Shrink Plants 25
Magic Door 40 Control Winds 30
Repair Temporary Magical Object* 40 Harden 30
Rulership* 50 Control Temperature 10’ Radius 35
Magic Lock 60 Dissolve 35
Remove Traps 75%* 60 Lower Water 40
Remove Barrier 70 Open Locks 80%* 40
Repair Permanent Magical Object* 70 Passwall 45
Victory* 75 Move Earth 50
Metal to Wood 80 Open Locks 90%* 55
Close Gate 85 Summon Weather 55
Permanence 90 Reverse Gravity 60
Remove Traps 100%* 90 Open Locks 100%* 70
Gate 95 Weather Control 80
Timestop 100 Open Locks 110%* 85
Spell Generation* 250 Earthquake 90
*see description in this chapter Open Locks 120%* 95
Wish 100
Dodge Normal Missiles: When activated, the artifact grants the *see description in this chapter
wielder the power to dodge missiles for the next 10 minutes.
ing the wielder is using a melee weapon rather than striking with
Only normal missiles or thrown weapons can be dodged. Siege natural weaponry then it gets a +4 bonus to the saving throw.
missiles and Magic Missile spells may not be dodged.
The artifact can be activated and de-activated as often as the wearer
To dodge missiles, the wielder must take a use non-activatable desires providing it still has enough power points left to release a
item action, and may then dodge up to 6 missile attacks during charge, but will only actually expend power points when it releases
the round by making a saving throw vs. wands against each one. the charge. Once the charge has been released, the artifact deac-
tivates and must be re-activated for the charge to be used again.
Draining: When activated, the artifact will drain the given number
of levels from any mortal target it touches. Extinguishing: When activated, this artifact will immediately
douse all non-magical fires in a 500’ radius and prevent further fires
Immortal targets are drained of 15 power points per level that from being lit in the area for 1 hour. It has no effect on magical fires.
would be drained from a mortal.
If the artifact is in the form of a weapon, it does double damage
Elasticity: When activated, the artifact will affect the wielder as if against fire-based creatures while this power is active.
the wielder has drunk a potion of elasticity except that the dura-
tion is 2 hours. Find Secret Doors: When activated, this will allow the wielder
to automatically find all secret doors that they encounter for the
Electricity: When activated, the wielder of the artifact becomes next hour.
charged with energy. The next creature to attack the wielder in
melee will be hit for 6d6 lightning damage, unless it can make a Find Traps: When activated, the wielder gains the find traps ability
saving throw vs. spells to take half damage. If the creature strik- of a thief at the given chance of success. This ability lasts for 2 hours.

387
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–4a: Defence Powers (cures) Table 20–4b: Defence Powers (personal Bonuses)
Power Cost (pp) Power Cost (pp)
Remove Fear 10 Prepare +1 Bonus Spell/level* 10
Cure Light Wounds 15 Armour Class Bonus –2* 20
Cure Blindness 20 Ability Score Bonus (1 Ability)* 20
Cure Disease 20 Prepare +2 Bonus Spells/level* 20
Free Person 25 Parry* 25
Cure Serious Wounds 25 Saving Throw Bonus +1* 25
Neutralise Poison 30 Hit Point Bonus +1* 30
Cure Critical Wounds 35 Prepare +3 Bonus Spells/level* 30
Free Monster 40 Dodge Normal Missiles* 35
Remove Geas 45 Size Control 3”–18’* 35
Stone to Flesh 50 Ability Score Bonus (2 Abilities)* 40
Raise Dead 60 Armour Class Bonus –4* 40
Remove Curse 70 Prepare +4 Bonus Spells/level* 40
Raise Dead Fully 85 Elasticity* 45
Restore 90 Dodge Any Missiles* 50
Regeneration* 95 Prepare +5 Bonus Spells/level* 50
Cureall 100 Saving Throw Bonus +4* 50
Automatic Healing* 100 Ability Score Bonus (3 Abilities)* 60
*see description in this chapter Armour Class Bonus –6* 60
Hit Point Bonus +2* 60
Fire Breath: When activated, the wielder breathes a fire breath
weapon 30’ long and 5’ across which does damage equal to one Prepare +6 Bonus Spells/level* 60
half of the wielder’s current hit points (to a maximum of 70 dam- Dodge Directional Attacks* 65
age). Creatures hit may make a saving throw vs. breath weapon to Polymorph Self 65
take half damage.
Prepare +7 Bonus Spells/level* 70
Flaming: This power can only be given to an artifact that is in the Saving Throw Bonus +6* 75
form of a weapon. Ability Score Bonus (4 Abilities)* 80
Armour Class Bonus –8* 80
When activated, the artifact becomes a flaming weapon for the
next hour. Prepare +8 Bonus Spells/level* 80
Inertia Control* 85
During that time, the wielder of the artifact can activate it at will Hit Point Bonus +3* 90
and it will burst into flames that burn without fuel until the artifact
Prepare +9 Bonus Spells/level* 90
is deactivated again.
Ability Score Bonus (all Abilities)* 100
The flaming artifact has an additional +2 bonus against trolls and Armour Class Bonus –10* 100
against feathered creatures; and an additional +3 bonus against Prepare +10 Bonus Spells/level* 100
creatures made of wood or undead. If a creature comes under more
than one of these categories, these bonuses do not stack. Shapechange 100
*see description in this chapter
Flying: This power can only be given to an artifact that is in the
form of a weapon. still wielding it. After three rounds (or when its wielder commands,
whichever is sooner) the artifact will return to its wielder’s hand.
When activated, the artifact becomes a flying weapon for the next
hour. Gaseous Form: When activated, the artifact will affect the wielder
as if the wielder has drunk a potion of gaseous form.
During that time, the artifact must be wielded in combat for at least
one round, then its wielder can let go of it and it will continue to Hear Noise: When activated, the wielder gains the hear noise
attack the same opponent for three rounds, as if its wielder were ability of a thief at the given chance of success. This ability lasts
for 2 hours.

388
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–4c: Defence Powers (personal Protections) Table 20–4d: Defence Powers (misdirection)
Power Cost (pp) Power Cost (pp)
Shield 10 Ventriloquism 10
Anti-magic 10%* 15 Confuse Alignment 15
Mindmask 15 Obscure 20
Reflection* 15 Mirror Image 25
Water Breathing 15 Hide in Shadows 30%* 30
Defending* 20 Massmorph 30
Invisibility 20 Hallucinatory Terrain 35
Immune to Disease* 20 Merging* 40
Invisibility 10’ Radius 25 Hide in Shadows 50%* 45
Immune to Paralysis* 30 Phantasmal Force 50
Security* 30 Hide in Shadows 70%* 60
Anti-magic 20%* 35 Projected Image 70
Immune to Poison* 40 Blend with Surroundings* 90
Immune to Aging Attacks* 50 *see description in this chapter
Anti-magic 30%* 55
the effect. Immortals may automatically avoid the effect if they
Mass Invisibility 60
are unwilling.
Survival 65
Statue 70 Only one creature can be held in the artifact at one time. If a second
Anti-magic 40%* 75 creature is trapped, this frees the first creature.
Immune to Energy Drain* 80
The creature trapped in the artifact can take no actions and does
Mind Barrier 80 not age or die. However, the victim can bring an image of their
Immune to Magical Detection* 85 face to the artifact’s surface and see and hear out of it.
Anti-magic 50%* 95
While at the surface of the artifact, the creature can also speak.
Luck* 100
Immunity 100 Immune to Aging Attacks: When activated, the artifact makes
Immune to Breath Weapons* 100 its wielder immune to aging attacks from all sources for 3 hours.
*see description in this chapter
Immune to Breath Weapons: When activated, the artifact makes
Hide in Shadows: When activated, the wielder gains the hide in its wielder immune to all breath weapons for 10 minutes.
shadows ability of a thief at the given chance of success. This abil-
ity lasts for 2 hours. Immune to Disease: When activated, the artifact makes its wielder
immune to diseases from all sources for 3 hours.
Hit Point Bonus: When activated, the artifact grants its wielder
the given bonus number of hit points per hit die for 10 minutes. Immune to Energy Drain: When activated, the artifact makes its
Any damage taken comes off the extra hit points first. wielder immune to Energy Drain attacks from all sources for 1 hour.

Ice Breath: When activated, the wielder breathes an ice breath Immune to Magical Detection: When activated, the artifact makes
weapon 30’ long and 5’ across which does damage equal to one its wielder and all the wielder’s equipment immune to any form of
half of the wielder’s current hit points (to a maximum of 70 dam- magical detection except Detect Immortal Power for 1 hour.
age). Creatures hit may make a saving throw vs. breath weapon to
take half damage. Immune to Paralysis: When activated, the artifact makes its
wielder immune to paralysis from all sources for 1 hour.
Immortal Life Trapping: This power may not be given to the same
artifact as the container or shelter powers. Immune to Poison: When activated, the artifact makes its wielder
immune to poison attacks from all sources for 3 hours.
When activated, any single creature touched will be sucked into
the artifact along with whatever items they are wearing and carry- Inertia Control: When activated, artifact can make any non-living
ing. Mortal creatures may make a saving throw vs. spells to avoid object stop. The object will be frozen in place and cannot be moved
by any means short of a Wish spell.

389
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–4e: Defence Powers (barriers) Table 20–5a: Miscellaneous Powers (aids to Normal Senses)
Power Cost (pp) Power Cost (pp)
Resist Cold 10 Detect New Construction* 10
Protection from Evil 10 Read Languages 10
Resist Fire 15 Read Magic 10
Protection from Normal Missiles 20 Timekeeping* 10
Protection From Some Creatures* 20 Detect Slopes* 15
Protection from Evil 10’ Radius 25 Speak With Animals 15
Bug Repellent* 25 Infravision 20
Wall of Ice 25 Hear Noise 50%* 25
Wall of Fire 25 Speak with Dead 25
Anti-Plant Shell 30 Speak with Plants 30
Protection from Poison 30 Tracking, Lesser* 30
Wall of Stone 35 Communication, Lesser* 30
Shelter* 35 Find Secret Doors* 50
Protection from Lightning 40 Communication, Greater* 50
Anti-Animal Shell 45 Hear Noise, 90%* 50
Wall of Iron 50 Lie Detection* 50
Protection From Most Creatures* 60 Speak with Monsters 60
Barrier 70 Tracking, Greater* 70
Anti-Magic Shell 75 Hear Noise, 140%* 75
Force Field 80 X-ray Vision* 80
Protection From All Creatures* 85 *see description in this chapter
Prismatic Wall 100
*see description in this chapter
When activated, any single creature touched will be sucked into the
The object will remain frozen in place for 4 hours or until the artifact along with whatever items they are wearing and carrying.
wielder of the artifact deactivates it. In either case, once the object Mortal creatures may make a saving throw vs. spells to avoid the
is no longer frozen it will continue moving on its last trajectory. effect. Immortals are immune to the effect even if they are willing.

Leap: When activated, the artifact allows its wielder to make great Only one creature can be held in the artifact at one time. If a second
leaps of up to the specified distance for 10 minutes. If the wielder creature is trapped, this frees the first creature.
leaps into combat while under the effect of this power, they gain
the stated bonus on their to-hit roll. The creature trapped in the artifact can take no actions and does
not age or die. However, the victim can be contacted via ESP or
Lie Detection: When activated, the artifact allows the wielder to telepathy.
concentrate on any one mortal creature within 120’.
Luck: When activated, the wielder gains supernatural luck for 10
While the wielder concentrates, they will be able to tell if the crea- minutes. The player of the wielding character may choose any one
ture knowingly lies. roll that they make on behalf of the wielding character within that
duration and simply place the dice on the result of their choice
Note that the creature saying something that is accidentally incor- rather than having to actually roll them.
rect because the creature is genuinely mistaken does not count as
a lie. Mapmaking: When activated, the artifact will reproduce an ac-
curate map of everything within a 100’ radius. Each secret door
Once activated, this power lasts for 30 minutes, and the wielder has a 1-in–6 chance of being drawn, although the presence of
may stop and re-start concentrating on the same mortal creature some secret doors may be inferred by what is drawn behind them.
or a different one during that time.
Merging: When activated, this artifact allows the wielder to merge
Life Trapping: This power may not be given to the same artifact other creatures into their own body. The wielder can merge up to
as the container or shelter powers. seven other creatures, and both the wielder and the other creatures

390
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–5b: Miscellaneous Powers (additional Senses) Table 20–5c: Miscellaneous Powers (aids to Movement)
Power Cost (pp) Power Cost (pp)
Find Traps, 50%* 10 Climb Walls, 70%* 10
Predict Weather 10 Levitate 15
Detect Magic 15 Tree Movement* 15
Detect Evil 15 Climb Walls, 80%* 20
Find Traps, 60%* 20 Plant Door 20
Know Alignment 20 Climb Walls, 90%* 25
Locate Object 20 Dimension Door 25
Clairvoyance 25 Fly 25
ESP 25 Gaseous Form* 30
Find Traps, 70%* 30 Haste 30
Wizard Eye 30 Move Silently, 50%* 35
Find Traps 35 Pass Plant 35
Detect Invisible 35 Web Movement* 35
Detect Danger 40 Climb Walls, 100%* 40
Find Traps, 80%* 40 Telekinesis 40
Choose Best Option* 45 Transport Through Plants 45
Find Traps, 90%* 50 Teleport 50
Truesight 50 Climb Walls, 110%* 55
Mapmaking* 55 Move Silently, 70%* 55
Find Traps, 100%* 60 Burrowing* 60
Treasure Finding* 60 Plane Travel* 65
Find Traps, 110%* 70 Climb Walls, 120%* 70
Lore 70 Move Silently, 90%* 75
Find the Path 80 Travel 80
*see description in this chapter Teleport any Object 85
Word of Recall 90
must be willing. Creatures simply step “into” the wielder and disap-
*see description in this chapter
pear along with their items and equipment.
Plane Travel: When activated, the wielder and all equipment car-
While merged with the wielder, the creatures do not take damage ried (but not other creatures) moves from the plane they are on to
if the wielder is hit, and they cannot take any actions other than another adjacent plane.
speaking. The merged creatures can step “out of ” the wielder at
any time. Poison Gas Breath: When activated, the wielder breathes a poison
gas breath weapon 30’ long and 5’ across which does damage equal
Move Silently: When activated, the wielder gains the move silently to one half of the wielder’s current hit points (to a maximum of 70
ability of a thief at the given chance of success. This ability lasts damage). Creatures hit may make a saving throw vs. breath weapon
for 2 hours. to take half damage.

Open Locks: When activated, the wielder gains the open locks Prepare Bonus Spells/level: When activated during the wielder’s
ability of a thief at the given chance of success. This ability lasts normal spell preparation time, the wielder can prepare a number
for 2 hours. of extra spells as indicated of each level that the wielder can cast
for the day.
Parry: When activated, the wielder gains the parry ability of a
fighter. This ability lasts for 1 hour. Wielders who are not spell casters gain no benefit from activating
this power.
Pick Pockets: When activated, the wielder gains the pick pockets
ability of a thief at the given chance of success. This ability lasts Protection from All Creatures: When activated, the wielder of
for 2 hours. the artifact cannot be touched by any mortal creature for 1 hour.

391
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
Table 20–5d: Miscellaneous Powers (encumbrance Offset) Repair Normal Objects: When activated, the artifact will repair
Power Cost (pp) one mundane (not magical) object weighing up to 100lb.
Container: 500lb* 10
All parts of the object must be present for the repair to take place.
Floating Disc 10
Buoyancy: 1,000lb* 15 Repair Permanent Magical Object: When activated, the artifact
Container: 1,000lb* 20 will repair one permanent magic object such as a magical weapon or
shield weighing up to 100lb. This power will not repair an artifact.
Container: 1,500lb* 30
Buoyancy: 2,000lb* 30 All parts of the object must be present for the repair to take place.
Container: 2,000lb* 40
Buoyancy: 4,000lb* 45 Repair Temporary Magical Object: When activated, the artifact
will repair one temporarily magic object such as a scroll or wand
Container: 2,500lb* 50 weighing up to 100lb. This power will not repair an artifact.
Container: 3,000lb* 60
Buoyancy: 8,000lb* 60 All parts of the object must be present for the repair to take place.
Container: 3,500lb* 70
Rulership: When activated and paraded through a dominion, the
Buoyancy: Any Weight* 75 artifact acts as a rod of dominion.
Container: 4,000lb* 80
Container: 5,000lb* 90 Saving Throw Bonus: When activated, the wielder gains the given
bonus to all saving throws for 1 hour.
*see description in this chapter
Creatures can still use missile attacks and spells against the wielder. Security: When activated, this artifact will temporarily enchant up
to five objects to magically shout for help when stolen as if they
Protection from Most Creatures: When activated, the wielder of are pouches of security.
the artifact cannot be touched by any mortal creature with 15 or
fewer hit dice for 1 hour. The enchantment fades after 24 hours.

Creatures can still use missile attacks and spells against the wielder. Set Normal Trap: When activated, the artifact will create a trap
with a given chance of working. The trap can be one doing up
Protection from Some Creatures: When activated, the wielder to 6d6 damage to a victim or one doing up to 3d6 damage to a
of the artifact cannot be touched by any mortal creature with 5 or victim and entangling them.
fewer hit dice for 1 hour.
The artifact can only form the trap out of existing materials. It
Creatures can still use missile attacks and spells against the wielder. cannot create a trap out of nothing.

Reflection: When cast, the wielder is protected from Light spells Shelter: This power may not be given to the same artifact as the
and gaze attacks for 1 hour. If any Light or Continual Light spell container or life trapping powers.
(or their reverse) is cast at the wielder during this time, the spell is
reflected back to the caster. When activated, the wielder will be sucked into the artifact along
with whatever items they are wearing and carrying.
Additionally, the wielder is treated as if they are holding a mirror
for the duration in order to either attempt to reflect the gaze of While in the artifact, the wielder can take no actions and does not
a creature with a gaze attack (such as a basilisk) or to fight such age or die; but they can rest and sleep. The wielder can bring an
a creature without meeting its gaze (in which case the normal –2 image of their face to the artifact’s surface and see and hear out of
penalty for fighting while using a mirror does not apply). it. While at the surface of the artifact, the wielder can also speak.

Regeneration: When activated, the wielder re-gains 3 lost hit The wielder can emerge from the artifact whenever they like, but
points per round for 10 minutes (30 rounds). no other power can force the wielder out or force a way in.

This regeneration will not help the wielder if they die, and will not After 24 hours inside the artifact, the wielder must either come out
re-grow body parts. or activate this power again (which they can do from the inside).

Remove Traps: When activated, the wielder gains the remove Size Control 3”–18’: When activated, the wielder can control
traps ability of a thief at the given chance of success. This ability their size for the next hour.
lasts for 2 hours.

392
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
The wielder can shrink to as small as 3” tall, as if having drunk a Treasure Finding: When activated, the wielder will be telepathi-
potion of diminution; or grow as tall as 18’ tall, as if having drunk cally informed of the distance and direction to the largest amount
a potion of growth. of treasure within 360’. The wielder gains no insight about the
nature of the treasure or how to get to it.
Slicing: This power can only be given to an artifact that is in the
form of an edged weapon. Tree Movement: When activated, the wielder will be able to swing
through trees like an ape or monkey at full speed (given normal
When activated, the artifact gains the properties of a weapon of encumbrance penalties) for the next 2 hours.
slicing for one hour.
Turn Undead: When activated, the wielder gains the turn undead
Smash Attack: When activated, the wielder gains the smash attack ability of a cleric of the given level. This ability lasts for 30 minutes.
ability of a fighter. This ability lasts for 1 hour.
Turn Undead Bonus: When activated, the wielder gains the given
Spell Damage Bonus: When activated while the wielder is cast- bonus on rolls to turn undead for the next 10 minutes. The bonus
ing a spell that does damage (but not a spell-like power of an item applies to both the initial attempt to turn and the roll for how many
the wielder carries), the spell cast by the wielder will do the given hit dice of undead are affected.
additional damage per die of damage that it does.
If the wielder cannot turn undead, this power is of no use to them.
The wielder of the artifact does not need to take a special action to
use this power. It is used as part of the normal cast a spell action. Victory: When activated while the wielder is in command of an
army in battle, the artifact gives the army a +25 bonus to their
Spell Generation: This power automatically activates itself at the roll for the battle, and prevents them from losing the battle roll by
start of any day when the creator of the artifact is unable to provide more than 100 points.
spells to their clerics. The artifact provides the spells instead.
Any loss greater than this is treated as a 100-point loss when deter-
This means that the immortal’s clerics will continue to gain spells mining casualties and post-battle tactical positioning.
while the immortal is no longer in the same celestial sphere as the
cleric, and theoretically it means that the clerics will continue to Weapon Damage Bonus: When activated, the wielder does the
gain spells even if the immortal dies. given amount of additional damage with any weapon they use for
the next 10 minutes. This includes unarmed attacks.
Timekeeping: When activated, the artifact starts tracking time. At
any point it can be asked how long has passed since it was activated Weapon Strength Bonus: When activated, any weapon the wielder
and it will inform the user the exact duration. uses for the next ten minutes is treated as if it had the given num-
ber of extra magical “plusses”, to a maximum of +5. This includes
The artifact can track time from up to three activations at once. unarmed attacks, and it does make a mundane weapon count as
magical for the purposes of what creatures it can affect.
Tracking, Greater: When activated, the artifact will cause a set
of tracks less than 24 hours old to glow so that they can be easily Web Movement: When activated, the wielder may move freely
followed. through webs of any kind without being stuck to them for the
next 2 hours.
The glow can be seen by the wielder of the artifact or by anyone
using a Detect Magic spell. There is a 10% chance every 240’ (in- The wielder is not given any special ability to walk up vertical sur-
doors) or half mile (outdoors) that the artifact will lose the trail. faces or walk on ceilings just because they are webbed, unless the
This chance is not affected by weather or other conditions. wielder has the ability to walk on walls or ceilings from another
source.
The glow will last until the tracks are more than 24 hours old.
X-ray Vision: When activated, the wielder can see up to  30’
Tracking, Lesser: When activated, the artifact will cause a set of through stone or up to 60’ through wood. It cannot be used to
tracks less than 24 hours old to glow so that they can be easily see through metal.
followed. The glow can be seen by the wielder of the artifact or by
anyone using a Detect Magic spell. There is a 50% chance every 240’ To use the power, the wearer must stand still and concentrate, and
(indoors) or 10% chance every half mile (outdoors) that the artifact can view a 10’x10’ area per activation. It takes 10 minutes to scan
will lose the trail. This chance is not affected by weather or other such an area, and the power can only be activated once per hour.
conditions.
Handicaps & Penalties
The glow will last until the tracks are more than 24 hours old. When used by mortals, all artifacts have handicaps and penalties.
These are not part of the design of the artifact, they are merely a
side-effect of a mortal trying to use such a powerful item.

393
Chapter 20 - Artifacts
The creator of the artifact does not choose what handicaps and Magic Disruption: The wielder of the artifact has a chance of any
penalties will be associated with an artifact. Instead they are chosen spell they cast or any magical item they activate (except the artifact
by the Game Master. itself ) failing. The chance could be anywhere from 10% to 80%.

The Game Master should try to be fair when assigning handicaps Operating Cost: The artifact may require some kind of sacrifice
and penalties to an artifact, and assign those that seem to fit its (of magical items, of gems, or even a blood sacrifice) before a new
“theme” and will not render it completely useless. wielder can use it for the first time, or start to use it again after
having misused it.
As a general rule, the stronger the theme of an artifact, the weaker
the handicaps and penalties should be; whereas artifacts that have Recharge Cost: The artifact’s power reserve will not recharge on its
no theme and are simply an item with collection of completely own. Some kind of sacrifice (magical items, gems or even a blood
unrelated powers should be given harsher handicaps and penalties. sacrifice) must be made each time it is to be recharged.

Handicaps Penalties
A handicap is a long-term adverse effect that affects the mortal Penalties are instant adverse effects that may affect the wielder of
wielder of an artifact. the artifact when they activate its powers. Unlike handicaps, they
have no long term effect on the wielder, and can be avoided simply
The Game Master should decide when the handicap comes into by avoiding activating the power or powers that trigger them.
play. This can be either:
Some penalties may be activated whenever a particular power of
◊ When the wielder claims the artifact as their own. the artifact is used, others may only have a chance of activation
◊ When the wielder first uses the artifact. each use – for example the percentage chance of activation could
◊ When the wielder first uses the artifact in a particular manner be equal to the power point cost of the power being used.
(e.g. First activates a particular power, or first uses it against a
particular type of opponent). As with handicaps, the Game Master should decide the exact nature
of penalties and when they come into play; and again it is not pos-
Once the handicap is active, it will remain active until a certain sible to list the endless effects that could be possible here, so only
time (given on Table 20–1) after the wielder has lost or given a few examples are given:
away the artifact.
Wounding: The wielder takes an amount of damage.
The Game Master should decide the exact nature of the handicap or
handicaps of the artifact, and it is not possible to list all possibilities Aging: The wielder is aged a number of years.
here. However, here are some suggestions:
Energy Drain: The wielder loses one or more levels.
Doom: The wielder of the artifact undergoes some kind of trans-
formation or extra-dimensional imprisonment (leaving the artifact Ability Score Penalty: One of the wielder’s ability scores is tem-
behind for another to claim) until the duration is up. porarily reduced to 3.

The fate that has befallen the wielder can only be discovered by a Spell Loss: The wielder loses one or more prepared spells as if they
Wish, and it is not possible to recover them early. had been cast.

Naturally, this handicap is suitable only for the most powerful Activation Error: The power that the wielder is activating either
artifacts that mortals shouldn’t be messing with or for when an fails to go off or goes off on the wrong target (possibly the user
artifact is used in a way completely against its purpose. themselves).

Transform: The wielder of the artifact is transformed (either im- Polymorph: The wielder is affected as if by a Polymorph Other spell.
mediately or as a gradual process) into another type of creature;
perhaps a race that the creator of the artifact is a patron of, or Saving Throw Penalty: The wielder takes a penalty to all saving
perhaps a race that suits the theme of the artifact particularly well. throws for a duration after activating the power.

This change cannot be dispelled, and if the wielder is polymorphed


back into their original race the change will start happening again.

Lameness: The wielder of the artifact partially loses the use of a


limb for some reason associated with the artifact. Losing the use
of an arm means that the wielder may only perform actions that
use one arm, and losing the use of a leg means that the wielder
moves at half speed.

394
Chapter 21 - Game Master Advice
A
lthough the rest of the chapters of this book contain rules either drink a potion of longevity or use a Wish spell to wish to
for most things that may arise during the course of a game, have their youth restored.
there may be some situations that are not covered.
Creating a Setting
This chapter contains guidelines, advice, and miscellaneous rules The Dark Dungeons rules are not tied to a particular setting. The
for handling those situations. exact setting of the game – and in particular the towns and coun-
tries that exist and so forth – is left for the Game Master to decide.
Character Aging
When a campaign reaches mid levels and characters start settling This may seem a daunting task, but it can be done piecemeal as a
down and ruling dominions, things get a lot less hectic for the campaign is run. For example at very low levels, all that is needed
characters. Instead of going from adventure to adventure, they is some kind of town for the adventurers to start in and a few
may now be spending whole seasons or even years ruling from adventure locations around it. It is only when the adventurers
their castles between important events happening. reach a higher level and have a need or a wish to go exploring that
the Game Master needs to know what lies beyond the mountains.
And, of course, the characters will age during that time.
However, the Dark Dungeons rules do make various assumptions
Additionally there are some magical effects that will prematurely about the setting that the Game Master must bear in mind, since
age a character, or even restore youth to a character. although the player characters might not interact with them much
at lower levels, their presence in the world deeply affects the way
Dark dungeons does not include detailed rules for aging charac- the world works and the effects of that should be visible to the
ters. There are no modifiers to ability scores for different ages or players in the background.
anything like that.
If this is not taken into account, the sudden introduction of ele-
For the most part, age is simply assumed to be something that ments such as skysailing or immortals into the campaign because
is role-played rather than something that has game mechanics the adventurers are now “ready for them” will be jarring, as such
attached to it. things should have been around all the time.

However, there is a limit to this. People do not live forever. In particular, the following key parts of the assumed setting may
have a large influence on the feel of the campaign:
While characters are unlikely to die of old age over the course of a
normal campaign, magical aging attacks can bring people perilously ◊ Guns exist using red powder to fire.
close after only a couple of hits. ◊ Ships equipped with sails of skysailing can fly at high speed,
connecting major cities around the world in a trade network.
Whenever a character is magically aged (or whenever a character ◊ Immortals play an active, yet subtle, part in the world’s politics
becomes a year older naturally), make an aging roll based on the and events.
character’s race: ◊ There is likely to be more than one inhabited planet in the celes-
tial sphere, and ships can fly between them.
clockwork = 120+2d20 ◊ There are an effectively infinite number of celestial spheres out
elf = 750+2d100 there to explore, each containing its own worlds.
dwarf = 375+1d100 ◊ Travellers, settlers or invaders of unusual or never-before-seen
halfling = 190+2d20 races can come from other worlds.
human = 95+2d12
lupine = 70+2d12 All these parts of the assumed setting have been deliberately de-
signed to be modular, so that the Game Master can choose not to
If the result of this roll is less than the character’s new age, the make them part of their specific setting.
character dies of old age. These age rolls are quite high, because
they are designed for healthy and heroic adventurers. The average For example, if the Game Master doesn’t want travel through the
peasant may well die far earlier than the ages listed here. luminiferous aether to be part of the game, they can simply say that
only one celestial sphere exists and that there is no way to leave it.
When a character dies of old age, they may still be raised by a Raise The celestial sphere and its associated inner and outer planes are
Dead spell – but will only last for 1d10 days before dying once more. effectively the whole multi-verse.

The only way to keep an old character alive for longer is by reducing Similarly, the Game Master could go a step further and simply
their age below the dangerous level. If the character was magically say that travel through the void is impossible – effectively limiting
aged, this can be done with a Restore spell. If the character was the campaign world to the single planet; or even say that sails of
not magically aged – their age is entirely natural – then they must skysailing don’t exist in the world, limiting large scale movement

395
Chapter 21 - Game Master Advice
and communication around the world and effectively reducing The mortal must then spend one week plus one day per 1,000gp
the campaign setting to a single continent or part of a continent. value of the item working (8 hours per day) in their laboratory to
create the item.
Either immortals or red powder can be dropped from the game
very easily if the Game Master doesn’t like their effect on the tone Once the mortal spell caster has followed all those requirements,
of the campaign. In the case of immortals, this would simply mean the percentage chance of successfully making the magical item is
ruling that clerics get their power straight from whatever gods exist, determined by adding together the caster’s level and either the
or that they get their power from the strength of their faith. caster’s intelligence or wisdom score (whichever is higher), doubling
the result, and subtracting one for each 1,000gp (rounded down) of
However, in any of these cases, the decision to drop the item from the item’s value – the full value of the item, not the cost in materials.
the setting should be taken (and should be discussed with the play-
ers in order to manage their expectations of the campaign) before If the caster is trying to make an item with both “plusses” and a
the campaign starts. power, or is trying to make an item with multiple powers, then
each should be rolled separately, and all must succeed for the item
Although these elements of the setting may see little use in a low to be made.
level game (low level characters are unlikely to travel off the planet,
for example) their presence – or lack of it – will shape the social and If any creation roll fails, the item will be ruined and all time and
political structures of the world to an extent, and should therefore materials (including the rare ingredient) will have been wasted.
be consistent throughout the campaign.

Crafting Magic Items Example: Elfstar wishes to make a potion of healing. This item will
When an immortal wants to create a magic item, they simply use cost only 50gp in ingredients and take a week to make.
the create mundane item spell and the desired item appears – either
temporarily or permanently depending on whether they spent The Game Master decides that for such a low level item, the rare
experience or just power points. However, mortals who want to ingredient is not going to be difficult to find, so specifies that Elf-
make magic items don’t have it so easy. When mortals try to create star needs to find a rare herb that is known to grow in a nearby
magic items, the process is difficult and time consuming, and isn’t enchanted forest.
guaranteed to work.
Elfstar gathers the herb and starts to make the potion. Since Elfstar
If a mortal wishes to create a magic item, you should apply the is currently 11th level and has a wisdom of 17, her chance of success
following rules: is (11+17)x2 = 54%

◊ The mortal must be a spell caster able to cast each spell that the Elfstar’s player rolls 1d100 and gets a 19. At the end of the week,
item will have as a power. Elfstar has successfully made a potion of healing.

◊ The item must be a standard item from the lists in Chapter 19 - Aloysius wishes to make a +3 sword of speed. The value of such
Treasure, which represent the known types of magically stable an item is 25,000gp, so it will take 12,500gp in materials to
item. Additionally, all normal restrictions on the item will ap- make plus a rare ingredient.
ply – it is not possible to create a wand of fireballs that is in the
shape of a sword or is usable by fighters, for example. Since this is a fairly powerful item, the Game Master decides
that it needs a fairly difficult to find rare ingredient – the tail
◊ The mortal must own a magical laboratory in which to work. feather of a cockatrice.
Note that – like spell books – magical laboratories are personal;
a spell caster can only use their own laboratory that they had Aloysius manages to find a suitable tail feather, and spends 32 days
built to their own specifications, and cannot simply “rent” the in his workshop making the sword.
laboratory of another.
At the end of that period, he must make a roll. Since he is 23rd
◊ The mortal must gather materials costing half the value of the level, and has an intelligence of 16, his chance of success is (23+16)
item (as defined above). These materials are used up regardless x2 - 25 = 53%
of whether creating the item is successful or not.
Aloysius’s player rolls 1d100 and gets an 80. He has failed to make
◊ The mortal must also quest for and use one rare ingredient (de- the sword properly and his 12,500gp worth of materials (and his 32
termined by the Game Master) that must be personally gathered days) have been wasted.
and used while fresh – it is not possible to simply buy a rare
ingredient or to gather them in bulk in advance. The difficulty
and danger of the quest for the rare ingredient should depend
on the power of the item that is being made.

396
Chapter 21 - Game Master Advice
Alignment
Constructs This edition of Dark Dungeons has no alignment system. If you
Many of the creatures in chapter 18 have the “construct” keyword. are using things designed for the older Dark Dungeons or the
These creatures are artificial beings created and animated by magic. game that it emulates, simply ignore any mentions of alignment.

It is suggested that these creatures are treated as if they were magic


items for purposes of creation by both immortals and mortal spell Developer Commentary
casters. Alignment is quite possibly the most misinterpreted and least well
implemented rule in the entire roleplaying hobby. I’ve ignored it in
The base value of a construct should be  2,000gp per hit die, my games since the ‘80s, so removing it from this edition (i actually
plus 5,000gp per asterisk that the creature has on its hit dice in removed it for Darker Dungeons) was an easy decision to make.
its monster entry.

When a mortal wishes to make a construct, it should be just like Classes


making a magic item; they need to use the value in materials, find In the original edition of Dark Dungeons, and the game it emulates,
a special rare ingredient, and spend a week plus a day per 1,000gp the magic-user class is physically weak but needs less experience
of value making it. than the elf class – which can use magic and fight. Dark dungeons
reverses this, making the magic-user class the one that can fight
Example: Aloysius wishes to make a manikin construct. A manikin (but needs more experience) and the elf class the one that is more
construct has a hit dice value of 6**. delicate but needs less experience.

The cost of making the manikin construct is therefore 6x2,000gp To convert an older magic-user or elf character to Dark Dungeons,
plus 2x5,000gp – a total of 22,000gp. you will need to decide whether it is more important to keep their
race intact – in which case you should re-calculate their level and
The construct will take 29 days to make, and the chance of success abilities based on their existing experience total and the new class
will be (23+16)x2 - 22 = 56%. description; or to keep their “style” intact – in which case you
should switch their class to the other (with old magic-users becom-
ing elves, and old elves becoming magic-users).
Once a construct is made, it will obey the commands of its creator,
who becomes its first owner. There is no mountebank class in the original edition of Dark Dun-
geons or its source material. Thief characters should be given the
Ownership of a construct may be transferred to someone else at option of becoming mountebanks of a similar level when converted
any time by the current owner, although once a construct becomes to this edition of Dark Dungeons.
ownerless (because its old owner died without passing on owner-
ship) nothing short of a Wish can take ownership of it again. The original Dark Dungeons and its source material have a class
called a mystic, which uses martial arts to get unarmed attacks of
Usually, constructs are unintelligent, and will therefore continue increasing power and number.
to operate under their current instructions indefinitely if ownerless.
However, occasionally the inability to carry out its instructions This class is mechanically identical to the lupine class, although the
combined with the lack of an owner to give it new instructions will lupine class gets its unarmed combat prowess from its increasingly
cause a construct to break its magical programming and go rogue. bestial form rather than from skill at martial arts.

Most rogue constructs simply go berserk and attack any creature If you are happy that a martial artist fits in your Dark Dungeons
they encounter. Rarely, however, one will develop a free will and campaign then simply leave the character as a mystic and use the
intelligence of its own and may even develop a personality. lupine tables and abilities while continuing to refer to them as
being martial arts.
Conversion
There are a number of differences between this edition of Dark Alternately, a mystic character can simply be changed to a lupine
Dungeons and the original edition. character of the same level and experience.

If you are simply playing a Dark Dungeons campaign using this In the original Dark Dungeons and the game it emulates, char-
book, then this does not really matter; but if you are converting acters cannot start as first level druids. To become a druid, you
material from the older edition of Dark Dungeons or its sources, must first reach 9th level as a cleric and then change to the druid
then this section tells you what has changed. class. Dark dungeons now allows druids from first level, so clerics
of less than 9th level who were intending to become druids when
This section tells you how to convert older Dark Dungeons material they could should simply be changed to druids with the same level
and characters to the new Dark Dungeons. Obviously, to go the and experience.
other way you need to reverse the changes listed here.

397
Chapter 21 - Game Master Advice
Additionally, druids in Dark Dungeons and the game it emulates When converting older characters to the new Dark Dungeons, the
do not have the animal control ability. This should be given to them. Game Master should agree whether all characters will have their hit
point totals replaced by the standard ones for this Dark Dungeons
There is no clockwork race in the older Dark Dungeons or the or whether all characters will keep their existing totals.
game that it emulates, and no conversion is necessary. However if
you are converting back to one of those games then you need to Saving Throws
decide whether to keep clockworks or convert the characters to a In the old Dark Dungeons and the game that it emulates, saving
different class. The dwarf class is the closest match. throws are presented as a number from 1 to 20, and to successfully
make the saving throw the player or Game Master rolls a d20 and
Finally, the fighter class in the older Dark Dungeons allows char- needs to roll equal to or higher than the listed number.
acters to take vows of chivalry and gain minor clerical powers once
they reach 9th level. In this newer Dark Dungeons it is also possible In the new Dark Dungeons, this special mechanic is replaced by
for them to become rangers and gain minor druidic powers instead. a standard check.
Players should be given the option to switch from being a chevalier
to a ranger if they wish to. To convert an older character or monster’s saving throws to the new
Dark Dungeons equivalent, simply look up the relevant bonus from
Spell Types & Domains the character’s class and level table or from the monster’s description.
In the original Dark Dungeons, and the game it emulates, there
are no spell types and no domains. Consequently, immortals (and Thief Skills & Class Abilities
their clerics) do not specialise in certain domains and magic-users In the old Dark Dungeons and the game it emulates, thief skills
and elves do not specialise in certain types of spell. were measured as a percentage, and were rolled in a special way
(roll 1d100 and get less than or equal to the score) and some
To convert an older immortal, simply choose from one to three other class abilities such as the cleric’s turn undead or the dwarf ’s
favoured domains based on the immortal’s personality. Cleric char- stonelore were rolled in other ways (such as having a 1 in 6 chance
acters will then inherit their patron immortals’ favoured domains. of success, rolled on a d6).

Magic-user characters and elf characters should be given the choice In this edition of Dark Dungeons, all these abilities and skills are
of whether to specialise in a particular spell type or remain unspe- made using standard checks. To convert a character, simply look up
cialised. the relevant check bonus from the character’s class and level table.

Ability Scores Ability Checks and Skills


Characters in the older Dark Dungeons and the game it emulates As with the other systems mentioned above, ability checks and
rolled their ability scores randomly; which can result in a wide skills in the older Dark Dungeons and the game it emulates were
disparity between characters and can result in players being unable made using special mechanics. In this case, the player needed to
to play the character they wanted because the rolls don’t fit what roll a d20 and get less than or equal to their relevant ability score
they have in their head. plus any skill points spent.

In the new Dark Dungeons, all characters use the same array of In this new edition of Dark Dungeons, these checks are made via
ability scores and may choose the order in which they place them. the standard check mechanic, using the character’s ability score
plus any skill points spent as the check bonus.
When converting older characters to the new Dark Dungeons, the
Game Master should agree whether all characters will have their Although the checks are now made with a different mechanic, there
scores replaced by the standard array or whether all characters will are no changes that need to be made to a character’s scores and
keep their existing scores. skills for this to happen.

Similarly, in order to encourage players to choose a class that was Shields


appropriate for their rolled scores, the old Dark Dungeons and In the first edition of Dark Dungeons and the game it emulates,
the game it emulates gave bonus experience to characters who had using a shield gives a straight +1 bonus to a character’s armour class
high scores in the abilities most suited to their class. The new Dark against all attackers. However, it is not possible for a character to get
Dungeons no longer has these, and any experience bonus that a better at using a shield, nor is it possible for a character to deflect
character has should simply be dropped. blows with one or to bash opponents with one.

Hit Points This new Dark Dungeons treats shields as just another weapon
In the original Dark Dungeons and the game that it emulates, type – albeit one that happens to be more defensive than offen-
characters roll randomly each level from first to ninth to see how sive. There are now three types of shield – buckler, normal and
many hit points they gain. The new Dark Dungeons gives fixed tower – and characters spend weapon feats to train with these just
hit point totals instead. as with other weapons.

398
Chapter 21 - Game Master Advice
To convert older characters to the new Dark Dungeons, just give The way in which deflect abilities on weapons work has been clari-
each character the basic proficiency level with a shield type of their fied. In the older Dark Dungeons it misleadingly implied that if
choice that their class allows them to use. a weapon had separate tables for armed and unarmed foes (e.g. A
normal sword) and both those tables included the deflect ability,
Encumbrance then the character got to make two sets of deflect attempts each
The older Dark Dungeons and the game it emulates required players round. They should only get one, and this has been re-worded in
to keep track of the weight of every item that their characters were this edition to make this clear.
carrying, which was measured in “coins”, and based the movement
rates of characters on how much this totalled. Similarly, the way in which deflect abilities of a primary weapon
and an off-hand weapon combine has been clarified.
The new Dark Dungeons simplifies this by just giving each armour
type a base movement rate. In the original edition, mortals who are making magic items are
assumed to have a laboratory in which to work, but this was never
To convert a character to the new Dark Dungeons, simply replace made explicit. This is now explicitly listed as a requirement, and
their old movement rate based on what they are carrying with the the cost of building such a laboratory has been added to the price
new one for their armour type. list for buildings.

General Rule Clean-ups This edition of Dark Dungeons also clarifies that the listed magic
In a few other places, the text of various rules has changed between items are the “known recipes” for magic item creation. Anyone
the old Dark Dungeons and new Dark Dungeons. These are not creating a magic item must use one of those recipes, and the item
meant to be changes between the different games, but are clarifica- will have all the limitations of the standard item.
tions to the author’s intent for both games which in some places
was badly communicated in the original Dark Dungeons:

Developer Commentary
Dark dungeons has always held a special place in my heart. When I matically over time, I can’t deny that my first game is my most well
first decided to make it – because my copy of the original game that received. So it’s been good to be able to revisit what is now considered
it emulates was old and decrepit and at the time it was very hard to be something of an old classic (ironic, really, since it was emulating
to find replacement copies at a reasonable price (these days you can something far older and far more classic in turn) and bring it up to
get them in electronic format of through print-on-demand, but this date by smoothing out some of the rough edges.
wasn’t possible ten years ago) – i had no idea that it would be such
a large project or that it would lead on to a whole series of games. This ten years has also been a personal journey for me. When I wrote
Dark Dungeons I had in mind that it would be a good game for
In the decade since I finished the first edition of Dark Dungeons i’ve introducing my children (and the children of the other players in my
written many more games; which have mostly also been based on group) to roleplaying. Dark dungeons was the first role playing game
older out-of-print games to a greater or lesser extent. they ever played, joining their parents at the table.

Some of these games have sunk into obscurity as niche products that And now, a decade later, those children are finishing school and going
no-one was interested in, whereas others have proven to be more off to college and university; and are taking the roleplaying hobby
popular and I often see them mentioned or recommended online. with them and introducing it to their friends and producing a new
generation of gamers.
None of these later games have ever come close to Dark Dungeons,
though, in terms of popularity; and although I like to think that If Dark Dungeons has achieved nothing else other than that over the
my skills – both as a writer and as a designer – have improved dra- last ten years, then the work I have put into it has still been worth it.

399
Part 5

Additional
Material
Index
Barding......................................... 150, 151, 152 Charm Person (Spell)............................49, 102
A Baron..............................................................203 Charm Plant (Spell).....................................103
Barque............................................................152 Check.........................................................15, 16
Ability Check Modifiers.................................60 Barred Door..................................................165 Chevalier...................................................40, 96
Ability Checks.................................................59 Barrier (Spell)............................................... 101 Chivalric Vows................................................40
Ability Score..............................................16, 23 Battering Ram...............................................159 Clairvoyance (Spell).....................................103
AC Bonus.........................................................89 Battle Rating..................................................216 Cleric................................................................24
Actions...........................................................172 Battles.............................................................216 Cleric Spells.....................................................94
Activate Magic Item......................................172 Battle Tactics.................................................218 Climb Walls.........................................46, 51, 56
Adding New Skills.......................................... 61 Battle Turns...................................................216 Cloak..............................................................146
Aging..............................................................395 Becalmed.......................................................193 Clockwork....................................................... 27
Airborne Movement.....................................194 Belfry..............................................................160 Clone (Spell).................................................103
Alertness.......................................................... 47 Belt.................................................................145 Close Gate (Spell).........................................115
Ammunition............................................67, 377 Bestow (Spell)............................................... 247 Clothes...........................................................146
Analyse (Spell)..............................................100 Bind (Aura Attack).......................................246 Clothform (Spell).........................................104
Animal Control (Power)..............................234 Blackjack............................................68, 70, 147 Cloudkill (Spell)...........................................104
Animate Dead (Spell)...................................100 Bless (Spell)...................................................102 Club................................................... 68, 72, 148
Animate Objects (Spell)............................... 101 Blight (Spell).................................................102 coins...............................................................145
Anti-Animal Shell (Spell)............................ 101 Bluff (Skill)...................................................... 61 Combat.......................................................... 171
Anti-Magic............................................ 244, 260 Boarding Actions..........................................194 Commune (Spell)...................................30, 104
Anti-Magic Shell (Spell)............................... 101 Bolas...................................................68, 70, 147 Conceal Magical Nature (Spell).................. 247
Anti-Plant Shell (Spell)................................ 101 Bolts...............................................................145 Concentrate...................................................174
Apotheriosis....................................................49 Boots......................................................145, 146 Confidence Check........................................ 211
Appear (Spell)................................................ 121 Bore................................................................160 Confidence Level.......................................... 211
Arcane Lore (Skill).......................................... 61 Bow, Long......................................... 68, 71, 148 Conflicting Spells.........................................100
Archduke........................................................204 Bow, Short........................................ 68, 71, 148 Confuse Alignment (Spell).........................118
Armies............................................................215 Breath Evasion....................................39, 44, 47 Confusion (Spell).........................................105
Armour..................................................149, 376 Building a Stronghold..................................205 Conjure Elemental (Spell)...........................105
Armour Class.................................................. 17 Buildings........................................................154 Conjurers.........................................................98
Armour Class Modifiers.............................. 177 Bullets............................................................146 Constitution.................................................... 17
Armoured........................................................29 Constructs..................................................... 397
Army Rank....................................................215 C Contact Outer Plane (Spell)........................105
Arrows............................................................145 Contingency (Spell).....................................106
Artifact Handicaps........................................393 Call Lightning (Spell)...................................102 Continual Darkness (Spell)................ 106, 164
Artifact Penalties...........................................393 Call Other (Power).......................................234 Continual Light (Spell)........................106, 163
Artifact Powers..............................................382 Cannon..........................................................160 Control Animals.............................................32
Artifacts.......................................................... 381 Canoe.............................................................152 Control Temperature 10’ Radius (Spell)....106
Artificial Body.................................................29 Capability Score............................................215 Control Undead (Power).............................234
Astronomical Bodies....................................224 Cart.................................................................150 Control Winds (Spell)..................................106
Attack.......................................................17, 173 Casting Spells................................................100 Cooking (Skill)............................................... 61
Attack Bonus................................................... 17 Castle Maintenance......................................209 Count.............................................................203
Attack Modifiers...........................................176 Castles............................................................ 197 Cover..............................................................176
Attack Rolls....................................................175 Cast Mortal Magic (Spell)........................... 247 Crafting Magic Items...................................396
Aura................................................................245 Cast Spell.......................................................174 Craft (Skill)......................................................62
Aura Combat.........................................239, 245 Catapult.........................................................160 Create Air (Spell).......................................... 107
Aura Flares.....................................................245 Cause Critical Wounds (Spell)...................109 Create Any Monster (Spell)........................ 107
Avatars....................................................231, 241 Cause Disease (Spell)...................................109 Create Artifact (Spell)..................................248
Axe, Battle..........................................68, 69, 147 Cause Fear (Spell).........................................130 Create Food (Spell)...................................... 107
Axe, Hand..........................................68, 69, 147 Cause Light Wounds (Spell).......................109 Create Magical Monsters (Spell)................ 107
Cause Serious Wounds (Spell)....................109 Create Manifest-Form Vessel (Spell).........248
B Celestial Sphere................................... 221, 224 Create Mortal-form Vessel (Spell).............248
Cestus................................................ 68, 72, 148 Create Mundane Object (Spell)..................248
Babble (Spell)................................................132 Chain Mail.....................................................149 Create Normal Animals (Spell)..................108
Backpack........................................................145 Character Class...............................................23 Create Normal Monsters (Spell).................108
Balance (Skill)................................................. 61 Charge......................................................89, 174 Create Poison (Spell)....................................123
Ballista...........................................................159 Charisma......................................................... 17 Create Species (Spell)...................................248
Banded Mail..................................................149 Charm Monster (Spell)................................102 Create Water (Spell).....................................108

403
Index
Creeping Doom (Spell)................................108 Duke...............................................................203 Floating Disc (Spell).....................................114
Crossbow, Heavy............................. 68, 73, 148 Dungeons......................................................154 Fly (Spell)......................................................114
Crossbow, Light............................... 68, 73, 148 Dwarf...............................................................34 Foraging.........................................................192
Crown Prince................................................204 Dying.....................................................179, 183 Force Field (Spell)........................................114
Cureall (Spell).........................................49, 109 Forms............................................................. 241
Cure Blindness (Spell).................................109 E Foul Air..........................................................223
Cure Critical Wounds (Spell).....................109 Free Monster (Spell).....................................116
Cure Disease (Spell).....................................109 Earthquake (Spell)........................................112 Free Person (Spell).......................................116
Cure Light Wounds (Spell).........................109 Economy Check............................................ 207 Fresh Air........................................................223
Cure Serious Wounds (Spell)......................109 Ectoplasm......................................................225
Elemental Planes..........................................226 G
D Elf.....................................................................36
Elfsight.............................................................39 Gaining Experience......................................184
Dagger............................................... 68, 74, 148 Elf Spells.......................................................... 97 Gaining Levels..............................................184
Damage..........................................................178 Embodied Form Powers..............................234 Gallery Shed..................................................160
Damage to Ships...........................................194 Emperor.........................................................204 Galley.............................................................152
Dance (Spell).................................................110 Enchanters.......................................................98 Gambling (Skill).............................................63
Darkness (Spell)....................................119, 163 Encounter Balance.......................................198 Game Master..................................................... 9
darkvision......................................................163 Encounters............................................167, 197 Gaseous Body...............................................224
daylight..........................................................163 Encumbrance................................................145 Gate (Spell)....................................................114
Dead Air........................................................223 Energy Drain.........................................184, 261 Geas (Spell)...................................................115
Death......................................................179, 183 Energy Drain (Spell).................................... 131 Gems.............................................................. 357
Death Spell (Spell)........................................110 Engineering (Skill).........................................63 Geography (Skill)...........................................64
Deflect..............................................................89 Enhanced Reflexes (Power).........................234 Getting Lost...........................................190, 193
Deflect Penalty................................................89 Entangle...........................................................89 Ghoul Immunity.............................................39
Delay................................................................89 Entangle (Spell)............................................112 Grant Immortality (Spell)...........................249
Delayed Blast Fireball (Spell)......................110 Entertaining Visitors....................................209 Grant Power (Spell)......................................249
Destroying an Artifact................................. 381 Environmental Damage...............................166 Grappling Hook............................................146
Detect Danger (Spell)..................................110 Escape Artist (Skill).......................................63 Gravity...........................................................222
Detect Evil (Spell)...................................40, 111 ESP (Spell).....................................................112 Greater Avatar...................................... 241, 242
Detect Immortal Power (Spell)...................249 Ethereal Plane...............................................225 Groan (Power)..............................................234
Detect Invisible (Spell)................................. 111 Etiquette (Skill)...............................................63 Growth of Animal (Spell)............................115
Detection Suite (Power)..............................234 Experience...................................... 18, 184, 210 Growth of Plants (Spell)..............................115
Detect Magic (Spell)..................................... 111 Explosive Cloud (Spell)...............................112
Developer Commentary................................10 Extra Attacks (Power)..................................234 H
Dexterity..........................................................16
Dice..................................................................15 F Halberd............................................. 68, 75, 148
Dimension Door (Spell).............................. 111 Halfling............................................................ 41
Diplomacy (Skill)...........................................62 Faerie Fire (Spell).........................................113 Hallucinatory Terrain (Spell)......................115
Disarm.............................................................89 Falling............................................................166 Hammer.........................................................146
Disguise (Skill)................................................62 Fatigue............................................................190 Hammer, Throwing......................... 68, 75, 148
Disintegrate (Spell)....................................... 111 Favoured Domains.......................................236 Hammer, War.................................. 68, 76, 148
Dispel.............................................................246 Feeblemind (Spell).......................................113 Harden (Spell)...............................................112
Dispel (Aura Attack)....................................246 Festivals.........................................................209 Haste.............................................................. 177
Dispel Evil (Spell)......................................... 111 Fiefs................................................................206 Hasted............................................................ 177
Dispel Magic (Spell)..................................... 111 Fighter..............................................................39 Haste (Spell)..................................................115
Dissolve (Spell).............................................112 Fighter Options (Power).............................234 Hat..................................................................146
Domains..........................................................96 Fighting Withdrawal....................................174 Healing...........................................................183
Dominion Events..........................................213 Find the Path (Spell)....................................113 Hear Noise.......................................................56
Doors.............................................................165 Find Traps.................................................46, 54 Hear Prayers (Spell).....................................249
Double Damage..............................................89 Find Traps (Spell).........................................113 Heat Metal (Spell)........................................116
Double-hasted............................................... 177 Finger of Death (Spell)................................128 Height Decrease (Power).............................235
Double-slowed.............................................. 177 Fire.................................................................166 Height Increase (Power)..............................235
Dragon Breath (Power)................................234 Fireball (Spell)...............................................114 Helpless Targets............................................179
Dragon Form (Power).................................234 First Aid.........................................................183 Hex-Maps......................................................189
Drowning......................................................166 First Aid (Skill)...............................................63 Hide in Shadows.................................46, 53, 56
Druid................................................................30 Flail.................................................... 68, 74, 148 Hirelings........................................................156
Druid Spells.....................................................95 Flesh to Stone (Spell)...................................133 History (Skill).................................................64

404
Index
Hit Points.........................................................18 Know Alignment (Spell)..............................118 Massmorph (Spell)....................................... 121
Hoist...............................................................160 Material Resources.......................................206
Hold Animal (Spell).....................................116 L Maze (Spell)..................................................122
Hold Monster (Spell)...................................116 Mercenaries................................................... 157
Hold Person (Spell)......................................116 Lack of Power Points....................................246 Merging Armies............................................ 217
Hold Portal (Spell).......................................116 Ladder............................................................160 Metal to Wood (Spell)..................................122
Holidays.........................................................209 Lance................................................. 68, 77, 148 Meteor Swarm (Spell)..................................122
Holy Symbol..................................................146 Language (Skill)..............................................65 Mind Barrier (Spell).....................................122
Holy Water....................................................146 Lantern..........................................................146 Mindmask (Spell).........................................112
Holy Word (Spell)........................................116 lanterns..........................................................163 Mind of the Beast........................................... 47
Home Plane...................................................233 Laws (Skill)......................................................65 Mirror............................................................146
Hook................................................................90 Learning New Spells....................................185 Mirror Image (Spell)....................................122
Howl (Power)................................................235 Learning Weapon Feats...............................185 Missile Range..................................................90
Hurled Weapons...........................................178 Leather Armour............................................149 Missile Weapons.............................................68
Hurl Range......................................................90 Leech (Power)...............................................235 Money............................................................145
Lesser Avatar........................................ 241, 242 Monster............................................................16
I Level.................................................................13 Monster Leaders...........................................262
Levels.............................................................184 Monsters........................................................ 257
Ice Storm (Spell)...........................................116 Levitate (Spell)..............................................118 Morale............................................................180
Immortal Eye (Spell)....................................250 Light & Darkness..........................................163 Morning Star.................................... 68, 78, 148
Immortality.......................................... 231, 239 Lightning Bolt (Spell)..................................119 Mortal Form..................................................243
Immortal Level Spells.................................. 247 Light (Spell)...........................................119, 163 Mountebank.................................................... 51
Immortals...................................................... 231 Lip Reading (Skill).........................................65 Mounts...........................................................194
Immunity (Spell).......................................... 117 Liquid Body...................................................224 Move Earth (Spell).......................................123
Imperial Prince.............................................204 Loading............................................................ 67 Move Silently.......................................46, 53, 56
Improve Ability (Spell)................................250 Locate Object (Spell)....................................119 Moving Armies............................................. 217
Improved Saving Throws (Power)..............235 Locate (Spell)................................................119
Increased Damage (Power).........................235 Locked Door.................................................165 N
Increased Movement Rate (Power)............235 Longship........................................................152
Increase Spell Duration (Spell)...................250 Lore (Spell)....................................................119 Nature Lore (Skill)..........................................65
infravision.....................................................163 Lost Souls......................................................239 Navigating (Skill)............................................65
Infravision.................................................35, 39 Lower Water (Spell).....................................120 Net..................................................... 68, 78, 149
Infravision (Spell)......................................... 117 Luminiferous Aether........................... 221, 228 Neutralise Poison (Spell).............................123
Initiative.........................................................172 Lupine..............................................................44 Nimble.............................................................43
Inner Planes..................................................225 Lupine Form (Power)..................................236 Nobility..........................................................203
Insect Plague (Spell)..................................... 117 Non-Player Character....................................16
Intelligence..............................................16, 258 M Normal Darkness.........................................163
Intimidation (Skill)........................................64 Normal Door................................................165
Invest Cleric (Spell)......................................250 Mace.................................................. 68, 77, 148 Normal Light................................................163
Invisibility 10’ Radius (Spell)...................... 117 Magical Engineering (Skill)..........................65 Noticing Things............................................164
Invisibility (Spell)......................................... 117 Magical Healing............................................183
Invisible Stalker (Spell)................................ 117 Magically Locked Door...............................165 O
Ironform (Spell)............................................118 Magic Door (Spell).......................................120
Iron Spike......................................................146 Magic Item Costs..........................................359 Obliterate (Spell)..........................................129
Item Use...........................................................54 Magic Items...................................................359 Obscure (Spell).............................................123
Magic Jar (Spell)...........................................120 Off-hand..........................................................90
J Magic Lock (Spell).......................................120 Off Hand........................................................176
Magic Missile (Spell)....................................120 Oil...................................................................146
Javelin................................................ 68, 76, 148 Magic-user.......................................................49 One Handed Melee Weapons.......................68
Jewellery......................................................... 357 Magic-user Spells........................................... 97 One-way Door..............................................165
Jumping (Skill)................................................64 Manifest Form..............................................243 Open Locks.....................................................54
Mantlet...........................................................160 Open Mind (Spell).......................................122
K Mapping.........................................................169 Outer Planes.................................................. 227
Maps.......................................................189, 363 Overland Movement....................................189
King................................................................204 Marquis..........................................................203
Knight............................................................203 Mass Charm (Spell)...................................... 121 P
Knockout.........................................................90 Mass Combat................................................216
Knock (Spell)................................................118 Mass Invisibility (Spell)............................... 121 Parry...............................................................174

405
Index
Pass Plant (Spell)..........................................123 Raft.................................................................153 Set.....................................................................90
Passwall (Spell).............................................123 Raise Dead Fully (Spell)..............................128 Set Spear........................................................175
Peasant Militia..............................................209 Raise Dead (Spell)........................................128 Settled Terrain..............................................206
Pellets.............................................................146 Range.............................................................176 Shadow Predator............................................ 47
Performance (Skill)........................................65 Ranger.............................................................. 41 Shaman............................................................96
Permanence (Spell)......................................123 Rations........................................................... 147 Shamans.........................................................262
Petrification...................................................183 Reaction Rolls............................................... 167 Shaman Spells.................................................96
Phantasmal Force (Spell).............................124 Read Languages.............................................. 57 Shapechange (Spell)..................................... 131
Pick Pockets..............................................53, 56 Read Languages (Spell)................................129 Shape Reality (Spell).................................... 251
Pike.................................................... 68, 79, 149 Read Magic......................................................38 Shield, Buckler................................. 68, 80, 149
Pin (Aura Attack).........................................246 Read Magic (Spell).................................50, 129 Shield, Normal................................. 68, 81, 149
Pistol.................................................. 68, 79, 149 Red Powder................................................... 147 Shields......................................................68, 376
Planar Anchor Point............................221, 227 Reduce Saving Throw (Spell)...................... 251 Shield (Spell)................................................. 131
Planets................................................... 221, 224 Reincarnation (Spell)...................................129 Shield, Tower.................................... 68, 81, 149
Plant Door (Spell)........................................124 Religion............................................................24 Ship’s Ram.....................................................160
Plate Mail.......................................................150 Religious Lore (Skill).....................................66 Ship to Ship Combat....................................193
Plot Goals......................................................184 Remove Barrier (Spell)................................ 101 Shrink Plants (Spell)....................................115
Poison (Power).............................................236 Remove Charm (Spell)................................ 121 Shroud (Aura Attack)..................................246
Pole................................................................. 147 Remove Curse (Spell)..................................130 Siege Weaponry............................................159
Poleaxe.............................................. 68, 80, 149 Remove Fear (Spell).....................................130 Silence 15’ Radius (Spell)............................ 131
Polymorph Any Object (Spell)...................125 Remove Geas (Spell)....................................115 Skewer..............................................................90
Polymorph Other (Spell).............................125 Remove Quest (Spell)..................................128 Skiff................................................................154
Polymorph Self (Spell).................................125 Remove Traps...........................................46, 54 Skill...................................................................59
Population Change.......................................208 Repairing Ships.............................................194 Skysailing...................................... 153, 194, 224
Potions........................................................... 361 Research......................................................... 187 Skysailing Combat........................................196
Power Points.................................................246 Resist Cold (Spell)........................................130 Sleep (Spell)................................................... 131
Power Reserve...................................... 241, 382 Resist Fire (Spell)..........................................130 Sling................................................... 68, 82, 149
Power Word Blind (Spell)...........................125 Resource Income..........................................208 Sloop..............................................................154
Power Word Kill (Spell)...............................126 Restore (Spell)...............................................130 Slow................................................................ 177
Power Word Stun (Spell).............................126 Reverse Gravity (Spell)................................ 131 Slowed............................................................ 177
Predict Weather (Spell)................................126 Reversible Spells.............................................99 Slow (Spell)...................................................115
Preparing Spells..............................................99 Riding (Skill)...................................................66 Small................................................................43
Prime Plane................................................... 221 Rings..............................................................370 Smash.............................................................175
Prince.............................................................204 River Barge....................................................153 Smoothbore...................................... 68, 82, 149
Prismatic Wall (Spell)..................................126 Rods...............................................................366 Snake Charm (Spell)....................................132
Probe Shield (Spell)...................................... 251 Rogue States..................................................205 Snap (Power).................................................236
Probe (Spell)..................................................250 Rope............................................................... 147 Sneak Attack...................................................54
Produce Fire (Spell)..................................... 127 Round......................................................17, 171 Sneak Attacks................................................178
Proficiency Levels........................................... 67 Rowing Boat..................................................153 Social Skills......................................................60
Projected Image (Spell)............................... 127 Ruling a Dominion...................................... 207 Solar System.................................................. 221
Protection from Evil 10’ Radius (Spell)..... 127 Run.................................................................175 Solid Body.....................................................224
Protection from Evil (Spell)........................ 127 Sorcerer............................................................96
Protection from Lightning (Spell).............. 127 S Sorcerers........................................................262
Protection from Normal Missiles (Spell).. 127 Sorcerer Spells.................................................98
Protection from Poison (Spell)...................128 Sack................................................................ 147 Speak with Animals....................................... 47
Public Works.................................................210 Saddle.............................................................152 Speak with Animal (Spell)..........................132
Purify Food and Water (Spell)....................128 Saddle Bags...................................................152 Speak with Anyone........................................ 47
Purse.............................................................. 147 Sail of Skysailing.................................. 153, 194 Speak with Dead (Spell)..............................132
Salt Tax.................................................. 208, 209 Speak with Monsters (Spell).......................132
Q Saving Throw..................................................18 Speak with Plants (Spell).............................132
Saving Throws...............................................100 Spear.................................................. 68, 83, 149
Quest (Spell)...........................................49, 128 Scale Mail......................................................150 Specialists...................................................... 157
Quinquirime.................................................153 Scrolls.............................................................363 Special Items................................................. 357
Quiver............................................................ 147 Searching.......................................................165 Special Movement........................................163
Secret Door...................................................165 Special Skills.................................................... 61
R Self Healing..................................................... 47 Spell..................................................................93
Sense Motive (Skill).......................................66 Spell Book................................... 38, 50, 94, 147
Radiating Body.............................................224 Service Income.............................................208 Spell Domains.................................................96

406
Index
Spell Level........................................................93 Teleport Any Object (Spell)........................136 Use Non-activatable Item............................175
Spell Research............................................... 187 Teleport (Spell).............................................136 Using an Artifact.......................................... 381
Spell Resistance.............................30, 36, 43, 47 Tent................................................................. 147
Spending Experience...................................239 Terrain....................................................190, 206 V
Spirit Form............................................231, 243 Thaumaturges..................................................98
Spit Poison (Power)......................................236 The Void.........................................................222 Ventriloquism (Spell)...................................138
Splitting Armies............................................ 217 Thief..................................................................54 Vessels....................................................231, 241
Staff.................................................... 68, 83, 149 Thief Abilities (Power).................................236 Viscount.........................................................203
Starting Money.............................................145 Thieves’ Tools................................................ 147 Voidspeed......................................................224
Statement of Intent....................................... 171 Throw Range................................................... 91
Statue (Spell).................................................132 Thrust (Aura Attack)....................................246 W
Staves..............................................................366 Timber Fort...................................................160
Steelform (Spell)...........................................133 Time & Movement.......................................163 Wagon............................................................152
Sticks to Snakes (Spell)................................133 Timestop (Spell)........................................... 137 Wall of Fire (Spell)........................................138
Stoneform (Spell).........................................133 Tinder Box..................................................... 147 Wall of Ice (Spell)..........................................116
Stonelore.......................................................... 35 Tithes..............................................................209 Wall of Iron (Spell).......................................138
Stone to Flesh (Spell)...................................133 Titles of Nobility...........................................203 Wall of Stone (Spell).....................................138
Storms............................................................193 Torch.............................................................. 147 Wandering Monsters.................................... 167
Strangle............................................................90 Torches...........................................................163 Wands.............................................................366
Strategy............................................................ 41 Tracking (Skill)...............................................66 Warlocks..........................................................98
Strength...........................................................16 Training.........................................................185 Warlord............................................................ 41
Striking (Spell)..............................................134 Transform (Spell)..........................................253 Warp Wood (Spell).......................................138
Strongholds...................................................205 Transport Through Plants (Spell)............... 137 Waterborne Movement................................192
Structures in Combat...................................180 Trap................................................................152 Water Breathing (Spell)................................139
Stuck Door....................................................165 Traps...............................................................165 Waterskin....................................................... 147
Stun.................................................................. 91 Travel (Spell)................................................. 137 Weak Magic.....................................................54
Suffocating.....................................................166 Treasure.................................................184, 357 Weapon Abilities.............................................89
Suit Armour..................................................150 Treasure Types.............................................. 357 Weapon Expertise (Power)..........................236
Summon Animals (Spell)............................134 Trebuchet....................................................... 161 Weapon Feats..........................................67, 185
Summon Elemental (Spell).........................134 Trident............................................... 68, 86, 149 Weapons......................................................... 377
Summon Object (Spell)...............................134 Trireme..........................................................154 Weather Control (Spell)...............................139
Summon Weapons (Power)........................236 Troops............................................................209 Web (Spell)....................................................139
Summon Weather (Spell)............................134 Troopship......................................................154 Whip.................................................. 68, 88, 149
Surprise.......................................................... 171 Truesight (Spell)........................................... 137 Wilderness.....................................................189
Survival (Spell).............................................135 Turn Undead...................................................25 Wilderness Encounters................................ 197
Swimming (Skill)............................................66 Turn Undead (Power)..................................236 Wind & Storms.............................................193
Swoop (Power)..............................................236 Turn Wood (Spell)........................................138 Wind Walker (Spell).....................................139
Sword, Bastard................................. 68, 84, 149 Two Handed Melee Weapons.......................68 Wisdom............................................................16
Sword, Normal................................. 68, 85, 149 Two Weapon Fighting..................................178 Wish (Spell)...................................................139
Sword, Short..................................... 68, 85, 149 Wizard Eye (Spell)........................................140
Sword (Spell).................................................135 U Wizard Lock (Spell)......................................140
Sword, Two-handed........................ 68, 86, 149 Wizardry (Spell)...........................................140
Symbol (Spell)...............................................135 Unarmed Strike..............................................68 Wizards............................................................98
Undead Lieges............................................... 261 Wondrous Items............................................372
T Unobtrusive.....................................................43 Woodform (Spell).........................................140
Unseen Attacks............................................. 177 Word of Recall (Spell).................................. 141
Tack................................................................152 Unseen Target............................................... 177 Worshippers......................................... 233, 239
Telekinesis (Spell).........................................135 Use Magic-user Scroll.................................... 57 Wrestling..........................................................88

407
Open Game License
Designation of Open Content
Dark Dungeons uses several terms and names that are Copyright 2000-2003 Wizards of the Coast, Inc. These terms are used under the
terms of the Open Game License v1.0a, and are designated as Open Content by that license.

Other than those terms and names, all original text in Dark Dungeons is hereby placed in the Public Domain.

All artwork found in Dark Dungeons is taken from, or derivative of artwork taken from, the Public Domain.

Derivative artwork in Dark Dungeons is hereby placed in the Public Domain.

OPEN GAME LICENSE Version 1.0a


The following text is the property of Wizards of the Coast, Inc. and is Copyright 2000 Wizards of the Coast, Inc (“Wizards”). All Rights
Reserved.

1. Definitions: (a)”Contributors” means the copyright and/or trademark owners who have contributed Open Game Content; (b)”Derivative
Material” means copyrighted material including derivative works and translations (including into other computer languages), potation,
modification, correction, addition, extension, upgrade, improvement, compilation, abridgment or other form in which an existing
work may be recast, transformed or adapted; (c) “Distribute” means to reproduce, license, rent, lease, sell, broadcast, publicly display,
transmit or otherwise distribute; (d)”Open Game Content” means the game mechanic and includes the methods, procedures, processes
and routines to the extent such content does not embody the Product Identity and is an enhancement over the prior art and any ad-
ditional content clearly identified as Open Game Content by the Contributor, and means any work covered by this License, including
translations and derivative works under copyright law, but specifically excludes Product Identity. (e) “Product Identity” means product
and product line names, logos and identifying marks including trade dress; artifacts; creatures characters; stories, storylines, plots, the-
matic elements, dialogue, incidents, language, artwork, symbols, designs, depictions, likenesses, formats, poses, concepts, themes and
graphic, photographic and other visual or audio representations; names and descriptions of characters, spells, enchantments, personalities,
teams, personas, likenesses and special abilities; places, locations, environments, creatures, equipment, magical or supernatural abilities
or effects, logos, symbols, or graphic designs; and any other trademark or registered trademark clearly identified as Product identity by
the owner of the Product Identity, and which specifically excludes the Open Game Content; (f ) “Trademark” means the logos, names,
mark, sign, motto, designs that are used by a Contributor to identify itself or its products or the associated products contributed to the
Open Game License by the Contributor (g) “Use”, “Used” or “Using” means to use, Distribute, copy, edit, format, modify, translate
and otherwise create Derivative Material of Open Game Content. (h) “You” or “Your” means the licensee in terms of this agreement.

2. The License: This License applies to any Open Game Content that contains a notice indicating that the Open Game Content may
only be Used under and in terms of this License. You must affix such a notice to any Open Game Content that you Use. No terms may
be added to or subtracted from this License except as described by the License itself. No other terms or conditions may be applied to
any Open Game Content distributed using this License.

3. Offer and Acceptance: By Using the Open Game Content You indicate Your acceptance of the terms of this License.

4. Grant and Consideration: In consideration for agreeing to use this License, the Contributors grant You a perpetual, worldwide,
royalty-free, non-exclusive license with the exact terms of this License to Use, the Open Game Content.

5. Representation of Authority to Contribute: If You are contributing original material as Open Game Content, You represent that Your
Contributions are Your original creation and/or You have sufficient rights to grant the rights conveyed by this License.

6. Notice of License Copyright: You must update the COPYRIGHT NOTICE portion of this License to include the exact text of the
COPYRIGHT NOTICE of any Open Game Content You are copying, modifying or distributing, and You must add the title, the
copyright date, and the copyright holder’s name to the COPYRIGHT NOTICE of any original Open Game Content you Distribute.

7. Use of Product Identity: You agree not to Use any Product Identity, including as an indication as to compatibility, except as expressly
licensed in another, independent Agreement with the owner of each element of that Product Identity. You agree not to indicate com-
patibility or co-adaptability with any Trademark or Registered Trademark in conjunction with a work containing Open Game Content
except as expressly licensed in another, independent Agreement with the owner of such Trademark or Registered Trademark. The use of
any Product Identity in Open Game Content does not constitute a challenge to the ownership of that Product Identity. The owner of
any Product Identity used in Open Game Content shall retain all rights, title and interest in and to that Product Identity.

409
Open Game License
8. Identification: If you distribute Open Game Content You must clearly indicate which portions of the work that you are distributing
are Open Game Content.

9. Updating the License: Wizards or its designated Agents may publish updated versions of this License. You may use any authorized
version of this License to copy, modify and distribute any Open Game Content originally distributed under any version of this License.

10 Copy of this License: You MUST include a copy of this License with every copy of the Open Game Content You Distribute.

11. Use of Contributor Credits: You may not market or advertise the Open Game Content using the name of any Contributor unless
You have written permission from the Contributor to do so.

12 Inability to Comply: If it is impossible for You to comply with any of the terms of this License with respect to some or all of the Open
Game Content due to statute, judicial order, or governmental regulation then You may not Use any Open Game Material so affected.

13 Termination: This License will terminate automatically if You fail to comply with all terms herein and fail to cure such breach within
30 days of becoming aware of the breach. All sublicenses shall survive the termination of this License.

14 Reformation: If any provision of this License is held to be unenforceable, such provision shall be reformed only to the extent neces-
sary to make it enforceable.

15 COPYRIGHT NOTICE

Open Game License v 1.0 Copyright 2000, Wizards of the Coast, Inc.

System Reference Document Copyright 2000, Wizards of the Coast, Inc.; Authors: Jonathon Tweet, Monte Cook, Skip Williams, based
on original material by E. Gary Gygax and Dave Arneson.

System Reference Document Copyright 2000-2003, Wizards of the Coast, Inc.; Authors: Jonathan Tweet, Monte Cook, Skip Williams,
Rich Baker, Andy Collins, David Noonan, Rich Redman, Bruce R. Cordell, John D. Rateliff, Thomas Reid, James Wyatt, based on
original material by E. Gary Gygax and Dave Arneson.

Dark Dungeons published 2010-2020, no Copyright is asserted on the original text found in this work.

410

You might also like